Fix "breakpoint always-inserted off"; remove "breakpoint always-inserted auto"
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988-2014 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 @c
4 @c %**start of header
5 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
6 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
7 @setfilename gdb.info
8 @c
9 @c man begin INCLUDE
10 @include gdb-cfg.texi
11 @c man end
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @c To avoid file-name clashes between index.html and Index.html, when
24 @c the manual is produced on a Posix host and then moved to a
25 @c case-insensitive filesystem (e.g., MS-Windows), we separate the
26 @c indices into two: Concept Index and all the rest.
27 @syncodeindex ky fn
28 @syncodeindex tp fn
29
30 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
31 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
32 @syncodeindex vr fn
33
34 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
35 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
36 @set EDITION Tenth
37
38 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
39 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
40
41 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
42
43 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
44 @c manuals to an info tree.
45 @dircategory Software development
46 @direntry
47 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
48 * gdbserver: (gdb) Server. The GNU debugging server.
49 @end direntry
50
51 @copying
52 @c man begin COPYRIGHT
53 Copyright @copyright{} 1988-2014 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
54
55 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
56 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
57 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
58 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
59 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
60 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
61
62 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
63 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
64 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
65 @c man end
66 @end copying
67
68 @ifnottex
69 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
70
71 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
72 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
73 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
74 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
75 @end ifset
76 Version @value{GDBVN}.
77
78 @insertcopying
79 @end ifnottex
80
81 @titlepage
82 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
83 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
84 @sp 1
85 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
86 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
87 @sp 1
88 @subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
89 @end ifset
90 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
91 @page
92 @tex
93 {\parskip=0pt
94 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.)\par
95 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
96 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
97 }
98 @end tex
99
100 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
101 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
102 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
103 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
104 ISBN 978-0-9831592-3-0 @*
105
106 @insertcopying
107 @end titlepage
108 @page
109
110 @ifnottex
111 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
112
113 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
114
115 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
116
117 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN}
118 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
119 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
120 @end ifset
121 Version @value{GDBVN}.
122
123 Copyright (C) 1988-2014 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
124
125 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
126 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
127 software in general. We will miss him.
128
129 @menu
130 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
131 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
132
133 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
134 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
135 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
136 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
137 * Reverse Execution:: Running programs backward
138 * Process Record and Replay:: Recording inferior's execution and replaying it
139 * Stack:: Examining the stack
140 * Source:: Examining source files
141 * Data:: Examining data
142 * Optimized Code:: Debugging optimized code
143 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
144 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
145 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
146
147 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
148
149 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
150 * Altering:: Altering execution
151 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
152 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
153 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
154 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
155 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
156 * Extending GDB:: Extending @value{GDBN}
157 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
158 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
159 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
160 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
161 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
162 * JIT Interface:: Using the JIT debugging interface.
163 * In-Process Agent:: In-Process Agent
164
165 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
166
167 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
168 * Command Line Editing: (rluserman). Command Line Editing
169 * Using History Interactively: (history). Using History Interactively
170 @end ifset
171 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
172 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
173 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
174 @end ifclear
175 * In Memoriam:: In Memoriam
176 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
177 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
178 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
179 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
180 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
181 * Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
182 @value{GDBN}
183 * Operating System Information:: Getting additional information from
184 the operating system
185 * Trace File Format:: GDB trace file format
186 * Index Section Format:: .gdb_index section format
187 * Man Pages:: Manual pages
188 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
189 how you can copy and share GDB
190 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
191 * Concept Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} concepts
192 * Command and Variable Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} commands, variables,
193 functions, and Python data types
194 @end menu
195
196 @end ifnottex
197
198 @contents
199
200 @node Summary
201 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
202
203 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
204 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
205 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
206
207 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
208 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
209
210 @itemize @bullet
211 @item
212 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
213
214 @item
215 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
216
217 @item
218 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
219
220 @item
221 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
222 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
223 @end itemize
224
225 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
226 For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
227 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
228
229 Support for D is partial. For information on D, see
230 @ref{D,,D}.
231
232 @cindex Modula-2
233 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
234 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
235
236 Support for OpenCL C is partial. For information on OpenCL C, see
237 @ref{OpenCL C,,OpenCL C}.
238
239 @cindex Pascal
240 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
241 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
242 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
243 syntax.
244
245 @cindex Fortran
246 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
247 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
248 underscore.
249
250 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
251 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
252
253 @menu
254 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
255 * Free Documentation:: Free Software Needs Free Documentation
256 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
257 @end menu
258
259 @node Free Software
260 @unnumberedsec Free Software
261
262 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
263 General Public License
264 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
265 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
266 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
267 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
268 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
269 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
270
271 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
272 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
273 from anyone else.
274
275 @node Free Documentation
276 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
277
278 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
279 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
280 include with the free software. Many of our most important
281 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
282 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
283 when an important free software package does not come with a free
284 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
285 gaps today.
286
287 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
288 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
289 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
290 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
291 them from the free software world.
292
293 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
294 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
295 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
296 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
297 contract to make it non-free.
298
299 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
300 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
301 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
302 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
303 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
304 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
305 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
306
307 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
308 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
309 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
310 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
311
312 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
313 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
314 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
315 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
316 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
317 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
318 community.
319
320 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
321 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
322 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
323 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
324 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
325 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
326 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
327 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
328 of the manual.
329
330 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
331 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
332 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
333 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
334 manual to replace it.
335
336 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
337 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
338 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
339 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
340 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
341 the free software community.
342
343 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
344 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
345 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
346 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
347 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
348 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
349 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
350 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
351 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
352
353 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
354 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
355 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
356 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
357 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
358 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
359 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
360 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
361
362 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
363 published by other publishers, at
364 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
365
366 @node Contributors
367 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
368
369 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
370 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
371 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
372 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
373 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
374 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
375 blow-by-blow account.
376
377 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
378
379 @quotation
380 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
381 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
382 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
383 @end quotation
384
385 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
386 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
387 releases:
388 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
389 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
390 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
391 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
392 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
393 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
394 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
395 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
396 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
397
398 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
399 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
400
401 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
402 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
403 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
404 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
405 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
406
407 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
408 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
409 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
410
411 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
412 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
413
414 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
415
416 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
417 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
418 support.
419 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
420 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
421 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
422 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
423 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
424 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
425 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
426 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
427 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
428 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
429 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
430 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
431 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
432 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
433 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
434 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
435
436 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
437
438 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
439 libraries.
440
441 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
442 about several machine instruction sets.
443
444 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
445 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
446 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
447 and RDI targets, respectively.
448
449 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
450 command-line editing and command history.
451
452 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
453 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
454
455 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
456 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
457 symbols.
458
459 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
460 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
461
462 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
463
464 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
465 processors.
466
467 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
468
469 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
470
471 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
472
473 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
474 watchpoints.
475
476 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
477
478 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
479
480 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
481 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
482
483 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
484 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
485 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
486 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
487 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
488 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
489 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
490
491 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
492 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
493
494 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
495 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
496 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
497 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
498 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
499 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
500 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
501 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
502 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
503 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
504 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
505 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
506 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
507 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
508 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
509
510 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
511 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
512
513 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
514 Hat.
515
516 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
517 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
518 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
519 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
520 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
521 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
522
523 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
524 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
525 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
526 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
527 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
528 trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
529 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
530 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
531 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
532 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
533 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
534 Weigand.
535
536 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
537 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
538 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
539 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
540
541 Michael Eager and staff of Xilinx, Inc., contributed support for the
542 Xilinx MicroBlaze architecture.
543
544 @node Sample Session
545 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
546
547 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
548 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
549 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
550
551 @iftex
552 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
553 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
554 @end iftex
555
556 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
557 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
558
559 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
560 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
561 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
562 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
563 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
564 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
565 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
566 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
567 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
568
569 @smallexample
570 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
571 $ @b{./m4}
572 @b{define(foo,0000)}
573
574 @b{foo}
575 0000
576 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
577
578 @b{bar}
579 0000
580 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
581
582 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
583 @b{baz}
584 @b{Ctrl-d}
585 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
586 @end smallexample
587
588 @noindent
589 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
590
591 @smallexample
592 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
593 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
594 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
595 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
596 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
597 the conditions.
598 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
599 for details.
600
601 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
602 (@value{GDBP})
603 @end smallexample
604
605 @noindent
606 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
607 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
608 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
609 that examples fit in this manual.
610
611 @smallexample
612 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
613 @end smallexample
614
615 @noindent
616 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
617 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
618 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
619 @code{break} command.
620
621 @smallexample
622 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
623 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
624 @end smallexample
625
626 @noindent
627 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
628 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
629 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
630
631 @smallexample
632 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
633 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
634 @b{define(foo,0000)}
635
636 @b{foo}
637 0000
638 @end smallexample
639
640 @noindent
641 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
642 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
643 context where it stops.
644
645 @smallexample
646 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
647
648 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
649 at builtin.c:879
650 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
651 @end smallexample
652
653 @noindent
654 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
655 the next line of the current function.
656
657 @smallexample
658 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
659 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
660 : nil,
661 @end smallexample
662
663 @noindent
664 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
665 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
666 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
667 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
668
669 @smallexample
670 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
671 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
672 at input.c:530
673 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
674 @end smallexample
675
676 @noindent
677 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
678 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
679 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
680 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
681 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
682 stack frame for each active subroutine.
683
684 @smallexample
685 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
686 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
687 at input.c:530
688 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
689 at builtin.c:882
690 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
691 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
692 at macro.c:71
693 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
694 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
695 @end smallexample
696
697 @noindent
698 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
699 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
700 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
701
702 @smallexample
703 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
704 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
705 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
706 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
707 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
708 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
709 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
710 : xstrdup(rq);
711 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
712 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
713 @end smallexample
714
715 @noindent
716 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
717 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
718 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
719 (@code{print}) to see their values.
720
721 @smallexample
722 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
723 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
724 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
725 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
726 @end smallexample
727
728 @noindent
729 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
730 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
731 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
732
733 @smallexample
734 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
735 533 xfree(rquote);
736 534
737 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
738 : xstrdup (lq);
739 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
740 : xstrdup (rq);
741 537
742 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
743 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
744 540 @}
745 541
746 542 void
747 @end smallexample
748
749 @noindent
750 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
751 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
752
753 @smallexample
754 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
755 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
756 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
757 540 @}
758 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
759 $3 = 9
760 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
761 $4 = 7
762 @end smallexample
763
764 @noindent
765 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
766 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
767 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
768 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
769 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
770 assignments.
771
772 @smallexample
773 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
774 $5 = 7
775 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
776 $6 = 9
777 @end smallexample
778
779 @noindent
780 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
781 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
782 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
783 example that caused trouble initially:
784
785 @smallexample
786 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
787 Continuing.
788
789 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
790
791 baz
792 0000
793 @end smallexample
794
795 @noindent
796 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
797 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
798 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
799
800 @smallexample
801 @b{Ctrl-d}
802 Program exited normally.
803 @end smallexample
804
805 @noindent
806 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
807 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
808 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
809
810 @smallexample
811 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
812 @end smallexample
813
814 @node Invocation
815 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
816
817 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
818 The essentials are:
819 @itemize @bullet
820 @item
821 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
822 @item
823 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
824 @end itemize
825
826 @menu
827 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
828 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
829 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
830 * Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
831 @end menu
832
833 @node Invoking GDB
834 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
835
836 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
837 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
838
839 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
840 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
841
842 The command-line options described here are designed
843 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
844 options may effectively be unavailable.
845
846 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
847 specifying an executable program:
848
849 @smallexample
850 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
851 @end smallexample
852
853 @noindent
854 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
855 specified:
856
857 @smallexample
858 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
859 @end smallexample
860
861 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
862 to debug a running process:
863
864 @smallexample
865 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
866 @end smallexample
867
868 @noindent
869 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
870 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
871
872 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
873 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
874 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
875 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
876 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
877
878 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
879 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
880 option processing.
881 @smallexample
882 @value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
883 @end smallexample
884 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
885 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
886
887 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
888 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{--silent}
889 (or @code{-q}/@code{--quiet}):
890
891 @smallexample
892 @value{GDBP} --silent
893 @end smallexample
894
895 @noindent
896 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
897 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
898
899 @noindent
900 Type
901
902 @smallexample
903 @value{GDBP} -help
904 @end smallexample
905
906 @noindent
907 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
908 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
909
910 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
911 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
912 @samp{-x} option is used.
913
914
915 @menu
916 * File Options:: Choosing files
917 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
918 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
919 @end menu
920
921 @node File Options
922 @subsection Choosing Files
923
924 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
925 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
926 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
927 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
928 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
929 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
930 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
931 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
932 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
933 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
934 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
935 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
936 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
937
938 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
939 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
940 argument and ignore it.
941
942 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
943 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
944 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
945 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
946 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
947
948 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
949 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
950 @c it.
951
952 @table @code
953 @item -symbols @var{file}
954 @itemx -s @var{file}
955 @cindex @code{--symbols}
956 @cindex @code{-s}
957 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
958
959 @item -exec @var{file}
960 @itemx -e @var{file}
961 @cindex @code{--exec}
962 @cindex @code{-e}
963 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
964 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
965
966 @item -se @var{file}
967 @cindex @code{--se}
968 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
969 file.
970
971 @item -core @var{file}
972 @itemx -c @var{file}
973 @cindex @code{--core}
974 @cindex @code{-c}
975 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
976
977 @item -pid @var{number}
978 @itemx -p @var{number}
979 @cindex @code{--pid}
980 @cindex @code{-p}
981 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
982
983 @item -command @var{file}
984 @itemx -x @var{file}
985 @cindex @code{--command}
986 @cindex @code{-x}
987 Execute commands from file @var{file}. The contents of this file is
988 evaluated exactly as the @code{source} command would.
989 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
990
991 @item -eval-command @var{command}
992 @itemx -ex @var{command}
993 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
994 @cindex @code{-ex}
995 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
996
997 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
998 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
999
1000 @smallexample
1001 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
1002 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
1003 @end smallexample
1004
1005 @item -init-command @var{file}
1006 @itemx -ix @var{file}
1007 @cindex @code{--init-command}
1008 @cindex @code{-ix}
1009 Execute commands from file @var{file} before loading the inferior (but
1010 after loading gdbinit files).
1011 @xref{Startup}.
1012
1013 @item -init-eval-command @var{command}
1014 @itemx -iex @var{command}
1015 @cindex @code{--init-eval-command}
1016 @cindex @code{-iex}
1017 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command before loading the inferior (but
1018 after loading gdbinit files).
1019 @xref{Startup}.
1020
1021 @item -directory @var{directory}
1022 @itemx -d @var{directory}
1023 @cindex @code{--directory}
1024 @cindex @code{-d}
1025 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
1026
1027 @item -r
1028 @itemx -readnow
1029 @cindex @code{--readnow}
1030 @cindex @code{-r}
1031 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
1032 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
1033 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
1034
1035 @end table
1036
1037 @node Mode Options
1038 @subsection Choosing Modes
1039
1040 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
1041 batch mode or quiet mode.
1042
1043 @table @code
1044 @anchor{-nx}
1045 @item -nx
1046 @itemx -n
1047 @cindex @code{--nx}
1048 @cindex @code{-n}
1049 Do not execute commands found in any initialization file.
1050 There are three init files, loaded in the following order:
1051
1052 @table @code
1053 @item @file{system.gdbinit}
1054 This is the system-wide init file.
1055 Its location is specified with the @code{--with-system-gdbinit}
1056 configure option (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
1057 It is loaded first when @value{GDBN} starts, before command line options
1058 have been processed.
1059 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}
1060 This is the init file in your home directory.
1061 It is loaded next, after @file{system.gdbinit}, and before
1062 command options have been processed.
1063 @item @file{./.gdbinit}
1064 This is the init file in the current directory.
1065 It is loaded last, after command line options other than @code{-x} and
1066 @code{-ex} have been processed. Command line options @code{-x} and
1067 @code{-ex} are processed last, after @file{./.gdbinit} has been loaded.
1068 @end table
1069
1070 For further documentation on startup processing, @xref{Startup}.
1071 For documentation on how to write command files,
1072 @xref{Command Files,,Command Files}.
1073
1074 @anchor{-nh}
1075 @item -nh
1076 @cindex @code{--nh}
1077 Do not execute commands found in @file{~/.gdbinit}, the init file
1078 in your home directory.
1079 @xref{Startup}.
1080
1081 @item -quiet
1082 @itemx -silent
1083 @itemx -q
1084 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1085 @cindex @code{--silent}
1086 @cindex @code{-q}
1087 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1088 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1089
1090 @item -batch
1091 @cindex @code{--batch}
1092 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1093 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1094 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1095 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1096 in the command files. Batch mode also disables pagination, sets unlimited
1097 terminal width and height @pxref{Screen Size}, and acts as if @kbd{set confirm
1098 off} were in effect (@pxref{Messages/Warnings}).
1099
1100 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1101 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1102 make this more useful, the message
1103
1104 @smallexample
1105 Program exited normally.
1106 @end smallexample
1107
1108 @noindent
1109 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1110 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1111 mode.
1112
1113 @item -batch-silent
1114 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1115 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1116 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1117 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1118 for an interactive session.
1119
1120 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1121 messages, for example.
1122
1123 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1124 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1125
1126 @item -return-child-result
1127 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1128 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1129 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1130
1131 @itemize @bullet
1132 @item
1133 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1134 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1135 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1136 @item
1137 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1138 @item
1139 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1140 the exit code will be -1.
1141 @end itemize
1142
1143 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1144 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1145 interface.
1146
1147 @item -nowindows
1148 @itemx -nw
1149 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1150 @cindex @code{-nw}
1151 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1152 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1153 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1154
1155 @item -windows
1156 @itemx -w
1157 @cindex @code{--windows}
1158 @cindex @code{-w}
1159 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1160 used if possible.
1161
1162 @item -cd @var{directory}
1163 @cindex @code{--cd}
1164 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1165 instead of the current directory.
1166
1167 @item -data-directory @var{directory}
1168 @itemx -D @var{directory}
1169 @cindex @code{--data-directory}
1170 @cindex @code{-D}
1171 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its data directory.
1172 The data directory is where @value{GDBN} searches for its
1173 auxiliary files. @xref{Data Files}.
1174
1175 @item -fullname
1176 @itemx -f
1177 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1178 @cindex @code{-f}
1179 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1180 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1181 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1182 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1183 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1184 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1185 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1186 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1187 frame.
1188
1189 @item -annotate @var{level}
1190 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1191 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1192 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1193 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1194 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1195 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1196 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1197 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1198 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1199
1200 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1201 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1202
1203 @item --args
1204 @cindex @code{--args}
1205 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1206 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1207 This option stops option processing.
1208
1209 @item -baud @var{bps}
1210 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1211 @cindex @code{--baud}
1212 @cindex @code{-b}
1213 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1214 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1215
1216 @item -l @var{timeout}
1217 @cindex @code{-l}
1218 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1219 for remote debugging.
1220
1221 @item -tty @var{device}
1222 @itemx -t @var{device}
1223 @cindex @code{--tty}
1224 @cindex @code{-t}
1225 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1226 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1227
1228 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1229 @item -tui
1230 @cindex @code{--tui}
1231 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1232 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1233 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1234 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Do not use this
1235 option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,
1236 Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1237
1238 @c @item -xdb
1239 @c @cindex @code{--xdb}
1240 @c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1241 @c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1242 @c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1243 @c systems.
1244
1245 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1246 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1247 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1248 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1249 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1250 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1251
1252 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1253 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1254 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1255 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1256 selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1257 @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1258
1259 @item -write
1260 @cindex @code{--write}
1261 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1262 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1263 (@pxref{Patching}).
1264
1265 @item -statistics
1266 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1267 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1268 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1269
1270 @item -version
1271 @cindex @code{--version}
1272 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1273 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1274
1275 @item -configuration
1276 @cindex @code{--configuration}
1277 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print details about its build-time
1278 configuration parameters, and then exit. These details can be
1279 important when reporting @value{GDBN} bugs (@pxref{GDB Bugs}).
1280
1281 @end table
1282
1283 @node Startup
1284 @subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1285 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1286
1287 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1288
1289 @enumerate
1290 @item
1291 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1292 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1293
1294 @item
1295 @cindex init file
1296 Reads the system-wide @dfn{init file} (if @option{--with-system-gdbinit} was
1297 used when building @value{GDBN}; @pxref{System-wide configuration,
1298 ,System-wide configuration and settings}) and executes all the commands in
1299 that file.
1300
1301 @anchor{Home Directory Init File}
1302 @item
1303 Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1304 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1305 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1306 that file.
1307
1308 @anchor{Option -init-eval-command}
1309 @item
1310 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-iex} and
1311 @samp{-ix} options in their specified order. Usually you should use the
1312 @samp{-ex} and @samp{-x} options instead, but this way you can apply
1313 settings before @value{GDBN} init files get executed and before inferior
1314 gets loaded.
1315
1316 @item
1317 Processes command line options and operands.
1318
1319 @anchor{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}
1320 @item
1321 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1322 working directory as long as @samp{set auto-load local-gdbinit} is set to
1323 @samp{on} (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory}).
1324 This is only done if the current directory is
1325 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1326 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1327 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1328 @value{GDBN}.
1329
1330 @item
1331 If the command line specified a program to debug, or a process to
1332 attach to, or a core file, @value{GDBN} loads any auto-loaded
1333 scripts provided for the program or for its loaded shared libraries.
1334 @xref{Auto-loading}.
1335
1336 If you wish to disable the auto-loading during startup,
1337 you must do something like the following:
1338
1339 @smallexample
1340 $ gdb -iex "set auto-load python-scripts off" myprogram
1341 @end smallexample
1342
1343 Option @samp{-ex} does not work because the auto-loading is then turned
1344 off too late.
1345
1346 @item
1347 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-ex} and
1348 @samp{-x} options in their specified order. @xref{Command Files}, for
1349 more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1350
1351 @item
1352 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1353 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1354 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1355 @end enumerate
1356
1357 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1358 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1359 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1360 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1361 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1362 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1363
1364 To display the list of init files loaded by gdb at startup, you
1365 can use @kbd{gdb --help}.
1366
1367 @cindex init file name
1368 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1369 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1370 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1371 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1372 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1373 port of @value{GDBN} uses the standard name, but if it finds a
1374 @file{gdb.ini} file in your home directory, it warns you about that
1375 and suggests to rename the file to the standard name.
1376
1377
1378 @node Quitting GDB
1379 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1380 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1381 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1382
1383 @table @code
1384 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1385 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1386 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1387 @itemx q
1388 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1389 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1390 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1391 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1392 error code.
1393 @end table
1394
1395 @cindex interrupt
1396 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1397 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1398 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1399 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1400 until a time when it is safe.
1401
1402 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1403 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1404 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1405
1406 @node Shell Commands
1407 @section Shell Commands
1408
1409 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1410 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1411 just use the @code{shell} command.
1412
1413 @table @code
1414 @kindex shell
1415 @kindex !
1416 @cindex shell escape
1417 @item shell @var{command-string}
1418 @itemx !@var{command-string}
1419 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command-string}.
1420 Note that no space is needed between @code{!} and @var{command-string}.
1421 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1422 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1423 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1424 @end table
1425
1426 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1427 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1428 @value{GDBN}:
1429
1430 @table @code
1431 @kindex make
1432 @cindex calling make
1433 @item make @var{make-args}
1434 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1435 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1436 @end table
1437
1438 @node Logging Output
1439 @section Logging Output
1440 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1441 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1442
1443 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1444 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1445
1446 @table @code
1447 @kindex set logging
1448 @item set logging on
1449 Enable logging.
1450 @item set logging off
1451 Disable logging.
1452 @cindex logging file name
1453 @item set logging file @var{file}
1454 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1455 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1456 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1457 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1458 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1459 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1460 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1461 @kindex show logging
1462 @item show logging
1463 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1464 @end table
1465
1466 @node Commands
1467 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1468
1469 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1470 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1471 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1472 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1473 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1474
1475 @menu
1476 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1477 * Completion:: Command completion
1478 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1479 @end menu
1480
1481 @node Command Syntax
1482 @section Command Syntax
1483
1484 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1485 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1486 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1487 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1488 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1489 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1490
1491 @cindex abbreviation
1492 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1493 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1494 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1495 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1496 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1497 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1498 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1499
1500 @cindex repeating commands
1501 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1502 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1503 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1504 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1505 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1506 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1507 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1508
1509 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1510 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1511 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1512
1513 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1514 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1515 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1516 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1517 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1518
1519 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1520 @cindex comment
1521 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1522 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1523 Files,,Command Files}).
1524
1525 @cindex repeating command sequences
1526 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1527 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1528 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1529 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1530 for editing.
1531
1532 @node Completion
1533 @section Command Completion
1534
1535 @cindex completion
1536 @cindex word completion
1537 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1538 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1539 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1540 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1541
1542 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1543 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1544 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1545 enter it). For example, if you type
1546
1547 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1548 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1549 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1550 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1551 @smallexample
1552 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1553 @end smallexample
1554
1555 @noindent
1556 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1557 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1558
1559 @smallexample
1560 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1561 @end smallexample
1562
1563 @noindent
1564 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1565 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1566 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1567 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1568 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1569 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1570
1571 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1572 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1573 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1574 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1575 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1576 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1577 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1578 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1579 example:
1580
1581 @smallexample
1582 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1583 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1584 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1585 make_abs_section make_function_type
1586 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1587 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1588 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1589 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1590 @end smallexample
1591
1592 @noindent
1593 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1594 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1595 command.
1596
1597 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1598 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1599 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1600 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1601 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1602
1603 @cindex quotes in commands
1604 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1605 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1606 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1607 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1608 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1609 @value{GDBN} commands.
1610
1611 The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1612 name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1613 overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1614 by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1615 may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1616 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1617 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1618 word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1619 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1620 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1621 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1622
1623 @smallexample
1624 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1625 bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1626 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1627 @end smallexample
1628
1629 In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1630 quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1631 completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1632 place:
1633
1634 @smallexample
1635 (@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1636 @exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1637 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1638 @end smallexample
1639
1640 @noindent
1641 In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1642 you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1643 completion on an overloaded symbol.
1644
1645 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1646 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1647 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1648 see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1649
1650 @cindex completion of structure field names
1651 @cindex structure field name completion
1652 @cindex completion of union field names
1653 @cindex union field name completion
1654 When completing in an expression which looks up a field in a
1655 structure, @value{GDBN} also tries@footnote{The completer can be
1656 confused by certain kinds of invalid expressions. Also, it only
1657 examines the static type of the expression, not the dynamic type.} to
1658 limit completions to the field names available in the type of the
1659 left-hand-side:
1660
1661 @smallexample
1662 (@value{GDBP}) p gdb_stdout.@kbd{M-?}
1663 magic to_fputs to_rewind
1664 to_data to_isatty to_write
1665 to_delete to_put to_write_async_safe
1666 to_flush to_read
1667 @end smallexample
1668
1669 @noindent
1670 This is because the @code{gdb_stdout} is a variable of the type
1671 @code{struct ui_file} that is defined in @value{GDBN} sources as
1672 follows:
1673
1674 @smallexample
1675 struct ui_file
1676 @{
1677 int *magic;
1678 ui_file_flush_ftype *to_flush;
1679 ui_file_write_ftype *to_write;
1680 ui_file_write_async_safe_ftype *to_write_async_safe;
1681 ui_file_fputs_ftype *to_fputs;
1682 ui_file_read_ftype *to_read;
1683 ui_file_delete_ftype *to_delete;
1684 ui_file_isatty_ftype *to_isatty;
1685 ui_file_rewind_ftype *to_rewind;
1686 ui_file_put_ftype *to_put;
1687 void *to_data;
1688 @}
1689 @end smallexample
1690
1691
1692 @node Help
1693 @section Getting Help
1694 @cindex online documentation
1695 @kindex help
1696
1697 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1698 using the command @code{help}.
1699
1700 @table @code
1701 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1702 @item help
1703 @itemx h
1704 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1705 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1706
1707 @smallexample
1708 (@value{GDBP}) help
1709 List of classes of commands:
1710
1711 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1712 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1713 data -- Examining data
1714 files -- Specifying and examining files
1715 internals -- Maintenance commands
1716 obscure -- Obscure features
1717 running -- Running the program
1718 stack -- Examining the stack
1719 status -- Status inquiries
1720 support -- Support facilities
1721 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1722 stopping the program
1723 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1724
1725 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1726 commands in that class.
1727 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1728 documentation.
1729 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1730 (@value{GDBP})
1731 @end smallexample
1732 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1733
1734 @item help @var{class}
1735 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1736 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1737 help display for the class @code{status}:
1738
1739 @smallexample
1740 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1741 Status inquiries.
1742
1743 List of commands:
1744
1745 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1746 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1747 info -- Generic command for showing things
1748 about the program being debugged
1749 show -- Generic command for showing things
1750 about the debugger
1751
1752 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1753 documentation.
1754 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1755 (@value{GDBP})
1756 @end smallexample
1757
1758 @item help @var{command}
1759 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1760 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1761
1762 @kindex apropos
1763 @item apropos @var{args}
1764 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1765 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1766 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1767
1768 @smallexample
1769 apropos alias
1770 @end smallexample
1771
1772 @noindent
1773 results in:
1774
1775 @smallexample
1776 @c @group
1777 alias -- Define a new command that is an alias of an existing command
1778 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1779 d -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1780 del -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1781 delete -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1782 @c @end group
1783 @end smallexample
1784
1785 @kindex complete
1786 @item complete @var{args}
1787 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1788 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1789 command you want completed. For example:
1790
1791 @smallexample
1792 complete i
1793 @end smallexample
1794
1795 @noindent results in:
1796
1797 @smallexample
1798 @group
1799 if
1800 ignore
1801 info
1802 inspect
1803 @end group
1804 @end smallexample
1805
1806 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1807 @end table
1808
1809 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1810 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1811 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1812 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1813 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Command, Variable, and
1814 Function Index point to all the sub-commands. @xref{Command and Variable
1815 Index}.
1816
1817 @c @group
1818 @table @code
1819 @kindex info
1820 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1821 @item info
1822 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1823 program. For example, you can show the arguments passed to a function
1824 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1825 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1826 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1827 @w{@code{help info}}.
1828
1829 @kindex set
1830 @item set
1831 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1832 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1833 @code{set prompt $}.
1834
1835 @kindex show
1836 @item show
1837 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1838 @value{GDBN} itself.
1839 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1840 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1841 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1842 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1843
1844 @kindex info set
1845 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1846 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1847 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1848 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1849 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1850 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1851 @end table
1852 @c @end group
1853
1854 Here are several miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1855 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1856
1857 @table @code
1858 @kindex show version
1859 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1860 @item show version
1861 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1862 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1863 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1864 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1865 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1866 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1867 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1868 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1869 @value{GDBN}.
1870
1871 @kindex show copying
1872 @kindex info copying
1873 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1874 @item show copying
1875 @itemx info copying
1876 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1877
1878 @kindex show warranty
1879 @kindex info warranty
1880 @item show warranty
1881 @itemx info warranty
1882 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1883 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1884
1885 @kindex show configuration
1886 @item show configuration
1887 Display detailed information about the way @value{GDBN} was configured
1888 when it was built. This displays the optional arguments passed to the
1889 @file{configure} script and also configuration parameters detected
1890 automatically by @command{configure}. When reporting a @value{GDBN}
1891 bug (@pxref{GDB Bugs}), it is important to include this information in
1892 your report.
1893
1894 @end table
1895
1896 @node Running
1897 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1898
1899 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1900 debugging information when you compile it.
1901
1902 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1903 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1904 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1905 kill a child process.
1906
1907 @menu
1908 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1909 * Starting:: Starting your program
1910 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1911 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1912
1913 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1914 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1915 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1916 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1917
1918 * Inferiors and Programs:: Debugging multiple inferiors and programs
1919 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1920 * Forks:: Debugging forks
1921 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1922 @end menu
1923
1924 @node Compilation
1925 @section Compiling for Debugging
1926
1927 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1928 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1929 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1930 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1931 and addresses in the executable code.
1932
1933 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1934 the compiler.
1935
1936 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1937 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, some
1938 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
1939 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1940 executables containing debugging information.
1941
1942 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1943 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1944 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1945 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1946 in pushing your luck. For more information, see @ref{Optimized Code}.
1947
1948 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1949 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1950 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1951
1952 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
1953 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
1954 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
1955 the @option{-g} flag alone. Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC},
1956 the @sc{gnu} C compiler, provides macro information if you are using
1957 the DWARF debugging format, and specify the option @option{-g3}.
1958
1959 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
1960 gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}, for more
1961 information on @value{NGCC} options affecting debug information.
1962
1963 You will have the best debugging experience if you use the latest
1964 version of the DWARF debugging format that your compiler supports.
1965 DWARF is currently the most expressive and best supported debugging
1966 format in @value{GDBN}.
1967
1968 @need 2000
1969 @node Starting
1970 @section Starting your Program
1971 @cindex starting
1972 @cindex running
1973
1974 @table @code
1975 @kindex run
1976 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
1977 @item run
1978 @itemx r
1979 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1980 You must first specify the program name with an argument to
1981 @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1982 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file}
1983 command (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
1984
1985 @end table
1986
1987 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1988 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1989 that process run your program. In some environments without processes,
1990 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program. Other targets,
1991 like @samp{remote}, are always running. If you get an error
1992 message like this one:
1993
1994 @smallexample
1995 The "remote" target does not support "run".
1996 Try "help target" or "continue".
1997 @end smallexample
1998
1999 @noindent
2000 then use @code{continue} to run your program. You may need @code{load}
2001 first (@pxref{load}).
2002
2003 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
2004 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
2005 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
2006 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
2007 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
2008 divided into four categories:
2009
2010 @table @asis
2011 @item The @emph{arguments.}
2012 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
2013 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
2014 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
2015 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
2016 the arguments.
2017 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
2018 @code{SHELL} environment variable. If you do not define @code{SHELL},
2019 @value{GDBN} uses the default shell (@file{/bin/sh}). You can disable
2020 use of any shell with the @code{set startup-with-shell} command (see
2021 below for details).
2022
2023 @item The @emph{environment.}
2024 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
2025 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
2026 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
2027 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
2028
2029 @item The @emph{working directory.}
2030 Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
2031 the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
2032 @xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working Directory}.
2033
2034 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
2035 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
2036 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
2037 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
2038 set a different device for your program.
2039 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
2040
2041 @cindex pipes
2042 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
2043 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
2044 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
2045 wrong program.
2046 @end table
2047
2048 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
2049 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
2050 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
2051 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
2052 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
2053
2054 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
2055 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
2056 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
2057 your current breakpoints.
2058
2059 @table @code
2060 @kindex start
2061 @item start
2062 @cindex run to main procedure
2063 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
2064 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
2065 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
2066 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
2067 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
2068 procedure, depending on the language used.
2069
2070 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
2071 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
2072 the @samp{run} command.
2073
2074 @cindex elaboration phase
2075 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
2076 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
2077 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
2078 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
2079 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
2080 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
2081 will remain to halt execution.
2082
2083 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
2084 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
2085 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
2086 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
2087 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
2088
2089 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
2090 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution of
2091 your program too late, as the program would have already completed the
2092 elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, insert breakpoints in your
2093 elaboration code before running your program.
2094
2095 @anchor{set exec-wrapper}
2096 @kindex set exec-wrapper
2097 @item set exec-wrapper @var{wrapper}
2098 @itemx show exec-wrapper
2099 @itemx unset exec-wrapper
2100 When @samp{exec-wrapper} is set, the specified wrapper is used to
2101 launch programs for debugging. @value{GDBN} starts your program
2102 with a shell command of the form @kbd{exec @var{wrapper}
2103 @var{program}}. Quoting is added to @var{program} and its
2104 arguments, but not to @var{wrapper}, so you should add quotes if
2105 appropriate for your shell. The wrapper runs until it executes
2106 your program, and then @value{GDBN} takes control.
2107
2108 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
2109 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
2110 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
2111 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
2112
2113 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
2114 the debugged program, without setting the variable in your shell's
2115 environment:
2116
2117 @smallexample
2118 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper env 'LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so'
2119 (@value{GDBP}) run
2120 @end smallexample
2121
2122 This command is available when debugging locally on most targets, excluding
2123 @sc{djgpp}, Cygwin, MS Windows, and QNX Neutrino.
2124
2125 @kindex set startup-with-shell
2126 @item set startup-with-shell
2127 @itemx set startup-with-shell on
2128 @itemx set startup-with-shell off
2129 @itemx show set startup-with-shell
2130 On Unix systems, by default, if a shell is available on your target,
2131 @value{GDBN}) uses it to start your program. Arguments of the
2132 @code{run} command are passed to the shell, which does variable
2133 substitution, expands wildcard characters and performs redirection of
2134 I/O. In some circumstances, it may be useful to disable such use of a
2135 shell, for example, when debugging the shell itself or diagnosing
2136 startup failures such as:
2137
2138 @smallexample
2139 (@value{GDBP}) run
2140 Starting program: ./a.out
2141 During startup program terminated with signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
2142 @end smallexample
2143
2144 @noindent
2145 which indicates the shell or the wrapper specified with
2146 @samp{exec-wrapper} crashed, not your program. Most often, this is
2147 caused by something odd in your shell's non-interactive mode
2148 initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell,
2149 $@file{.zshenv} for the Z shell, or the file specified in the
2150 @samp{BASH_ENV} environment variable for BASH.
2151
2152 @anchor{set auto-connect-native-target}
2153 @kindex set auto-connect-native-target
2154 @item set auto-connect-native-target
2155 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target on
2156 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target off
2157 @itemx show auto-connect-native-target
2158
2159 By default, if not connected to any target yet (e.g., with
2160 @code{target remote}), the @code{run} command starts your program as a
2161 native process under @value{GDBN}, on your local machine. If you're
2162 sure you don't want to debug programs on your local machine, you can
2163 tell @value{GDBN} to not connect to the native target automatically
2164 with the @code{set auto-connect-native-target off} command.
2165
2166 If @code{on}, which is the default, and if @value{GDBN} is not
2167 connected to a target already, the @code{run} command automaticaly
2168 connects to the native target, if one is available.
2169
2170 If @code{off}, and if @value{GDBN} is not connected to a target
2171 already, the @code{run} command fails with an error:
2172
2173 @smallexample
2174 (@value{GDBP}) run
2175 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2176 @end smallexample
2177
2178 If @value{GDBN} is already connected to a target, @value{GDBN} always
2179 uses it with the @code{run} command.
2180
2181 In any case, you can explicitly connect to the native target with the
2182 @code{target native} command. For example,
2183
2184 @smallexample
2185 (@value{GDBP}) set auto-connect-native-target off
2186 (@value{GDBP}) run
2187 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2188 (@value{GDBP}) target native
2189 (@value{GDBP}) run
2190 Starting program: ./a.out
2191 [Inferior 1 (process 10421) exited normally]
2192 @end smallexample
2193
2194 In case you connected explicitly to the @code{native} target,
2195 @value{GDBN} remains connected even if all inferiors exit, ready for
2196 the next @code{run} command. Use the @code{disconnect} command to
2197 disconnect.
2198
2199 Examples of other commands that likewise respect the
2200 @code{auto-connect-native-target} setting: @code{attach}, @code{info
2201 proc}, @code{info os}.
2202
2203 @kindex set disable-randomization
2204 @item set disable-randomization
2205 @itemx set disable-randomization on
2206 This option (enabled by default in @value{GDBN}) will turn off the native
2207 randomization of the virtual address space of the started program. This option
2208 is useful for multiple debugging sessions to make the execution better
2209 reproducible and memory addresses reusable across debugging sessions.
2210
2211 This feature is implemented only on certain targets, including @sc{gnu}/Linux.
2212 On @sc{gnu}/Linux you can get the same behavior using
2213
2214 @smallexample
2215 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper setarch `uname -m` -R
2216 @end smallexample
2217
2218 @item set disable-randomization off
2219 Leave the behavior of the started executable unchanged. Some bugs rear their
2220 ugly heads only when the program is loaded at certain addresses. If your bug
2221 disappears when you run the program under @value{GDBN}, that might be because
2222 @value{GDBN} by default disables the address randomization on platforms, such
2223 as @sc{gnu}/Linux, which do that for stand-alone programs. Use @kbd{set
2224 disable-randomization off} to try to reproduce such elusive bugs.
2225
2226 On targets where it is available, virtual address space randomization
2227 protects the programs against certain kinds of security attacks. In these
2228 cases the attacker needs to know the exact location of a concrete executable
2229 code. Randomizing its location makes it impossible to inject jumps misusing
2230 a code at its expected addresses.
2231
2232 Prelinking shared libraries provides a startup performance advantage but it
2233 makes addresses in these libraries predictable for privileged processes by
2234 having just unprivileged access at the target system. Reading the shared
2235 library binary gives enough information for assembling the malicious code
2236 misusing it. Still even a prelinked shared library can get loaded at a new
2237 random address just requiring the regular relocation process during the
2238 startup. Shared libraries not already prelinked are always loaded at
2239 a randomly chosen address.
2240
2241 Position independent executables (PIE) contain position independent code
2242 similar to the shared libraries and therefore such executables get loaded at
2243 a randomly chosen address upon startup. PIE executables always load even
2244 already prelinked shared libraries at a random address. You can build such
2245 executable using @command{gcc -fPIE -pie}.
2246
2247 Heap (malloc storage), stack and custom mmap areas are always placed randomly
2248 (as long as the randomization is enabled).
2249
2250 @item show disable-randomization
2251 Show the current setting of the explicit disable of the native randomization of
2252 the virtual address space of the started program.
2253
2254 @end table
2255
2256 @node Arguments
2257 @section Your Program's Arguments
2258
2259 @cindex arguments (to your program)
2260 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
2261 @code{run} command.
2262 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
2263 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
2264 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
2265 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
2266 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
2267
2268 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
2269 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
2270 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
2271 the program, not by the shell.
2272
2273 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
2274 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
2275
2276 @table @code
2277 @kindex set args
2278 @item set args
2279 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
2280 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
2281 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
2282 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
2283 it again without arguments.
2284
2285 @kindex show args
2286 @item show args
2287 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
2288 @end table
2289
2290 @node Environment
2291 @section Your Program's Environment
2292
2293 @cindex environment (of your program)
2294 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
2295 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
2296 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
2297 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
2298 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
2299 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
2300 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
2301
2302 @table @code
2303 @kindex path
2304 @item path @var{directory}
2305 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
2306 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
2307 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
2308 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
2309 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
2310 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
2311 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
2312
2313 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
2314 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
2315 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
2316 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
2317 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
2318 @var{directory} to the search path.
2319 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
2320 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
2321
2322 @kindex show paths
2323 @item show paths
2324 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
2325 environment variable).
2326
2327 @kindex show environment
2328 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2329 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2330 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2331 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2332 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2333
2334 @kindex set environment
2335 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2336 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2337 changes for your program (and the shell @value{GDBN} uses to launch
2338 it), not for @value{GDBN} itself. The @var{value} may be any string; the
2339 values of environment variables are just strings, and any
2340 interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2341 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2342 null value.
2343 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2344 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2345
2346 For example, this command:
2347
2348 @smallexample
2349 set env USER = foo
2350 @end smallexample
2351
2352 @noindent
2353 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2354 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2355 are not actually required.)
2356
2357 Note that on Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program via a shell,
2358 which also inherits the environment set with @code{set environment}.
2359 If necessary, you can avoid that by using the @samp{env} program as a
2360 wrapper instead of using @code{set environment}. @xref{set
2361 exec-wrapper}, for an example doing just that.
2362
2363 @kindex unset environment
2364 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2365 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2366 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2367 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2368 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2369 @end table
2370
2371 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2372 the shell indicated by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it
2373 exists (or @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable
2374 names a shell that runs an initialization file when started
2375 non-interactively---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, $@file{.zshenv}
2376 for the Z shell, or the file specified in the @samp{BASH_ENV}
2377 environment variable for BASH---any variables you set in that file
2378 affect your program. You may wish to move setting of environment
2379 variables to files that are only run when you sign on, such as
2380 @file{.login} or @file{.profile}.
2381
2382 @node Working Directory
2383 @section Your Program's Working Directory
2384
2385 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2386 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
2387 working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
2388 The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
2389 from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
2390 working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
2391
2392 The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
2393 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2394 Specify Files}.
2395
2396 @table @code
2397 @kindex cd
2398 @cindex change working directory
2399 @item cd @r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
2400 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}. If not
2401 given, @var{directory} uses @file{'~'}.
2402
2403 @kindex pwd
2404 @item pwd
2405 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2406 @end table
2407
2408 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2409 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2410 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} is
2411 configured with the @file{/proc} support, you can use the @code{info
2412 proc} command (@pxref{SVR4 Process Information}) to find out the
2413 current working directory of the debuggee.
2414
2415 @node Input/Output
2416 @section Your Program's Input and Output
2417
2418 @cindex redirection
2419 @cindex i/o
2420 @cindex terminal
2421 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2422 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2423 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2424 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2425 running your program.
2426
2427 @table @code
2428 @kindex info terminal
2429 @item info terminal
2430 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2431 program is using.
2432 @end table
2433
2434 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2435 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2436
2437 @smallexample
2438 run > outfile
2439 @end smallexample
2440
2441 @noindent
2442 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2443
2444 @kindex tty
2445 @cindex controlling terminal
2446 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2447 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2448 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2449 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2450 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2451
2452 @smallexample
2453 tty /dev/ttyb
2454 @end smallexample
2455
2456 @noindent
2457 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2458 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2459 that as their controlling terminal.
2460
2461 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2462 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2463 terminal.
2464
2465 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2466 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2467 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2468 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2469
2470 @cindex inferior tty
2471 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2472 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2473 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2474 program.
2475
2476 @table @code
2477 @item set inferior-tty /dev/ttyb
2478 @kindex set inferior-tty
2479 Set the tty for the program being debugged to /dev/ttyb.
2480
2481 @item show inferior-tty
2482 @kindex show inferior-tty
2483 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2484 @end table
2485
2486 @node Attach
2487 @section Debugging an Already-running Process
2488 @kindex attach
2489 @cindex attach
2490
2491 @table @code
2492 @item attach @var{process-id}
2493 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2494 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2495 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2496 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2497 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2498
2499 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2500 executing the command.
2501 @end table
2502
2503 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2504 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2505 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2506 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2507
2508 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2509 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2510 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2511 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2512 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2513 Specify Files}.
2514
2515 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2516 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2517 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2518 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2519 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2520 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2521 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2522
2523 @table @code
2524 @kindex detach
2525 @item detach
2526 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2527 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2528 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2529 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2530 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2531 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2532 executing the command.
2533 @end table
2534
2535 If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2536 that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2537 By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2538 things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2539 @code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2540 Messages}).
2541
2542 @node Kill Process
2543 @section Killing the Child Process
2544
2545 @table @code
2546 @kindex kill
2547 @item kill
2548 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2549 @end table
2550
2551 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2552 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2553 is running.
2554
2555 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2556 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2557 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2558 outside the debugger.
2559
2560 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2561 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2562 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2563 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2564 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2565 breakpoint settings).
2566
2567 @node Inferiors and Programs
2568 @section Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs
2569
2570 @value{GDBN} lets you run and debug multiple programs in a single
2571 session. In addition, @value{GDBN} on some systems may let you run
2572 several programs simultaneously (otherwise you have to exit from one
2573 before starting another). In the most general case, you can have
2574 multiple threads of execution in each of multiple processes, launched
2575 from multiple executables.
2576
2577 @cindex inferior
2578 @value{GDBN} represents the state of each program execution with an
2579 object called an @dfn{inferior}. An inferior typically corresponds to
2580 a process, but is more general and applies also to targets that do not
2581 have processes. Inferiors may be created before a process runs, and
2582 may be retained after a process exits. Inferiors have unique
2583 identifiers that are different from process ids. Usually each
2584 inferior will also have its own distinct address space, although some
2585 embedded targets may have several inferiors running in different parts
2586 of a single address space. Each inferior may in turn have multiple
2587 threads running in it.
2588
2589 To find out what inferiors exist at any moment, use @w{@code{info
2590 inferiors}}:
2591
2592 @table @code
2593 @kindex info inferiors
2594 @item info inferiors
2595 Print a list of all inferiors currently being managed by @value{GDBN}.
2596
2597 @value{GDBN} displays for each inferior (in this order):
2598
2599 @enumerate
2600 @item
2601 the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2602
2603 @item
2604 the target system's inferior identifier
2605
2606 @item
2607 the name of the executable the inferior is running.
2608
2609 @end enumerate
2610
2611 @noindent
2612 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} inferior number
2613 indicates the current inferior.
2614
2615 For example,
2616 @end table
2617 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2618
2619 @smallexample
2620 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2621 Num Description Executable
2622 2 process 2307 hello
2623 * 1 process 3401 goodbye
2624 @end smallexample
2625
2626 To switch focus between inferiors, use the @code{inferior} command:
2627
2628 @table @code
2629 @kindex inferior @var{infno}
2630 @item inferior @var{infno}
2631 Make inferior number @var{infno} the current inferior. The argument
2632 @var{infno} is the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}, as shown
2633 in the first field of the @samp{info inferiors} display.
2634 @end table
2635
2636
2637 You can get multiple executables into a debugging session via the
2638 @code{add-inferior} and @w{@code{clone-inferior}} commands. On some
2639 systems @value{GDBN} can add inferiors to the debug session
2640 automatically by following calls to @code{fork} and @code{exec}. To
2641 remove inferiors from the debugging session use the
2642 @w{@code{remove-inferiors}} command.
2643
2644 @table @code
2645 @kindex add-inferior
2646 @item add-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ -exec @var{executable} ]
2647 Adds @var{n} inferiors to be run using @var{executable} as the
2648 executable; @var{n} defaults to 1. If no executable is specified,
2649 the inferiors begins empty, with no program. You can still assign or
2650 change the program assigned to the inferior at any time by using the
2651 @code{file} command with the executable name as its argument.
2652
2653 @kindex clone-inferior
2654 @item clone-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ @var{infno} ]
2655 Adds @var{n} inferiors ready to execute the same program as inferior
2656 @var{infno}; @var{n} defaults to 1, and @var{infno} defaults to the
2657 number of the current inferior. This is a convenient command when you
2658 want to run another instance of the inferior you are debugging.
2659
2660 @smallexample
2661 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2662 Num Description Executable
2663 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2664 (@value{GDBP}) clone-inferior
2665 Added inferior 2.
2666 1 inferiors added.
2667 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2668 Num Description Executable
2669 2 <null> helloworld
2670 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2671 @end smallexample
2672
2673 You can now simply switch focus to inferior 2 and run it.
2674
2675 @kindex remove-inferiors
2676 @item remove-inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2677 Removes the inferior or inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}. It is not
2678 possible to remove an inferior that is running with this command. For
2679 those, use the @code{kill} or @code{detach} command first.
2680
2681 @end table
2682
2683 To quit debugging one of the running inferiors that is not the current
2684 inferior, you can either detach from it by using the @w{@code{detach
2685 inferior}} command (allowing it to run independently), or kill it
2686 using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}} command:
2687
2688 @table @code
2689 @kindex detach inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2690 @item detach inferior @var{infno}@dots{}
2691 Detach from the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN}
2692 inferior number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry
2693 still stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors},
2694 but its Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2695
2696 @kindex kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2697 @item kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2698 Kill the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN} inferior
2699 number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry still
2700 stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors}, but its
2701 Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2702 @end table
2703
2704 After the successful completion of a command such as @code{detach},
2705 @code{detach inferiors}, @code{kill} or @code{kill inferiors}, or after
2706 a normal process exit, the inferior is still valid and listed with
2707 @code{info inferiors}, ready to be restarted.
2708
2709
2710 To be notified when inferiors are started or exit under @value{GDBN}'s
2711 control use @w{@code{set print inferior-events}}:
2712
2713 @table @code
2714 @kindex set print inferior-events
2715 @cindex print messages on inferior start and exit
2716 @item set print inferior-events
2717 @itemx set print inferior-events on
2718 @itemx set print inferior-events off
2719 The @code{set print inferior-events} command allows you to enable or
2720 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new
2721 inferiors have started or that inferiors have exited or have been
2722 detached. By default, these messages will not be printed.
2723
2724 @kindex show print inferior-events
2725 @item show print inferior-events
2726 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that
2727 inferiors have started, exited or have been detached.
2728 @end table
2729
2730 Many commands will work the same with multiple programs as with a
2731 single program: e.g., @code{print myglobal} will simply display the
2732 value of @code{myglobal} in the current inferior.
2733
2734
2735 Occasionaly, when debugging @value{GDBN} itself, it may be useful to
2736 get more info about the relationship of inferiors, programs, address
2737 spaces in a debug session. You can do that with the @w{@code{maint
2738 info program-spaces}} command.
2739
2740 @table @code
2741 @kindex maint info program-spaces
2742 @item maint info program-spaces
2743 Print a list of all program spaces currently being managed by
2744 @value{GDBN}.
2745
2746 @value{GDBN} displays for each program space (in this order):
2747
2748 @enumerate
2749 @item
2750 the program space number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2751
2752 @item
2753 the name of the executable loaded into the program space, with e.g.,
2754 the @code{file} command.
2755
2756 @end enumerate
2757
2758 @noindent
2759 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} program space number
2760 indicates the current program space.
2761
2762 In addition, below each program space line, @value{GDBN} prints extra
2763 information that isn't suitable to display in tabular form. For
2764 example, the list of inferiors bound to the program space.
2765
2766 @smallexample
2767 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2768 Id Executable
2769 2 goodbye
2770 Bound inferiors: ID 1 (process 21561)
2771 * 1 hello
2772 @end smallexample
2773
2774 Here we can see that no inferior is running the program @code{hello},
2775 while @code{process 21561} is running the program @code{goodbye}. On
2776 some targets, it is possible that multiple inferiors are bound to the
2777 same program space. The most common example is that of debugging both
2778 the parent and child processes of a @code{vfork} call. For example,
2779
2780 @smallexample
2781 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2782 Id Executable
2783 * 1 vfork-test
2784 Bound inferiors: ID 2 (process 18050), ID 1 (process 18045)
2785 @end smallexample
2786
2787 Here, both inferior 2 and inferior 1 are running in the same program
2788 space as a result of inferior 1 having executed a @code{vfork} call.
2789 @end table
2790
2791 @node Threads
2792 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2793
2794 @cindex threads of execution
2795 @cindex multiple threads
2796 @cindex switching threads
2797 In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
2798 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2799 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2800 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2801 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2802 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2803 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2804
2805 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2806 programs:
2807
2808 @itemize @bullet
2809 @item automatic notification of new threads
2810 @item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
2811 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2812 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2813 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2814 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2815 @item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of
2816 messages on thread start and exit.
2817 @item @samp{set libthread-db-search-path @var{path}}, which lets
2818 the user specify which @code{libthread_db} to use if the default choice
2819 isn't compatible with the program.
2820 @end itemize
2821
2822 @quotation
2823 @emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
2824 @value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
2825 If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
2826 effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
2827 from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
2828 like this:
2829
2830 @smallexample
2831 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2832 (@value{GDBP}) thread 1
2833 Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
2834 see the IDs of currently known threads.
2835 @end smallexample
2836 @c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
2837 @c doesn't support threads"?
2838 @end quotation
2839
2840 @cindex focus of debugging
2841 @cindex current thread
2842 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2843 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2844 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2845 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2846 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2847
2848 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2849 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2850 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2851 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2852 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2853 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2854 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2855 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}, where @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2856 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2857 @sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2858
2859 @smallexample
2860 [New Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 25582)]
2861 @end smallexample
2862
2863 @noindent
2864 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
2865 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2866 further qualifier.
2867
2868 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2869 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2870 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2871 @c program?
2872 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2873 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2874 @c threads ab initio?
2875
2876 @cindex thread number
2877 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2878 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2879 number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2880
2881 @table @code
2882 @kindex info threads
2883 @item info threads @r{[}@var{id}@dots{}@r{]}
2884 Display a summary of all threads currently in your program. Optional
2885 argument @var{id}@dots{} is one or more thread ids separated by spaces, and
2886 means to print information only about the specified thread or threads.
2887 @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2888
2889 @enumerate
2890 @item
2891 the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2892
2893 @item
2894 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2895
2896 @item
2897 the thread's name, if one is known. A thread can either be named by
2898 the user (see @code{thread name}, below), or, in some cases, by the
2899 program itself.
2900
2901 @item
2902 the current stack frame summary for that thread
2903 @end enumerate
2904
2905 @noindent
2906 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2907 indicates the current thread.
2908
2909 For example,
2910 @end table
2911 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2912
2913 @smallexample
2914 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2915 Id Target Id Frame
2916 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2917 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2918 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2919 at threadtest.c:68
2920 @end smallexample
2921
2922 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
2923 Solaris-specific command:
2924
2925 @table @code
2926 @item maint info sol-threads
2927 @kindex maint info sol-threads
2928 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
2929 Display info on Solaris user threads.
2930 @end table
2931
2932 @table @code
2933 @kindex thread @var{threadno}
2934 @item thread @var{threadno}
2935 Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2936 argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2937 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2938 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2939 you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2940
2941 @smallexample
2942 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
2943 [Switching to thread 2 (Thread 0xb7fdab70 (LWP 12747))]
2944 #0 some_function (ignore=0x0) at example.c:8
2945 8 printf ("hello\n");
2946 @end smallexample
2947
2948 @noindent
2949 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2950 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
2951 threads.
2952
2953 @vindex $_thread@r{, convenience variable}
2954 The debugger convenience variable @samp{$_thread} contains the number
2955 of the current thread. You may find this useful in writing breakpoint
2956 conditional expressions, command scripts, and so forth. See
2957 @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for general
2958 information on convenience variables.
2959
2960 @kindex thread apply
2961 @cindex apply command to several threads
2962 @item thread apply [@var{threadno} | all] @var{command}
2963 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
2964 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the numbers of the
2965 threads that you want affected with the command argument
2966 @var{threadno}. It can be a single thread number, one of the numbers
2967 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display; or it
2968 could be a range of thread numbers, as in @code{2-4}. To apply a
2969 command to all threads, type @kbd{thread apply all @var{command}}.
2970
2971 @kindex thread name
2972 @cindex name a thread
2973 @item thread name [@var{name}]
2974 This command assigns a name to the current thread. If no argument is
2975 given, any existing user-specified name is removed. The thread name
2976 appears in the @samp{info threads} display.
2977
2978 On some systems, such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, @value{GDBN} is able to
2979 determine the name of the thread as given by the OS. On these
2980 systems, a name specified with @samp{thread name} will override the
2981 system-give name, and removing the user-specified name will cause
2982 @value{GDBN} to once again display the system-specified name.
2983
2984 @kindex thread find
2985 @cindex search for a thread
2986 @item thread find [@var{regexp}]
2987 Search for and display thread ids whose name or @var{systag}
2988 matches the supplied regular expression.
2989
2990 As well as being the complement to the @samp{thread name} command,
2991 this command also allows you to identify a thread by its target
2992 @var{systag}. For instance, on @sc{gnu}/Linux, the target @var{systag}
2993 is the LWP id.
2994
2995 @smallexample
2996 (@value{GDBN}) thread find 26688
2997 Thread 4 has target id 'Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688)'
2998 (@value{GDBN}) info thread 4
2999 Id Target Id Frame
3000 4 Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688) 0x00000031ca6cd372 in select ()
3001 @end smallexample
3002
3003 @kindex set print thread-events
3004 @cindex print messages on thread start and exit
3005 @item set print thread-events
3006 @itemx set print thread-events on
3007 @itemx set print thread-events off
3008 The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or
3009 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have
3010 started or that threads have exited. By default, these messages will
3011 be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target.
3012 Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets.
3013
3014 @kindex show print thread-events
3015 @item show print thread-events
3016 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads
3017 have started and exited.
3018 @end table
3019
3020 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
3021 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
3022 programs with multiple threads.
3023
3024 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
3025 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
3026
3027 @anchor{set libthread-db-search-path}
3028 @table @code
3029 @kindex set libthread-db-search-path
3030 @cindex search path for @code{libthread_db}
3031 @item set libthread-db-search-path @r{[}@var{path}@r{]}
3032 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
3033 directories @value{GDBN} will use to search for @code{libthread_db}.
3034 If you omit @var{path}, @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to
3035 its default value (@code{$sdir:$pdir} on @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems).
3036 Internally, the default value comes from the @code{LIBTHREAD_DB_SEARCH_PATH}
3037 macro.
3038
3039 On @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems, @value{GDBN} uses a ``helper''
3040 @code{libthread_db} library to obtain information about threads in the
3041 inferior process. @value{GDBN} will use @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3042 to find @code{libthread_db}. @value{GDBN} also consults first if inferior
3043 specific thread debugging library loading is enabled
3044 by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3045
3046 A special entry @samp{$sdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3047 refers to the default system directories that are
3048 normally searched for loading shared libraries. The @samp{$sdir} entry
3049 is the only kind not needing to be enabled by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db}
3050 (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3051
3052 A special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3053 refers to the directory from which @code{libpthread}
3054 was loaded in the inferior process.
3055
3056 For any @code{libthread_db} library @value{GDBN} finds in above directories,
3057 @value{GDBN} attempts to initialize it with the current inferior process.
3058 If this initialization fails (which could happen because of a version
3059 mismatch between @code{libthread_db} and @code{libpthread}), @value{GDBN}
3060 will unload @code{libthread_db}, and continue with the next directory.
3061 If none of @code{libthread_db} libraries initialize successfully,
3062 @value{GDBN} will issue a warning and thread debugging will be disabled.
3063
3064 Setting @code{libthread-db-search-path} is currently implemented
3065 only on some platforms.
3066
3067 @kindex show libthread-db-search-path
3068 @item show libthread-db-search-path
3069 Display current libthread_db search path.
3070
3071 @kindex set debug libthread-db
3072 @kindex show debug libthread-db
3073 @cindex debugging @code{libthread_db}
3074 @item set debug libthread-db
3075 @itemx show debug libthread-db
3076 Turns on or off display of @code{libthread_db}-related events.
3077 Use @code{1} to enable, @code{0} to disable.
3078 @end table
3079
3080 @node Forks
3081 @section Debugging Forks
3082
3083 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
3084 @cindex multiple processes
3085 @cindex processes, multiple
3086 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
3087 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
3088 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
3089 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
3090 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
3091 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
3092 will cause it to terminate.
3093
3094 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
3095 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
3096 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
3097 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
3098 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
3099 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
3100 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
3101 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
3102 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
3103 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
3104
3105 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs that
3106 create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork} functions.
3107 Currently, the only platforms with this feature are HP-UX (11.x and later
3108 only?) and @sc{gnu}/Linux (kernel version 2.5.60 and later).
3109
3110 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
3111 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
3112
3113 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
3114 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
3115
3116 @table @code
3117 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
3118 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
3119 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
3120 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
3121 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
3122
3123 @table @code
3124 @item parent
3125 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
3126 unimpeded. This is the default.
3127
3128 @item child
3129 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
3130 unimpeded.
3131
3132 @end table
3133
3134 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
3135 @item show follow-fork-mode
3136 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
3137 @end table
3138
3139 @cindex debugging multiple processes
3140 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
3141 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
3142
3143 @table @code
3144 @kindex set detach-on-fork
3145 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
3146 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
3147 retain debugger control over them both.
3148
3149 @table @code
3150 @item on
3151 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
3152 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
3153 independently. This is the default.
3154
3155 @item off
3156 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
3157 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
3158 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
3159 is held suspended.
3160
3161 @end table
3162
3163 @kindex show detach-on-fork
3164 @item show detach-on-fork
3165 Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off.
3166 @end table
3167
3168 If you choose to set @samp{detach-on-fork} mode off, then @value{GDBN}
3169 will retain control of all forked processes (including nested forks).
3170 You can list the forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN} by
3171 using the @w{@code{info inferiors}} command, and switch from one fork
3172 to another by using the @code{inferior} command (@pxref{Inferiors and
3173 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}).
3174
3175 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
3176 from it by using the @w{@code{detach inferiors}} command (allowing it
3177 to run independently), or kill it using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}}
3178 command. @xref{Inferiors and Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors
3179 and Programs}.
3180
3181 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
3182 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
3183 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
3184 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
3185 the child process's @code{main}.
3186
3187 On some systems, when a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you
3188 cannot debug the child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
3189
3190 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
3191 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent
3192 process, use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name
3193 as its argument. By default, after an @code{exec} call executes,
3194 @value{GDBN} discards the symbols of the previous executable image.
3195 You can change this behaviour with the @w{@code{set follow-exec-mode}}
3196 command.
3197
3198 @table @code
3199 @kindex set follow-exec-mode
3200 @item set follow-exec-mode @var{mode}
3201
3202 Set debugger response to a program call of @code{exec}. An
3203 @code{exec} call replaces the program image of a process.
3204
3205 @code{follow-exec-mode} can be:
3206
3207 @table @code
3208 @item new
3209 @value{GDBN} creates a new inferior and rebinds the process to this
3210 new inferior. The program the process was running before the
3211 @code{exec} call can be restarted afterwards by restarting the
3212 original inferior.
3213
3214 For example:
3215
3216 @smallexample
3217 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3218 (gdb) info inferior
3219 Id Description Executable
3220 * 1 <null> prog1
3221 (@value{GDBP}) run
3222 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3223 Program exited normally.
3224 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3225 Id Description Executable
3226 * 2 <null> prog2
3227 1 <null> prog1
3228 @end smallexample
3229
3230 @item same
3231 @value{GDBN} keeps the process bound to the same inferior. The new
3232 executable image replaces the previous executable loaded in the
3233 inferior. Restarting the inferior after the @code{exec} call, with
3234 e.g., the @code{run} command, restarts the executable the process was
3235 running after the @code{exec} call. This is the default mode.
3236
3237 For example:
3238
3239 @smallexample
3240 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3241 Id Description Executable
3242 * 1 <null> prog1
3243 (@value{GDBP}) run
3244 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3245 Program exited normally.
3246 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3247 Id Description Executable
3248 * 1 <null> prog2
3249 @end smallexample
3250
3251 @end table
3252 @end table
3253
3254 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
3255 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
3256 Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
3257
3258 @node Checkpoint/Restart
3259 @section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
3260
3261 @cindex checkpoint
3262 @cindex restart
3263 @cindex bookmark
3264 @cindex snapshot of a process
3265 @cindex rewind program state
3266
3267 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
3268 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
3269 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
3270 later.
3271
3272 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
3273 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
3274 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
3275 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
3276 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
3277
3278 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
3279 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
3280 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
3281 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
3282 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
3283 start again from there.
3284
3285 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
3286 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
3287
3288 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
3289
3290 @table @code
3291 @kindex checkpoint
3292 @item checkpoint
3293 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
3294 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
3295 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
3296
3297 @kindex info checkpoints
3298 @item info checkpoints
3299 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
3300 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
3301 listed:
3302
3303 @table @code
3304 @item Checkpoint ID
3305 @item Process ID
3306 @item Code Address
3307 @item Source line, or label
3308 @end table
3309
3310 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3311 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3312 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
3313 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
3314 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
3315 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
3316 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
3317
3318 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
3319 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
3320 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
3321 the debugger.
3322
3323 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3324 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3325 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
3326
3327 @end table
3328
3329 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
3330 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
3331 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
3332 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
3333 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
3334 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
3335 previously read data can be read again.
3336
3337 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
3338 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
3339 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
3340 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
3341 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
3342 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
3343
3344 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
3345 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
3346 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
3347 different execution path this time.
3348
3349 @cindex checkpoints and process id
3350 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
3351 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
3352 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
3353 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
3354 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
3355 potentially pose a problem.
3356
3357 @subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
3358
3359 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
3360 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
3361 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
3362 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
3363 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
3364 next.
3365
3366 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
3367 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
3368 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
3369 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
3370 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
3371
3372 @node Stopping
3373 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
3374
3375 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
3376 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
3377 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
3378
3379 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
3380 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
3381 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
3382 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
3383 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
3384 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
3385 explicitly request this information at any time.
3386
3387 @table @code
3388 @kindex info program
3389 @item info program
3390 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
3391 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
3392 @end table
3393
3394 @menu
3395 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
3396 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
3397 * Skipping Over Functions and Files::
3398 Skipping over functions and files
3399 * Signals:: Signals
3400 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3401 @end menu
3402
3403 @node Breakpoints
3404 @section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
3405
3406 @cindex breakpoints
3407 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
3408 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
3409 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
3410 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
3411 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
3412 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
3413 program.
3414
3415 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
3416 the executable is run. There is a minor limitation on HP-UX systems:
3417 you must wait until the executable is run in order to set breakpoints
3418 in shared library routines that are not called directly by the program
3419 (for example, routines that are arguments in a @code{pthread_create}
3420 call).
3421
3422 @cindex watchpoints
3423 @cindex data breakpoints
3424 @cindex memory tracing
3425 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
3426 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
3427 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
3428 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
3429 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
3430 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
3431 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
3432 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
3433 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
3434 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
3435 same commands.
3436
3437 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
3438 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
3439 Automatic Display}.
3440
3441 @cindex catchpoints
3442 @cindex breakpoint on events
3443 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
3444 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
3445 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
3446 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
3447 Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
3448 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
3449 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3450
3451 @cindex breakpoint numbers
3452 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
3453 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3454 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
3455 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
3456 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
3457 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
3458 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
3459 enable it again.
3460
3461 @cindex breakpoint ranges
3462 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
3463 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
3464 operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
3465 @samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
3466 hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
3467 all breakpoints in that range are operated on.
3468
3469 @menu
3470 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
3471 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
3472 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
3473 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
3474 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
3475 * Conditions:: Break conditions
3476 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
3477 * Dynamic Printf:: Dynamic printf
3478 * Save Breakpoints:: How to save breakpoints in a file
3479 * Static Probe Points:: Listing static probe points
3480 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3481 * Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3482 @end menu
3483
3484 @node Set Breaks
3485 @subsection Setting Breakpoints
3486
3487 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
3488 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
3489 @c
3490 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
3491
3492 @kindex break
3493 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
3494 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
3495 @cindex latest breakpoint
3496 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
3497 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
3498 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
3499 Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
3500 convenience variables.
3501
3502 @table @code
3503 @item break @var{location}
3504 Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a
3505 function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction.
3506 (@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to
3507 specify a @var{location}.) The breakpoint will stop your program just
3508 before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}.
3509
3510 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
3511 C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break.
3512 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}, for a discussion of
3513 that situation.
3514
3515 It is also possible to insert a breakpoint that will stop the program
3516 only if a specific thread (@pxref{Thread-Specific Breakpoints})
3517 or a specific task (@pxref{Ada Tasks}) hits that breakpoint.
3518
3519 @item break
3520 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
3521 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
3522 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
3523 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
3524 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
3525 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
3526 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
3527 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
3528 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
3529 inside loops.
3530
3531 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
3532 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
3533 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
3534 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
3535 existed when your program stopped.
3536
3537 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
3538 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
3539 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
3540 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
3541 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
3542 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
3543 ,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
3544
3545 @kindex tbreak
3546 @item tbreak @var{args}
3547 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args} are the
3548 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
3549 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
3550 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3551
3552 @kindex hbreak
3553 @cindex hardware breakpoints
3554 @item hbreak @var{args}
3555 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. The @var{args} are the same as for the
3556 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
3557 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
3558 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
3559 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
3560 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
3561 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
3562 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
3563 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
3564 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
3565 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
3566 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
3567 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
3568 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
3569 @xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3570 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3571 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3572 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3573
3574 @kindex thbreak
3575 @item thbreak @var{args}
3576 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args}
3577 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
3578 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
3579 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
3580 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
3581 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
3582 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3583 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3584
3585 @kindex rbreak
3586 @cindex regular expression
3587 @cindex breakpoints at functions matching a regexp
3588 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
3589 @item rbreak @var{regex}
3590 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
3591 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
3592 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
3593 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
3594 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
3595 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
3596
3597 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
3598 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
3599 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
3600 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
3601 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
3602 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
3603
3604 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
3605 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
3606 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
3607 classes.
3608
3609 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
3610 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
3611 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
3612
3613 @smallexample
3614 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
3615 @end smallexample
3616
3617 @item rbreak @var{file}:@var{regex}
3618 If @code{rbreak} is called with a filename qualification, it limits
3619 the search for functions matching the given regular expression to the
3620 specified @var{file}. This can be used, for example, to set breakpoints on
3621 every function in a given file:
3622
3623 @smallexample
3624 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak file.c:.
3625 @end smallexample
3626
3627 The colon separating the filename qualifier from the regex may
3628 optionally be surrounded by spaces.
3629
3630 @kindex info breakpoints
3631 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
3632 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
3633 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
3634 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
3635 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
3636 about the specified breakpoint(s) (or watchpoint(s) or catchpoint(s)).
3637 For each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
3638
3639 @table @emph
3640 @item Breakpoint Numbers
3641 @item Type
3642 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
3643 @item Disposition
3644 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
3645 @item Enabled or Disabled
3646 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
3647 that are not enabled.
3648 @item Address
3649 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a
3650 pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
3651 contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Such breakpoint won't fire until a shared
3652 library that has the symbol or line referred by breakpoint is loaded.
3653 See below for details. A breakpoint with several locations will
3654 have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
3655 @item What
3656 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3657 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3658 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3659 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3660 @end table
3661
3662 @noindent
3663 If a breakpoint is conditional, there are two evaluation modes: ``host'' and
3664 ``target''. If mode is ``host'', breakpoint condition evaluation is done by
3665 @value{GDBN} on the host's side. If it is ``target'', then the condition
3666 is evaluated by the target. The @code{info break} command shows
3667 the condition on the line following the affected breakpoint, together with
3668 its condition evaluation mode in between parentheses.
3669
3670 Breakpoint commands, if any, are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is
3671 allowed to have a condition specified for it. The condition is not parsed for
3672 validity until a shared library is loaded that allows the pending
3673 breakpoint to resolve to a valid location.
3674
3675 @noindent
3676 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3677 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3678 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3679 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3680 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3681
3682 @noindent
3683 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3684 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3685 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3686 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3687 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3688 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3689
3690 @noindent
3691 For a breakpoints with an enable count (xref) greater than 1,
3692 @code{info break} also displays that count.
3693
3694 @end table
3695
3696 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3697 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3698 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3699 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3700
3701 @cindex multiple locations, breakpoints
3702 @cindex breakpoints, multiple locations
3703 It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
3704 in your program. Examples of this situation are:
3705
3706 @itemize @bullet
3707 @item
3708 Multiple functions in the program may have the same name.
3709
3710 @item
3711 For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
3712 instances of the function body, used in different cases.
3713
3714 @item
3715 For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
3716 correspond to any number of instantiations.
3717
3718 @item
3719 For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
3720 several places where that function is inlined.
3721 @end itemize
3722
3723 In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
3724 the relevant locations.
3725
3726 A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint
3727 table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for
3728 each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the
3729 address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual
3730 addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those
3731 locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form
3732 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
3733
3734 For example:
3735
3736 @smallexample
3737 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
3738 1 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
3739 stop only if i==1
3740 breakpoint already hit 1 time
3741 1.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
3742 1.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
3743 @end smallexample
3744
3745 Each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
3746 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
3747 @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. Note that you cannot
3748 delete the individual locations from the list, you can only delete the
3749 entire list of locations that belong to their parent breakpoint (with
3750 the @kbd{delete @var{num}} command, where @var{num} is the number of
3751 the parent breakpoint, 1 in the above example). Disabling or enabling
3752 the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects all of the locations
3753 that belong to that breakpoint.
3754
3755 @cindex pending breakpoints
3756 It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
3757 Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
3758 and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support
3759 this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
3760 any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would
3761 set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
3762 debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
3763 symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set
3764 breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
3765 a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
3766 is not yet resolved.
3767
3768 After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
3769 @value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded
3770 shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
3771 pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
3772 ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
3773 that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
3774
3775 This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For
3776 example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
3777 a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
3778 a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
3779
3780 Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
3781 differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands,
3782 enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
3783
3784 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
3785 happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
3786 address specification to an address:
3787
3788 @kindex set breakpoint pending
3789 @kindex show breakpoint pending
3790 @table @code
3791 @item set breakpoint pending auto
3792 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
3793 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
3794
3795 @item set breakpoint pending on
3796 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
3797 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
3798
3799 @item set breakpoint pending off
3800 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
3801 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
3802 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
3803
3804 @item show breakpoint pending
3805 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
3806 @end table
3807
3808 The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
3809 variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
3810 as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
3811
3812 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
3813 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
3814 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
3815 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
3816 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
3817 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
3818 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
3819 breakpoints.
3820
3821 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands::
3822
3823 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
3824 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
3825 @table @code
3826 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
3827 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
3828 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
3829 breakpoint must be used.
3830
3831 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
3832 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
3833 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
3834 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
3835 @end table
3836
3837 @value{GDBN} normally implements breakpoints by replacing the program code
3838 at the breakpoint address with a special instruction, which, when
3839 executed, given control to the debugger. By default, the program
3840 code is so modified only when the program is resumed. As soon as
3841 the program stops, @value{GDBN} restores the original instructions. This
3842 behaviour guards against leaving breakpoints inserted in the
3843 target should gdb abrubptly disconnect. However, with slow remote
3844 targets, inserting and removing breakpoint can reduce the performance.
3845 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands::
3846
3847 @kindex set breakpoint always-inserted
3848 @kindex show breakpoint always-inserted
3849 @table @code
3850 @item set breakpoint always-inserted off
3851 All breakpoints, including newly added by the user, are inserted in
3852 the target only when the target is resumed. All breakpoints are
3853 removed from the target when it stops. This is the default mode.
3854
3855 @item set breakpoint always-inserted on
3856 Causes all breakpoints to be inserted in the target at all times. If
3857 the user adds a new breakpoint, or changes an existing breakpoint, the
3858 breakpoints in the target are updated immediately. A breakpoint is
3859 removed from the target only when breakpoint itself is deleted.
3860
3861 @value{GDBN} handles conditional breakpoints by evaluating these conditions
3862 when a breakpoint breaks. If the condition is true, then the process being
3863 debugged stops, otherwise the process is resumed.
3864
3865 If the target supports evaluating conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} may
3866 download the breakpoint, together with its conditions, to it.
3867
3868 This feature can be controlled via the following commands:
3869
3870 @kindex set breakpoint condition-evaluation
3871 @kindex show breakpoint condition-evaluation
3872 @table @code
3873 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation host
3874 This option commands @value{GDBN} to evaluate the breakpoint
3875 conditions on the host's side. Unconditional breakpoints are sent to
3876 the target which in turn receives the triggers and reports them back to GDB
3877 for condition evaluation. This is the standard evaluation mode.
3878
3879 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation target
3880 This option commands @value{GDBN} to download breakpoint conditions
3881 to the target at the moment of their insertion. The target
3882 is responsible for evaluating the conditional expression and reporting
3883 breakpoint stop events back to @value{GDBN} whenever the condition
3884 is true. Due to limitations of target-side evaluation, some conditions
3885 cannot be evaluated there, e.g., conditions that depend on local data
3886 that is only known to the host. Examples include
3887 conditional expressions involving convenience variables, complex types
3888 that cannot be handled by the agent expression parser and expressions
3889 that are too long to be sent over to the target, specially when the
3890 target is a remote system. In these cases, the conditions will be
3891 evaluated by @value{GDBN}.
3892
3893 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation auto
3894 This is the default mode. If the target supports evaluating breakpoint
3895 conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} will download breakpoint conditions to
3896 the target (limitations mentioned previously apply). If the target does
3897 not support breakpoint condition evaluation, then @value{GDBN} will fallback
3898 to evaluating all these conditions on the host's side.
3899 @end table
3900
3901
3902 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
3903 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
3904 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
3905 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
3906 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
3907 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
3908 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
3909 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
3910
3911
3912 @node Set Watchpoints
3913 @subsection Setting Watchpoints
3914
3915 @cindex setting watchpoints
3916 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
3917 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
3918 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
3919 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
3920 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
3921
3922 @itemize @bullet
3923 @item
3924 A reference to the value of a single variable.
3925
3926 @item
3927 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
3928 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
3929 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
3930
3931 @item
3932 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
3933 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
3934 language (@pxref{Languages}).
3935 @end itemize
3936
3937 You can set a watchpoint on an expression even if the expression can
3938 not be evaluated yet. For instance, you can set a watchpoint on
3939 @samp{*global_ptr} before @samp{global_ptr} is initialized.
3940 @value{GDBN} will stop when your program sets @samp{global_ptr} and
3941 the expression produces a valid value. If the expression becomes
3942 valid in some other way than changing a variable (e.g.@: if the memory
3943 pointed to by @samp{*global_ptr} becomes readable as the result of a
3944 @code{malloc} call), @value{GDBN} may not stop until the next time
3945 the expression changes.
3946
3947 @cindex software watchpoints
3948 @cindex hardware watchpoints
3949 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
3950 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
3951 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
3952 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
3953 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
3954 culprit.)
3955
3956 On some systems, such as HP-UX, PowerPC, @sc{gnu}/Linux and most other
3957 x86-based targets, @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware
3958 watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your program.
3959
3960 @table @code
3961 @kindex watch
3962 @item watch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
3963 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
3964 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
3965 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
3966 to watch the value of a single variable:
3967
3968 @smallexample
3969 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
3970 @end smallexample
3971
3972 If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}}
3973 argument, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by
3974 @var{threadnum} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads
3975 change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note
3976 that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work
3977 with Hardware Watchpoints.
3978
3979 Ordinarily a watchpoint respects the scope of variables in @var{expr}
3980 (see below). The @code{-location} argument tells @value{GDBN} to
3981 instead watch the memory referred to by @var{expr}. In this case,
3982 @value{GDBN} will evaluate @var{expr}, take the address of the result,
3983 and watch the memory at that address. The type of the result is used
3984 to determine the size of the watched memory. If the expression's
3985 result does not have an address, then @value{GDBN} will print an
3986 error.
3987
3988 The @code{@r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}} argument allows creation
3989 of masked watchpoints, if the current architecture supports this
3990 feature (e.g., PowerPC Embedded architecture, see @ref{PowerPC
3991 Embedded}.) A @dfn{masked watchpoint} specifies a mask in addition
3992 to an address to watch. The mask specifies that some bits of an address
3993 (the bits which are reset in the mask) should be ignored when matching
3994 the address accessed by the inferior against the watchpoint address.
3995 Thus, a masked watchpoint watches many addresses simultaneously---those
3996 addresses whose unmasked bits are identical to the unmasked bits in the
3997 watchpoint address. The @code{mask} argument implies @code{-location}.
3998 Examples:
3999
4000 @smallexample
4001 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo mask 0xffff00ff
4002 (@value{GDBP}) watch *0xdeadbeef mask 0xffffff00
4003 @end smallexample
4004
4005 @kindex rwatch
4006 @item rwatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4007 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
4008 by the program.
4009
4010 @kindex awatch
4011 @item awatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4012 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
4013 or written into by the program.
4014
4015 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
4016 @item info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
4017 This command prints a list of watchpoints, using the same format as
4018 @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
4019 @end table
4020
4021 If you watch for a change in a numerically entered address you need to
4022 dereference it, as the address itself is just a constant number which will
4023 never change. @value{GDBN} refuses to create a watchpoint that watches
4024 a never-changing value:
4025
4026 @smallexample
4027 (@value{GDBP}) watch 0x600850
4028 Cannot watch constant value 0x600850.
4029 (@value{GDBP}) watch *(int *) 0x600850
4030 Watchpoint 1: *(int *) 6293584
4031 @end smallexample
4032
4033 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
4034 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
4035 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
4036 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
4037 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
4038 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
4039
4040 @cindex use only software watchpoints
4041 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
4042 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
4043 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
4044 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
4045 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
4046 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
4047 mechanism of watching expression values.)
4048
4049 @table @code
4050 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4051 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4052 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
4053
4054 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4055 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4056 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
4057 @end table
4058
4059 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
4060 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
4061 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
4062
4063 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
4064
4065 @smallexample
4066 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
4067 @end smallexample
4068
4069 @noindent
4070 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
4071
4072 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
4073 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
4074 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
4075 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
4076 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
4077 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
4078 will print a message like this:
4079
4080 @smallexample
4081 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
4082 @end smallexample
4083
4084 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
4085 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
4086 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
4087 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
4088 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
4089 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
4090 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
4091 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
4092
4093 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
4094 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
4095 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
4096 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
4097 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
4098 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
4099
4100 @smallexample
4101 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
4102 @end smallexample
4103
4104 @noindent
4105 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
4106
4107 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
4108 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
4109 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
4110 expression with separately allocated resources.
4111
4112 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
4113 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
4114 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
4115
4116 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
4117 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
4118 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
4119 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
4120 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
4121 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
4122 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
4123 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
4124 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
4125
4126 @cindex watchpoints and threads
4127 @cindex threads and watchpoints
4128 In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
4129 watched expression from every thread.
4130
4131 @quotation
4132 @emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
4133 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
4134 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
4135 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
4136 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
4137 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
4138 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
4139 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
4140 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
4141 @end quotation
4142
4143 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
4144
4145 @node Set Catchpoints
4146 @subsection Setting Catchpoints
4147 @cindex catchpoints, setting
4148 @cindex exception handlers
4149 @cindex event handling
4150
4151 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
4152 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
4153 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
4154
4155 @table @code
4156 @kindex catch
4157 @item catch @var{event}
4158 Stop when @var{event} occurs. The @var{event} can be any of the following:
4159
4160 @table @code
4161 @item throw @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4162 @itemx rethrow @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4163 @itemx catch @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4164 @kindex catch throw
4165 @kindex catch rethrow
4166 @kindex catch catch
4167 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
4168 The throwing, re-throwing, or catching of a C@t{++} exception.
4169
4170 If @var{regexp} is given, then only exceptions whose type matches the
4171 regular expression will be caught.
4172
4173 @vindex $_exception@r{, convenience variable}
4174 The convenience variable @code{$_exception} is available at an
4175 exception-related catchpoint, on some systems. This holds the
4176 exception being thrown.
4177
4178 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling in
4179 @value{GDBN}:
4180
4181 @itemize @bullet
4182 @item
4183 The support for these commands is system-dependent. Currently, only
4184 systems using the @samp{gnu-v3} C@t{++} ABI (@pxref{ABI}) are
4185 supported.
4186
4187 @item
4188 The regular expression feature and the @code{$_exception} convenience
4189 variable rely on the presence of some SDT probes in @code{libstdc++}.
4190 If these probes are not present, then these features cannot be used.
4191 These probes were first available in the GCC 4.8 release, but whether
4192 or not they are available in your GCC also depends on how it was
4193 built.
4194
4195 @item
4196 The @code{$_exception} convenience variable is only valid at the
4197 instruction at which an exception-related catchpoint is set.
4198
4199 @item
4200 When an exception-related catchpoint is hit, @value{GDBN} stops at a
4201 location in the system library which implements runtime exception
4202 support for C@t{++}, usually @code{libstdc++}. You can use @code{up}
4203 (@pxref{Selection}) to get to your code.
4204
4205 @item
4206 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
4207 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
4208 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
4209 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
4210 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
4211 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
4212 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
4213 disabled within interactive calls. @xref{Calling}, for information on
4214 controlling this with @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception}.
4215
4216 @item
4217 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
4218
4219 @item
4220 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
4221 @end itemize
4222
4223 @item exception
4224 @kindex catch exception
4225 @cindex Ada exception catching
4226 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
4227 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
4228 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
4229 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
4230 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
4231
4232 When inserting an exception catchpoint on a user-defined exception whose
4233 name is identical to one of the exceptions defined by the language, the
4234 fully qualified name must be used as the exception name. Otherwise,
4235 @value{GDBN} will assume that it should stop on the pre-defined exception
4236 rather than the user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception
4237 called @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then
4238 the command to use to catch such exceptions is @kbd{catch exception
4239 Pck.Constraint_Error}.
4240
4241 @item exception unhandled
4242 @kindex catch exception unhandled
4243 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
4244
4245 @item assert
4246 @kindex catch assert
4247 A failed Ada assertion.
4248
4249 @item exec
4250 @kindex catch exec
4251 @cindex break on fork/exec
4252 A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
4253 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
4254
4255 @item syscall
4256 @itemx syscall @r{[}@var{name} @r{|} @var{number}@r{]} @dots{}
4257 @kindex catch syscall
4258 @cindex break on a system call.
4259 A call to or return from a system call, a.k.a.@: @dfn{syscall}. A
4260 syscall is a mechanism for application programs to request a service
4261 from the operating system (OS) or one of the OS system services.
4262 @value{GDBN} can catch some or all of the syscalls issued by the
4263 debuggee, and show the related information for each syscall. If no
4264 argument is specified, calls to and returns from all system calls
4265 will be caught.
4266
4267 @var{name} can be any system call name that is valid for the
4268 underlying OS. Just what syscalls are valid depends on the OS. On
4269 GNU and Unix systems, you can find the full list of valid syscall
4270 names on @file{/usr/include/asm/unistd.h}.
4271
4272 @c For MS-Windows, the syscall names and the corresponding numbers
4273 @c can be found, e.g., on this URL:
4274 @c http://www.metasploit.com/users/opcode/syscalls.html
4275 @c but we don't support Windows syscalls yet.
4276
4277 Normally, @value{GDBN} knows in advance which syscalls are valid for
4278 each OS, so you can use the @value{GDBN} command-line completion
4279 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4280 available choices.
4281
4282 You may also specify the system call numerically. A syscall's
4283 number is the value passed to the OS's syscall dispatcher to
4284 identify the requested service. When you specify the syscall by its
4285 name, @value{GDBN} uses its database of syscalls to convert the name
4286 into the corresponding numeric code, but using the number directly
4287 may be useful if @value{GDBN}'s database does not have the complete
4288 list of syscalls on your system (e.g., because @value{GDBN} lags
4289 behind the OS upgrades).
4290
4291 The example below illustrates how this command works if you don't provide
4292 arguments to it:
4293
4294 @smallexample
4295 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4296 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4297 (@value{GDBP}) r
4298 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4299
4300 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'close'), \
4301 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4302 (@value{GDBP}) c
4303 Continuing.
4304
4305 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'close'), \
4306 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4307 (@value{GDBP})
4308 @end smallexample
4309
4310 Here is an example of catching a system call by name:
4311
4312 @smallexample
4313 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall chroot
4314 Catchpoint 1 (syscall 'chroot' [61])
4315 (@value{GDBP}) r
4316 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4317
4318 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'chroot'), \
4319 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4320 (@value{GDBP}) c
4321 Continuing.
4322
4323 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'chroot'), \
4324 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4325 (@value{GDBP})
4326 @end smallexample
4327
4328 An example of specifying a system call numerically. In the case
4329 below, the syscall number has a corresponding entry in the XML
4330 file, so @value{GDBN} finds its name and prints it:
4331
4332 @smallexample
4333 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4334 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 'exit_group')
4335 (@value{GDBP}) r
4336 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4337
4338 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'exit_group'), \
4339 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4340 (@value{GDBP}) c
4341 Continuing.
4342
4343 Program exited normally.
4344 (@value{GDBP})
4345 @end smallexample
4346
4347 However, there can be situations when there is no corresponding name
4348 in XML file for that syscall number. In this case, @value{GDBN} prints
4349 a warning message saying that it was not able to find the syscall name,
4350 but the catchpoint will be set anyway. See the example below:
4351
4352 @smallexample
4353 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 764
4354 warning: The number '764' does not represent a known syscall.
4355 Catchpoint 2 (syscall 764)
4356 (@value{GDBP})
4357 @end smallexample
4358
4359 If you configure @value{GDBN} using the @samp{--without-expat} option,
4360 it will not be able to display syscall names. Also, if your
4361 architecture does not have an XML file describing its system calls,
4362 you will not be able to see the syscall names. It is important to
4363 notice that these two features are used for accessing the syscall
4364 name database. In either case, you will see a warning like this:
4365
4366 @smallexample
4367 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4368 warning: Could not open "syscalls/i386-linux.xml"
4369 warning: Could not load the syscall XML file 'syscalls/i386-linux.xml'.
4370 GDB will not be able to display syscall names.
4371 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4372 (@value{GDBP})
4373 @end smallexample
4374
4375 Of course, the file name will change depending on your architecture and system.
4376
4377 Still using the example above, you can also try to catch a syscall by its
4378 number. In this case, you would see something like:
4379
4380 @smallexample
4381 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4382 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 252)
4383 @end smallexample
4384
4385 Again, in this case @value{GDBN} would not be able to display syscall's names.
4386
4387 @item fork
4388 @kindex catch fork
4389 A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
4390 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
4391
4392 @item vfork
4393 @kindex catch vfork
4394 A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
4395 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
4396
4397 @item load @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4398 @itemx unload @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4399 @kindex catch load
4400 @kindex catch unload
4401 The loading or unloading of a shared library. If @var{regexp} is
4402 given, then the catchpoint will stop only if the regular expression
4403 matches one of the affected libraries.
4404
4405 @item signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
4406 @kindex catch signal
4407 The delivery of a signal.
4408
4409 With no arguments, this catchpoint will catch any signal that is not
4410 used internally by @value{GDBN}, specifically, all signals except
4411 @samp{SIGTRAP} and @samp{SIGINT}.
4412
4413 With the argument @samp{all}, all signals, including those used by
4414 @value{GDBN}, will be caught. This argument cannot be used with other
4415 signal names.
4416
4417 Otherwise, the arguments are a list of signal names as given to
4418 @code{handle} (@pxref{Signals}). Only signals specified in this list
4419 will be caught.
4420
4421 One reason that @code{catch signal} can be more useful than
4422 @code{handle} is that you can attach commands and conditions to the
4423 catchpoint.
4424
4425 When a signal is caught by a catchpoint, the signal's @code{stop} and
4426 @code{print} settings, as specified by @code{handle}, are ignored.
4427 However, whether the signal is still delivered to the inferior depends
4428 on the @code{pass} setting; this can be changed in the catchpoint's
4429 commands.
4430
4431 @end table
4432
4433 @item tcatch @var{event}
4434 @kindex tcatch
4435 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
4436 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
4437
4438 @end table
4439
4440 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
4441
4442
4443 @node Delete Breaks
4444 @subsection Deleting Breakpoints
4445
4446 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4447 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4448 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
4449 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
4450 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
4451 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
4452
4453 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
4454 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
4455 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
4456 their breakpoint numbers.
4457
4458 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
4459 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
4460 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
4461
4462 @table @code
4463 @kindex clear
4464 @item clear
4465 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
4466 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
4467 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
4468 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
4469
4470 @item clear @var{location}
4471 Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}.
4472 @xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the
4473 most useful ones are listed below:
4474
4475 @table @code
4476 @item clear @var{function}
4477 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
4478 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
4479
4480 @item clear @var{linenum}
4481 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
4482 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
4483 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
4484 @end table
4485
4486 @cindex delete breakpoints
4487 @kindex delete
4488 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
4489 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4490 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
4491 ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
4492 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
4493 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
4494 @end table
4495
4496 @node Disabling
4497 @subsection Disabling Breakpoints
4498
4499 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
4500 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
4501 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
4502 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
4503 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
4504
4505 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
4506 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying
4507 one or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} to
4508 print a list of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints if you
4509 do not know which numbers to use.
4510
4511 Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
4512 affects all of its locations.
4513
4514 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of several
4515 different states of enablement:
4516
4517 @itemize @bullet
4518 @item
4519 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
4520 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
4521 @item
4522 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
4523 @item
4524 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
4525 disabled.
4526 @item
4527 Enabled for a count. The breakpoint stops your program for the next
4528 N times, then becomes disabled.
4529 @item
4530 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
4531 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
4532 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
4533 @end itemize
4534
4535 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
4536 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
4537
4538 @table @code
4539 @kindex disable
4540 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
4541 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4542 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
4543 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
4544 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
4545 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
4546 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
4547
4548 @kindex enable
4549 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4550 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
4551 become effective once again in stopping your program.
4552
4553 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
4554 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
4555 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
4556
4557 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} count @var{count} @var{range}@dots{}
4558 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} records
4559 @var{count} with each of the specified breakpoints, and decrements a
4560 breakpoint's count when it is hit. When any count reaches 0,
4561 @value{GDBN} disables that breakpoint. If a breakpoint has an ignore
4562 count (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}), that will be
4563 decremented to 0 before @var{count} is affected.
4564
4565 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
4566 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
4567 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
4568 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
4569 @end table
4570
4571 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
4572 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
4573 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
4574 ,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
4575 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
4576 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
4577 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
4578 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
4579 Stepping}.)
4580
4581 @node Conditions
4582 @subsection Break Conditions
4583 @cindex conditional breakpoints
4584 @cindex breakpoint conditions
4585
4586 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
4587 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
4588 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
4589 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
4590 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
4591 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
4592 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
4593 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
4594
4595 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
4596 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
4597 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
4598 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
4599 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
4600
4601 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
4602 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
4603 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
4604 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
4605 one.
4606
4607 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
4608 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
4609 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
4610 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
4611 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
4612 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
4613 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
4614 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
4615 conditions for the
4616 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
4617 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
4618
4619 Breakpoint conditions can also be evaluated on the target's side if
4620 the target supports it. Instead of evaluating the conditions locally,
4621 @value{GDBN} encodes the expression into an agent expression
4622 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) suitable for execution on the target,
4623 independently of @value{GDBN}. Global variables become raw memory
4624 locations, locals become stack accesses, and so forth.
4625
4626 In this case, @value{GDBN} will only be notified of a breakpoint trigger
4627 when its condition evaluates to true. This mechanism may provide faster
4628 response times depending on the performance characteristics of the target
4629 since it does not need to keep @value{GDBN} informed about
4630 every breakpoint trigger, even those with false conditions.
4631
4632 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
4633 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
4634 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
4635 with the @code{condition} command.
4636
4637 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
4638 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
4639 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
4640 catchpoint.
4641
4642 @table @code
4643 @kindex condition
4644 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
4645 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
4646 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
4647 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
4648 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
4649 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
4650 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
4651 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
4652 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
4653 prints an error message:
4654
4655 @smallexample
4656 No symbol "foo" in current context.
4657 @end smallexample
4658
4659 @noindent
4660 @value{GDBN} does
4661 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
4662 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
4663 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4664
4665 @item condition @var{bnum}
4666 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
4667 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
4668 @end table
4669
4670 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
4671 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
4672 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
4673 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
4674 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
4675 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
4676 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
4677 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
4678 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
4679 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
4680 your program reaches it.
4681
4682 @table @code
4683 @kindex ignore
4684 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
4685 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
4686 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
4687 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
4688 takes no action.
4689
4690 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
4691 a count of zero.
4692
4693 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
4694 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
4695 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
4696 Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
4697
4698 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
4699 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
4700 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
4701
4702 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
4703 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
4704 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4705 Variables}.
4706 @end table
4707
4708 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
4709
4710
4711 @node Break Commands
4712 @subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
4713
4714 @cindex breakpoint commands
4715 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
4716 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
4717 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
4718 enable other breakpoints.
4719
4720 @table @code
4721 @kindex commands
4722 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
4723 @item commands @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4724 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
4725 @itemx end
4726 Specify a list of commands for the given breakpoints. The commands
4727 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
4728 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
4729
4730 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
4731 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
4732
4733 With no argument, @code{commands} refers to the last breakpoint,
4734 watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most recently
4735 encountered). If the most recent breakpoints were set with a single
4736 command, then the @code{commands} will apply to all the breakpoints
4737 set by that command. This applies to breakpoints set by
4738 @code{rbreak}, and also applies when a single @code{break} command
4739 creates multiple breakpoints (@pxref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous
4740 Expressions}).
4741 @end table
4742
4743 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
4744 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
4745
4746 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
4747 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
4748 that resumes execution.
4749
4750 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
4751 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
4752 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
4753 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
4754 ambiguities about which list to execute.
4755
4756 @kindex silent
4757 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
4758 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
4759 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
4760 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
4761 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
4762 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
4763
4764 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
4765 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
4766 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
4767
4768 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
4769 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
4770
4771 @smallexample
4772 break foo if x>0
4773 commands
4774 silent
4775 printf "x is %d\n",x
4776 cont
4777 end
4778 @end smallexample
4779
4780 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
4781 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
4782 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
4783 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
4784 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
4785 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
4786 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
4787
4788 @smallexample
4789 break 403
4790 commands
4791 silent
4792 set x = y + 4
4793 cont
4794 end
4795 @end smallexample
4796
4797 @node Dynamic Printf
4798 @subsection Dynamic Printf
4799
4800 @cindex dynamic printf
4801 @cindex dprintf
4802 The dynamic printf command @code{dprintf} combines a breakpoint with
4803 formatted printing of your program's data to give you the effect of
4804 inserting @code{printf} calls into your program on-the-fly, without
4805 having to recompile it.
4806
4807 In its most basic form, the output goes to the GDB console. However,
4808 you can set the variable @code{dprintf-style} for alternate handling.
4809 For instance, you can ask to format the output by calling your
4810 program's @code{printf} function. This has the advantage that the
4811 characters go to the program's output device, so they can recorded in
4812 redirects to files and so forth.
4813
4814 If you are doing remote debugging with a stub or agent, you can also
4815 ask to have the printf handled by the remote agent. In addition to
4816 ensuring that the output goes to the remote program's device along
4817 with any other output the program might produce, you can also ask that
4818 the dprintf remain active even after disconnecting from the remote
4819 target. Using the stub/agent is also more efficient, as it can do
4820 everything without needing to communicate with @value{GDBN}.
4821
4822 @table @code
4823 @kindex dprintf
4824 @item dprintf @var{location},@var{template},@var{expression}[,@var{expression}@dots{}]
4825 Whenever execution reaches @var{location}, print the values of one or
4826 more @var{expressions} under the control of the string @var{template}.
4827 To print several values, separate them with commas.
4828
4829 @item set dprintf-style @var{style}
4830 Set the dprintf output to be handled in one of several different
4831 styles enumerated below. A change of style affects all existing
4832 dynamic printfs immediately. (If you need individual control over the
4833 print commands, simply define normal breakpoints with
4834 explicitly-supplied command lists.)
4835
4836 @item gdb
4837 @kindex dprintf-style gdb
4838 Handle the output using the @value{GDBN} @code{printf} command.
4839
4840 @item call
4841 @kindex dprintf-style call
4842 Handle the output by calling a function in your program (normally
4843 @code{printf}).
4844
4845 @item agent
4846 @kindex dprintf-style agent
4847 Have the remote debugging agent (such as @code{gdbserver}) handle
4848 the output itself. This style is only available for agents that
4849 support running commands on the target.
4850
4851 @item set dprintf-function @var{function}
4852 Set the function to call if the dprintf style is @code{call}. By
4853 default its value is @code{printf}. You may set it to any expression.
4854 that @value{GDBN} can evaluate to a function, as per the @code{call}
4855 command.
4856
4857 @item set dprintf-channel @var{channel}
4858 Set a ``channel'' for dprintf. If set to a non-empty value,
4859 @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as an expression and pass the result as
4860 a first argument to the @code{dprintf-function}, in the manner of
4861 @code{fprintf} and similar functions. Otherwise, the dprintf format
4862 string will be the first argument, in the manner of @code{printf}.
4863
4864 As an example, if you wanted @code{dprintf} output to go to a logfile
4865 that is a standard I/O stream assigned to the variable @code{mylog},
4866 you could do the following:
4867
4868 @example
4869 (gdb) set dprintf-style call
4870 (gdb) set dprintf-function fprintf
4871 (gdb) set dprintf-channel mylog
4872 (gdb) dprintf 25,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob
4873 Dprintf 1 at 0x123456: file main.c, line 25.
4874 (gdb) info break
4875 1 dprintf keep y 0x00123456 in main at main.c:25
4876 call (void) fprintf (mylog,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob)
4877 continue
4878 (gdb)
4879 @end example
4880
4881 Note that the @code{info break} displays the dynamic printf commands
4882 as normal breakpoint commands; you can thus easily see the effect of
4883 the variable settings.
4884
4885 @item set disconnected-dprintf on
4886 @itemx set disconnected-dprintf off
4887 @kindex set disconnected-dprintf
4888 Choose whether @code{dprintf} commands should continue to run if
4889 @value{GDBN} has disconnected from the target. This only applies
4890 if the @code{dprintf-style} is @code{agent}.
4891
4892 @item show disconnected-dprintf off
4893 @kindex show disconnected-dprintf
4894 Show the current choice for disconnected @code{dprintf}.
4895
4896 @end table
4897
4898 @value{GDBN} does not check the validity of function and channel,
4899 relying on you to supply values that are meaningful for the contexts
4900 in which they are being used. For instance, the function and channel
4901 may be the values of local variables, but if that is the case, then
4902 all enabled dynamic prints must be at locations within the scope of
4903 those locals. If evaluation fails, @value{GDBN} will report an error.
4904
4905 @node Save Breakpoints
4906 @subsection How to save breakpoints to a file
4907
4908 To save breakpoint definitions to a file use the @w{@code{save
4909 breakpoints}} command.
4910
4911 @table @code
4912 @kindex save breakpoints
4913 @cindex save breakpoints to a file for future sessions
4914 @item save breakpoints [@var{filename}]
4915 This command saves all current breakpoint definitions together with
4916 their commands and ignore counts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
4917 suitable for use in a later debugging session. This includes all
4918 types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints,
4919 tracepoints). To read the saved breakpoint definitions, use the
4920 @code{source} command (@pxref{Command Files}). Note that watchpoints
4921 with expressions involving local variables may fail to be recreated
4922 because it may not be possible to access the context where the
4923 watchpoint is valid anymore. Because the saved breakpoint definitions
4924 are simply a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands that recreate the
4925 breakpoints, you can edit the file in your favorite editing program,
4926 and remove the breakpoint definitions you're not interested in, or
4927 that can no longer be recreated.
4928 @end table
4929
4930 @node Static Probe Points
4931 @subsection Static Probe Points
4932
4933 @cindex static probe point, SystemTap
4934 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{SDT} probes in the code. @acronym{SDT} stands
4935 for Statically Defined Tracing, and the probes are designed to have a tiny
4936 runtime code and data footprint, and no dynamic relocations. They are
4937 usable from assembly, C and C@t{++} languages. See
4938 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/UserSpaceProbeImplementation}
4939 for a good reference on how the @acronym{SDT} probes are implemented.
4940
4941 Currently, @code{SystemTap} (@uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/})
4942 @acronym{SDT} probes are supported on ELF-compatible systems. See
4943 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/AddingUserSpaceProbingToApps}
4944 for more information on how to add @code{SystemTap} @acronym{SDT} probes
4945 in your applications.
4946
4947 @cindex semaphores on static probe points
4948 Some probes have an associated semaphore variable; for instance, this
4949 happens automatically if you defined your probe using a DTrace-style
4950 @file{.d} file. If your probe has a semaphore, @value{GDBN} will
4951 automatically enable it when you specify a breakpoint using the
4952 @samp{-probe-stap} notation. But, if you put a breakpoint at a probe's
4953 location by some other method (e.g., @code{break file:line}), then
4954 @value{GDBN} will not automatically set the semaphore.
4955
4956 You can examine the available static static probes using @code{info
4957 probes}, with optional arguments:
4958
4959 @table @code
4960 @kindex info probes
4961 @item info probes stap @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
4962 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against provider
4963 names when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probes by all
4964 probes from all providers are listed.
4965
4966 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe names
4967 when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probe names are not
4968 considered when deciding whether to display them.
4969
4970 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
4971 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
4972 given, all object files are considered.
4973
4974 @item info probes all
4975 List the available static probes, from all types.
4976 @end table
4977
4978 @vindex $_probe_arg@r{, convenience variable}
4979 A probe may specify up to twelve arguments. These are available at the
4980 point at which the probe is defined---that is, when the current PC is
4981 at the probe's location. The arguments are available using the
4982 convenience variables (@pxref{Convenience Vars})
4983 @code{$_probe_arg0}@dots{}@code{$_probe_arg11}. Each probe argument is
4984 an integer of the appropriate size; types are not preserved. The
4985 convenience variable @code{$_probe_argc} holds the number of arguments
4986 at the current probe point.
4987
4988 These variables are always available, but attempts to access them at
4989 any location other than a probe point will cause @value{GDBN} to give
4990 an error message.
4991
4992
4993 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
4994 @node Error in Breakpoints
4995 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
4996
4997 If you request too many active hardware-assisted breakpoints and
4998 watchpoints, you will see this error message:
4999
5000 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
5001 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
5002 @smallexample
5003 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
5004 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
5005 @end smallexample
5006
5007 @noindent
5008 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
5009 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
5010 watchpoints it needs to insert.
5011
5012 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
5013 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
5014
5015 @node Breakpoint-related Warnings
5016 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
5017 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
5018
5019 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
5020 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
5021 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
5022 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
5023
5024 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
5025 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
5026 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
5027 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
5028 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
5029 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
5030 first in the bundle.
5031
5032 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
5033 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
5034 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
5035 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
5036 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
5037 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
5038 is hit.
5039
5040 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
5041 that's been subject to address adjustment:
5042
5043 @smallexample
5044 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
5045 @end smallexample
5046
5047 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
5048 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
5049 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
5050 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
5051 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
5052 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
5053 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
5054 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
5055
5056 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
5057 adjusted breakpoints:
5058
5059 @smallexample
5060 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
5061 to 0x00010410.
5062 @end smallexample
5063
5064 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
5065 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
5066 frequently than expected.
5067
5068 @node Continuing and Stepping
5069 @section Continuing and Stepping
5070
5071 @cindex stepping
5072 @cindex continuing
5073 @cindex resuming execution
5074 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
5075 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
5076 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
5077 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
5078 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
5079 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
5080 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
5081 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
5082
5083 @table @code
5084 @kindex continue
5085 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
5086 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
5087 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5088 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5089 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5090 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
5091 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
5092 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
5093 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
5094 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
5095
5096 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
5097 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
5098 @code{continue} is ignored.
5099
5100 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
5101 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
5102 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
5103 @code{continue}.
5104 @end table
5105
5106 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
5107 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
5108 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
5109 Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
5110
5111 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
5112 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
5113 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
5114 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
5115 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
5116 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
5117
5118 @table @code
5119 @kindex step
5120 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
5121 @item step
5122 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
5123 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
5124 abbreviated @code{s}.
5125
5126 @quotation
5127 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
5128 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
5129 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
5130 @c distinction here.
5131 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
5132 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
5133 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
5134 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
5135 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
5136 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
5137 below.
5138 @end quotation
5139
5140 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
5141 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5142 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
5143 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
5144 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
5145 called within the line.
5146
5147 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
5148 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
5149 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
5150 on @acronym{MIPS} machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
5151 was any debugging information about the routine.
5152
5153 @item step @var{count}
5154 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
5155 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
5156 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
5157
5158 @kindex next
5159 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
5160 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5161 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
5162 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
5163 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
5164 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
5165 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
5166 is abbreviated @code{n}.
5167
5168 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
5169
5170
5171 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
5172 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
5173 @c
5174 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
5175 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
5176 @c function are executed without stopping.
5177
5178 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
5179 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5180 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
5181
5182 @kindex set step-mode
5183 @item set step-mode
5184 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
5185 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
5186 @itemx set step-mode on
5187 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
5188 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
5189 information rather than stepping over it.
5190
5191 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
5192 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
5193 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
5194
5195 @item set step-mode off
5196 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
5197 debug information. This is the default.
5198
5199 @item show step-mode
5200 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
5201 source line debug information.
5202
5203 @kindex finish
5204 @kindex fin @r{(@code{finish})}
5205 @item finish
5206 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
5207 returns. Print the returned value (if any). This command can be
5208 abbreviated as @code{fin}.
5209
5210 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
5211 ,Returning from a Function}).
5212
5213 @kindex until
5214 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
5215 @cindex run until specified location
5216 @item until
5217 @itemx u
5218 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
5219 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
5220 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
5221 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
5222 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
5223 than the address of the jump.
5224
5225 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
5226 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
5227 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
5228 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
5229 through the next iteration.
5230
5231 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
5232 stack frame.
5233
5234 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
5235 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
5236 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
5237 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
5238 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
5239
5240 @smallexample
5241 (@value{GDBP}) f
5242 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
5243 206 expand_input();
5244 (@value{GDBP}) until
5245 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
5246 @end smallexample
5247
5248 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
5249 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
5250 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
5251 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
5252 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
5253 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
5254 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
5255
5256 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
5257 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
5258 argument.
5259
5260 @item until @var{location}
5261 @itemx u @var{location}
5262 Continue running your program until either the specified @var{location} is
5263 reached, or the current stack frame returns. The location is any of
5264 the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}.
5265 This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and
5266 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
5267 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
5268 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
5269 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
5270 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
5271 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
5272 invocations have returned.
5273
5274 @smallexample
5275 94 int factorial (int value)
5276 95 @{
5277 96 if (value > 1) @{
5278 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
5279 98 @}
5280 99 return (value);
5281 100 @}
5282 @end smallexample
5283
5284
5285 @kindex advance @var{location}
5286 @item advance @var{location}
5287 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
5288 required, which should be of one of the forms described in
5289 @ref{Specify Location}.
5290 Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
5291 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
5292 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
5293 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
5294
5295
5296 @kindex stepi
5297 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
5298 @item stepi
5299 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
5300 @itemx si
5301 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
5302
5303 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
5304 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
5305 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
5306 Display,, Automatic Display}.
5307
5308 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
5309
5310 @need 750
5311 @kindex nexti
5312 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
5313 @item nexti
5314 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
5315 @itemx ni
5316 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
5317 proceed until the function returns.
5318
5319 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
5320
5321 @end table
5322
5323 @anchor{range stepping}
5324 @cindex range stepping
5325 @cindex target-assisted range stepping
5326 By default, and if available, @value{GDBN} makes use of
5327 target-assisted @dfn{range stepping}. In other words, whenever you
5328 use a stepping command (e.g., @code{step}, @code{next}), @value{GDBN}
5329 tells the target to step the corresponding range of instruction
5330 addresses instead of issuing multiple single-steps. This speeds up
5331 line stepping, particularly for remote targets. Ideally, there should
5332 be no reason you would want to turn range stepping off. However, it's
5333 possible that a bug in the debug info, a bug in the remote stub (for
5334 remote targets), or even a bug in @value{GDBN} could make line
5335 stepping behave incorrectly when target-assisted range stepping is
5336 enabled. You can use the following command to turn off range stepping
5337 if necessary:
5338
5339 @table @code
5340 @kindex set range-stepping
5341 @kindex show range-stepping
5342 @item set range-stepping
5343 @itemx show range-stepping
5344 Control whether range stepping is enabled.
5345
5346 If @code{on}, and the target supports it, @value{GDBN} tells the
5347 target to step a range of addresses itself, instead of issuing
5348 multiple single-steps. If @code{off}, @value{GDBN} always issues
5349 single-steps, even if range stepping is supported by the target. The
5350 default is @code{on}.
5351
5352 @end table
5353
5354 @node Skipping Over Functions and Files
5355 @section Skipping Over Functions and Files
5356 @cindex skipping over functions and files
5357
5358 The program you are debugging may contain some functions which are
5359 uninteresting to debug. The @code{skip} comand lets you tell @value{GDBN} to
5360 skip a function or all functions in a file when stepping.
5361
5362 For example, consider the following C function:
5363
5364 @smallexample
5365 101 int func()
5366 102 @{
5367 103 foo(boring());
5368 104 bar(boring());
5369 105 @}
5370 @end smallexample
5371
5372 @noindent
5373 Suppose you wish to step into the functions @code{foo} and @code{bar}, but you
5374 are not interested in stepping through @code{boring}. If you run @code{step}
5375 at line 103, you'll enter @code{boring()}, but if you run @code{next}, you'll
5376 step over both @code{foo} and @code{boring}!
5377
5378 One solution is to @code{step} into @code{boring} and use the @code{finish}
5379 command to immediately exit it. But this can become tedious if @code{boring}
5380 is called from many places.
5381
5382 A more flexible solution is to execute @kbd{skip boring}. This instructs
5383 @value{GDBN} never to step into @code{boring}. Now when you execute
5384 @code{step} at line 103, you'll step over @code{boring} and directly into
5385 @code{foo}.
5386
5387 You can also instruct @value{GDBN} to skip all functions in a file, with, for
5388 example, @code{skip file boring.c}.
5389
5390 @table @code
5391 @kindex skip function
5392 @item skip @r{[}@var{linespec}@r{]}
5393 @itemx skip function @r{[}@var{linespec}@r{]}
5394 After running this command, the function named by @var{linespec} or the
5395 function containing the line named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when
5396 stepping. @xref{Specify Location}.
5397
5398 If you do not specify @var{linespec}, the function you're currently debugging
5399 will be skipped.
5400
5401 (If you have a function called @code{file} that you want to skip, use
5402 @kbd{skip function file}.)
5403
5404 @kindex skip file
5405 @item skip file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
5406 After running this command, any function whose source lives in @var{filename}
5407 will be skipped over when stepping.
5408
5409 If you do not specify @var{filename}, functions whose source lives in the file
5410 you're currently debugging will be skipped.
5411 @end table
5412
5413 Skips can be listed, deleted, disabled, and enabled, much like breakpoints.
5414 These are the commands for managing your list of skips:
5415
5416 @table @code
5417 @kindex info skip
5418 @item info skip @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5419 Print details about the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified,
5420 print a table with details about all functions and files marked for skipping.
5421 @code{info skip} prints the following information about each skip:
5422
5423 @table @emph
5424 @item Identifier
5425 A number identifying this skip.
5426 @item Type
5427 The type of this skip, either @samp{function} or @samp{file}.
5428 @item Enabled or Disabled
5429 Enabled skips are marked with @samp{y}. Disabled skips are marked with @samp{n}.
5430 @item Address
5431 For function skips, this column indicates the address in memory of the function
5432 being skipped. If you've set a function skip on a function which has not yet
5433 been loaded, this field will contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Once a shared library
5434 which has the function is loaded, @code{info skip} will show the function's
5435 address here.
5436 @item What
5437 For file skips, this field contains the filename being skipped. For functions
5438 skips, this field contains the function name and its line number in the file
5439 where it is defined.
5440 @end table
5441
5442 @kindex skip delete
5443 @item skip delete @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5444 Delete the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, delete all
5445 skips.
5446
5447 @kindex skip enable
5448 @item skip enable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5449 Enable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, enable all
5450 skips.
5451
5452 @kindex skip disable
5453 @item skip disable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5454 Disable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, disable all
5455 skips.
5456
5457 @end table
5458
5459 @node Signals
5460 @section Signals
5461 @cindex signals
5462
5463 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
5464 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
5465 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
5466 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
5467 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
5468 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
5469 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
5470 requested an alarm).
5471
5472 @cindex fatal signals
5473 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
5474 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
5475 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
5476 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
5477 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
5478 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
5479
5480 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
5481 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
5482 signal.
5483
5484 @cindex handling signals
5485 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
5486 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
5487 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
5488 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
5489 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
5490
5491 @table @code
5492 @kindex info signals
5493 @kindex info handle
5494 @item info signals
5495 @itemx info handle
5496 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
5497 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
5498 the defined types of signals.
5499
5500 @item info signals @var{sig}
5501 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
5502
5503 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
5504
5505 @item catch signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
5506 Set a catchpoint for the indicated signals. @xref{Set Catchpoints},
5507 for details about this command.
5508
5509 @kindex handle
5510 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
5511 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal}
5512 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
5513 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
5514 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
5515 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
5516 say what change to make.
5517 @end table
5518
5519 @c @group
5520 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
5521 Their full names are:
5522
5523 @table @code
5524 @item nostop
5525 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
5526 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
5527
5528 @item stop
5529 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
5530 the @code{print} keyword as well.
5531
5532 @item print
5533 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
5534
5535 @item noprint
5536 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
5537 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
5538
5539 @item pass
5540 @itemx noignore
5541 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
5542 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
5543 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
5544
5545 @item nopass
5546 @itemx ignore
5547 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
5548 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
5549 @end table
5550 @c @end group
5551
5552 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
5553 program until you
5554 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
5555 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
5556 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
5557 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
5558 program sees that signal when you continue.
5559
5560 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
5561 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
5562 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
5563 erroneous signals.
5564
5565 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
5566 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
5567 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
5568 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
5569 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
5570 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
5571 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
5572 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
5573 Program a Signal}.
5574
5575 @cindex extra signal information
5576 @anchor{extra signal information}
5577
5578 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can inspect extra signal information
5579 associated with the intercepted signal, before it is actually
5580 delivered to the program being debugged. This information is exported
5581 by the convenience variable @code{$_siginfo}, and consists of data
5582 that is passed by the kernel to the signal handler at the time of the
5583 receipt of a signal. The data type of the information itself is
5584 target dependent. You can see the data type using the @code{ptype
5585 $_siginfo} command. On Unix systems, it typically corresponds to the
5586 standard @code{siginfo_t} type, as defined in the @file{signal.h}
5587 system header.
5588
5589 Here's an example, on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, printing the stray
5590 referenced address that raised a segmentation fault.
5591
5592 @smallexample
5593 @group
5594 (@value{GDBP}) continue
5595 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
5596 0x0000000000400766 in main ()
5597 69 *(int *)p = 0;
5598 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo
5599 type = struct @{
5600 int si_signo;
5601 int si_errno;
5602 int si_code;
5603 union @{
5604 int _pad[28];
5605 struct @{...@} _kill;
5606 struct @{...@} _timer;
5607 struct @{...@} _rt;
5608 struct @{...@} _sigchld;
5609 struct @{...@} _sigfault;
5610 struct @{...@} _sigpoll;
5611 @} _sifields;
5612 @}
5613 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault
5614 type = struct @{
5615 void *si_addr;
5616 @}
5617 (@value{GDBP}) p $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault.si_addr
5618 $1 = (void *) 0x7ffff7ff7000
5619 @end group
5620 @end smallexample
5621
5622 Depending on target support, @code{$_siginfo} may also be writable.
5623
5624 @node Thread Stops
5625 @section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
5626
5627 @cindex stopped threads
5628 @cindex threads, stopped
5629
5630 @cindex continuing threads
5631 @cindex threads, continuing
5632
5633 @value{GDBN} supports debugging programs with multiple threads
5634 (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads}). There
5635 are two modes of controlling execution of your program within the
5636 debugger. In the default mode, referred to as @dfn{all-stop mode},
5637 when any thread in your program stops (for example, at a breakpoint
5638 or while being stepped), all other threads in the program are also stopped by
5639 @value{GDBN}. On some targets, @value{GDBN} also supports
5640 @dfn{non-stop mode}, in which other threads can continue to run freely while
5641 you examine the stopped thread in the debugger.
5642
5643 @menu
5644 * All-Stop Mode:: All threads stop when GDB takes control
5645 * Non-Stop Mode:: Other threads continue to execute
5646 * Background Execution:: Running your program asynchronously
5647 * Thread-Specific Breakpoints:: Controlling breakpoints
5648 * Interrupted System Calls:: GDB may interfere with system calls
5649 * Observer Mode:: GDB does not alter program behavior
5650 @end menu
5651
5652 @node All-Stop Mode
5653 @subsection All-Stop Mode
5654
5655 @cindex all-stop mode
5656
5657 In all-stop mode, whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
5658 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
5659 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
5660 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
5661 underfoot.
5662
5663 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
5664 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
5665 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
5666
5667 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
5668 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
5669 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
5670 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
5671 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
5672 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
5673 stops.
5674
5675 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
5676 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
5677 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
5678 first thread completes whatever you requested.
5679
5680 @cindex automatic thread selection
5681 @cindex switching threads automatically
5682 @cindex threads, automatic switching
5683 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
5684 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
5685 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
5686 message such as @samp{[Switching to Thread @var{n}]} to identify the
5687 thread.
5688
5689 On some OSes, you can modify @value{GDBN}'s default behavior by
5690 locking the OS scheduler to allow only a single thread to run.
5691
5692 @table @code
5693 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
5694 @cindex scheduler locking mode
5695 @cindex lock scheduler
5696 Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
5697 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
5698 current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
5699 mode optimizes for single-stepping; it prevents other threads
5700 from preempting the current thread while you are stepping, so that
5701 the focus of debugging does not change unexpectedly.
5702 Other threads only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
5703 when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
5704 function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
5705 like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
5706 thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, @value{GDBN} does not change
5707 the current thread away from the thread that you are debugging.
5708
5709 @item show scheduler-locking
5710 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
5711 @end table
5712
5713 @cindex resume threads of multiple processes simultaneously
5714 By default, when you issue one of the execution commands such as
5715 @code{continue}, @code{next} or @code{step}, @value{GDBN} allows only
5716 threads of the current inferior to run. For example, if @value{GDBN}
5717 is attached to two inferiors, each with two threads, the
5718 @code{continue} command resumes only the two threads of the current
5719 inferior. This is useful, for example, when you debug a program that
5720 forks and you want to hold the parent stopped (so that, for instance,
5721 it doesn't run to exit), while you debug the child. In other
5722 situations, you may not be interested in inspecting the current state
5723 of any of the processes @value{GDBN} is attached to, and you may want
5724 to resume them all until some breakpoint is hit. In the latter case,
5725 you can instruct @value{GDBN} to allow all threads of all the
5726 inferiors to run with the @w{@code{set schedule-multiple}} command.
5727
5728 @table @code
5729 @kindex set schedule-multiple
5730 @item set schedule-multiple
5731 Set the mode for allowing threads of multiple processes to be resumed
5732 when an execution command is issued. When @code{on}, all threads of
5733 all processes are allowed to run. When @code{off}, only the threads
5734 of the current process are resumed. The default is @code{off}. The
5735 @code{scheduler-locking} mode takes precedence when set to @code{on},
5736 or while you are stepping and set to @code{step}.
5737
5738 @item show schedule-multiple
5739 Display the current mode for resuming the execution of threads of
5740 multiple processes.
5741 @end table
5742
5743 @node Non-Stop Mode
5744 @subsection Non-Stop Mode
5745
5746 @cindex non-stop mode
5747
5748 @c This section is really only a place-holder, and needs to be expanded
5749 @c with more details.
5750
5751 For some multi-threaded targets, @value{GDBN} supports an optional
5752 mode of operation in which you can examine stopped program threads in
5753 the debugger while other threads continue to execute freely. This
5754 minimizes intrusion when debugging live systems, such as programs
5755 where some threads have real-time constraints or must continue to
5756 respond to external events. This is referred to as @dfn{non-stop} mode.
5757
5758 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops to report a debugging event,
5759 @emph{only} that thread is stopped; @value{GDBN} does not stop other
5760 threads as well, in contrast to the all-stop mode behavior. Additionally,
5761 execution commands such as @code{continue} and @code{step} apply by default
5762 only to the current thread in non-stop mode, rather than all threads as
5763 in all-stop mode. This allows you to control threads explicitly in
5764 ways that are not possible in all-stop mode --- for example, stepping
5765 one thread while allowing others to run freely, stepping
5766 one thread while holding all others stopped, or stepping several threads
5767 independently and simultaneously.
5768
5769 To enter non-stop mode, use this sequence of commands before you run
5770 or attach to your program:
5771
5772 @smallexample
5773 # If using the CLI, pagination breaks non-stop.
5774 set pagination off
5775
5776 # Finally, turn it on!
5777 set non-stop on
5778 @end smallexample
5779
5780 You can use these commands to manipulate the non-stop mode setting:
5781
5782 @table @code
5783 @kindex set non-stop
5784 @item set non-stop on
5785 Enable selection of non-stop mode.
5786 @item set non-stop off
5787 Disable selection of non-stop mode.
5788 @kindex show non-stop
5789 @item show non-stop
5790 Show the current non-stop enablement setting.
5791 @end table
5792
5793 Note these commands only reflect whether non-stop mode is enabled,
5794 not whether the currently-executing program is being run in non-stop mode.
5795 In particular, the @code{set non-stop} preference is only consulted when
5796 @value{GDBN} starts or connects to the target program, and it is generally
5797 not possible to switch modes once debugging has started. Furthermore,
5798 since not all targets support non-stop mode, even when you have enabled
5799 non-stop mode, @value{GDBN} may still fall back to all-stop operation by
5800 default.
5801
5802 In non-stop mode, all execution commands apply only to the current thread
5803 by default. That is, @code{continue} only continues one thread.
5804 To continue all threads, issue @code{continue -a} or @code{c -a}.
5805
5806 You can use @value{GDBN}'s background execution commands
5807 (@pxref{Background Execution}) to run some threads in the background
5808 while you continue to examine or step others from @value{GDBN}.
5809 The MI execution commands (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}) are
5810 always executed asynchronously in non-stop mode.
5811
5812 Suspending execution is done with the @code{interrupt} command when
5813 running in the background, or @kbd{Ctrl-c} during foreground execution.
5814 In all-stop mode, this stops the whole process;
5815 but in non-stop mode the interrupt applies only to the current thread.
5816 To stop the whole program, use @code{interrupt -a}.
5817
5818 Other execution commands do not currently support the @code{-a} option.
5819
5820 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops, @value{GDBN} doesn't automatically make
5821 that thread current, as it does in all-stop mode. This is because the
5822 thread stop notifications are asynchronous with respect to @value{GDBN}'s
5823 command interpreter, and it would be confusing if @value{GDBN} unexpectedly
5824 changed to a different thread just as you entered a command to operate on the
5825 previously current thread.
5826
5827 @node Background Execution
5828 @subsection Background Execution
5829
5830 @cindex foreground execution
5831 @cindex background execution
5832 @cindex asynchronous execution
5833 @cindex execution, foreground, background and asynchronous
5834
5835 @value{GDBN}'s execution commands have two variants: the normal
5836 foreground (synchronous) behavior, and a background
5837 (asynchronous) behavior. In foreground execution, @value{GDBN} waits for
5838 the program to report that some thread has stopped before prompting for
5839 another command. In background execution, @value{GDBN} immediately gives
5840 a command prompt so that you can issue other commands while your program runs.
5841
5842 If the target doesn't support async mode, @value{GDBN} issues an error
5843 message if you attempt to use the background execution commands.
5844
5845 To specify background execution, add a @code{&} to the command. For example,
5846 the background form of the @code{continue} command is @code{continue&}, or
5847 just @code{c&}. The execution commands that accept background execution
5848 are:
5849
5850 @table @code
5851 @kindex run&
5852 @item run
5853 @xref{Starting, , Starting your Program}.
5854
5855 @item attach
5856 @kindex attach&
5857 @xref{Attach, , Debugging an Already-running Process}.
5858
5859 @item step
5860 @kindex step&
5861 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, step}.
5862
5863 @item stepi
5864 @kindex stepi&
5865 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, stepi}.
5866
5867 @item next
5868 @kindex next&
5869 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, next}.
5870
5871 @item nexti
5872 @kindex nexti&
5873 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, nexti}.
5874
5875 @item continue
5876 @kindex continue&
5877 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, continue}.
5878
5879 @item finish
5880 @kindex finish&
5881 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, finish}.
5882
5883 @item until
5884 @kindex until&
5885 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, until}.
5886
5887 @end table
5888
5889 Background execution is especially useful in conjunction with non-stop
5890 mode for debugging programs with multiple threads; see @ref{Non-Stop Mode}.
5891 However, you can also use these commands in the normal all-stop mode with
5892 the restriction that you cannot issue another execution command until the
5893 previous one finishes. Examples of commands that are valid in all-stop
5894 mode while the program is running include @code{help} and @code{info break}.
5895
5896 You can interrupt your program while it is running in the background by
5897 using the @code{interrupt} command.
5898
5899 @table @code
5900 @kindex interrupt
5901 @item interrupt
5902 @itemx interrupt -a
5903
5904 Suspend execution of the running program. In all-stop mode,
5905 @code{interrupt} stops the whole process, but in non-stop mode, it stops
5906 only the current thread. To stop the whole program in non-stop mode,
5907 use @code{interrupt -a}.
5908 @end table
5909
5910 @node Thread-Specific Breakpoints
5911 @subsection Thread-Specific Breakpoints
5912
5913 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
5914 Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
5915 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
5916
5917 @table @code
5918 @cindex breakpoints and threads
5919 @cindex thread breakpoints
5920 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
5921 @item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
5922 @itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
5923 @var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
5924 writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to
5925 specify some source line.
5926
5927 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
5928 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
5929 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. The @var{threadno} specifier
5930 is one of the numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown
5931 in the first column of the @samp{info threads} display.
5932
5933 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
5934 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
5935 program.
5936
5937 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
5938 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before or
5939 after the breakpoint condition, like this:
5940
5941 @smallexample
5942 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
5943 @end smallexample
5944
5945 @end table
5946
5947 Thread-specific breakpoints are automatically deleted when
5948 @value{GDBN} detects the corresponding thread is no longer in the
5949 thread list. For example:
5950
5951 @smallexample
5952 (@value{GDBP}) c
5953 Thread-specific breakpoint 3 deleted - thread 28 no longer in the thread list.
5954 @end smallexample
5955
5956 There are several ways for a thread to disappear, such as a regular
5957 thread exit, but also when you detach from the process with the
5958 @code{detach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running
5959 Process}), or if @value{GDBN} loses the remote connection
5960 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), etc. Note that with some targets,
5961 @value{GDBN} is only able to detect a thread has exited when the user
5962 explictly asks for the thread list with the @code{info threads}
5963 command.
5964
5965 @node Interrupted System Calls
5966 @subsection Interrupted System Calls
5967
5968 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
5969 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
5970 @cindex premature return from system calls
5971 There is an unfortunate side effect when using @value{GDBN} to debug
5972 multi-threaded programs. If one thread stops for a
5973 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
5974 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
5975 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
5976 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
5977 stop execution.
5978
5979 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
5980 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
5981 style anyways.
5982
5983 For example, do not write code like this:
5984
5985 @smallexample
5986 sleep (10);
5987 @end smallexample
5988
5989 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
5990 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
5991
5992 Instead, write this:
5993
5994 @smallexample
5995 int unslept = 10;
5996 while (unslept > 0)
5997 unslept = sleep (unslept);
5998 @end smallexample
5999
6000 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
6001 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
6002 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
6003 @value{GDBN}.
6004
6005 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
6006 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
6007 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
6008 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
6009
6010 @node Observer Mode
6011 @subsection Observer Mode
6012
6013 If you want to build on non-stop mode and observe program behavior
6014 without any chance of disruption by @value{GDBN}, you can set
6015 variables to disable all of the debugger's attempts to modify state,
6016 whether by writing memory, inserting breakpoints, etc. These operate
6017 at a low level, intercepting operations from all commands.
6018
6019 When all of these are set to @code{off}, then @value{GDBN} is said to
6020 be @dfn{observer mode}. As a convenience, the variable
6021 @code{observer} can be set to disable these, plus enable non-stop
6022 mode.
6023
6024 Note that @value{GDBN} will not prevent you from making nonsensical
6025 combinations of these settings. For instance, if you have enabled
6026 @code{may-insert-breakpoints} but disabled @code{may-write-memory},
6027 then breakpoints that work by writing trap instructions into the code
6028 stream will still not be able to be placed.
6029
6030 @table @code
6031
6032 @kindex observer
6033 @item set observer on
6034 @itemx set observer off
6035 When set to @code{on}, this disables all the permission variables
6036 below (except for @code{insert-fast-tracepoints}), plus enables
6037 non-stop debugging. Setting this to @code{off} switches back to
6038 normal debugging, though remaining in non-stop mode.
6039
6040 @item show observer
6041 Show whether observer mode is on or off.
6042
6043 @kindex may-write-registers
6044 @item set may-write-registers on
6045 @itemx set may-write-registers off
6046 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the values of
6047 registers, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}, or the
6048 @code{jump} command. It defaults to @code{on}.
6049
6050 @item show may-write-registers
6051 Show the current permission to write registers.
6052
6053 @kindex may-write-memory
6054 @item set may-write-memory on
6055 @itemx set may-write-memory off
6056 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the contents
6057 of memory, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}. It
6058 defaults to @code{on}.
6059
6060 @item show may-write-memory
6061 Show the current permission to write memory.
6062
6063 @kindex may-insert-breakpoints
6064 @item set may-insert-breakpoints on
6065 @itemx set may-insert-breakpoints off
6066 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert breakpoints.
6067 This affects all breakpoints, including internal breakpoints defined
6068 by @value{GDBN}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6069
6070 @item show may-insert-breakpoints
6071 Show the current permission to insert breakpoints.
6072
6073 @kindex may-insert-tracepoints
6074 @item set may-insert-tracepoints on
6075 @itemx set may-insert-tracepoints off
6076 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert (regular)
6077 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6078 non-fast tracepoints, fast tracepoints being under the control of
6079 @code{may-insert-fast-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6080
6081 @item show may-insert-tracepoints
6082 Show the current permission to insert tracepoints.
6083
6084 @kindex may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6085 @item set may-insert-fast-tracepoints on
6086 @itemx set may-insert-fast-tracepoints off
6087 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert fast
6088 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6089 fast tracepoints, regular (non-fast) tracepoints being under the
6090 control of @code{may-insert-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6091
6092 @item show may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6093 Show the current permission to insert fast tracepoints.
6094
6095 @kindex may-interrupt
6096 @item set may-interrupt on
6097 @itemx set may-interrupt off
6098 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to interrupt or stop
6099 program execution. When this variable is @code{off}, the
6100 @code{interrupt} command will have no effect, nor will
6101 @kbd{Ctrl-c}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6102
6103 @item show may-interrupt
6104 Show the current permission to interrupt or stop the program.
6105
6106 @end table
6107
6108 @node Reverse Execution
6109 @chapter Running programs backward
6110 @cindex reverse execution
6111 @cindex running programs backward
6112
6113 When you are debugging a program, it is not unusual to realize that
6114 you have gone too far, and some event of interest has already happened.
6115 If the target environment supports it, @value{GDBN} can allow you to
6116 ``rewind'' the program by running it backward.
6117
6118 A target environment that supports reverse execution should be able
6119 to ``undo'' the changes in machine state that have taken place as the
6120 program was executing normally. Variables, registers etc.@: should
6121 revert to their previous values. Obviously this requires a great
6122 deal of sophistication on the part of the target environment; not
6123 all target environments can support reverse execution.
6124
6125 When a program is executed in reverse, the instructions that
6126 have most recently been executed are ``un-executed'', in reverse
6127 order. The program counter runs backward, following the previous
6128 thread of execution in reverse. As each instruction is ``un-executed'',
6129 the values of memory and/or registers that were changed by that
6130 instruction are reverted to their previous states. After executing
6131 a piece of source code in reverse, all side effects of that code
6132 should be ``undone'', and all variables should be returned to their
6133 prior values@footnote{
6134 Note that some side effects are easier to undo than others. For instance,
6135 memory and registers are relatively easy, but device I/O is hard. Some
6136 targets may be able undo things like device I/O, and some may not.
6137
6138 The contract between @value{GDBN} and the reverse executing target
6139 requires only that the target do something reasonable when
6140 @value{GDBN} tells it to execute backwards, and then report the
6141 results back to @value{GDBN}. Whatever the target reports back to
6142 @value{GDBN}, @value{GDBN} will report back to the user. @value{GDBN}
6143 assumes that the memory and registers that the target reports are in a
6144 consistant state, but @value{GDBN} accepts whatever it is given.
6145 }.
6146
6147 If you are debugging in a target environment that supports
6148 reverse execution, @value{GDBN} provides the following commands.
6149
6150 @table @code
6151 @kindex reverse-continue
6152 @kindex rc @r{(@code{reverse-continue})}
6153 @item reverse-continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6154 @itemx rc @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6155 Beginning at the point where your program last stopped, start executing
6156 in reverse. Reverse execution will stop for breakpoints and synchronous
6157 exceptions (signals), just like normal execution. Behavior of
6158 asynchronous signals depends on the target environment.
6159
6160 @kindex reverse-step
6161 @kindex rs @r{(@code{step})}
6162 @item reverse-step @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6163 Run the program backward until control reaches the start of a
6164 different source line; then stop it, and return control to @value{GDBN}.
6165
6166 Like the @code{step} command, @code{reverse-step} will only stop
6167 at the beginning of a source line. It ``un-executes'' the previously
6168 executed source line. If the previous source line included calls to
6169 debuggable functions, @code{reverse-step} will step (backward) into
6170 the called function, stopping at the beginning of the @emph{last}
6171 statement in the called function (typically a return statement).
6172
6173 Also, as with the @code{step} command, if non-debuggable functions are
6174 called, @code{reverse-step} will run thru them backward without stopping.
6175
6176 @kindex reverse-stepi
6177 @kindex rsi @r{(@code{reverse-stepi})}
6178 @item reverse-stepi @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6179 Reverse-execute one machine instruction. Note that the instruction
6180 to be reverse-executed is @emph{not} the one pointed to by the program
6181 counter, but the instruction executed prior to that one. For instance,
6182 if the last instruction was a jump, @code{reverse-stepi} will take you
6183 back from the destination of the jump to the jump instruction itself.
6184
6185 @kindex reverse-next
6186 @kindex rn @r{(@code{reverse-next})}
6187 @item reverse-next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6188 Run backward to the beginning of the previous line executed in
6189 the current (innermost) stack frame. If the line contains function
6190 calls, they will be ``un-executed'' without stopping. Starting from
6191 the first line of a function, @code{reverse-next} will take you back
6192 to the caller of that function, @emph{before} the function was called,
6193 just as the normal @code{next} command would take you from the last
6194 line of a function back to its return to its caller
6195 @footnote{Unless the code is too heavily optimized.}.
6196
6197 @kindex reverse-nexti
6198 @kindex rni @r{(@code{reverse-nexti})}
6199 @item reverse-nexti @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6200 Like @code{nexti}, @code{reverse-nexti} executes a single instruction
6201 in reverse, except that called functions are ``un-executed'' atomically.
6202 That is, if the previously executed instruction was a return from
6203 another function, @code{reverse-nexti} will continue to execute
6204 in reverse until the call to that function (from the current stack
6205 frame) is reached.
6206
6207 @kindex reverse-finish
6208 @item reverse-finish
6209 Just as the @code{finish} command takes you to the point where the
6210 current function returns, @code{reverse-finish} takes you to the point
6211 where it was called. Instead of ending up at the end of the current
6212 function invocation, you end up at the beginning.
6213
6214 @kindex set exec-direction
6215 @item set exec-direction
6216 Set the direction of target execution.
6217 @item set exec-direction reverse
6218 @cindex execute forward or backward in time
6219 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in reverse, until the
6220 exec-direction mode is changed to ``forward''. Affected commands include
6221 @code{step, stepi, next, nexti, continue, and finish}. The @code{return}
6222 command cannot be used in reverse mode.
6223 @item set exec-direction forward
6224 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in the normal fashion.
6225 This is the default.
6226 @end table
6227
6228
6229 @node Process Record and Replay
6230 @chapter Recording Inferior's Execution and Replaying It
6231 @cindex process record and replay
6232 @cindex recording inferior's execution and replaying it
6233
6234 On some platforms, @value{GDBN} provides a special @dfn{process record
6235 and replay} target that can record a log of the process execution, and
6236 replay it later with both forward and reverse execution commands.
6237
6238 @cindex replay mode
6239 When this target is in use, if the execution log includes the record
6240 for the next instruction, @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{replay
6241 mode}. In the replay mode, the inferior does not really execute code
6242 instructions. Instead, all the events that normally happen during
6243 code execution are taken from the execution log. While code is not
6244 really executed in replay mode, the values of registers (including the
6245 program counter register) and the memory of the inferior are still
6246 changed as they normally would. Their contents are taken from the
6247 execution log.
6248
6249 @cindex record mode
6250 If the record for the next instruction is not in the execution log,
6251 @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{record mode}. In this mode, the
6252 inferior executes normally, and @value{GDBN} records the execution log
6253 for future replay.
6254
6255 The process record and replay target supports reverse execution
6256 (@pxref{Reverse Execution}), even if the platform on which the
6257 inferior runs does not. However, the reverse execution is limited in
6258 this case by the range of the instructions recorded in the execution
6259 log. In other words, reverse execution on platforms that don't
6260 support it directly can only be done in the replay mode.
6261
6262 When debugging in the reverse direction, @value{GDBN} will work in
6263 replay mode as long as the execution log includes the record for the
6264 previous instruction; otherwise, it will work in record mode, if the
6265 platform supports reverse execution, or stop if not.
6266
6267 For architecture environments that support process record and replay,
6268 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands:
6269
6270 @table @code
6271 @kindex target record
6272 @kindex target record-full
6273 @kindex target record-btrace
6274 @kindex record
6275 @kindex record full
6276 @kindex record btrace
6277 @kindex rec
6278 @kindex rec full
6279 @kindex rec btrace
6280 @item record @var{method}
6281 This command starts the process record and replay target. The
6282 recording method can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6283 the command uses the @code{full} recording method. The following
6284 recording methods are available:
6285
6286 @table @code
6287 @item full
6288 Full record/replay recording using @value{GDBN}'s software record and
6289 replay implementation. This method allows replaying and reverse
6290 execution.
6291
6292 @item btrace
6293 Hardware-supported instruction recording. This method does not record
6294 data. Further, the data is collected in a ring buffer so old data will
6295 be overwritten when the buffer is full. It allows limited replay and
6296 reverse execution.
6297
6298 This recording method may not be available on all processors.
6299 @end table
6300
6301 The process record and replay target can only debug a process that is
6302 already running. Therefore, you need first to start the process with
6303 the @kbd{run} or @kbd{start} commands, and then start the recording
6304 with the @kbd{record @var{method}} command.
6305
6306 Both @code{record @var{method}} and @code{rec @var{method}} are
6307 aliases of @code{target record-@var{method}}.
6308
6309 @cindex displaced stepping, and process record and replay
6310 Displaced stepping (@pxref{Maintenance Commands,, displaced stepping})
6311 will be automatically disabled when process record and replay target
6312 is started. That's because the process record and replay target
6313 doesn't support displaced stepping.
6314
6315 @cindex non-stop mode, and process record and replay
6316 @cindex asynchronous execution, and process record and replay
6317 If the inferior is in the non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) or in
6318 the asynchronous execution mode (@pxref{Background Execution}), not
6319 all recording methods are available. The @code{full} recording method
6320 does not support these two modes.
6321
6322 @kindex record stop
6323 @kindex rec s
6324 @item record stop
6325 Stop the process record and replay target. When process record and
6326 replay target stops, the entire execution log will be deleted and the
6327 inferior will either be terminated, or will remain in its final state.
6328
6329 When you stop the process record and replay target in record mode (at
6330 the end of the execution log), the inferior will be stopped at the
6331 next instruction that would have been recorded. In other words, if
6332 you record for a while and then stop recording, the inferior process
6333 will be left in the same state as if the recording never happened.
6334
6335 On the other hand, if the process record and replay target is stopped
6336 while in replay mode (that is, not at the end of the execution log,
6337 but at some earlier point), the inferior process will become ``live''
6338 at that earlier state, and it will then be possible to continue the
6339 usual ``live'' debugging of the process from that state.
6340
6341 When the inferior process exits, or @value{GDBN} detaches from it,
6342 process record and replay target will automatically stop itself.
6343
6344 @kindex record goto
6345 @item record goto
6346 Go to a specific location in the execution log. There are several
6347 ways to specify the location to go to:
6348
6349 @table @code
6350 @item record goto begin
6351 @itemx record goto start
6352 Go to the beginning of the execution log.
6353
6354 @item record goto end
6355 Go to the end of the execution log.
6356
6357 @item record goto @var{n}
6358 Go to instruction number @var{n} in the execution log.
6359 @end table
6360
6361 @kindex record save
6362 @item record save @var{filename}
6363 Save the execution log to a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6364 Default filename is @file{gdb_record.@var{process_id}}, where
6365 @var{process_id} is the process ID of the inferior.
6366
6367 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6368
6369 @kindex record restore
6370 @item record restore @var{filename}
6371 Restore the execution log from a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6372 File must have been created with @code{record save}.
6373
6374 @kindex set record full
6375 @item set record full insn-number-max @var{limit}
6376 @itemx set record full insn-number-max unlimited
6377 Set the limit of instructions to be recorded for the @code{full}
6378 recording method. Default value is 200000.
6379
6380 If @var{limit} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will start
6381 deleting instructions from the log once the number of the record
6382 instructions becomes greater than @var{limit}. For every new recorded
6383 instruction, @value{GDBN} will delete the earliest recorded
6384 instruction to keep the number of recorded instructions at the limit.
6385 (Since deleting recorded instructions loses information, @value{GDBN}
6386 lets you control what happens when the limit is reached, by means of
6387 the @code{stop-at-limit} option, described below.)
6388
6389 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will never
6390 delete recorded instructions from the execution log. The number of
6391 recorded instructions is limited only by the available memory.
6392
6393 @kindex show record full
6394 @item show record full insn-number-max
6395 Show the limit of instructions to be recorded with the @code{full}
6396 recording method.
6397
6398 @item set record full stop-at-limit
6399 Control the behavior of the @code{full} recording method when the
6400 number of recorded instructions reaches the limit. If ON (the
6401 default), @value{GDBN} will stop when the limit is reached for the
6402 first time and ask you whether you want to stop the inferior or
6403 continue running it and recording the execution log. If you decide
6404 to continue recording, each new recorded instruction will cause the
6405 oldest one to be deleted.
6406
6407 If this option is OFF, @value{GDBN} will automatically delete the
6408 oldest record to make room for each new one, without asking.
6409
6410 @item show record full stop-at-limit
6411 Show the current setting of @code{stop-at-limit}.
6412
6413 @item set record full memory-query
6414 Control the behavior when @value{GDBN} is unable to record memory
6415 changes caused by an instruction for the @code{full} recording method.
6416 If ON, @value{GDBN} will query whether to stop the inferior in that
6417 case.
6418
6419 If this option is OFF (the default), @value{GDBN} will automatically
6420 ignore the effect of such instructions on memory. Later, when
6421 @value{GDBN} replays this execution log, it will mark the log of this
6422 instruction as not accessible, and it will not affect the replay
6423 results.
6424
6425 @item show record full memory-query
6426 Show the current setting of @code{memory-query}.
6427
6428 @kindex set record btrace
6429 The @code{btrace} record target does not trace data. As a
6430 convenience, when replaying, @value{GDBN} reads read-only memory off
6431 the live program directly, assuming that the addresses of the
6432 read-only areas don't change. This for example makes it possible to
6433 disassemble code while replaying, but not to print variables.
6434 In some cases, being able to inspect variables might be useful.
6435 You can use the following command for that:
6436
6437 @item set record btrace replay-memory-access
6438 Control the behavior of the @code{btrace} recording method when
6439 accessing memory during replay. If @code{read-only} (the default),
6440 @value{GDBN} will only allow accesses to read-only memory.
6441 If @code{read-write}, @value{GDBN} will allow accesses to read-only
6442 and to read-write memory. Beware that the accessed memory corresponds
6443 to the live target and not necessarily to the current replay
6444 position.
6445
6446 @kindex show record btrace
6447 @item show record btrace replay-memory-access
6448 Show the current setting of @code{replay-memory-access}.
6449
6450 @kindex info record
6451 @item info record
6452 Show various statistics about the recording depending on the recording
6453 method:
6454
6455 @table @code
6456 @item full
6457 For the @code{full} recording method, it shows the state of process
6458 record and its in-memory execution log buffer, including:
6459
6460 @itemize @bullet
6461 @item
6462 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
6463 @item
6464 Lowest recorded instruction number (counting from when the current execution log started recording instructions).
6465 @item
6466 Highest recorded instruction number.
6467 @item
6468 Current instruction about to be replayed (if in replay mode).
6469 @item
6470 Number of instructions contained in the execution log.
6471 @item
6472 Maximum number of instructions that may be contained in the execution log.
6473 @end itemize
6474
6475 @item btrace
6476 For the @code{btrace} recording method, it shows the number of
6477 instructions that have been recorded and the number of blocks of
6478 sequential control-flow that is formed by the recorded instructions.
6479 @end table
6480
6481 @kindex record delete
6482 @kindex rec del
6483 @item record delete
6484 When record target runs in replay mode (``in the past''), delete the
6485 subsequent execution log and begin to record a new execution log starting
6486 from the current address. This means you will abandon the previously
6487 recorded ``future'' and begin recording a new ``future''.
6488
6489 @kindex record instruction-history
6490 @kindex rec instruction-history
6491 @item record instruction-history
6492 Disassembles instructions from the recorded execution log. By
6493 default, ten instructions are disassembled. This can be changed using
6494 the @code{set record instruction-history-size} command. Instructions
6495 are printed in execution order. There are several ways to specify
6496 what part of the execution log to disassemble:
6497
6498 @table @code
6499 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}
6500 Disassembles ten instructions starting from instruction number
6501 @var{insn}.
6502
6503 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}, +/-@var{n}
6504 Disassembles @var{n} instructions around instruction number
6505 @var{insn}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, disassembles
6506 @var{n} instructions after instruction number @var{insn}. If
6507 @var{n} is preceded with @code{-}, disassembles @var{n}
6508 instructions before instruction number @var{insn}.
6509
6510 @item record instruction-history
6511 Disassembles ten more instructions after the last disassembly.
6512
6513 @item record instruction-history -
6514 Disassembles ten more instructions before the last disassembly.
6515
6516 @item record instruction-history @var{begin} @var{end}
6517 Disassembles instructions beginning with instruction number
6518 @var{begin} until instruction number @var{end}. The instruction
6519 number @var{end} is included.
6520 @end table
6521
6522 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6523
6524 @kindex set record
6525 @item set record instruction-history-size @var{size}
6526 @itemx set record instruction-history-size unlimited
6527 Define how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
6528 instruction-history} command. The default value is 10.
6529 A @var{size} of @code{unlimited} means unlimited instructions.
6530
6531 @kindex show record
6532 @item show record instruction-history-size
6533 Show how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
6534 instruction-history} command.
6535
6536 @kindex record function-call-history
6537 @kindex rec function-call-history
6538 @item record function-call-history
6539 Prints the execution history at function granularity. It prints one
6540 line for each sequence of instructions that belong to the same
6541 function giving the name of that function, the source lines
6542 for this instruction sequence (if the @code{/l} modifier is
6543 specified), and the instructions numbers that form the sequence (if
6544 the @code{/i} modifier is specified). The function names are indented
6545 to reflect the call stack depth if the @code{/c} modifier is
6546 specified. The @code{/l}, @code{/i}, and @code{/c} modifiers can be
6547 given together.
6548
6549 @smallexample
6550 (@value{GDBP}) @b{list 1, 10}
6551 1 void foo (void)
6552 2 @{
6553 3 @}
6554 4
6555 5 void bar (void)
6556 6 @{
6557 7 ...
6558 8 foo ();
6559 9 ...
6560 10 @}
6561 (@value{GDBP}) @b{record function-call-history /ilc}
6562 1 bar inst 1,4 at foo.c:6,8
6563 2 foo inst 5,10 at foo.c:2,3
6564 3 bar inst 11,13 at foo.c:9,10
6565 @end smallexample
6566
6567 By default, ten lines are printed. This can be changed using the
6568 @code{set record function-call-history-size} command. Functions are
6569 printed in execution order. There are several ways to specify what
6570 to print:
6571
6572 @table @code
6573 @item record function-call-history @var{func}
6574 Prints ten functions starting from function number @var{func}.
6575
6576 @item record function-call-history @var{func}, +/-@var{n}
6577 Prints @var{n} functions around function number @var{func}. If
6578 @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, prints @var{n} functions after
6579 function number @var{func}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{-},
6580 prints @var{n} functions before function number @var{func}.
6581
6582 @item record function-call-history
6583 Prints ten more functions after the last ten-line print.
6584
6585 @item record function-call-history -
6586 Prints ten more functions before the last ten-line print.
6587
6588 @item record function-call-history @var{begin} @var{end}
6589 Prints functions beginning with function number @var{begin} until
6590 function number @var{end}. The function number @var{end} is included.
6591 @end table
6592
6593 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6594
6595 @item set record function-call-history-size @var{size}
6596 @itemx set record function-call-history-size unlimited
6597 Define how many lines to print in the
6598 @code{record function-call-history} command. The default value is 10.
6599 A size of @code{unlimited} means unlimited lines.
6600
6601 @item show record function-call-history-size
6602 Show how many lines to print in the
6603 @code{record function-call-history} command.
6604 @end table
6605
6606
6607 @node Stack
6608 @chapter Examining the Stack
6609
6610 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
6611 stopped and how it got there.
6612
6613 @cindex call stack
6614 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
6615 is generated.
6616 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
6617 the arguments of the call,
6618 and the local variables of the function being called.
6619 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
6620 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
6621 stack}.
6622
6623 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
6624 stack allow you to see all of this information.
6625
6626 @cindex selected frame
6627 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
6628 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
6629 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
6630 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
6631 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
6632 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
6633
6634 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
6635 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
6636 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
6637
6638 @menu
6639 * Frames:: Stack frames
6640 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
6641 * Frame Filter Management:: Managing frame filters
6642 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
6643 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
6644
6645 @end menu
6646
6647 @node Frames
6648 @section Stack Frames
6649
6650 @cindex frame, definition
6651 @cindex stack frame
6652 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
6653 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
6654 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
6655 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
6656 which the function is executing.
6657
6658 @cindex initial frame
6659 @cindex outermost frame
6660 @cindex innermost frame
6661 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
6662 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
6663 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
6664 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
6665 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
6666 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
6667 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
6668 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
6669
6670 @cindex frame pointer
6671 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
6672 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
6673 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
6674 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
6675 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
6676 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
6677
6678 @cindex frame number
6679 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
6680 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
6681 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
6682 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
6683 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
6684
6685 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
6686 @c underflow problems.
6687 @cindex frameless execution
6688 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
6689 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
6690 @smallexample
6691 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
6692 @end smallexample
6693 generates functions without a frame.)
6694 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
6695 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
6696 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
6697 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
6698 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
6699 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
6700 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
6701
6702 @table @code
6703 @kindex frame@r{, command}
6704 @cindex current stack frame
6705 @item frame @r{[}@var{framespec}@r{]}
6706 The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
6707 and to print the stack frame you select. The @var{framespec} may be either the
6708 address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
6709 @code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
6710
6711 @kindex select-frame
6712 @cindex selecting frame silently
6713 @item select-frame
6714 The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
6715 to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
6716 @code{frame}.
6717 @end table
6718
6719 @node Backtrace
6720 @section Backtraces
6721
6722 @cindex traceback
6723 @cindex call stack traces
6724 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
6725 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
6726 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
6727 stack.
6728
6729 @anchor{backtrace-command}
6730 @table @code
6731 @kindex backtrace
6732 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
6733 @item backtrace
6734 @itemx bt
6735 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
6736 frames in the stack.
6737
6738 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
6739 character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
6740
6741 @item backtrace @var{n}
6742 @itemx bt @var{n}
6743 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
6744
6745 @item backtrace -@var{n}
6746 @itemx bt -@var{n}
6747 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
6748
6749 @item backtrace full
6750 @itemx bt full
6751 @itemx bt full @var{n}
6752 @itemx bt full -@var{n}
6753 Print the values of the local variables also. As described above,
6754 @var{n} specifies the number of frames to print.
6755
6756 @item backtrace no-filters
6757 @itemx bt no-filters
6758 @itemx bt no-filters @var{n}
6759 @itemx bt no-filters -@var{n}
6760 @itemx bt no-filters full
6761 @itemx bt no-filters full @var{n}
6762 @itemx bt no-filters full -@var{n}
6763 Do not run Python frame filters on this backtrace. @xref{Frame
6764 Filter API}, for more information. Additionally use @ref{disable
6765 frame-filter all} to turn off all frame filters. This is only
6766 relevant when @value{GDBN} has been configured with @code{Python}
6767 support.
6768 @end table
6769
6770 @kindex where
6771 @kindex info stack
6772 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
6773 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
6774
6775 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
6776 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
6777 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
6778 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
6779 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
6780 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
6781 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
6782 multi-threaded program.
6783
6784 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
6785 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
6786 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
6787 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
6788 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
6789 line number.
6790
6791 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
6792 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
6793
6794 @smallexample
6795 @group
6796 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
6797 at builtin.c:993
6798 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600, data=...) at macro.c:242
6799 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
6800 at macro.c:71
6801 (More stack frames follow...)
6802 @end group
6803 @end smallexample
6804
6805 @noindent
6806 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
6807 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
6808 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
6809
6810 @noindent
6811 The value of parameter @code{data} in frame 1 has been replaced by
6812 @code{@dots{}}. By default, @value{GDBN} prints the value of a parameter
6813 only if it is a scalar (integer, pointer, enumeration, etc). See command
6814 @kbd{set print frame-arguments} in @ref{Print Settings} for more details
6815 on how to configure the way function parameter values are printed.
6816
6817 @cindex optimized out, in backtrace
6818 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
6819 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
6820 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
6821 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
6822 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
6823 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
6824 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
6825 such a backtrace might look like:
6826
6827 @smallexample
6828 @group
6829 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
6830 at builtin.c:993
6831 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<optimized out>) at macro.c:242
6832 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
6833 at macro.c:71
6834 (More stack frames follow...)
6835 @end group
6836 @end smallexample
6837
6838 @noindent
6839 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
6840 shown as @samp{<optimized out>}.
6841
6842 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
6843 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
6844 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
6845
6846 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
6847 @cindex program entry point
6848 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
6849 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
6850 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
6851 @code{main}@footnote{
6852 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
6853 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
6854 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
6855 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
6856 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
6857 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
6858
6859 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
6860 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
6861
6862 @table @code
6863 @item set backtrace past-main
6864 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
6865 @kindex set backtrace
6866 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
6867
6868 @item set backtrace past-main off
6869 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
6870 default.
6871
6872 @item show backtrace past-main
6873 @kindex show backtrace
6874 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
6875
6876 @item set backtrace past-entry
6877 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
6878 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
6879 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
6880 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
6881
6882 @item set backtrace past-entry off
6883 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
6884 application. This is the default.
6885
6886 @item show backtrace past-entry
6887 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
6888
6889 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
6890 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
6891 @itemx set backtrace limit unlimited
6892 @cindex backtrace limit
6893 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of @code{unlimited}
6894 or zero means unlimited levels.
6895
6896 @item show backtrace limit
6897 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
6898 @end table
6899
6900 You can control how file names are displayed.
6901
6902 @table @code
6903 @item set filename-display
6904 @itemx set filename-display relative
6905 @cindex filename-display
6906 Display file names relative to the compilation directory. This is the default.
6907
6908 @item set filename-display basename
6909 Display only basename of a filename.
6910
6911 @item set filename-display absolute
6912 Display an absolute filename.
6913
6914 @item show filename-display
6915 Show the current way to display filenames.
6916 @end table
6917
6918 @node Frame Filter Management
6919 @section Management of Frame Filters.
6920 @cindex managing frame filters
6921
6922 Frame filters are Python based utilities to manage and decorate the
6923 output of frames. @xref{Frame Filter API}, for further information.
6924
6925 Managing frame filters is performed by several commands available
6926 within @value{GDBN}, detailed here.
6927
6928 @table @code
6929 @kindex info frame-filter
6930 @item info frame-filter
6931 Print a list of installed frame filters from all dictionaries, showing
6932 their name, priority and enabled status.
6933
6934 @kindex disable frame-filter
6935 @anchor{disable frame-filter all}
6936 @item disable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
6937 Disable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
6938 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
6939 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
6940 @code{progspace}, or the name of the object file where the frame filter
6941 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters
6942 across all dictionaries are disabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name
6943 of the frame filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
6944 @var{filter-dictionary}. A disabled frame-filter is not deleted, it
6945 may be enabled again later.
6946
6947 @kindex enable frame-filter
6948 @item enable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
6949 Enable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
6950 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
6951 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
6952 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
6953 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters across
6954 all dictionaries are enabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name of the frame
6955 filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
6956 @var{filter-dictionary}.
6957
6958 Example:
6959
6960 @smallexample
6961 (gdb) info frame-filter
6962
6963 global frame-filters:
6964 Priority Enabled Name
6965 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
6966 100 Yes Reverse
6967
6968 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
6969 Priority Enabled Name
6970 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
6971
6972 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
6973 Priority Enabled Name
6974 999 Yes BuildProgra Filter
6975
6976 (gdb) disable frame-filter /build/test BuildProgramFilter
6977 (gdb) info frame-filter
6978
6979 global frame-filters:
6980 Priority Enabled Name
6981 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
6982 100 Yes Reverse
6983
6984 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
6985 Priority Enabled Name
6986 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
6987
6988 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
6989 Priority Enabled Name
6990 999 No BuildProgramFilter
6991
6992 (gdb) enable frame-filter global PrimaryFunctionFilter
6993 (gdb) info frame-filter
6994
6995 global frame-filters:
6996 Priority Enabled Name
6997 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
6998 100 Yes Reverse
6999
7000 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7001 Priority Enabled Name
7002 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7003
7004 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7005 Priority Enabled Name
7006 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7007 @end smallexample
7008
7009 @kindex set frame-filter priority
7010 @item set frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name} @var{priority}
7011 Set the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7012 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
7013 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
7014 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7015 dictionary resides. The @var{priority} is an integer.
7016
7017 @kindex show frame-filter priority
7018 @item show frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7019 Show the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7020 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
7021 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
7022 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7023 dictionary resides.
7024
7025 Example:
7026
7027 @smallexample
7028 (gdb) info frame-filter
7029
7030 global frame-filters:
7031 Priority Enabled Name
7032 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7033 100 Yes Reverse
7034
7035 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7036 Priority Enabled Name
7037 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7038
7039 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7040 Priority Enabled Name
7041 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7042
7043 (gdb) set frame-filter priority global Reverse 50
7044 (gdb) info frame-filter
7045
7046 global frame-filters:
7047 Priority Enabled Name
7048 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7049 50 Yes Reverse
7050
7051 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7052 Priority Enabled Name
7053 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7054
7055 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7056 Priority Enabled Name
7057 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7058 @end smallexample
7059 @end table
7060
7061 @node Selection
7062 @section Selecting a Frame
7063
7064 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
7065 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
7066 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
7067 of the stack frame just selected.
7068
7069 @table @code
7070 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
7071 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
7072 @item frame @var{n}
7073 @itemx f @var{n}
7074 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
7075 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
7076 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
7077 @code{main}.
7078
7079 @item frame @var{addr}
7080 @itemx f @var{addr}
7081 Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
7082 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
7083 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
7084 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
7085 switches between them.
7086
7087 On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
7088 select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
7089
7090 On the @acronym{MIPS} and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
7091 pointer and a program counter.
7092
7093 On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
7094 pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
7095
7096 @kindex up
7097 @item up @var{n}
7098 Move @var{n} frames up the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For positive
7099 numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the outermost frame, to higher
7100 frame numbers, to frames that have existed longer.
7101
7102 @kindex down
7103 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
7104 @item down @var{n}
7105 Move @var{n} frames down the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For
7106 positive numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the innermost frame, to
7107 lower frame numbers, to frames that were created more recently.
7108 You may abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
7109 @end table
7110
7111 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
7112 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
7113 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
7114 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
7115
7116 @need 1000
7117 For example:
7118
7119 @smallexample
7120 @group
7121 (@value{GDBP}) up
7122 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
7123 at env.c:10
7124 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
7125 @end group
7126 @end smallexample
7127
7128 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
7129 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
7130 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
7131 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
7132 @xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
7133 for details.
7134
7135 @table @code
7136 @kindex down-silently
7137 @kindex up-silently
7138 @item up-silently @var{n}
7139 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
7140 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
7141 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
7142 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
7143 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
7144 distracting.
7145 @end table
7146
7147 @node Frame Info
7148 @section Information About a Frame
7149
7150 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
7151 stack frame.
7152
7153 @table @code
7154 @item frame
7155 @itemx f
7156 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
7157 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
7158 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
7159 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
7160 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7161
7162 @kindex info frame
7163 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
7164 @item info frame
7165 @itemx info f
7166 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
7167 including:
7168
7169 @itemize @bullet
7170 @item
7171 the address of the frame
7172 @item
7173 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
7174 @item
7175 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
7176 @item
7177 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
7178 @item
7179 the address of the frame's arguments
7180 @item
7181 the address of the frame's local variables
7182 @item
7183 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
7184 @item
7185 which registers were saved in the frame
7186 @end itemize
7187
7188 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
7189 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
7190 the usual conventions.
7191
7192 @item info frame @var{addr}
7193 @itemx info f @var{addr}
7194 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
7195 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
7196 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
7197 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
7198 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7199
7200 @kindex info args
7201 @item info args
7202 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
7203
7204 @item info locals
7205 @kindex info locals
7206 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
7207 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
7208 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
7209
7210 @end table
7211
7212
7213 @node Source
7214 @chapter Examining Source Files
7215
7216 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
7217 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
7218 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
7219 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
7220 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
7221 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
7222 source files by explicit command.
7223
7224 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
7225 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
7226 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
7227
7228 @menu
7229 * List:: Printing source lines
7230 * Specify Location:: How to specify code locations
7231 * Edit:: Editing source files
7232 * Search:: Searching source files
7233 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
7234 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
7235 @end menu
7236
7237 @node List
7238 @section Printing Source Lines
7239
7240 @kindex list
7241 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
7242 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
7243 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
7244 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to
7245 print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list.
7246
7247 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
7248
7249 @table @code
7250 @item list @var{linenum}
7251 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
7252 current source file.
7253
7254 @item list @var{function}
7255 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
7256 @var{function}.
7257
7258 @item list
7259 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
7260 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
7261 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
7262 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
7263 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
7264
7265 @item list -
7266 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
7267 @end table
7268
7269 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
7270 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
7271 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
7272
7273 @table @code
7274 @kindex set listsize
7275 @item set listsize @var{count}
7276 @itemx set listsize unlimited
7277 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
7278 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
7279 Setting @var{count} to @code{unlimited} or 0 means there's no limit.
7280
7281 @kindex show listsize
7282 @item show listsize
7283 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
7284 @end table
7285
7286 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
7287 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
7288 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
7289 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
7290 each repetition moves up in the source file.
7291
7292 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
7293 @dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
7294 of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always
7295 to specify some source line.
7296
7297 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
7298
7299 @table @code
7300 @item list @var{linespec}
7301 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
7302
7303 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
7304 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
7305 linespecs. When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, and the
7306 source file of the second linespec is omitted, this refers to
7307 the same source file as the first linespec.
7308
7309 @item list ,@var{last}
7310 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
7311
7312 @item list @var{first},
7313 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
7314
7315 @item list +
7316 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
7317
7318 @item list -
7319 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
7320
7321 @item list
7322 As described in the preceding table.
7323 @end table
7324
7325 @node Specify Location
7326 @section Specifying a Location
7327 @cindex specifying location
7328 @cindex linespec
7329
7330 Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location
7331 of your program's code. Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level
7332 debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code;
7333 for that reason, locations are also known as @dfn{linespecs}.
7334
7335 Here are all the different ways of specifying a code location that
7336 @value{GDBN} understands:
7337
7338 @table @code
7339 @item @var{linenum}
7340 Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file.
7341
7342 @item -@var{offset}
7343 @itemx +@var{offset}
7344 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current
7345 line}. For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one
7346 printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which
7347 execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}
7348 (@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.) When
7349 used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command,
7350 this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first
7351 linespec.
7352
7353 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
7354 Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}.
7355 If @var{filename} is a relative file name, then it will match any
7356 source file name with the same trailing components. For example, if
7357 @var{filename} is @samp{gcc/expr.c}, then it will match source file
7358 name of @file{/build/trunk/gcc/expr.c}, but not
7359 @file{/build/trunk/libcpp/expr.c} or @file{/build/trunk/gcc/x-expr.c}.
7360
7361 @item @var{function}
7362 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
7363 For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace.
7364
7365 @item @var{function}:@var{label}
7366 Specifies the line where @var{label} appears in @var{function}.
7367
7368 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
7369 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}
7370 in the file @var{filename}. You only need the file name with a
7371 function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named
7372 functions in different source files.
7373
7374 @item @var{label}
7375 Specifies the line at which the label named @var{label} appears.
7376 @value{GDBN} searches for the label in the function corresponding to
7377 the currently selected stack frame. If there is no current selected
7378 stack frame (for instance, if the inferior is not running), then
7379 @value{GDBN} will not search for a label.
7380
7381 @item *@var{address}
7382 Specifies the program address @var{address}. For line-oriented
7383 commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this specifies a source
7384 line that contains @var{address}. For @code{break} and other
7385 breakpoint oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in
7386 parts of your program which do not have debugging information or
7387 source files.
7388
7389 Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working
7390 language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code
7391 address. In addition, as a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the
7392 semantics of expressions used in locations to cover the situations
7393 that frequently happen during debugging. Here are the various forms
7394 of @var{address}:
7395
7396 @table @code
7397 @item @var{expression}
7398 Any expression valid in the current working language.
7399
7400 @item @var{funcaddr}
7401 An address of a function or procedure derived from its name. In C,
7402 C@t{++}, Java, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is
7403 simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case
7404 of a valid expression). In Pascal and Modula-2, this is
7405 @code{&@var{function}}. In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address}
7406 (although the Pascal form also works).
7407
7408 This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction,
7409 before the stack frame and arguments have been set up.
7410
7411 @item '@var{filename}'::@var{funcaddr}
7412 Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source
7413 file explicitly. This is useful if the name of the function does not
7414 specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several
7415 functions with identical names in different source files.
7416 @end table
7417
7418 @cindex breakpoint at static probe point
7419 @item -pstap|-probe-stap @r{[}@var{objfile}:@r{[}@var{provider}:@r{]}@r{]}@var{name}
7420 The @sc{gnu}/Linux tool @code{SystemTap} provides a way for
7421 applications to embed static probes. @xref{Static Probe Points}, for more
7422 information on finding and using static probes. This form of linespec
7423 specifies the location of such a static probe.
7424
7425 If @var{objfile} is given, only probes coming from that shared library
7426 or executable matching @var{objfile} as a regular expression are considered.
7427 If @var{provider} is given, then only probes from that provider are considered.
7428 If several probes match the spec, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at
7429 each one of those probes.
7430
7431 @end table
7432
7433
7434 @node Edit
7435 @section Editing Source Files
7436 @cindex editing source files
7437
7438 @kindex edit
7439 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
7440 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
7441 The editing program of your choice
7442 is invoked with the current line set to
7443 the active line in the program.
7444 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
7445 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program:
7446
7447 @table @code
7448 @item edit @var{location}
7449 Edit the source file specified by @code{location}. Editing starts at
7450 that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the
7451 specified file. @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms
7452 of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit}
7453 command most commonly used:
7454
7455 @table @code
7456 @item edit @var{number}
7457 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
7458
7459 @item edit @var{function}
7460 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
7461 @end table
7462
7463 @end table
7464
7465 @subsection Choosing your Editor
7466 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
7467 @footnote{
7468 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
7469 following command-line syntax:
7470 @smallexample
7471 ex +@var{number} file
7472 @end smallexample
7473 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
7474 the file where to start editing.}.
7475 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
7476 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
7477 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
7478 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
7479 @smallexample
7480 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
7481 export EDITOR
7482 gdb @dots{}
7483 @end smallexample
7484 or in the @code{csh} shell,
7485 @smallexample
7486 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
7487 gdb @dots{}
7488 @end smallexample
7489
7490 @node Search
7491 @section Searching Source Files
7492 @cindex searching source files
7493
7494 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
7495 regular expression.
7496
7497 @table @code
7498 @kindex search
7499 @kindex forward-search
7500 @kindex fo @r{(@code{forward-search})}
7501 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
7502 @itemx search @var{regexp}
7503 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
7504 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
7505 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
7506 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
7507 @code{fo}.
7508
7509 @kindex reverse-search
7510 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
7511 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
7512 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
7513 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
7514 this command as @code{rev}.
7515 @end table
7516
7517 @node Source Path
7518 @section Specifying Source Directories
7519
7520 @cindex source path
7521 @cindex directories for source files
7522 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
7523 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
7524 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
7525 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
7526 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
7527 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
7528 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
7529
7530 For example, suppose an executable references the file
7531 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
7532 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
7533 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
7534 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
7535 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
7536 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
7537 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
7538 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
7539 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
7540 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
7541
7542 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
7543 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
7544 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
7545 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
7546 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
7547 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
7548
7549 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
7550 source files.
7551
7552 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
7553 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
7554 each line is in the file.
7555
7556 @kindex directory
7557 @kindex dir
7558 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
7559 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
7560 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
7561
7562 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
7563 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
7564
7565 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
7566 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
7567 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
7568 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
7569 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
7570 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
7571 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
7572 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
7573 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
7574 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
7575 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
7576 name to look up the sources.
7577
7578 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
7579 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
7580 @value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
7581 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
7582 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
7583 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
7584 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
7585 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
7586
7587 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
7588 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
7589 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
7590 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
7591 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
7592 is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
7593 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
7594
7595 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
7596 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
7597 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
7598 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
7599 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
7600 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
7601 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
7602 command.
7603
7604 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
7605 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
7606 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
7607 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
7608 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
7609 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
7610 method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
7611
7612 @cindex @samp{--with-relocated-sources}
7613 @cindex default source path substitution
7614 You can configure a default source path substitution rule by
7615 configuring @value{GDBN} with the
7616 @samp{--with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}} option. The @var{dir}
7617 should be the name of a directory under @value{GDBN}'s configured
7618 prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or @samp{--exec-prefix}), and
7619 directory names in debug information under @var{dir} will be adjusted
7620 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
7621 location. This is useful if @value{GDBN}, libraries or executables
7622 with debug information and corresponding source code are being moved
7623 together.
7624
7625 @table @code
7626 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
7627 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
7628 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
7629 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
7630 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
7631 part of absolute file names) or
7632 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
7633 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
7634
7635 @kindex cdir
7636 @kindex cwd
7637 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
7638 @vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
7639 @cindex compilation directory
7640 @cindex current directory
7641 @cindex working directory
7642 @cindex directory, current
7643 @cindex directory, compilation
7644 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
7645 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
7646 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
7647 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
7648 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
7649 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
7650
7651 @item directory
7652 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
7653
7654 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
7655 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
7656
7657 @item set directories @var{path-list}
7658 @kindex set directories
7659 Set the source path to @var{path-list}.
7660 @samp{$cdir:$cwd} are added if missing.
7661
7662 @item show directories
7663 @kindex show directories
7664 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
7665
7666 @anchor{set substitute-path}
7667 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
7668 @kindex set substitute-path
7669 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
7670 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
7671 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
7672
7673 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
7674 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
7675
7676 @smallexample
7677 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/cross
7678 @end smallexample
7679
7680 @noindent
7681 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/usr/src} with
7682 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
7683 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
7684
7685 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
7686 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
7687 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
7688 the substitution.
7689
7690 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
7691
7692 @smallexample
7693 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
7694 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
7695 @end smallexample
7696
7697 @noindent
7698 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
7699 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
7700 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
7701 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
7702
7703
7704 @item unset substitute-path [path]
7705 @kindex unset substitute-path
7706 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
7707 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
7708 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
7709
7710 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
7711
7712 @item show substitute-path [path]
7713 @kindex show substitute-path
7714 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
7715 which would rewrite that path, if any.
7716
7717 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
7718 rules.
7719
7720 @end table
7721
7722 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
7723 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
7724 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
7725
7726 @enumerate
7727 @item
7728 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
7729
7730 @item
7731 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
7732 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
7733 directories in one command.
7734 @end enumerate
7735
7736 @node Machine Code
7737 @section Source and Machine Code
7738 @cindex source line and its code address
7739
7740 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
7741 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
7742 a range of addresses as machine instructions. You can use the command
7743 @code{set disassemble-next-line} to set whether to disassemble next
7744 source line when execution stops. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
7745 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
7746 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
7747 well as hex.
7748
7749 @table @code
7750 @kindex info line
7751 @item info line @var{linespec}
7752 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
7753 source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
7754 the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}.
7755 @end table
7756
7757 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
7758 the object code for the first line of function
7759 @code{m4_changequote}:
7760
7761 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
7762 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
7763 @smallexample
7764 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
7765 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
7766 @end smallexample
7767
7768 @noindent
7769 @cindex code address and its source line
7770 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
7771 @var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
7772 @smallexample
7773 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
7774 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
7775 @end smallexample
7776
7777 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
7778 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
7779 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
7780 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
7781 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
7782 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
7783 ,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
7784 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
7785 Variables}).
7786
7787 @table @code
7788 @kindex disassemble
7789 @cindex assembly instructions
7790 @cindex instructions, assembly
7791 @cindex machine instructions
7792 @cindex listing machine instructions
7793 @item disassemble
7794 @itemx disassemble /m
7795 @itemx disassemble /r
7796 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
7797 instructions. It can also print mixed source+disassembly by specifying
7798 the @code{/m} modifier and print the raw instructions in hex as well as
7799 in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r}.
7800 The default memory range is the function surrounding the
7801 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
7802 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
7803 surrounding this value. When two arguments are given, they should
7804 be separated by a comma, possibly surrounded by whitespace. The
7805 arguments specify a range of addresses to dump, in one of two forms:
7806
7807 @table @code
7808 @item @var{start},@var{end}
7809 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to @var{end} (exclusive)
7810 @item @var{start},+@var{length}
7811 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to
7812 @code{@var{start}+@var{length}} (exclusive).
7813 @end table
7814
7815 @noindent
7816 When 2 arguments are specified, the name of the function is also
7817 printed (since there could be several functions in the given range).
7818
7819 The argument(s) can be any expression yielding a numeric value, such as
7820 @samp{0x32c4}, @samp{&main+10} or @samp{$pc - 8}.
7821
7822 If the range of memory being disassembled contains current program counter,
7823 the instruction at that location is shown with a @code{=>} marker.
7824 @end table
7825
7826 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
7827 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
7828
7829 @smallexample
7830 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4, 0x32e4
7831 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
7832 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
7833 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
7834 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
7835 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
7836 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
7837 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
7838 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
7839 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
7840 End of assembler dump.
7841 @end smallexample
7842
7843 Here is an example showing mixed source+assembly for Intel x86, when the
7844 program is stopped just after function prologue:
7845
7846 @smallexample
7847 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
7848 Dump of assembler code for function main:
7849 5 @{
7850 0x08048330 <+0>: push %ebp
7851 0x08048331 <+1>: mov %esp,%ebp
7852 0x08048333 <+3>: sub $0x8,%esp
7853 0x08048336 <+6>: and $0xfffffff0,%esp
7854 0x08048339 <+9>: sub $0x10,%esp
7855
7856 6 printf ("Hello.\n");
7857 => 0x0804833c <+12>: movl $0x8048440,(%esp)
7858 0x08048343 <+19>: call 0x8048284 <puts@@plt>
7859
7860 7 return 0;
7861 8 @}
7862 0x08048348 <+24>: mov $0x0,%eax
7863 0x0804834d <+29>: leave
7864 0x0804834e <+30>: ret
7865
7866 End of assembler dump.
7867 @end smallexample
7868
7869 Here is another example showing raw instructions in hex for AMD x86-64,
7870
7871 @smallexample
7872 (gdb) disas /r 0x400281,+10
7873 Dump of assembler code from 0x400281 to 0x40028b:
7874 0x0000000000400281: 38 36 cmp %dh,(%rsi)
7875 0x0000000000400283: 2d 36 34 2e 73 sub $0x732e3436,%eax
7876 0x0000000000400288: 6f outsl %ds:(%rsi),(%dx)
7877 0x0000000000400289: 2e 32 00 xor %cs:(%rax),%al
7878 End of assembler dump.
7879 @end smallexample
7880
7881 Addresses cannot be specified as a linespec (@pxref{Specify Location}).
7882 So, for example, if you want to disassemble function @code{bar}
7883 in file @file{foo.c}, you must type @samp{disassemble 'foo.c'::bar}
7884 and not @samp{disassemble foo.c:bar}.
7885
7886 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
7887 mnemonics or other syntax.
7888
7889 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
7890 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
7891 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
7892 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
7893 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
7894
7895 @table @code
7896 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
7897 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
7898 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
7899 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
7900 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
7901 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
7902
7903 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
7904 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
7905 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
7906 assemblers for x86-based targets.
7907
7908 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
7909 @item show disassembly-flavor
7910 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
7911 @end table
7912
7913 @table @code
7914 @kindex set disassemble-next-line
7915 @kindex show disassemble-next-line
7916 @item set disassemble-next-line
7917 @itemx show disassemble-next-line
7918 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will disassemble the next source
7919 line or instruction when execution stops. If ON, @value{GDBN} will
7920 display disassembly of the next source line when execution of the
7921 program being debugged stops. This is @emph{in addition} to
7922 displaying the source line itself, which @value{GDBN} always does if
7923 possible. If the next source line cannot be displayed for some reason
7924 (e.g., if @value{GDBN} cannot find the source file, or there's no line
7925 info in the debug info), @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of the
7926 next @emph{instruction} instead of showing the next source line. If
7927 AUTO, @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of next instruction only
7928 if the source line cannot be displayed. This setting causes
7929 @value{GDBN} to display some feedback when you step through a function
7930 with no line info or whose source file is unavailable. The default is
7931 OFF, which means never display the disassembly of the next line or
7932 instruction.
7933 @end table
7934
7935
7936 @node Data
7937 @chapter Examining Data
7938
7939 @cindex printing data
7940 @cindex examining data
7941 @kindex print
7942 @kindex inspect
7943 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
7944 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
7945 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
7946 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
7947 Different Languages}). It may also print the expression using a
7948 Python-based pretty-printer (@pxref{Pretty Printing}).
7949
7950 @table @code
7951 @item print @var{expr}
7952 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
7953 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
7954 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
7955 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
7956 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
7957 Formats}.
7958
7959 @item print
7960 @itemx print /@var{f}
7961 @cindex reprint the last value
7962 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
7963 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
7964 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
7965 @end table
7966
7967 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
7968 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
7969 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
7970
7971 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
7972 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
7973 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
7974 Table}.
7975
7976 @cindex exploring hierarchical data structures
7977 @kindex explore
7978 Another way of examining values of expressions and type information is
7979 through the Python extension command @code{explore} (available only if
7980 the @value{GDBN} build is configured with @code{--with-python}). It
7981 offers an interactive way to start at the highest level (or, the most
7982 abstract level) of the data type of an expression (or, the data type
7983 itself) and explore all the way down to leaf scalar values/fields
7984 embedded in the higher level data types.
7985
7986 @table @code
7987 @item explore @var{arg}
7988 @var{arg} is either an expression (in the source language), or a type
7989 visible in the current context of the program being debugged.
7990 @end table
7991
7992 The working of the @code{explore} command can be illustrated with an
7993 example. If a data type @code{struct ComplexStruct} is defined in your
7994 C program as
7995
7996 @smallexample
7997 struct SimpleStruct
7998 @{
7999 int i;
8000 double d;
8001 @};
8002
8003 struct ComplexStruct
8004 @{
8005 struct SimpleStruct *ss_p;
8006 int arr[10];
8007 @};
8008 @end smallexample
8009
8010 @noindent
8011 followed by variable declarations as
8012
8013 @smallexample
8014 struct SimpleStruct ss = @{ 10, 1.11 @};
8015 struct ComplexStruct cs = @{ &ss, @{ 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9 @} @};
8016 @end smallexample
8017
8018 @noindent
8019 then, the value of the variable @code{cs} can be explored using the
8020 @code{explore} command as follows.
8021
8022 @smallexample
8023 (gdb) explore cs
8024 The value of `cs' is a struct/class of type `struct ComplexStruct' with
8025 the following fields:
8026
8027 ss_p = <Enter 0 to explore this field of type `struct SimpleStruct *'>
8028 arr = <Enter 1 to explore this field of type `int [10]'>
8029
8030 Enter the field number of choice:
8031 @end smallexample
8032
8033 @noindent
8034 Since the fields of @code{cs} are not scalar values, you are being
8035 prompted to chose the field you want to explore. Let's say you choose
8036 the field @code{ss_p} by entering @code{0}. Then, since this field is a
8037 pointer, you will be asked if it is pointing to a single value. From
8038 the declaration of @code{cs} above, it is indeed pointing to a single
8039 value, hence you enter @code{y}. If you enter @code{n}, then you will
8040 be asked if it were pointing to an array of values, in which case this
8041 field will be explored as if it were an array.
8042
8043 @smallexample
8044 `cs.ss_p' is a pointer to a value of type `struct SimpleStruct'
8045 Continue exploring it as a pointer to a single value [y/n]: y
8046 The value of `*(cs.ss_p)' is a struct/class of type `struct
8047 SimpleStruct' with the following fields:
8048
8049 i = 10 .. (Value of type `int')
8050 d = 1.1100000000000001 .. (Value of type `double')
8051
8052 Press enter to return to parent value:
8053 @end smallexample
8054
8055 @noindent
8056 If the field @code{arr} of @code{cs} was chosen for exploration by
8057 entering @code{1} earlier, then since it is as array, you will be
8058 prompted to enter the index of the element in the array that you want
8059 to explore.
8060
8061 @smallexample
8062 `cs.arr' is an array of `int'.
8063 Enter the index of the element you want to explore in `cs.arr': 5
8064
8065 `(cs.arr)[5]' is a scalar value of type `int'.
8066
8067 (cs.arr)[5] = 4
8068
8069 Press enter to return to parent value:
8070 @end smallexample
8071
8072 In general, at any stage of exploration, you can go deeper towards the
8073 leaf values by responding to the prompts appropriately, or hit the
8074 return key to return to the enclosing data structure (the @i{higher}
8075 level data structure).
8076
8077 Similar to exploring values, you can use the @code{explore} command to
8078 explore types. Instead of specifying a value (which is typically a
8079 variable name or an expression valid in the current context of the
8080 program being debugged), you specify a type name. If you consider the
8081 same example as above, your can explore the type
8082 @code{struct ComplexStruct} by passing the argument
8083 @code{struct ComplexStruct} to the @code{explore} command.
8084
8085 @smallexample
8086 (gdb) explore struct ComplexStruct
8087 @end smallexample
8088
8089 @noindent
8090 By responding to the prompts appropriately in the subsequent interactive
8091 session, you can explore the type @code{struct ComplexStruct} in a
8092 manner similar to how the value @code{cs} was explored in the above
8093 example.
8094
8095 The @code{explore} command also has two sub-commands,
8096 @code{explore value} and @code{explore type}. The former sub-command is
8097 a way to explicitly specify that value exploration of the argument is
8098 being invoked, while the latter is a way to explicitly specify that type
8099 exploration of the argument is being invoked.
8100
8101 @table @code
8102 @item explore value @var{expr}
8103 @cindex explore value
8104 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the value of the
8105 expression @var{expr} (if @var{expr} is an expression valid in the
8106 current context of the program being debugged). The behavior of this
8107 command is identical to that of the behavior of the @code{explore}
8108 command being passed the argument @var{expr}.
8109
8110 @item explore type @var{arg}
8111 @cindex explore type
8112 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the type of @var{arg} (if
8113 @var{arg} is a type visible in the current context of program being
8114 debugged), or the type of the value/expression @var{arg} (if @var{arg}
8115 is an expression valid in the current context of the program being
8116 debugged). If @var{arg} is a type, then the behavior of this command is
8117 identical to that of the @code{explore} command being passed the
8118 argument @var{arg}. If @var{arg} is an expression, then the behavior of
8119 this command will be identical to that of the @code{explore} command
8120 being passed the type of @var{arg} as the argument.
8121 @end table
8122
8123 @menu
8124 * Expressions:: Expressions
8125 * Ambiguous Expressions:: Ambiguous Expressions
8126 * Variables:: Program variables
8127 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
8128 * Output Formats:: Output formats
8129 * Memory:: Examining memory
8130 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
8131 * Print Settings:: Print settings
8132 * Pretty Printing:: Python pretty printing
8133 * Value History:: Value history
8134 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
8135 * Convenience Funs:: Convenience functions
8136 * Registers:: Registers
8137 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
8138 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
8139 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
8140 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
8141 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
8142 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
8143 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
8144 character set than GDB does
8145 * Caching Target Data:: Data caching for targets
8146 * Searching Memory:: Searching memory for a sequence of bytes
8147 @end menu
8148
8149 @node Expressions
8150 @section Expressions
8151
8152 @cindex expressions
8153 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
8154 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
8155 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
8156 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
8157 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
8158 you compiled your program to include this information; see
8159 @ref{Compilation}.
8160
8161 @cindex arrays in expressions
8162 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
8163 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
8164 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to create an array
8165 of three integers. If you pass an array to a function or assign it
8166 to a program variable, @value{GDBN} copies the array to memory that
8167 is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
8168
8169 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
8170 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
8171 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
8172 languages.
8173
8174 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
8175 expressions regardless of your programming language.
8176
8177 @cindex casts, in expressions
8178 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
8179 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
8180 at that address in memory.
8181 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
8182
8183 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
8184 to programming languages:
8185
8186 @table @code
8187 @item @@
8188 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
8189 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
8190
8191 @item ::
8192 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
8193 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
8194
8195 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
8196 @cindex type casting memory
8197 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
8198 @cindex casts, to view memory
8199 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
8200 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
8201 memory. The address @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is
8202 an integer or pointer (but parentheses are required around binary
8203 operators, just as in a cast). This construct is allowed regardless
8204 of what kind of data is normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
8205 @end table
8206
8207 @node Ambiguous Expressions
8208 @section Ambiguous Expressions
8209 @cindex ambiguous expressions
8210
8211 Expressions can sometimes contain some ambiguous elements. For instance,
8212 some programming languages (notably Ada, C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit
8213 a single function name to be defined several times, for application in
8214 different contexts. This is called @dfn{overloading}. Another example
8215 involving Ada is generics. A @dfn{generic package} is similar to C@t{++}
8216 templates and is typically instantiated several times, resulting in
8217 the same function name being defined in different contexts.
8218
8219 In some cases and depending on the language, it is possible to adjust
8220 the expression to remove the ambiguity. For instance in C@t{++}, you
8221 can specify the signature of the function you want to break on, as in
8222 @kbd{break @var{function}(@var{types})}. In Ada, using the fully
8223 qualified name of your function often makes the expression unambiguous
8224 as well.
8225
8226 When an ambiguity that needs to be resolved is detected, the debugger
8227 has the capability to display a menu of numbered choices for each
8228 possibility, and then waits for the selection with the prompt @samp{>}.
8229 The first option is always @samp{[0] cancel}, and typing @kbd{0 @key{RET}}
8230 aborts the current command. If the command in which the expression was
8231 used allows more than one choice to be selected, the next option in the
8232 menu is @samp{[1] all}, and typing @kbd{1 @key{RET}} selects all possible
8233 choices.
8234
8235 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
8236 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
8237 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
8238
8239 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
8240 @smallexample
8241 @group
8242 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
8243 [0] cancel
8244 [1] all
8245 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
8246 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
8247 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
8248 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
8249 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
8250 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
8251 > 2 4 6
8252 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
8253 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
8254 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
8255 Multiple breakpoints were set.
8256 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
8257 breakpoints.
8258 (@value{GDBP})
8259 @end group
8260 @end smallexample
8261
8262 @table @code
8263 @kindex set multiple-symbols
8264 @item set multiple-symbols @var{mode}
8265 @cindex multiple-symbols menu
8266
8267 This option allows you to adjust the debugger behavior when an expression
8268 is ambiguous.
8269
8270 By default, @var{mode} is set to @code{all}. If the command with which
8271 the expression is used allows more than one choice, then @value{GDBN}
8272 automatically selects all possible choices. For instance, inserting
8273 a breakpoint on a function using an ambiguous name results in a breakpoint
8274 inserted on each possible match. However, if a unique choice must be made,
8275 then @value{GDBN} uses the menu to help you disambiguate the expression.
8276 For instance, printing the address of an overloaded function will result
8277 in the use of the menu.
8278
8279 When @var{mode} is set to @code{ask}, the debugger always uses the menu
8280 when an ambiguity is detected.
8281
8282 Finally, when @var{mode} is set to @code{cancel}, the debugger reports
8283 an error due to the ambiguity and the command is aborted.
8284
8285 @kindex show multiple-symbols
8286 @item show multiple-symbols
8287 Show the current value of the @code{multiple-symbols} setting.
8288 @end table
8289
8290 @node Variables
8291 @section Program Variables
8292
8293 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
8294 in your program.
8295
8296 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
8297 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
8298
8299 @itemize @bullet
8300 @item
8301 global (or file-static)
8302 @end itemize
8303
8304 @noindent or
8305
8306 @itemize @bullet
8307 @item
8308 visible according to the scope rules of the
8309 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
8310 @end itemize
8311
8312 @noindent This means that in the function
8313
8314 @smallexample
8315 foo (a)
8316 int a;
8317 @{
8318 bar (a);
8319 @{
8320 int b = test ();
8321 bar (b);
8322 @}
8323 @}
8324 @end smallexample
8325
8326 @noindent
8327 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
8328 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
8329 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
8330 the block where @code{b} is declared.
8331
8332 @cindex variable name conflict
8333 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
8334 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
8335 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
8336 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
8337 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
8338 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file by
8339 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
8340
8341 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
8342 @ifnotinfo
8343 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
8344 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
8345 @end ifnotinfo
8346 @smallexample
8347 @var{file}::@var{variable}
8348 @var{function}::@var{variable}
8349 @end smallexample
8350
8351 @noindent
8352 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
8353 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
8354 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
8355 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
8356
8357 @smallexample
8358 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
8359 @end smallexample
8360
8361 The @code{::} notation is normally used for referring to
8362 static variables, since you typically disambiguate uses of local variables
8363 in functions by selecting the appropriate frame and using the
8364 simple name of the variable. However, you may also use this notation
8365 to refer to local variables in frames enclosing the selected frame:
8366
8367 @smallexample
8368 void
8369 foo (int a)
8370 @{
8371 if (a < 10)
8372 bar (a);
8373 else
8374 process (a); /* Stop here */
8375 @}
8376
8377 int
8378 bar (int a)
8379 @{
8380 foo (a + 5);
8381 @}
8382 @end smallexample
8383
8384 @noindent
8385 For example, if there is a breakpoint at the commented line,
8386 here is what you might see
8387 when the program stops after executing the call @code{bar(0)}:
8388
8389 @smallexample
8390 (@value{GDBP}) p a
8391 $1 = 10
8392 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
8393 $2 = 5
8394 (@value{GDBP}) up 2
8395 #2 0x080483d0 in foo (a=5) at foobar.c:12
8396 (@value{GDBP}) p a
8397 $3 = 5
8398 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
8399 $4 = 0
8400 @end smallexample
8401
8402 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
8403 These uses of @samp{::} are very rarely in conflict with the very
8404 similar use of the same notation in C@t{++}. When they are in
8405 conflict, the C@t{++} meaning takes precedence; however, this can be
8406 overridden by quoting the file or function name with single quotes.
8407
8408 For example, suppose the program is stopped in a method of a class
8409 that has a field named @code{includefile}, and there is also an
8410 include file named @file{includefile} that defines a variable,
8411 @code{some_global}.
8412
8413 @smallexample
8414 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile
8415 $1 = 23
8416 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile::some_global
8417 A syntax error in expression, near `'.
8418 (@value{GDBP}) p 'includefile'::some_global
8419 $2 = 27
8420 @end smallexample
8421
8422 @cindex wrong values
8423 @cindex variable values, wrong
8424 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
8425 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
8426 @quotation
8427 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
8428 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
8429 scope, and just before exit.
8430 @end quotation
8431 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
8432 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
8433 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
8434 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
8435 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
8436 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
8437 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
8438 variable definitions may be gone.
8439
8440 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
8441 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
8442 when compiling.
8443
8444 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
8445 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
8446 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
8447 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
8448 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
8449 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
8450 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
8451
8452 @smallexample
8453 No symbol "foo" in current context.
8454 @end smallexample
8455
8456 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
8457 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
8458 formats. @xref{Compilation}, for more information on choosing compiler
8459 options. @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug
8460 info formats that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
8461
8462 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
8463 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
8464 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
8465 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
8466
8467 If you append @kbd{@@entry} string to a function parameter name you get its
8468 value at the time the function got called. If the value is not available an
8469 error message is printed. Entry values are available only with some compilers.
8470 Entry values are normally also printed at the function parameter list according
8471 to @ref{set print entry-values}.
8472
8473 @smallexample
8474 Breakpoint 1, d (i=30) at gdb.base/entry-value.c:29
8475 29 i++;
8476 (gdb) next
8477 30 e (i);
8478 (gdb) print i
8479 $1 = 31
8480 (gdb) print i@@entry
8481 $2 = 30
8482 @end smallexample
8483
8484 Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
8485 signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
8486 printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
8487 @code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
8488 defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
8489 For program code
8490
8491 @smallexample
8492 char var0[] = "A";
8493 signed char var1[] = "A";
8494 @end smallexample
8495
8496 You get during debugging
8497 @smallexample
8498 (gdb) print var0
8499 $1 = "A"
8500 (gdb) print var1
8501 $2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
8502 @end smallexample
8503
8504 @node Arrays
8505 @section Artificial Arrays
8506
8507 @cindex artificial array
8508 @cindex arrays
8509 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
8510 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
8511 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
8512 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
8513 program.
8514
8515 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
8516 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
8517 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
8518 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
8519 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
8520 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
8521 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
8522 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
8523 example. If a program says
8524
8525 @smallexample
8526 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
8527 @end smallexample
8528
8529 @noindent
8530 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
8531
8532 @smallexample
8533 p *array@@len
8534 @end smallexample
8535
8536 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
8537 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
8538 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
8539 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
8540 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
8541
8542 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
8543 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
8544 The value need not be in memory:
8545 @smallexample
8546 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
8547 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
8548 @end smallexample
8549
8550 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
8551 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
8552 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
8553 @smallexample
8554 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
8555 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
8556 @end smallexample
8557
8558 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
8559 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
8560 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
8561 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
8562 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
8563 Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
8564 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
8565 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
8566 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
8567 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
8568
8569 @smallexample
8570 set $i = 0
8571 p dtab[$i++]->fv
8572 @key{RET}
8573 @key{RET}
8574 @dots{}
8575 @end smallexample
8576
8577 @node Output Formats
8578 @section Output Formats
8579
8580 @cindex formatted output
8581 @cindex output formats
8582 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
8583 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
8584 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
8585 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
8586 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
8587
8588 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
8589 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
8590 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
8591 letters supported are:
8592
8593 @table @code
8594 @item x
8595 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
8596 hexadecimal.
8597
8598 @item d
8599 Print as integer in signed decimal.
8600
8601 @item u
8602 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
8603
8604 @item o
8605 Print as integer in octal.
8606
8607 @item t
8608 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
8609 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
8610 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
8611 see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
8612
8613 @item a
8614 @cindex unknown address, locating
8615 @cindex locate address
8616 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
8617 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
8618 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
8619
8620 @smallexample
8621 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
8622 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
8623 @end smallexample
8624
8625 @noindent
8626 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
8627 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
8628
8629 @item c
8630 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
8631 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
8632 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
8633 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
8634
8635 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
8636 @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
8637 constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
8638 data.
8639
8640 @item f
8641 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
8642 using typical floating point syntax.
8643
8644 @item s
8645 @cindex printing strings
8646 @cindex printing byte arrays
8647 Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte
8648 data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
8649 are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their
8650 natural types.
8651
8652 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
8653 @code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
8654 strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
8655 array.
8656
8657 @item z
8658 Like @samp{x} formatting, the value is treated as an integer and
8659 printed as hexadecimal, but leading zeros are printed to pad the value
8660 to the size of the integer type.
8661
8662 @item r
8663 @cindex raw printing
8664 Print using the @samp{raw} formatting. By default, @value{GDBN} will
8665 use a Python-based pretty-printer, if one is available (@pxref{Pretty
8666 Printing}). This typically results in a higher-level display of the
8667 value's contents. The @samp{r} format bypasses any Python
8668 pretty-printer which might exist.
8669 @end table
8670
8671 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
8672
8673 @smallexample
8674 p/x $pc
8675 @end smallexample
8676
8677 @noindent
8678 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
8679 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
8680
8681 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
8682 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
8683 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
8684
8685 @node Memory
8686 @section Examining Memory
8687
8688 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
8689 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
8690
8691 @cindex examining memory
8692 @table @code
8693 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
8694 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
8695 @itemx x @var{addr}
8696 @itemx x
8697 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
8698 @end table
8699
8700 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
8701 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
8702 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
8703 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
8704 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
8705
8706 @table @r
8707 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
8708 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
8709 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
8710 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
8711 @c 4.1.2.
8712
8713 @item @var{f}, the display format
8714 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
8715 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
8716 @samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
8717 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes
8718 each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
8719
8720 @item @var{u}, the unit size
8721 The unit size is any of
8722
8723 @table @code
8724 @item b
8725 Bytes.
8726 @item h
8727 Halfwords (two bytes).
8728 @item w
8729 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
8730 @item g
8731 Giant words (eight bytes).
8732 @end table
8733
8734 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
8735 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. For the @samp{i} format,
8736 the unit size is ignored and is normally not written. For the @samp{s} format,
8737 the unit size defaults to @samp{b}, unless it is explicitly given.
8738 Use @kbd{x /hs} to display 16-bit char strings and @kbd{x /ws} to display
8739 32-bit strings. The next use of @kbd{x /s} will again display 8-bit strings.
8740 Note that the results depend on the programming language of the
8741 current compilation unit. If the language is C, the @samp{s}
8742 modifier will use the UTF-16 encoding while @samp{w} will use
8743 UTF-32. The encoding is set by the programming language and cannot
8744 be altered.
8745
8746 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
8747 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
8748 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
8749 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
8750 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
8751 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
8752 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
8753 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
8754 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
8755 a value from memory).
8756 @end table
8757
8758 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
8759 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
8760 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
8761 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
8762 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
8763
8764 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
8765 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
8766 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
8767 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
8768 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
8769
8770 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
8771 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
8772 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
8773 including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
8774 the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
8775 slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
8776 follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
8777 @code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
8778 instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
8779
8780 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
8781 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
8782 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
8783 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
8784 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
8785 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
8786 for successive uses of @code{x}.
8787
8788 When examining machine instructions, the instruction at current program
8789 counter is shown with a @code{=>} marker. For example:
8790
8791 @smallexample
8792 (@value{GDBP}) x/5i $pc-6
8793 0x804837f <main+11>: mov %esp,%ebp
8794 0x8048381 <main+13>: push %ecx
8795 0x8048382 <main+14>: sub $0x4,%esp
8796 => 0x8048385 <main+17>: movl $0x8048460,(%esp)
8797 0x804838c <main+24>: call 0x80482d4 <puts@@plt>
8798 @end smallexample
8799
8800 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
8801 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
8802 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
8803 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
8804 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
8805 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
8806 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
8807 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
8808 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
8809
8810 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
8811 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
8812 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
8813
8814 @cindex remote memory comparison
8815 @cindex target memory comparison
8816 @cindex verify remote memory image
8817 @cindex verify target memory image
8818 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
8819 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image
8820 in the remote machine's memory against the executable file you
8821 downloaded to the target. Or, on any target, you may want to check
8822 whether the program has corrupted its own read-only sections. The
8823 @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such situations.
8824
8825 @table @code
8826 @kindex compare-sections
8827 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{|}@code{-r}@r{]}
8828 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
8829 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
8830 the target machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
8831 arguments, compares all loadable sections. With an argument of
8832 @code{-r}, compares all loadable read-only sections.
8833
8834 Note: for remote targets, this command can be accelerated if the
8835 target supports computing the CRC checksum of a block of memory
8836 (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
8837 @end table
8838
8839 @node Auto Display
8840 @section Automatic Display
8841 @cindex automatic display
8842 @cindex display of expressions
8843
8844 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
8845 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
8846 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
8847 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
8848 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
8849 The automatic display looks like this:
8850
8851 @smallexample
8852 2: foo = 38
8853 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
8854 @end smallexample
8855
8856 @noindent
8857 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
8858 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
8859 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
8860 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
8861 specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
8862 or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
8863
8864 @table @code
8865 @kindex display
8866 @item display @var{expr}
8867 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
8868 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
8869
8870 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
8871
8872 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
8873 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
8874 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
8875 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
8876 @xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
8877
8878 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
8879 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
8880 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
8881 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
8882 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
8883 @end table
8884
8885 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
8886 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
8887 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
8888
8889 @table @code
8890 @kindex delete display
8891 @kindex undisplay
8892 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
8893 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
8894 Remove items from the list of expressions to display. Specify the
8895 numbers of the displays that you want affected with the command
8896 argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one of the
8897 numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display} display;
8898 or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
8899
8900 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
8901 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
8902
8903 @kindex disable display
8904 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
8905 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
8906 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
8907 enabled again later. Specify the numbers of the displays that you
8908 want affected with the command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a
8909 single display number, one of the numbers shown in the first field of
8910 the @samp{info display} display; or it could be a range of display
8911 numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
8912
8913 @kindex enable display
8914 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
8915 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
8916 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
8917 Specify the numbers of the displays that you want affected with the
8918 command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one
8919 of the numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display}
8920 display; or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
8921
8922 @item display
8923 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
8924 done when your program stops.
8925
8926 @kindex info display
8927 @item info display
8928 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
8929 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
8930 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
8931 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
8932 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
8933 @end table
8934
8935 @cindex display disabled out of scope
8936 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
8937 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
8938 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
8939 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
8940 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
8941 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
8942 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
8943 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
8944 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
8945 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
8946
8947 @node Print Settings
8948 @section Print Settings
8949
8950 @cindex format options
8951 @cindex print settings
8952 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
8953 and symbols are printed.
8954
8955 @noindent
8956 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
8957
8958 @table @code
8959 @kindex set print
8960 @item set print address
8961 @itemx set print address on
8962 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
8963 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
8964 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
8965 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
8966 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
8967 @code{set print address on}:
8968
8969 @smallexample
8970 @group
8971 (@value{GDBP}) f
8972 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
8973 at input.c:530
8974 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
8975 @end group
8976 @end smallexample
8977
8978 @item set print address off
8979 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
8980 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
8981
8982 @smallexample
8983 @group
8984 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
8985 (@value{GDBP}) f
8986 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
8987 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
8988 @end group
8989 @end smallexample
8990
8991 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
8992 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
8993 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
8994 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
8995
8996 @kindex show print
8997 @item show print address
8998 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
8999 @end table
9000
9001 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
9002 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
9003 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
9004 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
9005 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
9006 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
9007 it prints a symbolic address:
9008
9009 @table @code
9010 @item set print symbol-filename on
9011 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
9012 @cindex symbol, source file and line
9013 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
9014 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
9015
9016 @item set print symbol-filename off
9017 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
9018 default.
9019
9020 @item show print symbol-filename
9021 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
9022 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
9023 @end table
9024
9025 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
9026 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
9027 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
9028
9029 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
9030 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
9031
9032 @table @code
9033 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
9034 @itemx set print max-symbolic-offset unlimited
9035 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
9036 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
9037 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
9038 @var{max-offset}. The default is @code{unlimited}, which tells @value{GDBN}
9039 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes
9040 it. Zero is equivalent to @code{unlimited}.
9041
9042 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
9043 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
9044 symbolic address.
9045 @end table
9046
9047 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
9048 @cindex pointer, finding referent
9049 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
9050 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
9051 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
9052 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
9053 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
9054 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
9055
9056 @smallexample
9057 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
9058 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
9059 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
9060 @end smallexample
9061
9062 @quotation
9063 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
9064 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
9065 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
9066 @end quotation
9067
9068 You can also enable @samp{/a}-like formatting all the time using
9069 @samp{set print symbol on}:
9070
9071 @table @code
9072 @item set print symbol on
9073 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the symbol corresponding to an address, if
9074 one exists.
9075
9076 @item set print symbol off
9077 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print the symbol corresponding to an
9078 address. In this mode, @value{GDBN} will still print the symbol
9079 corresponding to pointers to functions. This is the default.
9080
9081 @item show print symbol
9082 Show whether @value{GDBN} will display the symbol corresponding to an
9083 address.
9084 @end table
9085
9086 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
9087
9088 @table @code
9089 @item set print array
9090 @itemx set print array on
9091 @cindex pretty print arrays
9092 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
9093 but uses more space. The default is off.
9094
9095 @item set print array off
9096 Return to compressed format for arrays.
9097
9098 @item show print array
9099 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
9100 arrays.
9101
9102 @cindex print array indexes
9103 @item set print array-indexes
9104 @itemx set print array-indexes on
9105 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
9106 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
9107 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
9108
9109 @item set print array-indexes off
9110 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
9111
9112 @item show print array-indexes
9113 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
9114 arrays.
9115
9116 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
9117 @itemx set print elements unlimited
9118 @cindex number of array elements to print
9119 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
9120 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
9121 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
9122 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
9123 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
9124 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
9125 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to @code{unlimited} or zero means
9126 that the number of elements to print is unlimited.
9127
9128 @item show print elements
9129 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
9130 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
9131
9132 @item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
9133 @kindex set print frame-arguments
9134 @cindex printing frame argument values
9135 @cindex print all frame argument values
9136 @cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
9137 @cindex do not print frame argument values
9138 This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
9139 when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible
9140 values are:
9141
9142 @table @code
9143 @item all
9144 The values of all arguments are printed.
9145
9146 @item scalars
9147 Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more
9148 complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
9149 by @code{@dots{}}. This is the default. Here is an example where
9150 only scalar arguments are shown:
9151
9152 @smallexample
9153 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
9154 at frame-args.c:23
9155 @end smallexample
9156
9157 @item none
9158 None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument
9159 is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes:
9160
9161 @smallexample
9162 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
9163 at frame-args.c:23
9164 @end smallexample
9165 @end table
9166
9167 By default, only scalar arguments are printed. This command can be used
9168 to configure the debugger to print the value of all arguments, regardless
9169 of their type. However, it is often advantageous to not print the value
9170 of more complex parameters. For instance, it reduces the amount of
9171 information printed in each frame, making the backtrace more readable.
9172 Also, it improves performance when displaying Ada frames, because
9173 the computation of large arguments can sometimes be CPU-intensive,
9174 especially in large applications. Setting @code{print frame-arguments}
9175 to @code{scalars} (the default) or @code{none} avoids this computation,
9176 thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
9177
9178 @item show print frame-arguments
9179 Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
9180
9181 @item set print raw frame-arguments on
9182 Print frame arguments in raw, non pretty-printed, form.
9183
9184 @item set print raw frame-arguments off
9185 Print frame arguments in pretty-printed form, if there is a pretty-printer
9186 for the value (@pxref{Pretty Printing}),
9187 otherwise print the value in raw form.
9188 This is the default.
9189
9190 @item show print raw frame-arguments
9191 Show whether to print frame arguments in raw form.
9192
9193 @anchor{set print entry-values}
9194 @item set print entry-values @var{value}
9195 @kindex set print entry-values
9196 Set printing of frame argument values at function entry. In some cases
9197 @value{GDBN} can determine the value of function argument which was passed by
9198 the function caller, even if the value was modified inside the called function
9199 and therefore is different. With optimized code, the current value could be
9200 unavailable, but the entry value may still be known.
9201
9202 The default value is @code{default} (see below for its description). Older
9203 @value{GDBN} behaved as with the setting @code{no}. Compilers not supporting
9204 this feature will behave in the @code{default} setting the same way as with the
9205 @code{no} setting.
9206
9207 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
9208 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_GNU_call_site} tags. With
9209 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
9210 this information.
9211
9212 The @var{value} parameter can be one of the following:
9213
9214 @table @code
9215 @item no
9216 Print only actual parameter values, never print values from function entry
9217 point.
9218 @smallexample
9219 #0 equal (val=5)
9220 #0 different (val=6)
9221 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>)
9222 #0 born (val=10)
9223 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9224 @end smallexample
9225
9226 @item only
9227 Print only parameter values from function entry point. The actual parameter
9228 values are never printed.
9229 @smallexample
9230 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
9231 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
9232 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9233 #0 born (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9234 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9235 @end smallexample
9236
9237 @item preferred
9238 Print only parameter values from function entry point. If value from function
9239 entry point is not known while the actual value is known, print the actual
9240 value for such parameter.
9241 @smallexample
9242 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
9243 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
9244 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9245 #0 born (val=10)
9246 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9247 @end smallexample
9248
9249 @item if-needed
9250 Print actual parameter values. If actual parameter value is not known while
9251 value from function entry point is known, print the entry point value for such
9252 parameter.
9253 @smallexample
9254 #0 equal (val=5)
9255 #0 different (val=6)
9256 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9257 #0 born (val=10)
9258 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9259 @end smallexample
9260
9261 @item both
9262 Always print both the actual parameter value and its value from function entry
9263 point, even if values of one or both are not available due to compiler
9264 optimizations.
9265 @smallexample
9266 #0 equal (val=5, val@@entry=5)
9267 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9268 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
9269 #0 born (val=10, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9270 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9271 @end smallexample
9272
9273 @item compact
9274 Print the actual parameter value if it is known and also its value from
9275 function entry point if it is known. If neither is known, print for the actual
9276 value @code{<optimized out>}. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and if both
9277 values are known and identical, print the shortened
9278 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
9279 @smallexample
9280 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
9281 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9282 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9283 #0 born (val=10)
9284 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9285 @end smallexample
9286
9287 @item default
9288 Always print the actual parameter value. Print also its value from function
9289 entry point, but only if it is known. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and
9290 if both values are known and identical, print the shortened
9291 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
9292 @smallexample
9293 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
9294 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9295 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
9296 #0 born (val=10)
9297 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9298 @end smallexample
9299 @end table
9300
9301 For analysis messages on possible failures of frame argument values at function
9302 entry resolution see @ref{set debug entry-values}.
9303
9304 @item show print entry-values
9305 Show the method being used for printing of frame argument values at function
9306 entry.
9307
9308 @item set print repeats @var{number-of-repeats}
9309 @itemx set print repeats unlimited
9310 @cindex repeated array elements
9311 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
9312 elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
9313 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
9314 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
9315 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
9316 themselves. Setting the threshold to @code{unlimited} or zero will
9317 cause all elements to be individually printed. The default threshold
9318 is 10.
9319
9320 @item show print repeats
9321 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
9322 elements.
9323
9324 @item set print null-stop
9325 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
9326 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
9327 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
9328 contain only short strings.
9329 The default is off.
9330
9331 @item show print null-stop
9332 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
9333 @sc{null} character.
9334
9335 @item set print pretty on
9336 @cindex print structures in indented form
9337 @cindex indentation in structure display
9338 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
9339 per line, like this:
9340
9341 @smallexample
9342 @group
9343 $1 = @{
9344 next = 0x0,
9345 flags = @{
9346 sweet = 1,
9347 sour = 1
9348 @},
9349 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
9350 @}
9351 @end group
9352 @end smallexample
9353
9354 @item set print pretty off
9355 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
9356
9357 @smallexample
9358 @group
9359 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
9360 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
9361 @end group
9362 @end smallexample
9363
9364 @noindent
9365 This is the default format.
9366
9367 @item show print pretty
9368 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
9369
9370 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
9371 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
9372 @cindex octal escapes in strings
9373 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
9374 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
9375 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
9376 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
9377 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
9378
9379 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
9380 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
9381 international character sets, and is the default.
9382
9383 @item show print sevenbit-strings
9384 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
9385
9386 @item set print union on
9387 @cindex unions in structures, printing
9388 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
9389 and other unions. This is the default setting.
9390
9391 @item set print union off
9392 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
9393 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
9394 instead.
9395
9396 @item show print union
9397 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
9398 structures and other unions.
9399
9400 For example, given the declarations
9401
9402 @smallexample
9403 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
9404 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
9405 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
9406 Bug_forms;
9407
9408 struct thing @{
9409 Species it;
9410 union @{
9411 Tree_forms tree;
9412 Bug_forms bug;
9413 @} form;
9414 @};
9415
9416 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
9417 @end smallexample
9418
9419 @noindent
9420 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
9421
9422 @smallexample
9423 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
9424 @end smallexample
9425
9426 @noindent
9427 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
9428
9429 @smallexample
9430 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
9431 @end smallexample
9432
9433 @noindent
9434 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
9435 and in Pascal.
9436 @end table
9437
9438 @need 1000
9439 @noindent
9440 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
9441
9442 @table @code
9443 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
9444 @item set print demangle
9445 @itemx set print demangle on
9446 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
9447 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
9448 linkage. The default is on.
9449
9450 @item show print demangle
9451 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
9452
9453 @item set print asm-demangle
9454 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
9455 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
9456 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
9457 The default is off.
9458
9459 @item show print asm-demangle
9460 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
9461 or demangled form.
9462
9463 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
9464 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
9465 @kindex set demangle-style
9466 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
9467 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
9468 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
9469
9470 @table @code
9471 @item auto
9472 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
9473 This is the default.
9474
9475 @item gnu
9476 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
9477
9478 @item hp
9479 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
9480
9481 @item lucid
9482 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
9483
9484 @item arm
9485 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
9486 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
9487 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
9488 require further enhancement to permit that.
9489
9490 @end table
9491 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
9492
9493 @item show demangle-style
9494 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
9495
9496 @item set print object
9497 @itemx set print object on
9498 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
9499 @cindex display derived types
9500 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
9501 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
9502 the virtual function table. Note that the virtual function table is
9503 required---this feature can only work for objects that have run-time
9504 type identification; a single virtual method in the object's declared
9505 type is sufficient. Note that this setting is also taken into account when
9506 working with variable objects via MI (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
9507
9508 @item set print object off
9509 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
9510 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
9511
9512 @item show print object
9513 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
9514
9515 @item set print static-members
9516 @itemx set print static-members on
9517 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
9518 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
9519
9520 @item set print static-members off
9521 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
9522
9523 @item show print static-members
9524 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
9525
9526 @item set print pascal_static-members
9527 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
9528 @cindex static members of Pascal objects
9529 @cindex Pascal objects, static members display
9530 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
9531
9532 @item set print pascal_static-members off
9533 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
9534
9535 @item show print pascal_static-members
9536 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
9537
9538 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
9539 @item set print vtbl
9540 @itemx set print vtbl on
9541 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
9542 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
9543 @cindex VTBL display
9544 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
9545 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
9546 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
9547
9548 @item set print vtbl off
9549 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
9550
9551 @item show print vtbl
9552 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
9553 @end table
9554
9555 @node Pretty Printing
9556 @section Pretty Printing
9557
9558 @value{GDBN} provides a mechanism to allow pretty-printing of values using
9559 Python code. It greatly simplifies the display of complex objects. This
9560 mechanism works for both MI and the CLI.
9561
9562 @menu
9563 * Pretty-Printer Introduction:: Introduction to pretty-printers
9564 * Pretty-Printer Example:: An example pretty-printer
9565 * Pretty-Printer Commands:: Pretty-printer commands
9566 @end menu
9567
9568 @node Pretty-Printer Introduction
9569 @subsection Pretty-Printer Introduction
9570
9571 When @value{GDBN} prints a value, it first sees if there is a pretty-printer
9572 registered for the value. If there is then @value{GDBN} invokes the
9573 pretty-printer to print the value. Otherwise the value is printed normally.
9574
9575 Pretty-printers are normally named. This makes them easy to manage.
9576 The @samp{info pretty-printer} command will list all the installed
9577 pretty-printers with their names.
9578 If a pretty-printer can handle multiple data types, then its
9579 @dfn{subprinters} are the printers for the individual data types.
9580 Each such subprinter has its own name.
9581 The format of the name is @var{printer-name};@var{subprinter-name}.
9582
9583 Pretty-printers are installed by @dfn{registering} them with @value{GDBN}.
9584 Typically they are automatically loaded and registered when the corresponding
9585 debug information is loaded, thus making them available without having to
9586 do anything special.
9587
9588 There are three places where a pretty-printer can be registered.
9589
9590 @itemize @bullet
9591 @item
9592 Pretty-printers registered globally are available when debugging
9593 all inferiors.
9594
9595 @item
9596 Pretty-printers registered with a program space are available only
9597 when debugging that program.
9598 @xref{Progspaces In Python}, for more details on program spaces in Python.
9599
9600 @item
9601 Pretty-printers registered with an objfile are loaded and unloaded
9602 with the corresponding objfile (e.g., shared library).
9603 @xref{Objfiles In Python}, for more details on objfiles in Python.
9604 @end itemize
9605
9606 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for further information on how
9607 pretty-printers are selected,
9608
9609 @xref{Writing a Pretty-Printer}, for implementing pretty printers
9610 for new types.
9611
9612 @node Pretty-Printer Example
9613 @subsection Pretty-Printer Example
9614
9615 Here is how a C@t{++} @code{std::string} looks without a pretty-printer:
9616
9617 @smallexample
9618 (@value{GDBP}) print s
9619 $1 = @{
9620 static npos = 4294967295,
9621 _M_dataplus = @{
9622 <std::allocator<char>> = @{
9623 <__gnu_cxx::new_allocator<char>> = @{
9624 <No data fields>@}, <No data fields>
9625 @},
9626 members of std::basic_string<char, std::char_traits<char>,
9627 std::allocator<char> >::_Alloc_hider:
9628 _M_p = 0x804a014 "abcd"
9629 @}
9630 @}
9631 @end smallexample
9632
9633 With a pretty-printer for @code{std::string} only the contents are printed:
9634
9635 @smallexample
9636 (@value{GDBP}) print s
9637 $2 = "abcd"
9638 @end smallexample
9639
9640 @node Pretty-Printer Commands
9641 @subsection Pretty-Printer Commands
9642 @cindex pretty-printer commands
9643
9644 @table @code
9645 @kindex info pretty-printer
9646 @item info pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
9647 Print the list of installed pretty-printers.
9648 This includes disabled pretty-printers, which are marked as such.
9649
9650 @var{object-regexp} is a regular expression matching the objects
9651 whose pretty-printers to list.
9652 Objects can be @code{global}, the program space's file
9653 (@pxref{Progspaces In Python}),
9654 and the object files within that program space (@pxref{Objfiles In Python}).
9655 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for details on how @value{GDBN}
9656 looks up a printer from these three objects.
9657
9658 @var{name-regexp} is a regular expression matching the name of the printers
9659 to list.
9660
9661 @kindex disable pretty-printer
9662 @item disable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
9663 Disable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
9664 A disabled pretty-printer is not forgotten, it may be enabled again later.
9665
9666 @kindex enable pretty-printer
9667 @item enable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
9668 Enable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
9669 @end table
9670
9671 Example:
9672
9673 Suppose we have three pretty-printers installed: one from library1.so
9674 named @code{foo} that prints objects of type @code{foo}, and
9675 another from library2.so named @code{bar} that prints two types of objects,
9676 @code{bar1} and @code{bar2}.
9677
9678 @smallexample
9679 (gdb) info pretty-printer
9680 library1.so:
9681 foo
9682 library2.so:
9683 bar
9684 bar1
9685 bar2
9686 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
9687 library2.so:
9688 bar
9689 bar1
9690 bar2
9691 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library1
9692 1 printer disabled
9693 2 of 3 printers enabled
9694 (gdb) info pretty-printer
9695 library1.so:
9696 foo [disabled]
9697 library2.so:
9698 bar
9699 bar1
9700 bar2
9701 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar:bar1
9702 1 printer disabled
9703 1 of 3 printers enabled
9704 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
9705 library1.so:
9706 foo [disabled]
9707 library2.so:
9708 bar
9709 bar1 [disabled]
9710 bar2
9711 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar
9712 1 printer disabled
9713 0 of 3 printers enabled
9714 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
9715 library1.so:
9716 foo [disabled]
9717 library2.so:
9718 bar [disabled]
9719 bar1 [disabled]
9720 bar2
9721 @end smallexample
9722
9723 Note that for @code{bar} the entire printer can be disabled,
9724 as can each individual subprinter.
9725
9726 @node Value History
9727 @section Value History
9728
9729 @cindex value history
9730 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
9731 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
9732 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
9733 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
9734 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
9735 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
9736 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
9737 symbol table.
9738
9739 @cindex @code{$}
9740 @cindex @code{$$}
9741 @cindex history number
9742 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
9743 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
9744 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
9745 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
9746 history number.
9747
9748 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
9749 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
9750 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
9751 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
9752 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
9753 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
9754 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
9755
9756 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
9757 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
9758
9759 @smallexample
9760 p *$
9761 @end smallexample
9762
9763 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
9764 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
9765
9766 @smallexample
9767 p *$.next
9768 @end smallexample
9769
9770 @noindent
9771 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
9772 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
9773
9774 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
9775 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
9776
9777 @smallexample
9778 print x
9779 set x=5
9780 @end smallexample
9781
9782 @noindent
9783 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
9784 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
9785
9786 @table @code
9787 @kindex show values
9788 @item show values
9789 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
9790 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
9791 values} does not change the history.
9792
9793 @item show values @var{n}
9794 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
9795
9796 @item show values +
9797 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
9798 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
9799 @end table
9800
9801 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
9802 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
9803
9804 @node Convenience Vars
9805 @section Convenience Variables
9806
9807 @cindex convenience variables
9808 @cindex user-defined variables
9809 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
9810 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
9811 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
9812 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
9813 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
9814
9815 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
9816 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
9817 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
9818 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
9819 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
9820
9821 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
9822 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
9823 For example:
9824
9825 @smallexample
9826 set $foo = *object_ptr
9827 @end smallexample
9828
9829 @noindent
9830 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
9831 @code{object_ptr}.
9832
9833 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
9834 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
9835 value with another assignment at any time.
9836
9837 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
9838 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
9839 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
9840 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
9841
9842 @table @code
9843 @kindex show convenience
9844 @cindex show all user variables and functions
9845 @item show convenience
9846 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values,
9847 as well as a list of the convenience functions.
9848 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
9849
9850 @kindex init-if-undefined
9851 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
9852 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
9853 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
9854 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
9855 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
9856 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
9857 override default values used in a command script.
9858
9859 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
9860 any side-effects do not occur.
9861 @end table
9862
9863 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
9864 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
9865 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
9866
9867 @smallexample
9868 set $i = 0
9869 print bar[$i++]->contents
9870 @end smallexample
9871
9872 @noindent
9873 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
9874
9875 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
9876 values likely to be useful.
9877
9878 @table @code
9879 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
9880 @item $_
9881 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
9882 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
9883 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
9884 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
9885 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
9886 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
9887 to the type of @code{$__}.
9888
9889 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
9890 @item $__
9891 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
9892 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
9893 to match the format in which the data was printed.
9894
9895 @item $_exitcode
9896 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
9897 When the program being debugged terminates normally, @value{GDBN}
9898 automatically sets this variable to the exit code of the program, and
9899 resets @code{$_exitsignal} to @code{void}.
9900
9901 @item $_exitsignal
9902 @vindex $_exitsignal@r{, convenience variable}
9903 When the program being debugged dies due to an uncaught signal,
9904 @value{GDBN} automatically sets this variable to that signal's number,
9905 and resets @code{$_exitcode} to @code{void}.
9906
9907 To distinguish between whether the program being debugged has exited
9908 (i.e., @code{$_exitcode} is not @code{void}) or signalled (i.e.,
9909 @code{$_exitsignal} is not @code{void}), the convenience function
9910 @code{$_isvoid} can be used (@pxref{Convenience Funs,, Convenience
9911 Functions}). For example, considering the following source code:
9912
9913 @smallexample
9914 #include <signal.h>
9915
9916 int
9917 main (int argc, char *argv[])
9918 @{
9919 raise (SIGALRM);
9920 return 0;
9921 @}
9922 @end smallexample
9923
9924 A valid way of telling whether the program being debugged has exited
9925 or signalled would be:
9926
9927 @smallexample
9928 (@value{GDBP}) define has_exited_or_signalled
9929 Type commands for definition of ``has_exited_or_signalled''.
9930 End with a line saying just ``end''.
9931 >if $_isvoid ($_exitsignal)
9932 >echo The program has exited\n
9933 >else
9934 >echo The program has signalled\n
9935 >end
9936 >end
9937 (@value{GDBP}) run
9938 Starting program:
9939
9940 Program terminated with signal SIGALRM, Alarm clock.
9941 The program no longer exists.
9942 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
9943 The program has signalled
9944 @end smallexample
9945
9946 As can be seen, @value{GDBN} correctly informs that the program being
9947 debugged has signalled, since it calls @code{raise} and raises a
9948 @code{SIGALRM} signal. If the program being debugged had not called
9949 @code{raise}, then @value{GDBN} would report a normal exit:
9950
9951 @smallexample
9952 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
9953 The program has exited
9954 @end smallexample
9955
9956 @item $_exception
9957 The variable @code{$_exception} is set to the exception object being
9958 thrown at an exception-related catchpoint. @xref{Set Catchpoints}.
9959
9960 @item $_probe_argc
9961 @itemx $_probe_arg0@dots{}$_probe_arg11
9962 Arguments to a static probe. @xref{Static Probe Points}.
9963
9964 @item $_sdata
9965 @vindex $_sdata@r{, inspect, convenience variable}
9966 The variable @code{$_sdata} contains extra collected static tracepoint
9967 data. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}. Note that
9968 @code{$_sdata} could be empty, if not inspecting a trace buffer, or
9969 if extra static tracepoint data has not been collected.
9970
9971 @item $_siginfo
9972 @vindex $_siginfo@r{, convenience variable}
9973 The variable @code{$_siginfo} contains extra signal information
9974 (@pxref{extra signal information}). Note that @code{$_siginfo}
9975 could be empty, if the application has not yet received any signals.
9976 For example, it will be empty before you execute the @code{run} command.
9977
9978 @item $_tlb
9979 @vindex $_tlb@r{, convenience variable}
9980 The variable @code{$_tlb} is automatically set when debugging
9981 applications running on MS-Windows in native mode or connected to
9982 gdbserver that supports the @code{qGetTIBAddr} request.
9983 @xref{General Query Packets}.
9984 This variable contains the address of the thread information block.
9985
9986 @end table
9987
9988 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
9989 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
9990 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
9991
9992 @node Convenience Funs
9993 @section Convenience Functions
9994
9995 @cindex convenience functions
9996 @value{GDBN} also supplies some @dfn{convenience functions}. These
9997 have a syntax similar to convenience variables. A convenience
9998 function can be used in an expression just like an ordinary function;
9999 however, a convenience function is implemented internally to
10000 @value{GDBN}.
10001
10002 These functions do not require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
10003 @code{Python} support, which means that they are always available.
10004
10005 @table @code
10006
10007 @item $_isvoid (@var{expr})
10008 @findex $_isvoid@r{, convenience function}
10009 Return one if the expression @var{expr} is @code{void}. Otherwise it
10010 returns zero.
10011
10012 A @code{void} expression is an expression where the type of the result
10013 is @code{void}. For example, you can examine a convenience variable
10014 (see @ref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}) to check whether
10015 it is @code{void}:
10016
10017 @smallexample
10018 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
10019 $1 = void
10020 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
10021 $2 = 1
10022 (@value{GDBP}) run
10023 Starting program: ./a.out
10024 [Inferior 1 (process 29572) exited normally]
10025 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
10026 $3 = 0
10027 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
10028 $4 = 0
10029 @end smallexample
10030
10031 In the example above, we used @code{$_isvoid} to check whether
10032 @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void} before and after the execution of the
10033 program being debugged. Before the execution there is no exit code to
10034 be examined, therefore @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void}. After the
10035 execution the program being debugged returned zero, therefore
10036 @code{$_exitcode} is zero, which means that it is not @code{void}
10037 anymore.
10038
10039 The @code{void} expression can also be a call of a function from the
10040 program being debugged. For example, given the following function:
10041
10042 @smallexample
10043 void
10044 foo (void)
10045 @{
10046 @}
10047 @end smallexample
10048
10049 The result of calling it inside @value{GDBN} is @code{void}:
10050
10051 @smallexample
10052 (@value{GDBP}) print foo ()
10053 $1 = void
10054 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid (foo ())
10055 $2 = 1
10056 (@value{GDBP}) set $v = foo ()
10057 (@value{GDBP}) print $v
10058 $3 = void
10059 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($v)
10060 $4 = 1
10061 @end smallexample
10062
10063 @end table
10064
10065 These functions require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
10066 @code{Python} support.
10067
10068 @table @code
10069
10070 @item $_memeq(@var{buf1}, @var{buf2}, @var{length})
10071 @findex $_memeq@r{, convenience function}
10072 Returns one if the @var{length} bytes at the addresses given by
10073 @var{buf1} and @var{buf2} are equal.
10074 Otherwise it returns zero.
10075
10076 @item $_regex(@var{str}, @var{regex})
10077 @findex $_regex@r{, convenience function}
10078 Returns one if the string @var{str} matches the regular expression
10079 @var{regex}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10080 The syntax of the regular expression is that specified by @code{Python}'s
10081 regular expression support.
10082
10083 @item $_streq(@var{str1}, @var{str2})
10084 @findex $_streq@r{, convenience function}
10085 Returns one if the strings @var{str1} and @var{str2} are equal.
10086 Otherwise it returns zero.
10087
10088 @item $_strlen(@var{str})
10089 @findex $_strlen@r{, convenience function}
10090 Returns the length of string @var{str}.
10091
10092 @item $_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10093 @findex $_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
10094 Returns one if the calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
10095 Otherwise it returns zero.
10096
10097 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10098 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10099 The default is 1.
10100
10101 Example:
10102
10103 @smallexample
10104 (gdb) backtrace
10105 #0 bottom_func ()
10106 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:21
10107 #1 0x00000000004005a0 in middle_func ()
10108 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:27
10109 #2 0x00000000004005ab in top_func ()
10110 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:33
10111 #3 0x00000000004005b6 in main ()
10112 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:39
10113 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("middle_func")
10114 $1 = 1
10115 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("top_func", 2)
10116 $1 = 1
10117 @end smallexample
10118
10119 @item $_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10120 @findex $_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
10121 Returns one if the calling function's name matches the regular expression
10122 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10123
10124 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10125 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10126 The default is 1.
10127
10128 @item $_any_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10129 @findex $_any_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
10130 Returns one if any calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
10131 Otherwise it returns zero.
10132
10133 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10134 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10135 The default is 1.
10136
10137 This function differs from @code{$_caller_is} in that this function
10138 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
10139 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_is} only checks the
10140 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
10141
10142 @item $_any_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10143 @findex $_any_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
10144 Returns one if any calling function's name matches the regular expression
10145 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10146
10147 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10148 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10149 The default is 1.
10150
10151 This function differs from @code{$_caller_matches} in that this function
10152 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
10153 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_matches} only checks the
10154 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
10155
10156 @end table
10157
10158 @value{GDBN} provides the ability to list and get help on
10159 convenience functions.
10160
10161 @table @code
10162 @item help function
10163 @kindex help function
10164 @cindex show all convenience functions
10165 Print a list of all convenience functions.
10166 @end table
10167
10168 @node Registers
10169 @section Registers
10170
10171 @cindex registers
10172 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
10173 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
10174 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
10175 your machine.
10176
10177 @table @code
10178 @kindex info registers
10179 @item info registers
10180 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
10181 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
10182
10183 @kindex info all-registers
10184 @cindex floating point registers
10185 @item info all-registers
10186 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
10187 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
10188
10189 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
10190 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
10191 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
10192 the selected stack frame. The @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
10193 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
10194 @end table
10195
10196 @cindex stack pointer register
10197 @cindex program counter register
10198 @cindex process status register
10199 @cindex frame pointer register
10200 @cindex standard registers
10201 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
10202 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
10203 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
10204 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
10205 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
10206 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
10207 register that contains the processor status. For example,
10208 you could print the program counter in hex with
10209
10210 @smallexample
10211 p/x $pc
10212 @end smallexample
10213
10214 @noindent
10215 or print the instruction to be executed next with
10216
10217 @smallexample
10218 x/i $pc
10219 @end smallexample
10220
10221 @noindent
10222 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
10223 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
10224 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
10225 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
10226 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
10227 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
10228 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
10229
10230 @smallexample
10231 set $sp += 4
10232 @end smallexample
10233
10234 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
10235 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
10236 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
10237 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
10238 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
10239 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
10240 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
10241
10242 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
10243 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
10244 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
10245 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
10246 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
10247 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
10248 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
10249
10250 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
10251 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
10252 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
10253 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
10254 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
10255 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
10256 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
10257 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
10258 prints the data in both formats.
10259
10260 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
10261 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
10262 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
10263 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
10264 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
10265 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
10266 registers in @code{struct} notation:
10267
10268 @smallexample
10269 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
10270 $1 = @{
10271 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
10272 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
10273 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
10274 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
10275 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
10276 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
10277 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
10278 @}
10279 @end smallexample
10280
10281 @noindent
10282 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
10283 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
10284 value to a @code{struct} member:
10285
10286 @smallexample
10287 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
10288 @end smallexample
10289
10290 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
10291 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
10292 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
10293 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
10294 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
10295 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
10296
10297 @cindex caller-saved registers
10298 @cindex call-clobbered registers
10299 @cindex volatile registers
10300 @cindex <not saved> values
10301 Usually ABIs reserve some registers as not needed to be saved by the
10302 callee (a.k.a.: ``caller-saved'', ``call-clobbered'' or ``volatile''
10303 registers). It may therefore not be possible for @value{GDBN} to know
10304 the value a register had before the call (in other words, in the outer
10305 frame), if the register value has since been changed by the callee.
10306 @value{GDBN} tries to deduce where the inner frame saved
10307 (``callee-saved'') registers, from the debug info, unwind info, or the
10308 machine code generated by your compiler. If some register is not
10309 saved, and @value{GDBN} knows the register is ``caller-saved'' (via
10310 its own knowledge of the ABI, or because the debug/unwind info
10311 explicitly says the register's value is undefined), @value{GDBN}
10312 displays @w{@samp{<not saved>}} as the register's value. With targets
10313 that @value{GDBN} has no knowledge of the register saving convention,
10314 if a register was not saved by the callee, then its value and location
10315 in the outer frame are assumed to be the same of the inner frame.
10316 This is usually harmless, because if the register is call-clobbered,
10317 the caller either does not care what is in the register after the
10318 call, or has code to restore the value that it does care about. Note,
10319 however, that if you change such a register in the outer frame, you
10320 may also be affecting the inner frame. Also, the more ``outer'' the
10321 frame is you're looking at, the more likely a call-clobbered
10322 register's value is to be wrong, in the sense that it doesn't actually
10323 represent the value the register had just before the call.
10324
10325 @node Floating Point Hardware
10326 @section Floating Point Hardware
10327 @cindex floating point
10328
10329 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
10330 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
10331
10332 @table @code
10333 @kindex info float
10334 @item info float
10335 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
10336 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
10337 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
10338 the ARM and x86 machines.
10339 @end table
10340
10341 @node Vector Unit
10342 @section Vector Unit
10343 @cindex vector unit
10344
10345 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
10346 more information about the status of the vector unit.
10347
10348 @table @code
10349 @kindex info vector
10350 @item info vector
10351 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
10352 layout vary depending on the hardware.
10353 @end table
10354
10355 @node OS Information
10356 @section Operating System Auxiliary Information
10357 @cindex OS information
10358
10359 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
10360 you debug your program.
10361
10362 @cindex auxiliary vector
10363 @cindex vector, auxiliary
10364 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
10365 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
10366 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
10367 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
10368 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
10369 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
10370 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
10371 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
10372 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
10373 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
10374 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
10375
10376 @table @code
10377 @kindex info auxv
10378 @item info auxv
10379 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
10380 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
10381 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
10382 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
10383 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
10384 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
10385 an unrecognized tag.
10386 @end table
10387
10388 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can access operating system-specific
10389 information and show it to you. The types of information available
10390 will differ depending on the type of operating system running on the
10391 target. The mechanism used to fetch the data is described in
10392 @ref{Operating System Information}. For remote targets, this
10393 functionality depends on the remote stub's support of the
10394 @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet, see @ref{qXfer osdata read}.
10395
10396 @table @code
10397 @kindex info os
10398 @item info os @var{infotype}
10399
10400 Display OS information of the requested type.
10401
10402 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, the following values of @var{infotype} are valid:
10403
10404 @anchor{linux info os infotypes}
10405 @table @code
10406 @kindex info os processes
10407 @item processes
10408 Display the list of processes on the target. For each process,
10409 @value{GDBN} prints the process identifier, the name of the user, the
10410 command corresponding to the process, and the list of processor cores
10411 that the process is currently running on. (To understand what these
10412 properties mean, for this and the following info types, please consult
10413 the general @sc{gnu}/Linux documentation.)
10414
10415 @kindex info os procgroups
10416 @item procgroups
10417 Display the list of process groups on the target. For each process,
10418 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process group that it belongs
10419 to, the command corresponding to the process group leader, the process
10420 identifier, and the command line of the process. The list is sorted
10421 first by the process group identifier, then by the process identifier,
10422 so that processes belonging to the same process group are grouped together
10423 and the process group leader is listed first.
10424
10425 @kindex info os threads
10426 @item threads
10427 Display the list of threads running on the target. For each thread,
10428 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process that the thread
10429 belongs to, the command of the process, the thread identifier, and the
10430 processor core that it is currently running on. The main thread of a
10431 process is not listed.
10432
10433 @kindex info os files
10434 @item files
10435 Display the list of open file descriptors on the target. For each
10436 file descriptor, @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process
10437 owning the descriptor, the command of the owning process, the value
10438 of the descriptor, and the target of the descriptor.
10439
10440 @kindex info os sockets
10441 @item sockets
10442 Display the list of Internet-domain sockets on the target. For each
10443 socket, @value{GDBN} prints the address and port of the local and
10444 remote endpoints, the current state of the connection, the creator of
10445 the socket, the IP address family of the socket, and the type of the
10446 connection.
10447
10448 @kindex info os shm
10449 @item shm
10450 Display the list of all System V shared-memory regions on the target.
10451 For each shared-memory region, @value{GDBN} prints the region key,
10452 the shared-memory identifier, the access permissions, the size of the
10453 region, the process that created the region, the process that last
10454 attached to or detached from the region, the current number of live
10455 attaches to the region, and the times at which the region was last
10456 attached to, detach from, and changed.
10457
10458 @kindex info os semaphores
10459 @item semaphores
10460 Display the list of all System V semaphore sets on the target. For each
10461 semaphore set, @value{GDBN} prints the semaphore set key, the semaphore
10462 set identifier, the access permissions, the number of semaphores in the
10463 set, the user and group of the owner and creator of the semaphore set,
10464 and the times at which the semaphore set was operated upon and changed.
10465
10466 @kindex info os msg
10467 @item msg
10468 Display the list of all System V message queues on the target. For each
10469 message queue, @value{GDBN} prints the message queue key, the message
10470 queue identifier, the access permissions, the current number of bytes
10471 on the queue, the current number of messages on the queue, the processes
10472 that last sent and received a message on the queue, the user and group
10473 of the owner and creator of the message queue, the times at which a
10474 message was last sent and received on the queue, and the time at which
10475 the message queue was last changed.
10476
10477 @kindex info os modules
10478 @item modules
10479 Display the list of all loaded kernel modules on the target. For each
10480 module, @value{GDBN} prints the module name, the size of the module in
10481 bytes, the number of times the module is used, the dependencies of the
10482 module, the status of the module, and the address of the loaded module
10483 in memory.
10484 @end table
10485
10486 @item info os
10487 If @var{infotype} is omitted, then list the possible values for
10488 @var{infotype} and the kind of OS information available for each
10489 @var{infotype}. If the target does not return a list of possible
10490 types, this command will report an error.
10491 @end table
10492
10493 @node Memory Region Attributes
10494 @section Memory Region Attributes
10495 @cindex memory region attributes
10496
10497 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
10498 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
10499 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
10500 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
10501 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
10502 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
10503 user can override the fetched regions.
10504
10505 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
10506 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
10507 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
10508 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
10509 all memory.
10510
10511 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
10512 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
10513
10514 @table @code
10515 @kindex mem
10516 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
10517 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
10518 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
10519 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
10520 case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
10521 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
10522
10523 @item mem auto
10524 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
10525 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
10526
10527 @kindex delete mem
10528 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
10529 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
10530 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
10531
10532 @kindex disable mem
10533 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
10534 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
10535 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
10536 It may be enabled again later.
10537
10538 @kindex enable mem
10539 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
10540 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
10541
10542 @kindex info mem
10543 @item info mem
10544 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
10545 for each region:
10546
10547 @table @emph
10548 @item Memory Region Number
10549 @item Enabled or Disabled.
10550 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
10551 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
10552
10553 @item Lo Address
10554 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
10555
10556 @item Hi Address
10557 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
10558
10559 @item Attributes
10560 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
10561 @end table
10562 @end table
10563
10564
10565 @subsection Attributes
10566
10567 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
10568 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
10569 write accesses to a memory region.
10570
10571 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
10572 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
10573 etc.@: from accessing memory.
10574
10575 @table @code
10576 @item ro
10577 Memory is read only.
10578 @item wo
10579 Memory is write only.
10580 @item rw
10581 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
10582 @end table
10583
10584 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
10585 The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
10586 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
10587 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
10588 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
10589
10590 @table @code
10591 @item 8
10592 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
10593 @item 16
10594 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
10595 @item 32
10596 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
10597 @item 64
10598 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
10599 @end table
10600
10601 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
10602 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
10603 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
10604 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
10605 @c
10606 @c @table @code
10607 @c @item hwbreak
10608 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
10609 @c @item swbreak (default)
10610 @c @end table
10611
10612 @subsubsection Data Cache
10613 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
10614 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
10615 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
10616 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
10617 registers.
10618
10619 @table @code
10620 @item cache
10621 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
10622 @item nocache
10623 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
10624 @end table
10625
10626 @subsection Memory Access Checking
10627 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
10628 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
10629 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
10630 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
10631
10632 @table @code
10633 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
10634 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
10635 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
10636 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
10637 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
10638 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
10639 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
10640 The default value is @code{on}.
10641 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
10642 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
10643 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
10644 @end table
10645
10646
10647 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
10648 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
10649 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
10650 @c
10651 @c @table @code
10652 @c @item verify
10653 @c @item noverify (default)
10654 @c @end table
10655
10656 @node Dump/Restore Files
10657 @section Copy Between Memory and a File
10658 @cindex dump/restore files
10659 @cindex append data to a file
10660 @cindex dump data to a file
10661 @cindex restore data from a file
10662
10663 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
10664 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
10665 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
10666 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
10667 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex, or
10668 Tektronix Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only append to binary
10669 files.
10670
10671 @table @code
10672
10673 @kindex dump
10674 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
10675 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
10676 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
10677 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
10678
10679 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
10680 @table @code
10681 @item binary
10682 Raw binary form.
10683 @item ihex
10684 Intel hex format.
10685 @item srec
10686 Motorola S-record format.
10687 @item tekhex
10688 Tektronix Hex format.
10689 @end table
10690
10691 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
10692 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
10693 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
10694 form.
10695
10696 @kindex append
10697 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
10698 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
10699 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
10700 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
10701 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
10702
10703 @kindex restore
10704 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
10705 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
10706 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
10707 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
10708 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
10709
10710 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
10711 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
10712 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
10713 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
10714 from that location.
10715
10716 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
10717 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
10718 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
10719 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
10720
10721 @end table
10722
10723 @node Core File Generation
10724 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
10725 @cindex dump core from inferior
10726
10727 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
10728 image of a running process and its process status (register values
10729 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
10730 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
10731 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
10732 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
10733 the post-mortem debugging mode.
10734
10735 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
10736 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
10737 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
10738
10739 @table @code
10740 @kindex gcore
10741 @kindex generate-core-file
10742 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
10743 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
10744 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
10745 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
10746 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
10747 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
10748
10749 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
10750 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, and S390).
10751 @end table
10752
10753 @node Character Sets
10754 @section Character Sets
10755 @cindex character sets
10756 @cindex charset
10757 @cindex translating between character sets
10758 @cindex host character set
10759 @cindex target character set
10760
10761 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
10762 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
10763 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
10764 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
10765 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
10766 @dfn{target character set}.
10767
10768 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
10769 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
10770 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
10771 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
10772 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
10773 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
10774 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
10775 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
10776 character and string literals in expressions.
10777
10778 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
10779 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
10780 target-charset} command, described below.
10781
10782 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
10783 support:
10784
10785 @table @code
10786 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
10787 @kindex set target-charset
10788 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. To display the
10789 list of supported target character sets, type
10790 @kbd{@w{set target-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
10791
10792 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
10793 @kindex set host-charset
10794 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
10795
10796 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
10797 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
10798 @code{set host-charset} command. On some systems, @value{GDBN} cannot
10799 automatically determine the appropriate host character set. In this
10800 case, @value{GDBN} uses @samp{UTF-8}.
10801
10802 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
10803 set. If you type @kbd{@w{set host-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
10804 @value{GDBN} will list the host character sets it supports.
10805
10806 @item set charset @var{charset}
10807 @kindex set charset
10808 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
10809 above, if you type @kbd{@w{set charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
10810 @value{GDBN} will list the names of the character sets that can be used
10811 for both host and target.
10812
10813 @item show charset
10814 @kindex show charset
10815 Show the names of the current host and target character sets.
10816
10817 @item show host-charset
10818 @kindex show host-charset
10819 Show the name of the current host character set.
10820
10821 @item show target-charset
10822 @kindex show target-charset
10823 Show the name of the current target character set.
10824
10825 @item set target-wide-charset @var{charset}
10826 @kindex set target-wide-charset
10827 Set the current target's wide character set to @var{charset}. This is
10828 the character set used by the target's @code{wchar_t} type. To
10829 display the list of supported wide character sets, type
10830 @kbd{@w{set target-wide-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
10831
10832 @item show target-wide-charset
10833 @kindex show target-wide-charset
10834 Show the name of the current target's wide character set.
10835 @end table
10836
10837 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
10838 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
10839 @file{charset-test.c}:
10840
10841 @smallexample
10842 #include <stdio.h>
10843
10844 char ascii_hello[]
10845 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
10846 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
10847 char ibm1047_hello[]
10848 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
10849 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
10850
10851 main ()
10852 @{
10853 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
10854 @}
10855 @end smallexample
10856
10857 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
10858 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
10859 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
10860
10861 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
10862
10863 @smallexample
10864 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
10865 $ gdb -nw charset-test
10866 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
10867 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
10868 @dots{}
10869 (@value{GDBP})
10870 @end smallexample
10871
10872 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
10873 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
10874 strings:
10875
10876 @smallexample
10877 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
10878 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
10879 (@value{GDBP})
10880 @end smallexample
10881
10882 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
10883 initial character set:
10884 @smallexample
10885 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
10886 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
10887 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
10888 (@value{GDBP})
10889 @end smallexample
10890
10891 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
10892 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
10893 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
10894 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
10895 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
10896
10897 @smallexample
10898 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
10899 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
10900 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
10901 $2 = 72 'H'
10902 (@value{GDBP})
10903 @end smallexample
10904
10905 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
10906 literals you use in expressions:
10907
10908 @smallexample
10909 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
10910 $3 = 43 '+'
10911 (@value{GDBP})
10912 @end smallexample
10913
10914 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
10915 character.
10916
10917 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
10918 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
10919 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
10920
10921 @smallexample
10922 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
10923 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
10924 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
10925 $5 = 200 '\310'
10926 (@value{GDBP})
10927 @end smallexample
10928
10929 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
10930 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
10931
10932 @smallexample
10933 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
10934 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
10935 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
10936 @end smallexample
10937
10938 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
10939 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
10940 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
10941 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
10942 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
10943
10944 @smallexample
10945 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
10946 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
10947 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
10948 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
10949 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
10950 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
10951 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
10952 $7 = 72 '\110'
10953 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
10954 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
10955 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
10956 $9 = 200 'H'
10957 (@value{GDBP})
10958 @end smallexample
10959
10960 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
10961 string literals you use in expressions:
10962
10963 @smallexample
10964 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
10965 $10 = 78 '+'
10966 (@value{GDBP})
10967 @end smallexample
10968
10969 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
10970 character.
10971
10972 @node Caching Target Data
10973 @section Caching Data of Targets
10974 @cindex caching data of targets
10975
10976 @value{GDBN} caches data exchanged between the debugger and a target.
10977 Each cache is associated with the address space of the inferior.
10978 @xref{Inferiors and Programs}, about inferior and address space.
10979 Such caching generally improves performance in remote debugging
10980 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), because it reduces the overhead of the
10981 remote protocol by bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks.
10982 Unfortunately, simply caching everything would lead to incorrect results,
10983 since @value{GDBN} does not necessarily know anything about volatile
10984 values, memory-mapped I/O addresses, etc. Furthermore, in non-stop mode
10985 (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) memory can be changed @emph{while} a gdb command
10986 is executing.
10987 Therefore, by default, @value{GDBN} only caches data
10988 known to be on the stack@footnote{In non-stop mode, it is moderately
10989 rare for a running thread to modify the stack of a stopped thread
10990 in a way that would interfere with a backtrace, and caching of
10991 stack reads provides a significant speed up of remote backtraces.} or
10992 in the code segment.
10993 Other regions of memory can be explicitly marked as
10994 cacheable; @pxref{Memory Region Attributes}.
10995
10996 @table @code
10997 @kindex set remotecache
10998 @item set remotecache on
10999 @itemx set remotecache off
11000 This option no longer does anything; it exists for compatibility
11001 with old scripts.
11002
11003 @kindex show remotecache
11004 @item show remotecache
11005 Show the current state of the obsolete remotecache flag.
11006
11007 @kindex set stack-cache
11008 @item set stack-cache on
11009 @itemx set stack-cache off
11010 Enable or disable caching of stack accesses. When @code{on}, use
11011 caching. By default, this option is @code{on}.
11012
11013 @kindex show stack-cache
11014 @item show stack-cache
11015 Show the current state of data caching for memory accesses.
11016
11017 @kindex set code-cache
11018 @item set code-cache on
11019 @itemx set code-cache off
11020 Enable or disable caching of code segment accesses. When @code{on},
11021 use caching. By default, this option is @code{on}. This improves
11022 performance of disassembly in remote debugging.
11023
11024 @kindex show code-cache
11025 @item show code-cache
11026 Show the current state of target memory cache for code segment
11027 accesses.
11028
11029 @kindex info dcache
11030 @item info dcache @r{[}line@r{]}
11031 Print the information about the performance of data cache of the
11032 current inferior's address space. The information displayed
11033 includes the dcache width and depth, and for each cache line, its
11034 number, address, and how many times it was referenced. This
11035 command is useful for debugging the data cache operation.
11036
11037 If a line number is specified, the contents of that line will be
11038 printed in hex.
11039
11040 @item set dcache size @var{size}
11041 @cindex dcache size
11042 @kindex set dcache size
11043 Set maximum number of entries in dcache (dcache depth above).
11044
11045 @item set dcache line-size @var{line-size}
11046 @cindex dcache line-size
11047 @kindex set dcache line-size
11048 Set number of bytes each dcache entry caches (dcache width above).
11049 Must be a power of 2.
11050
11051 @item show dcache size
11052 @kindex show dcache size
11053 Show maximum number of dcache entries. @xref{Caching Target Data, info dcache}.
11054
11055 @item show dcache line-size
11056 @kindex show dcache line-size
11057 Show default size of dcache lines.
11058
11059 @end table
11060
11061 @node Searching Memory
11062 @section Search Memory
11063 @cindex searching memory
11064
11065 Memory can be searched for a particular sequence of bytes with the
11066 @code{find} command.
11067
11068 @table @code
11069 @kindex find
11070 @item find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, +@var{len}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
11071 @itemx find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, @var{end_addr}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
11072 Search memory for the sequence of bytes specified by @var{val1}, @var{val2},
11073 etc. The search begins at address @var{start_addr} and continues for either
11074 @var{len} bytes or through to @var{end_addr} inclusive.
11075 @end table
11076
11077 @var{s} and @var{n} are optional parameters.
11078 They may be specified in either order, apart or together.
11079
11080 @table @r
11081 @item @var{s}, search query size
11082 The size of each search query value.
11083
11084 @table @code
11085 @item b
11086 bytes
11087 @item h
11088 halfwords (two bytes)
11089 @item w
11090 words (four bytes)
11091 @item g
11092 giant words (eight bytes)
11093 @end table
11094
11095 All values are interpreted in the current language.
11096 This means, for example, that if the current source language is C/C@t{++}
11097 then searching for the string ``hello'' includes the trailing '\0'.
11098
11099 If the value size is not specified, it is taken from the
11100 value's type in the current language.
11101 This is useful when one wants to specify the search
11102 pattern as a mixture of types.
11103 Note that this means, for example, that in the case of C-like languages
11104 a search for an untyped 0x42 will search for @samp{(int) 0x42}
11105 which is typically four bytes.
11106
11107 @item @var{n}, maximum number of finds
11108 The maximum number of matches to print. The default is to print all finds.
11109 @end table
11110
11111 You can use strings as search values. Quote them with double-quotes
11112 (@code{"}).
11113 The string value is copied into the search pattern byte by byte,
11114 regardless of the endianness of the target and the size specification.
11115
11116 The address of each match found is printed as well as a count of the
11117 number of matches found.
11118
11119 The address of the last value found is stored in convenience variable
11120 @samp{$_}.
11121 A count of the number of matches is stored in @samp{$numfound}.
11122
11123 For example, if stopped at the @code{printf} in this function:
11124
11125 @smallexample
11126 void
11127 hello ()
11128 @{
11129 static char hello[] = "hello-hello";
11130 static struct @{ char c; short s; int i; @}
11131 __attribute__ ((packed)) mixed
11132 = @{ 'c', 0x1234, 0x87654321 @};
11133 printf ("%s\n", hello);
11134 @}
11135 @end smallexample
11136
11137 @noindent
11138 you get during debugging:
11139
11140 @smallexample
11141 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), "hello"
11142 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
11143 1 pattern found
11144 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 'e', 'l', 'l', 'o'
11145 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
11146 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
11147 2 patterns found
11148 (gdb) find /b1 &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 0x65, 'l'
11149 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
11150 1 pattern found
11151 (gdb) find &mixed, +sizeof(mixed), (char) 'c', (short) 0x1234, (int) 0x87654321
11152 0x8049560 <mixed.1625>
11153 1 pattern found
11154 (gdb) print $numfound
11155 $1 = 1
11156 (gdb) print $_
11157 $2 = (void *) 0x8049560
11158 @end smallexample
11159
11160 @node Optimized Code
11161 @chapter Debugging Optimized Code
11162 @cindex optimized code, debugging
11163 @cindex debugging optimized code
11164
11165 Almost all compilers support optimization. With optimization
11166 disabled, the compiler generates assembly code that corresponds
11167 directly to your source code, in a simplistic way. As the compiler
11168 applies more powerful optimizations, the generated assembly code
11169 diverges from your original source code. With help from debugging
11170 information generated by the compiler, @value{GDBN} can map from
11171 the running program back to constructs from your original source.
11172
11173 @value{GDBN} is more accurate with optimization disabled. If you
11174 can recompile without optimization, it is easier to follow the
11175 progress of your program during debugging. But, there are many cases
11176 where you may need to debug an optimized version.
11177
11178 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
11179 optimizer has rearranged your code; the debugger shows you what is
11180 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
11181 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
11182 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
11183 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
11184
11185 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
11186 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
11187 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
11188 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
11189 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
11190
11191 @menu
11192 * Inline Functions:: How @value{GDBN} presents inlining
11193 * Tail Call Frames:: @value{GDBN} analysis of jumps to functions
11194 @end menu
11195
11196 @node Inline Functions
11197 @section Inline Functions
11198 @cindex inline functions, debugging
11199
11200 @dfn{Inlining} is an optimization that inserts a copy of the function
11201 body directly at each call site, instead of jumping to a shared
11202 routine. @value{GDBN} displays inlined functions just like
11203 non-inlined functions. They appear in backtraces. You can view their
11204 arguments and local variables, step into them with @code{step}, skip
11205 them with @code{next}, and escape from them with @code{finish}.
11206 You can check whether a function was inlined by using the
11207 @code{info frame} command.
11208
11209 For @value{GDBN} to support inlined functions, the compiler must
11210 record information about inlining in the debug information ---
11211 @value{NGCC} using the @sc{dwarf 2} format does this, and several
11212 other compilers do also. @value{GDBN} only supports inlined functions
11213 when using @sc{dwarf 2}. Versions of @value{NGCC} before 4.1
11214 do not emit two required attributes (@samp{DW_AT_call_file} and
11215 @samp{DW_AT_call_line}); @value{GDBN} does not display inlined
11216 function calls with earlier versions of @value{NGCC}. It instead
11217 displays the arguments and local variables of inlined functions as
11218 local variables in the caller.
11219
11220 The body of an inlined function is directly included at its call site;
11221 unlike a non-inlined function, there are no instructions devoted to
11222 the call. @value{GDBN} still pretends that the call site and the
11223 start of the inlined function are different instructions. Stepping to
11224 the call site shows the call site, and then stepping again shows
11225 the first line of the inlined function, even though no additional
11226 instructions are executed.
11227
11228 This makes source-level debugging much clearer; you can see both the
11229 context of the call and then the effect of the call. Only stepping by
11230 a single instruction using @code{stepi} or @code{nexti} does not do
11231 this; single instruction steps always show the inlined body.
11232
11233 There are some ways that @value{GDBN} does not pretend that inlined
11234 function calls are the same as normal calls:
11235
11236 @itemize @bullet
11237 @item
11238 Setting breakpoints at the call site of an inlined function may not
11239 work, because the call site does not contain any code. @value{GDBN}
11240 may incorrectly move the breakpoint to the next line of the enclosing
11241 function, after the call. This limitation will be removed in a future
11242 version of @value{GDBN}; until then, set a breakpoint on an earlier line
11243 or inside the inlined function instead.
11244
11245 @item
11246 @value{GDBN} cannot locate the return value of inlined calls after
11247 using the @code{finish} command. This is a limitation of compiler-generated
11248 debugging information; after @code{finish}, you can step to the next line
11249 and print a variable where your program stored the return value.
11250
11251 @end itemize
11252
11253 @node Tail Call Frames
11254 @section Tail Call Frames
11255 @cindex tail call frames, debugging
11256
11257 Function @code{B} can call function @code{C} in its very last statement. In
11258 unoptimized compilation the call of @code{C} is immediately followed by return
11259 instruction at the end of @code{B} code. Optimizing compiler may replace the
11260 call and return in function @code{B} into one jump to function @code{C}
11261 instead. Such use of a jump instruction is called @dfn{tail call}.
11262
11263 During execution of function @code{C}, there will be no indication in the
11264 function call stack frames that it was tail-called from @code{B}. If function
11265 @code{A} regularly calls function @code{B} which tail-calls function @code{C},
11266 then @value{GDBN} will see @code{A} as the caller of @code{C}. However, in
11267 some cases @value{GDBN} can determine that @code{C} was tail-called from
11268 @code{B}, and it will then create fictitious call frame for that, with the
11269 return address set up as if @code{B} called @code{C} normally.
11270
11271 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
11272 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_GNU_call_site} tags. With
11273 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
11274 this information.
11275
11276 @kbd{info frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info}) will indicate the tail call frame
11277 kind by text @code{tail call frame} such as in this sample @value{GDBN} output:
11278
11279 @smallexample
11280 (gdb) x/i $pc - 2
11281 0x40066b <b(int, double)+11>: jmp 0x400640 <c(int, double)>
11282 (gdb) info frame
11283 Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30:
11284 rip = 0x40066d in b (amd64-entry-value.cc:59); saved rip 0x4004c5
11285 tail call frame, caller of frame at 0x7fffffffda30
11286 source language c++.
11287 Arglist at unknown address.
11288 Locals at unknown address, Previous frame's sp is 0x7fffffffda30
11289 @end smallexample
11290
11291 The detection of all the possible code path executions can find them ambiguous.
11292 There is no execution history stored (possible @ref{Reverse Execution} is never
11293 used for this purpose) and the last known caller could have reached the known
11294 callee by multiple different jump sequences. In such case @value{GDBN} still
11295 tries to show at least all the unambiguous top tail callers and all the
11296 unambiguous bottom tail calees, if any.
11297
11298 @table @code
11299 @anchor{set debug entry-values}
11300 @item set debug entry-values
11301 @kindex set debug entry-values
11302 When set to on, enables printing of analysis messages for both frame argument
11303 values at function entry and tail calls. It will show all the possible valid
11304 tail calls code paths it has considered. It will also print the intersection
11305 of them with the final unambiguous (possibly partial or even empty) code path
11306 result.
11307
11308 @item show debug entry-values
11309 @kindex show debug entry-values
11310 Show the current state of analysis messages printing for both frame argument
11311 values at function entry and tail calls.
11312 @end table
11313
11314 The analysis messages for tail calls can for example show why the virtual tail
11315 call frame for function @code{c} has not been recognized (due to the indirect
11316 reference by variable @code{x}):
11317
11318 @smallexample
11319 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void);
11320 void (*x) (void) = c;
11321 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
11322 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ a (); @}
11323 int main (void) @{ x (); return 0; @}
11324
11325 Breakpoint 1, DW_OP_GNU_entry_value resolving cannot find
11326 DW_TAG_GNU_call_site 0x40039a in main
11327 a () at t.c:3
11328 3 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
11329 (gdb) bt
11330 #0 a () at t.c:3
11331 #1 0x000000000040039a in main () at t.c:5
11332 @end smallexample
11333
11334 Another possibility is an ambiguous virtual tail call frames resolution:
11335
11336 @smallexample
11337 int i;
11338 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) f (void) @{ i++; @}
11339 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) e (void) @{ f (); @}
11340 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) d (void) @{ f (); @}
11341 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ d (); @}
11342 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (void)
11343 @{ if (i) c (); else e (); @}
11344 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ b (); @}
11345 int main (void) @{ a (); return 0; @}
11346
11347 tailcall: initial: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004ce(b) 0x4004b2(c) 0x4004a2(d)
11348 tailcall: compare: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004cc(b) 0x400492(e)
11349 tailcall: reduced: 0x4004d2(a) |
11350 (gdb) bt
11351 #0 f () at t.c:2
11352 #1 0x00000000004004d2 in a () at t.c:8
11353 #2 0x0000000000400395 in main () at t.c:9
11354 @end smallexample
11355
11356 @set CALLSEQ1A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}c@value{ARROW}d@value{ARROW}f}
11357 @set CALLSEQ2A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}e@value{ARROW}f}
11358
11359 @c Convert CALLSEQ#A to CALLSEQ#B depending on HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK.
11360 @ifset HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
11361 @set ARROW @click{}
11362 @set CALLSEQ1B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ1A}}
11363 @set CALLSEQ2B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ2A}}
11364 @end ifset
11365 @ifclear HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
11366 @set ARROW ->
11367 @set CALLSEQ1B @value{CALLSEQ1A}
11368 @set CALLSEQ2B @value{CALLSEQ2A}
11369 @end ifclear
11370
11371 Frames #0 and #2 are real, #1 is a virtual tail call frame.
11372 The code can have possible execution paths @value{CALLSEQ1B} or
11373 @value{CALLSEQ2B}, @value{GDBN} cannot find which one from the inferior state.
11374
11375 @code{initial:} state shows some random possible calling sequence @value{GDBN}
11376 has found. It then finds another possible calling sequcen - that one is
11377 prefixed by @code{compare:}. The non-ambiguous intersection of these two is
11378 printed as the @code{reduced:} calling sequence. That one could have many
11379 futher @code{compare:} and @code{reduced:} statements as long as there remain
11380 any non-ambiguous sequence entries.
11381
11382 For the frame of function @code{b} in both cases there are different possible
11383 @code{$pc} values (@code{0x4004cc} or @code{0x4004ce}), therefore this frame is
11384 also ambigous. The only non-ambiguous frame is the one for function @code{a},
11385 therefore this one is displayed to the user while the ambiguous frames are
11386 omitted.
11387
11388 There can be also reasons why printing of frame argument values at function
11389 entry may fail:
11390
11391 @smallexample
11392 int v;
11393 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (int i) @{ v++; @}
11394 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i);
11395 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (int i) @{ a (i); @}
11396 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i)
11397 @{ if (i) b (i - 1); else c (0); @}
11398 int main (void) @{ a (5); return 0; @}
11399
11400 (gdb) bt
11401 #0 c (i=i@@entry=0) at t.c:2
11402 #1 0x0000000000400428 in a (DW_OP_GNU_entry_value resolving has found
11403 function "a" at 0x400420 can call itself via tail calls
11404 i=<optimized out>) at t.c:6
11405 #2 0x000000000040036e in main () at t.c:7
11406 @end smallexample
11407
11408 @value{GDBN} cannot find out from the inferior state if and how many times did
11409 function @code{a} call itself (via function @code{b}) as these calls would be
11410 tail calls. Such tail calls would modify thue @code{i} variable, therefore
11411 @value{GDBN} cannot be sure the value it knows would be right - @value{GDBN}
11412 prints @code{<optimized out>} instead.
11413
11414 @node Macros
11415 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
11416
11417 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
11418 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
11419 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
11420 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
11421 where it was defined.
11422
11423 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
11424 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
11425 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
11426 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
11427
11428 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
11429 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
11430 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
11431 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
11432 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
11433 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
11434 see @ref{List}.
11435
11436 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
11437 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
11438 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
11439
11440 @table @code
11441
11442 @kindex macro expand
11443 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
11444 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
11445 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
11446 @item macro expand @var{expression}
11447 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
11448 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
11449 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
11450 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
11451 it can be any string of tokens.
11452
11453 @kindex macro exp1
11454 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
11455 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
11456 @cindex expand macro once
11457 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
11458 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
11459 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
11460 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
11461 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
11462 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
11463 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
11464 can be any string of tokens.
11465
11466 @kindex info macro
11467 @cindex macro definition, showing
11468 @cindex definition of a macro, showing
11469 @cindex macros, from debug info
11470 @item info macro [-a|-all] [--] @var{macro}
11471 Show the current definition or all definitions of the named @var{macro},
11472 and describe the source location or compiler command-line where that
11473 definition was established. The optional double dash is to signify the end of
11474 argument processing and the beginning of @var{macro} for non C-like macros where
11475 the macro may begin with a hyphen.
11476
11477 @kindex info macros
11478 @item info macros @var{linespec}
11479 Show all macro definitions that are in effect at the location specified
11480 by @var{linespec}, and describe the source location or compiler
11481 command-line where those definitions were established.
11482
11483 @kindex macro define
11484 @cindex user-defined macros
11485 @cindex defining macros interactively
11486 @cindex macros, user-defined
11487 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
11488 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
11489 Introduce a definition for a preprocessor macro named @var{macro},
11490 invocations of which are replaced by the tokens given in
11491 @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this command defines an
11492 ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the second form
11493 defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments given in
11494 @var{arglist}.
11495
11496 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every
11497 expression evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the
11498 @code{macro undef} command, described below. The definition overrides
11499 all definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged,
11500 as well as any previous user-supplied definition.
11501
11502 @kindex macro undef
11503 @item macro undef @var{macro}
11504 Remove any user-supplied definition for the macro named @var{macro}.
11505 This command only affects definitions provided with the @code{macro
11506 define} command, described above; it cannot remove definitions present
11507 in the program being debugged.
11508
11509 @kindex macro list
11510 @item macro list
11511 List all the macros defined using the @code{macro define} command.
11512 @end table
11513
11514 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
11515 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
11516 show our source files:
11517
11518 @smallexample
11519 $ cat sample.c
11520 #include <stdio.h>
11521 #include "sample.h"
11522
11523 #define M 42
11524 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
11525
11526 main ()
11527 @{
11528 #define N 28
11529 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
11530 #undef N
11531 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
11532 #define N 1729
11533 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
11534 @}
11535 $ cat sample.h
11536 #define Q <
11537 $
11538 @end smallexample
11539
11540 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
11541 @value{NGCC}. We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2}@footnote{This is the
11542 minimum. Recent versions of @value{NGCC} support @option{-gdwarf-3}
11543 and @option{-gdwarf-4}; we recommend always choosing the most recent
11544 version of DWARF.} @emph{and} @option{-g3} flags to ensure the compiler
11545 includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
11546 information.
11547
11548 @smallexample
11549 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
11550 $
11551 @end smallexample
11552
11553 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
11554
11555 @smallexample
11556 $ gdb -nw sample
11557 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
11558 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
11559 GDB is free software, @dots{}
11560 (@value{GDBP})
11561 @end smallexample
11562
11563 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
11564 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
11565 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
11566
11567 @smallexample
11568 (@value{GDBP}) list main
11569 3
11570 4 #define M 42
11571 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
11572 6
11573 7 main ()
11574 8 @{
11575 9 #define N 28
11576 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
11577 11 #undef N
11578 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
11579 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
11580 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
11581 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
11582 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
11583 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
11584 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
11585 #define Q <
11586 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
11587 expands to: (42 + 1)
11588 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
11589 expands to: once (M + 1)
11590 (@value{GDBP})
11591 @end smallexample
11592
11593 In the example above, note that @code{macro expand-once} expands only
11594 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
11595 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
11596 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
11597
11598 Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
11599 force at the source line of the current stack frame:
11600
11601 @smallexample
11602 (@value{GDBP}) break main
11603 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
11604 (@value{GDBP}) run
11605 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
11606
11607 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
11608 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
11609 (@value{GDBP})
11610 @end smallexample
11611
11612 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
11613
11614 @smallexample
11615 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
11616 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
11617 #define N 28
11618 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
11619 expands to: 28 < 42
11620 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
11621 $1 = 1
11622 (@value{GDBP})
11623 @end smallexample
11624
11625 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
11626 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
11627 thereof) in force at each point:
11628
11629 @smallexample
11630 (@value{GDBP}) next
11631 Hello, world!
11632 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
11633 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
11634 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
11635 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
11636 (@value{GDBP}) next
11637 We're so creative.
11638 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
11639 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
11640 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
11641 #define N 1729
11642 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
11643 expands to: 1729 < 42
11644 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
11645 $2 = 0
11646 (@value{GDBP})
11647 @end smallexample
11648
11649 In addition to source files, macros can be defined on the compilation command
11650 line using the @option{-D@var{name}=@var{value}} syntax. For macros defined in
11651 such a way, @value{GDBN} displays the location of their definition as line zero
11652 of the source file submitted to the compiler.
11653
11654 @smallexample
11655 (@value{GDBP}) info macro __STDC__
11656 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:0
11657 -D__STDC__=1
11658 (@value{GDBP})
11659 @end smallexample
11660
11661
11662 @node Tracepoints
11663 @chapter Tracepoints
11664 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
11665 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
11666
11667 @cindex tracepoints
11668 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
11669 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
11670 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
11671 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
11672 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
11673 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
11674 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
11675
11676 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
11677 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
11678 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
11679 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
11680 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
11681 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
11682 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
11683 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
11684 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
11685 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
11686 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
11687
11688 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
11689 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
11690 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
11691 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
11692 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
11693 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
11694 Packets}.
11695
11696 It is also possible to get trace data from a file, in a manner reminiscent
11697 of corefiles; you specify the filename, and use @code{tfind} to search
11698 through the file. @xref{Trace Files}, for more details.
11699
11700 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
11701
11702 @menu
11703 * Set Tracepoints::
11704 * Analyze Collected Data::
11705 * Tracepoint Variables::
11706 * Trace Files::
11707 @end menu
11708
11709 @node Set Tracepoints
11710 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
11711
11712 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
11713 tracepoints can be set. A tracepoint is actually a special type of
11714 breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), so you can manipulate it using
11715 standard breakpoint commands. For instance, as with breakpoints,
11716 tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from one, and many
11717 of the commands associated with tracepoints take the tracepoint number
11718 as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to work on.
11719
11720 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
11721 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
11722 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
11723 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
11724 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
11725 tracepoint was hit.
11726
11727 Tracepoints do not support every breakpoint feature. Ignore counts on
11728 tracepoints have no effect, and tracepoints cannot run @value{GDBN}
11729 commands when they are hit. Tracepoints may not be thread-specific
11730 either.
11731
11732 @cindex fast tracepoints
11733 Some targets may support @dfn{fast tracepoints}, which are inserted in
11734 a different way (such as with a jump instead of a trap), that is
11735 faster but possibly restricted in where they may be installed.
11736
11737 @cindex static tracepoints
11738 @cindex markers, static tracepoints
11739 @cindex probing markers, static tracepoints
11740 Regular and fast tracepoints are dynamic tracing facilities, meaning
11741 that they can be used to insert tracepoints at (almost) any location
11742 in the target. Some targets may also support controlling @dfn{static
11743 tracepoints} from @value{GDBN}. With static tracing, a set of
11744 instrumentation points, also known as @dfn{markers}, are embedded in
11745 the target program, and can be activated or deactivated by name or
11746 address. These are usually placed at locations which facilitate
11747 investigating what the target is actually doing. @value{GDBN}'s
11748 support for static tracing includes being able to list instrumentation
11749 points, and attach them with @value{GDBN} defined high level
11750 tracepoints that expose the whole range of convenience of
11751 @value{GDBN}'s tracepoints support. Namely, support for collecting
11752 registers values and values of global or local (to the instrumentation
11753 point) variables; tracepoint conditions and trace state variables.
11754 The act of installing a @value{GDBN} static tracepoint on an
11755 instrumentation point, or marker, is referred to as @dfn{probing} a
11756 static tracepoint marker.
11757
11758 @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints on some target systems.
11759 @xref{Server,,Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}}.
11760
11761 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
11762 conditions and actions.
11763
11764 @menu
11765 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
11766 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
11767 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
11768 * Tracepoint Conditions::
11769 * Trace State Variables::
11770 * Tracepoint Actions::
11771 * Listing Tracepoints::
11772 * Listing Static Tracepoint Markers::
11773 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
11774 * Tracepoint Restrictions::
11775 @end menu
11776
11777 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
11778 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
11779
11780 @table @code
11781 @cindex set tracepoint
11782 @kindex trace
11783 @item trace @var{location}
11784 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
11785 Its argument @var{location} can be a source line, a function name, or
11786 an address in the target program. @xref{Specify Location}. The
11787 @code{trace} command defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the
11788 target program where the debugger will briefly stop, collect some
11789 data, and then allow the program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or
11790 changing its actions takes effect immediately if the remote stub
11791 supports the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature (@pxref{install tracepoint
11792 in tracing}).
11793 If remote stub doesn't support the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature, all
11794 these changes don't take effect until the next @code{tstart}
11795 command, and once a trace experiment is running, further changes will
11796 not have any effect until the next trace experiment starts. In addition,
11797 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{pending tracepoints}---tracepoints whose
11798 address is not yet resolved. (This is similar to pending breakpoints.)
11799 Pending tracepoints are not downloaded to the target and not installed
11800 until they are resolved. The resolution of pending tracepoints requires
11801 @value{GDBN} support---when debugging with the remote target, and
11802 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the remote stub (@pxref{disconnected
11803 tracing}), pending tracepoints can not be resolved (and downloaded to
11804 the remote stub) while @value{GDBN} is disconnected.
11805
11806 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
11807
11808 @smallexample
11809 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
11810
11811 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
11812
11813 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
11814
11815 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
11816
11817 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
11818 @end smallexample
11819
11820 @noindent
11821 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
11822
11823 @item trace @var{location} if @var{cond}
11824 Set a tracepoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
11825 @var{cond} each time the tracepoint is reached, and collect data only
11826 if the value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
11827 @xref{Tracepoint Conditions, ,Tracepoint Conditions}, for more
11828 information on tracepoint conditions.
11829
11830 @item ftrace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
11831 @cindex set fast tracepoint
11832 @cindex fast tracepoints, setting
11833 @kindex ftrace
11834 The @code{ftrace} command sets a fast tracepoint. For targets that
11835 support them, fast tracepoints will use a more efficient but possibly
11836 less general technique to trigger data collection, such as a jump
11837 instruction instead of a trap, or some sort of hardware support. It
11838 may not be possible to create a fast tracepoint at the desired
11839 location, in which case the command will exit with an explanatory
11840 message.
11841
11842 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{ftrace} exactly as for
11843 @code{trace}.
11844
11845 On 32-bit x86-architecture systems, fast tracepoints normally need to
11846 be placed at an instruction that is 5 bytes or longer, but can be
11847 placed at 4-byte instructions if the low 64K of memory of the target
11848 program is available to install trampolines. Some Unix-type systems,
11849 such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, exclude low addresses from the program's
11850 address space; but for instance with the Linux kernel it is possible
11851 to let @value{GDBN} use this area by doing a @command{sysctl} command
11852 to set the @code{mmap_min_addr} kernel parameter, as in
11853
11854 @example
11855 sudo sysctl -w vm.mmap_min_addr=32768
11856 @end example
11857
11858 @noindent
11859 which sets the low address to 32K, which leaves plenty of room for
11860 trampolines. The minimum address should be set to a page boundary.
11861
11862 @item strace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
11863 @cindex set static tracepoint
11864 @cindex static tracepoints, setting
11865 @cindex probe static tracepoint marker
11866 @kindex strace
11867 The @code{strace} command sets a static tracepoint. For targets that
11868 support it, setting a static tracepoint probes a static
11869 instrumentation point, or marker, found at @var{location}. It may not
11870 be possible to set a static tracepoint at the desired location, in
11871 which case the command will exit with an explanatory message.
11872
11873 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{strace} exactly as for
11874 @code{trace}, with the addition that the user can also specify
11875 @code{-m @var{marker}} as @var{location}. This probes the marker
11876 identified by the @var{marker} string identifier. This identifier
11877 depends on the static tracepoint backend library your program is
11878 using. You can find all the marker identifiers in the @samp{ID} field
11879 of the @code{info static-tracepoint-markers} command output.
11880 @xref{Listing Static Tracepoint Markers,,Listing Static Tracepoint
11881 Markers}. For example, in the following small program using the UST
11882 tracing engine:
11883
11884 @smallexample
11885 main ()
11886 @{
11887 trace_mark(ust, bar33, "str %s", "FOOBAZ");
11888 @}
11889 @end smallexample
11890
11891 @noindent
11892 the marker id is composed of joining the first two arguments to the
11893 @code{trace_mark} call with a slash, which translates to:
11894
11895 @smallexample
11896 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
11897 Cnt Enb ID Address What
11898 1 n ust/bar33 0x0000000000400ddc in main at stexample.c:22
11899 Data: "str %s"
11900 [etc...]
11901 @end smallexample
11902
11903 @noindent
11904 so you may probe the marker above with:
11905
11906 @smallexample
11907 (@value{GDBP}) strace -m ust/bar33
11908 @end smallexample
11909
11910 Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action --- @code{collect
11911 $_sdata}. This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point
11912 call to the tracing library. In the UST example above, you'll see
11913 that the third argument to @code{trace_mark} is a printf-like format
11914 string. The user data is then the result of running that formating
11915 string against the following arguments. Note that @code{info
11916 static-tracepoint-markers} command output lists that format string in
11917 the @samp{Data:} field.
11918
11919 You can inspect this data when analyzing the trace buffer, by printing
11920 the $_sdata variable like any other variable available to
11921 @value{GDBN}. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}.
11922
11923 @vindex $tpnum
11924 @cindex last tracepoint number
11925 @cindex recent tracepoint number
11926 @cindex tracepoint number
11927 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
11928 of the most recently set tracepoint.
11929
11930 @kindex delete tracepoint
11931 @cindex tracepoint deletion
11932 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
11933 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
11934 default is to delete all tracepoints. Note that the regular
11935 @code{delete} command can remove tracepoints also.
11936
11937 Examples:
11938
11939 @smallexample
11940 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
11941
11942 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
11943 @end smallexample
11944
11945 @noindent
11946 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
11947 @end table
11948
11949 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
11950 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
11951
11952 These commands are deprecated; they are equivalent to plain @code{disable} and @code{enable}.
11953
11954 @table @code
11955 @kindex disable tracepoint
11956 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
11957 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
11958 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
11959 a trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
11960 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
11961 If the command is issued during a trace experiment and the debug target
11962 has support for disabling tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the
11963 change will be effective immediately. Otherwise, it will be applied to the
11964 next trace experiment.
11965
11966 @kindex enable tracepoint
11967 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
11968 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. If this command is
11969 issued during a trace experiment and the debug target supports enabling
11970 tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the enabled tracepoints will
11971 become effective immediately. Otherwise, they will become effective the
11972 next time a trace experiment is run.
11973 @end table
11974
11975 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
11976 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
11977
11978 @table @code
11979 @kindex passcount
11980 @cindex tracepoint pass count
11981 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
11982 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
11983 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
11984 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
11985 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
11986 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
11987 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
11988 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
11989 user.
11990
11991 Examples:
11992
11993 @smallexample
11994 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
11995 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
11996
11997 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
11998 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
11999 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
12000 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
12001 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
12002 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
12003 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
12004 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
12005 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
12006 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
12007 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
12008 @end smallexample
12009 @end table
12010
12011 @node Tracepoint Conditions
12012 @subsection Tracepoint Conditions
12013 @cindex conditional tracepoints
12014 @cindex tracepoint conditions
12015
12016 The simplest sort of tracepoint collects data every time your program
12017 reaches a specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for
12018 a tracepoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
12019 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A
12020 tracepoint with a condition evaluates the expression each time your
12021 program reaches it, and data collection happens only if the condition
12022 is true.
12023
12024 Tracepoint conditions can be specified when a tracepoint is set, by
12025 using @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{trace} command.
12026 @xref{Create and Delete Tracepoints, ,Setting Tracepoints}. They can
12027 also be set or changed at any time with the @code{condition} command,
12028 just as with breakpoints.
12029
12030 Unlike breakpoint conditions, @value{GDBN} does not actually evaluate
12031 the conditional expression itself. Instead, @value{GDBN} encodes the
12032 expression into an agent expression (@pxref{Agent Expressions})
12033 suitable for execution on the target, independently of @value{GDBN}.
12034 Global variables become raw memory locations, locals become stack
12035 accesses, and so forth.
12036
12037 For instance, suppose you have a function that is usually called
12038 frequently, but should not be called after an error has occurred. You
12039 could use the following tracepoint command to collect data about calls
12040 of that function that happen while the error code is propagating
12041 through the program; an unconditional tracepoint could end up
12042 collecting thousands of useless trace frames that you would have to
12043 search through.
12044
12045 @smallexample
12046 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{trace normal_operation if errcode > 0}
12047 @end smallexample
12048
12049 @node Trace State Variables
12050 @subsection Trace State Variables
12051 @cindex trace state variables
12052
12053 A @dfn{trace state variable} is a special type of variable that is
12054 created and managed by target-side code. The syntax is the same as
12055 that for GDB's convenience variables (a string prefixed with ``$''),
12056 but they are stored on the target. They must be created explicitly,
12057 using a @code{tvariable} command. They are always 64-bit signed
12058 integers.
12059
12060 Trace state variables are remembered by @value{GDBN}, and downloaded
12061 to the target along with tracepoint information when the trace
12062 experiment starts. There are no intrinsic limits on the number of
12063 trace state variables, beyond memory limitations of the target.
12064
12065 @cindex convenience variables, and trace state variables
12066 Although trace state variables are managed by the target, you can use
12067 them in print commands and expressions as if they were convenience
12068 variables; @value{GDBN} will get the current value from the target
12069 while the trace experiment is running. Trace state variables share
12070 the same namespace as other ``$'' variables, which means that you
12071 cannot have trace state variables with names like @code{$23} or
12072 @code{$pc}, nor can you have a trace state variable and a convenience
12073 variable with the same name.
12074
12075 @table @code
12076
12077 @item tvariable $@var{name} [ = @var{expression} ]
12078 @kindex tvariable
12079 The @code{tvariable} command creates a new trace state variable named
12080 @code{$@var{name}}, and optionally gives it an initial value of
12081 @var{expression}. The @var{expression} is evaluated when this command is
12082 entered; the result will be converted to an integer if possible,
12083 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error. A subsequent
12084 @code{tvariable} command specifying the same name does not create a
12085 variable, but instead assigns the supplied initial value to the
12086 existing variable of that name, overwriting any previous initial
12087 value. The default initial value is 0.
12088
12089 @item info tvariables
12090 @kindex info tvariables
12091 List all the trace state variables along with their initial values.
12092 Their current values may also be displayed, if the trace experiment is
12093 currently running.
12094
12095 @item delete tvariable @r{[} $@var{name} @dots{} @r{]}
12096 @kindex delete tvariable
12097 Delete the given trace state variables, or all of them if no arguments
12098 are specified.
12099
12100 @end table
12101
12102 @node Tracepoint Actions
12103 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
12104
12105 @table @code
12106 @kindex actions
12107 @cindex tracepoint actions
12108 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12109 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
12110 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
12111 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
12112 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
12113 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
12114 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
12115 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
12116 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect}, @code{teval}, and
12117 @code{while-stepping}.
12118
12119 @code{actions} is actually equivalent to @code{commands} (@pxref{Break
12120 Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}), except that only the defined
12121 actions are allowed; any other @value{GDBN} command is rejected.
12122
12123 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
12124 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
12125 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
12126
12127 @smallexample
12128 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
12129
12130 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
12131
12132 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
12133 @end smallexample
12134
12135 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
12136 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
12137 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
12138 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
12139 followed by the list of things to be collected after each step in a
12140 sequence of single steps. The @code{while-stepping} command is
12141 terminated by its own separate @code{end} command. Lastly, the action
12142 list is terminated by an @code{end} command.
12143
12144 @smallexample
12145 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
12146 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
12147 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
12148 > collect bar,baz
12149 > collect $regs
12150 > while-stepping 12
12151 > collect $pc, arr[i]
12152 > end
12153 end
12154 @end smallexample
12155
12156 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
12157 @item collect@r{[}/@var{mods}@r{]} @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
12158 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
12159 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
12160 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
12161 special arguments are supported:
12162
12163 @table @code
12164 @item $regs
12165 Collect all registers.
12166
12167 @item $args
12168 Collect all function arguments.
12169
12170 @item $locals
12171 Collect all local variables.
12172
12173 @item $_ret
12174 Collect the return address. This is helpful if you want to see more
12175 of a backtrace.
12176
12177 @item $_probe_argc
12178 Collects the number of arguments from the static probe at which the
12179 tracepoint is located.
12180 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
12181
12182 @item $_probe_arg@var{n}
12183 @var{n} is an integer between 0 and 11. Collects the @var{n}th argument
12184 from the static probe at which the tracepoint is located.
12185 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
12186
12187 @item $_sdata
12188 @vindex $_sdata@r{, collect}
12189 Collect static tracepoint marker specific data. Only available for
12190 static tracepoints. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action
12191 Lists}. On the UST static tracepoints library backend, an
12192 instrumentation point resembles a @code{printf} function call. The
12193 tracing library is able to collect user specified data formatted to a
12194 character string using the format provided by the programmer that
12195 instrumented the program. Other backends have similar mechanisms.
12196 Here's an example of a UST marker call:
12197
12198 @smallexample
12199 const char master_name[] = "$your_name";
12200 trace_mark(channel1, marker1, "hello %s", master_name)
12201 @end smallexample
12202
12203 In this case, collecting @code{$_sdata} collects the string
12204 @samp{hello $yourname}. When analyzing the trace buffer, you can
12205 inspect @samp{$_sdata} like any other variable available to
12206 @value{GDBN}.
12207 @end table
12208
12209 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
12210 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
12211 arguments separated by commas; the effect is the same.
12212
12213 The optional @var{mods} changes the usual handling of the arguments.
12214 @code{s} requests that pointers to chars be handled as strings, in
12215 particular collecting the contents of the memory being pointed at, up
12216 to the first zero. The upper bound is by default the value of the
12217 @code{print elements} variable; if @code{s} is followed by a decimal
12218 number, that is the upper bound instead. So for instance
12219 @samp{collect/s25 mystr} collects as many as 25 characters at
12220 @samp{mystr}.
12221
12222 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
12223 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
12224
12225 @kindex teval @r{(tracepoints)}
12226 @item teval @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
12227 Evaluate the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit. This
12228 command accepts a comma-separated list of expressions. The results
12229 are discarded, so this is mainly useful for assigning values to trace
12230 state variables (@pxref{Trace State Variables}) without adding those
12231 values to the trace buffer, as would be the case if the @code{collect}
12232 action were used.
12233
12234 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
12235 @item while-stepping @var{n}
12236 Perform @var{n} single-step instruction traces after the tracepoint,
12237 collecting new data after each step. The @code{while-stepping}
12238 command is followed by the list of what to collect while stepping
12239 (followed by its own @code{end} command):
12240
12241 @smallexample
12242 > while-stepping 12
12243 > collect $regs, myglobal
12244 > end
12245 >
12246 @end smallexample
12247
12248 @noindent
12249 Note that @code{$pc} is not automatically collected by
12250 @code{while-stepping}; you need to explicitly collect that register if
12251 you need it. You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
12252 @code{stepping}.
12253
12254 @item set default-collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
12255 @kindex set default-collect
12256 @cindex default collection action
12257 This variable is a list of expressions to collect at each tracepoint
12258 hit. It is effectively an additional @code{collect} action prepended
12259 to every tracepoint action list. The expressions are parsed
12260 individually for each tracepoint, so for instance a variable named
12261 @code{xyz} may be interpreted as a global for one tracepoint, and a
12262 local for another, as appropriate to the tracepoint's location.
12263
12264 @item show default-collect
12265 @kindex show default-collect
12266 Show the list of expressions that are collected by default at each
12267 tracepoint hit.
12268
12269 @end table
12270
12271 @node Listing Tracepoints
12272 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
12273
12274 @table @code
12275 @kindex info tracepoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
12276 @kindex info tp @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
12277 @cindex information about tracepoints
12278 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@dots{}@r{]}
12279 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't
12280 specify a tracepoint number, displays information about all the
12281 tracepoints defined so far. The format is similar to that used for
12282 @code{info breakpoints}; in fact, @code{info tracepoints} is the same
12283 command, simply restricting itself to tracepoints.
12284
12285 A tracepoint's listing may include additional information specific to
12286 tracing:
12287
12288 @itemize @bullet
12289 @item
12290 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
12291
12292 @item
12293 the state about installed on target of each location
12294 @end itemize
12295
12296 @smallexample
12297 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
12298 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
12299 1 tracepoint keep y 0x0804ab57 in foo() at main.cxx:7
12300 while-stepping 20
12301 collect globfoo, $regs
12302 end
12303 collect globfoo2
12304 end
12305 pass count 1200
12306 2 tracepoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
12307 collect $eip
12308 2.1 y 0x0804859c in func4 at change-loc.h:35
12309 installed on target
12310 2.2 y 0xb7ffc480 in func4 at change-loc.h:35
12311 installed on target
12312 2.3 y <PENDING> set_tracepoint
12313 3 tracepoint keep y 0x080485b1 in foo at change-loc.c:29
12314 not installed on target
12315 (@value{GDBP})
12316 @end smallexample
12317
12318 @noindent
12319 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
12320 @end table
12321
12322 @node Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
12323 @subsection Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
12324
12325 @table @code
12326 @kindex info static-tracepoint-markers
12327 @cindex information about static tracepoint markers
12328 @item info static-tracepoint-markers
12329 Display information about all static tracepoint markers defined in the
12330 program.
12331
12332 For each marker, the following columns are printed:
12333
12334 @table @emph
12335 @item Count
12336 An incrementing counter, output to help readability. This is not a
12337 stable identifier.
12338 @item ID
12339 The marker ID, as reported by the target.
12340 @item Enabled or Disabled
12341 Probed markers are tagged with @samp{y}. @samp{n} identifies marks
12342 that are not enabled.
12343 @item Address
12344 Where the marker is in your program, as a memory address.
12345 @item What
12346 Where the marker is in the source for your program, as a file and line
12347 number. If the debug information included in the program does not
12348 allow @value{GDBN} to locate the source of the marker, this column
12349 will be left blank.
12350 @end table
12351
12352 @noindent
12353 In addition, the following information may be printed for each marker:
12354
12355 @table @emph
12356 @item Data
12357 User data passed to the tracing library by the marker call. In the
12358 UST backend, this is the format string passed as argument to the
12359 marker call.
12360 @item Static tracepoints probing the marker
12361 The list of static tracepoints attached to the marker.
12362 @end table
12363
12364 @smallexample
12365 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
12366 Cnt ID Enb Address What
12367 1 ust/bar2 y 0x0000000000400e1a in main at stexample.c:25
12368 Data: number1 %d number2 %d
12369 Probed by static tracepoints: #2
12370 2 ust/bar33 n 0x0000000000400c87 in main at stexample.c:24
12371 Data: str %s
12372 (@value{GDBP})
12373 @end smallexample
12374 @end table
12375
12376 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
12377 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
12378
12379 @table @code
12380 @kindex tstart [ @var{notes} ]
12381 @cindex start a new trace experiment
12382 @cindex collected data discarded
12383 @item tstart
12384 This command starts the trace experiment, and begins collecting data.
12385 It has the side effect of discarding all the data collected in the
12386 trace buffer during the previous trace experiment. If any arguments
12387 are supplied, they are taken as a note and stored with the trace
12388 experiment's state. The notes may be arbitrary text, and are
12389 especially useful with disconnected tracing in a multi-user context;
12390 the notes can explain what the trace is doing, supply user contact
12391 information, and so forth.
12392
12393 @kindex tstop [ @var{notes} ]
12394 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
12395 @item tstop
12396 This command stops the trace experiment. If any arguments are
12397 supplied, they are recorded with the experiment as a note. This is
12398 useful if you are stopping a trace started by someone else, for
12399 instance if the trace is interfering with the system's behavior and
12400 needs to be stopped quickly.
12401
12402 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
12403 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
12404 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
12405
12406 @kindex tstatus
12407 @cindex status of trace data collection
12408 @cindex trace experiment, status of
12409 @item tstatus
12410 This command displays the status of the current trace data
12411 collection.
12412 @end table
12413
12414 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
12415
12416 @smallexample
12417 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
12418 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
12419 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
12420 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
12421 > while-stepping 11
12422 > collect $regs
12423 > end
12424 > end
12425 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
12426 [time passes @dots{}]
12427 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
12428 @end smallexample
12429
12430 @anchor{disconnected tracing}
12431 @cindex disconnected tracing
12432 You can choose to continue running the trace experiment even if
12433 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target, voluntarily or
12434 involuntarily. For commands such as @code{detach}, the debugger will
12435 ask what you want to do with the trace. But for unexpected
12436 terminations (@value{GDBN} crash, network outage), it would be
12437 unfortunate to lose hard-won trace data, so the variable
12438 @code{disconnected-tracing} lets you decide whether the trace should
12439 continue running without @value{GDBN}.
12440
12441 @table @code
12442 @item set disconnected-tracing on
12443 @itemx set disconnected-tracing off
12444 @kindex set disconnected-tracing
12445 Choose whether a tracing run should continue to run if @value{GDBN}
12446 has disconnected from the target. Note that @code{detach} or
12447 @code{quit} will ask you directly what to do about a running trace no
12448 matter what this variable's setting, so the variable is mainly useful
12449 for handling unexpected situations, such as loss of the network.
12450
12451 @item show disconnected-tracing
12452 @kindex show disconnected-tracing
12453 Show the current choice for disconnected tracing.
12454
12455 @end table
12456
12457 When you reconnect to the target, the trace experiment may or may not
12458 still be running; it might have filled the trace buffer in the
12459 meantime, or stopped for one of the other reasons. If it is running,
12460 it will continue after reconnection.
12461
12462 Upon reconnection, the target will upload information about the
12463 tracepoints in effect. @value{GDBN} will then compare that
12464 information to the set of tracepoints currently defined, and attempt
12465 to match them up, allowing for the possibility that the numbers may
12466 have changed due to creation and deletion in the meantime. If one of
12467 the target's tracepoints does not match any in @value{GDBN}, the
12468 debugger will create a new tracepoint, so that you have a number with
12469 which to specify that tracepoint. This matching-up process is
12470 necessarily heuristic, and it may result in useless tracepoints being
12471 created; you may simply delete them if they are of no use.
12472
12473 @cindex circular trace buffer
12474 If your target agent supports a @dfn{circular trace buffer}, then you
12475 can run a trace experiment indefinitely without filling the trace
12476 buffer; when space runs out, the agent deletes already-collected trace
12477 frames, oldest first, until there is enough room to continue
12478 collecting. This is especially useful if your tracepoints are being
12479 hit too often, and your trace gets terminated prematurely because the
12480 buffer is full. To ask for a circular trace buffer, simply set
12481 @samp{circular-trace-buffer} to on. You can set this at any time,
12482 including during tracing; if the agent can do it, it will change
12483 buffer handling on the fly, otherwise it will not take effect until
12484 the next run.
12485
12486 @table @code
12487 @item set circular-trace-buffer on
12488 @itemx set circular-trace-buffer off
12489 @kindex set circular-trace-buffer
12490 Choose whether a tracing run should use a linear or circular buffer
12491 for trace data. A linear buffer will not lose any trace data, but may
12492 fill up prematurely, while a circular buffer will discard old trace
12493 data, but it will have always room for the latest tracepoint hits.
12494
12495 @item show circular-trace-buffer
12496 @kindex show circular-trace-buffer
12497 Show the current choice for the trace buffer. Note that this may not
12498 match the agent's current buffer handling, nor is it guaranteed to
12499 match the setting that might have been in effect during a past run,
12500 for instance if you are looking at frames from a trace file.
12501
12502 @end table
12503
12504 @table @code
12505 @item set trace-buffer-size @var{n}
12506 @itemx set trace-buffer-size unlimited
12507 @kindex set trace-buffer-size
12508 Request that the target use a trace buffer of @var{n} bytes. Not all
12509 targets will honor the request; they may have a compiled-in size for
12510 the trace buffer, or some other limitation. Set to a value of
12511 @code{unlimited} or @code{-1} to let the target use whatever size it
12512 likes. This is also the default.
12513
12514 @item show trace-buffer-size
12515 @kindex show trace-buffer-size
12516 Show the current requested size for the trace buffer. Note that this
12517 will only match the actual size if the target supports size-setting,
12518 and was able to handle the requested size. For instance, if the
12519 target can only change buffer size between runs, this variable will
12520 not reflect the change until the next run starts. Use @code{tstatus}
12521 to get a report of the actual buffer size.
12522 @end table
12523
12524 @table @code
12525 @item set trace-user @var{text}
12526 @kindex set trace-user
12527
12528 @item show trace-user
12529 @kindex show trace-user
12530
12531 @item set trace-notes @var{text}
12532 @kindex set trace-notes
12533 Set the trace run's notes.
12534
12535 @item show trace-notes
12536 @kindex show trace-notes
12537 Show the trace run's notes.
12538
12539 @item set trace-stop-notes @var{text}
12540 @kindex set trace-stop-notes
12541 Set the trace run's stop notes. The handling of the note is as for
12542 @code{tstop} arguments; the set command is convenient way to fix a
12543 stop note that is mistaken or incomplete.
12544
12545 @item show trace-stop-notes
12546 @kindex show trace-stop-notes
12547 Show the trace run's stop notes.
12548
12549 @end table
12550
12551 @node Tracepoint Restrictions
12552 @subsection Tracepoint Restrictions
12553
12554 @cindex tracepoint restrictions
12555 There are a number of restrictions on the use of tracepoints. As
12556 described above, tracepoint data gathering occurs on the target
12557 without interaction from @value{GDBN}. Thus the full capabilities of
12558 the debugger are not available during data gathering, and then at data
12559 examination time, you will be limited by only having what was
12560 collected. The following items describe some common problems, but it
12561 is not exhaustive, and you may run into additional difficulties not
12562 mentioned here.
12563
12564 @itemize @bullet
12565
12566 @item
12567 Tracepoint expressions are intended to gather objects (lvalues). Thus
12568 the full flexibility of GDB's expression evaluator is not available.
12569 You cannot call functions, cast objects to aggregate types, access
12570 convenience variables or modify values (except by assignment to trace
12571 state variables). Some language features may implicitly call
12572 functions (for instance Objective-C fields with accessors), and therefore
12573 cannot be collected either.
12574
12575 @item
12576 Collection of local variables, either individually or in bulk with
12577 @code{$locals} or @code{$args}, during @code{while-stepping} may
12578 behave erratically. The stepping action may enter a new scope (for
12579 instance by stepping into a function), or the location of the variable
12580 may change (for instance it is loaded into a register). The
12581 tracepoint data recorded uses the location information for the
12582 variables that is correct for the tracepoint location. When the
12583 tracepoint is created, it is not possible, in general, to determine
12584 where the steps of a @code{while-stepping} sequence will advance the
12585 program---particularly if a conditional branch is stepped.
12586
12587 @item
12588 Collection of an incompletely-initialized or partially-destroyed object
12589 may result in something that @value{GDBN} cannot display, or displays
12590 in a misleading way.
12591
12592 @item
12593 When @value{GDBN} displays a pointer to character it automatically
12594 dereferences the pointer to also display characters of the string
12595 being pointed to. However, collecting the pointer during tracing does
12596 not automatically collect the string. You need to explicitly
12597 dereference the pointer and provide size information if you want to
12598 collect not only the pointer, but the memory pointed to. For example,
12599 @code{*ptr@@50} can be used to collect the 50 element array pointed to
12600 by @code{ptr}.
12601
12602 @item
12603 It is not possible to collect a complete stack backtrace at a
12604 tracepoint. Instead, you may collect the registers and a few hundred
12605 bytes from the stack pointer with something like @code{*(unsigned char *)$esp@@300}
12606 (adjust to use the name of the actual stack pointer register on your
12607 target architecture, and the amount of stack you wish to capture).
12608 Then the @code{backtrace} command will show a partial backtrace when
12609 using a trace frame. The number of stack frames that can be examined
12610 depends on the sizes of the frames in the collected stack. Note that
12611 if you ask for a block so large that it goes past the bottom of the
12612 stack, the target agent may report an error trying to read from an
12613 invalid address.
12614
12615 @item
12616 If you do not collect registers at a tracepoint, @value{GDBN} can
12617 infer that the value of @code{$pc} must be the same as the address of
12618 the tracepoint and use that when you are looking at a trace frame
12619 for that tracepoint. However, this cannot work if the tracepoint has
12620 multiple locations (for instance if it was set in a function that was
12621 inlined), or if it has a @code{while-stepping} loop. In those cases
12622 @value{GDBN} will warn you that it can't infer @code{$pc}, and default
12623 it to zero.
12624
12625 @end itemize
12626
12627 @node Analyze Collected Data
12628 @section Using the Collected Data
12629
12630 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
12631 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
12632 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
12633 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
12634 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
12635 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
12636 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
12637 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
12638 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
12639 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
12640 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
12641 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
12642 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
12643 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
12644 the buffer will fail.
12645
12646 @menu
12647 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
12648 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
12649 * save tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
12650 @end menu
12651
12652 @node tfind
12653 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
12654
12655 @kindex tfind
12656 @cindex select trace snapshot
12657 @cindex find trace snapshot
12658 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
12659 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
12660 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
12661 snapshot is selected.
12662
12663 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
12664
12665 @table @code
12666 @item tfind start
12667 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
12668 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
12669
12670 @item tfind none
12671 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
12672
12673 @item tfind end
12674 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
12675
12676 @item tfind
12677 No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
12678
12679 @item tfind -
12680 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
12681 retracing earlier steps.
12682
12683 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
12684 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
12685 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
12686 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
12687 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
12688
12689 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
12690 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
12691 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
12692 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
12693 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
12694
12695 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
12696 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
12697 addresses (exclusive).
12698
12699 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
12700 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
12701 @var{addr2} (inclusive).
12702
12703 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
12704 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
12705 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
12706 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
12707 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
12708 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
12709 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
12710 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
12711 @end table
12712
12713 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
12714 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
12715 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
12716 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
12717 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
12718 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
12719 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
12720 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
12721 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
12722 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
12723 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
12724 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
12725 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
12726 tracepoint as the current one.
12727
12728 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
12729 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
12730 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
12731 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
12732 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
12733
12734 @smallexample
12735 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
12736 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
12737 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
12738 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
12739 > tfind
12740 > end
12741
12742 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
12743 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
12744 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
12745 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
12746 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
12747 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
12748 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
12749 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
12750 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
12751 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
12752 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
12753 @end smallexample
12754
12755 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
12756 the buffer:
12757
12758 @smallexample
12759 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
12760 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
12761 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
12762 > tfind line
12763 > end
12764
12765 Frame 0, X = 1
12766 Frame 7, X = 2
12767 Frame 13, X = 255
12768 @end smallexample
12769
12770 @node tdump
12771 @subsection @code{tdump}
12772 @kindex tdump
12773 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
12774 @cindex tracepoint data, display
12775
12776 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
12777 the current trace snapshot.
12778
12779 @smallexample
12780 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
12781 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
12782 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
12783 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
12784 > end
12785
12786 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
12787
12788 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
12789 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
12790 at gdb_test.c:444
12791 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
12792
12793 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
12794 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
12795 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
12796 d1 0x18 24
12797 d2 0x80 128
12798 d3 0x33 51
12799 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
12800 d5 0x22 34
12801 d6 0xe0 224
12802 d7 0x380035 3670069
12803 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
12804 a1 0x3000668 50333288
12805 a2 0x100 256
12806 a3 0x322000 3284992
12807 a4 0x3000698 50333336
12808 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
12809 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
12810 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
12811 ps 0x0 0
12812 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
12813 fpcontrol 0x0 0
12814 fpstatus 0x0 0
12815 fpiaddr 0x0 0
12816 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
12817 p1 = (void *) 0x11
12818 p2 = (void *) 0x22
12819 p3 = (void *) 0x33
12820 p4 = (void *) 0x44
12821 p5 = (void *) 0x55
12822 p6 = (void *) 0x66
12823 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
12824
12825 (@value{GDBP})
12826 @end smallexample
12827
12828 @code{tdump} works by scanning the tracepoint's current collection
12829 actions and printing the value of each expression listed. So
12830 @code{tdump} can fail, if after a run, you change the tracepoint's
12831 actions to mention variables that were not collected during the run.
12832
12833 Also, for tracepoints with @code{while-stepping} loops, @code{tdump}
12834 uses the collected value of @code{$pc} to distinguish between trace
12835 frames that were collected at the tracepoint hit, and frames that were
12836 collected while stepping. This allows it to correctly choose whether
12837 to display the basic list of collections, or the collections from the
12838 body of the while-stepping loop. However, if @code{$pc} was not collected,
12839 then @code{tdump} will always attempt to dump using the basic collection
12840 list, and may fail if a while-stepping frame does not include all the
12841 same data that is collected at the tracepoint hit.
12842 @c This is getting pretty arcane, example would be good.
12843
12844 @node save tracepoints
12845 @subsection @code{save tracepoints @var{filename}}
12846 @kindex save tracepoints
12847 @kindex save-tracepoints
12848 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
12849
12850 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
12851 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
12852 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
12853 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
12854 Files}). The @w{@code{save-tracepoints}} command is a deprecated
12855 alias for @w{@code{save tracepoints}}
12856
12857 @node Tracepoint Variables
12858 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
12859 @cindex tracepoint variables
12860 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
12861
12862 @table @code
12863 @vindex $trace_frame
12864 @item (int) $trace_frame
12865 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
12866 snapshot is selected.
12867
12868 @vindex $tracepoint
12869 @item (int) $tracepoint
12870 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
12871
12872 @vindex $trace_line
12873 @item (int) $trace_line
12874 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
12875
12876 @vindex $trace_file
12877 @item (char []) $trace_file
12878 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
12879
12880 @vindex $trace_func
12881 @item (char []) $trace_func
12882 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
12883 @end table
12884
12885 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
12886 use @code{output} instead.
12887
12888 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
12889 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
12890 data. Note that these are not the same as trace state variables,
12891 which are managed by the target.
12892
12893 @smallexample
12894 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
12895
12896 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
12897 > output $trace_file
12898 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
12899 > tfind
12900 > end
12901 @end smallexample
12902
12903 @node Trace Files
12904 @section Using Trace Files
12905 @cindex trace files
12906
12907 In some situations, the target running a trace experiment may no
12908 longer be available; perhaps it crashed, or the hardware was needed
12909 for a different activity. To handle these cases, you can arrange to
12910 dump the trace data into a file, and later use that file as a source
12911 of trace data, via the @code{target tfile} command.
12912
12913 @table @code
12914
12915 @kindex tsave
12916 @item tsave [ -r ] @var{filename}
12917 @itemx tsave [-ctf] @var{dirname}
12918 Save the trace data to @var{filename}. By default, this command
12919 assumes that @var{filename} refers to the host filesystem, so if
12920 necessary @value{GDBN} will copy raw trace data up from the target and
12921 then save it. If the target supports it, you can also supply the
12922 optional argument @code{-r} (``remote'') to direct the target to save
12923 the data directly into @var{filename} in its own filesystem, which may be
12924 more efficient if the trace buffer is very large. (Note, however, that
12925 @code{target tfile} can only read from files accessible to the host.)
12926 By default, this command will save trace frame in tfile format.
12927 You can supply the optional argument @code{-ctf} to save date in CTF
12928 format. The @dfn{Common Trace Format} (CTF) is proposed as a trace format
12929 that can be shared by multiple debugging and tracing tools. Please go to
12930 @indicateurl{http://www.efficios.com/ctf} to get more information.
12931
12932 @kindex target tfile
12933 @kindex tfile
12934 @kindex target ctf
12935 @kindex ctf
12936 @item target tfile @var{filename}
12937 @itemx target ctf @var{dirname}
12938 Use the file named @var{filename} or directory named @var{dirname} as
12939 a source of trace data. Commands that examine data work as they do with
12940 a live target, but it is not possible to run any new trace experiments.
12941 @code{tstatus} will report the state of the trace run at the moment
12942 the data was saved, as well as the current trace frame you are examining.
12943 Both @var{filename} and @var{dirname} must be on a filesystem accessible to
12944 the host.
12945
12946 @smallexample
12947 (@value{GDBP}) target ctf ctf.ctf
12948 (@value{GDBP}) tfind
12949 Found trace frame 0, tracepoint 2
12950 39 ++a; /* set tracepoint 1 here */
12951 (@value{GDBP}) tdump
12952 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 0:
12953 i = 0
12954 a = 0
12955 b = 1 '\001'
12956 c = @{"123", "456", "789", "123", "456", "789"@}
12957 d = @{@{@{a = 1, b = 2@}, @{a = 3, b = 4@}@}, @{@{a = 5, b = 6@}, @{a = 7, b = 8@}@}@}
12958 (@value{GDBP}) p b
12959 $1 = 1
12960 @end smallexample
12961
12962 @end table
12963
12964 @node Overlays
12965 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
12966 @cindex overlays
12967
12968 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
12969 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
12970 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
12971 use overlays.
12972
12973 @menu
12974 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
12975 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
12976 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
12977 mapped by asking the inferior.
12978 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
12979 @end menu
12980
12981 @node How Overlays Work
12982 @section How Overlays Work
12983 @cindex mapped overlays
12984 @cindex unmapped overlays
12985 @cindex load address, overlay's
12986 @cindex mapped address
12987 @cindex overlay area
12988
12989 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
12990 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
12991 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
12992 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
12993 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
12994
12995 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
12996 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
12997 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
12998 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
12999 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
13000 largest overlay as well.
13001
13002 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
13003 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
13004 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
13005 there.
13006
13007 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
13008 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
13009 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
13010
13011 @smallexample
13012 @group
13013 Data Instruction Larger
13014 Address Space Address Space Address Space
13015 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
13016 | | | | | |
13017 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
13018 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
13019 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
13020 | and heap | | | | | |
13021 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
13022 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
13023 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
13024 | | | | | |
13025 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
13026 address | | | | | |
13027 | overlay | <-' | | |
13028 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
13029 | | <---. | | load address
13030 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
13031 | | | |
13032 +-----------+ | |
13033 +-----------+
13034 | |
13035 +-----------+
13036
13037 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
13038 @end group
13039 @end smallexample
13040
13041 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
13042 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
13043 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
13044 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
13045 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
13046 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
13047 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
13048 program and the overlay area.
13049
13050 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
13051 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
13052 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
13053 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
13054 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
13055 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
13056 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
13057
13058 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
13059 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
13060 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
13061
13062 @itemize @bullet
13063
13064 @item
13065 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
13066 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
13067 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
13068 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
13069
13070 @item
13071 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
13072 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
13073 your program's performance.
13074
13075 @item
13076 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
13077 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
13078 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
13079 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
13080 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
13081 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
13082 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
13083
13084 @item
13085 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
13086 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
13087 instruction and data spaces.
13088
13089 @end itemize
13090
13091 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
13092 improved in many ways:
13093
13094 @itemize @bullet
13095
13096 @item
13097 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
13098 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
13099 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
13100 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
13101 area in the usual way.
13102
13103 @item
13104 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
13105 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
13106
13107 @item
13108 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
13109 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
13110 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
13111 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
13112 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
13113 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
13114 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
13115
13116 @end itemize
13117
13118
13119 @node Overlay Commands
13120 @section Overlay Commands
13121
13122 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
13123 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
13124 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
13125 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
13126 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
13127 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
13128
13129 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
13130 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
13131
13132 @table @code
13133 @item overlay off
13134 @kindex overlay
13135 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
13136 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
13137 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
13138 overlay support is disabled.
13139
13140 @item overlay manual
13141 @cindex manual overlay debugging
13142 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
13143 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
13144 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
13145 commands described below.
13146
13147 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
13148 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
13149 @cindex map an overlay
13150 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
13151 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
13152 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
13153 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
13154 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
13155 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
13156
13157 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
13158 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
13159 @cindex unmap an overlay
13160 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
13161 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
13162 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
13163 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
13164
13165 @item overlay auto
13166 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
13167 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
13168 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
13169 Overlay Debugging}.
13170
13171 @item overlay load-target
13172 @itemx overlay load
13173 @cindex reloading the overlay table
13174 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
13175 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
13176 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
13177 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
13178 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
13179
13180 @item overlay list-overlays
13181 @itemx overlay list
13182 @cindex listing mapped overlays
13183 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
13184 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
13185
13186 @end table
13187
13188 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
13189 of the function the address falls in:
13190
13191 @smallexample
13192 (@value{GDBP}) print main
13193 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
13194 @end smallexample
13195 @noindent
13196 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
13197 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
13198 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
13199 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
13200
13201 @smallexample
13202 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
13203 No sections are mapped.
13204 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
13205 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
13206 @end smallexample
13207 @noindent
13208 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
13209 name normally:
13210
13211 @smallexample
13212 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
13213 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
13214 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
13215 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
13216 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
13217 @end smallexample
13218
13219 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
13220 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
13221 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
13222 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
13223 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
13224
13225 @itemize @bullet
13226 @item
13227 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
13228 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
13229 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
13230 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
13231 @item
13232 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
13233 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
13234 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
13235 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
13236 breakpoints properly.
13237 @end itemize
13238
13239
13240 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
13241 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
13242 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
13243
13244 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
13245 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
13246 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
13247 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
13248 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
13249 current state of the overlays.
13250
13251 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
13252 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
13253
13254 @table @asis
13255
13256 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
13257 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
13258
13259 @smallexample
13260 struct
13261 @{
13262 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
13263 unsigned long vma;
13264
13265 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
13266 unsigned long size;
13267
13268 /* The overlay's load address. */
13269 unsigned long lma;
13270
13271 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
13272 zero otherwise. */
13273 unsigned long mapped;
13274 @}
13275 @end smallexample
13276
13277 @item @code{_novlys}:
13278 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
13279 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
13280
13281 @end table
13282
13283 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
13284 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
13285 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
13286 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
13287 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
13288 currently mapped.
13289
13290 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
13291 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
13292 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
13293 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
13294 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
13295 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
13296 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
13297 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
13298 are not being executed.
13299
13300 @node Overlay Sample Program
13301 @section Overlay Sample Program
13302 @cindex overlay example program
13303
13304 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
13305 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
13306 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
13307 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
13308 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
13309 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
13310 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
13311
13312 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
13313 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
13314 suite. The program consists of the following files from
13315 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
13316
13317 @table @file
13318 @item overlays.c
13319 The main program file.
13320 @item ovlymgr.c
13321 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
13322 @item foo.c
13323 @itemx bar.c
13324 @itemx baz.c
13325 @itemx grbx.c
13326 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
13327 @item d10v.ld
13328 @itemx m32r.ld
13329 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
13330 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
13331 @end table
13332
13333 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
13334 cross-compiler like this:
13335
13336 @smallexample
13337 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
13338 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
13339 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
13340 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
13341 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
13342 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
13343 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
13344 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
13345 @end smallexample
13346
13347 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
13348 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
13349 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
13350
13351
13352 @node Languages
13353 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
13354 @cindex languages
13355
13356 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
13357 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
13358 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
13359 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
13360 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
13361 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
13362
13363 @cindex working language
13364 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
13365 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
13366 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
13367 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
13368 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
13369 language}.
13370
13371 @menu
13372 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
13373 * Show:: Displaying the language
13374 * Checks:: Type and range checks
13375 * Supported Languages:: Supported languages
13376 * Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
13377 @end menu
13378
13379 @node Setting
13380 @section Switching Between Source Languages
13381
13382 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
13383 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
13384 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
13385 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
13386 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
13387 are printed, etc.
13388
13389 In addition to the working language, every source file that
13390 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
13391 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
13392 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
13393 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
13394 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
13395 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
13396 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
13397 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
13398 Displaying the Language}.
13399
13400 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
13401 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
13402 another language. In that case, make the
13403 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
13404 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
13405 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
13406
13407 @menu
13408 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
13409 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
13410 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
13411 @end menu
13412
13413 @node Filenames
13414 @subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
13415
13416 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
13417 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
13418
13419 @table @file
13420 @item .ada
13421 @itemx .ads
13422 @itemx .adb
13423 @itemx .a
13424 Ada source file.
13425
13426 @item .c
13427 C source file
13428
13429 @item .C
13430 @itemx .cc
13431 @itemx .cp
13432 @itemx .cpp
13433 @itemx .cxx
13434 @itemx .c++
13435 C@t{++} source file
13436
13437 @item .d
13438 D source file
13439
13440 @item .m
13441 Objective-C source file
13442
13443 @item .f
13444 @itemx .F
13445 Fortran source file
13446
13447 @item .mod
13448 Modula-2 source file
13449
13450 @item .s
13451 @itemx .S
13452 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
13453 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
13454 @end table
13455
13456 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
13457 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
13458
13459 @node Manually
13460 @subsection Setting the Working Language
13461
13462 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
13463 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
13464 your program.
13465
13466 @kindex set language
13467 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
13468 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
13469 a language, such as
13470 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
13471 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
13472
13473 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
13474 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
13475 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
13476 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
13477 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
13478 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
13479 command such as:
13480
13481 @smallexample
13482 print a = b + c
13483 @end smallexample
13484
13485 @noindent
13486 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
13487 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
13488 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
13489 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
13490
13491 @node Automatically
13492 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
13493
13494 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
13495 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
13496 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
13497 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
13498 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
13499 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
13500 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
13501 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
13502 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
13503
13504 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
13505 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
13506 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
13507 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
13508 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
13509
13510 @node Show
13511 @section Displaying the Language
13512
13513 The following commands help you find out which language is the
13514 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
13515
13516 @table @code
13517 @item show language
13518 @anchor{show language}
13519 @kindex show language
13520 Display the current working language. This is the
13521 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
13522 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
13523
13524 @item info frame
13525 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
13526 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
13527 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
13528 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
13529 information listed here.
13530
13531 @item info source
13532 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
13533 Display the source language of this source file.
13534 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
13535 information listed here.
13536 @end table
13537
13538 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
13539 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
13540 with a language explicitly:
13541
13542 @table @code
13543 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
13544 @kindex set extension-language
13545 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
13546 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
13547
13548 @item info extensions
13549 @kindex info extensions
13550 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
13551 @end table
13552
13553 @node Checks
13554 @section Type and Range Checking
13555
13556 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
13557 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
13558 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators and making
13559 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
13560 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
13561 by eliminating type mismatches and providing active checks for range
13562 errors when your program is running.
13563
13564 By default @value{GDBN} checks for these errors according to the
13565 rules of the current source language. Although @value{GDBN} does not check
13566 the statements in your program, it can check expressions entered directly
13567 into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example.
13568
13569 @menu
13570 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
13571 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
13572 @end menu
13573
13574 @cindex type checking
13575 @cindex checks, type
13576 @node Type Checking
13577 @subsection An Overview of Type Checking
13578
13579 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, are strongly typed, meaning that the
13580 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
13581 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
13582 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
13583
13584 @smallexample
13585 int klass::my_method(char *b) @{ return b ? 1 : 2; @}
13586
13587 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0)
13588 $1 = 2
13589 @exdent but
13590 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0x1234)
13591 Cannot resolve method klass::my_method to any overloaded instance
13592 @end smallexample
13593
13594 The second example fails because in C@t{++} the integer constant
13595 @samp{0x1234} is not type-compatible with the pointer parameter type.
13596
13597 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
13598 @value{GDBN} to not enforce strict type checking or
13599 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
13600 When type checking is disabled, @value{GDBN} successfully evaluates
13601 expressions like the second example above.
13602
13603 Even if type checking is off, there may be other reasons
13604 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
13605 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
13606 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
13607 with the language in use and usually arise from expressions which make
13608 little sense to evaluate anyway.
13609
13610 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling type checking:
13611
13612 @kindex set check type
13613 @kindex show check type
13614 @table @code
13615 @item set check type on
13616 @itemx set check type off
13617 Set strict type checking on or off. If any type mismatches occur in
13618 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
13619 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
13620
13621 @item show check type
13622 Show the current setting of type checking and whether @value{GDBN}
13623 is enforcing strict type checking rules.
13624 @end table
13625
13626 @cindex range checking
13627 @cindex checks, range
13628 @node Range Checking
13629 @subsection An Overview of Range Checking
13630
13631 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
13632 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
13633 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
13634 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
13635 not exceed the bounds of the array.
13636
13637 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
13638 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
13639 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
13640 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
13641
13642 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
13643 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
13644 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
13645 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
13646 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
13647 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
13648
13649 @smallexample
13650 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
13651 @end smallexample
13652
13653 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
13654 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
13655 Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
13656
13657 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
13658
13659 @kindex set check range
13660 @kindex show check range
13661 @table @code
13662 @item set check range auto
13663 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
13664 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
13665 each language.
13666
13667 @item set check range on
13668 @itemx set check range off
13669 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
13670 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
13671 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
13672 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
13673
13674 @item set check range warn
13675 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
13676 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
13677 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
13678 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
13679 systems).
13680
13681 @item show range
13682 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
13683 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
13684 @end table
13685
13686 @node Supported Languages
13687 @section Supported Languages
13688
13689 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, D, Go, Objective-C, Fortran, Java,
13690 OpenCL C, Pascal, assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
13691 @c This is false ...
13692 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
13693 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
13694 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
13695 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
13696 language.
13697
13698 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
13699 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
13700 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
13701 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
13702 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
13703 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
13704 language reference or tutorial.
13705
13706 @menu
13707 * C:: C and C@t{++}
13708 * D:: D
13709 * Go:: Go
13710 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
13711 * OpenCL C:: OpenCL C
13712 * Fortran:: Fortran
13713 * Pascal:: Pascal
13714 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
13715 * Ada:: Ada
13716 @end menu
13717
13718 @node C
13719 @subsection C and C@t{++}
13720
13721 @cindex C and C@t{++}
13722 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
13723
13724 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
13725 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
13726 together.
13727
13728 @cindex C@t{++}
13729 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
13730 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
13731 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
13732 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
13733 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
13734 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
13735 compiler (@code{aCC}).
13736
13737 @menu
13738 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
13739 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
13740 * C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
13741 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
13742 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
13743 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
13744 * Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
13745 * Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format
13746 @end menu
13747
13748 @node C Operators
13749 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
13750
13751 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
13752
13753 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
13754 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
13755 often defined on groups of types.
13756
13757 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
13758
13759 @itemize @bullet
13760
13761 @item
13762 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
13763 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
13764
13765 @item
13766 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
13767 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
13768
13769 @item
13770 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
13771
13772 @item
13773 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
13774
13775 @end itemize
13776
13777 @noindent
13778 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
13779 in order of increasing precedence:
13780
13781 @table @code
13782 @item ,
13783 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
13784 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
13785 expression being the last expression evaluated.
13786
13787 @item =
13788 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
13789 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
13790
13791 @item @var{op}=
13792 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
13793 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
13794 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence. The operator
13795 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
13796 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
13797
13798 @item ?:
13799 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
13800 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. The argument @var{a}
13801 should be of an integral type.
13802
13803 @item ||
13804 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
13805
13806 @item &&
13807 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
13808
13809 @item |
13810 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
13811
13812 @item ^
13813 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
13814
13815 @item &
13816 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
13817
13818 @item ==@r{, }!=
13819 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
13820 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
13821
13822 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
13823 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
13824 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
13825 and non-zero for true.
13826
13827 @item <<@r{, }>>
13828 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
13829
13830 @item @@
13831 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
13832
13833 @item +@r{, }-
13834 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
13835 pointer types.
13836
13837 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
13838 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
13839 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
13840 integral types.
13841
13842 @item ++@r{, }--
13843 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
13844 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
13845 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
13846 operation takes place.
13847
13848 @item *
13849 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
13850 @code{++}.
13851
13852 @item &
13853 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
13854
13855 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
13856 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
13857 to examine the address
13858 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
13859 stored.
13860
13861 @item -
13862 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
13863 precedence as @code{++}.
13864
13865 @item !
13866 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
13867 @code{++}.
13868
13869 @item ~
13870 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
13871 @code{++}.
13872
13873
13874 @item .@r{, }->
13875 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
13876 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
13877 pointer based on the stored type information.
13878 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
13879
13880 @item .*@r{, }->*
13881 Dereferences of pointers to members.
13882
13883 @item []
13884 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
13885 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
13886
13887 @item ()
13888 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
13889
13890 @item ::
13891 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
13892 and @code{class} types.
13893
13894 @item ::
13895 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
13896 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
13897 above.
13898 @end table
13899
13900 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
13901 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
13902 predefined meaning.
13903
13904 @node C Constants
13905 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
13906
13907 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
13908
13909 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
13910 following ways:
13911
13912 @itemize @bullet
13913 @item
13914 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
13915 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
13916 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
13917 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
13918 @code{long} value.
13919
13920 @item
13921 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
13922 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
13923 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
13924 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
13925 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
13926 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
13927 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
13928 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
13929 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
13930 constant.
13931
13932 @item
13933 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
13934 integral equivalents.
13935
13936 @item
13937 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
13938 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
13939 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
13940 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
13941 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
13942 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
13943 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
13944 @samp{\n} for newline.
13945
13946 Wide character constants can be written by prefixing a character
13947 constant with @samp{L}, as in C. For example, @samp{L'x'} is the wide
13948 form of @samp{x}. The target wide character set is used when
13949 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
13950
13951 @item
13952 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
13953 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
13954 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
13955 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
13956 characters.
13957
13958 Wide string constants can be written by prefixing a string constant
13959 with @samp{L}, as in C. The target wide character set is used when
13960 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
13961
13962 @item
13963 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
13964 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
13965
13966 @item
13967 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
13968 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
13969 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
13970 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
13971 @end itemize
13972
13973 @node C Plus Plus Expressions
13974 @subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
13975
13976 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
13977 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
13978
13979 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
13980 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
13981 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
13982 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
13983 @quotation
13984 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use
13985 the proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently,
13986 @value{GDBN} works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled
13987 with the most recent version of @value{NGCC} possible. The DWARF
13988 debugging format is preferred; @value{NGCC} defaults to this on most
13989 popular platforms. Other compilers and/or debug formats are likely to
13990 work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug C@t{++}
13991 code. @xref{Compilation}.
13992 @end quotation
13993
13994 @enumerate
13995
13996 @cindex member functions
13997 @item
13998 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
13999
14000 @smallexample
14001 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
14002 @end smallexample
14003
14004 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
14005 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
14006 @item
14007 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
14008 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
14009 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
14010 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}. @code{using}
14011 declarations in the current scope are also respected by @value{GDBN}.
14012
14013 @cindex call overloaded functions
14014 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
14015 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
14016 @item
14017 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
14018 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
14019 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
14020 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
14021 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
14022 default arguments.
14023
14024 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
14025 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
14026 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
14027 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
14028 number of function arguments.
14029
14030 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
14031 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
14032 ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
14033
14034 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
14035 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
14036 @smallexample
14037 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
14038 @end smallexample
14039
14040 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
14041 see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
14042
14043 @cindex reference declarations
14044 @item
14045 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
14046 them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
14047 dereferenced.
14048
14049 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
14050 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
14051 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
14052 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
14053 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
14054
14055 @item
14056 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
14057 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
14058 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
14059 necessary, for example in an expression like
14060 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
14061 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
14062 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
14063
14064 @item
14065 @value{GDBN} performs argument-dependent lookup, following the C@t{++}
14066 specification.
14067 @end enumerate
14068
14069 @node C Defaults
14070 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
14071
14072 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
14073
14074 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set range checking automatically, it
14075 defaults to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
14076 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
14077 selects the working language.
14078
14079 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
14080 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
14081 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
14082 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
14083 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
14084 for further details.
14085
14086 @node C Checks
14087 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
14088
14089 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
14090
14091 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, strict type
14092 checking is used. However, if you turn type checking off, @value{GDBN}
14093 will allow certain non-standard conversions, such as promoting integer
14094 constants to pointers.
14095
14096 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
14097 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
14098 that is not itself an array.
14099
14100 @node Debugging C
14101 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
14102
14103 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
14104 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
14105 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
14106 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
14107
14108 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
14109 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
14110 ,Expressions}.
14111
14112 @node Debugging C Plus Plus
14113 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
14114
14115 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
14116
14117 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
14118 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
14119
14120 @table @code
14121 @cindex break in overloaded functions
14122 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
14123 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
14124 @value{GDBN} has the capability to display a menu of possible breakpoint
14125 locations to help you specify which function definition you want.
14126 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}.
14127
14128 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
14129 @item rbreak @var{regex}
14130 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
14131 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
14132 classes.
14133 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
14134
14135 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
14136 @item catch throw
14137 @itemx catch rethrow
14138 @itemx catch catch
14139 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
14140 Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
14141
14142 @cindex inheritance
14143 @item ptype @var{typename}
14144 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
14145 @var{typename}.
14146 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
14147
14148 @item info vtbl @var{expression}.
14149 The @code{info vtbl} command can be used to display the virtual
14150 method tables of the object computed by @var{expression}. This shows
14151 one entry per virtual table; there may be multiple virtual tables when
14152 multiple inheritance is in use.
14153
14154 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
14155 @item set print demangle
14156 @itemx show print demangle
14157 @itemx set print asm-demangle
14158 @itemx show print asm-demangle
14159 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
14160 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
14161 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14162
14163 @item set print object
14164 @itemx show print object
14165 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
14166 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14167
14168 @item set print vtbl
14169 @itemx show print vtbl
14170 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
14171 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14172 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
14173 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
14174
14175 @kindex set overload-resolution
14176 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
14177 @item set overload-resolution on
14178 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
14179 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
14180 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
14181 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
14182 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
14183 If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
14184
14185 @item set overload-resolution off
14186 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
14187 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
14188 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
14189 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
14190 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
14191 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
14192 argument types.
14193
14194 @kindex show overload-resolution
14195 @item show overload-resolution
14196 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
14197
14198 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
14199 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
14200 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
14201 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
14202 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
14203 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
14204 @xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
14205 @end table
14206
14207 @node Decimal Floating Point
14208 @subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format
14209 @cindex decimal floating point format
14210
14211 @value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in
14212 decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the
14213 @code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as
14214 specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic.
14215
14216 There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary
14217 Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for
14218 PowerPC and S/390. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the
14219 configured target.
14220
14221 Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN}
14222 to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert
14223 (using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float.
14224
14225 In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating
14226 point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores
14227 underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions.
14228
14229 In the PowerPC architecture, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers
14230 to inspect @code{_Decimal128} values stored in floating point registers.
14231 See @ref{PowerPC,,PowerPC} for more details.
14232
14233 @node D
14234 @subsection D
14235
14236 @cindex D
14237 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in D and compiled with
14238 GDC, LDC or DMD compilers. Currently @value{GDBN} supports only one D
14239 specific feature --- dynamic arrays.
14240
14241 @node Go
14242 @subsection Go
14243
14244 @cindex Go (programming language)
14245 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Go and compiled with
14246 @file{gccgo} or @file{6g} compilers.
14247
14248 Here is a summary of the Go-specific features and restrictions:
14249
14250 @table @code
14251 @cindex current Go package
14252 @item The current Go package
14253 The name of the current package does not need to be specified when
14254 specifying global variables and functions.
14255
14256 For example, given the program:
14257
14258 @example
14259 package main
14260 var myglob = "Shall we?"
14261 func main () @{
14262 // ...
14263 @}
14264 @end example
14265
14266 When stopped inside @code{main} either of these work:
14267
14268 @example
14269 (gdb) p myglob
14270 (gdb) p main.myglob
14271 @end example
14272
14273 @cindex builtin Go types
14274 @item Builtin Go types
14275 The @code{string} type is recognized by @value{GDBN} and is printed
14276 as a string.
14277
14278 @cindex builtin Go functions
14279 @item Builtin Go functions
14280 The @value{GDBN} expression parser recognizes the @code{unsafe.Sizeof}
14281 function and handles it internally.
14282
14283 @cindex restrictions on Go expressions
14284 @item Restrictions on Go expressions
14285 All Go operators are supported except @code{&^}.
14286 The Go @code{_} ``blank identifier'' is not supported.
14287 Automatic dereferencing of pointers is not supported.
14288 @end table
14289
14290 @node Objective-C
14291 @subsection Objective-C
14292
14293 @cindex Objective-C
14294 This section provides information about some commands and command
14295 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
14296 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
14297 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
14298
14299 @menu
14300 * Method Names in Commands::
14301 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
14302 @end menu
14303
14304 @node Method Names in Commands
14305 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
14306
14307 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
14308 names as line specifications:
14309
14310 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
14311 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
14312 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
14313 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
14314 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
14315 @itemize
14316 @item @code{clear}
14317 @item @code{break}
14318 @item @code{info line}
14319 @item @code{jump}
14320 @item @code{list}
14321 @end itemize
14322
14323 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
14324
14325 @smallexample
14326 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
14327 @end smallexample
14328
14329 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
14330 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
14331 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
14332 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
14333 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
14334 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
14335 debugged, enter:
14336
14337 @smallexample
14338 break -[Fruit create]
14339 @end smallexample
14340
14341 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
14342 enter:
14343
14344 @smallexample
14345 list +[NSText initialize]
14346 @end smallexample
14347
14348 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
14349 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
14350 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
14351 is also possible to specify just a method name:
14352
14353 @smallexample
14354 break create
14355 @end smallexample
14356
14357 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
14358 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
14359 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
14360 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
14361 none apply.
14362
14363 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
14364 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
14365
14366 @smallexample
14367 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
14368 @end smallexample
14369
14370 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
14371 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
14372 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
14373 @kindex print-object
14374 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
14375
14376 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
14377
14378 @smallexample
14379 print -[@var{object} hash]
14380 @end smallexample
14381
14382 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
14383 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
14384 @noindent
14385 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
14386 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
14387 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
14388 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
14389 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
14390 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
14391
14392 @node OpenCL C
14393 @subsection OpenCL C
14394
14395 @cindex OpenCL C
14396 This section provides information about @value{GDBN}s OpenCL C support.
14397
14398 @menu
14399 * OpenCL C Datatypes::
14400 * OpenCL C Expressions::
14401 * OpenCL C Operators::
14402 @end menu
14403
14404 @node OpenCL C Datatypes
14405 @subsubsection OpenCL C Datatypes
14406
14407 @cindex OpenCL C Datatypes
14408 @value{GDBN} supports the builtin scalar and vector datatypes specified
14409 by OpenCL 1.1. In addition the half- and double-precision floating point
14410 data types of the @code{cl_khr_fp16} and @code{cl_khr_fp64} OpenCL
14411 extensions are also known to @value{GDBN}.
14412
14413 @node OpenCL C Expressions
14414 @subsubsection OpenCL C Expressions
14415
14416 @cindex OpenCL C Expressions
14417 @value{GDBN} supports accesses to vector components including the access as
14418 lvalue where possible. Since OpenCL C is based on C99 most C expressions
14419 supported by @value{GDBN} can be used as well.
14420
14421 @node OpenCL C Operators
14422 @subsubsection OpenCL C Operators
14423
14424 @cindex OpenCL C Operators
14425 @value{GDBN} supports the operators specified by OpenCL 1.1 for scalar and
14426 vector data types.
14427
14428 @node Fortran
14429 @subsection Fortran
14430 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
14431
14432 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
14433 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
14434
14435 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
14436 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
14437 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
14438 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
14439 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
14440 underscore.
14441
14442 @menu
14443 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
14444 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
14445 * Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
14446 @end menu
14447
14448 @node Fortran Operators
14449 @subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
14450
14451 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
14452
14453 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
14454 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
14455 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
14456
14457 @table @code
14458 @item **
14459 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
14460 of the second one.
14461
14462 @item :
14463 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
14464 represent a section of array.
14465
14466 @item %
14467 The access component operator. Normally used to access elements in derived
14468 types. Also suitable for unions. As unions aren't part of regular Fortran,
14469 this can only happen when accessing a register that uses a gdbarch-defined
14470 union type.
14471 @end table
14472
14473 @node Fortran Defaults
14474 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
14475
14476 @cindex Fortran Defaults
14477
14478 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
14479 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
14480 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
14481 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
14482
14483 @node Special Fortran Commands
14484 @subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
14485
14486 @cindex Special Fortran commands
14487
14488 @value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
14489 such as displaying common blocks.
14490
14491 @table @code
14492 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
14493 @kindex info common
14494 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
14495 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
14496 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
14497 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
14498 printed.
14499 @end table
14500
14501 @node Pascal
14502 @subsection Pascal
14503
14504 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
14505 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
14506 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
14507 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
14508 syntax.
14509
14510 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
14511 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
14512 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
14513
14514 @node Modula-2
14515 @subsection Modula-2
14516
14517 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
14518
14519 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
14520 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
14521 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
14522 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
14523 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
14524 table.
14525
14526 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
14527 @menu
14528 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
14529 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
14530 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
14531 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
14532 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
14533 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
14534 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
14535 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
14536 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
14537 @end menu
14538
14539 @node M2 Operators
14540 @subsubsection Operators
14541 @cindex Modula-2 operators
14542
14543 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
14544 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
14545 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
14546 following definitions hold:
14547
14548 @itemize @bullet
14549
14550 @item
14551 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
14552 their subranges.
14553
14554 @item
14555 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
14556
14557 @item
14558 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
14559
14560 @item
14561 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
14562 @var{type}}.
14563
14564 @item
14565 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
14566
14567 @item
14568 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
14569
14570 @item
14571 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
14572 @end itemize
14573
14574 @noindent
14575 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
14576 increasing precedence:
14577
14578 @table @code
14579 @item ,
14580 Function argument or array index separator.
14581
14582 @item :=
14583 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
14584 @var{value}.
14585
14586 @item <@r{, }>
14587 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
14588 types.
14589
14590 @item <=@r{, }>=
14591 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
14592 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
14593 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
14594
14595 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
14596 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
14597 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
14598 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
14599 comment character.
14600
14601 @item IN
14602 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
14603 Same precedence as @code{<}.
14604
14605 @item OR
14606 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
14607
14608 @item AND@r{, }&
14609 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
14610
14611 @item @@
14612 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
14613
14614 @item +@r{, }-
14615 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
14616 and difference on set types.
14617
14618 @item *
14619 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
14620 on set types.
14621
14622 @item /
14623 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
14624 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
14625
14626 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
14627 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
14628 precedence as @code{*}.
14629
14630 @item -
14631 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
14632
14633 @item ^
14634 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
14635
14636 @item NOT
14637 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
14638 @code{^}.
14639
14640 @item .
14641 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
14642 precedence as @code{^}.
14643
14644 @item []
14645 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
14646
14647 @item ()
14648 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
14649 as @code{^}.
14650
14651 @item ::@r{, }.
14652 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
14653 @end table
14654
14655 @quotation
14656 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
14657 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
14658 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
14659 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
14660 @end quotation
14661
14662
14663 @node Built-In Func/Proc
14664 @subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
14665 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
14666
14667 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
14668 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
14669
14670 @table @var
14671
14672 @item a
14673 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
14674
14675 @item c
14676 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
14677
14678 @item i
14679 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
14680
14681 @item m
14682 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
14683 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
14684 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
14685
14686 @item n
14687 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
14688
14689 @item r
14690 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
14691
14692 @item t
14693 represents a type.
14694
14695 @item v
14696 represents a variable.
14697
14698 @item x
14699 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
14700 explanation of the function for details.
14701 @end table
14702
14703 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
14704
14705 @table @code
14706 @item ABS(@var{n})
14707 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
14708
14709 @item CAP(@var{c})
14710 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
14711 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
14712
14713 @item CHR(@var{i})
14714 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
14715
14716 @item DEC(@var{v})
14717 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
14718
14719 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
14720 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
14721 new value.
14722
14723 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
14724 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
14725 set.
14726
14727 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
14728 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
14729
14730 @item HIGH(@var{a})
14731 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
14732
14733 @item INC(@var{v})
14734 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
14735
14736 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
14737 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
14738 new value.
14739
14740 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
14741 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
14742 there. Returns the new set.
14743
14744 @item MAX(@var{t})
14745 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
14746
14747 @item MIN(@var{t})
14748 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
14749
14750 @item ODD(@var{i})
14751 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
14752
14753 @item ORD(@var{x})
14754 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
14755 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting
14756 the @sc{ascii} character set). The argument @var{x} must be of an
14757 ordered type, which include integral, character and enumerated types.
14758
14759 @item SIZE(@var{x})
14760 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
14761 variable or a type.
14762
14763 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
14764 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
14765
14766 @item TSIZE(@var{x})
14767 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
14768 variable or a type.
14769
14770 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
14771 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
14772 @end table
14773
14774 @quotation
14775 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
14776 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
14777 an error.
14778 @end quotation
14779
14780 @cindex Modula-2 constants
14781 @node M2 Constants
14782 @subsubsection Constants
14783
14784 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
14785 ways:
14786
14787 @itemize @bullet
14788
14789 @item
14790 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
14791 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
14792 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
14793 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
14794
14795 @item
14796 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
14797 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
14798 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
14799 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
14800 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
14801 digits.
14802
14803 @item
14804 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
14805 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
14806 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
14807 followed by a @samp{C}.
14808
14809 @item
14810 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
14811 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
14812 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
14813 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
14814 sequences.
14815
14816 @item
14817 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
14818
14819 @item
14820 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
14821 @code{FALSE}.
14822
14823 @item
14824 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
14825
14826 @item
14827 Set constants are not yet supported.
14828 @end itemize
14829
14830 @node M2 Types
14831 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
14832 @cindex Modula-2 types
14833
14834 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
14835 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
14836 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
14837 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
14838 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
14839 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
14840
14841 The first example contains the following section of code:
14842
14843 @smallexample
14844 VAR
14845 s: SET OF CHAR ;
14846 r: [20..40] ;
14847 @end smallexample
14848
14849 @noindent
14850 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
14851 @code{r} and @code{s}.
14852
14853 @smallexample
14854 (@value{GDBP}) print s
14855 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
14856 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
14857 SET OF CHAR
14858 (@value{GDBP}) print r
14859 21
14860 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
14861 [20..40]
14862 @end smallexample
14863
14864 @noindent
14865 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
14866
14867 @smallexample
14868 VAR
14869 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
14870 @end smallexample
14871
14872 @noindent
14873 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
14874
14875 @smallexample
14876 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
14877 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
14878 @end smallexample
14879
14880 @noindent
14881 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
14882 expressions using the debugger.
14883
14884 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
14885 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
14886
14887 @smallexample
14888 VAR
14889 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
14890 @end smallexample
14891
14892 @smallexample
14893 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
14894 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
14895 @end smallexample
14896
14897 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
14898 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
14899 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
14900 above.
14901
14902 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
14903
14904 @smallexample
14905 TYPE
14906 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
14907 t = [blue..yellow] ;
14908 VAR
14909 s: t ;
14910 BEGIN
14911 s := blue ;
14912 @end smallexample
14913
14914 @noindent
14915 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
14916 and value of a variable.
14917
14918 @smallexample
14919 (@value{GDBP}) print s
14920 $1 = blue
14921 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
14922 type = [blue..yellow]
14923 @end smallexample
14924
14925 @noindent
14926 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
14927 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
14928 their @code{C} counterparts.
14929
14930 @smallexample
14931 VAR
14932 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
14933 BEGIN
14934 s[1] := 1 ;
14935 @end smallexample
14936
14937 @smallexample
14938 (@value{GDBP}) print s
14939 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
14940 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
14941 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
14942 @end smallexample
14943
14944 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
14945 pointer types as shown in this example:
14946
14947 @smallexample
14948 VAR
14949 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
14950 BEGIN
14951 NEW(s) ;
14952 s^[1] := 1 ;
14953 @end smallexample
14954
14955 @noindent
14956 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
14957
14958 @smallexample
14959 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
14960 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
14961 @end smallexample
14962
14963 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
14964 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
14965 types:
14966
14967 @smallexample
14968 TYPE
14969 foo = RECORD
14970 f1: CARDINAL ;
14971 f2: CHAR ;
14972 f3: myarray ;
14973 END ;
14974
14975 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
14976 myrange = [-2..2] ;
14977 VAR
14978 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
14979 @end smallexample
14980
14981 @noindent
14982 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
14983 below.
14984
14985 @smallexample
14986 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
14987 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
14988 f1 : CARDINAL;
14989 f2 : CHAR;
14990 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
14991 END
14992 @end smallexample
14993
14994 @node M2 Defaults
14995 @subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
14996 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
14997
14998 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
14999 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
15000 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
15001 selected the working language.
15002
15003 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
15004 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
15005 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
15006 Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
15007
15008 @node Deviations
15009 @subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
15010 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
15011
15012 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
15013 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
15014
15015 @itemize @bullet
15016 @item
15017 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
15018 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
15019 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
15020 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
15021 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
15022 returned a pointer.)
15023
15024 @item
15025 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
15026 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
15027 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
15028 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
15029
15030 @item
15031 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
15032 argument.
15033
15034 @item
15035 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
15036 @end itemize
15037
15038 @node M2 Checks
15039 @subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
15040 @cindex Modula-2 checks
15041
15042 @quotation
15043 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
15044 range checking.
15045 @end quotation
15046 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
15047
15048 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
15049
15050 @itemize @bullet
15051 @item
15052 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
15053 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
15054
15055 @item
15056 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
15057 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
15058 @end itemize
15059
15060 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
15061 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
15062
15063 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
15064 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
15065
15066 @node M2 Scope
15067 @subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
15068 @cindex scope
15069 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
15070 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
15071 @ifinfo
15072 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
15073 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
15074 @end ifinfo
15075 @ifnotinfo
15076 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
15077 @end ifnotinfo
15078
15079 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
15080 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
15081 similar syntax:
15082
15083 @smallexample
15084
15085 @var{module} . @var{id}
15086 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
15087 @end smallexample
15088
15089 @noindent
15090 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
15091 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
15092 identifier within your program, except another module.
15093
15094 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
15095 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
15096 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
15097 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
15098
15099 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
15100 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
15101 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
15102 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
15103 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
15104 @var{module}.
15105
15106 @node GDB/M2
15107 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
15108
15109 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
15110 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
15111 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
15112 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
15113 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
15114 analogue in Modula-2.
15115
15116 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
15117 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
15118 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
15119 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
15120 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
15121 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
15122
15123 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
15124 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
15125 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
15126
15127 @node Ada
15128 @subsection Ada
15129 @cindex Ada
15130
15131 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
15132 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
15133 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
15134 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
15135 to be difficult.
15136
15137
15138 @cindex expressions in Ada
15139 @menu
15140 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
15141 and semantics supported by Ada mode
15142 in @value{GDBN}.
15143 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
15144 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
15145 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
15146 * Ada Exceptions:: Ada Exceptions
15147 * Ada Tasks:: Listing and setting breakpoints in tasks.
15148 * Ada Tasks and Core Files:: Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
15149 * Ravenscar Profile:: Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar
15150 Profile
15151 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
15152 @end menu
15153
15154 @node Ada Mode Intro
15155 @subsubsection Introduction
15156 @cindex Ada mode, general
15157
15158 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
15159 syntax, with some extensions.
15160 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
15161
15162 @itemize @bullet
15163 @item
15164 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
15165 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
15166 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
15167 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
15168
15169 @item
15170 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
15171 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
15172
15173 @item
15174 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
15175 @end itemize
15176
15177 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if all names declared in
15178 user-written packages are directly visible, even if they are not visible
15179 according to Ada rules, thus making it unnecessary to fully qualify most
15180 names with their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes
15181 ambiguity, @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
15182
15183 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
15184 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
15185 was translated from an Ada source file.
15186
15187 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
15188 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
15189 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
15190 middle (to allow based literals).
15191
15192 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
15193 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
15194 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
15195 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
15196 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
15197 functions to procedures elsewhere.
15198
15199 @node Omissions from Ada
15200 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
15201 @cindex Ada, omissions from
15202
15203 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
15204
15205 @itemize @bullet
15206 @item
15207 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
15208
15209 @itemize @minus
15210 @item
15211 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
15212 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
15213
15214 @item
15215 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
15216
15217 @item
15218 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
15219
15220 @item
15221 @t{'Tag}.
15222
15223 @item
15224 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
15225 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
15226
15227 @item
15228 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
15229 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
15230
15231 @item
15232 @t{'Address}.
15233 @end itemize
15234
15235 @item
15236 The names in
15237 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
15238 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
15239 not currently available.
15240
15241 @item
15242 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
15243 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
15244 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
15245 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
15246 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
15247 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
15248 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
15249 indeterminate values.
15250
15251 @item
15252 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
15253 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
15254 are not implemented.
15255
15256 @item
15257 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
15258 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
15259 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
15260 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
15261 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
15262
15263 @smallexample
15264 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
15265 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
15266 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
15267 (@value{GDBP}) set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
15268 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
15269 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
15270 @end smallexample
15271
15272 Changing a
15273 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
15274 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
15275 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
15276 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
15277 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
15278 declared to have a type such as:
15279
15280 @smallexample
15281 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
15282 Id : Integer;
15283 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
15284 end record;
15285 @end smallexample
15286
15287 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
15288 assignments:
15289
15290 @smallexample
15291 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec.Len := 4
15292 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
15293 @end smallexample
15294
15295 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
15296 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
15297 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
15298 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
15299 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
15300 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
15301 redundant component associations, although which component values are
15302 assigned in such cases is not defined.
15303
15304 @item
15305 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
15306
15307 @item
15308 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
15309 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
15310 which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
15311 looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
15312 function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
15313 the proper resolution.
15314
15315 @item
15316 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
15317
15318 @item
15319 Entry calls are not implemented.
15320
15321 @item
15322 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
15323 formats are not supported.
15324
15325 @item
15326 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
15327
15328 @item
15329 The names @code{True} and @code{False}, when not part of a qualified name,
15330 are interpreted as if implicitly prefixed by @code{Standard}, regardless of
15331 context.
15332 Should your program
15333 redefine these names in a package or procedure (at best a dubious practice),
15334 you will have to use fully qualified names to access their new definitions.
15335 @end itemize
15336
15337 @node Additions to Ada
15338 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
15339 @cindex Ada, deviations from
15340
15341 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
15342 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
15343
15344 @itemize @bullet
15345 @item
15346 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
15347 a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
15348 then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
15349 @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
15350 Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
15351 in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
15352 Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
15353 which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
15354
15355 @item
15356 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
15357 appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
15358 you must typically surround it in single quotes.
15359
15360 @item
15361 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
15362 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
15363
15364 @item
15365 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
15366 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
15367 @end itemize
15368
15369 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
15370 additions specific to Ada:
15371
15372 @itemize @bullet
15373 @item
15374 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
15375 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
15376
15377 @smallexample
15378 (@value{GDBP}) set x := y + 3
15379 (@value{GDBP}) print A(tmp := y + 1)
15380 @end smallexample
15381
15382 @item
15383 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
15384 the value of its right-hand operand.
15385 This allows, for example,
15386 complex conditional breaks:
15387
15388 @smallexample
15389 (@value{GDBP}) break f
15390 (@value{GDBP}) condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
15391 @end smallexample
15392
15393 @item
15394 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
15395 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
15396 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
15397 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
15398 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
15399 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
15400 in strings. For example,
15401 @smallexample
15402 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
15403 @end smallexample
15404 @noindent
15405 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
15406 after each period.
15407
15408 @item
15409 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
15410 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
15411 to write
15412
15413 @smallexample
15414 (@value{GDBP}) print 'max(x, y)
15415 @end smallexample
15416
15417 @item
15418 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
15419 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
15420 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
15421 of 3 might print as
15422
15423 @smallexample
15424 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
15425 @end smallexample
15426
15427 @noindent
15428 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
15429 clause.
15430
15431 @item
15432 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
15433 multi-character subsequence of
15434 their names (an exact match gets preference).
15435 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
15436 in place of @t{a'length}.
15437
15438 @item
15439 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
15440 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
15441 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
15442 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
15443 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
15444 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
15445 For example,
15446 @smallexample
15447 (@value{GDBP}) print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
15448 @end smallexample
15449
15450 @item
15451 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
15452 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
15453 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
15454 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
15455 object.
15456
15457 @end itemize
15458
15459 @node Stopping Before Main Program
15460 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
15461
15462 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
15463 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
15464 before reaching the main procedure.
15465 As defined in the Ada Reference
15466 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
15467 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
15468 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
15469 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
15470
15471 @node Ada Exceptions
15472 @subsubsection Ada Exceptions
15473
15474 A command is provided to list all Ada exceptions:
15475
15476 @table @code
15477 @kindex info exceptions
15478 @item info exceptions
15479 @itemx info exceptions @var{regexp}
15480 The @code{info exceptions} command allows you to list all Ada exceptions
15481 defined within the program being debugged, as well as their addresses.
15482 With a regular expression, @var{regexp}, as argument, only those exceptions
15483 whose names match @var{regexp} are listed.
15484 @end table
15485
15486 Below is a small example, showing how the command can be used, first
15487 without argument, and next with a regular expression passed as an
15488 argument.
15489
15490 @smallexample
15491 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions
15492 All defined Ada exceptions:
15493 constraint_error: 0x613da0
15494 program_error: 0x613d20
15495 storage_error: 0x613ce0
15496 tasking_error: 0x613ca0
15497 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
15498 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions const.aint
15499 All Ada exceptions matching regular expression "const.aint":
15500 constraint_error: 0x613da0
15501 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
15502 @end smallexample
15503
15504 It is also possible to ask @value{GDBN} to stop your program's execution
15505 when an exception is raised. For more details, see @ref{Set Catchpoints}.
15506
15507 @node Ada Tasks
15508 @subsubsection Extensions for Ada Tasks
15509 @cindex Ada, tasking
15510
15511 Support for Ada tasks is analogous to that for threads (@pxref{Threads}).
15512 @value{GDBN} provides the following task-related commands:
15513
15514 @table @code
15515 @kindex info tasks
15516 @item info tasks
15517 This command shows a list of current Ada tasks, as in the following example:
15518
15519
15520 @smallexample
15521 @iftex
15522 @leftskip=0.5cm
15523 @end iftex
15524 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15525 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15526 1 8088000 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15527 2 80a4000 1 15 Accept Statement b
15528 3 809a800 1 15 Child Activation Wait a
15529 * 4 80ae800 3 15 Runnable c
15530
15531 @end smallexample
15532
15533 @noindent
15534 In this listing, the asterisk before the last task indicates it to be the
15535 task currently being inspected.
15536
15537 @table @asis
15538 @item ID
15539 Represents @value{GDBN}'s internal task number.
15540
15541 @item TID
15542 The Ada task ID.
15543
15544 @item P-ID
15545 The parent's task ID (@value{GDBN}'s internal task number).
15546
15547 @item Pri
15548 The base priority of the task.
15549
15550 @item State
15551 Current state of the task.
15552
15553 @table @code
15554 @item Unactivated
15555 The task has been created but has not been activated. It cannot be
15556 executing.
15557
15558 @item Runnable
15559 The task is not blocked for any reason known to Ada. (It may be waiting
15560 for a mutex, though.) It is conceptually "executing" in normal mode.
15561
15562 @item Terminated
15563 The task is terminated, in the sense of ARM 9.3 (5). Any dependents
15564 that were waiting on terminate alternatives have been awakened and have
15565 terminated themselves.
15566
15567 @item Child Activation Wait
15568 The task is waiting for created tasks to complete activation.
15569
15570 @item Accept Statement
15571 The task is waiting on an accept or selective wait statement.
15572
15573 @item Waiting on entry call
15574 The task is waiting on an entry call.
15575
15576 @item Async Select Wait
15577 The task is waiting to start the abortable part of an asynchronous
15578 select statement.
15579
15580 @item Delay Sleep
15581 The task is waiting on a select statement with only a delay
15582 alternative open.
15583
15584 @item Child Termination Wait
15585 The task is sleeping having completed a master within itself, and is
15586 waiting for the tasks dependent on that master to become terminated or
15587 waiting on a terminate Phase.
15588
15589 @item Wait Child in Term Alt
15590 The task is sleeping waiting for tasks on terminate alternatives to
15591 finish terminating.
15592
15593 @item Accepting RV with @var{taskno}
15594 The task is accepting a rendez-vous with the task @var{taskno}.
15595 @end table
15596
15597 @item Name
15598 Name of the task in the program.
15599
15600 @end table
15601
15602 @kindex info task @var{taskno}
15603 @item info task @var{taskno}
15604 This command shows detailled informations on the specified task, as in
15605 the following example:
15606 @smallexample
15607 @iftex
15608 @leftskip=0.5cm
15609 @end iftex
15610 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15611 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15612 1 8077880 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15613 * 2 807c468 1 15 Runnable task_1
15614 (@value{GDBP}) info task 2
15615 Ada Task: 0x807c468
15616 Name: task_1
15617 Thread: 0x807f378
15618 Parent: 1 (main_task)
15619 Base Priority: 15
15620 State: Runnable
15621 @end smallexample
15622
15623 @item task
15624 @kindex task@r{ (Ada)}
15625 @cindex current Ada task ID
15626 This command prints the ID of the current task.
15627
15628 @smallexample
15629 @iftex
15630 @leftskip=0.5cm
15631 @end iftex
15632 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15633 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15634 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15635 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
15636 (@value{GDBP}) task
15637 [Current task is 2]
15638 @end smallexample
15639
15640 @item task @var{taskno}
15641 @cindex Ada task switching
15642 This command is like the @code{thread @var{threadno}}
15643 command (@pxref{Threads}). It switches the context of debugging
15644 from the current task to the given task.
15645
15646 @smallexample
15647 @iftex
15648 @leftskip=0.5cm
15649 @end iftex
15650 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15651 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15652 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15653 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
15654 (@value{GDBP}) task 1
15655 [Switching to task 1]
15656 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
15657 (@value{GDBP}) bt
15658 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
15659 #1 0x8056714 in system.os_interface.pthread_cond_wait ()
15660 #2 0x805cb63 in system.task_primitives.operations.sleep ()
15661 #3 0x806153e in system.tasking.stages.activate_tasks ()
15662 #4 0x804aacc in un () at un.adb:5
15663 @end smallexample
15664
15665 @item break @var{linespec} task @var{taskno}
15666 @itemx break @var{linespec} task @var{taskno} if @dots{}
15667 @cindex breakpoints and tasks, in Ada
15668 @cindex task breakpoints, in Ada
15669 @kindex break @dots{} task @var{taskno}@r{ (Ada)}
15670 These commands are like the @code{break @dots{} thread @dots{}}
15671 command (@pxref{Thread Stops}). The
15672 @var{linespec} argument specifies source lines, as described
15673 in @ref{Specify Location}.
15674
15675 Use the qualifier @samp{task @var{taskno}} with a breakpoint command
15676 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
15677 particular Ada task reaches this breakpoint. The @var{taskno} is one of the
15678 numeric task identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
15679 column of the @samp{info tasks} display.
15680
15681 If you do not specify @samp{task @var{taskno}} when you set a
15682 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} tasks of your
15683 program.
15684
15685 You can use the @code{task} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
15686 well; in this case, place @samp{task @var{taskno}} before the
15687 breakpoint condition (before the @code{if}).
15688
15689 For example,
15690
15691 @smallexample
15692 @iftex
15693 @leftskip=0.5cm
15694 @end iftex
15695 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15696 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15697 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15698 2 140045060 1 15 Accept/Select Wait t2
15699 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
15700 * 4 140056040 1 15 Runnable t3
15701 (@value{GDBP}) b 15 task 2
15702 Breakpoint 5 at 0x120044cb0: file test_task_debug.adb, line 15.
15703 (@value{GDBP}) cont
15704 Continuing.
15705 task # 1 running
15706 task # 2 running
15707
15708 Breakpoint 5, test_task_debug () at test_task_debug.adb:15
15709 15 flush;
15710 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15711 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15712 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15713 * 2 140045060 1 15 Runnable t2
15714 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
15715 4 140056040 1 15 Delay Sleep t3
15716 @end smallexample
15717 @end table
15718
15719 @node Ada Tasks and Core Files
15720 @subsubsection Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
15721 @cindex Ada tasking and core file debugging
15722
15723 When inspecting a core file, as opposed to debugging a live program,
15724 tasking support may be limited or even unavailable, depending on
15725 the platform being used.
15726 For instance, on x86-linux, the list of tasks is available, but task
15727 switching is not supported. On Tru64, however, task switching will work
15728 as usual.
15729
15730 On certain platforms, including Tru64, the debugger needs to perform some
15731 memory writes in order to provide Ada tasking support. When inspecting
15732 a core file, this means that the core file must be opened with read-write
15733 privileges, using the command @samp{"set write on"} (@pxref{Patching}).
15734 Under these circumstances, you should make a backup copy of the core
15735 file before inspecting it with @value{GDBN}.
15736
15737 @node Ravenscar Profile
15738 @subsubsection Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar Profile
15739 @cindex Ravenscar Profile
15740
15741 The @dfn{Ravenscar Profile} is a subset of the Ada tasking features,
15742 specifically designed for systems with safety-critical real-time
15743 requirements.
15744
15745 @table @code
15746 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching on
15747 @cindex task switching with program using Ravenscar Profile
15748 @item set ravenscar task-switching on
15749 Allows task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
15750 Profile. This is the default.
15751
15752 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching off
15753 @item set ravenscar task-switching off
15754 Turn off task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
15755 Profile. This is mostly intended to disable the code that adds support
15756 for the Ravenscar Profile, in case a bug in either @value{GDBN} or in
15757 the Ravenscar runtime is preventing @value{GDBN} from working properly.
15758 To be effective, this command should be run before the program is started.
15759
15760 @kindex show ravenscar task-switching
15761 @item show ravenscar task-switching
15762 Show whether it is possible to switch from task to task in a program
15763 using the Ravenscar Profile.
15764
15765 @end table
15766
15767 @node Ada Glitches
15768 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
15769 @cindex Ada, problems
15770
15771 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
15772 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
15773 @value{GDBN},
15774 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
15775 and the GNU Ada compiler.
15776
15777 @itemize @bullet
15778 @item
15779 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
15780 storage are invisible to the debugger.
15781
15782 @item
15783 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
15784 argument lists are treated as positional).
15785
15786 @item
15787 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
15788
15789 @item
15790 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
15791 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
15792 the host machine.
15793
15794 @item
15795 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
15796 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
15797 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
15798 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
15799 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
15800 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
15801 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
15802 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
15803 you can usually resolve the confusion
15804 by qualifying the problematic names with package
15805 @code{Standard} explicitly.
15806 @end itemize
15807
15808 Older versions of the compiler sometimes generate erroneous debugging
15809 information, resulting in the debugger incorrectly printing the value
15810 of affected entities. In some cases, the debugger is able to work
15811 around an issue automatically. In other cases, the debugger is able
15812 to work around the issue, but the work-around has to be specifically
15813 enabled.
15814
15815 @kindex set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
15816 @kindex show ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
15817 @table @code
15818
15819 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS on
15820 Configure GDB to strictly follow the GNAT encoding when computing the
15821 value of Ada entities, particularly when @code{PAD} and @code{PAD___XVS}
15822 types are involved (see @code{ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources for
15823 a complete description of the encoding used by the GNAT compiler).
15824 This is the default.
15825
15826 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS off
15827 This is related to the encoding using by the GNAT compiler. If @value{GDBN}
15828 sometimes prints the wrong value for certain entities, changing @code{ada
15829 trust-PAD-over-XVS} to @code{off} activates a work-around which may fix
15830 the issue. It is always safe to set @code{ada trust-PAD-over-XVS} to
15831 @code{off}, but this incurs a slight performance penalty, so it is
15832 recommended to leave this setting to @code{on} unless necessary.
15833
15834 @end table
15835
15836 @cindex GNAT descriptive types
15837 @cindex GNAT encoding
15838 Internally, the debugger also relies on the compiler following a number
15839 of conventions known as the @samp{GNAT Encoding}, all documented in
15840 @file{gcc/ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources. This encoding describes
15841 how the debugging information should be generated for certain types.
15842 In particular, this convention makes use of @dfn{descriptive types},
15843 which are artificial types generated purely to help the debugger.
15844
15845 These encodings were defined at a time when the debugging information
15846 format used was not powerful enough to describe some of the more complex
15847 types available in Ada. Since DWARF allows us to express nearly all
15848 Ada features, the long-term goal is to slowly replace these descriptive
15849 types by their pure DWARF equivalent. To facilitate that transition,
15850 a new maintenance option is available to force the debugger to ignore
15851 those descriptive types. It allows the user to quickly evaluate how
15852 well @value{GDBN} works without them.
15853
15854 @table @code
15855
15856 @kindex maint ada set ignore-descriptive-types
15857 @item maintenance ada set ignore-descriptive-types [on|off]
15858 Control whether the debugger should ignore descriptive types.
15859 The default is not to ignore descriptives types (@code{off}).
15860
15861 @kindex maint ada show ignore-descriptive-types
15862 @item maintenance ada show ignore-descriptive-types
15863 Show if descriptive types are ignored by @value{GDBN}.
15864
15865 @end table
15866
15867 @node Unsupported Languages
15868 @section Unsupported Languages
15869
15870 @cindex unsupported languages
15871 @cindex minimal language
15872 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
15873 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
15874 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
15875 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
15876 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
15877 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
15878
15879 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
15880 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
15881 language.
15882
15883 @node Symbols
15884 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
15885
15886 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
15887 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
15888 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
15889 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
15890 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
15891 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
15892 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
15893
15894 @cindex symbol names
15895 @cindex names of symbols
15896 @cindex quoting names
15897 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
15898 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
15899 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
15900 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
15901 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
15902 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
15903 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
15904 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
15905
15906 @smallexample
15907 p 'foo.c'::x
15908 @end smallexample
15909
15910 @noindent
15911 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
15912
15913 @table @code
15914 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
15915 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
15916 @kindex set case-sensitive
15917 @item set case-sensitive on
15918 @itemx set case-sensitive off
15919 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
15920 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
15921 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
15922 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
15923 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
15924 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
15925 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
15926 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
15927 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
15928 case-insensitive matches.
15929
15930 @kindex show case-sensitive
15931 @item show case-sensitive
15932 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
15933 lookups.
15934
15935 @kindex set print type methods
15936 @item set print type methods
15937 @itemx set print type methods on
15938 @itemx set print type methods off
15939 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any methods
15940 declared in that class. You can control this behavior either by
15941 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
15942 print type methods}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
15943 display the methods; this is the default. Specifying @code{off} will
15944 cause @value{GDBN} to omit the methods.
15945
15946 @kindex show print type methods
15947 @item show print type methods
15948 This command shows the current setting of method display when printing
15949 classes.
15950
15951 @kindex set print type typedefs
15952 @item set print type typedefs
15953 @itemx set print type typedefs on
15954 @itemx set print type typedefs off
15955
15956 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any typedefs
15957 defined in that class. You can control this behavior either by
15958 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
15959 print type typedefs}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
15960 display the typedef definitions; this is the default. Specifying
15961 @code{off} will cause @value{GDBN} to omit the typedef definitions.
15962 Note that this controls whether the typedef definition itself is
15963 printed, not whether typedef names are substituted when printing other
15964 types.
15965
15966 @kindex show print type typedefs
15967 @item show print type typedefs
15968 This command shows the current setting of typedef display when
15969 printing classes.
15970
15971 @kindex info address
15972 @cindex address of a symbol
15973 @item info address @var{symbol}
15974 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
15975 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
15976 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
15977 is always stored.
15978
15979 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
15980 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
15981 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
15982
15983 @kindex info symbol
15984 @cindex symbol from address
15985 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
15986 @item info symbol @var{addr}
15987 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
15988 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
15989 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
15990
15991 @smallexample
15992 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
15993 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
15994 @end smallexample
15995
15996 @noindent
15997 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
15998 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
15999
16000 For dynamically linked executables, the name of executable or shared
16001 library containing the symbol is also printed:
16002
16003 @smallexample
16004 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x400225
16005 _start + 5 in section .text of /tmp/a.out
16006 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x2aaaac2811cf
16007 __read_nocancel + 6 in section .text of /usr/lib64/libc.so.6
16008 @end smallexample
16009
16010 @kindex whatis
16011 @item whatis[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
16012 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression
16013 or a name of a data type. With no argument, print the data type of
16014 @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
16015
16016 If @var{arg} is an expression (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), it
16017 is not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
16018 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
16019
16020 If @var{arg} is a variable or an expression, @code{whatis} prints its
16021 literal type as it is used in the source code. If the type was
16022 defined using a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will @emph{not} print
16023 the data type underlying the @code{typedef}. If the type of the
16024 variable or the expression is a compound data type, such as
16025 @code{struct} or @code{class}, @code{whatis} never prints their
16026 fields or methods. It just prints the @code{struct}/@code{class}
16027 name (a.k.a.@: its @dfn{tag}). If you want to see the members of
16028 such a compound data type, use @code{ptype}.
16029
16030 If @var{arg} is a type name that was defined using @code{typedef},
16031 @code{whatis} @dfn{unrolls} only one level of that @code{typedef}.
16032 Unrolling means that @code{whatis} will show the underlying type used
16033 in the @code{typedef} declaration of @var{arg}. However, if that
16034 underlying type is also a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will not
16035 unroll it.
16036
16037 For C code, the type names may also have the form @samp{class
16038 @var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
16039 @var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
16040
16041 @var{flags} can be used to modify how the type is displayed.
16042 Available flags are:
16043
16044 @table @code
16045 @item r
16046 Display in ``raw'' form. Normally, @value{GDBN} substitutes template
16047 parameters and typedefs defined in a class when printing the class'
16048 members. The @code{/r} flag disables this.
16049
16050 @item m
16051 Do not print methods defined in the class.
16052
16053 @item M
16054 Print methods defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
16055 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type methods}.
16056
16057 @item t
16058 Do not print typedefs defined in the class. Note that this controls
16059 whether the typedef definition itself is printed, not whether typedef
16060 names are substituted when printing other types.
16061
16062 @item T
16063 Print typedefs defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
16064 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type typedefs}.
16065 @end table
16066
16067 @kindex ptype
16068 @item ptype[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
16069 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
16070 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
16071 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
16072
16073 Contrary to @code{whatis}, @code{ptype} always unrolls any
16074 @code{typedef}s in its argument declaration, whether the argument is
16075 a variable, expression, or a data type. This means that @code{ptype}
16076 of a variable or an expression will not print literally its type as
16077 present in the source code---use @code{whatis} for that. @code{typedef}s at
16078 the pointer or reference targets are also unrolled. Only @code{typedef}s of
16079 fields, methods and inner @code{class typedef}s of @code{struct}s,
16080 @code{class}es and @code{union}s are not unrolled even with @code{ptype}.
16081
16082 For example, for this variable declaration:
16083
16084 @smallexample
16085 typedef double real_t;
16086 struct complex @{ real_t real; double imag; @};
16087 typedef struct complex complex_t;
16088 complex_t var;
16089 real_t *real_pointer_var;
16090 @end smallexample
16091
16092 @noindent
16093 the two commands give this output:
16094
16095 @smallexample
16096 @group
16097 (@value{GDBP}) whatis var
16098 type = complex_t
16099 (@value{GDBP}) ptype var
16100 type = struct complex @{
16101 real_t real;
16102 double imag;
16103 @}
16104 (@value{GDBP}) whatis complex_t
16105 type = struct complex
16106 (@value{GDBP}) whatis struct complex
16107 type = struct complex
16108 (@value{GDBP}) ptype struct complex
16109 type = struct complex @{
16110 real_t real;
16111 double imag;
16112 @}
16113 (@value{GDBP}) whatis real_pointer_var
16114 type = real_t *
16115 (@value{GDBP}) ptype real_pointer_var
16116 type = double *
16117 @end group
16118 @end smallexample
16119
16120 @noindent
16121 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
16122 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
16123
16124 @cindex incomplete type
16125 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
16126 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
16127 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
16128 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
16129 given these declarations:
16130
16131 @smallexample
16132 struct foo;
16133 struct foo *fooptr;
16134 @end smallexample
16135
16136 @noindent
16137 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
16138
16139 @smallexample
16140 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
16141 $1 = <incomplete type>
16142 @end smallexample
16143
16144 @noindent
16145 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
16146 completely specified.
16147
16148 @kindex info types
16149 @item info types @var{regexp}
16150 @itemx info types
16151 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
16152 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
16153 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
16154 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
16155 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
16156 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
16157 name is @code{value}.
16158
16159 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
16160 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
16161 lists all source files where a type is defined.
16162
16163 @kindex info type-printers
16164 @item info type-printers
16165 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled may
16166 have ``type printers'' available. When using @command{ptype} or
16167 @command{whatis}, these printers are consulted when the name of a type
16168 is needed. @xref{Type Printing API}, for more information on writing
16169 type printers.
16170
16171 @code{info type-printers} displays all the available type printers.
16172
16173 @kindex enable type-printer
16174 @kindex disable type-printer
16175 @item enable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
16176 @item disable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
16177 These commands can be used to enable or disable type printers.
16178
16179 @kindex info scope
16180 @cindex local variables
16181 @item info scope @var{location}
16182 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
16183 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
16184 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
16185 to the scope defined by that location. (@xref{Specify Location}, for
16186 details about supported forms of @var{location}.) For example:
16187
16188 @smallexample
16189 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
16190 Scope for command_line_handler:
16191 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
16192 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
16193 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
16194 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
16195 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
16196 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
16197 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
16198 @end smallexample
16199
16200 @noindent
16201 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
16202 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
16203 collect}.
16204
16205 @kindex info source
16206 @item info source
16207 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
16208 the function containing the current point of execution:
16209 @itemize @bullet
16210 @item
16211 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
16212 @item
16213 the directory it was compiled in,
16214 @item
16215 its length, in lines,
16216 @item
16217 which programming language it is written in,
16218 @item
16219 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
16220 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
16221 @item
16222 whether the debugging information includes information about
16223 preprocessor macros.
16224 @end itemize
16225
16226
16227 @kindex info sources
16228 @item info sources
16229 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
16230 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
16231 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
16232
16233 @kindex info functions
16234 @item info functions
16235 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
16236
16237 @item info functions @var{regexp}
16238 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
16239 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
16240 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
16241 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
16242 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
16243 that conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
16244 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
16245
16246 @kindex info variables
16247 @item info variables
16248 Print the names and data types of all variables that are defined
16249 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
16250
16251 @item info variables @var{regexp}
16252 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
16253 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
16254 @var{regexp}.
16255
16256 @kindex info classes
16257 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
16258 @item info classes
16259 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
16260 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
16261 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
16262 expression.
16263
16264 @kindex info selectors
16265 @item info selectors
16266 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
16267 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
16268 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
16269 expression.
16270
16271 @ignore
16272 This was never implemented.
16273 @kindex info methods
16274 @item info methods
16275 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
16276 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
16277 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
16278 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
16279 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
16280 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
16281 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
16282 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
16283 @end ignore
16284
16285 @cindex opaque data types
16286 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
16287 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
16288 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
16289 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
16290 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
16291 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
16292 another source file. The default is on.
16293
16294 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
16295 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
16296
16297 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
16298 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
16299 is printed as follows:
16300 @smallexample
16301 @{<no data fields>@}
16302 @end smallexample
16303
16304 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
16305 @item show opaque-type-resolution
16306 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
16307
16308 @kindex set print symbol-loading
16309 @cindex print messages when symbols are loaded
16310 @item set print symbol-loading
16311 @itemx set print symbol-loading full
16312 @itemx set print symbol-loading brief
16313 @itemx set print symbol-loading off
16314 The @code{set print symbol-loading} command allows you to control the
16315 printing of messages when @value{GDBN} loads symbol information.
16316 By default a message is printed for the executable and one for each
16317 shared library, and normally this is what you want. However, when
16318 debugging apps with large numbers of shared libraries these messages
16319 can be annoying.
16320 When set to @code{brief} a message is printed for each executable,
16321 and when @value{GDBN} loads a collection of shared libraries at once
16322 it will only print one message regardless of the number of shared
16323 libraries. When set to @code{off} no messages are printed.
16324
16325 @kindex show print symbol-loading
16326 @item show print symbol-loading
16327 Show whether messages will be printed when a @value{GDBN} command
16328 entered from the keyboard causes symbol information to be loaded.
16329
16330 @kindex maint print symbols
16331 @cindex symbol dump
16332 @kindex maint print psymbols
16333 @cindex partial symbol dump
16334 @kindex maint print msymbols
16335 @cindex minimal symbol dump
16336 @item maint print symbols @var{filename}
16337 @itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
16338 @itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
16339 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
16340 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
16341 symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
16342 symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
16343 collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
16344 only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
16345 command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
16346 use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
16347 symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
16348 files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
16349 @samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
16350 required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
16351 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
16352 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
16353
16354 @kindex maint info symtabs
16355 @kindex maint info psymtabs
16356 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
16357 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
16358 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
16359 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
16360 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
16361 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
16362
16363 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
16364 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
16365 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
16366 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
16367 structure in more detail. For example:
16368
16369 @smallexample
16370 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
16371 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
16372 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
16373 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
16374 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
16375 readin no
16376 fullname (null)
16377 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
16378 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
16379 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
16380 dependencies (none)
16381 @}
16382 @}
16383 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
16384 (@value{GDBP})
16385 @end smallexample
16386 @noindent
16387 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
16388 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
16389 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
16390 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
16391 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
16392
16393 @smallexample
16394 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
16395 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
16396 line 1574.
16397 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
16398 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
16399 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
16400 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
16401 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
16402 dirname (null)
16403 fullname (null)
16404 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
16405 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
16406 debugformat DWARF 2
16407 @}
16408 @}
16409 (@value{GDBP})
16410 @end smallexample
16411 @end table
16412
16413
16414 @node Altering
16415 @chapter Altering Execution
16416
16417 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
16418 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
16419 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
16420 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
16421 program.
16422
16423 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
16424 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
16425 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
16426
16427 @menu
16428 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
16429 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
16430 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
16431 * Returning:: Returning from a function
16432 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
16433 * Patching:: Patching your program
16434 @end menu
16435
16436 @node Assignment
16437 @section Assignment to Variables
16438
16439 @cindex assignment
16440 @cindex setting variables
16441 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
16442 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
16443
16444 @smallexample
16445 print x=4
16446 @end smallexample
16447
16448 @noindent
16449 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
16450 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
16451 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
16452 information on operators in supported languages.
16453
16454 @kindex set variable
16455 @cindex variables, setting
16456 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
16457 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
16458 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
16459 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
16460 ,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
16461
16462 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
16463 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
16464 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
16465 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
16466 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
16467 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
16468 command @code{set width}:
16469
16470 @smallexample
16471 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
16472 type = double
16473 (@value{GDBP}) p width
16474 $4 = 13
16475 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
16476 Invalid syntax in expression.
16477 @end smallexample
16478
16479 @noindent
16480 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
16481 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
16482
16483 @smallexample
16484 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
16485 @end smallexample
16486
16487 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
16488 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
16489 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
16490 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
16491 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
16492 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
16493
16494 @smallexample
16495 @group
16496 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
16497 type = double
16498 (@value{GDBP}) p g
16499 $1 = 1
16500 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
16501 (@value{GDBP}) p g
16502 $2 = 1
16503 (@value{GDBP}) r
16504 The program being debugged has been started already.
16505 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
16506 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
16507 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
16508 Invalid bfd target.
16509 (@value{GDBP}) show g
16510 The current BFD target is "=4".
16511 @end group
16512 @end smallexample
16513
16514 @noindent
16515 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
16516 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
16517 @code{g}, use
16518
16519 @smallexample
16520 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
16521 @end smallexample
16522
16523 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
16524 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
16525 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
16526 same length or shorter.
16527 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
16528 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
16529
16530 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
16531 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
16532 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
16533 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
16534 and representation in memory), and
16535
16536 @smallexample
16537 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
16538 @end smallexample
16539
16540 @noindent
16541 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
16542
16543 @node Jumping
16544 @section Continuing at a Different Address
16545
16546 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
16547 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
16548 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
16549
16550 @table @code
16551 @kindex jump
16552 @kindex j @r{(@code{jump})}
16553 @item jump @var{linespec}
16554 @itemx j @var{linespec}
16555 @itemx jump @var{location}
16556 @itemx j @var{location}
16557 Resume execution at line @var{linespec} or at address given by
16558 @var{location}. Execution stops again immediately if there is a
16559 breakpoint there. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
16560 different forms of @var{linespec} and @var{location}. It is common
16561 practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with
16562 @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
16563
16564 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
16565 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
16566 register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
16567 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
16568 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
16569 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
16570 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
16571 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
16572 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
16573 @end table
16574
16575 @c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
16576 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
16577 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
16578 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
16579 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
16580 example,
16581
16582 @smallexample
16583 set $pc = 0x485
16584 @end smallexample
16585
16586 @noindent
16587 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
16588 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
16589 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
16590
16591 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
16592 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
16593 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
16594 detail.
16595
16596 @c @group
16597 @node Signaling
16598 @section Giving your Program a Signal
16599 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
16600
16601 @table @code
16602 @kindex signal
16603 @item signal @var{signal}
16604 Resume execution where your program is stopped, but immediately give it the
16605 signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
16606 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
16607 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
16608
16609 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
16610 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
16611 a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
16612 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
16613 signal.
16614
16615 @emph{Note:} When resuming a multi-threaded program, @var{signal} is
16616 delivered to the currently selected thread, not the thread that last
16617 reported a stop. This includes the situation where a thread was
16618 stopped due to a signal. So if you want to continue execution
16619 suppressing the signal that stopped a thread, you should select that
16620 same thread before issuing the @samp{signal 0} command. If you issue
16621 the @samp{signal 0} command with another thread as the selected one,
16622 @value{GDBN} detects that and asks for confirmation.
16623
16624 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
16625 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
16626 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
16627 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
16628 passes the signal directly to your program.
16629
16630 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
16631 after executing the command.
16632
16633 @kindex queue-signal
16634 @item queue-signal @var{signal}
16635 Queue @var{signal} to be delivered immediately to the current thread
16636 when execution of the thread resumes. The @var{signal} can be the name or
16637 the number of a signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and
16638 @code{signal SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
16639 The handling of the signal must be set to pass the signal to the program,
16640 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error.
16641 You can control the handling of signals from @value{GDBN} with the
16642 @code{handle} command (@pxref{Signals}).
16643
16644 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, any currently queued signal
16645 for the current thread is discarded and when execution resumes no signal
16646 will be delivered. This is useful when your program stopped on account
16647 of a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
16648 @code{continue} command.
16649
16650 This command differs from the @code{signal} command in that the signal
16651 is just queued, execution is not resumed. And @code{queue-signal} cannot
16652 be used to pass a signal whose handling state has been set to @code{nopass}
16653 (@pxref{Signals}).
16654 @end table
16655 @c @end group
16656
16657 @node Returning
16658 @section Returning from a Function
16659
16660 @table @code
16661 @cindex returning from a function
16662 @kindex return
16663 @item return
16664 @itemx return @var{expression}
16665 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
16666 command. If you give an
16667 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
16668 value.
16669 @end table
16670
16671 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
16672 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
16673 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
16674 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
16675
16676 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
16677 Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
16678 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
16679 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
16680 of functions.
16681
16682 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
16683 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
16684 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
16685 and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
16686 selected stack frame returns naturally.
16687
16688 @value{GDBN} needs to know how the @var{expression} argument should be set for
16689 the inferior. The concrete registers assignment depends on the OS ABI and the
16690 type being returned by the selected stack frame. For example it is common for
16691 OS ABI to return floating point values in FPU registers while integer values in
16692 CPU registers. Still some ABIs return even floating point values in CPU
16693 registers. Larger integer widths (such as @code{long long int}) also have
16694 specific placement rules. @value{GDBN} already knows the OS ABI from its
16695 current target so it needs to find out also the type being returned to make the
16696 assignment into the right register(s).
16697
16698 Normally, the selected stack frame has debug info. @value{GDBN} will always
16699 use the debug info instead of the implicit type of @var{expression} when the
16700 debug info is available. For example, if you type @kbd{return -1}, and the
16701 function in the current stack frame is declared to return a @code{long long
16702 int}, @value{GDBN} transparently converts the implicit @code{int} value of -1
16703 into a @code{long long int}:
16704
16705 @smallexample
16706 Breakpoint 1, func () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:29
16707 29 return 31;
16708 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
16709 Make func return now? (y or n) y
16710 #0 0x004004f6 in main () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:43
16711 43 printf ("result=%lld\n", func ());
16712 (@value{GDBP})
16713 @end smallexample
16714
16715 However, if the selected stack frame does not have a debug info, e.g., if the
16716 function was compiled without debug info, @value{GDBN} has to find out the type
16717 to return from user. Specifying a different type by mistake may set the value
16718 in different inferior registers than the caller code expects. For example,
16719 typing @kbd{return -1} with its implicit type @code{int} would set only a part
16720 of a @code{long long int} result for a debug info less function (on 32-bit
16721 architectures). Therefore the user is required to specify the return type by
16722 an appropriate cast explicitly:
16723
16724 @smallexample
16725 Breakpoint 2, 0x0040050b in func ()
16726 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
16727 Return value type not available for selected stack frame.
16728 Please use an explicit cast of the value to return.
16729 (@value{GDBP}) return (long long int) -1
16730 Make selected stack frame return now? (y or n) y
16731 #0 0x00400526 in main ()
16732 (@value{GDBP})
16733 @end smallexample
16734
16735 @node Calling
16736 @section Calling Program Functions
16737
16738 @table @code
16739 @cindex calling functions
16740 @cindex inferior functions, calling
16741 @item print @var{expr}
16742 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
16743 The expression may include calls to functions in the program being
16744 debugged.
16745
16746 @kindex call
16747 @item call @var{expr}
16748 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
16749 returned values.
16750
16751 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
16752 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
16753 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
16754 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
16755 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
16756 value history.
16757 @end table
16758
16759 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
16760 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
16761 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
16762 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
16763
16764 Similarly, with a C@t{++} program it is possible for the function you
16765 call via the @code{print} or @code{call} command to generate an
16766 exception that is not handled due to the constraints of the dummy
16767 frame. In this case, any exception that is raised in the frame, but has
16768 an out-of-frame exception handler will not be found. GDB builds a
16769 dummy-frame for the inferior function call, and the unwinder cannot
16770 seek for exception handlers outside of this dummy-frame. What happens
16771 in that case is controlled by the
16772 @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception} command.
16773
16774 @table @code
16775 @item set unwindonsignal
16776 @kindex set unwindonsignal
16777 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
16778 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
16779 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
16780 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
16781 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
16782 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
16783 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
16784 received.
16785
16786 @item show unwindonsignal
16787 @kindex show unwindonsignal
16788 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
16789 @value{GDBN}.
16790
16791 @item set unwind-on-terminating-exception
16792 @kindex set unwind-on-terminating-exception
16793 @cindex unwind stack in called functions with unhandled exceptions
16794 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding on unhandled exception.
16795 Set unwinding of the stack if a C@t{++} exception is raised, but left
16796 unhandled while in a function that @value{GDBN} called in the program being
16797 debugged. If set to on (the default), @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack
16798 it created for the call and restores the context to what it was before
16799 the call. If set to off, @value{GDBN} the exception is delivered to
16800 the default C@t{++} exception handler and the inferior terminated.
16801
16802 @item show unwind-on-terminating-exception
16803 @kindex show unwind-on-terminating-exception
16804 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
16805 @value{GDBN}.
16806
16807 @end table
16808
16809 @cindex weak alias functions
16810 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is actually a @dfn{weak alias}
16811 for another function. In such case, @value{GDBN} might not pick up
16812 the type information, including the types of the function arguments,
16813 which causes @value{GDBN} to call the inferior function incorrectly.
16814 As a result, the called function will function erroneously and may
16815 even crash. A solution to that is to use the name of the aliased
16816 function instead.
16817
16818 @node Patching
16819 @section Patching Programs
16820
16821 @cindex patching binaries
16822 @cindex writing into executables
16823 @cindex writing into corefiles
16824
16825 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
16826 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
16827 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
16828 patching your program's binary.
16829
16830 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
16831 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
16832 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
16833 repairs.
16834
16835 @table @code
16836 @kindex set write
16837 @item set write on
16838 @itemx set write off
16839 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
16840 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @kbd{set write
16841 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
16842
16843 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
16844 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
16845 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
16846
16847 @item show write
16848 @kindex show write
16849 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
16850 as well as reading.
16851 @end table
16852
16853 @node GDB Files
16854 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
16855
16856 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
16857 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
16858 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
16859 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
16860
16861 @menu
16862 * Files:: Commands to specify files
16863 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
16864 * MiniDebugInfo:: Debugging information in a special section
16865 * Index Files:: Index files speed up GDB
16866 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
16867 * Data Files:: GDB data files
16868 @end menu
16869
16870 @node Files
16871 @section Commands to Specify Files
16872
16873 @cindex symbol table
16874 @cindex core dump file
16875
16876 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
16877 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
16878 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
16879 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
16880
16881 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
16882 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
16883 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
16884 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
16885 Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
16886 new files are useful.
16887
16888 @table @code
16889 @cindex executable file
16890 @kindex file
16891 @item file @var{filename}
16892 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
16893 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
16894 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
16895 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
16896 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
16897 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
16898 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
16899 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
16900
16901 @cindex unlinked object files
16902 @cindex patching object files
16903 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
16904 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
16905 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
16906 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
16907 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
16908 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
16909 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
16910 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
16911
16912 @item file
16913 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
16914 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
16915
16916 @kindex exec-file
16917 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
16918 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
16919 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
16920 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
16921 discard information on the executable file.
16922
16923 @kindex symbol-file
16924 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
16925 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
16926 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
16927 table and program to run from the same file.
16928
16929 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
16930 program's symbol table.
16931
16932 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
16933 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
16934 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
16935 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
16936 @value{GDBN}.
16937
16938 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
16939 executing it once.
16940
16941 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
16942 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
16943 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
16944 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
16945 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
16946 using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
16947 optimized code.
16948
16949 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
16950 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
16951 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
16952 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
16953 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
16954
16955 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
16956 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
16957 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
16958 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
16959 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
16960 Warnings and Messages}.)
16961
16962 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
16963 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
16964 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
16965 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
16966 in stabs format.
16967
16968 @kindex readnow
16969 @cindex reading symbols immediately
16970 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
16971 @item symbol-file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
16972 @itemx file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
16973 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
16974 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
16975 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
16976 entire symbol table available.
16977
16978 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
16979 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
16980 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
16981 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
16982 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
16983 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
16984 @c files.
16985
16986 @kindex core-file
16987 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
16988 @itemx core
16989 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
16990 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
16991 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
16992 executable file itself for other parts.
16993
16994 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
16995 to be used.
16996
16997 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
16998 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
16999 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
17000 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
17001 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
17002
17003 @kindex add-symbol-file
17004 @cindex dynamic linking
17005 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
17006 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
17007 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} -s @var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
17008 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
17009 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
17010 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
17011 into the program that is running. The @var{address} should give the memory
17012 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
17013 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
17014 of @samp{-s @var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
17015 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
17016 @var{address} as an expression.
17017
17018 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
17019 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
17020 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
17021 thus read is kept in addition to the old.
17022
17023 Changes can be reverted using the command @code{remove-symbol-file}.
17024
17025 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
17026 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
17027 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
17028 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
17029 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
17030 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
17031 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
17032 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
17033 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
17034
17035 @itemize @bullet
17036 @item
17037 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
17038 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
17039 @item
17040 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
17041 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
17042 @item
17043 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
17044 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
17045 @end itemize
17046
17047 @noindent
17048 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
17049 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
17050 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
17051 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
17052 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
17053 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
17054 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
17055 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
17056 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
17057 way.
17058
17059 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
17060
17061 @kindex remove-symbol-file
17062 @item remove-symbol-file @var{filename}
17063 @item remove-symbol-file -a @var{address}
17064 Remove a symbol file added via the @code{add-symbol-file} command. The
17065 file to remove can be identified by its @var{filename} or by an @var{address}
17066 that lies within the boundaries of this symbol file in memory. Example:
17067
17068 @smallexample
17069 (gdb) add-symbol-file /home/user/gdb/mylib.so 0x7ffff7ff9480
17070 add symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so" at
17071 .text_addr = 0x7ffff7ff9480
17072 (y or n) y
17073 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/mylib.so...done.
17074 (gdb) remove-symbol-file -a 0x7ffff7ff9480
17075 Remove symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so"? (y or n) y
17076 (gdb)
17077 @end smallexample
17078
17079
17080 @code{remove-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
17081
17082 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
17083 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
17084 @cindex load symbols from memory
17085 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
17086 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
17087 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
17088 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
17089 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
17090 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
17091 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
17092 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
17093 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
17094
17095 @kindex add-shared-symbol-files
17096 @kindex assf
17097 @item add-shared-symbol-files @var{library-file}
17098 @itemx assf @var{library-file}
17099 This command is deprecated and will be removed in future versions
17100 of @value{GDBN}. Use the @code{sharedlibrary} command instead.
17101
17102 The @code{add-shared-symbol-files} command can currently be used only
17103 in the Cygwin build of @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows OS, where it is an
17104 alias for the @code{dll-symbols} command (@pxref{Cygwin Native}).
17105 @value{GDBN} automatically looks for shared libraries, however if
17106 @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can invoke
17107 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}. It takes one argument: the shared
17108 library's file name. @code{assf} is a shorthand alias for
17109 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}.
17110
17111 @kindex section
17112 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
17113 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
17114 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
17115 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
17116 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
17117 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
17118 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
17119 their addresses.
17120
17121 @kindex info files
17122 @kindex info target
17123 @item info files
17124 @itemx info target
17125 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
17126 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
17127 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
17128 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
17129 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
17130 current ones.
17131
17132 @kindex maint info sections
17133 @item maint info sections
17134 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
17135 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
17136 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
17137 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
17138 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
17139 may be arbitrarily combined):
17140
17141 @table @code
17142 @item ALLOBJ
17143 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
17144 @item @var{sections}
17145 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
17146 @item @var{section-flags}
17147 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
17148 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
17149 @table @code
17150 @item ALLOC
17151 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
17152 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
17153 @item LOAD
17154 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
17155 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
17156 @item RELOC
17157 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
17158 @item READONLY
17159 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
17160 @item CODE
17161 Section contains executable code only.
17162 @item DATA
17163 Section contains data only (no executable code).
17164 @item ROM
17165 Section will reside in ROM.
17166 @item CONSTRUCTOR
17167 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
17168 @item HAS_CONTENTS
17169 Section is not empty.
17170 @item NEVER_LOAD
17171 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
17172 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
17173 A notification to the linker that the section contains
17174 COFF shared library information.
17175 @item IS_COMMON
17176 Section contains common symbols.
17177 @end table
17178 @end table
17179 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
17180 @cindex read-only sections
17181 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
17182 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
17183 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
17184 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
17185 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
17186 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
17187 enhancement to debugging performance.
17188
17189 The default is off.
17190
17191 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
17192 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
17193 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
17194 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
17195
17196 @item show trust-readonly-sections
17197 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
17198 @end table
17199
17200 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
17201 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
17202 name and remembers it that way.
17203
17204 @cindex shared libraries
17205 @anchor{Shared Libraries}
17206 @value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix,
17207 and IBM RS/6000 AIX shared libraries.
17208
17209 On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
17210 shared libraries. @xref{Expat}.
17211
17212 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
17213 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
17214 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
17215 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
17216 debugging a core file).
17217
17218 On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
17219 automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
17220
17221 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
17222 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
17223 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
17224
17225 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
17226 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
17227 particularly large or there are many of them.
17228
17229 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
17230 commands:
17231
17232 @table @code
17233 @kindex set auto-solib-add
17234 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
17235 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
17236 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
17237 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
17238 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
17239 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
17240 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
17241
17242 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
17243 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
17244 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
17245 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
17246 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
17247 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
17248 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
17249 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
17250 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
17251
17252 @kindex show auto-solib-add
17253 @item show auto-solib-add
17254 Display the current autoloading mode.
17255 @end table
17256
17257 @cindex load shared library
17258 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
17259 command:
17260
17261 @table @code
17262 @kindex info sharedlibrary
17263 @kindex info share
17264 @item info share @var{regex}
17265 @itemx info sharedlibrary @var{regex}
17266 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded
17267 that match @var{regex}. If @var{regex} is omitted then print
17268 all shared libraries that are loaded.
17269
17270 @kindex sharedlibrary
17271 @kindex share
17272 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
17273 @itemx share @var{regex}
17274 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
17275 Unix regular expression.
17276 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
17277 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
17278 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
17279 loaded.
17280
17281 @item nosharedlibrary
17282 @kindex nosharedlibrary
17283 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
17284 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
17285 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
17286 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
17287 discarded.
17288 @end table
17289
17290 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
17291 when any of shared library events happen. The best way to do this is
17292 to use @code{catch load} and @code{catch unload} (@pxref{Set
17293 Catchpoints}).
17294
17295 @value{GDBN} also supports the the @code{set stop-on-solib-events}
17296 command for this. This command exists for historical reasons. It is
17297 less useful than setting a catchpoint, because it does not allow for
17298 conditions or commands as a catchpoint does.
17299
17300 @table @code
17301 @item set stop-on-solib-events
17302 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
17303 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
17304 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
17305 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
17306 shared library.
17307
17308 @item show stop-on-solib-events
17309 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
17310 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
17311 library events happen.
17312 @end table
17313
17314 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
17315 configurations. @value{GDBN} needs to have access to the target's libraries;
17316 this can be accomplished either by providing copies of the libraries
17317 on the host system, or by asking @value{GDBN} to automatically retrieve the
17318 libraries from the target. If copies of the target libraries are
17319 provided, they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
17320 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
17321 not.
17322
17323 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
17324 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
17325 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
17326 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
17327 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
17328
17329 @table @code
17330 @cindex prefix for shared library file names
17331 @cindex system root, alternate
17332 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
17333 @kindex set sysroot
17334 @item set sysroot @var{path}
17335 Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
17336 absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
17337 runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
17338 target program's memory. If you use @code{set sysroot} to find shared
17339 libraries, they need to be laid out in the same way that they are on
17340 the target, with e.g.@: a @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy
17341 under @var{path}.
17342
17343 If @var{path} starts with the sequence @file{remote:}, @value{GDBN} will
17344 retrieve the target libraries from the remote system. This is only
17345 supported when using a remote target that supports the @code{remote get}
17346 command (@pxref{File Transfer,,Sending files to a remote system}).
17347 The part of @var{path} following the initial @file{remote:}
17348 (if present) is used as system root prefix on the remote file system.
17349 @footnote{If you want to specify a local system root using a directory
17350 that happens to be named @file{remote:}, you need to use some equivalent
17351 variant of the name like @file{./remote:}.}
17352
17353 For targets with an MS-DOS based filesystem, such as MS-Windows and
17354 SymbianOS, @value{GDBN} tries prefixing a few variants of the target
17355 absolute file name with @var{path}. But first, on Unix hosts,
17356 @value{GDBN} converts all backslash directory separators into forward
17357 slashes, because the backslash is not a directory separator on Unix:
17358
17359 @smallexample
17360 c:\foo\bar.dll @result{} c:/foo/bar.dll
17361 @end smallexample
17362
17363 Then, @value{GDBN} attempts prefixing the target file name with
17364 @var{path}, and looks for the resulting file name in the host file
17365 system:
17366
17367 @smallexample
17368 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c:/foo/bar.dll
17369 @end smallexample
17370
17371 If that does not find the shared library, @value{GDBN} tries removing
17372 the @samp{:} character from the drive spec, both for convenience, and,
17373 for the case of the host file system not supporting file names with
17374 colons:
17375
17376 @smallexample
17377 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c/foo/bar.dll
17378 @end smallexample
17379
17380 This makes it possible to have a system root that mirrors a target
17381 with more than one drive. E.g., you may want to setup your local
17382 copies of the target system shared libraries like so (note @samp{c} vs
17383 @samp{z}):
17384
17385 @smallexample
17386 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/foo.dll}
17387 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/bar.dll}
17388 @file{/path/to/sysroot/z/sys/bin/bar.dll}
17389 @end smallexample
17390
17391 @noindent
17392 and point the system root at @file{/path/to/sysroot}, so that
17393 @value{GDBN} can find the correct copies of both
17394 @file{c:\sys\bin\foo.dll}, and @file{z:\sys\bin\bar.dll}.
17395
17396 If that still does not find the shared library, @value{GDBN} tries
17397 removing the whole drive spec from the target file name:
17398
17399 @smallexample
17400 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/foo/bar.dll
17401 @end smallexample
17402
17403 This last lookup makes it possible to not care about the drive name,
17404 if you don't want or need to.
17405
17406 The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
17407 sysroot}.
17408
17409 @cindex default system root
17410 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
17411 You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
17412 @samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
17413 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
17414 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
17415 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
17416 location.
17417
17418 @kindex show sysroot
17419 @item show sysroot
17420 Display the current shared library prefix.
17421
17422 @kindex set solib-search-path
17423 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
17424 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
17425 directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
17426 is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
17427 path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
17428 use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
17429 @samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
17430 finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
17431 it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
17432 of shared library symbols.
17433
17434 @kindex show solib-search-path
17435 @item show solib-search-path
17436 Display the current shared library search path.
17437
17438 @cindex DOS file-name semantics of file names.
17439 @kindex set target-file-system-kind (unix|dos-based|auto)
17440 @kindex show target-file-system-kind
17441 @item set target-file-system-kind @var{kind}
17442 Set assumed file system kind for target reported file names.
17443
17444 Shared library file names as reported by the target system may not
17445 make sense as is on the system @value{GDBN} is running on. For
17446 example, when remote debugging a target that has MS-DOS based file
17447 system semantics, from a Unix host, the target may be reporting to
17448 @value{GDBN} a list of loaded shared libraries with file names such as
17449 @file{c:\Windows\kernel32.dll}. On Unix hosts, there's no concept of
17450 drive letters, so the @samp{c:\} prefix is not normally understood as
17451 indicating an absolute file name, and neither is the backslash
17452 normally considered a directory separator character. In that case,
17453 the native file system would interpret this whole absolute file name
17454 as a relative file name with no directory components. This would make
17455 it impossible to point @value{GDBN} at a copy of the remote target's
17456 shared libraries on the host using @code{set sysroot}, and impractical
17457 with @code{set solib-search-path}. Setting
17458 @code{target-file-system-kind} to @code{dos-based} tells @value{GDBN}
17459 to interpret such file names similarly to how the target would, and to
17460 map them to file names valid on @value{GDBN}'s native file system
17461 semantics. The value of @var{kind} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition
17462 to one of the supported file system kinds. In that case, @value{GDBN}
17463 tries to determine the appropriate file system variant based on the
17464 current target's operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the
17465 Current ABI}). The supported file system settings are:
17466
17467 @table @code
17468 @item unix
17469 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is of Unix
17470 kind. Only file names starting the forward slash (@samp{/}) character
17471 are considered absolute, and the directory separator character is also
17472 the forward slash.
17473
17474 @item dos-based
17475 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is DOS based.
17476 File names starting with either a forward slash, or a drive letter
17477 followed by a colon (e.g., @samp{c:}), are considered absolute, and
17478 both the slash (@samp{/}) and the backslash (@samp{\\}) characters are
17479 considered directory separators.
17480
17481 @item auto
17482 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the file system kind associated with the
17483 target operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
17484 This is the default.
17485 @end table
17486 @end table
17487
17488 @cindex file name canonicalization
17489 @cindex base name differences
17490 When processing file names provided by the user, @value{GDBN}
17491 frequently needs to compare them to the file names recorded in the
17492 program's debug info. Normally, @value{GDBN} compares just the
17493 @dfn{base names} of the files as strings, which is reasonably fast
17494 even for very large programs. (The base name of a file is the last
17495 portion of its name, after stripping all the leading directories.)
17496 This shortcut in comparison is based upon the assumption that files
17497 cannot have more than one base name. This is usually true, but
17498 references to files that use symlinks or similar filesystem
17499 facilities violate that assumption. If your program records files
17500 using such facilities, or if you provide file names to @value{GDBN}
17501 using symlinks etc., you can set @code{basenames-may-differ} to
17502 @code{true} to instruct @value{GDBN} to completely canonicalize each
17503 pair of file names it needs to compare. This will make file-name
17504 comparisons accurate, but at a price of a significant slowdown.
17505
17506 @table @code
17507 @item set basenames-may-differ
17508 @kindex set basenames-may-differ
17509 Set whether a source file may have multiple base names.
17510
17511 @item show basenames-may-differ
17512 @kindex show basenames-may-differ
17513 Show whether a source file may have multiple base names.
17514 @end table
17515
17516 @node Separate Debug Files
17517 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
17518 @cindex separate debugging information files
17519 @cindex debugging information in separate files
17520 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
17521 @cindex debugging information directory, global
17522 @cindex global debugging information directories
17523 @cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
17524 @cindex @file{.build-id} directory
17525
17526 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
17527 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
17528 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
17529 Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
17530 than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
17531 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
17532 install only when they need to debug a problem.
17533
17534 @value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
17535 file:
17536
17537 @itemize @bullet
17538 @item
17539 The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
17540 the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is
17541 usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
17542 name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
17543 (e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the
17544 debug link specifies a 32-bit @dfn{Cyclic Redundancy Check} (CRC)
17545 checksum for the debug file, which @value{GDBN} uses to validate that
17546 the executable and the debug file came from the same build.
17547
17548 @item
17549 The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
17550 also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported
17551 only on some operating systems, notably those which use the ELF format
17552 for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about
17553 this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
17554 command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld.info,
17555 The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified
17556 explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
17557 below.
17558 @end itemize
17559
17560 Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
17561 uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
17562
17563 @itemize @bullet
17564 @item
17565 For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
17566 the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
17567 directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under each one of the global debug
17568 directories, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to the leading
17569 directories of the executable's absolute file name.
17570
17571 @item
17572 For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
17573 @file{.build-id} subdirectory of each one of the global debug directories for
17574 a file named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
17575 first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
17576 are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
17577 hex characters, not 10.)
17578 @end itemize
17579
17580 So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
17581 @file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
17582 file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
17583 @code{abcdef1234}. If the list of the global debug directories includes
17584 @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
17585 debug information files, in the indicated order:
17586
17587 @itemize @minus
17588 @item
17589 @file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
17590 @item
17591 @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
17592 @item
17593 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
17594 @item
17595 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
17596 @end itemize
17597
17598 @anchor{debug-file-directory}
17599 Global debugging info directories default to what is set by @value{GDBN}
17600 configure option @option{--with-separate-debug-dir}. During @value{GDBN} run
17601 you can also set the global debugging info directories, and view the list
17602 @value{GDBN} is currently using.
17603
17604 @table @code
17605
17606 @kindex set debug-file-directory
17607 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directories}
17608 Set the directories which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
17609 information files to @var{directory}. Multiple path components can be set
17610 concatenating them by a path separator.
17611
17612 @kindex show debug-file-directory
17613 @item show debug-file-directory
17614 Show the directories @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
17615 information files.
17616
17617 @end table
17618
17619 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
17620 @cindex debug link sections
17621 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
17622 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
17623
17624 @itemize
17625 @item
17626 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
17627 a zero byte,
17628 @item
17629 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
17630 boundary within the section, and
17631 @item
17632 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
17633 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
17634 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
17635 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
17636 @end itemize
17637
17638 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
17639 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
17640 described above.
17641
17642 @cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
17643 @cindex build ID sections
17644 The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
17645 ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is
17646 often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
17647 It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
17648 the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default
17649 algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
17650 content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical
17651 value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
17652 stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
17653
17654 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
17655 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
17656 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
17657 should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
17658 but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
17659 in an ordinary executable.
17660
17661 The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
17662 @samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
17663 the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
17664 following commands:
17665
17666 @smallexample
17667 @kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
17668 @kbd{strip -g foo}
17669 @end smallexample
17670
17671 @noindent
17672 These commands remove the debugging
17673 information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
17674 @file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
17675 two files:
17676
17677 @itemize @bullet
17678 @item
17679 The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
17680 behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
17681
17682 @smallexample
17683 @kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
17684 @end smallexample
17685
17686 Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
17687 a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
17688 foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
17689 the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
17690
17691 @item
17692 Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
17693 the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus
17694 compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
17695 utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
17696 @end itemize
17697
17698 @noindent
17699
17700 @cindex CRC algorithm definition
17701 The CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} is the CRC-32 defined in
17702 IEEE 802.3 using the polynomial:
17703
17704 @c TexInfo requires naked braces for multi-digit exponents for Tex
17705 @c output, but this causes HTML output to barf. HTML has to be set using
17706 @c raw commands. So we end up having to specify this equation in 2
17707 @c different ways!
17708 @ifhtml
17709 @display
17710 @html
17711 <em>x</em><sup>32</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>26</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>23</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>22</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>16</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>12</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>11</sup>
17712 + <em>x</em><sup>10</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>8</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>7</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>5</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>4</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>2</sup> + <em>x</em> + 1
17713 @end html
17714 @end display
17715 @end ifhtml
17716 @ifnothtml
17717 @display
17718 @math{x^{32} + x^{26} + x^{23} + x^{22} + x^{16} + x^{12} + x^{11}}
17719 @math{+ x^{10} + x^8 + x^7 + x^5 + x^4 + x^2 + x + 1}
17720 @end display
17721 @end ifnothtml
17722
17723 The function is computed byte at a time, taking the least
17724 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern
17725 @code{0xffffffff} is used, to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC and
17726 the final result is inverted to ensure trailing zeros also affect the
17727 CRC.
17728
17729 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC polynomial as used in handling the
17730 @dfn{Remote Serial Protocol} @code{qCRC} packet (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
17731 However in the case of the Remote Serial Protocol, the CRC is computed
17732 @emph{most} significant bit first, and the result is not inverted, so
17733 trailing zeros have no effect on the CRC value.
17734
17735 To complete the description, we show below the code of the function
17736 which produces the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}. Inverting the
17737 initially supplied @code{crc} argument means that an initial call to
17738 this function passing in zero will start computing the CRC using
17739 @code{0xffffffff}.
17740
17741 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
17742 @smallexample
17743 unsigned long
17744 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
17745 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
17746 @{
17747 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
17748 @{
17749 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
17750 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
17751 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
17752 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
17753 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
17754 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
17755 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
17756 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
17757 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
17758 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
17759 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
17760 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
17761 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
17762 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
17763 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
17764 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
17765 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
17766 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
17767 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
17768 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
17769 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
17770 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
17771 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
17772 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
17773 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
17774 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
17775 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
17776 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
17777 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
17778 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
17779 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
17780 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
17781 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
17782 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
17783 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
17784 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
17785 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
17786 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
17787 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
17788 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
17789 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
17790 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
17791 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
17792 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
17793 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
17794 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
17795 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
17796 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
17797 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
17798 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
17799 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
17800 0x2d02ef8d
17801 @};
17802 unsigned char *end;
17803
17804 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
17805 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
17806 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
17807 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
17808 @}
17809 @end smallexample
17810
17811 @noindent
17812 This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
17813
17814 @node MiniDebugInfo
17815 @section Debugging information in a special section
17816 @cindex separate debug sections
17817 @cindex @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section
17818
17819 Some systems ship pre-built executables and libraries that have a
17820 special @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section. This feature is called
17821 @dfn{MiniDebugInfo}. This section holds an LZMA-compressed object and
17822 is used to supply extra symbols for backtraces.
17823
17824 The intent of this section is to provide extra minimal debugging
17825 information for use in simple backtraces. It is not intended to be a
17826 replacement for full separate debugging information (@pxref{Separate
17827 Debug Files}). The example below shows the intended use; however,
17828 @value{GDBN} does not currently put restrictions on what sort of
17829 debugging information might be included in the section.
17830
17831 @value{GDBN} has support for this extension. If the section exists,
17832 then it is used provided that no other source of debugging information
17833 can be found, and that @value{GDBN} was configured with LZMA support.
17834
17835 This section can be easily created using @command{objcopy} and other
17836 standard utilities:
17837
17838 @smallexample
17839 # Extract the dynamic symbols from the main binary, there is no need
17840 # to also have these in the normal symbol table.
17841 nm -D @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
17842 | awk '@{ print $1 @}' | sort > dynsyms
17843
17844 # Extract all the text (i.e. function) symbols from the debuginfo.
17845 # (Note that we actually also accept "D" symbols, for the benefit
17846 # of platforms like PowerPC64 that use function descriptors.)
17847 nm @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
17848 | awk '@{ if ($2 == "T" || $2 == "t" || $2 == "D") print $1 @}' \
17849 | sort > funcsyms
17850
17851 # Keep all the function symbols not already in the dynamic symbol
17852 # table.
17853 comm -13 dynsyms funcsyms > keep_symbols
17854
17855 # Separate full debug info into debug binary.
17856 objcopy --only-keep-debug @var{binary} debug
17857
17858 # Copy the full debuginfo, keeping only a minimal set of symbols and
17859 # removing some unnecessary sections.
17860 objcopy -S --remove-section .gdb_index --remove-section .comment \
17861 --keep-symbols=keep_symbols debug mini_debuginfo
17862
17863 # Drop the full debug info from the original binary.
17864 strip --strip-all -R .comment @var{binary}
17865
17866 # Inject the compressed data into the .gnu_debugdata section of the
17867 # original binary.
17868 xz mini_debuginfo
17869 objcopy --add-section .gnu_debugdata=mini_debuginfo.xz @var{binary}
17870 @end smallexample
17871
17872 @node Index Files
17873 @section Index Files Speed Up @value{GDBN}
17874 @cindex index files
17875 @cindex @samp{.gdb_index} section
17876
17877 When @value{GDBN} finds a symbol file, it scans the symbols in the
17878 file in order to construct an internal symbol table. This lets most
17879 @value{GDBN} operations work quickly---at the cost of a delay early
17880 on. For large programs, this delay can be quite lengthy, so
17881 @value{GDBN} provides a way to build an index, which speeds up
17882 startup.
17883
17884 The index is stored as a section in the symbol file. @value{GDBN} can
17885 write the index to a file, then you can put it into the symbol file
17886 using @command{objcopy}.
17887
17888 To create an index file, use the @code{save gdb-index} command:
17889
17890 @table @code
17891 @item save gdb-index @var{directory}
17892 @kindex save gdb-index
17893 Create an index file for each symbol file currently known by
17894 @value{GDBN}. Each file is named after its corresponding symbol file,
17895 with @samp{.gdb-index} appended, and is written into the given
17896 @var{directory}.
17897 @end table
17898
17899 Once you have created an index file you can merge it into your symbol
17900 file, here named @file{symfile}, using @command{objcopy}:
17901
17902 @smallexample
17903 $ objcopy --add-section .gdb_index=symfile.gdb-index \
17904 --set-section-flags .gdb_index=readonly symfile symfile
17905 @end smallexample
17906
17907 @value{GDBN} will normally ignore older versions of @file{.gdb_index}
17908 sections that have been deprecated. Usually they are deprecated because
17909 they are missing a new feature or have performance issues.
17910 To tell @value{GDBN} to use a deprecated index section anyway
17911 specify @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
17912 The default is @code{off}.
17913 This can speed up startup, but may result in some functionality being lost.
17914 @xref{Index Section Format}.
17915
17916 @emph{Warning:} Setting @code{use-deprecated-index-sections} to @code{on}
17917 must be done before gdb reads the file. The following will not work:
17918
17919 @smallexample
17920 $ gdb -ex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
17921 @end smallexample
17922
17923 Instead you must do, for example,
17924
17925 @smallexample
17926 $ gdb -iex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
17927 @end smallexample
17928
17929 There are currently some limitation on indices. They only work when
17930 for DWARF debugging information, not stabs. And, they do not
17931 currently work for programs using Ada.
17932
17933 @node Symbol Errors
17934 @section Errors Reading Symbol Files
17935
17936 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
17937 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
17938 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
17939 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
17940 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
17941 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
17942 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
17943 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
17944 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
17945 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
17946 Messages}).
17947
17948 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
17949
17950 @table @code
17951 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
17952
17953 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
17954 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
17955 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
17956 in its outer scope blocks.
17957
17958 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
17959 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
17960 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
17961 function.
17962
17963 @item block at @var{address} out of order
17964
17965 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
17966 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
17967 do so.
17968
17969 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
17970 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
17971 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
17972 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
17973 Messages}.)
17974
17975 @item bad block start address patched
17976
17977 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
17978 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
17979 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
17980
17981 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
17982 starting on the previous source line.
17983
17984 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
17985
17986 @cindex foo
17987 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
17988 larger than the size of the string table.
17989
17990 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
17991 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
17992 with this name.
17993
17994 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
17995
17996 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
17997 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
17998 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
17999
18000 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
18001 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
18002 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
18003 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
18004 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
18005 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
18006
18007 @item stub type has NULL name
18008
18009 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
18010
18011 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
18012 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
18013 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
18014 it.
18015
18016 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
18017
18018 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
18019
18020 @end table
18021
18022 @node Data Files
18023 @section GDB Data Files
18024
18025 @cindex prefix for data files
18026 @value{GDBN} will sometimes read an auxiliary data file. These files
18027 are kept in a directory known as the @dfn{data directory}.
18028
18029 You can set the data directory's name, and view the name @value{GDBN}
18030 is currently using.
18031
18032 @table @code
18033 @kindex set data-directory
18034 @item set data-directory @var{directory}
18035 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files
18036 to @var{directory}.
18037
18038 @kindex show data-directory
18039 @item show data-directory
18040 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files.
18041 @end table
18042
18043 @cindex default data directory
18044 @cindex @samp{--with-gdb-datadir}
18045 You can set the default data directory by using the configure-time
18046 @samp{--with-gdb-datadir} option. If the data directory is inside
18047 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
18048 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default data directory will be updated
18049 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
18050 location.
18051
18052 The data directory may also be specified with the
18053 @code{--data-directory} command line option.
18054 @xref{Mode Options}.
18055
18056 @node Targets
18057 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
18058
18059 @cindex debugging target
18060 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
18061
18062 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
18063 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
18064 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
18065 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
18066 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
18067 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
18068 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
18069 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
18070
18071 @cindex target architecture
18072 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
18073 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
18074 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
18075 command.
18076
18077 @table @code
18078 @kindex set architecture
18079 @kindex show architecture
18080 @item set architecture @var{arch}
18081 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
18082 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
18083 supported architectures.
18084
18085 @item show architecture
18086 Show the current target architecture.
18087
18088 @item set processor
18089 @itemx processor
18090 @kindex set processor
18091 @kindex show processor
18092 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
18093 and @code{show architecture}.
18094 @end table
18095
18096 @menu
18097 * Active Targets:: Active targets
18098 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
18099 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
18100 @end menu
18101
18102 @node Active Targets
18103 @section Active Targets
18104
18105 @cindex stacking targets
18106 @cindex active targets
18107 @cindex multiple targets
18108
18109 There are multiple classes of targets such as: processes, executable files or
18110 recording sessions. Core files belong to the process class, making core file
18111 and process mutually exclusive. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} can work concurrently
18112 on multiple active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for
18113 example) start a process and inspect its activity, while still having access to
18114 the executable file after the process finishes. Or if you start process
18115 recording (@pxref{Reverse Execution}) and @code{reverse-step} there, you are
18116 presented a virtual layer of the recording target, while the process target
18117 remains stopped at the chronologically last point of the process execution.
18118
18119 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new core
18120 file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}). To
18121 specify as a target a process that is already running, use the @code{attach}
18122 command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
18123
18124 @node Target Commands
18125 @section Commands for Managing Targets
18126
18127 @table @code
18128 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
18129 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
18130 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
18131 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
18132 protocol of the target machine.
18133
18134 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
18135 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
18136 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
18137
18138 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
18139 after executing the command.
18140
18141 @kindex help target
18142 @item help target
18143 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
18144 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
18145 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
18146
18147 @item help target @var{name}
18148 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
18149 select it.
18150
18151 @kindex set gnutarget
18152 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
18153 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
18154 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
18155 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
18156 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
18157 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
18158
18159 @quotation
18160 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
18161 you must know the actual BFD name.
18162 @end quotation
18163
18164 @noindent
18165 @xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
18166
18167 @kindex show gnutarget
18168 @item show gnutarget
18169 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
18170 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
18171 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
18172 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BFD target is "auto"}.
18173 @end table
18174
18175 @cindex common targets
18176 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
18177 configuration):
18178
18179 @table @code
18180 @kindex target
18181 @item target exec @var{program}
18182 @cindex executable file target
18183 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
18184 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
18185
18186 @item target core @var{filename}
18187 @cindex core dump file target
18188 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
18189 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
18190
18191 @item target remote @var{medium}
18192 @cindex remote target
18193 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
18194 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
18195 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
18196
18197 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
18198 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
18199
18200 @smallexample
18201 target remote /dev/ttya
18202 @end smallexample
18203
18204 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
18205 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
18206 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
18207 clobbered by the download.
18208
18209 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
18210 @cindex built-in simulator target
18211 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
18212 In general,
18213 @smallexample
18214 target sim
18215 load
18216 run
18217 @end smallexample
18218 @noindent
18219 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
18220 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
18221 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
18222 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
18223 Processors}.
18224
18225 @item target native
18226 @cindex native target
18227 Setup for local/native process debugging. Useful to make the
18228 @code{run} command spawn native processes (likewise @code{attach},
18229 etc.@:) even when @code{set auto-connect-native-target} is @code{off}
18230 (@pxref{set auto-connect-native-target}).
18231
18232 @end table
18233
18234 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
18235 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
18236
18237 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
18238 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
18239 various aspects of this process.
18240
18241 @table @code
18242
18243 @item set hash
18244 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
18245 @cindex hash mark while downloading
18246 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
18247 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
18248 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
18249 monitor.
18250
18251 @item show hash
18252 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
18253 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
18254
18255 @item set debug monitor
18256 @kindex set debug monitor
18257 @cindex display remote monitor communications
18258 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
18259 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
18260
18261 @item show debug monitor
18262 @kindex show debug monitor
18263 Show the current status of displaying communications between
18264 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
18265 @end table
18266
18267 @table @code
18268
18269 @kindex load @var{filename}
18270 @item load @var{filename}
18271 @anchor{load}
18272 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
18273 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
18274 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
18275 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
18276 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
18277 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
18278
18279 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
18280 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
18281 target is @dots{}}''
18282
18283 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
18284 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
18285 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
18286 specifies a fixed address.
18287 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
18288
18289 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
18290 load programs into flash memory.
18291
18292 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
18293 @end table
18294
18295 @node Byte Order
18296 @section Choosing Target Byte Order
18297
18298 @cindex choosing target byte order
18299 @cindex target byte order
18300
18301 Some types of processors, such as the @acronym{MIPS}, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
18302 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
18303 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
18304 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
18305 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
18306 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
18307
18308 @table @code
18309 @kindex set endian
18310 @item set endian big
18311 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
18312
18313 @item set endian little
18314 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
18315
18316 @item set endian auto
18317 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
18318 executable.
18319
18320 @item show endian
18321 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
18322
18323 @end table
18324
18325 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
18326 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
18327 target system.
18328
18329
18330 @node Remote Debugging
18331 @chapter Debugging Remote Programs
18332 @cindex remote debugging
18333
18334 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
18335 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
18336 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
18337 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
18338 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
18339
18340 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
18341 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
18342 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
18343 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
18344 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
18345 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
18346
18347 Other remote targets may be available in your
18348 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
18349
18350 @menu
18351 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
18352 * File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system
18353 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
18354 * Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
18355 * Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
18356 @end menu
18357
18358 @node Connecting
18359 @section Connecting to a Remote Target
18360
18361 On the @value{GDBN} host machine, you will need an unstripped copy of
18362 your program, since @value{GDBN} needs symbol and debugging information.
18363 Start up @value{GDBN} as usual, using the name of the local copy of your
18364 program as the first argument.
18365
18366 @cindex @code{target remote}
18367 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or
18368 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
18369 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
18370 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
18371 @code{target remote} command establishes a connection to the target.
18372 Its arguments indicate which medium to use:
18373
18374 @table @code
18375
18376 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
18377 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
18378 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
18379 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
18380
18381 @smallexample
18382 target remote /dev/ttyb
18383 @end smallexample
18384
18385 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
18386 @samp{--baud} option, or use the @code{set serial baud} command
18387 (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set serial baud}) before the
18388 @code{target} command.
18389
18390 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
18391 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
18392 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
18393 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
18394 The @var{host} may be either a host name or a numeric @acronym{IP}
18395 address; @var{port} must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be
18396 the target machine itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or
18397 it might be a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
18398 target.
18399
18400 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
18401 @code{manyfarms}:
18402
18403 @smallexample
18404 target remote manyfarms:2828
18405 @end smallexample
18406
18407 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
18408 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
18409 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
18410 port 1234 on your local machine:
18411
18412 @smallexample
18413 target remote :1234
18414 @end smallexample
18415 @noindent
18416
18417 Note that the colon is still required here.
18418
18419 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
18420 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
18421 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
18422 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
18423
18424 @smallexample
18425 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
18426 @end smallexample
18427
18428 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
18429 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
18430 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
18431 cause havoc with your debugging session.
18432
18433 @item target remote | @var{command}
18434 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
18435 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
18436 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
18437 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
18438 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
18439 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
18440 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
18441 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
18442
18443 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
18444 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
18445 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
18446
18447 @end table
18448
18449 Once the connection has been established, you can use all the usual
18450 commands to examine and change data. The remote program is already
18451 running; you can use @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue}, and you do not
18452 need to use @kbd{run}.
18453
18454 @cindex interrupting remote programs
18455 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
18456 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
18457 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
18458 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
18459 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
18460 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
18461
18462 @smallexample
18463 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
18464 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
18465 @end smallexample
18466
18467 If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
18468 (If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
18469 remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
18470 goes back to waiting.
18471
18472 @table @code
18473 @kindex detach (remote)
18474 @item detach
18475 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
18476 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
18477 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
18478 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
18479 command, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to another target.
18480
18481 @kindex disconnect
18482 @item disconnect
18483 The @code{disconnect} command behaves like @code{detach}, except that
18484 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
18485 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
18486 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
18487 another target.
18488
18489 @cindex send command to remote monitor
18490 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
18491 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
18492 @kindex monitor
18493 @item monitor @var{cmd}
18494 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
18495 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
18496 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
18497 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
18498 and implement.
18499 @end table
18500
18501 @node File Transfer
18502 @section Sending files to a remote system
18503 @cindex remote target, file transfer
18504 @cindex file transfer
18505 @cindex sending files to remote systems
18506
18507 Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same
18508 connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient
18509 for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems
18510 running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets,
18511 e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be
18512 the only way to upload or download files.
18513
18514 Not all remote targets support these commands.
18515
18516 @table @code
18517 @kindex remote put
18518 @item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
18519 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
18520 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
18521
18522 @kindex remote get
18523 @item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
18524 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
18525 on the host system.
18526
18527 @kindex remote delete
18528 @item remote delete @var{targetfile}
18529 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
18530
18531 @end table
18532
18533 @node Server
18534 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
18535
18536 @kindex gdbserver
18537 @cindex remote connection without stubs
18538 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
18539 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
18540 @code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
18541
18542 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
18543 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
18544 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
18545 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
18546 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
18547 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
18548 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
18549 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
18550 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
18551 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
18552 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
18553 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
18554 choice for debugging.
18555
18556 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
18557 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
18558 protocol.
18559
18560 @quotation
18561 @emph{Warning:} @code{gdbserver} does not have any built-in security.
18562 Do not run @code{gdbserver} connected to any public network; a
18563 @value{GDBN} connection to @code{gdbserver} provides access to the
18564 target system with the same privileges as the user running
18565 @code{gdbserver}.
18566 @end quotation
18567
18568 @subsection Running @code{gdbserver}
18569 @cindex arguments, to @code{gdbserver}
18570 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, command-line arguments
18571
18572 Run @code{gdbserver} on the target system. You need a copy of the
18573 program you want to debug, including any libraries it requires.
18574 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
18575 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
18576 system does all the symbol handling.
18577
18578 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
18579 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
18580 syntax is:
18581
18582 @smallexample
18583 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
18584 @end smallexample
18585
18586 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line), or a TCP
18587 hostname and portnumber, or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
18588 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}.
18589 For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
18590 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
18591 @file{/dev/com1}:
18592
18593 @smallexample
18594 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
18595 @end smallexample
18596
18597 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
18598 with it.
18599
18600 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
18601
18602 @smallexample
18603 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
18604 @end smallexample
18605
18606 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
18607 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
18608 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
18609 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
18610 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
18611 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
18612 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
18613 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
18614 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
18615 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
18616 @code{target remote} command.
18617
18618 The @code{stdio} connection is useful when starting @code{gdbserver}
18619 with ssh:
18620
18621 @smallexample
18622 (gdb) target remote | ssh -T hostname gdbserver - hello
18623 @end smallexample
18624
18625 The @samp{-T} option to ssh is provided because we don't need a remote pty,
18626 and we don't want escape-character handling. Ssh does this by default when
18627 a command is provided, the flag is provided to make it explicit.
18628 You could elide it if you want to.
18629
18630 Programs started with stdio-connected gdbserver have @file{/dev/null} for
18631 @code{stdin}, and @code{stdout},@code{stderr} are sent back to gdb for
18632 display through a pipe connected to gdbserver.
18633 Both @code{stdout} and @code{stderr} use the same pipe.
18634
18635 @subsubsection Attaching to a Running Program
18636 @cindex attach to a program, @code{gdbserver}
18637 @cindex @option{--attach}, @code{gdbserver} option
18638
18639 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
18640 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
18641
18642 @smallexample
18643 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
18644 @end smallexample
18645
18646 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't necessary
18647 to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
18648
18649 @pindex pidof
18650 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
18651 @code{pidof} utility:
18652
18653 @smallexample
18654 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} `pidof @var{program}`
18655 @end smallexample
18656
18657 In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
18658 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
18659 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
18660
18661 @subsubsection Multi-Process Mode for @code{gdbserver}
18662 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, multiple processes
18663 @cindex multiple processes with @code{gdbserver}
18664
18665 When you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target remote},
18666 @code{gdbserver} debugs the specified program only once. When the
18667 program exits, or you detach from it, @value{GDBN} closes the connection
18668 and @code{gdbserver} exits.
18669
18670 If you connect using @kbd{target extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver}
18671 enters multi-process mode. When the debugged program exits, or you
18672 detach from it, @value{GDBN} stays connected to @code{gdbserver} even
18673 though no program is running. The @code{run} and @code{attach}
18674 commands instruct @code{gdbserver} to run or attach to a new program.
18675 The @code{run} command uses @code{set remote exec-file} (@pxref{set
18676 remote exec-file}) to select the program to run. Command line
18677 arguments are supported, except for wildcard expansion and I/O
18678 redirection (@pxref{Arguments}).
18679
18680 @cindex @option{--multi}, @code{gdbserver} option
18681 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
18682 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
18683 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
18684 the program you want to debug.
18685
18686 In multi-process mode @code{gdbserver} does not automatically exit unless you
18687 use the option @option{--once}. You can terminate it by using
18688 @code{monitor exit} (@pxref{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}). Note that the
18689 conditions under which @code{gdbserver} terminates depend on how @value{GDBN}
18690 connects to it (@kbd{target remote} or @kbd{target extended-remote}). The
18691 @option{--multi} option to @code{gdbserver} has no influence on that.
18692
18693 @subsubsection TCP port allocation lifecycle of @code{gdbserver}
18694
18695 This section applies only when @code{gdbserver} is run to listen on a TCP port.
18696
18697 @code{gdbserver} normally terminates after all of its debugged processes have
18698 terminated in @kbd{target remote} mode. On the other hand, for @kbd{target
18699 extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver} stays running even with no processes left.
18700 @value{GDBN} normally terminates the spawned debugged process on its exit,
18701 which normally also terminates @code{gdbserver} in the @kbd{target remote}
18702 mode. Therefore, when the connection drops unexpectedly, and @value{GDBN}
18703 cannot ask @code{gdbserver} to kill its debugged processes, @code{gdbserver}
18704 stays running even in the @kbd{target remote} mode.
18705
18706 When @code{gdbserver} stays running, @value{GDBN} can connect to it again later.
18707 Such reconnecting is useful for features like @ref{disconnected tracing}. For
18708 completeness, at most one @value{GDBN} can be connected at a time.
18709
18710 @cindex @option{--once}, @code{gdbserver} option
18711 By default, @code{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
18712 subsequent connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
18713 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
18714 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session. This
18715 means no further connections to @code{gdbserver} will be possible after the
18716 first one. It also means @code{gdbserver} will terminate after the first
18717 connection with remote @value{GDBN} has closed, even for unexpectedly closed
18718 connections and even in the @kbd{target extended-remote} mode. The
18719 @option{--once} option allows reusing the same port number for connecting to
18720 multiple instances of @code{gdbserver} running on the same host, since each
18721 instance closes its port after the first connection.
18722
18723 @anchor{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}
18724 @subsubsection Other Command-Line Arguments for @code{gdbserver}
18725
18726 @cindex @option{--debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
18727 The @option{--debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display extra
18728 status information about the debugging process.
18729 @cindex @option{--remote-debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
18730 The @option{--remote-debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display
18731 remote protocol debug output. These options are intended for
18732 @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to the developers.
18733
18734 @cindex @option{--debug-format}, @code{gdbserver} option
18735 The @option{--debug-format=option1[,option2,...]} option tells
18736 @code{gdbserver} to include additional information in each output.
18737 Possible options are:
18738
18739 @table @code
18740 @item none
18741 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
18742 @item all
18743 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
18744 @item timestamps
18745 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
18746 @end table
18747
18748 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
18749 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
18750
18751 @cindex @option{--wrapper}, @code{gdbserver} option
18752 The @option{--wrapper} option specifies a wrapper to launch programs
18753 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
18754 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
18755 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
18756
18757 @code{gdbserver} runs the specified wrapper program with a combined
18758 command line including the wrapper arguments, then the name of the
18759 program to debug, then any arguments to the program. The wrapper
18760 runs until it executes your program, and then @value{GDBN} gains control.
18761
18762 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
18763 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
18764 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
18765 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
18766
18767 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
18768 the debugged program, without setting the variable in @code{gdbserver}'s
18769 environment:
18770
18771 @smallexample
18772 $ gdbserver --wrapper env LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so -- :2222 ./testprog
18773 @end smallexample
18774
18775 @subsection Connecting to @code{gdbserver}
18776
18777 Run @value{GDBN} on the host system.
18778
18779 First make sure you have the necessary symbol files. Load symbols for
18780 your application using the @code{file} command before you connect. Use
18781 @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN}
18782 was compiled with the correct sysroot using @code{--with-sysroot}).
18783
18784 The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
18785 and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
18786 system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
18787 are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
18788 during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
18789 files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
18790 programs.
18791
18792 Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
18793 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
18794 the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
18795 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
18796 @samp{Connection refused}. Don't use the @code{load}
18797 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{gdbserver}, since the program is
18798 already on the target.
18799
18800 @subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
18801 @cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
18802 @anchor{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}
18803
18804 During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
18805 @code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
18806 Here are the available commands.
18807
18808 @table @code
18809 @item monitor help
18810 List the available monitor commands.
18811
18812 @item monitor set debug 0
18813 @itemx monitor set debug 1
18814 Disable or enable general debugging messages.
18815
18816 @item monitor set remote-debug 0
18817 @itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
18818 Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
18819 protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
18820
18821 @item monitor set debug-format option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
18822 Specify additional text to add to debugging messages.
18823 Possible options are:
18824
18825 @table @code
18826 @item none
18827 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
18828 @item all
18829 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
18830 @item timestamps
18831 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
18832 @end table
18833
18834 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
18835 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
18836
18837 @item monitor set libthread-db-search-path [PATH]
18838 @cindex gdbserver, search path for @code{libthread_db}
18839 When this command is issued, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
18840 directories to search for @code{libthread_db} (@pxref{Threads,,set
18841 libthread-db-search-path}). If you omit @var{path},
18842 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to its default value.
18843
18844 The special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path} is
18845 not supported in @code{gdbserver}.
18846
18847 @item monitor exit
18848 Tell gdbserver to exit immediately. This command should be followed by
18849 @code{disconnect} to close the debugging session. @code{gdbserver} will
18850 detach from any attached processes and kill any processes it created.
18851 Use @code{monitor exit} to terminate @code{gdbserver} at the end
18852 of a multi-process mode debug session.
18853
18854 @end table
18855
18856 @subsection Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
18857 @cindex tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
18858
18859 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints, fast
18860 tracepoints and static tracepoints.
18861
18862 For fast or static tracepoints to work, a special library called the
18863 @dfn{in-process agent} (IPA), must be loaded in the inferior process.
18864 This library is built and distributed as an integral part of
18865 @code{gdbserver}. In addition, support for static tracepoints
18866 requires building the in-process agent library with static tracepoints
18867 support. At present, the UST (LTTng Userspace Tracer,
18868 @url{http://lttng.org/ust}) tracing engine is supported. This support
18869 is automatically available if UST development headers are found in the
18870 standard include path when @code{gdbserver} is built, or if
18871 @code{gdbserver} was explicitly configured using @option{--with-ust}
18872 to point at such headers. You can explicitly disable the support
18873 using @option{--with-ust=no}.
18874
18875 There are several ways to load the in-process agent in your program:
18876
18877 @table @code
18878 @item Specifying it as dependency at link time
18879
18880 You can link your program dynamically with the in-process agent
18881 library. On most systems, this is accomplished by adding
18882 @code{-linproctrace} to the link command.
18883
18884 @item Using the system's preloading mechanisms
18885
18886 You can force loading the in-process agent at startup time by using
18887 your system's support for preloading shared libraries. Many Unixes
18888 support the concept of preloading user defined libraries. In most
18889 cases, you do that by specifying @code{LD_PRELOAD=libinproctrace.so}
18890 in the environment. See also the description of @code{gdbserver}'s
18891 @option{--wrapper} command line option.
18892
18893 @item Using @value{GDBN} to force loading the agent at run time
18894
18895 On some systems, you can force the inferior to load a shared library,
18896 by calling a dynamic loader function in the inferior that takes care
18897 of dynamically looking up and loading a shared library. On most Unix
18898 systems, the function is @code{dlopen}. You'll use the @code{call}
18899 command for that. For example:
18900
18901 @smallexample
18902 (@value{GDBP}) call dlopen ("libinproctrace.so", ...)
18903 @end smallexample
18904
18905 Note that on most Unix systems, for the @code{dlopen} function to be
18906 available, the program needs to be linked with @code{-ldl}.
18907 @end table
18908
18909 On systems that have a userspace dynamic loader, like most Unix
18910 systems, when you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target
18911 remote}, you'll find that the program is stopped at the dynamic
18912 loader's entry point, and no shared library has been loaded in the
18913 program's address space yet, including the in-process agent. In that
18914 case, before being able to use any of the fast or static tracepoints
18915 features, you need to let the loader run and load the shared
18916 libraries. The simplest way to do that is to run the program to the
18917 main procedure. E.g., if debugging a C or C@t{++} program, start
18918 @code{gdbserver} like so:
18919
18920 @smallexample
18921 $ gdbserver :9999 myprogram
18922 @end smallexample
18923
18924 Start GDB and connect to @code{gdbserver} like so, and run to main:
18925
18926 @smallexample
18927 $ gdb myprogram
18928 (@value{GDBP}) target remote myhost:9999
18929 0x00007f215893ba60 in ?? () from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
18930 (@value{GDBP}) b main
18931 (@value{GDBP}) continue
18932 @end smallexample
18933
18934 The in-process tracing agent library should now be loaded into the
18935 process; you can confirm it with the @code{info sharedlibrary}
18936 command, which will list @file{libinproctrace.so} as loaded in the
18937 process. You are now ready to install fast tracepoints, list static
18938 tracepoint markers, probe static tracepoints markers, and start
18939 tracing.
18940
18941 @node Remote Configuration
18942 @section Remote Configuration
18943
18944 @kindex set remote
18945 @kindex show remote
18946 This section documents the configuration options available when
18947 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
18948 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
18949 system-call-allowed}.
18950
18951 @table @code
18952 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
18953 @cindex address size for remote targets
18954 @cindex bits in remote address
18955 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
18956 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
18957 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
18958 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
18959
18960 @item show remoteaddresssize
18961 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
18962
18963 @item set serial baud @var{n}
18964 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
18965 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
18966 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
18967 remote targets.
18968
18969 @item show serial baud
18970 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
18971
18972 @item set remotebreak
18973 @cindex interrupt remote programs
18974 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
18975 @anchor{set remotebreak}
18976 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
18977 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
18978 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
18979 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
18980 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
18981
18982 @item show remotebreak
18983 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
18984 interrupt the remote program.
18985
18986 @item set remoteflow on
18987 @itemx set remoteflow off
18988 @kindex set remoteflow
18989 Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
18990 on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
18991
18992 @item show remoteflow
18993 @kindex show remoteflow
18994 Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
18995
18996 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
18997 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
18998 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
18999 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
19000 @code{ascii}.
19001
19002 @item show remotelogbase
19003 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
19004 protocol.
19005
19006 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
19007 @cindex record serial communications on file
19008 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
19009 default is not to record at all.
19010
19011 @item show remotelogfile.
19012 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
19013 serial communications.
19014
19015 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
19016 @cindex timeout for serial communications
19017 @cindex remote timeout
19018 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
19019 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
19020
19021 @item show remotetimeout
19022 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
19023 responses.
19024
19025 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
19026 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
19027 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
19028 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
19029 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
19030 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
19031 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
19032 watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
19033
19034 @cindex limit hardware watchpoints length
19035 @cindex remote target, limit watchpoints length
19036 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit}
19037 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit @var{limit}
19038 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} bytes for the maximum length of
19039 a remote hardware watchpoint. A limit of -1, the default, is treated
19040 as unlimited.
19041
19042 @item show remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit
19043 Show the current limit (in bytes) of the maximum length of
19044 a remote hardware watchpoint.
19045
19046 @item set remote exec-file @var{filename}
19047 @itemx show remote exec-file
19048 @anchor{set remote exec-file}
19049 @cindex executable file, for remote target
19050 Select the file used for @code{run} with @code{target
19051 extended-remote}. This should be set to a filename valid on the
19052 target system. If it is not set, the target will use a default
19053 filename (e.g.@: the last program run).
19054
19055 @item set remote interrupt-sequence
19056 @cindex interrupt remote programs
19057 @cindex select Ctrl-C, BREAK or BREAK-g
19058 Allow the user to select one of @samp{Ctrl-C}, a @code{BREAK} or
19059 @samp{BREAK-g} as the
19060 sequence to the remote target in order to interrupt the execution.
19061 @samp{Ctrl-C} is a default. Some system prefers @code{BREAK} which
19062 is high level of serial line for some certain time.
19063 Linux kernel prefers @samp{BREAK-g}, a.k.a Magic SysRq g.
19064 It is @code{BREAK} signal followed by character @code{g}.
19065
19066 @item show interrupt-sequence
19067 Show which of @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or @code{BREAK-g}
19068 is sent by @value{GDBN} to interrupt the remote program.
19069 @code{BREAK-g} is BREAK signal followed by @code{g} and
19070 also known as Magic SysRq g.
19071
19072 @item set remote interrupt-on-connect
19073 @cindex send interrupt-sequence on start
19074 Specify whether interrupt-sequence is sent to remote target when
19075 @value{GDBN} connects to it. This is mostly needed when you debug
19076 Linux kernel. Linux kernel expects @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}
19077 which is known as Magic SysRq g in order to connect @value{GDBN}.
19078
19079 @item show interrupt-on-connect
19080 Show whether interrupt-sequence is sent
19081 to remote target when @value{GDBN} connects to it.
19082
19083 @kindex set tcp
19084 @kindex show tcp
19085 @item set tcp auto-retry on
19086 @cindex auto-retry, for remote TCP target
19087 Enable auto-retry for remote TCP connections. This is useful if the remote
19088 debugging agent is launched in parallel with @value{GDBN}; there is a race
19089 condition because the agent may not become ready to accept the connection
19090 before @value{GDBN} attempts to connect. When auto-retry is
19091 enabled, if the initial attempt to connect fails, @value{GDBN} reattempts
19092 to establish the connection using the timeout specified by
19093 @code{set tcp connect-timeout}.
19094
19095 @item set tcp auto-retry off
19096 Do not auto-retry failed TCP connections.
19097
19098 @item show tcp auto-retry
19099 Show the current auto-retry setting.
19100
19101 @item set tcp connect-timeout @var{seconds}
19102 @itemx set tcp connect-timeout unlimited
19103 @cindex connection timeout, for remote TCP target
19104 @cindex timeout, for remote target connection
19105 Set the timeout for establishing a TCP connection to the remote target to
19106 @var{seconds}. The timeout affects both polling to retry failed connections
19107 (enabled by @code{set tcp auto-retry on}) and waiting for connections
19108 that are merely slow to complete, and represents an approximate cumulative
19109 value. If @var{seconds} is @code{unlimited}, there is no timeout and
19110 @value{GDBN} will keep attempting to establish a connection forever,
19111 unless interrupted with @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The default is 15 seconds.
19112
19113 @item show tcp connect-timeout
19114 Show the current connection timeout setting.
19115 @end table
19116
19117 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
19118 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
19119 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
19120 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
19121 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
19122 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
19123 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
19124 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
19125 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
19126
19127 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
19128 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
19129 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
19130 @value{GDBN} developers.
19131
19132 For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
19133 packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
19134 are:
19135
19136 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
19137 @item Command Name
19138 @tab Remote Packet
19139 @tab Related Features
19140
19141 @item @code{fetch-register}
19142 @tab @code{p}
19143 @tab @code{info registers}
19144
19145 @item @code{set-register}
19146 @tab @code{P}
19147 @tab @code{set}
19148
19149 @item @code{binary-download}
19150 @tab @code{X}
19151 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
19152
19153 @item @code{read-aux-vector}
19154 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
19155 @tab @code{info auxv}
19156
19157 @item @code{symbol-lookup}
19158 @tab @code{qSymbol}
19159 @tab Detecting multiple threads
19160
19161 @item @code{attach}
19162 @tab @code{vAttach}
19163 @tab @code{attach}
19164
19165 @item @code{verbose-resume}
19166 @tab @code{vCont}
19167 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
19168
19169 @item @code{run}
19170 @tab @code{vRun}
19171 @tab @code{run}
19172
19173 @item @code{software-breakpoint}
19174 @tab @code{Z0}
19175 @tab @code{break}
19176
19177 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
19178 @tab @code{Z1}
19179 @tab @code{hbreak}
19180
19181 @item @code{write-watchpoint}
19182 @tab @code{Z2}
19183 @tab @code{watch}
19184
19185 @item @code{read-watchpoint}
19186 @tab @code{Z3}
19187 @tab @code{rwatch}
19188
19189 @item @code{access-watchpoint}
19190 @tab @code{Z4}
19191 @tab @code{awatch}
19192
19193 @item @code{target-features}
19194 @tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
19195 @tab @code{set architecture}
19196
19197 @item @code{library-info}
19198 @tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
19199 @tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
19200
19201 @item @code{memory-map}
19202 @tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
19203 @tab @code{info mem}
19204
19205 @item @code{read-sdata-object}
19206 @tab @code{qXfer:sdata:read}
19207 @tab @code{print $_sdata}
19208
19209 @item @code{read-spu-object}
19210 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
19211 @tab @code{info spu}
19212
19213 @item @code{write-spu-object}
19214 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
19215 @tab @code{info spu}
19216
19217 @item @code{read-siginfo-object}
19218 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:read}
19219 @tab @code{print $_siginfo}
19220
19221 @item @code{write-siginfo-object}
19222 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:write}
19223 @tab @code{set $_siginfo}
19224
19225 @item @code{threads}
19226 @tab @code{qXfer:threads:read}
19227 @tab @code{info threads}
19228
19229 @item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
19230 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
19231 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
19232
19233 @item @code{get-thread-information-block-address}
19234 @tab @code{qGetTIBAddr}
19235 @tab Display MS-Windows Thread Information Block.
19236
19237 @item @code{search-memory}
19238 @tab @code{qSearch:memory}
19239 @tab @code{find}
19240
19241 @item @code{supported-packets}
19242 @tab @code{qSupported}
19243 @tab Remote communications parameters
19244
19245 @item @code{pass-signals}
19246 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
19247 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
19248
19249 @item @code{program-signals}
19250 @tab @code{QProgramSignals}
19251 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
19252
19253 @item @code{hostio-close-packet}
19254 @tab @code{vFile:close}
19255 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
19256
19257 @item @code{hostio-open-packet}
19258 @tab @code{vFile:open}
19259 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
19260
19261 @item @code{hostio-pread-packet}
19262 @tab @code{vFile:pread}
19263 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
19264
19265 @item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet}
19266 @tab @code{vFile:pwrite}
19267 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
19268
19269 @item @code{hostio-unlink-packet}
19270 @tab @code{vFile:unlink}
19271 @tab @code{remote delete}
19272
19273 @item @code{hostio-readlink-packet}
19274 @tab @code{vFile:readlink}
19275 @tab Host I/O
19276
19277 @item @code{noack-packet}
19278 @tab @code{QStartNoAckMode}
19279 @tab Packet acknowledgment
19280
19281 @item @code{osdata}
19282 @tab @code{qXfer:osdata:read}
19283 @tab @code{info os}
19284
19285 @item @code{query-attached}
19286 @tab @code{qAttached}
19287 @tab Querying remote process attach state.
19288
19289 @item @code{trace-buffer-size}
19290 @tab @code{QTBuffer:size}
19291 @tab @code{set trace-buffer-size}
19292
19293 @item @code{trace-status}
19294 @tab @code{qTStatus}
19295 @tab @code{tstatus}
19296
19297 @item @code{traceframe-info}
19298 @tab @code{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
19299 @tab Traceframe info
19300
19301 @item @code{install-in-trace}
19302 @tab @code{InstallInTrace}
19303 @tab Install tracepoint in tracing
19304
19305 @item @code{disable-randomization}
19306 @tab @code{QDisableRandomization}
19307 @tab @code{set disable-randomization}
19308
19309 @item @code{conditional-breakpoints-packet}
19310 @tab @code{Z0 and Z1}
19311 @tab @code{Support for target-side breakpoint condition evaluation}
19312 @end multitable
19313
19314 @node Remote Stub
19315 @section Implementing a Remote Stub
19316
19317 @cindex debugging stub, example
19318 @cindex remote stub, example
19319 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
19320 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
19321 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
19322 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
19323 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
19324 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
19325 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
19326 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
19327
19328 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
19329 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
19330 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
19331 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
19332 program, you need:
19333
19334 @enumerate
19335 @item
19336 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
19337 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
19338 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
19339
19340 @item
19341 A C subroutine library to support your program's
19342 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
19343
19344 @item
19345 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
19346 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
19347 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
19348 documentation.
19349 @end enumerate
19350
19351 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
19352 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
19353 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
19354
19355 @table @emph
19356 @item On the host,
19357 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
19358 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
19359 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
19360
19361 @item On the target,
19362 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
19363 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
19364 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
19365
19366 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
19367 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
19368 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
19369 @end table
19370
19371 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
19372 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
19373 @sc{sparc} boards.
19374
19375 @cindex remote serial stub list
19376 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
19377
19378 @table @code
19379
19380 @item i386-stub.c
19381 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
19382 @cindex Intel
19383 @cindex i386
19384 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
19385
19386 @item m68k-stub.c
19387 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
19388 @cindex Motorola 680x0
19389 @cindex m680x0
19390 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
19391
19392 @item sh-stub.c
19393 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
19394 @cindex Renesas
19395 @cindex SH
19396 For Renesas SH architectures.
19397
19398 @item sparc-stub.c
19399 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
19400 @cindex Sparc
19401 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
19402
19403 @item sparcl-stub.c
19404 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
19405 @cindex Fujitsu
19406 @cindex SparcLite
19407 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
19408
19409 @end table
19410
19411 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
19412 recently added stubs.
19413
19414 @menu
19415 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
19416 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
19417 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
19418 @end menu
19419
19420 @node Stub Contents
19421 @subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
19422
19423 @cindex remote serial stub
19424 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
19425 subroutines:
19426
19427 @table @code
19428 @item set_debug_traps
19429 @findex set_debug_traps
19430 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
19431 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
19432 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly in your
19433 program's startup code.
19434
19435 @item handle_exception
19436 @findex handle_exception
19437 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
19438 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
19439 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
19440 run when a trap is triggered.
19441
19442 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
19443 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
19444 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
19445 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
19446 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
19447 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
19448 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
19449 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
19450 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
19451 machine.
19452
19453 @item breakpoint
19454 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
19455 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
19456 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
19457 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
19458 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
19459 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
19460 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
19461 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
19462 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
19463 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
19464 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
19465
19466 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
19467 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
19468 start of your debugging session.
19469 @end table
19470
19471 @node Bootstrapping
19472 @subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
19473
19474 @cindex remote stub, support routines
19475 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
19476 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
19477 debugging target machine.
19478
19479 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
19480 serial port.
19481
19482 @table @code
19483 @item int getDebugChar()
19484 @findex getDebugChar
19485 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
19486 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
19487 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
19488
19489 @item void putDebugChar(int)
19490 @findex putDebugChar
19491 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
19492 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
19493 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
19494 @end table
19495
19496 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
19497 @cindex interrupting remote targets
19498 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
19499 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
19500 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
19501 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
19502 remote system to stop.
19503
19504 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
19505 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
19506 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
19507 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
19508
19509 Other routines you need to supply are:
19510
19511 @table @code
19512 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
19513 @findex exceptionHandler
19514 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
19515 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
19516 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
19517 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
19518 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
19519 The @var{exception_number} specifies the exception which should be changed;
19520 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
19521 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
19522 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
19523 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
19524 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
19525 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
19526 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
19527
19528 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
19529 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
19530 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
19531 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
19532 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
19533
19534 @item void flush_i_cache()
19535 @findex flush_i_cache
19536 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
19537 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
19538 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
19539
19540 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
19541 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
19542 @end table
19543
19544 @noindent
19545 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
19546
19547 @table @code
19548 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
19549 @findex memset
19550 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
19551 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
19552 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
19553 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
19554 @end table
19555
19556 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
19557 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
19558 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
19559 subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
19560
19561
19562 @node Debug Session
19563 @subsection Putting it All Together
19564
19565 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
19566 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
19567 steps.
19568
19569 @enumerate
19570 @item
19571 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
19572 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
19573 @display
19574 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
19575 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
19576 @end display
19577
19578 @item
19579 Insert these lines in your program's startup code, before the main
19580 procedure is called:
19581
19582 @smallexample
19583 set_debug_traps();
19584 breakpoint();
19585 @end smallexample
19586
19587 On some machines, when a breakpoint trap is raised, the hardware
19588 automatically makes the PC point to the instruction after the
19589 breakpoint. If your machine doesn't do that, you may need to adjust
19590 @code{handle_exception} to arrange for it to return to the instruction
19591 after the breakpoint on this first invocation, so that your program
19592 doesn't keep hitting the initial breakpoint instead of making
19593 progress.
19594
19595 @item
19596 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
19597 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
19598
19599 @smallexample
19600 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
19601 @end smallexample
19602
19603 @noindent
19604 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
19605 function in your program, that function is called when
19606 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
19607 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
19608 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
19609
19610 @item
19611 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
19612 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
19613
19614 @item
19615 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
19616 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
19617
19618 @item
19619 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
19620 @c document that. FIXME.
19621 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
19622 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
19623
19624 @item
19625 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
19626 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
19627
19628 @end enumerate
19629
19630 @node Configurations
19631 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
19632
19633 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
19634 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
19635 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
19636
19637 There are three major categories of configurations: native
19638 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
19639 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
19640 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
19641 are quite different from each other.
19642
19643 @menu
19644 * Native::
19645 * Embedded OS::
19646 * Embedded Processors::
19647 * Architectures::
19648 @end menu
19649
19650 @node Native
19651 @section Native
19652
19653 This section describes details specific to particular native
19654 configurations.
19655
19656 @menu
19657 * HP-UX:: HP-UX
19658 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
19659 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
19660 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
19661 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
19662 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
19663 * Darwin:: Features specific to Darwin
19664 @end menu
19665
19666 @node HP-UX
19667 @subsection HP-UX
19668
19669 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
19670 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
19671 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
19672
19673
19674 @node BSD libkvm Interface
19675 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
19676
19677 @cindex libkvm
19678 @cindex kernel memory image
19679 @cindex kernel crash dump
19680
19681 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
19682 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
19683 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
19684 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
19685 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
19686 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
19687 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
19688 @code{kvm} target:
19689
19690 @smallexample
19691 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
19692 @end smallexample
19693
19694 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
19695 argument:
19696
19697 @smallexample
19698 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
19699 @end smallexample
19700
19701 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
19702 available:
19703
19704 @table @code
19705 @kindex kvm
19706 @item kvm pcb
19707 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
19708
19709 @item kvm proc
19710 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
19711 modern FreeBSD systems.
19712 @end table
19713
19714 @node SVR4 Process Information
19715 @subsection SVR4 Process Information
19716 @cindex /proc
19717 @cindex examine process image
19718 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
19719
19720 Many versions of SVR4 and compatible systems provide a facility called
19721 @samp{/proc} that can be used to examine the image of a running
19722 process using file-system subroutines.
19723
19724 If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system with this
19725 facility, the command @code{info proc} is available to report
19726 information about the process running your program, or about any
19727 process running on your system. This includes, as of this writing,
19728 @sc{gnu}/Linux, OSF/1 (Digital Unix), Solaris, and Irix, but
19729 not HP-UX, for example.
19730
19731 This command may also work on core files that were created on a system
19732 that has the @samp{/proc} facility.
19733
19734 @table @code
19735 @kindex info proc
19736 @cindex process ID
19737 @item info proc
19738 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
19739 Summarize available information about any running process. If a
19740 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
19741 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
19742 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
19743 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
19744 executable file's absolute file name.
19745
19746 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
19747 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
19748 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
19749 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
19750 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
19751 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
19752
19753 @item info proc cmdline
19754 @cindex info proc cmdline
19755 Show the original command line of the process. This command is
19756 specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
19757
19758 @item info proc cwd
19759 @cindex info proc cwd
19760 Show the current working directory of the process. This command is
19761 specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
19762
19763 @item info proc exe
19764 @cindex info proc exe
19765 Show the name of executable of the process. This command is specific
19766 to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
19767
19768 @item info proc mappings
19769 @cindex memory address space mappings
19770 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program, with
19771 information on whether the process has read, write, or execute access
19772 rights to each range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, each memory range
19773 includes the object file which is mapped to that range, instead of the
19774 memory access rights to that range.
19775
19776 @item info proc stat
19777 @itemx info proc status
19778 @cindex process detailed status information
19779 These subcommands are specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. They show
19780 the process-related information, including the user ID and group ID;
19781 how many threads are there in the process; its virtual memory usage;
19782 the signals that are pending, blocked, and ignored; its TTY; its
19783 consumption of system and user time; its stack size; its @samp{nice}
19784 value; etc. For more information, see the @samp{proc} man page
19785 (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
19786
19787 @item info proc all
19788 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
19789 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
19790
19791 @ignore
19792 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
19793 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
19794 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
19795 @kindex info proc times
19796 @item info proc times
19797 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
19798 its children.
19799
19800 @kindex info proc id
19801 @item info proc id
19802 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
19803 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
19804 @end ignore
19805
19806 @item set procfs-trace
19807 @kindex set procfs-trace
19808 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
19809 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
19810
19811 @item show procfs-trace
19812 @kindex show procfs-trace
19813 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
19814
19815 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
19816 @kindex set procfs-file
19817 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
19818 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
19819 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
19820 standard output.
19821
19822 @item show procfs-file
19823 @kindex show procfs-file
19824 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
19825
19826 @item proc-trace-entry
19827 @itemx proc-trace-exit
19828 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
19829 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
19830 @kindex proc-trace-entry
19831 @kindex proc-trace-exit
19832 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
19833 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
19834 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
19835 from the @code{syscall} interface.
19836
19837 @item info pidlist
19838 @kindex info pidlist
19839 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
19840 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
19841 processes and all the threads within each process.
19842
19843 @item info meminfo
19844 @kindex info meminfo
19845 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
19846 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
19847 @end table
19848
19849 @node DJGPP Native
19850 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
19851 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
19852 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
19853 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
19854
19855 @cindex DPMI
19856 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
19857 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
19858 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
19859 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
19860
19861 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
19862 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
19863 subsection describes those commands.
19864
19865 @table @code
19866 @kindex info dos
19867 @item info dos
19868 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
19869 information about the target system and important OS structures.
19870
19871 @kindex sysinfo
19872 @cindex MS-DOS system info
19873 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
19874 @item info dos sysinfo
19875 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
19876 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
19877 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
19878
19879 @cindex GDT
19880 @cindex LDT
19881 @cindex IDT
19882 @cindex segment descriptor tables
19883 @cindex descriptor tables display
19884 @item info dos gdt
19885 @itemx info dos ldt
19886 @itemx info dos idt
19887 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
19888 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
19889 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
19890 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
19891 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
19892 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
19893 rights.
19894
19895 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
19896 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
19897 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
19898 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
19899 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
19900
19901 @cindex garbled pointers
19902 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
19903 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
19904 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
19905 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
19906 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
19907 debugged program's data segment:
19908
19909 @smallexample
19910 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
19911 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
19912 @end smallexample
19913
19914 @noindent
19915 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
19916 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
19917
19918 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
19919 @item info dos pde
19920 @itemx info dos pte
19921 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
19922 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
19923 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
19924 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
19925 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
19926 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
19927 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
19928 that is currently in use.
19929
19930 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
19931 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
19932 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
19933 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
19934 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
19935 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
19936 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
19937
19938 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
19939 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
19940 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
19941 controller.
19942
19943 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
19944
19945 @cindex physical address from linear address
19946 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
19947 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
19948 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
19949 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
19950 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
19951 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
19952 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
19953
19954 @smallexample
19955 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
19956 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
19957 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
19958 @end smallexample
19959
19960 @noindent
19961 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
19962 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
19963 attributes of that page.
19964
19965 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
19966 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
19967 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
19968 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
19969 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
19970 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
19971
19972 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
19973 transfer buffer:
19974
19975 @smallexample
19976 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
19977 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
19978 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
19979 @end smallexample
19980
19981 @noindent
19982 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
19983 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
19984 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
19985 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
19986 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
19987
19988 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
19989 @end table
19990
19991 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
19992 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
19993 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
19994 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
19995
19996 @table @code
19997 @kindex set com1base
19998 @kindex set com1irq
19999 @kindex set com2base
20000 @kindex set com2irq
20001 @kindex set com3base
20002 @kindex set com3irq
20003 @kindex set com4base
20004 @kindex set com4irq
20005 @item set com1base @var{addr}
20006 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
20007 port.
20008
20009 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
20010 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
20011 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
20012
20013 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
20014 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
20015 other 3 COM ports.
20016
20017 @kindex show com1base
20018 @kindex show com1irq
20019 @kindex show com2base
20020 @kindex show com2irq
20021 @kindex show com3base
20022 @kindex show com3irq
20023 @kindex show com4base
20024 @kindex show com4irq
20025 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
20026 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
20027 lines used by the COM ports.
20028
20029 @item info serial
20030 @kindex info serial
20031 @cindex DOS serial port status
20032 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
20033 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
20034 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
20035 counts of various errors encountered so far.
20036 @end table
20037
20038
20039 @node Cygwin Native
20040 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
20041 @cindex MS Windows debugging
20042 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
20043 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
20044
20045 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
20046 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information.
20047
20048 @cindex Ctrl-BREAK, MS-Windows
20049 @cindex interrupt debuggee on MS-Windows
20050 MS-Windows programs that call @code{SetConsoleMode} to switch off the
20051 special meaning of the @samp{Ctrl-C} keystroke cannot be interrupted
20052 by typing @kbd{C-c}. For this reason, @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows
20053 supports @kbd{C-@key{BREAK}} as an alternative interrupt key
20054 sequence, which can be used to interrupt the debuggee even if it
20055 ignores @kbd{C-c}.
20056
20057 There are various additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in
20058 this section. Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is
20059 described in @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
20060
20061 @table @code
20062 @kindex info w32
20063 @item info w32
20064 This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
20065 information about the target system and important OS structures.
20066
20067 @item info w32 selector
20068 This command displays information returned by
20069 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
20070 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
20071 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
20072 Without argument, this command displays information
20073 about the six segment registers.
20074
20075 @item info w32 thread-information-block
20076 This command displays thread specific information stored in the
20077 Thread Information Block (readable on the X86 CPU family using @code{$fs}
20078 selector for 32-bit programs and @code{$gs} for 64-bit programs).
20079
20080 @kindex info dll
20081 @item info dll
20082 This is a Cygwin-specific alias of @code{info shared}.
20083
20084 @kindex dll-symbols
20085 @item dll-symbols
20086 This command is deprecated and will be removed in future versions
20087 of @value{GDBN}. Use the @code{sharedlibrary} command instead.
20088
20089 This command loads symbols from a dll similarly to
20090 add-sym command but without the need to specify a base address.
20091
20092 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
20093 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
20094 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
20095 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
20096 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
20097 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
20098 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
20099 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
20100 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
20101 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
20102 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
20103
20104 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
20105 @item show cygwin-exceptions
20106 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
20107 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
20108
20109 @kindex set new-console
20110 @item set new-console @var{mode}
20111 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
20112 be started in a new console on next start.
20113 If @var{mode} is @code{off}, the debuggee will
20114 be started in the same console as the debugger.
20115
20116 @kindex show new-console
20117 @item show new-console
20118 Displays whether a new console is used
20119 when the debuggee is started.
20120
20121 @kindex set new-group
20122 @item set new-group @var{mode}
20123 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
20124 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
20125 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
20126 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
20127
20128 @kindex show new-group
20129 @item show new-group
20130 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
20131
20132 @kindex set debugevents
20133 @item set debugevents
20134 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
20135 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
20136 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
20137 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
20138 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
20139
20140 @kindex set debugexec
20141 @item set debugexec
20142 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
20143 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
20144
20145 @kindex set debugexceptions
20146 @item set debugexceptions
20147 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
20148 debuggee seen by the debugger.
20149
20150 @kindex set debugmemory
20151 @item set debugmemory
20152 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
20153 and writes by the debugger.
20154
20155 @kindex set shell
20156 @item set shell
20157 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
20158 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
20159
20160 @kindex show shell
20161 @item show shell
20162 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
20163
20164 @end table
20165
20166 @menu
20167 * Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
20168 @end menu
20169
20170 @node Non-debug DLL Symbols
20171 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
20172 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
20173 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
20174
20175 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
20176 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
20177 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
20178 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
20179 information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
20180 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
20181 ``minimal symbols''.
20182
20183 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
20184 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
20185 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
20186 program run once to completion.
20187
20188 @subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
20189
20190 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
20191 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
20192 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
20193 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
20194 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
20195 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
20196 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
20197 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
20198 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
20199
20200 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
20201 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
20202 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
20203 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
20204 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
20205 (@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
20206
20207 @smallexample
20208 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
20209 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
20210
20211 Non-debugging symbols:
20212 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
20213 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
20214 @end smallexample
20215
20216 @smallexample
20217 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
20218 All functions matching regular expression "!":
20219
20220 Non-debugging symbols:
20221 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
20222 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
20223 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
20224 [etc...]
20225 @end smallexample
20226
20227 @subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
20228
20229 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
20230 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
20231 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
20232 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
20233 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
20234 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
20235 a function within a DLL without a running program.
20236
20237 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
20238 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
20239 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
20240 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
20241 problem:
20242
20243 @smallexample
20244 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
20245 $1 = 268572168
20246 @end smallexample
20247
20248 @smallexample
20249 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
20250 0x10021610: "\230y\""
20251 @end smallexample
20252
20253 And two possible solutions:
20254
20255 @smallexample
20256 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
20257 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
20258 @end smallexample
20259
20260 @smallexample
20261 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
20262 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
20263 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
20264 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
20265 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
20266 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
20267 @end smallexample
20268
20269 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
20270 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
20271 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
20272 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
20273 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
20274
20275 @smallexample
20276 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
20277 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
20278 @end smallexample
20279
20280 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
20281 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
20282 safe.
20283
20284 @node Hurd Native
20285 @subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
20286 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
20287
20288 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
20289 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
20290
20291 @table @code
20292 @item set signals
20293 @itemx set sigs
20294 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
20295 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
20296 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
20297 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
20298 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
20299 @code{signals}.
20300
20301 @item show signals
20302 @itemx show sigs
20303 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
20304 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
20305 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
20306
20307 @item set signal-thread
20308 @itemx set sigthread
20309 @kindex set signal-thread
20310 @kindex set sigthread
20311 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
20312 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
20313 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
20314 signal-thread}.
20315
20316 @item show signal-thread
20317 @itemx show sigthread
20318 @kindex show signal-thread
20319 @kindex show sigthread
20320 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
20321 delivered a signal.
20322
20323 @item set stopped
20324 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
20325 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
20326 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
20327 continued by delivering a signal to it.
20328
20329 @item show stopped
20330 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
20331 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
20332 stopped.
20333
20334 @item set exceptions
20335 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
20336 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
20337 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
20338 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
20339 trapping on.
20340
20341 @item show exceptions
20342 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
20343 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
20344
20345 @item set task pause
20346 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
20347 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
20348 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
20349 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
20350 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
20351 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
20352 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
20353 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
20354 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
20355
20356 @item show task pause
20357 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
20358 Show the current state of task suspension.
20359
20360 @item set task detach-suspend-count
20361 @cindex task suspend count
20362 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20363 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
20364 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
20365
20366 @item show task detach-suspend-count
20367 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
20368
20369 @item set task exception-port
20370 @itemx set task excp
20371 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20372 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
20373 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
20374 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
20375
20376 @item set noninvasive
20377 @cindex noninvasive task options
20378 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
20379 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
20380 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
20381 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
20382
20383 @item info send-rights
20384 @itemx info receive-rights
20385 @itemx info port-rights
20386 @itemx info port-sets
20387 @itemx info dead-names
20388 @itemx info ports
20389 @itemx info psets
20390 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20391 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20392 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20393 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20394 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20395 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
20396 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
20397 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
20398 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
20399
20400 @item set thread pause
20401 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
20402 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20403 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
20404 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
20405 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
20406 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
20407 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
20408 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
20409 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
20410 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
20411 only the current thread.
20412
20413 @item show thread pause
20414 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
20415 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
20416
20417 @item set thread run
20418 This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
20419
20420 @item show thread run
20421 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
20422
20423 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
20424 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20425 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20426 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
20427 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
20428 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
20429 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
20430
20431 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
20432 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
20433 detaching.
20434
20435 @item set thread exception-port
20436 @itemx set thread excp
20437 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
20438 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
20439 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
20440
20441 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
20442 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
20443 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
20444 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
20445
20446 @item set thread default
20447 @itemx show thread default
20448 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20449 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
20450 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
20451 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
20452 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
20453 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
20454 the non-default commands.
20455 @end table
20456
20457 @node Darwin
20458 @subsection Darwin
20459 @cindex Darwin
20460
20461 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the Darwin target:
20462
20463 @table @code
20464 @item set debug darwin @var{num}
20465 @kindex set debug darwin
20466 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages specific to
20467 the Darwin support. Higher values produce more verbose output.
20468
20469 @item show debug darwin
20470 @kindex show debug darwin
20471 Show the current state of Darwin messages.
20472
20473 @item set debug mach-o @var{num}
20474 @kindex set debug mach-o
20475 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages while
20476 @value{GDBN} is reading Darwin object files. (@dfn{Mach-O} is the
20477 file format used on Darwin for object and executable files.) Higher
20478 values produce more verbose output. This is a command to diagnose
20479 problems internal to @value{GDBN} and should not be needed in normal
20480 usage.
20481
20482 @item show debug mach-o
20483 @kindex show debug mach-o
20484 Show the current state of Mach-O file messages.
20485
20486 @item set mach-exceptions on
20487 @itemx set mach-exceptions off
20488 @kindex set mach-exceptions
20489 On Darwin, faults are first reported as a Mach exception and are then
20490 mapped to a Posix signal. Use this command to turn on trapping of
20491 Mach exceptions in the inferior. This might be sometimes useful to
20492 better understand the cause of a fault. The default is off.
20493
20494 @item show mach-exceptions
20495 @kindex show mach-exceptions
20496 Show the current state of exceptions trapping.
20497 @end table
20498
20499
20500 @node Embedded OS
20501 @section Embedded Operating Systems
20502
20503 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
20504 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
20505 architectures.
20506
20507 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
20508 various real-time operating systems.
20509
20510 @node Embedded Processors
20511 @section Embedded Processors
20512
20513 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
20514 configurations.
20515
20516 @cindex send command to simulator
20517 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
20518 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
20519
20520 @table @code
20521 @item sim @var{command}
20522 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
20523 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
20524 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
20525 acceptable commands.
20526 @end table
20527
20528
20529 @menu
20530 * ARM:: ARM RDI
20531 * M32R/D:: Renesas M32R/D
20532 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
20533 * MicroBlaze:: Xilinx MicroBlaze
20534 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
20535 * PowerPC Embedded:: PowerPC Embedded
20536 * PA:: HP PA Embedded
20537 * Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
20538 * Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
20539 * Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
20540 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
20541 * CRIS:: CRIS
20542 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
20543 @end menu
20544
20545 @node ARM
20546 @subsection ARM
20547 @cindex ARM RDI
20548
20549 @table @code
20550 @kindex target rdi
20551 @item target rdi @var{dev}
20552 ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
20553 use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
20554 monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
20555
20556 @kindex target rdp
20557 @item target rdp @var{dev}
20558 ARM Demon monitor.
20559
20560 @end table
20561
20562 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
20563
20564 @table @code
20565 @item set arm disassembler
20566 @kindex set arm
20567 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
20568 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
20569
20570 @item show arm disassembler
20571 @kindex show arm
20572 Show the current disassembly style.
20573
20574 @item set arm apcs32
20575 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
20576 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
20577
20578 @item show arm apcs32
20579 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
20580
20581 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
20582 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
20583 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
20584
20585 @table @code
20586 @item auto
20587 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
20588 @item softfpa
20589 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
20590 processors.
20591 @item fpa
20592 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
20593 @item softvfp
20594 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
20595 @item vfp
20596 VFP co-processor.
20597 @end table
20598
20599 @item show arm fpu
20600 Show the current type of the FPU.
20601
20602 @item set arm abi
20603 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
20604
20605 @item show arm abi
20606 Show the currently used ABI.
20607
20608 @item set arm fallback-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
20609 @value{GDBN} uses the symbol table, when available, to determine
20610 whether instructions are ARM or Thumb. This command controls
20611 @value{GDBN}'s default behavior when the symbol table is not
20612 available. The default is @samp{auto}, which causes @value{GDBN} to
20613 use the current execution mode (from the @code{T} bit in the @code{CPSR}
20614 register).
20615
20616 @item show arm fallback-mode
20617 Show the current fallback instruction mode.
20618
20619 @item set arm force-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
20620 This command overrides use of the symbol table to determine whether
20621 instructions are ARM or Thumb. The default is @samp{auto}, which
20622 causes @value{GDBN} to use the symbol table and then the setting
20623 of @samp{set arm fallback-mode}.
20624
20625 @item show arm force-mode
20626 Show the current forced instruction mode.
20627
20628 @item set debug arm
20629 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
20630 target support subsystem.
20631
20632 @item show debug arm
20633 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
20634 @end table
20635
20636 The following commands are available when an ARM target is debugged
20637 using the RDI interface:
20638
20639 @table @code
20640 @item rdilogfile @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
20641 @kindex rdilogfile
20642 @cindex ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) logging
20643 Set the filename for the ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) packet log.
20644 With an argument, sets the log file to the specified @var{file}. With
20645 no argument, show the current log file name. The default log file is
20646 @file{rdi.log}.
20647
20648 @item rdilogenable @r{[}@var{arg}@r{]}
20649 @kindex rdilogenable
20650 Control logging of ADP packets. With an argument of 1 or @code{"yes"}
20651 enables logging, with an argument 0 or @code{"no"} disables it. With
20652 no arguments displays the current setting. When logging is enabled,
20653 ADP packets exchanged between @value{GDBN} and the RDI target device
20654 are logged to a file.
20655
20656 @item set rdiromatzero
20657 @kindex set rdiromatzero
20658 @cindex ROM at zero address, RDI
20659 Tell @value{GDBN} whether the target has ROM at address 0. If on,
20660 vector catching is disabled, so that zero address can be used. If off
20661 (the default), vector catching is enabled. For this command to take
20662 effect, it needs to be invoked prior to the @code{target rdi} command.
20663
20664 @item show rdiromatzero
20665 @kindex show rdiromatzero
20666 Show the current setting of ROM at zero address.
20667
20668 @item set rdiheartbeat
20669 @kindex set rdiheartbeat
20670 @cindex RDI heartbeat
20671 Enable or disable RDI heartbeat packets. It is not recommended to
20672 turn on this option, since it confuses ARM and EPI JTAG interface, as
20673 well as the Angel monitor.
20674
20675 @item show rdiheartbeat
20676 @kindex show rdiheartbeat
20677 Show the setting of RDI heartbeat packets.
20678 @end table
20679
20680 @table @code
20681 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
20682 The @value{GDBN} ARM simulator accepts the following optional arguments.
20683
20684 @table @code
20685 @item --swi-support=@var{type}
20686 Tell the simulator which SWI interfaces to support. The argument
20687 @var{type} may be a comma separated list of the following values.
20688 The default value is @code{all}.
20689
20690 @table @code
20691 @item none
20692 @item demon
20693 @item angel
20694 @item redboot
20695 @item all
20696 @end table
20697 @end table
20698 @end table
20699
20700 @node M32R/D
20701 @subsection Renesas M32R/D and M32R/SDI
20702
20703 @table @code
20704 @kindex target m32r
20705 @item target m32r @var{dev}
20706 Renesas M32R/D ROM monitor.
20707
20708 @kindex target m32rsdi
20709 @item target m32rsdi @var{dev}
20710 Renesas M32R SDI server, connected via parallel port to the board.
20711 @end table
20712
20713 The following @value{GDBN} commands are specific to the M32R monitor:
20714
20715 @table @code
20716 @item set download-path @var{path}
20717 @kindex set download-path
20718 @cindex find downloadable @sc{srec} files (M32R)
20719 Set the default path for finding downloadable @sc{srec} files.
20720
20721 @item show download-path
20722 @kindex show download-path
20723 Show the default path for downloadable @sc{srec} files.
20724
20725 @item set board-address @var{addr}
20726 @kindex set board-address
20727 @cindex M32-EVA target board address
20728 Set the IP address for the M32R-EVA target board.
20729
20730 @item show board-address
20731 @kindex show board-address
20732 Show the current IP address of the target board.
20733
20734 @item set server-address @var{addr}
20735 @kindex set server-address
20736 @cindex download server address (M32R)
20737 Set the IP address for the download server, which is the @value{GDBN}'s
20738 host machine.
20739
20740 @item show server-address
20741 @kindex show server-address
20742 Display the IP address of the download server.
20743
20744 @item upload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
20745 @kindex upload@r{, M32R}
20746 Upload the specified @sc{srec} @var{file} via the monitor's Ethernet
20747 upload capability. If no @var{file} argument is given, the current
20748 executable file is uploaded.
20749
20750 @item tload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
20751 @kindex tload@r{, M32R}
20752 Test the @code{upload} command.
20753 @end table
20754
20755 The following commands are available for M32R/SDI:
20756
20757 @table @code
20758 @item sdireset
20759 @kindex sdireset
20760 @cindex reset SDI connection, M32R
20761 This command resets the SDI connection.
20762
20763 @item sdistatus
20764 @kindex sdistatus
20765 This command shows the SDI connection status.
20766
20767 @item debug_chaos
20768 @kindex debug_chaos
20769 @cindex M32R/Chaos debugging
20770 Instructs the remote that M32R/Chaos debugging is to be used.
20771
20772 @item use_debug_dma
20773 @kindex use_debug_dma
20774 Instructs the remote to use the DEBUG_DMA method of accessing memory.
20775
20776 @item use_mon_code
20777 @kindex use_mon_code
20778 Instructs the remote to use the MON_CODE method of accessing memory.
20779
20780 @item use_ib_break
20781 @kindex use_ib_break
20782 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by IB break.
20783
20784 @item use_dbt_break
20785 @kindex use_dbt_break
20786 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by DBT.
20787 @end table
20788
20789 @node M68K
20790 @subsection M68k
20791
20792 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and a
20793 target command for the following ROM monitor.
20794
20795 @table @code
20796
20797 @kindex target dbug
20798 @item target dbug @var{dev}
20799 dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
20800
20801 @end table
20802
20803 @node MicroBlaze
20804 @subsection MicroBlaze
20805 @cindex Xilinx MicroBlaze
20806 @cindex XMD, Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger
20807
20808 The MicroBlaze is a soft-core processor supported on various Xilinx
20809 FPGAs, such as Spartan or Virtex series. Boards with these processors
20810 usually have JTAG ports which connect to a host system running the Xilinx
20811 Embedded Development Kit (EDK) or Software Development Kit (SDK).
20812 This host system is used to download the configuration bitstream to
20813 the target FPGA. The Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger (XMD) program
20814 communicates with the target board using the JTAG interface and
20815 presents a @code{gdbserver} interface to the board. By default
20816 @code{xmd} uses port @code{1234}. (While it is possible to change
20817 this default port, it requires the use of undocumented @code{xmd}
20818 commands. Contact Xilinx support if you need to do this.)
20819
20820 Use these GDB commands to connect to the MicroBlaze target processor.
20821
20822 @table @code
20823 @item target remote :1234
20824 Use this command to connect to the target if you are running @value{GDBN}
20825 on the same system as @code{xmd}.
20826
20827 @item target remote @var{xmd-host}:1234
20828 Use this command to connect to the target if it is connected to @code{xmd}
20829 running on a different system named @var{xmd-host}.
20830
20831 @item load
20832 Use this command to download a program to the MicroBlaze target.
20833
20834 @item set debug microblaze @var{n}
20835 Enable MicroBlaze-specific debugging messages if non-zero.
20836
20837 @item show debug microblaze @var{n}
20838 Show MicroBlaze-specific debugging level.
20839 @end table
20840
20841 @node MIPS Embedded
20842 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Embedded
20843
20844 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} boards
20845 @value{GDBN} can use the @acronym{MIPS} remote debugging protocol to talk to a
20846 @acronym{MIPS} board attached to a serial line. This is available when
20847 you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-elf}.
20848
20849 @need 1000
20850 Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
20851
20852 @table @code
20853 @item target mips @var{port}
20854 @kindex target mips @var{port}
20855 To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
20856 name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
20857 command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
20858 the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
20859 been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
20860 download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
20861
20862 For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
20863 port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
20864 debugger:
20865
20866 @smallexample
20867 host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
20868 @value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
20869 (@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
20870 (@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
20871 (@value{GDBP}) run
20872 @end smallexample
20873
20874 @item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
20875 On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
20876 connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
20877 concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
20878 @samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
20879
20880 @item target pmon @var{port}
20881 @kindex target pmon @var{port}
20882 PMON ROM monitor.
20883
20884 @item target ddb @var{port}
20885 @kindex target ddb @var{port}
20886 NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
20887
20888 @item target lsi @var{port}
20889 @kindex target lsi @var{port}
20890 LSI variant of PMON.
20891
20892 @kindex target r3900
20893 @item target r3900 @var{dev}
20894 Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
20895
20896 @kindex target array
20897 @item target array @var{dev}
20898 Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
20899
20900 @end table
20901
20902
20903 @noindent
20904 @value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for @acronym{MIPS} targets:
20905
20906 @table @code
20907 @item set mipsfpu double
20908 @itemx set mipsfpu single
20909 @itemx set mipsfpu none
20910 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
20911 @itemx show mipsfpu
20912 @kindex set mipsfpu
20913 @kindex show mipsfpu
20914 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} remote floating point
20915 @cindex floating point, @acronym{MIPS} remote
20916 If your target board does not support the @acronym{MIPS} floating point
20917 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
20918 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
20919 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
20920 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
20921 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
20922 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
20923 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
20924 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
20925 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
20926 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
20927
20928 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
20929 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
20930 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
20931
20932 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
20933 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
20934
20935 @item set timeout @var{seconds}
20936 @itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
20937 @itemx show timeout
20938 @itemx show retransmit-timeout
20939 @cindex @code{timeout}, @acronym{MIPS} protocol
20940 @cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, @acronym{MIPS} protocol
20941 @kindex set timeout
20942 @kindex show timeout
20943 @kindex set retransmit-timeout
20944 @kindex show retransmit-timeout
20945 You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the @acronym{MIPS}
20946 remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
20947 default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
20948 waiting for an acknowledgment of a packet with the @code{set
20949 retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
20950 You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
20951 retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
20952 @value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-elf}.)
20953
20954 The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
20955 is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
20956 forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
20957 to run before stopping.
20958
20959 @item set syn-garbage-limit @var{num}
20960 @kindex set syn-garbage-limit@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
20961 @cindex synchronize with remote @acronym{MIPS} target
20962 Limit the maximum number of characters @value{GDBN} should ignore when
20963 it tries to synchronize with the remote target. The default is 10
20964 characters. Setting the limit to -1 means there's no limit.
20965
20966 @item show syn-garbage-limit
20967 @kindex show syn-garbage-limit@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
20968 Show the current limit on the number of characters to ignore when
20969 trying to synchronize with the remote system.
20970
20971 @item set monitor-prompt @var{prompt}
20972 @kindex set monitor-prompt@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
20973 @cindex remote monitor prompt
20974 Tell @value{GDBN} to expect the specified @var{prompt} string from the
20975 remote monitor. The default depends on the target:
20976 @table @asis
20977 @item pmon target
20978 @samp{PMON}
20979 @item ddb target
20980 @samp{NEC010}
20981 @item lsi target
20982 @samp{PMON>}
20983 @end table
20984
20985 @item show monitor-prompt
20986 @kindex show monitor-prompt@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
20987 Show the current strings @value{GDBN} expects as the prompt from the
20988 remote monitor.
20989
20990 @item set monitor-warnings
20991 @kindex set monitor-warnings@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
20992 Enable or disable monitor warnings about hardware breakpoints. This
20993 has effect only for the @code{lsi} target. When on, @value{GDBN} will
20994 display warning messages whose codes are returned by the @code{lsi}
20995 PMON monitor for breakpoint commands.
20996
20997 @item show monitor-warnings
20998 @kindex show monitor-warnings@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
20999 Show the current setting of printing monitor warnings.
21000
21001 @item pmon @var{command}
21002 @kindex pmon@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21003 @cindex send PMON command
21004 This command allows sending an arbitrary @var{command} string to the
21005 monitor. The monitor must be in debug mode for this to work.
21006 @end table
21007
21008 @node PowerPC Embedded
21009 @subsection PowerPC Embedded
21010
21011 @cindex DVC register
21012 @value{GDBN} supports using the DVC (Data Value Compare) register to
21013 implement in hardware simple hardware watchpoint conditions of the form:
21014
21015 @smallexample
21016 (@value{GDBP}) watch @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} \
21017 if @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} == @var{CONSTANT EXPRESSION}
21018 @end smallexample
21019
21020 The DVC register will be automatically used when @value{GDBN} detects
21021 such pattern in a condition expression, and the created watchpoint uses one
21022 debug register (either the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on and the
21023 variable is scalar, or the variable has a length of one byte). This feature
21024 is available in native @value{GDBN} running on a Linux kernel version 2.6.34
21025 or newer.
21026
21027 When running on PowerPC embedded processors, @value{GDBN} automatically uses
21028 ranged hardware watchpoints, unless the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on,
21029 in which case watchpoints using only one debug register are created when
21030 watching variables of scalar types.
21031
21032 You can create an artificial array to watch an arbitrary memory
21033 region using one of the following commands (@pxref{Expressions}):
21034
21035 @smallexample
21036 (@value{GDBP}) watch *((char *) @var{address})@@@var{length}
21037 (@value{GDBP}) watch @{char[@var{length}]@} @var{address}
21038 @end smallexample
21039
21040 PowerPC embedded processors support masked watchpoints. See the discussion
21041 about the @code{mask} argument in @ref{Set Watchpoints}.
21042
21043 @cindex ranged breakpoint
21044 PowerPC embedded processors support hardware accelerated
21045 @dfn{ranged breakpoints}. A ranged breakpoint stops execution of
21046 the inferior whenever it executes an instruction at any address within
21047 the range it specifies. To set a ranged breakpoint in @value{GDBN},
21048 use the @code{break-range} command.
21049
21050 @value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
21051
21052 @table @code
21053 @kindex break-range
21054 @item break-range @var{start-location}, @var{end-location}
21055 Set a breakpoint for an address range given by
21056 @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}, which can specify a function name,
21057 a line number, an offset of lines from the current line or from the start
21058 location, or an address of an instruction (see @ref{Specify Location},
21059 for a list of all the possible ways to specify a @var{location}.)
21060 The breakpoint will stop execution of the inferior whenever it
21061 executes an instruction at any address within the specified range,
21062 (including @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}.)
21063
21064 @kindex set powerpc
21065 @item set powerpc soft-float
21066 @itemx show powerpc soft-float
21067 Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
21068 convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
21069 on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
21070
21071 @item set powerpc vector-abi
21072 @itemx show powerpc vector-abi
21073 Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
21074 arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto};
21075 @samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
21076 @samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
21077 registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
21078 based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
21079
21080 @item set powerpc exact-watchpoints
21081 @itemx show powerpc exact-watchpoints
21082 Allow @value{GDBN} to use only one debug register when watching a variable
21083 of scalar type, thus assuming that the variable is accessed through the
21084 address of its first byte.
21085
21086 @kindex target dink32
21087 @item target dink32 @var{dev}
21088 DINK32 ROM monitor.
21089
21090 @kindex target ppcbug
21091 @item target ppcbug @var{dev}
21092 @kindex target ppcbug1
21093 @item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
21094 PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
21095
21096 @kindex target sds
21097 @item target sds @var{dev}
21098 SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
21099 @end table
21100
21101 @cindex SDS protocol
21102 The following commands specific to the SDS protocol are supported
21103 by @value{GDBN}:
21104
21105 @table @code
21106 @item set sdstimeout @var{nsec}
21107 @kindex set sdstimeout
21108 Set the timeout for SDS protocol reads to be @var{nsec} seconds. The
21109 default is 2 seconds.
21110
21111 @item show sdstimeout
21112 @kindex show sdstimeout
21113 Show the current value of the SDS timeout.
21114
21115 @item sds @var{command}
21116 @kindex sds@r{, a command}
21117 Send the specified @var{command} string to the SDS monitor.
21118 @end table
21119
21120
21121 @node PA
21122 @subsection HP PA Embedded
21123
21124 @table @code
21125
21126 @kindex target op50n
21127 @item target op50n @var{dev}
21128 OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
21129
21130 @kindex target w89k
21131 @item target w89k @var{dev}
21132 W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
21133
21134 @end table
21135
21136 @node Sparclet
21137 @subsection Tsqware Sparclet
21138
21139 @cindex Sparclet
21140
21141 @value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
21142 Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
21143 @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
21144 both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
21145 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
21146
21147 @table @code
21148 @item remotetimeout @var{args}
21149 @kindex remotetimeout
21150 @value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
21151 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
21152 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
21153 @end table
21154
21155 @cindex compiling, on Sparclet
21156 When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
21157 information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
21158 load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
21159 @samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
21160
21161 @smallexample
21162 sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
21163 @end smallexample
21164
21165 You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
21166
21167 @smallexample
21168 sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
21169 @end smallexample
21170
21171 @cindex running, on Sparclet
21172 Once you have set
21173 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
21174 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
21175 (or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
21176
21177 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
21178
21179 @smallexample
21180 (gdbslet)
21181 @end smallexample
21182
21183 @menu
21184 * Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
21185 * Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
21186 * Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
21187 * Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
21188 @end menu
21189
21190 @node Sparclet File
21191 @subsubsection Setting File to Debug
21192
21193 The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
21194
21195 @smallexample
21196 (gdbslet) file prog
21197 @end smallexample
21198
21199 @need 1000
21200 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
21201 @value{GDBN} locates
21202 the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
21203 path.
21204 If the file was compiled with debug information (option @samp{-g}), source
21205 files will be searched as well.
21206 @value{GDBN} locates
21207 the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
21208 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}).
21209 If it fails
21210 to find a file, it displays a message such as:
21211
21212 @smallexample
21213 prog: No such file or directory.
21214 @end smallexample
21215
21216 When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
21217 the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
21218 @code{target} command again.
21219
21220 @node Sparclet Connection
21221 @subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
21222
21223 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
21224 To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
21225
21226 @smallexample
21227 (gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
21228 Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
21229 main () at ../prog.c:3
21230 @end smallexample
21231
21232 @need 750
21233 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
21234
21235 @smallexample
21236 Connected to ttya.
21237 @end smallexample
21238
21239 @node Sparclet Download
21240 @subsubsection Sparclet Download
21241
21242 @cindex download to Sparclet
21243 Once connected to the Sparclet target,
21244 you can use the @value{GDBN}
21245 @code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
21246 The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
21247 command.
21248 Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
21249 address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
21250 offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
21251 of each of the file's sections.
21252 For instance, if the program
21253 @file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
21254 and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
21255
21256 @smallexample
21257 (gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
21258 Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
21259 @end smallexample
21260
21261 If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
21262 to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
21263 to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
21264
21265 @node Sparclet Execution
21266 @subsubsection Running and Debugging
21267
21268 @cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
21269 You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
21270 commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
21271 manual for the list of commands.
21272
21273 @smallexample
21274 (gdbslet) b main
21275 Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
21276 (gdbslet) run
21277 Starting program: prog
21278 Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
21279 3 char *symarg = 0;
21280 (gdbslet) step
21281 4 char *execarg = "hello!";
21282 (gdbslet)
21283 @end smallexample
21284
21285 @node Sparclite
21286 @subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
21287
21288 @table @code
21289
21290 @kindex target sparclite
21291 @item target sparclite @var{dev}
21292 Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
21293 You must use an additional command to debug the program.
21294 For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
21295 remote protocol.
21296
21297 @end table
21298
21299 @node Z8000
21300 @subsection Zilog Z8000
21301
21302 @cindex Z8000
21303 @cindex simulator, Z8000
21304 @cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
21305
21306 When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
21307 a Z8000 simulator.
21308
21309 For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
21310 unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
21311 segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
21312 appropriate by inspecting the object code.
21313
21314 @table @code
21315 @item target sim @var{args}
21316 @kindex sim
21317 @kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
21318 Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
21319 options, specify them via @var{args}.
21320 @end table
21321
21322 @noindent
21323 After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
21324 CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
21325 @code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
21326 to run your program, and so on.
21327
21328 As well as making available all the usual machine registers
21329 (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
21330 additional items of information as specially named registers:
21331
21332 @table @code
21333
21334 @item cycles
21335 Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
21336
21337 @item insts
21338 Counts instructions run in the simulator.
21339
21340 @item time
21341 Execution time in 60ths of a second.
21342
21343 @end table
21344
21345 You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
21346 conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
21347 conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
21348 simulated clock ticks.
21349
21350 @node AVR
21351 @subsection Atmel AVR
21352 @cindex AVR
21353
21354 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
21355 following AVR-specific commands:
21356
21357 @table @code
21358 @item info io_registers
21359 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
21360 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
21361 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
21362 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
21363 @end table
21364
21365 @node CRIS
21366 @subsection CRIS
21367 @cindex CRIS
21368
21369 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
21370 following CRIS-specific commands:
21371
21372 @table @code
21373 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
21374 @cindex CRIS version
21375 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
21376 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
21377 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
21378
21379 @item show cris-version
21380 Show the current CRIS version.
21381
21382 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
21383 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
21384 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
21385 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
21386 @code{R59}.
21387
21388 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
21389 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
21390
21391 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
21392 @cindex CRIS mode
21393 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
21394 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
21395 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
21396
21397 @item show cris-mode
21398 Show the current CRIS mode.
21399 @end table
21400
21401 @node Super-H
21402 @subsection Renesas Super-H
21403 @cindex Super-H
21404
21405 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
21406 commands:
21407
21408 @table @code
21409 @item set sh calling-convention @var{convention}
21410 @kindex set sh calling-convention
21411 Set the calling-convention used when calling functions from @value{GDBN}.
21412 Allowed values are @samp{gcc}, which is the default setting, and @samp{renesas}.
21413 With the @samp{gcc} setting, functions are called using the @value{NGCC} calling
21414 convention. If the DWARF-2 information of the called function specifies
21415 that the function follows the Renesas calling convention, the function
21416 is called using the Renesas calling convention. If the calling convention
21417 is set to @samp{renesas}, the Renesas calling convention is always used,
21418 regardless of the DWARF-2 information. This can be used to override the
21419 default of @samp{gcc} if debug information is missing, or the compiler
21420 does not emit the DWARF-2 calling convention entry for a function.
21421
21422 @item show sh calling-convention
21423 @kindex show sh calling-convention
21424 Show the current calling convention setting.
21425
21426 @end table
21427
21428
21429 @node Architectures
21430 @section Architectures
21431
21432 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
21433 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
21434
21435 @menu
21436 * AArch64::
21437 * i386::
21438 * Alpha::
21439 * MIPS::
21440 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
21441 * SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
21442 * PowerPC::
21443 * Nios II::
21444 @end menu
21445
21446 @node AArch64
21447 @subsection AArch64
21448 @cindex AArch64 support
21449
21450 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides the
21451 following special commands:
21452
21453 @table @code
21454 @item set debug aarch64
21455 @kindex set debug aarch64
21456 This command determines whether AArch64 architecture-specific debugging
21457 messages are to be displayed.
21458
21459 @item show debug aarch64
21460 Show whether AArch64 debugging messages are displayed.
21461
21462 @end table
21463
21464 @node i386
21465 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
21466
21467 @table @code
21468 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
21469 @kindex set struct-convention
21470 @cindex struct return convention
21471 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
21472 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
21473 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
21474 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
21475 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
21476 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
21477 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
21478 be returned in a register.
21479
21480 @item show struct-convention
21481 @kindex show struct-convention
21482 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
21483 from functions.
21484 @end table
21485
21486 @subsubsection Intel(R) @dfn{Memory Protection Extensions} (MPX).
21487 @cindex Intel(R) Memory Protection Extensions (MPX).
21488
21489 Memory Protection Extension (MPX) adds the bound registers @samp{BND0}
21490 @footnote{The register named with capital letters represent the architecture
21491 registers.} through @samp{BND3}. Bound registers store a pair of 64-bit values
21492 which are the lower bound and upper bound. Bounds are effective addresses or
21493 memory locations. The upper bounds are architecturally represented in 1's
21494 complement form. A bound having lower bound = 0, and upper bound = 0
21495 (1's complement of all bits set) will allow access to the entire address space.
21496
21497 @samp{BND0} through @samp{BND3} are represented in @value{GDBN} as @samp{bnd0raw}
21498 through @samp{bnd3raw}. Pseudo registers @samp{bnd0} through @samp{bnd3}
21499 display the upper bound performing the complement of one operation on the
21500 upper bound value, i.e.@ when upper bound in @samp{bnd0raw} is 0 in the
21501 @value{GDBN} @samp{bnd0} it will be @code{0xfff@dots{}}. In this sense it
21502 can also be noted that the upper bounds are inclusive.
21503
21504 As an example, assume that the register BND0 holds bounds for a pointer having
21505 access allowed for the range between 0x32 and 0x71. The values present on
21506 bnd0raw and bnd registers are presented as follows:
21507
21508 @smallexample
21509 bnd0raw = @{0x32, 0xffffffff8e@}
21510 bnd0 = @{lbound = 0x32, ubound = 0x71@} : size 64
21511 @end smallexample
21512
21513 This way the raw value can be accessed via bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw. Any
21514 change on bnd0@dots{}bnd3 or bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw is reflect on its
21515 counterpart. When the bnd0@dots{}bnd3 registers are displayed via
21516 Python, the display includes the memory size, in bits, accessible to
21517 the pointer.
21518
21519 @node Alpha
21520 @subsection Alpha
21521
21522 See the following section.
21523
21524 @node MIPS
21525 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}
21526
21527 @cindex stack on Alpha
21528 @cindex stack on @acronym{MIPS}
21529 @cindex Alpha stack
21530 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} stack
21531 Alpha- and @acronym{MIPS}-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
21532 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
21533 find the beginning of a function.
21534
21535 @cindex response time, @acronym{MIPS} debugging
21536 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
21537 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
21538 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
21539 commands:
21540
21541 @table @code
21542 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, @acronym{MIPS})
21543 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
21544 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
21545 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
21546 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
21547 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
21548 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
21549 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
21550
21551 @item show heuristic-fence-post
21552 Display the current limit.
21553 @end table
21554
21555 @noindent
21556 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
21557 for debugging programs on Alpha or @acronym{MIPS} processors.
21558
21559 Several @acronym{MIPS}-specific commands are available when debugging @acronym{MIPS}
21560 programs:
21561
21562 @table @code
21563 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
21564 @kindex set mips abi
21565 @cindex set ABI for @acronym{MIPS}
21566 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
21567 values of @var{arg} are:
21568
21569 @table @samp
21570 @item auto
21571 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
21572 default).
21573 @item o32
21574 @item o64
21575 @item n32
21576 @item n64
21577 @item eabi32
21578 @item eabi64
21579 @end table
21580
21581 @item show mips abi
21582 @kindex show mips abi
21583 Show the @acronym{MIPS} ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
21584
21585 @item set mips compression @var{arg}
21586 @kindex set mips compression
21587 @cindex code compression, @acronym{MIPS}
21588 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} compressed
21589 @acronym{ISA, Instruction Set Architecture} encoding is used by the
21590 inferior. @value{GDBN} uses this for code disassembly and other
21591 internal interpretation purposes. This setting is only referred to
21592 when no executable has been associated with the debugging session or
21593 the executable does not provide information about the encoding it uses.
21594 Otherwise this setting is automatically updated from information
21595 provided by the executable.
21596
21597 Possible values of @var{arg} are @samp{mips16} and @samp{micromips}.
21598 The default compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding is @samp{mips16}, as
21599 executables containing @acronym{MIPS16} code frequently are not
21600 identified as such.
21601
21602 This setting is ``sticky''; that is, it retains its value across
21603 debugging sessions until reset either explicitly with this command or
21604 implicitly from an executable.
21605
21606 The compiler and/or assembler typically add symbol table annotations to
21607 identify functions compiled for the @acronym{MIPS16} or
21608 @acronym{microMIPS} @acronym{ISA}s. If these function-scope annotations
21609 are present, @value{GDBN} uses them in preference to the global
21610 compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding setting.
21611
21612 @item show mips compression
21613 @kindex show mips compression
21614 Show the @acronym{MIPS} compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding used by
21615 @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
21616
21617 @item set mipsfpu
21618 @itemx show mipsfpu
21619 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
21620
21621 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
21622 @kindex set mips mask-address
21623 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} addresses, masking
21624 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
21625 @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
21626 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
21627 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
21628
21629 @item show mips mask-address
21630 @kindex show mips mask-address
21631 Show whether the upper 32 bits of @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off or
21632 not.
21633
21634 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
21635 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
21636 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit @acronym{MIPS} targets that
21637 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old @acronym{MIPS} 64 target
21638 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
21639 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
21640
21641 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
21642 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
21643 Show the current setting of compatibility with older @acronym{MIPS} 64 targets.
21644
21645 @item set debug mips
21646 @kindex set debug mips
21647 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the @acronym{MIPS}-specific
21648 target code in @value{GDBN}.
21649
21650 @item show debug mips
21651 @kindex show debug mips
21652 Show the current setting of @acronym{MIPS} debugging messages.
21653 @end table
21654
21655
21656 @node HPPA
21657 @subsection HPPA
21658 @cindex HPPA support
21659
21660 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
21661 following special commands:
21662
21663 @table @code
21664 @item set debug hppa
21665 @kindex set debug hppa
21666 This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
21667 messages are to be displayed.
21668
21669 @item show debug hppa
21670 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
21671
21672 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
21673 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
21674 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
21675 given @var{address}.
21676
21677 @end table
21678
21679
21680 @node SPU
21681 @subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
21682 @cindex Cell Broadband Engine
21683 @cindex SPU
21684
21685 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
21686 it provides the following special commands:
21687
21688 @table @code
21689 @item info spu event
21690 @kindex info spu
21691 Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask
21692 and pending event status.
21693
21694 @item info spu signal
21695 Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending
21696 signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
21697 notification channels.
21698
21699 @item info spu mailbox
21700 Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries,
21701 in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
21702 SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
21703
21704 @item info spu dma
21705 Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
21706 DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
21707 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
21708
21709 @item info spu proxydma
21710 Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
21711 Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
21712 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
21713
21714 @end table
21715
21716 When @value{GDBN} is debugging a combined PowerPC/SPU application
21717 on the Cell Broadband Engine, it provides in addition the following
21718 special commands:
21719
21720 @table @code
21721 @item set spu stop-on-load @var{arg}
21722 @kindex set spu
21723 Set whether to stop for new SPE threads. When set to @code{on}, @value{GDBN}
21724 will give control to the user when a new SPE thread enters its @code{main}
21725 function. The default is @code{off}.
21726
21727 @item show spu stop-on-load
21728 @kindex show spu
21729 Show whether to stop for new SPE threads.
21730
21731 @item set spu auto-flush-cache @var{arg}
21732 Set whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache. When set to
21733 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will automatically cause the SPE software-managed
21734 cache to be flushed whenever SPE execution stops. This provides a consistent
21735 view of PowerPC memory that is accessed via the cache. If an application
21736 does not use the software-managed cache, this option has no effect.
21737
21738 @item show spu auto-flush-cache
21739 Show whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache.
21740
21741 @end table
21742
21743 @node PowerPC
21744 @subsection PowerPC
21745 @cindex PowerPC architecture
21746
21747 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the PowerPC architecture, it provides a set of
21748 pseudo-registers to enable inspection of 128-bit wide Decimal Floating Point
21749 numbers stored in the floating point registers. These values must be stored
21750 in two consecutive registers, always starting at an even register like
21751 @code{f0} or @code{f2}.
21752
21753 The pseudo-registers go from @code{$dl0} through @code{$dl15}, and are formed
21754 by joining the even/odd register pairs @code{f0} and @code{f1} for @code{$dl0},
21755 @code{f2} and @code{f3} for @code{$dl1} and so on.
21756
21757 For POWER7 processors, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers, the 64-bit
21758 wide Extended Floating Point Registers (@samp{f32} through @samp{f63}).
21759
21760 @node Nios II
21761 @subsection Nios II
21762 @cindex Nios II architecture
21763
21764 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Nios II architecture,
21765 it provides the following special commands:
21766
21767 @table @code
21768
21769 @item set debug nios2
21770 @kindex set debug nios2
21771 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the Nios II
21772 target code in @value{GDBN}.
21773
21774 @item show debug nios2
21775 @kindex show debug nios2
21776 Show the current setting of Nios II debugging messages.
21777 @end table
21778
21779 @node Controlling GDB
21780 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
21781
21782 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
21783 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
21784 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
21785 described here.
21786
21787 @menu
21788 * Prompt:: Prompt
21789 * Editing:: Command editing
21790 * Command History:: Command history
21791 * Screen Size:: Screen size
21792 * Numbers:: Numbers
21793 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
21794 * Auto-loading:: Automatically loading associated files
21795 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
21796 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
21797 * Other Misc Settings:: Other Miscellaneous Settings
21798 @end menu
21799
21800 @node Prompt
21801 @section Prompt
21802
21803 @cindex prompt
21804
21805 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
21806 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
21807 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
21808 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
21809 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
21810 which one you are talking to.
21811
21812 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
21813 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
21814 or a prompt that does not.
21815
21816 @table @code
21817 @kindex set prompt
21818 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
21819 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
21820
21821 @kindex show prompt
21822 @item show prompt
21823 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
21824 @end table
21825
21826 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled have
21827 prompt extensions. The commands for interacting with these extensions
21828 are:
21829
21830 @table @code
21831 @kindex set extended-prompt
21832 @item set extended-prompt @var{prompt}
21833 Set an extended prompt that allows for substitutions.
21834 @xref{gdb.prompt}, for a list of escape sequences that can be used for
21835 substitution. Any escape sequences specified as part of the prompt
21836 string are replaced with the corresponding strings each time the prompt
21837 is displayed.
21838
21839 For example:
21840
21841 @smallexample
21842 set extended-prompt Current working directory: \w (gdb)
21843 @end smallexample
21844
21845 Note that when an extended-prompt is set, it takes control of the
21846 @var{prompt_hook} hook. @xref{prompt_hook}, for further information.
21847
21848 @kindex show extended-prompt
21849 @item show extended-prompt
21850 Prints the extended prompt. Any escape sequences specified as part of
21851 the prompt string with @code{set extended-prompt}, are replaced with the
21852 corresponding strings each time the prompt is displayed.
21853 @end table
21854
21855 @node Editing
21856 @section Command Editing
21857 @cindex readline
21858 @cindex command line editing
21859
21860 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
21861 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
21862 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
21863 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
21864 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
21865 debugging sessions.
21866
21867 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
21868 command @code{set}.
21869
21870 @table @code
21871 @kindex set editing
21872 @cindex editing
21873 @item set editing
21874 @itemx set editing on
21875 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
21876
21877 @item set editing off
21878 Disable command line editing.
21879
21880 @kindex show editing
21881 @item show editing
21882 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
21883 @end table
21884
21885 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
21886 @xref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library},
21887 @end ifset
21888 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
21889 @xref{Command Line Editing},
21890 @end ifclear
21891 for more details about the Readline
21892 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
21893 encouraged to read that chapter.
21894
21895 @node Command History
21896 @section Command History
21897 @cindex command history
21898
21899 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
21900 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
21901 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
21902 history facility.
21903
21904 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
21905 package, to provide the history facility.
21906 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
21907 @xref{Using History Interactively, , , history, GNU History Library},
21908 @end ifset
21909 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
21910 @xref{Using History Interactively},
21911 @end ifclear
21912 for the detailed description of the History library.
21913
21914 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
21915 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
21916 (@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
21917 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
21918 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
21919 pressed on a line by itself.
21920
21921 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
21922 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
21923 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
21924 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
21925
21926 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
21927 history.
21928
21929 @table @code
21930 @cindex history substitution
21931 @cindex history file
21932 @kindex set history filename
21933 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
21934 @item set history filename @var{fname}
21935 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
21936 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
21937 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
21938 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
21939 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
21940 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
21941 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
21942 is not set.
21943
21944 @cindex save command history
21945 @kindex set history save
21946 @item set history save
21947 @itemx set history save on
21948 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
21949 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
21950
21951 @item set history save off
21952 Stop recording command history in a file.
21953
21954 @cindex history size
21955 @kindex set history size
21956 @cindex @env{HISTSIZE}, environment variable
21957 @item set history size @var{size}
21958 @itemx set history size unlimited
21959 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
21960 This defaults to the value of the environment variable
21961 @code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set. If @var{size}
21962 is @code{unlimited}, the number of commands @value{GDBN} keeps in the
21963 history list is unlimited.
21964 @end table
21965
21966 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
21967 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
21968 @xref{Event Designators, , , history, GNU History Library},
21969 @end ifset
21970 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
21971 @xref{Event Designators},
21972 @end ifclear
21973 for more details.
21974
21975 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
21976 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
21977 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
21978 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
21979 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
21980 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
21981 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
21982 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
21983
21984 The commands to control history expansion are:
21985
21986 @table @code
21987 @item set history expansion on
21988 @itemx set history expansion
21989 @kindex set history expansion
21990 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
21991
21992 @item set history expansion off
21993 Disable history expansion.
21994
21995 @c @group
21996 @kindex show history
21997 @item show history
21998 @itemx show history filename
21999 @itemx show history save
22000 @itemx show history size
22001 @itemx show history expansion
22002 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
22003 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
22004 @c @end group
22005 @end table
22006
22007 @table @code
22008 @kindex show commands
22009 @cindex show last commands
22010 @cindex display command history
22011 @item show commands
22012 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
22013
22014 @item show commands @var{n}
22015 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
22016
22017 @item show commands +
22018 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
22019 @end table
22020
22021 @node Screen Size
22022 @section Screen Size
22023 @cindex size of screen
22024 @cindex screen size
22025 @cindex pagination
22026 @cindex page size
22027 @cindex pauses in output
22028
22029 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
22030 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
22031 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
22032 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
22033 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
22034 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
22035 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
22036 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
22037
22038 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
22039 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
22040 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
22041 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
22042 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
22043 width} commands:
22044
22045 @table @code
22046 @kindex set height
22047 @kindex set width
22048 @kindex show width
22049 @kindex show height
22050 @item set height @var{lpp}
22051 @itemx set height unlimited
22052 @itemx show height
22053 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
22054 @itemx set width unlimited
22055 @itemx show width
22056 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
22057 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
22058 commands display the current settings.
22059
22060 If you specify a height of either @code{unlimited} or zero lines,
22061 @value{GDBN} does not pause during output no matter how long the
22062 output is. This is useful if output is to a file or to an editor
22063 buffer.
22064
22065 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width unlimited} or @samp{set
22066 width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN} from wrapping its output.
22067
22068 @item set pagination on
22069 @itemx set pagination off
22070 @kindex set pagination
22071 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
22072 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height unlimited}. Note that
22073 running @value{GDBN} with the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode
22074 Options, -batch}) also automatically disables pagination.
22075
22076 @item show pagination
22077 @kindex show pagination
22078 Show the current pagination mode.
22079 @end table
22080
22081 @node Numbers
22082 @section Numbers
22083 @cindex number representation
22084 @cindex entering numbers
22085
22086 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
22087 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
22088 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
22089 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
22090 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
22091 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
22092 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
22093 both input and output with the commands described below.
22094
22095 @table @code
22096 @kindex set input-radix
22097 @item set input-radix @var{base}
22098 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
22099 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
22100 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
22101 example, any of
22102
22103 @smallexample
22104 set input-radix 012
22105 set input-radix 10.
22106 set input-radix 0xa
22107 @end smallexample
22108
22109 @noindent
22110 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
22111 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
22112 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
22113 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
22114 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
22115 change the radix.
22116
22117 @kindex set output-radix
22118 @item set output-radix @var{base}
22119 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
22120 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
22121 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
22122
22123 @kindex show input-radix
22124 @item show input-radix
22125 Display the current default base for numeric input.
22126
22127 @kindex show output-radix
22128 @item show output-radix
22129 Display the current default base for numeric display.
22130
22131 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
22132 @itemx show radix
22133 @kindex set radix
22134 @kindex show radix
22135 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
22136 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
22137 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
22138 default value of 10.
22139
22140 @end table
22141
22142 @node ABI
22143 @section Configuring the Current ABI
22144
22145 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
22146 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
22147 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
22148 current ABI.
22149
22150 @cindex OS ABI
22151 @kindex set osabi
22152 @kindex show osabi
22153 @cindex Newlib OS ABI and its influence on the longjmp handling
22154
22155 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
22156 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
22157 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
22158 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
22159 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
22160 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
22161 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
22162 platform provides.
22163
22164 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides a
22165 ``Newlib'' OS ABI. This is useful for handling @code{setjmp} and
22166 @code{longjmp} when debugging binaries that use the @sc{newlib} C library.
22167 The ``Newlib'' OS ABI can be selected by @code{set osabi Newlib}.
22168
22169 @table @code
22170 @item show osabi
22171 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
22172
22173 @item set osabi
22174 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
22175
22176 @item set osabi @var{abi}
22177 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
22178 @end table
22179
22180 @cindex float promotion
22181
22182 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
22183 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
22184 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
22185 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
22186 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
22187 @code{double} and then passed.
22188
22189 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
22190 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
22191 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
22192
22193 @table @code
22194 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
22195 @item set coerce-float-to-double
22196 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
22197 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
22198 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
22199
22200 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
22201 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
22202 functions.
22203
22204 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
22205 @item show coerce-float-to-double
22206 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
22207 @end table
22208
22209 @kindex set cp-abi
22210 @kindex show cp-abi
22211 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
22212 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
22213 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
22214 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
22215 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
22216 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
22217 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
22218 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
22219 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
22220 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
22221 ``auto''.
22222
22223 @table @code
22224 @item show cp-abi
22225 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
22226
22227 @item set cp-abi
22228 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
22229
22230 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
22231 @itemx set cp-abi auto
22232 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
22233 @end table
22234
22235 @node Auto-loading
22236 @section Automatically loading associated files
22237 @cindex auto-loading
22238
22239 @value{GDBN} sometimes reads files with commands and settings automatically,
22240 without being explicitly told so by the user. We call this feature
22241 @dfn{auto-loading}. While auto-loading is useful for automatically adapting
22242 @value{GDBN} to the needs of your project, it can sometimes produce unexpected
22243 results or introduce security risks (e.g., if the file comes from untrusted
22244 sources).
22245
22246 @menu
22247 * Init File in the Current Directory:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load local-gdbinit}
22248 * libthread_db.so.1 file:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load libthread-db}
22249
22250 * Auto-loading safe path:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load safe-path}
22251 * Auto-loading verbose mode:: @samp{set/show debug auto-load}
22252 @end menu
22253
22254 There are various kinds of files @value{GDBN} can automatically load.
22255 In addition to these files, @value{GDBN} supports auto-loading code written
22256 in various extension languages. @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
22257
22258 Note that loading of these associated files (including the local @file{.gdbinit}
22259 file) requires accordingly configured @code{auto-load safe-path}
22260 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
22261
22262 For these reasons, @value{GDBN} includes commands and options to let you
22263 control when to auto-load files and which files should be auto-loaded.
22264
22265 @table @code
22266 @anchor{set auto-load off}
22267 @kindex set auto-load off
22268 @item set auto-load off
22269 Globally disable loading of all auto-loaded files.
22270 You may want to use this command with the @samp{-iex} option
22271 (@pxref{Option -init-eval-command}) such as:
22272 @smallexample
22273 $ @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load off" untrusted-executable corefile}
22274 @end smallexample
22275
22276 Be aware that system init file (@pxref{System-wide configuration})
22277 and init files from your home directory (@pxref{Home Directory Init File})
22278 still get read (as they come from generally trusted directories).
22279 To prevent @value{GDBN} from auto-loading even those init files, use the
22280 @option{-nx} option (@pxref{Mode Options}), in addition to
22281 @code{set auto-load no}.
22282
22283 @anchor{show auto-load}
22284 @kindex show auto-load
22285 @item show auto-load
22286 Show whether auto-loading of each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) is enabled
22287 or disabled.
22288
22289 @smallexample
22290 (gdb) show auto-load
22291 gdb-scripts: Auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is on.
22292 libthread-db: Auto-loading of inferior specific libthread_db is on.
22293 local-gdbinit: Auto-loading of .gdbinit script from current directory
22294 is on.
22295 python-scripts: Auto-loading of Python scripts is on.
22296 safe-path: List of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
22297 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
22298 scripts-directory: List of directories from which to load auto-loaded scripts
22299 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
22300 @end smallexample
22301
22302 @anchor{info auto-load}
22303 @kindex info auto-load
22304 @item info auto-load
22305 Print whether each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) have been auto-loaded or
22306 not.
22307
22308 @smallexample
22309 (gdb) info auto-load
22310 gdb-scripts:
22311 Loaded Script
22312 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb
22313 libthread-db: No auto-loaded libthread-db.
22314 local-gdbinit: Local .gdbinit file "/home/user/gdb/.gdbinit" has been
22315 loaded.
22316 python-scripts:
22317 Loaded Script
22318 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py
22319 @end smallexample
22320 @end table
22321
22322 These are @value{GDBN} control commands for the auto-loading:
22323
22324 @multitable @columnfractions .5 .5
22325 @item @xref{set auto-load off}.
22326 @tab Disable auto-loading globally.
22327 @item @xref{show auto-load}.
22328 @tab Show setting of all kinds of files.
22329 @item @xref{info auto-load}.
22330 @tab Show state of all kinds of files.
22331 @item @xref{set auto-load gdb-scripts}.
22332 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} command scripts.
22333 @item @xref{show auto-load gdb-scripts}.
22334 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
22335 @item @xref{info auto-load gdb-scripts}.
22336 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
22337 @item @xref{set auto-load python-scripts}.
22338 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
22339 @item @xref{show auto-load python-scripts}.
22340 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
22341 @item @xref{info auto-load python-scripts}.
22342 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
22343 @item @xref{set auto-load guile-scripts}.
22344 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
22345 @item @xref{show auto-load guile-scripts}.
22346 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
22347 @item @xref{info auto-load guile-scripts}.
22348 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
22349 @item @xref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
22350 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
22351 @item @xref{show auto-load scripts-directory}.
22352 @tab Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
22353 @item @xref{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
22354 @tab Control for init file in the current directory.
22355 @item @xref{show auto-load local-gdbinit}.
22356 @tab Show setting of init file in the current directory.
22357 @item @xref{info auto-load local-gdbinit}.
22358 @tab Show state of init file in the current directory.
22359 @item @xref{set auto-load libthread-db}.
22360 @tab Control for thread debugging library.
22361 @item @xref{show auto-load libthread-db}.
22362 @tab Show setting of thread debugging library.
22363 @item @xref{info auto-load libthread-db}.
22364 @tab Show state of thread debugging library.
22365 @item @xref{set auto-load safe-path}.
22366 @tab Control directories trusted for automatic loading.
22367 @item @xref{show auto-load safe-path}.
22368 @tab Show directories trusted for automatic loading.
22369 @item @xref{add-auto-load-safe-path}.
22370 @tab Add directory trusted for automatic loading.
22371 @end multitable
22372
22373 @node Init File in the Current Directory
22374 @subsection Automatically loading init file in the current directory
22375 @cindex auto-loading init file in the current directory
22376
22377 By default, @value{GDBN} reads and executes the canned sequences of commands
22378 from init file (if any) in the current working directory,
22379 see @ref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}.
22380
22381 Note that loading of this local @file{.gdbinit} file also requires accordingly
22382 configured @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
22383
22384 @table @code
22385 @anchor{set auto-load local-gdbinit}
22386 @kindex set auto-load local-gdbinit
22387 @item set auto-load local-gdbinit [on|off]
22388 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands
22389 (@pxref{Sequences}) found in init file in the current directory.
22390
22391 @anchor{show auto-load local-gdbinit}
22392 @kindex show auto-load local-gdbinit
22393 @item show auto-load local-gdbinit
22394 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands from init file in the
22395 current directory is enabled or disabled.
22396
22397 @anchor{info auto-load local-gdbinit}
22398 @kindex info auto-load local-gdbinit
22399 @item info auto-load local-gdbinit
22400 Print whether canned sequences of commands from init file in the
22401 current directory have been auto-loaded.
22402 @end table
22403
22404 @node libthread_db.so.1 file
22405 @subsection Automatically loading thread debugging library
22406 @cindex auto-loading libthread_db.so.1
22407
22408 This feature is currently present only on @sc{gnu}/Linux native hosts.
22409
22410 @value{GDBN} reads in some cases thread debugging library from places specific
22411 to the inferior (@pxref{set libthread-db-search-path}).
22412
22413 The special @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entry @samp{$sdir} is processed
22414 without checking this @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} switch as system
22415 libraries have to be trusted in general. In all other cases of
22416 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entries @value{GDBN} checks first if @samp{set
22417 auto-load libthread-db} is enabled before trying to open such thread debugging
22418 library.
22419
22420 Note that loading of this debugging library also requires accordingly configured
22421 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
22422
22423 @table @code
22424 @anchor{set auto-load libthread-db}
22425 @kindex set auto-load libthread-db
22426 @item set auto-load libthread-db [on|off]
22427 Enable or disable the auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library.
22428
22429 @anchor{show auto-load libthread-db}
22430 @kindex show auto-load libthread-db
22431 @item show auto-load libthread-db
22432 Show whether auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library is
22433 enabled or disabled.
22434
22435 @anchor{info auto-load libthread-db}
22436 @kindex info auto-load libthread-db
22437 @item info auto-load libthread-db
22438 Print the list of all loaded inferior specific thread debugging libraries and
22439 for each such library print list of inferior @var{pid}s using it.
22440 @end table
22441
22442 @node Auto-loading safe path
22443 @subsection Security restriction for auto-loading
22444 @cindex auto-loading safe-path
22445
22446 As the files of inferior can come from untrusted source (such as submitted by
22447 an application user) @value{GDBN} does not always load any files automatically.
22448 @value{GDBN} provides the @samp{set auto-load safe-path} setting to list
22449 directories trusted for loading files not explicitly requested by user.
22450 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern.
22451
22452 If the path is not set properly you will see a warning and the file will not
22453 get loaded:
22454
22455 @smallexample
22456 $ ./gdb -q ./gdb
22457 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/gdb...done.
22458 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been
22459 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
22460 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
22461 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py" auto-loading has been
22462 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
22463 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
22464 @end smallexample
22465
22466 @noindent
22467 To instruct @value{GDBN} to go ahead and use the init files anyway,
22468 invoke @value{GDBN} like this:
22469
22470 @smallexample
22471 $ gdb -q -iex "set auto-load safe-path /home/user/gdb" ./gdb
22472 @end smallexample
22473
22474 The list of trusted directories is controlled by the following commands:
22475
22476 @table @code
22477 @anchor{set auto-load safe-path}
22478 @kindex set auto-load safe-path
22479 @item set auto-load safe-path @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
22480 Set the list of directories (and their subdirectories) trusted for automatic
22481 loading and execution of scripts. You can also enter a specific trusted file.
22482 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern; wildcards do not match
22483 directory separator - see @code{FNM_PATHNAME} for system function @code{fnmatch}
22484 (@pxref{Wildcard Matching, fnmatch, , libc, GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
22485 If you omit @var{directories}, @samp{auto-load safe-path} will be reset to
22486 its default value as specified during @value{GDBN} compilation.
22487
22488 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
22489 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
22490 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
22491
22492 @anchor{show auto-load safe-path}
22493 @kindex show auto-load safe-path
22494 @item show auto-load safe-path
22495 Show the list of directories trusted for automatic loading and execution of
22496 scripts.
22497
22498 @anchor{add-auto-load-safe-path}
22499 @kindex add-auto-load-safe-path
22500 @item add-auto-load-safe-path
22501 Add an entry (or list of entries) the list of directories trusted for automatic
22502 loading and execution of scripts. Multiple entries may be delimited by the
22503 host platform path separator in use.
22504 @end table
22505
22506 This variable defaults to what @code{--with-auto-load-dir} has been configured
22507 to (@pxref{with-auto-load-dir}). @file{$debugdir} and @file{$datadir}
22508 substitution applies the same as for @ref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
22509 The default @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by
22510 @value{GDBN} configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-safe-path}.
22511
22512 Setting this variable to @file{/} disables this security protection,
22513 corresponding @value{GDBN} configuration option is
22514 @option{--without-auto-load-safe-path}.
22515 This variable is supposed to be set to the system directories writable by the
22516 system superuser only. Users can add their source directories in init files in
22517 their home directories (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). See also deprecated
22518 init file in the current directory
22519 (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}).
22520
22521 To force @value{GDBN} to load the files it declined to load in the previous
22522 example, you could use one of the following ways:
22523
22524 @table @asis
22525 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{add-auto-load-safe-path ~/src/gdb}
22526 Specify this trusted directory (or a file) as additional component of the list.
22527 You have to specify also any existing directories displayed by
22528 by @samp{show auto-load safe-path} (such as @samp{/usr:/bin} in this example).
22529
22530 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /usr:/bin:~/src/gdb" @dots{}}
22531 Specify this directory as in the previous case but just for a single
22532 @value{GDBN} session.
22533
22534 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /" @dots{}}
22535 Disable auto-loading safety for a single @value{GDBN} session.
22536 This assumes all the files you debug during this @value{GDBN} session will come
22537 from trusted sources.
22538
22539 @item @kbd{./configure --without-auto-load-safe-path}
22540 During compilation of @value{GDBN} you may disable any auto-loading safety.
22541 This assumes all the files you will ever debug with this @value{GDBN} come from
22542 trusted sources.
22543 @end table
22544
22545 On the other hand you can also explicitly forbid automatic files loading which
22546 also suppresses any such warning messages:
22547
22548 @table @asis
22549 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load no" @dots{}}
22550 You can use @value{GDBN} command-line option for a single @value{GDBN} session.
22551
22552 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{set auto-load no}
22553 Disable auto-loading globally for the user
22554 (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). While it is improbable, you could also
22555 use system init file instead (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
22556 @end table
22557
22558 This setting applies to the file names as entered by user. If no entry matches
22559 @value{GDBN} tries as a last resort to also resolve all the file names into
22560 their canonical form (typically resolving symbolic links) and compare the
22561 entries again. @value{GDBN} already canonicalizes most of the filenames on its
22562 own before starting the comparison so a canonical form of directories is
22563 recommended to be entered.
22564
22565 @node Auto-loading verbose mode
22566 @subsection Displaying files tried for auto-load
22567 @cindex auto-loading verbose mode
22568
22569 For better visibility of all the file locations where you can place scripts to
22570 be auto-loaded with inferior --- or to protect yourself against accidental
22571 execution of untrusted scripts --- @value{GDBN} provides a feature for printing
22572 all the files attempted to be loaded. Both existing and non-existing files may
22573 be printed.
22574
22575 For example the list of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
22576 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}) applies also to canonicalized filenames which
22577 may not be too obvious while setting it up.
22578
22579 @smallexample
22580 (gdb) set debug auto-load on
22581 (gdb) file ~/src/t/true
22582 auto-load: Loading canned sequences of commands script "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb"
22583 for objfile "/tmp/true".
22584 auto-load: Updating directories of "/usr:/opt".
22585 auto-load: Using directory "/usr".
22586 auto-load: Using directory "/opt".
22587 warning: File "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been declined
22588 by your `auto-load safe-path' set to "/usr:/opt".
22589 @end smallexample
22590
22591 @table @code
22592 @anchor{set debug auto-load}
22593 @kindex set debug auto-load
22594 @item set debug auto-load [on|off]
22595 Set whether to print the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded.
22596
22597 @anchor{show debug auto-load}
22598 @kindex show debug auto-load
22599 @item show debug auto-load
22600 Show whether printing of the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded is turned
22601 on or off.
22602 @end table
22603
22604 @node Messages/Warnings
22605 @section Optional Warnings and Messages
22606
22607 @cindex verbose operation
22608 @cindex optional warnings
22609 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
22610 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
22611 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
22612 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
22613
22614 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
22615 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
22616 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
22617
22618 @table @code
22619 @kindex set verbose
22620 @item set verbose on
22621 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
22622
22623 @item set verbose off
22624 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
22625
22626 @kindex show verbose
22627 @item show verbose
22628 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
22629 @end table
22630
22631 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
22632 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
22633 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
22634 Symbol Files}).
22635
22636 @table @code
22637
22638 @kindex set complaints
22639 @item set complaints @var{limit}
22640 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
22641 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
22642 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
22643 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
22644
22645 @kindex show complaints
22646 @item show complaints
22647 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
22648
22649 @end table
22650
22651 @anchor{confirmation requests}
22652 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
22653 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
22654 you try to run a program which is already running:
22655
22656 @smallexample
22657 (@value{GDBP}) run
22658 The program being debugged has been started already.
22659 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
22660 @end smallexample
22661
22662 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
22663 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
22664
22665 @table @code
22666
22667 @kindex set confirm
22668 @cindex flinching
22669 @cindex confirmation
22670 @cindex stupid questions
22671 @item set confirm off
22672 Disables confirmation requests. Note that running @value{GDBN} with
22673 the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode Options, -batch}) also
22674 automatically disables confirmation requests.
22675
22676 @item set confirm on
22677 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
22678
22679 @kindex show confirm
22680 @item show confirm
22681 Displays state of confirmation requests.
22682
22683 @end table
22684
22685 @cindex command tracing
22686 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
22687 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
22688 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
22689 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
22690
22691 @table @code
22692 @kindex set trace-commands
22693 @cindex command scripts, debugging
22694 @item set trace-commands on
22695 Enable command tracing.
22696 @item set trace-commands off
22697 Disable command tracing.
22698 @item show trace-commands
22699 Display the current state of command tracing.
22700 @end table
22701
22702 @node Debugging Output
22703 @section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
22704 @cindex optional debugging messages
22705
22706 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
22707 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
22708 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
22709 section documents those commands.
22710
22711 @table @code
22712 @kindex set exec-done-display
22713 @item set exec-done-display
22714 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
22715 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
22716 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
22717 @kindex show exec-done-display
22718 @item show exec-done-display
22719 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
22720 notification.
22721 @kindex set debug
22722 @cindex ARM AArch64
22723 @item set debug aarch64
22724 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to ARM AArch64.
22725 The default is off.
22726 @kindex show debug
22727 @item show debug aarch64
22728 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
22729 ARM AArch64.
22730 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
22731 @cindex architecture debugging info
22732 @item set debug arch
22733 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
22734 @item show debug arch
22735 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
22736 @item set debug aix-solib
22737 @cindex AIX shared library debugging
22738 Control display of debugging messages from the AIX shared library
22739 support module. The default is off.
22740 @item show debug aix-thread
22741 Show the current state of displaying AIX shared library debugging messages.
22742 @item set debug aix-thread
22743 @cindex AIX threads
22744 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
22745 module.
22746 @item show debug aix-thread
22747 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
22748 @item set debug check-physname
22749 @cindex physname
22750 Check the results of the ``physname'' computation. When reading DWARF
22751 debugging information for C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} attempts to compute
22752 each entity's name. @value{GDBN} can do this computation in two
22753 different ways, depending on exactly what information is present.
22754 When enabled, this setting causes @value{GDBN} to compute the names
22755 both ways and display any discrepancies.
22756 @item show debug check-physname
22757 Show the current state of ``physname'' checking.
22758 @item set debug coff-pe-read
22759 @cindex COFF/PE exported symbols
22760 Control display of debugging messages related to reading of COFF/PE
22761 exported symbols. The default is off.
22762 @item show debug coff-pe-read
22763 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
22764 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
22765 @item set debug dwarf2-die
22766 @cindex DWARF2 DIEs
22767 Dump DWARF2 DIEs after they are read in.
22768 The value is the number of nesting levels to print.
22769 A value of zero turns off the display.
22770 @item show debug dwarf2-die
22771 Show the current state of DWARF2 DIE debugging.
22772 @item set debug dwarf2-read
22773 @cindex DWARF2 Reading
22774 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
22775 DWARF debug info. The default is 0 (off).
22776 A value of 1 provides basic information.
22777 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
22778 @item show debug dwarf2-read
22779 Show the current state of DWARF2 reader debugging.
22780 @item set debug displaced
22781 @cindex displaced stepping debugging info
22782 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for the
22783 displaced stepping support. The default is off.
22784 @item show debug displaced
22785 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} debugging info
22786 related to displaced stepping.
22787 @item set debug event
22788 @cindex event debugging info
22789 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
22790 default is off.
22791 @item show debug event
22792 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
22793 info.
22794 @item set debug expression
22795 @cindex expression debugging info
22796 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
22797 expression parsing. The default is off.
22798 @item show debug expression
22799 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
22800 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
22801 @item set debug frame
22802 @cindex frame debugging info
22803 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
22804 default is off.
22805 @item show debug frame
22806 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
22807 info.
22808 @item set debug gnu-nat
22809 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug messages
22810 Turns on or off debugging messages from the @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug support.
22811 @item show debug gnu-nat
22812 Show the current state of @sc{gnu}/Hurd debugging messages.
22813 @item set debug infrun
22814 @cindex inferior debugging info
22815 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
22816 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
22817 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
22818 @item show debug infrun
22819 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
22820 @item set debug jit
22821 @cindex just-in-time compilation, debugging messages
22822 Turns on or off debugging messages from JIT debug support.
22823 @item show debug jit
22824 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} JIT debugging.
22825 @item set debug lin-lwp
22826 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
22827 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
22828 Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
22829 @item show debug lin-lwp
22830 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
22831 @item set debug mach-o
22832 @cindex Mach-O symbols processing
22833 Control display of debugging messages related to Mach-O symbols
22834 processing. The default is off.
22835 @item show debug mach-o
22836 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
22837 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
22838 @item set debug notification
22839 @cindex remote async notification debugging info
22840 Turns on or off debugging messages about remote async notification.
22841 The default is off.
22842 @item show debug notification
22843 Displays the current state of remote async notification debugging messages.
22844 @item set debug observer
22845 @cindex observer debugging info
22846 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
22847 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
22848 @item show debug observer
22849 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
22850 @item set debug overload
22851 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
22852 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
22853 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
22854 is off.
22855 @item show debug overload
22856 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
22857 debugging info.
22858 @cindex expression parser, debugging info
22859 @cindex debug expression parser
22860 @item set debug parser
22861 Turns on or off the display of expression parser debugging output.
22862 Internally, this sets the @code{yydebug} variable in the expression
22863 parser. @xref{Tracing, , Tracing Your Parser, bison, Bison}, for
22864 details. The default is off.
22865 @item show debug parser
22866 Show the current state of expression parser debugging.
22867 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
22868 @cindex serial connections, debugging
22869 @cindex debug remote protocol
22870 @cindex remote protocol debugging
22871 @cindex display remote packets
22872 @item set debug remote
22873 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
22874 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
22875 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
22876 @item show debug remote
22877 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
22878 @item set debug serial
22879 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
22880 default is off.
22881 @item show debug serial
22882 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
22883 info.
22884 @item set debug solib-frv
22885 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
22886 Turns on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
22887 @item show debug solib-frv
22888 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
22889 messages.
22890 @item set debug symfile
22891 @cindex symbol file functions
22892 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol file functions.
22893 The default is off. @xref{Files}.
22894 @item show debug symfile
22895 Show the current state of symbol file debugging messages.
22896 @item set debug symtab-create
22897 @cindex symbol table creation
22898 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol table creation.
22899 The default is 0 (off).
22900 A value of 1 provides basic information.
22901 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
22902 @item show debug symtab-create
22903 Show the current state of symbol table creation debugging.
22904 @item set debug target
22905 @cindex target debugging info
22906 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
22907 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
22908 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
22909 value of large memory transfers.
22910 @item show debug target
22911 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
22912 info.
22913 @item set debug timestamp
22914 @cindex timestampping debugging info
22915 Turns on or off display of timestamps with @value{GDBN} debugging info.
22916 When enabled, seconds and microseconds are displayed before each debugging
22917 message.
22918 @item show debug timestamp
22919 Displays the current state of displaying timestamps with @value{GDBN}
22920 debugging info.
22921 @item set debug varobj
22922 @cindex variable object debugging info
22923 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
22924 info. The default is off.
22925 @item show debug varobj
22926 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
22927 debugging info.
22928 @item set debug xml
22929 @cindex XML parser debugging
22930 Turns on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
22931 @item show debug xml
22932 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
22933 @end table
22934
22935 @node Other Misc Settings
22936 @section Other Miscellaneous Settings
22937 @cindex miscellaneous settings
22938
22939 @table @code
22940 @kindex set interactive-mode
22941 @item set interactive-mode
22942 If @code{on}, forces @value{GDBN} to assume that GDB was started
22943 in a terminal. In practice, this means that @value{GDBN} should wait
22944 for the user to answer queries generated by commands entered at
22945 the command prompt. If @code{off}, forces @value{GDBN} to operate
22946 in the opposite mode, and it uses the default answers to all queries.
22947 If @code{auto} (the default), @value{GDBN} tries to determine whether
22948 its standard input is a terminal, and works in interactive-mode if it
22949 is, non-interactively otherwise.
22950
22951 In the vast majority of cases, the debugger should be able to guess
22952 correctly which mode should be used. But this setting can be useful
22953 in certain specific cases, such as running a MinGW @value{GDBN}
22954 inside a cygwin window.
22955
22956 @kindex show interactive-mode
22957 @item show interactive-mode
22958 Displays whether the debugger is operating in interactive mode or not.
22959 @end table
22960
22961 @node Extending GDB
22962 @chapter Extending @value{GDBN}
22963 @cindex extending GDB
22964
22965 @value{GDBN} provides several mechanisms for extension.
22966 @value{GDBN} also provides the ability to automatically load
22967 extensions when it reads a file for debugging. This allows the
22968 user to automatically customize @value{GDBN} for the program
22969 being debugged.
22970
22971 @menu
22972 * Sequences:: Canned Sequences of @value{GDBN} Commands
22973 * Python:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Python
22974 * Guile:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Guile
22975 * Auto-loading extensions:: Automatically loading extensions
22976 * Multiple Extension Languages:: Working with multiple extension languages
22977 * Aliases:: Creating new spellings of existing commands
22978 @end menu
22979
22980 To facilitate the use of extension languages, @value{GDBN} is capable
22981 of evaluating the contents of a file. When doing so, @value{GDBN}
22982 can recognize which extension language is being used by looking at
22983 the filename extension. Files with an unrecognized filename extension
22984 are always treated as a @value{GDBN} Command Files.
22985 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
22986
22987 You can control how @value{GDBN} evaluates these files with the following
22988 setting:
22989
22990 @table @code
22991 @kindex set script-extension
22992 @kindex show script-extension
22993 @item set script-extension off
22994 All scripts are always evaluated as @value{GDBN} Command Files.
22995
22996 @item set script-extension soft
22997 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
22998 extension. If this scripting language is supported, @value{GDBN}
22999 evaluates the script using that language. Otherwise, it evaluates
23000 the file as a @value{GDBN} Command File.
23001
23002 @item set script-extension strict
23003 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
23004 extension, and evaluates the script using that language. If the
23005 language is not supported, then the evaluation fails.
23006
23007 @item show script-extension
23008 Display the current value of the @code{script-extension} option.
23009
23010 @end table
23011
23012 @node Sequences
23013 @section Canned Sequences of Commands
23014
23015 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
23016 Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
23017 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
23018 files.
23019
23020 @menu
23021 * Define:: How to define your own commands
23022 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
23023 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
23024 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
23025 * Auto-loading sequences:: Controlling auto-loaded command files
23026 @end menu
23027
23028 @node Define
23029 @subsection User-defined Commands
23030
23031 @cindex user-defined command
23032 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
23033 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
23034 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
23035 @code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
23036 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
23037 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
23038
23039 @smallexample
23040 define adder
23041 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
23042 end
23043 @end smallexample
23044
23045 @noindent
23046 To execute the command use:
23047
23048 @smallexample
23049 adder 1 2 3
23050 @end smallexample
23051
23052 @noindent
23053 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
23054 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
23055 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
23056 functions calls.
23057
23058 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
23059 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
23060 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
23061 been passed. This expands to a number in the range 0@dots{}10.
23062
23063 @smallexample
23064 define adder
23065 if $argc == 2
23066 print $arg0 + $arg1
23067 end
23068 if $argc == 3
23069 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
23070 end
23071 end
23072 @end smallexample
23073
23074 @table @code
23075
23076 @kindex define
23077 @item define @var{commandname}
23078 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
23079 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
23080 The argument @var{commandname} may be a bare command name consisting of letters,
23081 numbers, dashes, and underscores. It may also start with any predefined
23082 prefix command. For example, @samp{define target my-target} creates
23083 a user-defined @samp{target my-target} command.
23084
23085 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
23086 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
23087 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
23088
23089 @kindex document
23090 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
23091 @item document @var{commandname}
23092 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
23093 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
23094 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
23095 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
23096 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
23097 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
23098
23099 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
23100 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
23101 does not change the documentation.
23102
23103 @kindex dont-repeat
23104 @cindex don't repeat command
23105 @item dont-repeat
23106 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
23107 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
23108 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
23109
23110 @kindex help user-defined
23111 @item help user-defined
23112 List all user-defined commands and all python commands defined in class
23113 COMAND_USER. The first line of the documentation or docstring is
23114 included (if any).
23115
23116 @kindex show user
23117 @item show user
23118 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
23119 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
23120 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
23121 definitions for all user-defined commands.
23122 This does not work for user-defined python commands.
23123
23124 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
23125 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
23126 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
23127 @item show max-user-call-depth
23128 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
23129 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
23130 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
23131 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
23132 This does not apply to user-defined python commands.
23133 @end table
23134
23135 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
23136 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
23137
23138 When user-defined commands are executed, the
23139 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
23140 stops execution of the user-defined command.
23141
23142 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
23143 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
23144 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
23145 messages when used in a user-defined command.
23146
23147 @node Hooks
23148 @subsection User-defined Command Hooks
23149 @cindex command hooks
23150 @cindex hooks, for commands
23151 @cindex hooks, pre-command
23152
23153 @kindex hook
23154 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
23155 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
23156 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
23157 before that command.
23158
23159 @cindex hooks, post-command
23160 @kindex hookpost
23161 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
23162 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
23163 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
23164 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
23165 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
23166
23167 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
23168 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
23169
23170 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
23171 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
23172
23173 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
23174 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
23175 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
23176 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
23177 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
23178
23179 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
23180 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
23181 you could define:
23182
23183 @smallexample
23184 define hook-stop
23185 handle SIGALRM nopass
23186 end
23187
23188 define hook-run
23189 handle SIGALRM pass
23190 end
23191
23192 define hook-continue
23193 handle SIGALRM pass
23194 end
23195 @end smallexample
23196
23197 As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
23198 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
23199 you could define:
23200
23201 @smallexample
23202 define hook-echo
23203 echo <<<---
23204 end
23205
23206 define hookpost-echo
23207 echo --->>>\n
23208 end
23209
23210 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
23211 <<<---Hello World--->>>
23212 (@value{GDBP})
23213
23214 @end smallexample
23215
23216 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
23217 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
23218 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
23219 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
23220 @c or not?
23221 You can hook a multi-word command by adding @code{hook-} or
23222 @code{hookpost-} to the last word of the command, e.g.@:
23223 @samp{define target hook-remote} to add a hook to @samp{target remote}.
23224
23225 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
23226 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
23227 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
23228
23229 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
23230 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
23231
23232 @node Command Files
23233 @subsection Command Files
23234
23235 @cindex command files
23236 @cindex scripting commands
23237 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
23238 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
23239 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
23240 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
23241 terminal.
23242
23243 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
23244 command. Note that the @code{source} command is also used to evaluate
23245 scripts that are not Command Files. The exact behavior can be configured
23246 using the @code{script-extension} setting.
23247 @xref{Extending GDB,, Extending GDB}.
23248
23249 @table @code
23250 @kindex source
23251 @cindex execute commands from a file
23252 @item source [-s] [-v] @var{filename}
23253 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
23254 @end table
23255
23256 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
23257 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
23258 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
23259 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
23260 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
23261
23262 @value{GDBN} first searches for @var{filename} in the current directory.
23263 If the file is not found there, and @var{filename} does not specify a
23264 directory, then @value{GDBN} also looks for the file on the source search path
23265 (specified with the @samp{directory} command);
23266 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched because the compilation directory
23267 is not relevant to scripts.
23268
23269 If @code{-s} is specified, then @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename}
23270 on the search path even if @var{filename} specifies a directory.
23271 The search is done by appending @var{filename} to each element of the
23272 search path. So, for example, if @var{filename} is @file{mylib/myscript}
23273 and the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
23274 look for the script @file{/home/user/mylib/myscript}.
23275 The search is also done if @var{filename} is an absolute path.
23276 For example, if @var{filename} is @file{/tmp/myscript} and
23277 the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
23278 look for the script @file{/home/user/tmp/myscript}.
23279 For DOS-like systems, if @var{filename} contains a drive specification,
23280 it is stripped before concatenation. For example, if @var{filename} is
23281 @file{d:myscript} and the search path contains @file{c:/tmp} then @value{GDBN}
23282 will look for the script @file{c:/tmp/myscript}.
23283
23284 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
23285 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
23286 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
23287
23288 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
23289 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
23290 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
23291 when called from command files.
23292
23293 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
23294 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
23295 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
23296 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
23297 the next command.
23298
23299 @smallexample
23300 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
23301 @end smallexample
23302
23303 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
23304 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
23305 would be directed to @file{log}.
23306
23307 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
23308 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
23309 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
23310 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
23311 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
23312 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
23313 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
23314 conditionally, etc.
23315
23316 @table @code
23317 @kindex if
23318 @kindex else
23319 @item if
23320 @itemx else
23321 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
23322 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
23323 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
23324 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
23325 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
23326 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
23327 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
23328
23329 @kindex while
23330 @item while
23331 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
23332 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
23333 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
23334 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
23335 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
23336 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
23337
23338 @kindex loop_break
23339 @item loop_break
23340 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
23341 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
23342 line.
23343
23344 @kindex loop_continue
23345 @item loop_continue
23346 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
23347 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
23348 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
23349 the controlling expression.
23350
23351 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
23352 @item end
23353 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
23354 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
23355 @end table
23356
23357
23358 @node Output
23359 @subsection Commands for Controlled Output
23360
23361 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
23362 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
23363 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
23364 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
23365 want.
23366
23367 @table @code
23368 @kindex echo
23369 @item echo @var{text}
23370 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
23371 @c because it is not in ANSI.
23372 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
23373 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
23374 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
23375 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
23376 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
23377 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
23378 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
23379 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
23380 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
23381
23382 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
23383 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
23384
23385 @smallexample
23386 echo This is some text\n\
23387 which is continued\n\
23388 onto several lines.\n
23389 @end smallexample
23390
23391 produces the same output as
23392
23393 @smallexample
23394 echo This is some text\n
23395 echo which is continued\n
23396 echo onto several lines.\n
23397 @end smallexample
23398
23399 @kindex output
23400 @item output @var{expression}
23401 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
23402 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
23403 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
23404 on expressions.
23405
23406 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
23407 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
23408 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
23409 Formats}, for more information.
23410
23411 @kindex printf
23412 @item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
23413 Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
23414 the string @var{template}. To print several values, make
23415 @var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
23416 which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as
23417 specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
23418 executing the code below:
23419
23420 @smallexample
23421 printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
23422 @end smallexample
23423
23424 As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
23425 are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
23426 by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
23427 evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
23428 style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
23429 printed.
23430
23431 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
23432
23433 @smallexample
23434 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
23435 @end smallexample
23436
23437 @code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
23438 specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
23439 character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
23440
23441 @itemize @bullet
23442 @item
23443 The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
23444
23445 @item
23446 The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
23447 width.
23448
23449 @item
23450 The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
23451 @code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
23452
23453 @item
23454 The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
23455 supported.
23456
23457 @item
23458 The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
23459
23460 @item
23461 The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
23462 @end itemize
23463
23464 @noindent
23465 Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
23466 underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
23467 the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
23468 supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
23469
23470 As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
23471 sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
23472 @samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
23473 single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
23474 supported.
23475
23476 Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
23477 (@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers
23478 together with a floating point specifier.
23479 letters:
23480
23481 @itemize @bullet
23482 @item
23483 @samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
23484
23485 @item
23486 @samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
23487
23488 @item
23489 @samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
23490 @end itemize
23491
23492 If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
23493 support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers
23494 such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
23495
23496 In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
23497 available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
23498
23499 Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
23500 @smallexample
23501 printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
23502 @end smallexample
23503
23504 @kindex eval
23505 @item eval @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
23506 Convert the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
23507 the string @var{template} to a command line, and call it.
23508
23509 @end table
23510
23511 @node Auto-loading sequences
23512 @subsection Controlling auto-loading native @value{GDBN} scripts
23513 @cindex native script auto-loading
23514
23515 When a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
23516 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library),
23517 @value{GDBN} will look for the command file @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}.
23518 @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
23519
23520 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
23521 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
23522
23523 @table @code
23524 @anchor{set auto-load gdb-scripts}
23525 @kindex set auto-load gdb-scripts
23526 @item set auto-load gdb-scripts [on|off]
23527 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts.
23528
23529 @anchor{show auto-load gdb-scripts}
23530 @kindex show auto-load gdb-scripts
23531 @item show auto-load gdb-scripts
23532 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is enabled or
23533 disabled.
23534
23535 @anchor{info auto-load gdb-scripts}
23536 @kindex info auto-load gdb-scripts
23537 @cindex print list of auto-loaded canned sequences of commands scripts
23538 @item info auto-load gdb-scripts [@var{regexp}]
23539 Print the list of all canned sequences of commands scripts that @value{GDBN}
23540 auto-loaded.
23541 @end table
23542
23543 If @var{regexp} is supplied only canned sequences of commands scripts with
23544 matching names are printed.
23545
23546 @c Python docs live in a separate file.
23547 @include python.texi
23548
23549 @c Guile docs live in a separate file.
23550 @include guile.texi
23551
23552 @node Auto-loading extensions
23553 @section Auto-loading extensions
23554 @cindex auto-loading extensions
23555
23556 @value{GDBN} provides two mechanisms for automatically loading extensions
23557 when a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
23558 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library):
23559 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} and the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}
23560 section of modern file formats like ELF.
23561
23562 @menu
23563 * objfile-gdb.ext file: objfile-gdbdotext file. The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
23564 * .debug_gdb_scripts section: dotdebug_gdb_scripts section. The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
23565 * Which flavor to choose?::
23566 @end menu
23567
23568 The auto-loading feature is useful for supplying application-specific
23569 debugging commands and features.
23570
23571 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
23572 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
23573 See the @samp{auto-loading} section of each extension language
23574 for more information.
23575 For @value{GDBN} command files see @ref{Auto-loading sequences}.
23576 For Python files see @ref{Python Auto-loading}.
23577
23578 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
23579 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23580
23581 @node objfile-gdbdotext file
23582 @subsection The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
23583 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
23584 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
23585 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
23586
23587 When a new object file is read, @value{GDBN} looks for a file named
23588 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} (we call it @var{script-name} below),
23589 where @var{objfile} is the object file's name and
23590 where @var{ext} is the file extension for the extension language:
23591
23592 @table @code
23593 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
23594 GDB's own command language
23595 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
23596 Python
23597 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
23598 Guile
23599 @end table
23600
23601 @var{script-name} is formed by ensuring that the file name of @var{objfile}
23602 is absolute, following all symlinks, and resolving @code{.} and @code{..}
23603 components, and appending the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} suffix.
23604 If this file exists and is readable, @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as a
23605 script in the specified extension language.
23606
23607 If this file does not exist, then @value{GDBN} will look for
23608 @var{script-name} file in all of the directories as specified below.
23609
23610 Note that loading of these files requires an accordingly configured
23611 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23612
23613 For object files using @file{.exe} suffix @value{GDBN} tries to load first the
23614 scripts normally according to its @file{.exe} filename. But if no scripts are
23615 found @value{GDBN} also tries script filenames matching the object file without
23616 its @file{.exe} suffix. This @file{.exe} stripping is case insensitive and it
23617 is attempted on any platform. This makes the script filenames compatible
23618 between Unix and MS-Windows hosts.
23619
23620 @table @code
23621 @anchor{set auto-load scripts-directory}
23622 @kindex set auto-load scripts-directory
23623 @item set auto-load scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
23624 Control @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location. Multiple directory entries
23625 may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use
23626 (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS).
23627
23628 Each entry here needs to be covered also by the security setting
23629 @code{set auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{set auto-load safe-path}).
23630
23631 @anchor{with-auto-load-dir}
23632 This variable defaults to @file{$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load}. The default
23633 @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by @value{GDBN}
23634 configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-dir}.
23635
23636 Any reference to @file{$debugdir} will get replaced by
23637 @var{debug-file-directory} value (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}) and any
23638 reference to @file{$datadir} will get replaced by @var{data-directory} which is
23639 determined at @value{GDBN} startup (@pxref{Data Files}). @file{$debugdir} and
23640 @file{$datadir} must be placed as a directory component --- either alone or
23641 delimited by @file{/} or @file{\} directory separators, depending on the host
23642 platform.
23643
23644 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
23645 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
23646 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
23647
23648 @anchor{show auto-load scripts-directory}
23649 @kindex show auto-load scripts-directory
23650 @item show auto-load scripts-directory
23651 Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
23652 @end table
23653
23654 @value{GDBN} does not track which files it has already auto-loaded this way.
23655 @value{GDBN} will load the associated script every time the corresponding
23656 @var{objfile} is opened.
23657 So your @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} file should be careful to avoid errors if it
23658 is evaluated more than once.
23659
23660 @node dotdebug_gdb_scripts section
23661 @subsection The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
23662 @cindex @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
23663
23664 For systems using file formats like ELF and COFF,
23665 when @value{GDBN} loads a new object file
23666 it will look for a special section named @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
23667 If this section exists, its contents is a list of NUL-terminated names
23668 of scripts to load. Each entry begins with a non-NULL prefix byte that
23669 specifies the kind of entry, typically the extension language.
23670
23671 @value{GDBN} will look for each specified script file first in the
23672 current directory and then along the source search path
23673 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}),
23674 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched, since the compilation
23675 directory is not relevant to scripts.
23676
23677 Entries can be placed in section @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} with,
23678 for example, this GCC macro for Python scripts.
23679
23680 @example
23681 /* Note: The "MS" section flags are to remove duplicates. */
23682 #define DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT(script_name) \
23683 asm("\
23684 .pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n\
23685 .byte 1 /* Python */\n\
23686 .asciz \"" script_name "\"\n\
23687 .popsection \n\
23688 ");
23689 @end example
23690
23691 @noindent
23692 For Guile scripts, replace @code{.byte 1} with @code{.byte 3}.
23693 Then one can reference the macro in a header or source file like this:
23694
23695 @example
23696 DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT ("my-app-scripts.py")
23697 @end example
23698
23699 The script name may include directories if desired.
23700
23701 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
23702 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23703
23704 If the macro invocation is put in a header, any application or library
23705 using this header will get a reference to the specified script,
23706 and with the use of @code{"MS"} attributes on the section, the linker
23707 will remove duplicates.
23708
23709 @node Which flavor to choose?
23710 @subsection Which flavor to choose?
23711
23712 Given the multiple ways of auto-loading extensions, it might not always
23713 be clear which one to choose. This section provides some guidance.
23714
23715 @noindent
23716 Benefits of the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way:
23717
23718 @itemize @bullet
23719 @item
23720 Can be used with file formats that don't support multiple sections.
23721
23722 @item
23723 Ease of finding scripts for public libraries.
23724
23725 Scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section are searched for
23726 in the source search path.
23727 For publicly installed libraries, e.g., @file{libstdc++}, there typically
23728 isn't a source directory in which to find the script.
23729
23730 @item
23731 Doesn't require source code additions.
23732 @end itemize
23733
23734 @noindent
23735 Benefits of the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} way:
23736
23737 @itemize @bullet
23738 @item
23739 Works with static linking.
23740
23741 Scripts for libraries done the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way require an objfile to
23742 trigger their loading. When an application is statically linked the only
23743 objfile available is the executable, and it is cumbersome to attach all the
23744 scripts from all the input libraries to the executable's
23745 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script.
23746
23747 @item
23748 Works with classes that are entirely inlined.
23749
23750 Some classes can be entirely inlined, and thus there may not be an associated
23751 shared library to attach a @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script to.
23752
23753 @item
23754 Scripts needn't be copied out of the source tree.
23755
23756 In some circumstances, apps can be built out of large collections of internal
23757 libraries, and the build infrastructure necessary to install the
23758 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} scripts in a place where @value{GDBN} can find them is
23759 cumbersome. It may be easier to specify the scripts in the
23760 @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section as relative paths, and add a path to the
23761 top of the source tree to the source search path.
23762 @end itemize
23763
23764 @node Multiple Extension Languages
23765 @section Multiple Extension Languages
23766
23767 The Guile and Python extension languages do not share any state,
23768 and generally do not interfere with each other.
23769 There are some things to be aware of, however.
23770
23771 @subsection Python comes first
23772
23773 Python was @value{GDBN}'s first extension language, and to avoid breaking
23774 existing behaviour Python comes first. This is generally solved by the
23775 ``first one wins'' principle. @value{GDBN} maintains a list of enabled
23776 extension languages, and when it makes a call to an extension language,
23777 (say to pretty-print a value), it tries each in turn until an extension
23778 language indicates it has performed the request (e.g., has returned the
23779 pretty-printed form of a value).
23780 This extends to errors while performing such requests: If an error happens
23781 while, for example, trying to pretty-print an object then the error is
23782 reported and any following extension languages are not tried.
23783
23784 @node Aliases
23785 @section Creating new spellings of existing commands
23786 @cindex aliases for commands
23787
23788 It is often useful to define alternate spellings of existing commands.
23789 For example, if a new @value{GDBN} command defined in Python has
23790 a long name to type, it is handy to have an abbreviated version of it
23791 that involves less typing.
23792
23793 @value{GDBN} itself uses aliases. For example @samp{s} is an alias
23794 of the @samp{step} command even though it is otherwise an ambiguous
23795 abbreviation of other commands like @samp{set} and @samp{show}.
23796
23797 Aliases are also used to provide shortened or more common versions
23798 of multi-word commands. For example, @value{GDBN} provides the
23799 @samp{tty} alias of the @samp{set inferior-tty} command.
23800
23801 You can define a new alias with the @samp{alias} command.
23802
23803 @table @code
23804
23805 @kindex alias
23806 @item alias [-a] [--] @var{ALIAS} = @var{COMMAND}
23807
23808 @end table
23809
23810 @var{ALIAS} specifies the name of the new alias.
23811 Each word of @var{ALIAS} must consist of letters, numbers, dashes and
23812 underscores.
23813
23814 @var{COMMAND} specifies the name of an existing command
23815 that is being aliased.
23816
23817 The @samp{-a} option specifies that the new alias is an abbreviation
23818 of the command. Abbreviations are not shown in command
23819 lists displayed by the @samp{help} command.
23820
23821 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
23822 and is useful when @var{ALIAS} begins with a dash.
23823
23824 Here is a simple example showing how to make an abbreviation
23825 of a command so that there is less to type.
23826 Suppose you were tired of typing @samp{disas}, the current
23827 shortest unambiguous abbreviation of the @samp{disassemble} command
23828 and you wanted an even shorter version named @samp{di}.
23829 The following will accomplish this.
23830
23831 @smallexample
23832 (gdb) alias -a di = disas
23833 @end smallexample
23834
23835 Note that aliases are different from user-defined commands.
23836 With a user-defined command, you also need to write documentation
23837 for it with the @samp{document} command.
23838 An alias automatically picks up the documentation of the existing command.
23839
23840 Here is an example where we make @samp{elms} an abbreviation of
23841 @samp{elements} in the @samp{set print elements} command.
23842 This is to show that you can make an abbreviation of any part
23843 of a command.
23844
23845 @smallexample
23846 (gdb) alias -a set print elms = set print elements
23847 (gdb) alias -a show print elms = show print elements
23848 (gdb) set p elms 20
23849 (gdb) show p elms
23850 Limit on string chars or array elements to print is 200.
23851 @end smallexample
23852
23853 Note that if you are defining an alias of a @samp{set} command,
23854 and you want to have an alias for the corresponding @samp{show}
23855 command, then you need to define the latter separately.
23856
23857 Unambiguously abbreviated commands are allowed in @var{COMMAND} and
23858 @var{ALIAS}, just as they are normally.
23859
23860 @smallexample
23861 (gdb) alias -a set pr elms = set p ele
23862 @end smallexample
23863
23864 Finally, here is an example showing the creation of a one word
23865 alias for a more complex command.
23866 This creates alias @samp{spe} of the command @samp{set print elements}.
23867
23868 @smallexample
23869 (gdb) alias spe = set print elements
23870 (gdb) spe 20
23871 @end smallexample
23872
23873 @node Interpreters
23874 @chapter Command Interpreters
23875 @cindex command interpreters
23876
23877 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
23878 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
23879 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
23880
23881 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
23882 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
23883 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
23884 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
23885
23886 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
23887 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
23888 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
23889 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
23890
23891 @table @code
23892 @item console
23893 @cindex console interpreter
23894 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
23895 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
23896 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
23897
23898 @item mi
23899 @cindex mi interpreter
23900 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
23901 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
23902 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
23903 Interface}.
23904
23905 @item mi2
23906 @cindex mi2 interpreter
23907 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
23908
23909 @item mi1
23910 @cindex mi1 interpreter
23911 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
23912
23913 @end table
23914
23915 @cindex invoke another interpreter
23916 The interpreter being used by @value{GDBN} may not be dynamically
23917 switched at runtime. Although possible, this could lead to a very
23918 precarious situation. Consider an IDE using @sc{gdb/mi}. If a user
23919 enters the command "interpreter-set console" in a console view,
23920 @value{GDBN} would switch to using the console interpreter, rendering
23921 the IDE inoperable!
23922
23923 @kindex interpreter-exec
23924 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, you may execute
23925 commands in any interpreter from the current interpreter using the appropriate
23926 command. If you are running the console interpreter, simply use the
23927 @code{interpreter-exec} command:
23928
23929 @smallexample
23930 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
23931 @end smallexample
23932
23933 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
23934 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
23935
23936 @node TUI
23937 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
23938 @cindex TUI
23939 @cindex Text User Interface
23940
23941 @menu
23942 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
23943 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
23944 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
23945 * TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
23946 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
23947 @end menu
23948
23949 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
23950 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
23951 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
23952 commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
23953 on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
23954 is available.
23955
23956 The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
23957 @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
23958 You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
23959 using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @kbd{C-x C-a}.
23960 @xref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
23961
23962 @node TUI Overview
23963 @section TUI Overview
23964
23965 In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
23966
23967 @table @emph
23968 @item command
23969 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
23970 prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
23971 managed using readline.
23972
23973 @item source
23974 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
23975 line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
23976
23977 @item assembly
23978 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
23979
23980 @item register
23981 This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
23982 when their values change.
23983 @end table
23984
23985 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
23986 by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
23987 Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
23988 indicates the breakpoint type:
23989
23990 @table @code
23991 @item B
23992 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
23993
23994 @item b
23995 Breakpoint which was never hit.
23996
23997 @item H
23998 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
23999
24000 @item h
24001 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
24002 @end table
24003
24004 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
24005
24006 @table @code
24007 @item +
24008 Breakpoint is enabled.
24009
24010 @item -
24011 Breakpoint is disabled.
24012 @end table
24013
24014 The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
24015 thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
24016 changes.
24017
24018 These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
24019 window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
24020 layouts:
24021
24022 @itemize @bullet
24023 @item
24024 source only,
24025
24026 @item
24027 assembly only,
24028
24029 @item
24030 source and assembly,
24031
24032 @item
24033 source and registers, or
24034
24035 @item
24036 assembly and registers.
24037 @end itemize
24038
24039 A status line above the command window shows the following information:
24040
24041 @table @emph
24042 @item target
24043 Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
24044 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
24045
24046 @item process
24047 Gives the current process or thread number.
24048 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
24049
24050 @item function
24051 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
24052 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
24053 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
24054 the string @code{??} is displayed.
24055
24056 @item line
24057 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
24058 When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
24059
24060 @item pc
24061 Indicates the current program counter address.
24062 @end table
24063
24064 @node TUI Keys
24065 @section TUI Key Bindings
24066 @cindex TUI key bindings
24067
24068 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
24069 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
24070 (@pxref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library}).
24071 @end ifset
24072 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
24073 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
24074 @end ifclear
24075 The following key bindings are installed for both TUI mode and the
24076 @value{GDBN} standard mode.
24077
24078 @table @kbd
24079 @kindex C-x C-a
24080 @item C-x C-a
24081 @kindex C-x a
24082 @itemx C-x a
24083 @kindex C-x A
24084 @itemx C-x A
24085 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
24086 the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
24087 its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
24088 the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
24089 The screen is then refreshed.
24090
24091 @kindex C-x 1
24092 @item C-x 1
24093 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
24094 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
24095 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
24096
24097 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
24098
24099 @kindex C-x 2
24100 @item C-x 2
24101 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
24102 layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
24103 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
24104 previous layout and the new one.
24105
24106 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
24107
24108 @kindex C-x o
24109 @item C-x o
24110 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
24111 (like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
24112 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
24113
24114 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
24115
24116 @kindex C-x s
24117 @item C-x s
24118 Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
24119 keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
24120 @end table
24121
24122 The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
24123
24124 @table @asis
24125 @kindex PgUp
24126 @item @key{PgUp}
24127 Scroll the active window one page up.
24128
24129 @kindex PgDn
24130 @item @key{PgDn}
24131 Scroll the active window one page down.
24132
24133 @kindex Up
24134 @item @key{Up}
24135 Scroll the active window one line up.
24136
24137 @kindex Down
24138 @item @key{Down}
24139 Scroll the active window one line down.
24140
24141 @kindex Left
24142 @item @key{Left}
24143 Scroll the active window one column left.
24144
24145 @kindex Right
24146 @item @key{Right}
24147 Scroll the active window one column right.
24148
24149 @kindex C-L
24150 @item @kbd{C-L}
24151 Refresh the screen.
24152 @end table
24153
24154 Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
24155 are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
24156 window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
24157 other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
24158 and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
24159
24160 @node TUI Single Key Mode
24161 @section TUI Single Key Mode
24162 @cindex TUI single key mode
24163
24164 The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
24165 frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
24166 switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
24167
24168 @table @kbd
24169 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24170 @item c
24171 continue
24172
24173 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24174 @item d
24175 down
24176
24177 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24178 @item f
24179 finish
24180
24181 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24182 @item n
24183 next
24184
24185 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24186 @item q
24187 exit the SingleKey mode.
24188
24189 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24190 @item r
24191 run
24192
24193 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24194 @item s
24195 step
24196
24197 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24198 @item u
24199 up
24200
24201 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24202 @item v
24203 info locals
24204
24205 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24206 @item w
24207 where
24208 @end table
24209
24210 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
24211 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
24212 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
24213 with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
24214 SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
24215 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
24216
24217
24218 @node TUI Commands
24219 @section TUI-specific Commands
24220 @cindex TUI commands
24221
24222 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
24223 These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
24224 the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
24225 of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
24226
24227 Note that if @value{GDBN}'s @code{stdout} is not connected to a
24228 terminal, or @value{GDBN} has been started with the machine interface
24229 interpreter (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}), most of
24230 these commands will fail with an error, because it would not be
24231 possible or desirable to enable curses window management.
24232
24233 @table @code
24234 @item info win
24235 @kindex info win
24236 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
24237
24238 @item layout next
24239 @kindex layout
24240 Display the next layout.
24241
24242 @item layout prev
24243 Display the previous layout.
24244
24245 @item layout src
24246 Display the source window only.
24247
24248 @item layout asm
24249 Display the assembly window only.
24250
24251 @item layout split
24252 Display the source and assembly window.
24253
24254 @item layout regs
24255 Display the register window together with the source or assembly window.
24256
24257 @item focus next
24258 @kindex focus
24259 Make the next window active for scrolling.
24260
24261 @item focus prev
24262 Make the previous window active for scrolling.
24263
24264 @item focus src
24265 Make the source window active for scrolling.
24266
24267 @item focus asm
24268 Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
24269
24270 @item focus regs
24271 Make the register window active for scrolling.
24272
24273 @item focus cmd
24274 Make the command window active for scrolling.
24275
24276 @item refresh
24277 @kindex refresh
24278 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
24279
24280 @item tui reg float
24281 @kindex tui reg
24282 Show the floating point registers in the register window.
24283
24284 @item tui reg general
24285 Show the general registers in the register window.
24286
24287 @item tui reg next
24288 Show the next register group. The list of register groups as well as
24289 their order is target specific. The predefined register groups are the
24290 following: @code{general}, @code{float}, @code{system}, @code{vector},
24291 @code{all}, @code{save}, @code{restore}.
24292
24293 @item tui reg system
24294 Show the system registers in the register window.
24295
24296 @item update
24297 @kindex update
24298 Update the source window and the current execution point.
24299
24300 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
24301 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
24302 @kindex winheight
24303 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
24304 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
24305 decrease it.
24306
24307 @item tabset @var{nchars}
24308 @kindex tabset
24309 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters.
24310 @end table
24311
24312 @node TUI Configuration
24313 @section TUI Configuration Variables
24314 @cindex TUI configuration variables
24315
24316 Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
24317
24318 @table @code
24319 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
24320 @kindex set tui border-kind
24321 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
24322 The possible values are the following:
24323 @table @code
24324 @item space
24325 Use a space character to draw the border.
24326
24327 @item ascii
24328 Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
24329
24330 @item acs
24331 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
24332 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
24333 @end table
24334
24335 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
24336 @kindex set tui border-mode
24337 @itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
24338 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
24339 Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
24340 or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
24341 @table @code
24342 @item normal
24343 Use normal attributes to display the border.
24344
24345 @item standout
24346 Use standout mode.
24347
24348 @item reverse
24349 Use reverse video mode.
24350
24351 @item half
24352 Use half bright mode.
24353
24354 @item half-standout
24355 Use half bright and standout mode.
24356
24357 @item bold
24358 Use extra bright or bold mode.
24359
24360 @item bold-standout
24361 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
24362 @end table
24363 @end table
24364
24365 @node Emacs
24366 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
24367
24368 @cindex Emacs
24369 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
24370 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
24371 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
24372 @value{GDBN}.
24373
24374 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
24375 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
24376 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
24377 created Emacs buffer.
24378 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
24379
24380 Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
24381 things:
24382
24383 @itemize @bullet
24384 @item
24385 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
24386 the GUD buffer.
24387
24388 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
24389 and output done by the program you are debugging.
24390
24391 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
24392 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
24393 in this way.
24394
24395 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
24396 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
24397 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
24398 stop.
24399
24400 @item
24401 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
24402
24403 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
24404 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
24405 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
24406 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
24407 and the source.
24408
24409 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
24410 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
24411 @end itemize
24412
24413 We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
24414 a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
24415 that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
24416 @xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
24417
24418 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
24419 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
24420 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
24421 sets your current working directory to the directory associated
24422 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
24423 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
24424 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
24425 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
24426 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
24427
24428 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
24429 line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
24430 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
24431 ,Commands to Specify Files}.
24432
24433 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
24434 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
24435 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
24436 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
24437 one you want.
24438
24439 In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
24440 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
24441
24442 @table @kbd
24443 @item C-h m
24444 Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
24445
24446 @item C-c C-s
24447 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
24448 update the display window to show the current file and location.
24449
24450 @item C-c C-n
24451 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
24452 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
24453 to show the current file and location.
24454
24455 @item C-c C-i
24456 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
24457 display window accordingly.
24458
24459 @item C-c C-f
24460 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
24461 @code{finish} command.
24462
24463 @item C-c C-r
24464 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
24465 command.
24466
24467 @item C-c <
24468 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
24469 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
24470 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
24471
24472 @item C-c >
24473 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
24474 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
24475 @end table
24476
24477 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
24478 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
24479
24480 In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
24481 separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
24482 Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
24483 become the current frame and display the associated source in the
24484 source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
24485 selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
24486 speedbar displays watch expressions.
24487
24488 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
24489 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
24490 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
24491 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
24492 frame.
24493
24494 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
24495 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
24496 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
24497 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
24498 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
24499 to correspond properly with the code.
24500
24501 A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
24502 given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
24503 Emacs Manual}).
24504
24505 @node GDB/MI
24506 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
24507
24508 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
24509
24510 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
24511 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
24512 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
24513 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
24514 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
24515 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
24516
24517 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
24518 in the form of a reference manual.
24519
24520 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
24521 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
24522 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
24523
24524 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
24525
24526 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
24527 This chapter uses the following notation:
24528
24529 @itemize @bullet
24530 @item
24531 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
24532
24533 @item
24534 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
24535 it may or may not be given.
24536
24537 @item
24538 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
24539 may repeat zero or more times.
24540
24541 @item
24542 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
24543 may repeat one or more times.
24544
24545 @item
24546 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
24547 @end itemize
24548
24549 @ignore
24550 @heading Dependencies
24551 @end ignore
24552
24553 @menu
24554 * GDB/MI General Design::
24555 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
24556 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
24557 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
24558 * GDB/MI Output Records::
24559 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
24560 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
24561 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
24562 * GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
24563 * GDB/MI Program Context::
24564 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
24565 * GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands::
24566 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
24567 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
24568 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
24569 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
24570 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
24571 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
24572 * GDB/MI File Commands::
24573 @ignore
24574 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
24575 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
24576 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
24577 @end ignore
24578 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
24579 * GDB/MI File Transfer Commands::
24580 * GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands::
24581 * GDB/MI Support Commands::
24582 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
24583 @end menu
24584
24585 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
24586 @node GDB/MI General Design
24587 @section @sc{gdb/mi} General Design
24588 @cindex GDB/MI General Design
24589
24590 Interaction of a @sc{GDB/MI} frontend with @value{GDBN} involves three
24591 parts---commands sent to @value{GDBN}, responses to those commands
24592 and notifications. Each command results in exactly one response,
24593 indicating either successful completion of the command, or an error.
24594 For the commands that do not resume the target, the response contains the
24595 requested information. For the commands that resume the target, the
24596 response only indicates whether the target was successfully resumed.
24597 Notifications is the mechanism for reporting changes in the state of the
24598 target, or in @value{GDBN} state, that cannot conveniently be associated with
24599 a command and reported as part of that command response.
24600
24601 The important examples of notifications are:
24602 @itemize @bullet
24603
24604 @item
24605 Exec notifications. These are used to report changes in
24606 target state---when a target is resumed, or stopped. It would not
24607 be feasible to include this information in response of resuming
24608 commands, because one resume commands can result in multiple events in
24609 different threads. Also, quite some time may pass before any event
24610 happens in the target, while a frontend needs to know whether the resuming
24611 command itself was successfully executed.
24612
24613 @item
24614 Console output, and status notifications. Console output
24615 notifications are used to report output of CLI commands, as well as
24616 diagnostics for other commands. Status notifications are used to
24617 report the progress of a long-running operation. Naturally, including
24618 this information in command response would mean no output is produced
24619 until the command is finished, which is undesirable.
24620
24621 @item
24622 General notifications. Commands may have various side effects on
24623 the @value{GDBN} or target state beyond their official purpose. For example,
24624 a command may change the selected thread. Although such changes can
24625 be included in command response, using notification allows for more
24626 orthogonal frontend design.
24627
24628 @end itemize
24629
24630 There's no guarantee that whenever an MI command reports an error,
24631 @value{GDBN} or the target are in any specific state, and especially,
24632 the state is not reverted to the state before the MI command was
24633 processed. Therefore, whenever an MI command results in an error,
24634 we recommend that the frontend refreshes all the information shown in
24635 the user interface.
24636
24637
24638 @menu
24639 * Context management::
24640 * Asynchronous and non-stop modes::
24641 * Thread groups::
24642 @end menu
24643
24644 @node Context management
24645 @subsection Context management
24646
24647 @subsubsection Threads and Frames
24648
24649 In most cases when @value{GDBN} accesses the target, this access is
24650 done in context of a specific thread and frame (@pxref{Frames}).
24651 Often, even when accessing global data, the target requires that a thread
24652 be specified. The CLI interface maintains the selected thread and frame,
24653 and supplies them to target on each command. This is convenient,
24654 because a command line user would not want to specify that information
24655 explicitly on each command, and because user interacts with
24656 @value{GDBN} via a single terminal, so no confusion is possible as
24657 to what thread and frame are the current ones.
24658
24659 In the case of MI, the concept of selected thread and frame is less
24660 useful. First, a frontend can easily remember this information
24661 itself. Second, a graphical frontend can have more than one window,
24662 each one used for debugging a different thread, and the frontend might
24663 want to access additional threads for internal purposes. This
24664 increases the risk that by relying on implicitly selected thread, the
24665 frontend may be operating on a wrong one. Therefore, each MI command
24666 should explicitly specify which thread and frame to operate on. To
24667 make it possible, each MI command accepts the @samp{--thread} and
24668 @samp{--frame} options, the value to each is @value{GDBN} identifier
24669 for thread and frame to operate on.
24670
24671 Usually, each top-level window in a frontend allows the user to select
24672 a thread and a frame, and remembers the user selection for further
24673 operations. However, in some cases @value{GDBN} may suggest that the
24674 current thread be changed. For example, when stopping on a breakpoint
24675 it is reasonable to switch to the thread where breakpoint is hit. For
24676 another example, if the user issues the CLI @samp{thread} command via
24677 the frontend, it is desirable to change the frontend's selected thread to the
24678 one specified by user. @value{GDBN} communicates the suggestion to
24679 change current thread using the @samp{=thread-selected} notification.
24680 No such notification is available for the selected frame at the moment.
24681
24682 Note that historically, MI shares the selected thread with CLI, so
24683 frontends used the @code{-thread-select} to execute commands in the
24684 right context. However, getting this to work right is cumbersome. The
24685 simplest way is for frontend to emit @code{-thread-select} command
24686 before every command. This doubles the number of commands that need
24687 to be sent. The alternative approach is to suppress @code{-thread-select}
24688 if the selected thread in @value{GDBN} is supposed to be identical to the
24689 thread the frontend wants to operate on. However, getting this
24690 optimization right can be tricky. In particular, if the frontend
24691 sends several commands to @value{GDBN}, and one of the commands changes the
24692 selected thread, then the behaviour of subsequent commands will
24693 change. So, a frontend should either wait for response from such
24694 problematic commands, or explicitly add @code{-thread-select} for
24695 all subsequent commands. No frontend is known to do this exactly
24696 right, so it is suggested to just always pass the @samp{--thread} and
24697 @samp{--frame} options.
24698
24699 @subsubsection Language
24700
24701 The execution of several commands depends on which language is selected.
24702 By default, the current language (@pxref{show language}) is used.
24703 But for commands known to be language-sensitive, it is recommended
24704 to use the @samp{--language} option. This option takes one argument,
24705 which is the name of the language to use while executing the command.
24706 For instance:
24707
24708 @smallexample
24709 -data-evaluate-expression --language c "sizeof (void*)"
24710 ^done,value="4"
24711 (gdb)
24712 @end smallexample
24713
24714 The valid language names are the same names accepted by the
24715 @samp{set language} command (@pxref{Manually}), excluding @samp{auto},
24716 @samp{local} or @samp{unknown}.
24717
24718 @node Asynchronous and non-stop modes
24719 @subsection Asynchronous command execution and non-stop mode
24720
24721 On some targets, @value{GDBN} is capable of processing MI commands
24722 even while the target is running. This is called @dfn{asynchronous
24723 command execution} (@pxref{Background Execution}). The frontend may
24724 specify a preferrence for asynchronous execution using the
24725 @code{-gdb-set mi-async 1} command, which should be emitted before
24726 either running the executable or attaching to the target. After the
24727 frontend has started the executable or attached to the target, it can
24728 find if asynchronous execution is enabled using the
24729 @code{-list-target-features} command.
24730
24731 @table @code
24732 @item -gdb-set mi-async on
24733 @item -gdb-set mi-async off
24734 Set whether MI is in asynchronous mode.
24735
24736 When @code{off}, which is the default, MI execution commands (e.g.,
24737 @code{-exec-continue}) are foreground commands, and @value{GDBN} waits
24738 for the program to stop before processing further commands.
24739
24740 When @code{on}, MI execution commands are background execution
24741 commands (e.g., @code{-exec-continue} becomes the equivalent of the
24742 @code{c&} CLI command), and so @value{GDBN} is capable of processing
24743 MI commands even while the target is running.
24744
24745 @item -gdb-show mi-async
24746 Show whether MI asynchronous mode is enabled.
24747 @end table
24748
24749 Note: In @value{GDBN} version 7.7 and earlier, this option was called
24750 @code{target-async} instead of @code{mi-async}, and it had the effect
24751 of both putting MI in asynchronous mode and making CLI background
24752 commands possible. CLI background commands are now always possible
24753 ``out of the box'' if the target supports them. The old spelling is
24754 kept as a deprecated alias for backwards compatibility.
24755
24756 Even if @value{GDBN} can accept a command while target is running,
24757 many commands that access the target do not work when the target is
24758 running. Therefore, asynchronous command execution is most useful
24759 when combined with non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}). Then,
24760 it is possible to examine the state of one thread, while other threads
24761 are running.
24762
24763 When a given thread is running, MI commands that try to access the
24764 target in the context of that thread may not work, or may work only on
24765 some targets. In particular, commands that try to operate on thread's
24766 stack will not work, on any target. Commands that read memory, or
24767 modify breakpoints, may work or not work, depending on the target. Note
24768 that even commands that operate on global state, such as @code{print},
24769 @code{set}, and breakpoint commands, still access the target in the
24770 context of a specific thread, so frontend should try to find a
24771 stopped thread and perform the operation on that thread (using the
24772 @samp{--thread} option).
24773
24774 Which commands will work in the context of a running thread is
24775 highly target dependent. However, the two commands
24776 @code{-exec-interrupt}, to stop a thread, and @code{-thread-info},
24777 to find the state of a thread, will always work.
24778
24779 @node Thread groups
24780 @subsection Thread groups
24781 @value{GDBN} may be used to debug several processes at the same time.
24782 On some platfroms, @value{GDBN} may support debugging of several
24783 hardware systems, each one having several cores with several different
24784 processes running on each core. This section describes the MI
24785 mechanism to support such debugging scenarios.
24786
24787 The key observation is that regardless of the structure of the
24788 target, MI can have a global list of threads, because most commands that
24789 accept the @samp{--thread} option do not need to know what process that
24790 thread belongs to. Therefore, it is not necessary to introduce
24791 neither additional @samp{--process} option, nor an notion of the
24792 current process in the MI interface. The only strictly new feature
24793 that is required is the ability to find how the threads are grouped
24794 into processes.
24795
24796 To allow the user to discover such grouping, and to support arbitrary
24797 hierarchy of machines/cores/processes, MI introduces the concept of a
24798 @dfn{thread group}. Thread group is a collection of threads and other
24799 thread groups. A thread group always has a string identifier, a type,
24800 and may have additional attributes specific to the type. A new
24801 command, @code{-list-thread-groups}, returns the list of top-level
24802 thread groups, which correspond to processes that @value{GDBN} is
24803 debugging at the moment. By passing an identifier of a thread group
24804 to the @code{-list-thread-groups} command, it is possible to obtain
24805 the members of specific thread group.
24806
24807 To allow the user to easily discover processes, and other objects, he
24808 wishes to debug, a concept of @dfn{available thread group} is
24809 introduced. Available thread group is an thread group that
24810 @value{GDBN} is not debugging, but that can be attached to, using the
24811 @code{-target-attach} command. The list of available top-level thread
24812 groups can be obtained using @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}.
24813 In general, the content of a thread group may be only retrieved only
24814 after attaching to that thread group.
24815
24816 Thread groups are related to inferiors (@pxref{Inferiors and
24817 Programs}). Each inferior corresponds to a thread group of a special
24818 type @samp{process}, and some additional operations are permitted on
24819 such thread groups.
24820
24821 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
24822 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
24823 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
24824
24825 @menu
24826 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
24827 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
24828 @end menu
24829
24830 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
24831 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
24832
24833 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
24834 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
24835 @table @code
24836 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
24837 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
24838
24839 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
24840 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
24841 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
24842
24843 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
24844 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
24845 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
24846
24847 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
24848 "any sequence of digits"
24849
24850 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
24851 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
24852
24853 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
24854 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
24855
24856 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
24857 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
24858
24859 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
24860 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
24861 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
24862
24863 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
24864 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
24865
24866 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
24867 @code{CR | CR-LF}
24868 @end table
24869
24870 @noindent
24871 Notes:
24872
24873 @itemize @bullet
24874 @item
24875 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
24876 output is described below.
24877
24878 @item
24879 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
24880 finishes.
24881
24882 @item
24883 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
24884 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
24885 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
24886 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
24887 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
24888 @end itemize
24889
24890 Pragmatics:
24891
24892 @itemize @bullet
24893 @item
24894 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
24895
24896 @item
24897 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
24898 @end itemize
24899
24900 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
24901 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
24902
24903 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
24904 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
24905 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
24906 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
24907 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
24908 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
24909
24910 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
24911 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
24912 @var{token}.
24913
24914 @table @code
24915 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
24916 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
24917
24918 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
24919 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
24920
24921 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
24922 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
24923
24924 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
24925 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
24926
24927 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
24928 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output nl}}
24929
24930 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
24931 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output nl}}
24932
24933 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
24934 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output nl}}
24935
24936 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
24937 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )*}
24938
24939 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
24940 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
24941
24942 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
24943 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
24944 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
24945
24946 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
24947 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
24948
24949 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
24950 @code{ @var{string} }
24951
24952 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
24953 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
24954
24955 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
24956 @code{@var{c-string}}
24957
24958 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
24959 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
24960
24961 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
24962 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
24963 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
24964
24965 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
24966 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
24967
24968 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
24969 @code{"~" @var{c-string nl}}
24970
24971 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
24972 @code{"@@" @var{c-string nl}}
24973
24974 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
24975 @code{"&" @var{c-string nl}}
24976
24977 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
24978 @code{CR | CR-LF}
24979
24980 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
24981 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
24982 @end table
24983
24984 @noindent
24985 Notes:
24986
24987 @itemize @bullet
24988 @item
24989 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
24990
24991 @item
24992 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. Note that
24993 for all async output, while the token is allowed by the grammar and
24994 may be output by future versions of @value{GDBN} for select async
24995 output messages, it is generally omitted. Frontends should treat
24996 all async output as reporting general changes in the state of the
24997 target and there should be no need to associate async output to any
24998 prior command.
24999
25000 @item
25001 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25002 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
25003 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
25004 prefixed by @samp{+}.
25005
25006 @item
25007 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25008 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
25009 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
25010 @samp{*}.
25011
25012 @item
25013 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25014 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
25015 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
25016 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
25017
25018 @item
25019 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25020 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
25021 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
25022 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
25023
25024 @item
25025 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25026 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
25027 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
25028
25029 @item
25030 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25031 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
25032 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
25033 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
25034
25035 @item
25036 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25037 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
25038 @var{values}.
25039
25040
25041 @end itemize
25042
25043 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
25044 details about the various output records.
25045
25046 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25047 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
25048 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
25049
25050 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
25051 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
25052
25053 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
25054 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
25055 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
25056 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
25057 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
25058 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
25059
25060 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
25061 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
25062 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
25063
25064 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25065 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
25066 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
25067 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
25068
25069 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
25070 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
25071
25072 Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
25073 by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
25074 to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
25075 section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
25076 might change.
25077
25078 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
25079 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
25080 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
25081 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
25082
25083 @itemize @bullet
25084 @item
25085 New MI commands may be added.
25086
25087 @item
25088 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
25089
25090 @item
25091 The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
25092 @code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
25093
25094 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
25095 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
25096
25097 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
25098 @c resolve inconsistencies.
25099 @end itemize
25100
25101 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
25102 will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
25103 output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
25104 @value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
25105 responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
25106
25107 @c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
25108 @c version?
25109
25110 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
25111 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
25112 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
25113 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}.
25114 @cindex mailing lists
25115
25116 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25117 @node GDB/MI Output Records
25118 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
25119
25120 @menu
25121 * GDB/MI Result Records::
25122 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
25123 * GDB/MI Async Records::
25124 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Information::
25125 * GDB/MI Frame Information::
25126 * GDB/MI Thread Information::
25127 * GDB/MI Ada Exception Information::
25128 @end menu
25129
25130 @node GDB/MI Result Records
25131 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
25132
25133 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
25134 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
25135 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
25136 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
25137
25138 @table @code
25139 @findex ^done
25140 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
25141 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
25142 values.
25143
25144 @item "^running"
25145 @findex ^running
25146 This result record is equivalent to @samp{^done}. Historically, it
25147 was output instead of @samp{^done} if the command has resumed the
25148 target. This behaviour is maintained for backward compatibility, but
25149 all frontends should treat @samp{^done} and @samp{^running}
25150 identically and rely on the @samp{*running} output record to determine
25151 which threads are resumed.
25152
25153 @item "^connected"
25154 @findex ^connected
25155 @value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
25156
25157 @item "^error" "," "msg=" @var{c-string} [ "," "code=" @var{c-string} ]
25158 @findex ^error
25159 The operation failed. The @code{msg=@var{c-string}} variable contains
25160 the corresponding error message.
25161
25162 If present, the @code{code=@var{c-string}} variable provides an error
25163 code on which consumers can rely on to detect the corresponding
25164 error condition. At present, only one error code is defined:
25165
25166 @table @samp
25167 @item "undefined-command"
25168 Indicates that the command causing the error does not exist.
25169 @end table
25170
25171 @item "^exit"
25172 @findex ^exit
25173 @value{GDBN} has terminated.
25174
25175 @end table
25176
25177 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
25178 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
25179
25180 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
25181 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
25182 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
25183 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
25184 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
25185
25186 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
25187 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
25188 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
25189 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
25190 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
25191
25192 @table @code
25193 @item "~" @var{string-output}
25194 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
25195 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
25196
25197 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
25198 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
25199 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
25200 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
25201
25202 @item "&" @var{string-output}
25203 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
25204 internals.
25205 @end table
25206
25207 @node GDB/MI Async Records
25208 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Async Records
25209
25210 @cindex async records in @sc{gdb/mi}
25211 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, async records
25212 @dfn{Async} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
25213 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
25214 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} commands (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
25215 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
25216
25217 The following is the list of possible async records:
25218
25219 @table @code
25220
25221 @item *running,thread-id="@var{thread}"
25222 The target is now running. The @var{thread} field tells which
25223 specific thread is now running, and can be @samp{all} if all threads
25224 are running. The frontend should assume that no interaction with a
25225 running thread is possible after this notification is produced.
25226 The frontend should not assume that this notification is output
25227 only once for any command. @value{GDBN} may emit this notification
25228 several times, either for different threads, because it cannot resume
25229 all threads together, or even for a single thread, if the thread must
25230 be stepped though some code before letting it run freely.
25231
25232 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}",thread-id="@var{id}",stopped-threads="@var{stopped}",core="@var{core}"
25233 The target has stopped. The @var{reason} field can have one of the
25234 following values:
25235
25236 @table @code
25237 @item breakpoint-hit
25238 A breakpoint was reached.
25239 @item watchpoint-trigger
25240 A watchpoint was triggered.
25241 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
25242 A read watchpoint was triggered.
25243 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
25244 An access watchpoint was triggered.
25245 @item function-finished
25246 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
25247 @item location-reached
25248 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
25249 @item watchpoint-scope
25250 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
25251 @item end-stepping-range
25252 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
25253 similar CLI command was accomplished.
25254 @item exited-signalled
25255 The inferior exited because of a signal.
25256 @item exited
25257 The inferior exited.
25258 @item exited-normally
25259 The inferior exited normally.
25260 @item signal-received
25261 A signal was received by the inferior.
25262 @item solib-event
25263 The inferior has stopped due to a library being loaded or unloaded.
25264 This can happen when @code{stop-on-solib-events} (@pxref{Files}) is
25265 set or when a @code{catch load} or @code{catch unload} catchpoint is
25266 in use (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}).
25267 @item fork
25268 The inferior has forked. This is reported when @code{catch fork}
25269 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
25270 @item vfork
25271 The inferior has vforked. This is reported in when @code{catch vfork}
25272 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
25273 @item syscall-entry
25274 The inferior entered a system call. This is reported when @code{catch
25275 syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
25276 @item syscall-entry
25277 The inferior returned from a system call. This is reported when
25278 @code{catch syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
25279 @item exec
25280 The inferior called @code{exec}. This is reported when @code{catch exec}
25281 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
25282 @end table
25283
25284 The @var{id} field identifies the thread that directly caused the stop
25285 -- for example by hitting a breakpoint. Depending on whether all-stop
25286 mode is in effect (@pxref{All-Stop Mode}), @value{GDBN} may either
25287 stop all threads, or only the thread that directly triggered the stop.
25288 If all threads are stopped, the @var{stopped} field will have the
25289 value of @code{"all"}. Otherwise, the value of the @var{stopped}
25290 field will be a list of thread identifiers. Presently, this list will
25291 always include a single thread, but frontend should be prepared to see
25292 several threads in the list. The @var{core} field reports the
25293 processor core on which the stop event has happened. This field may be absent
25294 if such information is not available.
25295
25296 @item =thread-group-added,id="@var{id}"
25297 @itemx =thread-group-removed,id="@var{id}"
25298 A thread group was either added or removed. The @var{id} field
25299 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. When a thread
25300 group is added, it generally might not be associated with a running
25301 process. When a thread group is removed, its id becomes invalid and
25302 cannot be used in any way.
25303
25304 @item =thread-group-started,id="@var{id}",pid="@var{pid}"
25305 A thread group became associated with a running program,
25306 either because the program was just started or the thread group
25307 was attached to a program. The @var{id} field contains the
25308 @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. The @var{pid} field
25309 contains process identifier, specific to the operating system.
25310
25311 @item =thread-group-exited,id="@var{id}"[,exit-code="@var{code}"]
25312 A thread group is no longer associated with a running program,
25313 either because the program has exited, or because it was detached
25314 from. The @var{id} field contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the
25315 thread group. The @var{code} field is the exit code of the inferior; it exists
25316 only when the inferior exited with some code.
25317
25318 @item =thread-created,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
25319 @itemx =thread-exited,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
25320 A thread either was created, or has exited. The @var{id} field
25321 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread. The @var{gid}
25322 field identifies the thread group this thread belongs to.
25323
25324 @item =thread-selected,id="@var{id}"
25325 Informs that the selected thread was changed as result of the last
25326 command. This notification is not emitted as result of @code{-thread-select}
25327 command but is emitted whenever an MI command that is not documented
25328 to change the selected thread actually changes it. In particular,
25329 invoking, directly or indirectly (via user-defined command), the CLI
25330 @code{thread} command, will generate this notification.
25331
25332 We suggest that in response to this notification, front ends
25333 highlight the selected thread and cause subsequent commands to apply to
25334 that thread.
25335
25336 @item =library-loaded,...
25337 Reports that a new library file was loaded by the program. This
25338 notification has 4 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name},
25339 @var{host-name}, and @var{symbols-loaded}. The @var{id} field is an
25340 opaque identifier of the library. For remote debugging case,
25341 @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} fields give the name of the
25342 library file on the target, and on the host respectively. For native
25343 debugging, both those fields have the same value. The
25344 @var{symbols-loaded} field is emitted only for backward compatibility
25345 and should not be relied on to convey any useful information. The
25346 @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the thread
25347 group in whose context the library was loaded. If the field is
25348 absent, it means the library was loaded in the context of all present
25349 thread groups.
25350
25351 @item =library-unloaded,...
25352 Reports that a library was unloaded by the program. This notification
25353 has 3 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} with
25354 the same meaning as for the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
25355 The @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the
25356 thread group in whose context the library was unloaded. If the field is
25357 absent, it means the library was unloaded in the context of all present
25358 thread groups.
25359
25360 @item =traceframe-changed,num=@var{tfnum},tracepoint=@var{tpnum}
25361 @itemx =traceframe-changed,end
25362 Reports that the trace frame was changed and its new number is
25363 @var{tfnum}. The number of the tracepoint associated with this trace
25364 frame is @var{tpnum}.
25365
25366 @item =tsv-created,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}
25367 Reports that the new trace state variable @var{name} is created with
25368 initial value @var{initial}.
25369
25370 @item =tsv-deleted,name=@var{name}
25371 @itemx =tsv-deleted
25372 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is deleted or all
25373 trace state variables are deleted.
25374
25375 @item =tsv-modified,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}[,current=@var{current}]
25376 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is modified with
25377 the initial value @var{initial}. The current value @var{current} of
25378 trace state variable is optional and is reported if the current
25379 value of trace state variable is known.
25380
25381 @item =breakpoint-created,bkpt=@{...@}
25382 @itemx =breakpoint-modified,bkpt=@{...@}
25383 @itemx =breakpoint-deleted,id=@var{number}
25384 Reports that a breakpoint was created, modified, or deleted,
25385 respectively. Only user-visible breakpoints are reported to the MI
25386 user.
25387
25388 The @var{bkpt} argument is of the same form as returned by the various
25389 breakpoint commands; @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}. The
25390 @var{number} is the ordinal number of the breakpoint.
25391
25392 Note that if a breakpoint is emitted in the result record of a
25393 command, then it will not also be emitted in an async record.
25394
25395 @item =record-started,thread-group="@var{id}"
25396 @itemx =record-stopped,thread-group="@var{id}"
25397 Execution log recording was either started or stopped on an
25398 inferior. The @var{id} is the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread
25399 group corresponding to the affected inferior.
25400
25401 @item =cmd-param-changed,param=@var{param},value=@var{value}
25402 Reports that a parameter of the command @code{set @var{param}} is
25403 changed to @var{value}. In the multi-word @code{set} command,
25404 the @var{param} is the whole parameter list to @code{set} command.
25405 For example, In command @code{set check type on}, @var{param}
25406 is @code{check type} and @var{value} is @code{on}.
25407
25408 @item =memory-changed,thread-group=@var{id},addr=@var{addr},len=@var{len}[,type="code"]
25409 Reports that bytes from @var{addr} to @var{data} + @var{len} were
25410 written in an inferior. The @var{id} is the identifier of the
25411 thread group corresponding to the affected inferior. The optional
25412 @code{type="code"} part is reported if the memory written to holds
25413 executable code.
25414 @end table
25415
25416 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Information
25417 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Information
25418
25419 When @value{GDBN} reports information about a breakpoint, a
25420 tracepoint, a watchpoint, or a catchpoint, it uses a tuple with the
25421 following fields:
25422
25423 @table @code
25424 @item number
25425 The breakpoint number. For a breakpoint that represents one location
25426 of a multi-location breakpoint, this will be a dotted pair, like
25427 @samp{1.2}.
25428
25429 @item type
25430 The type of the breakpoint. For ordinary breakpoints this will be
25431 @samp{breakpoint}, but many values are possible.
25432
25433 @item catch-type
25434 If the type of the breakpoint is @samp{catchpoint}, then this
25435 indicates the exact type of catchpoint.
25436
25437 @item disp
25438 This is the breakpoint disposition---either @samp{del}, meaning that
25439 the breakpoint will be deleted at the next stop, or @samp{keep},
25440 meaning that the breakpoint will not be deleted.
25441
25442 @item enabled
25443 This indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled, in which case the
25444 value is @samp{y}, or disabled, in which case the value is @samp{n}.
25445 Note that this is not the same as the field @code{enable}.
25446
25447 @item addr
25448 The address of the breakpoint. This may be a hexidecimal number,
25449 giving the address; or the string @samp{<PENDING>}, for a pending
25450 breakpoint; or the string @samp{<MULTIPLE>}, for a breakpoint with
25451 multiple locations. This field will not be present if no address can
25452 be determined. For example, a watchpoint does not have an address.
25453
25454 @item func
25455 If known, the function in which the breakpoint appears.
25456 If not known, this field is not present.
25457
25458 @item filename
25459 The name of the source file which contains this function, if known.
25460 If not known, this field is not present.
25461
25462 @item fullname
25463 The full file name of the source file which contains this function, if
25464 known. If not known, this field is not present.
25465
25466 @item line
25467 The line number at which this breakpoint appears, if known.
25468 If not known, this field is not present.
25469
25470 @item at
25471 If the source file is not known, this field may be provided. If
25472 provided, this holds the address of the breakpoint, possibly followed
25473 by a symbol name.
25474
25475 @item pending
25476 If this breakpoint is pending, this field is present and holds the
25477 text used to set the breakpoint, as entered by the user.
25478
25479 @item evaluated-by
25480 Where this breakpoint's condition is evaluated, either @samp{host} or
25481 @samp{target}.
25482
25483 @item thread
25484 If this is a thread-specific breakpoint, then this identifies the
25485 thread in which the breakpoint can trigger.
25486
25487 @item task
25488 If this breakpoint is restricted to a particular Ada task, then this
25489 field will hold the task identifier.
25490
25491 @item cond
25492 If the breakpoint is conditional, this is the condition expression.
25493
25494 @item ignore
25495 The ignore count of the breakpoint.
25496
25497 @item enable
25498 The enable count of the breakpoint.
25499
25500 @item traceframe-usage
25501 FIXME.
25502
25503 @item static-tracepoint-marker-string-id
25504 For a static tracepoint, the name of the static tracepoint marker.
25505
25506 @item mask
25507 For a masked watchpoint, this is the mask.
25508
25509 @item pass
25510 A tracepoint's pass count.
25511
25512 @item original-location
25513 The location of the breakpoint as originally specified by the user.
25514 This field is optional.
25515
25516 @item times
25517 The number of times the breakpoint has been hit.
25518
25519 @item installed
25520 This field is only given for tracepoints. This is either @samp{y},
25521 meaning that the tracepoint is installed, or @samp{n}, meaning that it
25522 is not.
25523
25524 @item what
25525 Some extra data, the exact contents of which are type-dependent.
25526
25527 @end table
25528
25529 For example, here is what the output of @code{-break-insert}
25530 (@pxref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}) might be:
25531
25532 @smallexample
25533 -> -break-insert main
25534 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
25535 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
25536 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
25537 times="0"@}
25538 <- (gdb)
25539 @end smallexample
25540
25541 @node GDB/MI Frame Information
25542 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Frame Information
25543
25544 Response from many MI commands includes an information about stack
25545 frame. This information is a tuple that may have the following
25546 fields:
25547
25548 @table @code
25549 @item level
25550 The level of the stack frame. The innermost frame has the level of
25551 zero. This field is always present.
25552
25553 @item func
25554 The name of the function corresponding to the frame. This field may
25555 be absent if @value{GDBN} is unable to determine the function name.
25556
25557 @item addr
25558 The code address for the frame. This field is always present.
25559
25560 @item file
25561 The name of the source files that correspond to the frame's code
25562 address. This field may be absent.
25563
25564 @item line
25565 The source line corresponding to the frames' code address. This field
25566 may be absent.
25567
25568 @item from
25569 The name of the binary file (either executable or shared library) the
25570 corresponds to the frame's code address. This field may be absent.
25571
25572 @end table
25573
25574 @node GDB/MI Thread Information
25575 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Information
25576
25577 Whenever @value{GDBN} has to report an information about a thread, it
25578 uses a tuple with the following fields:
25579
25580 @table @code
25581 @item id
25582 The numeric id assigned to the thread by @value{GDBN}. This field is
25583 always present.
25584
25585 @item target-id
25586 Target-specific string identifying the thread. This field is always present.
25587
25588 @item details
25589 Additional information about the thread provided by the target.
25590 It is supposed to be human-readable and not interpreted by the
25591 frontend. This field is optional.
25592
25593 @item state
25594 Either @samp{stopped} or @samp{running}, depending on whether the
25595 thread is presently running. This field is always present.
25596
25597 @item core
25598 The value of this field is an integer number of the processor core the
25599 thread was last seen on. This field is optional.
25600 @end table
25601
25602 @node GDB/MI Ada Exception Information
25603 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Exception Information
25604
25605 Whenever a @code{*stopped} record is emitted because the program
25606 stopped after hitting an exception catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}),
25607 @value{GDBN} provides the name of the exception that was raised via
25608 the @code{exception-name} field.
25609
25610 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25611 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
25612 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
25613 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
25614
25615 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
25616 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
25617 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
25618 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
25619
25620 Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
25621 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
25622
25623 @subheading Setting a Breakpoint
25624
25625 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
25626 information of the breakpoint.
25627
25628 @smallexample
25629 -> -break-insert main
25630 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
25631 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
25632 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
25633 times="0"@}
25634 <- (gdb)
25635 @end smallexample
25636
25637 @subheading Program Execution
25638
25639 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
25640 reason that execution stopped.
25641
25642 @smallexample
25643 -> -exec-run
25644 <- ^running
25645 <- (gdb)
25646 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
25647 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
25648 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
25649 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68"@}
25650 <- (gdb)
25651 -> -exec-continue
25652 <- ^running
25653 <- (gdb)
25654 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
25655 <- (gdb)
25656 @end smallexample
25657
25658 @subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
25659
25660 Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
25661
25662 @smallexample
25663 -> (gdb)
25664 <- -gdb-exit
25665 <- ^exit
25666 @end smallexample
25667
25668 Please note that @samp{^exit} is printed immediately, but it might
25669 take some time for @value{GDBN} to actually exit. During that time, @value{GDBN}
25670 performs necessary cleanups, including killing programs being debugged
25671 or disconnecting from debug hardware, so the frontend should wait till
25672 @value{GDBN} exits and should only forcibly kill @value{GDBN} if it
25673 fails to exit in reasonable time.
25674
25675 @subheading A Bad Command
25676
25677 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
25678
25679 @smallexample
25680 -> -rubbish
25681 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
25682 <- (gdb)
25683 @end smallexample
25684
25685
25686 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25687 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
25688 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
25689
25690 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
25691 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
25692
25693 @subheading Motivation
25694
25695 The motivation for this collection of commands.
25696
25697 @subheading Introduction
25698
25699 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
25700
25701 @subheading Commands
25702
25703 For each command in the block, the following is described:
25704
25705 @subsubheading Synopsis
25706
25707 @smallexample
25708 -command @var{args}@dots{}
25709 @end smallexample
25710
25711 @subsubheading Result
25712
25713 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25714
25715 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
25716
25717 @subsubheading Example
25718
25719 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
25720 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
25721
25722
25723 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25724 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
25725 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
25726
25727 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
25728 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
25729 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
25730 breakpoints.
25731
25732 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
25733 @findex -break-after
25734
25735 @subsubheading Synopsis
25736
25737 @smallexample
25738 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
25739 @end smallexample
25740
25741 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
25742 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
25743 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
25744 @samp{-break-list} command below.
25745
25746 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25747
25748 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
25749
25750 @subsubheading Example
25751
25752 @smallexample
25753 (gdb)
25754 -break-insert main
25755 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
25756 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
25757 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
25758 times="0"@}
25759 (gdb)
25760 -break-after 1 3
25761 ~
25762 ^done
25763 (gdb)
25764 -break-list
25765 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
25766 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
25767 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
25768 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
25769 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
25770 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
25771 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
25772 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
25773 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
25774 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
25775 (gdb)
25776 @end smallexample
25777
25778 @ignore
25779 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
25780 @findex -break-catch
25781 @end ignore
25782
25783 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
25784 @findex -break-commands
25785
25786 @subsubheading Synopsis
25787
25788 @smallexample
25789 -break-commands @var{number} [ @var{command1} ... @var{commandN} ]
25790 @end smallexample
25791
25792 Specifies the CLI commands that should be executed when breakpoint
25793 @var{number} is hit. The parameters @var{command1} to @var{commandN}
25794 are the commands. If no command is specified, any previously-set
25795 commands are cleared. @xref{Break Commands}. Typical use of this
25796 functionality is tracing a program, that is, printing of values of
25797 some variables whenever breakpoint is hit and then continuing.
25798
25799 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25800
25801 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{commands}.
25802
25803 @subsubheading Example
25804
25805 @smallexample
25806 (gdb)
25807 -break-insert main
25808 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
25809 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
25810 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
25811 times="0"@}
25812 (gdb)
25813 -break-commands 1 "print v" "continue"
25814 ^done
25815 (gdb)
25816 @end smallexample
25817
25818 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
25819 @findex -break-condition
25820
25821 @subsubheading Synopsis
25822
25823 @smallexample
25824 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
25825 @end smallexample
25826
25827 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
25828 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
25829 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
25830 command below).
25831
25832 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25833
25834 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
25835
25836 @subsubheading Example
25837
25838 @smallexample
25839 (gdb)
25840 -break-condition 1 1
25841 ^done
25842 (gdb)
25843 -break-list
25844 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
25845 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
25846 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
25847 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
25848 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
25849 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
25850 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
25851 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
25852 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
25853 line="5",cond="1",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
25854 (gdb)
25855 @end smallexample
25856
25857 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
25858 @findex -break-delete
25859
25860 @subsubheading Synopsis
25861
25862 @smallexample
25863 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
25864 @end smallexample
25865
25866 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
25867 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
25868
25869 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25870
25871 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
25872
25873 @subsubheading Example
25874
25875 @smallexample
25876 (gdb)
25877 -break-delete 1
25878 ^done
25879 (gdb)
25880 -break-list
25881 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
25882 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
25883 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
25884 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
25885 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
25886 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
25887 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
25888 body=[]@}
25889 (gdb)
25890 @end smallexample
25891
25892 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
25893 @findex -break-disable
25894
25895 @subsubheading Synopsis
25896
25897 @smallexample
25898 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
25899 @end smallexample
25900
25901 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
25902 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
25903
25904 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25905
25906 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
25907
25908 @subsubheading Example
25909
25910 @smallexample
25911 (gdb)
25912 -break-disable 2
25913 ^done
25914 (gdb)
25915 -break-list
25916 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
25917 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
25918 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
25919 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
25920 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
25921 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
25922 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
25923 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
25924 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
25925 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
25926 (gdb)
25927 @end smallexample
25928
25929 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
25930 @findex -break-enable
25931
25932 @subsubheading Synopsis
25933
25934 @smallexample
25935 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
25936 @end smallexample
25937
25938 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
25939
25940 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25941
25942 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
25943
25944 @subsubheading Example
25945
25946 @smallexample
25947 (gdb)
25948 -break-enable 2
25949 ^done
25950 (gdb)
25951 -break-list
25952 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
25953 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
25954 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
25955 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
25956 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
25957 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
25958 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
25959 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
25960 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
25961 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
25962 (gdb)
25963 @end smallexample
25964
25965 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
25966 @findex -break-info
25967
25968 @subsubheading Synopsis
25969
25970 @smallexample
25971 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
25972 @end smallexample
25973
25974 @c REDUNDANT???
25975 Get information about a single breakpoint.
25976
25977 The result is a table of breakpoints. @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint
25978 Information}, for details on the format of each breakpoint in the
25979 table.
25980
25981 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25982
25983 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
25984
25985 @subsubheading Example
25986 N.A.
25987
25988 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
25989 @findex -break-insert
25990
25991 @subsubheading Synopsis
25992
25993 @smallexample
25994 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ] [ -d ] [ -a ]
25995 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
25996 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ]
25997 @end smallexample
25998
25999 @noindent
26000 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
26001
26002 @itemize @bullet
26003 @item function
26004 @c @item +offset
26005 @c @item -offset
26006 @c @item linenum
26007 @item filename:linenum
26008 @item filename:function
26009 @item *address
26010 @end itemize
26011
26012 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
26013
26014 @table @samp
26015 @item -t
26016 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
26017 @item -h
26018 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
26019 @item -f
26020 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it
26021 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
26022 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
26023 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
26024 cannot be parsed.
26025 @item -d
26026 Create a disabled breakpoint.
26027 @item -a
26028 Create a tracepoint. @xref{Tracepoints}. When this parameter
26029 is used together with @samp{-h}, a fast tracepoint is created.
26030 @item -c @var{condition}
26031 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
26032 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
26033 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
26034 @item -p @var{thread-id}
26035 Restrict the breakpoint to the specified @var{thread-id}.
26036 @end table
26037
26038 @subsubheading Result
26039
26040 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
26041 resulting breakpoint.
26042
26043 Note: this format is open to change.
26044 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
26045
26046 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26047
26048 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
26049 @samp{hbreak}, and @samp{thbreak}. @c and @samp{rbreak}.
26050
26051 @subsubheading Example
26052
26053 @smallexample
26054 (gdb)
26055 -break-insert main
26056 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
26057 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
26058 times="0"@}
26059 (gdb)
26060 -break-insert -t foo
26061 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
26062 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
26063 times="0"@}
26064 (gdb)
26065 -break-list
26066 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
26067 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26068 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26069 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26070 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26071 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26072 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26073 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26074 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
26075 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
26076 times="0"@},
26077 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
26078 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
26079 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
26080 times="0"@}]@}
26081 (gdb)
26082 @c -break-insert -r foo.*
26083 @c ~int foo(int, int);
26084 @c ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
26085 @c "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
26086 @c times="0"@}
26087 @c (gdb)
26088 @end smallexample
26089
26090 @subheading The @code{-dprintf-insert} Command
26091 @findex -dprintf-insert
26092
26093 @subsubheading Synopsis
26094
26095 @smallexample
26096 -dprintf-insert [ -t ] [ -f ] [ -d ]
26097 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
26098 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ] [ @var{format} ]
26099 [ @var{argument} ]
26100 @end smallexample
26101
26102 @noindent
26103 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
26104
26105 @itemize @bullet
26106 @item @var{function}
26107 @c @item +offset
26108 @c @item -offset
26109 @c @item @var{linenum}
26110 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
26111 @item @var{filename}:function
26112 @item *@var{address}
26113 @end itemize
26114
26115 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
26116
26117 @table @samp
26118 @item -t
26119 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
26120 @item -f
26121 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example, if it
26122 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
26123 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
26124 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
26125 cannot be parsed.
26126 @item -d
26127 Create a disabled breakpoint.
26128 @item -c @var{condition}
26129 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
26130 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
26131 Set the ignore count of the breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ignore count})
26132 to @var{ignore-count}.
26133 @item -p @var{thread-id}
26134 Restrict the breakpoint to the specified @var{thread-id}.
26135 @end table
26136
26137 @subsubheading Result
26138
26139 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
26140 resulting breakpoint.
26141
26142 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
26143
26144 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26145
26146 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dprintf}.
26147
26148 @subsubheading Example
26149
26150 @smallexample
26151 (gdb)
26152 4-dprintf-insert foo "At foo entry\n"
26153 4^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26154 addr="0x000000000040061b",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
26155 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="25",thread-groups=["i1"],
26156 times="0",script=@{"printf \"At foo entry\\n\"","continue"@},
26157 original-location="foo"@}
26158 (gdb)
26159 5-dprintf-insert 26 "arg=%d, g=%d\n" arg g
26160 5^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26161 addr="0x000000000040062a",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
26162 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="26",thread-groups=["i1"],
26163 times="0",script=@{"printf \"arg=%d, g=%d\\n\", arg, g","continue"@},
26164 original-location="mi-dprintf.c:26"@}
26165 (gdb)
26166 @end smallexample
26167
26168 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
26169 @findex -break-list
26170
26171 @subsubheading Synopsis
26172
26173 @smallexample
26174 -break-list
26175 @end smallexample
26176
26177 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
26178
26179 @table @samp
26180 @item Number
26181 number of the breakpoint
26182 @item Type
26183 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
26184 @item Disposition
26185 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
26186 or @samp{nokeep}
26187 @item Enabled
26188 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
26189 @item Address
26190 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
26191 @item What
26192 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
26193 name, line number
26194 @item Thread-groups
26195 list of thread groups to which this breakpoint applies
26196 @item Times
26197 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
26198 @end table
26199
26200 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
26201 @code{body} field is an empty list.
26202
26203 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26204
26205 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
26206
26207 @subsubheading Example
26208
26209 @smallexample
26210 (gdb)
26211 -break-list
26212 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
26213 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26214 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26215 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26216 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26217 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26218 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26219 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26220 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
26221 times="0"@},
26222 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26223 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
26224 line="13",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
26225 (gdb)
26226 @end smallexample
26227
26228 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
26229
26230 @smallexample
26231 (gdb)
26232 -break-list
26233 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
26234 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26235 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26236 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26237 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26238 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26239 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26240 body=[]@}
26241 (gdb)
26242 @end smallexample
26243
26244 @subheading The @code{-break-passcount} Command
26245 @findex -break-passcount
26246
26247 @subsubheading Synopsis
26248
26249 @smallexample
26250 -break-passcount @var{tracepoint-number} @var{passcount}
26251 @end smallexample
26252
26253 Set the passcount for tracepoint @var{tracepoint-number} to
26254 @var{passcount}. If the breakpoint referred to by @var{tracepoint-number}
26255 is not a tracepoint, error is emitted. This corresponds to CLI
26256 command @samp{passcount}.
26257
26258 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
26259 @findex -break-watch
26260
26261 @subsubheading Synopsis
26262
26263 @smallexample
26264 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
26265 @end smallexample
26266
26267 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
26268 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
26269 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
26270 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
26271 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
26272 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
26273 i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
26274 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
26275
26276 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
26277 breakpoints inserted.
26278
26279 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26280
26281 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
26282 @samp{rwatch}.
26283
26284 @subsubheading Example
26285
26286 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
26287
26288 @smallexample
26289 (gdb)
26290 -break-watch x
26291 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
26292 (gdb)
26293 -exec-continue
26294 ^running
26295 (gdb)
26296 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
26297 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
26298 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
26299 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5"@}
26300 (gdb)
26301 @end smallexample
26302
26303 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
26304 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
26305 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
26306
26307 @smallexample
26308 (gdb)
26309 -break-watch C
26310 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
26311 (gdb)
26312 -exec-continue
26313 ^running
26314 (gdb)
26315 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
26316 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
26317 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
26318 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26319 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
26320 (gdb)
26321 -exec-continue
26322 ^running
26323 (gdb)
26324 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
26325 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
26326 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
26327 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26328 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
26329 (gdb)
26330 @end smallexample
26331
26332 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
26333 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
26334 deleted.
26335
26336 @smallexample
26337 (gdb)
26338 -break-watch C
26339 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
26340 (gdb)
26341 -break-list
26342 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
26343 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26344 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26345 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26346 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26347 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26348 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26349 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26350 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
26351 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26352 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
26353 times="1"@},
26354 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
26355 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
26356 (gdb)
26357 -exec-continue
26358 ^running
26359 (gdb)
26360 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
26361 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
26362 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
26363 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26364 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
26365 (gdb)
26366 -break-list
26367 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
26368 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26369 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26370 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26371 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26372 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26373 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26374 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26375 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
26376 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26377 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
26378 times="1"@},
26379 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
26380 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="-5"@}]@}
26381 (gdb)
26382 -exec-continue
26383 ^running
26384 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
26385 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
26386 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
26387 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26388 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
26389 (gdb)
26390 -break-list
26391 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
26392 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26393 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26394 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26395 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26396 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26397 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26398 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26399 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
26400 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26401 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
26402 thread-groups=["i1"],times="1"@}]@}
26403 (gdb)
26404 @end smallexample
26405
26406
26407 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26408 @node GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
26409 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoint Commands
26410
26411 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
26412 catchpoints.
26413
26414 @menu
26415 * Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
26416 * Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
26417 @end menu
26418
26419 @node Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
26420 @subsection Shared Library @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
26421
26422 @subheading The @code{-catch-load} Command
26423 @findex -catch-load
26424
26425 @subsubheading Synopsis
26426
26427 @smallexample
26428 -catch-load [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
26429 @end smallexample
26430
26431 Add a catchpoint for library load events. If the @samp{-t} option is used,
26432 the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
26433 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is created
26434 in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
26435 expression used to match the name of the loaded library.
26436
26437
26438 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26439
26440 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch load}.
26441
26442 @subsubheading Example
26443
26444 @smallexample
26445 -catch-load -t foo.so
26446 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="catchpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
26447 what="load of library matching foo.so",catch-type="load",times="0"@}
26448 (gdb)
26449 @end smallexample
26450
26451
26452 @subheading The @code{-catch-unload} Command
26453 @findex -catch-unload
26454
26455 @subsubheading Synopsis
26456
26457 @smallexample
26458 -catch-unload [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
26459 @end smallexample
26460
26461 Add a catchpoint for library unload events. If the @samp{-t} option is
26462 used, the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
26463 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is
26464 created in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
26465 expression used to match the name of the unloaded library.
26466
26467 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26468
26469 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch unload}.
26470
26471 @subsubheading Example
26472
26473 @smallexample
26474 -catch-unload -d bar.so
26475 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="catchpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
26476 what="load of library matching bar.so",catch-type="unload",times="0"@}
26477 (gdb)
26478 @end smallexample
26479
26480 @node Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
26481 @subsection Ada Exception @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
26482
26483 The following @sc{gdb/mi} commands can be used to create catchpoints
26484 that stop the execution when Ada exceptions are being raised.
26485
26486 @subheading The @code{-catch-assert} Command
26487 @findex -catch-assert
26488
26489 @subsubheading Synopsis
26490
26491 @smallexample
26492 -catch-assert [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -t ]
26493 @end smallexample
26494
26495 Add a catchpoint for failed Ada assertions.
26496
26497 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
26498
26499 @table @samp
26500 @item -c @var{condition}
26501 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
26502 @item -d
26503 Create a disabled catchpoint.
26504 @item -t
26505 Create a temporary catchpoint.
26506 @end table
26507
26508 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26509
26510 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch assert}.
26511
26512 @subsubheading Example
26513
26514 @smallexample
26515 -catch-assert
26516 ^done,bkptno="5",bkpt=@{number="5",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26517 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404888",what="failed Ada assertions",
26518 thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",
26519 original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_assert_failure"@}
26520 (gdb)
26521 @end smallexample
26522
26523 @subheading The @code{-catch-exception} Command
26524 @findex -catch-exception
26525
26526 @subsubheading Synopsis
26527
26528 @smallexample
26529 -catch-exception [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -e @var{exception-name} ]
26530 [ -t ] [ -u ]
26531 @end smallexample
26532
26533 Add a catchpoint stopping when Ada exceptions are raised.
26534 By default, the command stops the program when any Ada exception
26535 gets raised. But it is also possible, by using some of the
26536 optional parameters described below, to create more selective
26537 catchpoints.
26538
26539 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
26540
26541 @table @samp
26542 @item -c @var{condition}
26543 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
26544 @item -d
26545 Create a disabled catchpoint.
26546 @item -e @var{exception-name}
26547 Only stop when @var{exception-name} is raised. This option cannot
26548 be used combined with @samp{-u}.
26549 @item -t
26550 Create a temporary catchpoint.
26551 @item -u
26552 Stop only when an unhandled exception gets raised. This option
26553 cannot be used combined with @samp{-e}.
26554 @end table
26555
26556 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26557
26558 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{catch exception}
26559 and @samp{catch exception unhandled}.
26560
26561 @subsubheading Example
26562
26563 @smallexample
26564 -catch-exception -e Program_Error
26565 ^done,bkptno="4",bkpt=@{number="4",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26566 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404874",
26567 what="`Program_Error' Ada exception", thread-groups=["i1"],
26568 times="0",original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_exception"@}
26569 (gdb)
26570 @end smallexample
26571
26572 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26573 @node GDB/MI Program Context
26574 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
26575
26576 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
26577 @findex -exec-arguments
26578
26579
26580 @subsubheading Synopsis
26581
26582 @smallexample
26583 -exec-arguments @var{args}
26584 @end smallexample
26585
26586 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
26587 @samp{-exec-run}.
26588
26589 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26590
26591 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
26592
26593 @subsubheading Example
26594
26595 @smallexample
26596 (gdb)
26597 -exec-arguments -v word
26598 ^done
26599 (gdb)
26600 @end smallexample
26601
26602
26603 @ignore
26604 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
26605 @findex -exec-show-arguments
26606
26607 @subsubheading Synopsis
26608
26609 @smallexample
26610 -exec-show-arguments
26611 @end smallexample
26612
26613 Print the arguments of the program.
26614
26615 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26616
26617 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
26618
26619 @subsubheading Example
26620 N.A.
26621 @end ignore
26622
26623
26624 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
26625 @findex -environment-cd
26626
26627 @subsubheading Synopsis
26628
26629 @smallexample
26630 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
26631 @end smallexample
26632
26633 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
26634
26635 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26636
26637 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
26638
26639 @subsubheading Example
26640
26641 @smallexample
26642 (gdb)
26643 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
26644 ^done
26645 (gdb)
26646 @end smallexample
26647
26648
26649 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
26650 @findex -environment-directory
26651
26652 @subsubheading Synopsis
26653
26654 @smallexample
26655 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
26656 @end smallexample
26657
26658 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
26659 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
26660 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
26661 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
26662 occurs as normal.
26663 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
26664 multiple directories in a single command
26665 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
26666 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
26667 If blanks are needed as
26668 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
26669 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
26670 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
26671 character must not be used
26672 in any directory name.
26673 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
26674
26675 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26676
26677 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
26678
26679 @subsubheading Example
26680
26681 @smallexample
26682 (gdb)
26683 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
26684 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
26685 (gdb)
26686 -environment-directory ""
26687 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
26688 (gdb)
26689 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
26690 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
26691 (gdb)
26692 -environment-directory -r
26693 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
26694 (gdb)
26695 @end smallexample
26696
26697
26698 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
26699 @findex -environment-path
26700
26701 @subsubheading Synopsis
26702
26703 @smallexample
26704 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
26705 @end smallexample
26706
26707 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
26708 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
26709 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
26710 supplied in addition to the
26711 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
26712 occurs as normal.
26713 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
26714 multiple directories in a single command
26715 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
26716 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
26717 If blanks are needed as
26718 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
26719 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
26720 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
26721 character must not be used
26722 in any directory name.
26723 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
26724
26725
26726 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26727
26728 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
26729
26730 @subsubheading Example
26731
26732 @smallexample
26733 (gdb)
26734 -environment-path
26735 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
26736 (gdb)
26737 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
26738 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
26739 (gdb)
26740 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
26741 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
26742 (gdb)
26743 @end smallexample
26744
26745
26746 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
26747 @findex -environment-pwd
26748
26749 @subsubheading Synopsis
26750
26751 @smallexample
26752 -environment-pwd
26753 @end smallexample
26754
26755 Show the current working directory.
26756
26757 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26758
26759 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
26760
26761 @subsubheading Example
26762
26763 @smallexample
26764 (gdb)
26765 -environment-pwd
26766 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
26767 (gdb)
26768 @end smallexample
26769
26770 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26771 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
26772 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
26773
26774
26775 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
26776 @findex -thread-info
26777
26778 @subsubheading Synopsis
26779
26780 @smallexample
26781 -thread-info [ @var{thread-id} ]
26782 @end smallexample
26783
26784 Reports information about either a specific thread, if
26785 the @var{thread-id} parameter is present, or about all
26786 threads. When printing information about all threads,
26787 also reports the current thread.
26788
26789 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26790
26791 The @samp{info thread} command prints the same information
26792 about all threads.
26793
26794 @subsubheading Result
26795
26796 The result is a list of threads. The following attributes are
26797 defined for a given thread:
26798
26799 @table @samp
26800 @item current
26801 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
26802
26803 @item id
26804 The identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the thread.
26805
26806 @item target-id
26807 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the thread.
26808
26809 @item details
26810 Extra information about the thread, in a target-specific format. This
26811 field is optional.
26812
26813 @item name
26814 The name of the thread. If the user specified a name using the
26815 @code{thread name} command, then this name is given. Otherwise, if
26816 @value{GDBN} can extract the thread name from the target, then that
26817 name is given. If @value{GDBN} cannot find the thread name, then this
26818 field is omitted.
26819
26820 @item frame
26821 The stack frame currently executing in the thread.
26822
26823 @item state
26824 The thread's state. The @samp{state} field may have the following
26825 values:
26826
26827 @table @code
26828 @item stopped
26829 The thread is stopped. Frame information is available for stopped
26830 threads.
26831
26832 @item running
26833 The thread is running. There's no frame information for running
26834 threads.
26835
26836 @end table
26837
26838 @item core
26839 If @value{GDBN} can find the CPU core on which this thread is running,
26840 then this field is the core identifier. This field is optional.
26841
26842 @end table
26843
26844 @subsubheading Example
26845
26846 @smallexample
26847 -thread-info
26848 ^done,threads=[
26849 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
26850 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",
26851 args=[]@},state="running"@},
26852 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
26853 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",
26854 args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
26855 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},
26856 state="running"@}],
26857 current-thread-id="1"
26858 (gdb)
26859 @end smallexample
26860
26861 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
26862 @findex -thread-list-ids
26863
26864 @subsubheading Synopsis
26865
26866 @smallexample
26867 -thread-list-ids
26868 @end smallexample
26869
26870 Produces a list of the currently known @value{GDBN} thread ids. At the
26871 end of the list it also prints the total number of such threads.
26872
26873 This command is retained for historical reasons, the
26874 @code{-thread-info} command should be used instead.
26875
26876 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26877
26878 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
26879
26880 @subsubheading Example
26881
26882 @smallexample
26883 (gdb)
26884 -thread-list-ids
26885 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
26886 current-thread-id="1",number-of-threads="3"
26887 (gdb)
26888 @end smallexample
26889
26890
26891 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
26892 @findex -thread-select
26893
26894 @subsubheading Synopsis
26895
26896 @smallexample
26897 -thread-select @var{threadnum}
26898 @end smallexample
26899
26900 Make @var{threadnum} the current thread. It prints the number of the new
26901 current thread, and the topmost frame for that thread.
26902
26903 This command is deprecated in favor of explicitly using the
26904 @samp{--thread} option to each command.
26905
26906 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26907
26908 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
26909
26910 @subsubheading Example
26911
26912 @smallexample
26913 (gdb)
26914 -exec-next
26915 ^running
26916 (gdb)
26917 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
26918 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
26919 (gdb)
26920 -thread-list-ids
26921 ^done,
26922 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
26923 number-of-threads="3"
26924 (gdb)
26925 -thread-select 3
26926 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
26927 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
26928 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
26929 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
26930 (gdb)
26931 @end smallexample
26932
26933 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26934 @node GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands
26935 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Tasking Commands
26936
26937 @subheading The @code{-ada-task-info} Command
26938 @findex -ada-task-info
26939
26940 @subsubheading Synopsis
26941
26942 @smallexample
26943 -ada-task-info [ @var{task-id} ]
26944 @end smallexample
26945
26946 Reports information about either a specific Ada task, if the
26947 @var{task-id} parameter is present, or about all Ada tasks.
26948
26949 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26950
26951 The @samp{info tasks} command prints the same information
26952 about all Ada tasks (@pxref{Ada Tasks}).
26953
26954 @subsubheading Result
26955
26956 The result is a table of Ada tasks. The following columns are
26957 defined for each Ada task:
26958
26959 @table @samp
26960 @item current
26961 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
26962
26963 @item id
26964 The identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the Ada task.
26965
26966 @item task-id
26967 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the Ada task.
26968
26969 @item thread-id
26970 The identifier of the thread corresponding to the Ada task.
26971
26972 This field should always exist, as Ada tasks are always implemented
26973 on top of a thread. But if @value{GDBN} cannot find this corresponding
26974 thread for any reason, the field is omitted.
26975
26976 @item parent-id
26977 This field exists only when the task was created by another task.
26978 In this case, it provides the ID of the parent task.
26979
26980 @item priority
26981 The base priority of the task.
26982
26983 @item state
26984 The current state of the task. For a detailed description of the
26985 possible states, see @ref{Ada Tasks}.
26986
26987 @item name
26988 The name of the task.
26989
26990 @end table
26991
26992 @subsubheading Example
26993
26994 @smallexample
26995 -ada-task-info
26996 ^done,tasks=@{nr_rows="3",nr_cols="8",
26997 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr=""@},
26998 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="id",colhdr="ID"@},
26999 @{width="9",alignment="1",col_name="task-id",colhdr="TID"@},
27000 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="thread-id",colhdr=""@},
27001 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="parent-id",colhdr="P-ID"@},
27002 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="priority",colhdr="Pri"@},
27003 @{width="22",alignment="-1",col_name="state",colhdr="State"@},
27004 @{width="1",alignment="2",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@}],
27005 body=[@{current="*",id="1",task-id=" 644010",thread-id="1",priority="48",
27006 state="Child Termination Wait",name="main_task"@}]@}
27007 (gdb)
27008 @end smallexample
27009
27010 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27011 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
27012 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
27013
27014 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
27015 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
27016 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
27017 other cases.
27018
27019 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
27020 @findex -exec-continue
27021
27022 @subsubheading Synopsis
27023
27024 @smallexample
27025 -exec-continue [--reverse] [--all|--thread-group N]
27026 @end smallexample
27027
27028 Resumes the execution of the inferior program, which will continue
27029 to execute until it reaches a debugger stop event. If the
27030 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, execution resumes in reverse until
27031 it reaches a stop event. Stop events may include
27032 @itemize @bullet
27033 @item
27034 breakpoints or watchpoints
27035 @item
27036 signals or exceptions
27037 @item
27038 the end of the process (or its beginning under @samp{--reverse})
27039 @item
27040 the end or beginning of a replay log if one is being used.
27041 @end itemize
27042 In all-stop mode (@pxref{All-Stop
27043 Mode}), may resume only one thread, or all threads, depending on the
27044 value of the @samp{scheduler-locking} variable. If @samp{--all} is
27045 specified, all threads (in all inferiors) will be resumed. The @samp{--all} option is
27046 ignored in all-stop mode. If the @samp{--thread-group} options is
27047 specified, then all threads in that thread group are resumed.
27048
27049 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27050
27051 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
27052
27053 @subsubheading Example
27054
27055 @smallexample
27056 -exec-continue
27057 ^running
27058 (gdb)
27059 @@Hello world
27060 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="2",frame=@{
27061 func="foo",args=[],file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",
27062 line="13"@}
27063 (gdb)
27064 @end smallexample
27065
27066
27067 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
27068 @findex -exec-finish
27069
27070 @subsubheading Synopsis
27071
27072 @smallexample
27073 -exec-finish [--reverse]
27074 @end smallexample
27075
27076 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
27077 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
27078 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes the reverse
27079 execution of the inferior program until the point where current
27080 function was called.
27081
27082 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27083
27084 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
27085
27086 @subsubheading Example
27087
27088 Function returning @code{void}.
27089
27090 @smallexample
27091 -exec-finish
27092 ^running
27093 (gdb)
27094 @@hello from foo
27095 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
27096 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7"@}
27097 (gdb)
27098 @end smallexample
27099
27100 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
27101 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
27102 value itself.
27103
27104 @smallexample
27105 -exec-finish
27106 ^running
27107 (gdb)
27108 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
27109 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
27110 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27111 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
27112 (gdb)
27113 @end smallexample
27114
27115
27116 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
27117 @findex -exec-interrupt
27118
27119 @subsubheading Synopsis
27120
27121 @smallexample
27122 -exec-interrupt [--all|--thread-group N]
27123 @end smallexample
27124
27125 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
27126 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
27127 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
27128 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
27129 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
27130
27131 Note that when asynchronous execution is enabled, this command is
27132 asynchronous just like other execution commands. That is, first the
27133 @samp{^done} response will be printed, and the target stop will be
27134 reported after that using the @samp{*stopped} notification.
27135
27136 In non-stop mode, only the context thread is interrupted by default.
27137 All threads (in all inferiors) will be interrupted if the
27138 @samp{--all} option is specified. If the @samp{--thread-group}
27139 option is specified, all threads in that group will be interrupted.
27140
27141 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27142
27143 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
27144
27145 @subsubheading Example
27146
27147 @smallexample
27148 (gdb)
27149 111-exec-continue
27150 111^running
27151
27152 (gdb)
27153 222-exec-interrupt
27154 222^done
27155 (gdb)
27156 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
27157 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
27158 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13"@}
27159 (gdb)
27160
27161 (gdb)
27162 -exec-interrupt
27163 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
27164 (gdb)
27165 @end smallexample
27166
27167 @subheading The @code{-exec-jump} Command
27168 @findex -exec-jump
27169
27170 @subsubheading Synopsis
27171
27172 @smallexample
27173 -exec-jump @var{location}
27174 @end smallexample
27175
27176 Resumes execution of the inferior program at the location specified by
27177 parameter. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
27178 different forms of @var{location}.
27179
27180 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27181
27182 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{jump}.
27183
27184 @subsubheading Example
27185
27186 @smallexample
27187 -exec-jump foo.c:10
27188 *running,thread-id="all"
27189 ^running
27190 @end smallexample
27191
27192
27193 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
27194 @findex -exec-next
27195
27196 @subsubheading Synopsis
27197
27198 @smallexample
27199 -exec-next [--reverse]
27200 @end smallexample
27201
27202 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
27203 of the next source line is reached.
27204
27205 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
27206 of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the previous
27207 source line. If you issue this command on the first line of a
27208 function, it will take you back to the caller of that function, to the
27209 source line where the function was called.
27210
27211
27212 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27213
27214 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
27215
27216 @subsubheading Example
27217
27218 @smallexample
27219 -exec-next
27220 ^running
27221 (gdb)
27222 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
27223 (gdb)
27224 @end smallexample
27225
27226
27227 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
27228 @findex -exec-next-instruction
27229
27230 @subsubheading Synopsis
27231
27232 @smallexample
27233 -exec-next-instruction [--reverse]
27234 @end smallexample
27235
27236 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
27237 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
27238 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
27239 printed as well.
27240
27241 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
27242 of the inferior program, stopping at the previous instruction. If the
27243 previously executed instruction was a return from another function,
27244 it will continue to execute in reverse until the call to that function
27245 (from the current stack frame) is reached.
27246
27247 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27248
27249 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
27250
27251 @subsubheading Example
27252
27253 @smallexample
27254 (gdb)
27255 -exec-next-instruction
27256 ^running
27257
27258 (gdb)
27259 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
27260 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
27261 (gdb)
27262 @end smallexample
27263
27264
27265 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
27266 @findex -exec-return
27267
27268 @subsubheading Synopsis
27269
27270 @smallexample
27271 -exec-return
27272 @end smallexample
27273
27274 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
27275 Displays the new current frame.
27276
27277 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27278
27279 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
27280
27281 @subsubheading Example
27282
27283 @smallexample
27284 (gdb)
27285 200-break-insert callee4
27286 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
27287 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
27288 (gdb)
27289 000-exec-run
27290 000^running
27291 (gdb)
27292 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
27293 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
27294 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27295 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
27296 (gdb)
27297 205-break-delete
27298 205^done
27299 (gdb)
27300 111-exec-return
27301 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
27302 args=[@{name="strarg",
27303 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
27304 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27305 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
27306 (gdb)
27307 @end smallexample
27308
27309
27310 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
27311 @findex -exec-run
27312
27313 @subsubheading Synopsis
27314
27315 @smallexample
27316 -exec-run [ --all | --thread-group N ] [ --start ]
27317 @end smallexample
27318
27319 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
27320 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
27321 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
27322 the program has exited exceptionally.
27323
27324 When neither the @samp{--all} nor the @samp{--thread-group} option
27325 is specified, the current inferior is started. If the
27326 @samp{--thread-group} option is specified, it should refer to a thread
27327 group of type @samp{process}, and that thread group will be started.
27328 If the @samp{--all} option is specified, then all inferiors will be started.
27329
27330 Using the @samp{--start} option instructs the debugger to stop
27331 the execution at the start of the inferior's main subprogram,
27332 following the same behavior as the @code{start} command
27333 (@pxref{Starting}).
27334
27335 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27336
27337 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
27338
27339 @subsubheading Examples
27340
27341 @smallexample
27342 (gdb)
27343 -break-insert main
27344 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
27345 (gdb)
27346 -exec-run
27347 ^running
27348 (gdb)
27349 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
27350 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
27351 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}
27352 (gdb)
27353 @end smallexample
27354
27355 @noindent
27356 Program exited normally:
27357
27358 @smallexample
27359 (gdb)
27360 -exec-run
27361 ^running
27362 (gdb)
27363 x = 55
27364 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
27365 (gdb)
27366 @end smallexample
27367
27368 @noindent
27369 Program exited exceptionally:
27370
27371 @smallexample
27372 (gdb)
27373 -exec-run
27374 ^running
27375 (gdb)
27376 x = 55
27377 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
27378 (gdb)
27379 @end smallexample
27380
27381 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
27382 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
27383
27384 @smallexample
27385 (gdb)
27386 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
27387 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
27388 @end smallexample
27389
27390
27391 @c @subheading -exec-signal
27392
27393
27394 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
27395 @findex -exec-step
27396
27397 @subsubheading Synopsis
27398
27399 @smallexample
27400 -exec-step [--reverse]
27401 @end smallexample
27402
27403 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
27404 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
27405 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
27406 function. If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse
27407 execution of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the
27408 previously executed source line.
27409
27410 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27411
27412 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
27413
27414 @subsubheading Example
27415
27416 Stepping into a function:
27417
27418 @smallexample
27419 -exec-step
27420 ^running
27421 (gdb)
27422 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
27423 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
27424 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
27425 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@}
27426 (gdb)
27427 @end smallexample
27428
27429 Regular stepping:
27430
27431 @smallexample
27432 -exec-step
27433 ^running
27434 (gdb)
27435 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
27436 (gdb)
27437 @end smallexample
27438
27439
27440 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
27441 @findex -exec-step-instruction
27442
27443 @subsubheading Synopsis
27444
27445 @smallexample
27446 -exec-step-instruction [--reverse]
27447 @end smallexample
27448
27449 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. If the
27450 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution of the
27451 inferior program, stopping at the previously executed instruction.
27452 The output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on
27453 whether we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the
27454 former case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed
27455 as well.
27456
27457 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27458
27459 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
27460
27461 @subsubheading Example
27462
27463 @smallexample
27464 (gdb)
27465 -exec-step-instruction
27466 ^running
27467
27468 (gdb)
27469 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
27470 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
27471 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
27472 (gdb)
27473 -exec-step-instruction
27474 ^running
27475
27476 (gdb)
27477 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
27478 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
27479 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
27480 (gdb)
27481 @end smallexample
27482
27483
27484 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
27485 @findex -exec-until
27486
27487 @subsubheading Synopsis
27488
27489 @smallexample
27490 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
27491 @end smallexample
27492
27493 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
27494 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
27495 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
27496 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
27497
27498 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27499
27500 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
27501
27502 @subsubheading Example
27503
27504 @smallexample
27505 (gdb)
27506 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
27507 ^running
27508 (gdb)
27509 x = 55
27510 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
27511 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6"@}
27512 (gdb)
27513 @end smallexample
27514
27515 @ignore
27516 @subheading -file-clear
27517 Is this going away????
27518 @end ignore
27519
27520 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27521 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
27522 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
27523
27524 @subheading The @code{-enable-frame-filters} Command
27525 @findex -enable-frame-filters
27526
27527 @smallexample
27528 -enable-frame-filters
27529 @end smallexample
27530
27531 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based frame filters to affect the output of
27532 the MI commands relating to stack traces. As there is no way to
27533 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
27534 request that this functionality be enabled.
27535
27536 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
27537
27538 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
27539 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
27540
27541 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
27542 @findex -stack-info-frame
27543
27544 @subsubheading Synopsis
27545
27546 @smallexample
27547 -stack-info-frame
27548 @end smallexample
27549
27550 Get info on the selected frame.
27551
27552 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27553
27554 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
27555 (without arguments).
27556
27557 @subsubheading Example
27558
27559 @smallexample
27560 (gdb)
27561 -stack-info-frame
27562 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
27563 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27564 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}
27565 (gdb)
27566 @end smallexample
27567
27568 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
27569 @findex -stack-info-depth
27570
27571 @subsubheading Synopsis
27572
27573 @smallexample
27574 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
27575 @end smallexample
27576
27577 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
27578 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
27579
27580 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27581
27582 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
27583
27584 @subsubheading Example
27585
27586 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
27587
27588 @smallexample
27589 (gdb)
27590 -stack-info-depth
27591 ^done,depth="12"
27592 (gdb)
27593 -stack-info-depth 4
27594 ^done,depth="4"
27595 (gdb)
27596 -stack-info-depth 12
27597 ^done,depth="12"
27598 (gdb)
27599 -stack-info-depth 11
27600 ^done,depth="11"
27601 (gdb)
27602 -stack-info-depth 13
27603 ^done,depth="12"
27604 (gdb)
27605 @end smallexample
27606
27607 @anchor{-stack-list-arguments}
27608 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
27609 @findex -stack-list-arguments
27610
27611 @subsubheading Synopsis
27612
27613 @smallexample
27614 -stack-list-arguments [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
27615 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
27616 @end smallexample
27617
27618 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
27619 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
27620 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
27621 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
27622 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
27623 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
27624 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
27625 which case only existing frames will be returned.
27626
27627 If @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
27628 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
27629 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
27630 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
27631 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
27632 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
27633
27634 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, arguments that
27635 are not available are not listed. Partially available arguments
27636 are still displayed, however.
27637
27638 Use of this command to obtain arguments in a single frame is
27639 deprecated in favor of the @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
27640
27641 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27642
27643 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
27644 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
27645 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
27646
27647 @subsubheading Example
27648
27649 @smallexample
27650 (gdb)
27651 -stack-list-frames
27652 ^done,
27653 stack=[
27654 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
27655 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27656 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
27657 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
27658 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27659 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
27660 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
27661 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27662 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
27663 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
27664 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27665 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
27666 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
27667 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27668 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
27669 (gdb)
27670 -stack-list-arguments 0
27671 ^done,
27672 stack-args=[
27673 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
27674 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
27675 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
27676 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
27677 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
27678 (gdb)
27679 -stack-list-arguments 1
27680 ^done,
27681 stack-args=[
27682 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
27683 frame=@{level="1",
27684 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
27685 frame=@{level="2",args=[
27686 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
27687 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
27688 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
27689 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
27690 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
27691 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
27692 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
27693 (gdb)
27694 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
27695 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
27696 (gdb)
27697 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
27698 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
27699 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
27700 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
27701 (gdb)
27702 @end smallexample
27703
27704 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
27705
27706
27707 @anchor{-stack-list-frames}
27708 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
27709 @findex -stack-list-frames
27710
27711 @subsubheading Synopsis
27712
27713 @smallexample
27714 -stack-list-frames [ --no-frame-filters @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
27715 @end smallexample
27716
27717 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
27718 following info:
27719
27720 @table @samp
27721 @item @var{level}
27722 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
27723 @item @var{addr}
27724 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
27725 @item @var{func}
27726 Function name.
27727 @item @var{file}
27728 File name of the source file where the function lives.
27729 @item @var{fullname}
27730 The full file name of the source file where the function lives.
27731 @item @var{line}
27732 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
27733 @item @var{from}
27734 The shared library where this function is defined. This is only given
27735 if the frame's function is not known.
27736 @end table
27737
27738 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
27739 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
27740 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
27741 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
27742 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
27743 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
27744 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be
27745 returned. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
27746 Python frame filters will not be executed.
27747
27748 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27749
27750 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
27751
27752 @subsubheading Example
27753
27754 Full stack backtrace:
27755
27756 @smallexample
27757 (gdb)
27758 -stack-list-frames
27759 ^done,stack=
27760 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
27761 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@},
27762 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27763 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27764 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27765 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27766 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27767 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27768 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27769 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27770 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27771 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27772 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27773 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27774 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27775 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27776 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27777 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27778 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27779 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27780 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27781 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27782 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
27783 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
27784 (gdb)
27785 @end smallexample
27786
27787 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
27788
27789 @smallexample
27790 (gdb)
27791 -stack-list-frames 3 5
27792 ^done,stack=
27793 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27794 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27795 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27796 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27797 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27798 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
27799 (gdb)
27800 @end smallexample
27801
27802 Show a single frame:
27803
27804 @smallexample
27805 (gdb)
27806 -stack-list-frames 3 3
27807 ^done,stack=
27808 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27809 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
27810 (gdb)
27811 @end smallexample
27812
27813
27814 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
27815 @findex -stack-list-locals
27816 @anchor{-stack-list-locals}
27817
27818 @subsubheading Synopsis
27819
27820 @smallexample
27821 -stack-list-locals [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
27822 @end smallexample
27823
27824 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
27825 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
27826 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
27827 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
27828 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
27829 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
27830 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
27831 other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
27832 more detail. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
27833 Python frame filters will not be executed.
27834
27835 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
27836 that are not available are not listed. Partially available local
27837 variables are still displayed, however.
27838
27839 This command is deprecated in favor of the
27840 @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
27841
27842 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27843
27844 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
27845
27846 @subsubheading Example
27847
27848 @smallexample
27849 (gdb)
27850 -stack-list-locals 0
27851 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
27852 (gdb)
27853 -stack-list-locals --all-values
27854 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
27855 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
27856 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
27857 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
27858 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
27859 (gdb)
27860 @end smallexample
27861
27862 @anchor{-stack-list-variables}
27863 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-variables} Command
27864 @findex -stack-list-variables
27865
27866 @subsubheading Synopsis
27867
27868 @smallexample
27869 -stack-list-variables [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
27870 @end smallexample
27871
27872 Display the names of local variables and function arguments for the selected frame. If
27873 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
27874 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
27875 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
27876 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
27877 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
27878 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
27879
27880 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
27881 and arguments that are not available are not listed. Partially
27882 available arguments and local variables are still displayed, however.
27883
27884 @subsubheading Example
27885
27886 @smallexample
27887 (gdb)
27888 -stack-list-variables --thread 1 --frame 0 --all-values
27889 ^done,variables=[@{name="x",value="11"@},@{name="s",value="@{a = 1, b = 2@}"@}]
27890 (gdb)
27891 @end smallexample
27892
27893
27894 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
27895 @findex -stack-select-frame
27896
27897 @subsubheading Synopsis
27898
27899 @smallexample
27900 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
27901 @end smallexample
27902
27903 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
27904 the stack.
27905
27906 This command in deprecated in favor of passing the @samp{--frame}
27907 option to every command.
27908
27909 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27910
27911 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
27912 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
27913
27914 @subsubheading Example
27915
27916 @smallexample
27917 (gdb)
27918 -stack-select-frame 2
27919 ^done
27920 (gdb)
27921 @end smallexample
27922
27923 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27924 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
27925 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
27926
27927 @ignore
27928
27929 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
27930
27931 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
27932 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
27933 used by @code{Insight}.
27934
27935 The two main reasons for that are:
27936
27937 @enumerate 1
27938 @item
27939 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
27940
27941 @item
27942 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
27943 now).
27944 @end enumerate
27945
27946 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
27947 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
27948 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
27949 hints about their use.
27950
27951 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
27952 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
27953 least, the following operations:
27954
27955 @itemize @bullet
27956 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
27957 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
27958 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
27959 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
27960 @end itemize
27961
27962 @end ignore
27963
27964 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
27965
27966 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
27967
27968 Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
27969 changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
27970 work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
27971 simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
27972 is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
27973 frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
27974 expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
27975 expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
27976 variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
27977 operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
27978 object, or to change display format.
27979
27980 Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
27981 that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
27982 a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
27983 element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
27984 children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
27985 leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
27986 objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
27987 is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
27988 child will be created.
27989
27990 For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
27991 string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
27992 obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
27993 that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
27994 contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
27995
27996 A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
27997 the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
27998 variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
27999 operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
28000 be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
28001 objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
28002 real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
28003 variables that frontend has created.
28004
28005 The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
28006 might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
28007 and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
28008 relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
28009 to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
28010 visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
28011 called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
28012 implicitly updated.
28013
28014 Variable objects can be either @dfn{fixed} or @dfn{floating}. For the
28015 fixed variable object, the expression is parsed when the variable
28016 object is created, including associating identifiers to specific
28017 variables. The meaning of expression never changes. For a floating
28018 variable object the values of variables whose names appear in the
28019 expressions are re-evaluated every time in the context of the current
28020 frame. Consider this example:
28021
28022 @smallexample
28023 void do_work(...)
28024 @{
28025 struct work_state state;
28026
28027 if (...)
28028 do_work(...);
28029 @}
28030 @end smallexample
28031
28032 If a fixed variable object for the @code{state} variable is created in
28033 this function, and we enter the recursive call, the variable
28034 object will report the value of @code{state} in the top-level
28035 @code{do_work} invocation. On the other hand, a floating variable
28036 object will report the value of @code{state} in the current frame.
28037
28038 If an expression specified when creating a fixed variable object
28039 refers to a local variable, the variable object becomes bound to the
28040 thread and frame in which the variable object is created. When such
28041 variable object is updated, @value{GDBN} makes sure that the
28042 thread/frame combination the variable object is bound to still exists,
28043 and re-evaluates the variable object in context of that thread/frame.
28044
28045 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
28046 access this functionality:
28047
28048 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
28049 @item @strong{Operation}
28050 @tab @strong{Description}
28051
28052 @item @code{-enable-pretty-printing}
28053 @tab enable Python-based pretty-printing
28054 @item @code{-var-create}
28055 @tab create a variable object
28056 @item @code{-var-delete}
28057 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
28058 @item @code{-var-set-format}
28059 @tab set the display format of this variable
28060 @item @code{-var-show-format}
28061 @tab show the display format of this variable
28062 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
28063 @tab tells how many children this object has
28064 @item @code{-var-list-children}
28065 @tab return a list of the object's children
28066 @item @code{-var-info-type}
28067 @tab show the type of this variable object
28068 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
28069 @tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
28070 @item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
28071 @tab print full expression that this variable object represents
28072 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
28073 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
28074 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
28075 @tab get the value of this variable
28076 @item @code{-var-assign}
28077 @tab set the value of this variable
28078 @item @code{-var-update}
28079 @tab update the variable and its children
28080 @item @code{-var-set-frozen}
28081 @tab set frozeness attribute
28082 @item @code{-var-set-update-range}
28083 @tab set range of children to display on update
28084 @end multitable
28085
28086 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
28087 how it can be used.
28088
28089 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
28090
28091 @subheading The @code{-enable-pretty-printing} Command
28092 @findex -enable-pretty-printing
28093
28094 @smallexample
28095 -enable-pretty-printing
28096 @end smallexample
28097
28098 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based visualizers to affect the output of the
28099 MI variable object commands. However, because there was no way to
28100 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
28101 request that this functionality be enabled.
28102
28103 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
28104
28105 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
28106 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
28107
28108 This feature is currently (as of @value{GDBN} 7.0) experimental, and
28109 may work differently in future versions of @value{GDBN}.
28110
28111 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
28112 @findex -var-create
28113
28114 @subsubheading Synopsis
28115
28116 @smallexample
28117 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
28118 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*" | "@@"@} @var{expression}
28119 @end smallexample
28120
28121 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
28122 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
28123 register.
28124
28125 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
28126 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
28127 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
28128 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} of that format.
28129 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
28130
28131 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
28132 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
28133 frame should be used. A @samp{@@} indicates that a floating variable
28134 object must be created.
28135
28136 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
28137 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
28138
28139 @itemize @bullet
28140 @item
28141 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
28142
28143 @item
28144 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
28145
28146 @item
28147 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
28148 @end itemize
28149
28150 @cindex dynamic varobj
28151 A varobj's contents may be provided by a Python-based pretty-printer. In this
28152 case the varobj is known as a @dfn{dynamic varobj}. Dynamic varobjs
28153 have slightly different semantics in some cases. If the
28154 @code{-enable-pretty-printing} command is not sent, then @value{GDBN}
28155 will never create a dynamic varobj. This ensures backward
28156 compatibility for existing clients.
28157
28158 @subsubheading Result
28159
28160 This operation returns attributes of the newly-created varobj. These
28161 are:
28162
28163 @table @samp
28164 @item name
28165 The name of the varobj.
28166
28167 @item numchild
28168 The number of children of the varobj. This number is not necessarily
28169 reliable for a dynamic varobj. Instead, you must examine the
28170 @samp{has_more} attribute.
28171
28172 @item value
28173 The varobj's scalar value. For a varobj whose type is some sort of
28174 aggregate (e.g., a @code{struct}), or for a dynamic varobj, this value
28175 will not be interesting.
28176
28177 @item type
28178 The varobj's type. This is a string representation of the type, as
28179 would be printed by the @value{GDBN} CLI. If @samp{print object}
28180 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
28181 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
28182 @emph{declared} one.
28183
28184 @item thread-id
28185 If a variable object is bound to a specific thread, then this is the
28186 thread's identifier.
28187
28188 @item has_more
28189 For a dynamic varobj, this indicates whether there appear to be any
28190 children available. For a non-dynamic varobj, this will be 0.
28191
28192 @item dynamic
28193 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
28194 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
28195 then this attribute will not be present.
28196
28197 @item displayhint
28198 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
28199 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
28200 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
28201 @end table
28202
28203 Typical output will look like this:
28204
28205 @smallexample
28206 name="@var{name}",numchild="@var{N}",type="@var{type}",thread-id="@var{M}",
28207 has_more="@var{has_more}"
28208 @end smallexample
28209
28210
28211 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
28212 @findex -var-delete
28213
28214 @subsubheading Synopsis
28215
28216 @smallexample
28217 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
28218 @end smallexample
28219
28220 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
28221 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
28222
28223 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
28224
28225
28226 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
28227 @findex -var-set-format
28228
28229 @subsubheading Synopsis
28230
28231 @smallexample
28232 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
28233 @end smallexample
28234
28235 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
28236 @var{format-spec}.
28237
28238 @anchor{-var-set-format}
28239 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
28240
28241 @smallexample
28242 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
28243 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural@}
28244 @end smallexample
28245
28246 The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
28247 based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
28248 for pointers, etc.).
28249
28250 For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
28251 variable itself, and the children are not affected.
28252
28253 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
28254 @findex -var-show-format
28255
28256 @subsubheading Synopsis
28257
28258 @smallexample
28259 -var-show-format @var{name}
28260 @end smallexample
28261
28262 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
28263
28264 @smallexample
28265 @var{format} @expansion{}
28266 @var{format-spec}
28267 @end smallexample
28268
28269
28270 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
28271 @findex -var-info-num-children
28272
28273 @subsubheading Synopsis
28274
28275 @smallexample
28276 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
28277 @end smallexample
28278
28279 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
28280
28281 @smallexample
28282 numchild=@var{n}
28283 @end smallexample
28284
28285 Note that this number is not completely reliable for a dynamic varobj.
28286 It will return the current number of children, but more children may
28287 be available.
28288
28289
28290 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
28291 @findex -var-list-children
28292
28293 @subsubheading Synopsis
28294
28295 @smallexample
28296 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name} [@var{from} @var{to}]
28297 @end smallexample
28298 @anchor{-var-list-children}
28299
28300 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
28301 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
28302 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value of 0 or
28303 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
28304 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
28305 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
28306 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
28307 and unions.
28308
28309 @var{from} and @var{to}, if specified, indicate the range of children
28310 to report. If @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is
28311 reset and all children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting
28312 at @var{from} (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be
28313 reported.
28314
28315 If a child range is requested, it will only affect the current call to
28316 @code{-var-list-children}, but not future calls to @code{-var-update}.
28317 For this, you must instead use @code{-var-set-update-range}. The
28318 intent of this approach is to enable a front end to implement any
28319 update approach it likes; for example, scrolling a view may cause the
28320 front end to request more children with @code{-var-list-children}, and
28321 then the front end could call @code{-var-set-update-range} with a
28322 different range to ensure that future updates are restricted to just
28323 the visible items.
28324
28325 For each child the following results are returned:
28326
28327 @table @var
28328
28329 @item name
28330 Name of the variable object created for this child.
28331
28332 @item exp
28333 The expression to be shown to the user by the front end to designate this child.
28334 For example this may be the name of a structure member.
28335
28336 For a dynamic varobj, this value cannot be used to form an
28337 expression. There is no way to do this at all with a dynamic varobj.
28338
28339 For C/C@t{++} structures there are several pseudo children returned to
28340 designate access qualifiers. For these pseudo children @var{exp} is
28341 @samp{public}, @samp{private}, or @samp{protected}. In this case the
28342 type and value are not present.
28343
28344 A dynamic varobj will not report the access qualifying
28345 pseudo-children, regardless of the language. This information is not
28346 available at all with a dynamic varobj.
28347
28348 @item numchild
28349 Number of children this child has. For a dynamic varobj, this will be
28350 0.
28351
28352 @item type
28353 The type of the child. If @samp{print object}
28354 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
28355 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
28356 @emph{declared} one.
28357
28358 @item value
28359 If values were requested, this is the value.
28360
28361 @item thread-id
28362 If this variable object is associated with a thread, this is the thread id.
28363 Otherwise this result is not present.
28364
28365 @item frozen
28366 If the variable object is frozen, this variable will be present with a value of 1.
28367
28368 @item displayhint
28369 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
28370 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
28371 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
28372
28373 @item dynamic
28374 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
28375 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
28376 then this attribute will not be present.
28377
28378 @end table
28379
28380 The result may have its own attributes:
28381
28382 @table @samp
28383 @item displayhint
28384 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
28385 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
28386 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
28387
28388 @item has_more
28389 This is an integer attribute which is nonzero if there are children
28390 remaining after the end of the selected range.
28391 @end table
28392
28393 @subsubheading Example
28394
28395 @smallexample
28396 (gdb)
28397 -var-list-children n
28398 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
28399 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
28400 (gdb)
28401 -var-list-children --all-values n
28402 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
28403 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
28404 @end smallexample
28405
28406
28407 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
28408 @findex -var-info-type
28409
28410 @subsubheading Synopsis
28411
28412 @smallexample
28413 -var-info-type @var{name}
28414 @end smallexample
28415
28416 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
28417 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
28418 @value{GDBN} CLI:
28419
28420 @smallexample
28421 type=@var{typename}
28422 @end smallexample
28423
28424
28425 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
28426 @findex -var-info-expression
28427
28428 @subsubheading Synopsis
28429
28430 @smallexample
28431 -var-info-expression @var{name}
28432 @end smallexample
28433
28434 Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
28435 variable object in user interface. The string is generally
28436 not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
28437
28438 For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
28439 @code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
28440
28441 @smallexample
28442 (gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
28443 ^done,lang="C",exp="1"
28444 @end smallexample
28445
28446 @noindent
28447 Here, the value of @code{lang} is the language name, which can be
28448 found in @ref{Supported Languages}.
28449
28450 Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
28451 includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
28452 is of limited use.
28453
28454 @subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
28455 @findex -var-info-path-expression
28456
28457 @subsubheading Synopsis
28458
28459 @smallexample
28460 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
28461 @end smallexample
28462
28463 Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
28464 context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
28465 Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
28466 result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
28467 the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
28468 watchpoint from a variable object.
28469
28470 This command is currently not valid for children of a dynamic varobj,
28471 and will give an error when invoked on one.
28472
28473 For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
28474 @code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
28475 @code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
28476 @code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
28477 @code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
28478 @smallexample
28479 (gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
28480 ^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
28481 @end smallexample
28482
28483 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
28484 @findex -var-show-attributes
28485
28486 @subsubheading Synopsis
28487
28488 @smallexample
28489 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
28490 @end smallexample
28491
28492 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
28493
28494 @smallexample
28495 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
28496 @end smallexample
28497
28498 @noindent
28499 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
28500
28501 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
28502 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
28503
28504 @subsubheading Synopsis
28505
28506 @smallexample
28507 -var-evaluate-expression [-f @var{format-spec}] @var{name}
28508 @end smallexample
28509
28510 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
28511 object and returns its value as a string. The format of the string
28512 can be specified with the @samp{-f} option. The possible values of
28513 this option are the same as for @code{-var-set-format}
28514 (@pxref{-var-set-format}). If the @samp{-f} option is not specified,
28515 the current display format will be used. The current display format
28516 can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
28517
28518 @smallexample
28519 value=@var{value}
28520 @end smallexample
28521
28522 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
28523 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
28524
28525 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
28526 @findex -var-assign
28527
28528 @subsubheading Synopsis
28529
28530 @smallexample
28531 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
28532 @end smallexample
28533
28534 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
28535 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
28536 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
28537 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
28538
28539 @subsubheading Example
28540
28541 @smallexample
28542 (gdb)
28543 -var-assign var1 3
28544 ^done,value="3"
28545 (gdb)
28546 -var-update *
28547 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
28548 (gdb)
28549 @end smallexample
28550
28551 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
28552 @findex -var-update
28553
28554 @subsubheading Synopsis
28555
28556 @smallexample
28557 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
28558 @end smallexample
28559
28560 Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
28561 @var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
28562 list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
28563 be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
28564 @code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
28565 @code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
28566 object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
28567 for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
28568 @var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
28569 names are printed. The possible values of this option are the same
28570 as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
28571 recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
28572 number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
28573
28574 With the @samp{*} parameter, if a variable object is bound to a
28575 currently running thread, it will not be updated, without any
28576 diagnostic.
28577
28578 If @code{-var-set-update-range} was previously used on a varobj, then
28579 only the selected range of children will be reported.
28580
28581 @code{-var-update} reports all the changed varobjs in a tuple named
28582 @samp{changelist}.
28583
28584 Each item in the change list is itself a tuple holding:
28585
28586 @table @samp
28587 @item name
28588 The name of the varobj.
28589
28590 @item value
28591 If values were requested for this update, then this field will be
28592 present and will hold the value of the varobj.
28593
28594 @item in_scope
28595 @anchor{-var-update}
28596 This field is a string which may take one of three values:
28597
28598 @table @code
28599 @item "true"
28600 The variable object's current value is valid.
28601
28602 @item "false"
28603 The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
28604 hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
28605 scope.
28606
28607 @item "invalid"
28608 The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
28609 This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
28610 either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
28611 command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
28612 objects.
28613 @end table
28614
28615 In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
28616 be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
28617
28618 @item type_changed
28619 This is only present if the varobj is still valid. If the type
28620 changed, then this will be the string @samp{true}; otherwise it will
28621 be @samp{false}.
28622
28623 When a varobj's type changes, its children are also likely to have
28624 become incorrect. Therefore, the varobj's children are automatically
28625 deleted when this attribute is @samp{true}. Also, the varobj's update
28626 range, when set using the @code{-var-set-update-range} command, is
28627 unset.
28628
28629 @item new_type
28630 If the varobj's type changed, then this field will be present and will
28631 hold the new type.
28632
28633 @item new_num_children
28634 For a dynamic varobj, if the number of children changed, or if the
28635 type changed, this will be the new number of children.
28636
28637 The @samp{numchild} field in other varobj responses is generally not
28638 valid for a dynamic varobj -- it will show the number of children that
28639 @value{GDBN} knows about, but because dynamic varobjs lazily
28640 instantiate their children, this will not reflect the number of
28641 children which may be available.
28642
28643 The @samp{new_num_children} attribute only reports changes to the
28644 number of children known by @value{GDBN}. This is the only way to
28645 detect whether an update has removed children (which necessarily can
28646 only happen at the end of the update range).
28647
28648 @item displayhint
28649 The display hint, if any.
28650
28651 @item has_more
28652 This is an integer value, which will be 1 if there are more children
28653 available outside the varobj's update range.
28654
28655 @item dynamic
28656 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
28657 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
28658 then this attribute will not be present.
28659
28660 @item new_children
28661 If new children were added to a dynamic varobj within the selected
28662 update range (as set by @code{-var-set-update-range}), then they will
28663 be listed in this attribute.
28664 @end table
28665
28666 @subsubheading Example
28667
28668 @smallexample
28669 (gdb)
28670 -var-assign var1 3
28671 ^done,value="3"
28672 (gdb)
28673 -var-update --all-values var1
28674 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
28675 type_changed="false"@}]
28676 (gdb)
28677 @end smallexample
28678
28679 @subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
28680 @findex -var-set-frozen
28681 @anchor{-var-set-frozen}
28682
28683 @subsubheading Synopsis
28684
28685 @smallexample
28686 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
28687 @end smallexample
28688
28689 Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
28690 @var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
28691 frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
28692 frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
28693 implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
28694 a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
28695 @code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
28696 values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
28697 implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
28698 Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
28699 @code{-var-update} does.
28700
28701 @subsubheading Example
28702
28703 @smallexample
28704 (gdb)
28705 -var-set-frozen V 1
28706 ^done
28707 (gdb)
28708 @end smallexample
28709
28710 @subheading The @code{-var-set-update-range} command
28711 @findex -var-set-update-range
28712 @anchor{-var-set-update-range}
28713
28714 @subsubheading Synopsis
28715
28716 @smallexample
28717 -var-set-update-range @var{name} @var{from} @var{to}
28718 @end smallexample
28719
28720 Set the range of children to be returned by future invocations of
28721 @code{-var-update}.
28722
28723 @var{from} and @var{to} indicate the range of children to report. If
28724 @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is reset and all
28725 children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting at @var{from}
28726 (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be reported.
28727
28728 @subsubheading Example
28729
28730 @smallexample
28731 (gdb)
28732 -var-set-update-range V 1 2
28733 ^done
28734 @end smallexample
28735
28736 @subheading The @code{-var-set-visualizer} command
28737 @findex -var-set-visualizer
28738 @anchor{-var-set-visualizer}
28739
28740 @subsubheading Synopsis
28741
28742 @smallexample
28743 -var-set-visualizer @var{name} @var{visualizer}
28744 @end smallexample
28745
28746 Set a visualizer for the variable object @var{name}.
28747
28748 @var{visualizer} is the visualizer to use. The special value
28749 @samp{None} means to disable any visualizer in use.
28750
28751 If not @samp{None}, @var{visualizer} must be a Python expression.
28752 This expression must evaluate to a callable object which accepts a
28753 single argument. @value{GDBN} will call this object with the value of
28754 the varobj @var{name} as an argument (this is done so that the same
28755 Python pretty-printing code can be used for both the CLI and MI).
28756 When called, this object must return an object which conforms to the
28757 pretty-printing interface (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}).
28758
28759 The pre-defined function @code{gdb.default_visualizer} may be used to
28760 select a visualizer by following the built-in process
28761 (@pxref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}). This is done automatically when
28762 a varobj is created, and so ordinarily is not needed.
28763
28764 This feature is only available if Python support is enabled. The MI
28765 command @code{-list-features} (@pxref{GDB/MI Support Commands})
28766 can be used to check this.
28767
28768 @subsubheading Example
28769
28770 Resetting the visualizer:
28771
28772 @smallexample
28773 (gdb)
28774 -var-set-visualizer V None
28775 ^done
28776 @end smallexample
28777
28778 Reselecting the default (type-based) visualizer:
28779
28780 @smallexample
28781 (gdb)
28782 -var-set-visualizer V gdb.default_visualizer
28783 ^done
28784 @end smallexample
28785
28786 Suppose @code{SomeClass} is a visualizer class. A lambda expression
28787 can be used to instantiate this class for a varobj:
28788
28789 @smallexample
28790 (gdb)
28791 -var-set-visualizer V "lambda val: SomeClass()"
28792 ^done
28793 @end smallexample
28794
28795 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28796 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
28797 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
28798
28799 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
28800 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
28801 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
28802 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
28803
28804 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
28805 @c @subheading -data-assign
28806 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
28807 @c @subsubheading GDB Command
28808 @c set variable
28809 @c @subsubheading Example
28810 @c N.A.
28811
28812 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
28813 @findex -data-disassemble
28814
28815 @subsubheading Synopsis
28816
28817 @smallexample
28818 -data-disassemble
28819 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
28820 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
28821 -- @var{mode}
28822 @end smallexample
28823
28824 @noindent
28825 Where:
28826
28827 @table @samp
28828 @item @var{start-addr}
28829 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
28830 @item @var{end-addr}
28831 is the end address
28832 @item @var{filename}
28833 is the name of the file to disassemble
28834 @item @var{linenum}
28835 is the line number to disassemble around
28836 @item @var{lines}
28837 is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
28838 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
28839 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
28840 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
28841 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
28842 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
28843 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
28844 are displayed.
28845 @item @var{mode}
28846 is either 0 (meaning only disassembly), 1 (meaning mixed source and
28847 disassembly), 2 (meaning disassembly with raw opcodes), or 3 (meaning
28848 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes).
28849 @end table
28850
28851 @subsubheading Result
28852
28853 The result of the @code{-data-disassemble} command will be a list named
28854 @samp{asm_insns}, the contents of this list depend on the @var{mode}
28855 used with the @code{-data-disassemble} command.
28856
28857 For modes 0 and 2 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples with the
28858 following fields:
28859
28860 @table @code
28861 @item address
28862 The address at which this instruction was disassembled.
28863
28864 @item func-name
28865 The name of the function this instruction is within.
28866
28867 @item offset
28868 The decimal offset in bytes from the start of @samp{func-name}.
28869
28870 @item inst
28871 The text disassembly for this @samp{address}.
28872
28873 @item opcodes
28874 This field is only present for mode 2. This contains the raw opcode
28875 bytes for the @samp{inst} field.
28876
28877 @end table
28878
28879 For modes 1 and 3 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples named
28880 @samp{src_and_asm_line}, each of which has the following fields:
28881
28882 @table @code
28883 @item line
28884 The line number within @samp{file}.
28885
28886 @item file
28887 The file name from the compilation unit. This might be an absolute
28888 file name or a relative file name depending on the compile command
28889 used.
28890
28891 @item fullname
28892 Absolute file name of @samp{file}. It is converted to a canonical form
28893 using the source file search path
28894 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories})
28895 and after resolving all the symbolic links.
28896
28897 If the source file is not found this field will contain the path as
28898 present in the debug information.
28899
28900 @item line_asm_insn
28901 This is a list of tuples containing the disassembly for @samp{line} in
28902 @samp{file}. The fields of each tuple are the same as for
28903 @code{-data-disassemble} in @var{mode} 0 and 2, so @samp{address},
28904 @samp{func-name}, @samp{offset}, @samp{inst}, and optionally
28905 @samp{opcodes}.
28906
28907 @end table
28908
28909 Note that whatever included in the @samp{inst} field, is not
28910 manipulated directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to
28911 adjust its format.
28912
28913 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28914
28915 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disassemble}.
28916
28917 @subsubheading Example
28918
28919 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
28920
28921 @smallexample
28922 (gdb)
28923 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
28924 ^done,
28925 asm_insns=[
28926 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
28927 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
28928 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
28929 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
28930 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
28931 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
28932 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
28933 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
28934 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
28935 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
28936 (gdb)
28937 @end smallexample
28938
28939 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
28940 @code{main}.
28941
28942 @smallexample
28943 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
28944 ^done,asm_insns=[
28945 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
28946 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
28947 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
28948 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
28949 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
28950 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
28951 [@dots{}]
28952 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
28953 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
28954 (gdb)
28955 @end smallexample
28956
28957 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
28958
28959 @smallexample
28960 (gdb)
28961 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
28962 ^done,asm_insns=[
28963 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
28964 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
28965 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
28966 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
28967 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
28968 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
28969 (gdb)
28970 @end smallexample
28971
28972 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
28973
28974 @smallexample
28975 (gdb)
28976 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
28977 ^done,asm_insns=[
28978 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
28979 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28980 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28981 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107bc",
28982 func-name="main",offset="0",inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
28983 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
28984 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28985 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28986 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107c0",
28987 func-name="main",offset="4",inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
28988 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
28989 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
28990 (gdb)
28991 @end smallexample
28992
28993
28994 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
28995 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
28996
28997 @subsubheading Synopsis
28998
28999 @smallexample
29000 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
29001 @end smallexample
29002
29003 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
29004 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
29005 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
29006
29007 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29008
29009 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
29010 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
29011 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
29012
29013 @subsubheading Example
29014
29015 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
29016 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
29017 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
29018 output.
29019
29020 @smallexample
29021 211-data-evaluate-expression A
29022 211^done,value="1"
29023 (gdb)
29024 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
29025 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
29026 (gdb)
29027 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
29028 411^done,value="4"
29029 (gdb)
29030 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
29031 511^done,value="4"
29032 (gdb)
29033 @end smallexample
29034
29035
29036 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
29037 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
29038
29039 @subsubheading Synopsis
29040
29041 @smallexample
29042 -data-list-changed-registers
29043 @end smallexample
29044
29045 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
29046
29047 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29048
29049 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
29050 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
29051
29052 @subsubheading Example
29053
29054 On a PPC MBX board:
29055
29056 @smallexample
29057 (gdb)
29058 -exec-continue
29059 ^running
29060
29061 (gdb)
29062 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",frame=@{
29063 func="main",args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",
29064 line="5"@}
29065 (gdb)
29066 -data-list-changed-registers
29067 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
29068 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
29069 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
29070 (gdb)
29071 @end smallexample
29072
29073
29074 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
29075 @findex -data-list-register-names
29076
29077 @subsubheading Synopsis
29078
29079 @smallexample
29080 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
29081 @end smallexample
29082
29083 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
29084 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
29085 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
29086 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
29087 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
29088 include empty register names.
29089
29090 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29091
29092 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
29093 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
29094 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
29095
29096 @subsubheading Example
29097
29098 For the PPC MBX board:
29099 @smallexample
29100 (gdb)
29101 -data-list-register-names
29102 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
29103 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
29104 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
29105 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
29106 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
29107 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
29108 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
29109 (gdb)
29110 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
29111 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
29112 (gdb)
29113 @end smallexample
29114
29115 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
29116 @findex -data-list-register-values
29117
29118 @subsubheading Synopsis
29119
29120 @smallexample
29121 -data-list-register-values
29122 [ @code{--skip-unavailable} ] @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
29123 @end smallexample
29124
29125 Display the registers' contents. The format according to which the
29126 registers' contents are to be returned is given by @var{fmt}, followed
29127 by an optional list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A
29128 missing list of numbers indicates that the contents of all the
29129 registers must be returned. The @code{--skip-unavailable} option
29130 indicates that only the available registers are to be returned.
29131
29132 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
29133
29134 @table @code
29135 @item x
29136 Hexadecimal
29137 @item o
29138 Octal
29139 @item t
29140 Binary
29141 @item d
29142 Decimal
29143 @item r
29144 Raw
29145 @item N
29146 Natural
29147 @end table
29148
29149 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29150
29151 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
29152 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
29153
29154 @subsubheading Example
29155
29156 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
29157 don't appear in the actual output):
29158
29159 @smallexample
29160 (gdb)
29161 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
29162 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
29163 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
29164 (gdb)
29165 -data-list-register-values x
29166 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
29167 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
29168 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
29169 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
29170 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
29171 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
29172 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
29173 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
29174 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
29175 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
29176 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
29177 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
29178 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
29179 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
29180 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
29181 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
29182 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
29183 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
29184 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
29185 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
29186 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
29187 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
29188 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
29189 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
29190 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
29191 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
29192 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
29193 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
29194 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
29195 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
29196 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
29197 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
29198 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
29199 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
29200 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
29201 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
29202 (gdb)
29203 @end smallexample
29204
29205
29206 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
29207 @findex -data-read-memory
29208
29209 This command is deprecated, use @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} instead.
29210
29211 @subsubheading Synopsis
29212
29213 @smallexample
29214 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
29215 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
29216 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
29217 @end smallexample
29218
29219 @noindent
29220 where:
29221
29222 @table @samp
29223 @item @var{address}
29224 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
29225 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
29226 quoted using the C convention.
29227
29228 @item @var{word-format}
29229 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
29230 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
29231 ,Output Formats}).
29232
29233 @item @var{word-size}
29234 The size of each memory word in bytes.
29235
29236 @item @var{nr-rows}
29237 The number of rows in the output table.
29238
29239 @item @var{nr-cols}
29240 The number of columns in the output table.
29241
29242 @item @var{aschar}
29243 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
29244 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
29245 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
29246 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
29247
29248 @item @var{byte-offset}
29249 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
29250 @end table
29251
29252 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
29253 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
29254 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
29255 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
29256 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
29257 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
29258 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
29259 @samp{addr}.
29260
29261 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
29262 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
29263 @samp{prev-page}.
29264
29265 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29266
29267 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
29268 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
29269
29270 @subsubheading Example
29271
29272 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
29273 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
29274 word. Display each word in hex.
29275
29276 @smallexample
29277 (gdb)
29278 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
29279 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
29280 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
29281 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
29282 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
29283 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
29284 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
29285 (gdb)
29286 @end smallexample
29287
29288 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
29289 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
29290
29291 @smallexample
29292 (gdb)
29293 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
29294 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
29295 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
29296 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
29297 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
29298 (gdb)
29299 @end smallexample
29300
29301 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
29302 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
29303 used as the non-printable character.
29304
29305 @smallexample
29306 (gdb)
29307 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
29308 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
29309 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
29310 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
29311 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
29312 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
29313 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
29314 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
29315 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
29316 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
29317 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
29318 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
29319 (gdb)
29320 @end smallexample
29321
29322 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} Command
29323 @findex -data-read-memory-bytes
29324
29325 @subsubheading Synopsis
29326
29327 @smallexample
29328 -data-read-memory-bytes [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
29329 @var{address} @var{count}
29330 @end smallexample
29331
29332 @noindent
29333 where:
29334
29335 @table @samp
29336 @item @var{address}
29337 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
29338 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
29339 quoted using the C convention.
29340
29341 @item @var{count}
29342 The number of bytes to read. This should be an integer literal.
29343
29344 @item @var{byte-offset}
29345 The offsets in bytes relative to @var{address} at which to start
29346 reading. This should be an integer literal. This option is provided
29347 so that a frontend is not required to first evaluate address and then
29348 perform address arithmetics itself.
29349
29350 @end table
29351
29352 This command attempts to read all accessible memory regions in the
29353 specified range. First, all regions marked as unreadable in the memory
29354 map (if one is defined) will be skipped. @xref{Memory Region
29355 Attributes}. Second, @value{GDBN} will attempt to read the remaining
29356 regions. For each one, if reading full region results in an errors,
29357 @value{GDBN} will try to read a subset of the region.
29358
29359 In general, every single byte in the region may be readable or not,
29360 and the only way to read every readable byte is to try a read at
29361 every address, which is not practical. Therefore, @value{GDBN} will
29362 attempt to read all accessible bytes at either beginning or the end
29363 of the region, using a binary division scheme. This heuristic works
29364 well for reading accross a memory map boundary. Note that if a region
29365 has a readable range that is neither at the beginning or the end,
29366 @value{GDBN} will not read it.
29367
29368 The result record (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}) that is output of
29369 the command includes a field named @samp{memory} whose content is a
29370 list of tuples. Each tuple represent a successfully read memory block
29371 and has the following fields:
29372
29373 @table @code
29374 @item begin
29375 The start address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
29376
29377 @item end
29378 The end address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
29379
29380 @item offset
29381 The offset of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal, relative to
29382 the start address passed to @code{-data-read-memory-bytes}.
29383
29384 @item contents
29385 The contents of the memory block, in hex.
29386
29387 @end table
29388
29389
29390
29391 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29392
29393 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}.
29394
29395 @subsubheading Example
29396
29397 @smallexample
29398 (gdb)
29399 -data-read-memory-bytes &a 10
29400 ^done,memory=[@{begin="0xbffff154",offset="0x00000000",
29401 end="0xbffff15e",
29402 contents="01000000020000000300"@}]
29403 (gdb)
29404 @end smallexample
29405
29406
29407 @subheading The @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} Command
29408 @findex -data-write-memory-bytes
29409
29410 @subsubheading Synopsis
29411
29412 @smallexample
29413 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents}
29414 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents} @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
29415 @end smallexample
29416
29417 @noindent
29418 where:
29419
29420 @table @samp
29421 @item @var{address}
29422 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
29423 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
29424 quoted using the C convention.
29425
29426 @item @var{contents}
29427 The hex-encoded bytes to write.
29428
29429 @item @var{count}
29430 Optional argument indicating the number of bytes to be written. If @var{count}
29431 is greater than @var{contents}' length, @value{GDBN} will repeatedly
29432 write @var{contents} until it fills @var{count} bytes.
29433
29434 @end table
29435
29436 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29437
29438 There's no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
29439
29440 @subsubheading Example
29441
29442 @smallexample
29443 (gdb)
29444 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd"
29445 ^done
29446 (gdb)
29447 @end smallexample
29448
29449 @smallexample
29450 (gdb)
29451 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd" 16e
29452 ^done
29453 (gdb)
29454 @end smallexample
29455
29456 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29457 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
29458 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
29459
29460 The commands defined in this section implement MI support for
29461 tracepoints. For detailed introduction, see @ref{Tracepoints}.
29462
29463 @subheading The @code{-trace-find} Command
29464 @findex -trace-find
29465
29466 @subsubheading Synopsis
29467
29468 @smallexample
29469 -trace-find @var{mode} [@var{parameters}@dots{}]
29470 @end smallexample
29471
29472 Find a trace frame using criteria defined by @var{mode} and
29473 @var{parameters}. The following table lists permissible
29474 modes and their parameters. For details of operation, see @ref{tfind}.
29475
29476 @table @samp
29477
29478 @item none
29479 No parameters are required. Stops examining trace frames.
29480
29481 @item frame-number
29482 An integer is required as parameter. Selects tracepoint frame with
29483 that index.
29484
29485 @item tracepoint-number
29486 An integer is required as parameter. Finds next
29487 trace frame that corresponds to tracepoint with the specified number.
29488
29489 @item pc
29490 An address is required as parameter. Finds
29491 next trace frame that corresponds to any tracepoint at the specified
29492 address.
29493
29494 @item pc-inside-range
29495 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds next trace
29496 frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address inside the
29497 specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
29498
29499 @item pc-outside-range
29500 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds
29501 next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address outside
29502 the specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
29503
29504 @item line
29505 Line specification is required as parameter. @xref{Specify Location}.
29506 Finds next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at
29507 the specified location.
29508
29509 @end table
29510
29511 If @samp{none} was passed as @var{mode}, the response does not
29512 have fields. Otherwise, the response may have the following fields:
29513
29514 @table @samp
29515 @item found
29516 This field has either @samp{0} or @samp{1} as the value, depending
29517 on whether a matching tracepoint was found.
29518
29519 @item traceframe
29520 The index of the found traceframe. This field is present iff
29521 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
29522
29523 @item tracepoint
29524 The index of the found tracepoint. This field is present iff
29525 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
29526
29527 @item frame
29528 The information about the frame corresponding to the found trace
29529 frame. This field is present only if a trace frame was found.
29530 @xref{GDB/MI Frame Information}, for description of this field.
29531
29532 @end table
29533
29534 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29535
29536 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tfind}.
29537
29538 @subheading -trace-define-variable
29539 @findex -trace-define-variable
29540
29541 @subsubheading Synopsis
29542
29543 @smallexample
29544 -trace-define-variable @var{name} [ @var{value} ]
29545 @end smallexample
29546
29547 Create trace variable @var{name} if it does not exist. If
29548 @var{value} is specified, sets the initial value of the specified
29549 trace variable to that value. Note that the @var{name} should start
29550 with the @samp{$} character.
29551
29552 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29553
29554 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariable}.
29555
29556 @subheading The @code{-trace-frame-collected} Command
29557 @findex -trace-frame-collected
29558
29559 @subsubheading Synopsis
29560
29561 @smallexample
29562 -trace-frame-collected
29563 [--var-print-values @var{var_pval}]
29564 [--comp-print-values @var{comp_pval}]
29565 [--registers-format @var{regformat}]
29566 [--memory-contents]
29567 @end smallexample
29568
29569 This command returns the set of collected objects, register names,
29570 trace state variable names, memory ranges and computed expressions
29571 that have been collected at a particular trace frame. The optional
29572 parameters to the command affect the output format in different ways.
29573 See the output description table below for more details.
29574
29575 The reported names can be used in the normal manner to create
29576 varobjs and inspect the objects themselves. The items returned by
29577 this command are categorized so that it is clear which is a variable,
29578 which is a register, which is a trace state variable, which is a
29579 memory range and which is a computed expression.
29580
29581 For instance, if the actions were
29582 @smallexample
29583 collect myVar, myArray[myIndex], myObj.field, myPtr->field, myCount + 2
29584 collect *(int*)0xaf02bef0@@40
29585 @end smallexample
29586
29587 @noindent
29588 the object collected in its entirety would be @code{myVar}. The
29589 object @code{myArray} would be partially collected, because only the
29590 element at index @code{myIndex} would be collected. The remaining
29591 objects would be computed expressions.
29592
29593 An example output would be:
29594
29595 @smallexample
29596 (gdb)
29597 -trace-frame-collected
29598 ^done,
29599 explicit-variables=[@{name="myVar",value="1"@}],
29600 computed-expressions=[@{name="myArray[myIndex]",value="0"@},
29601 @{name="myObj.field",value="0"@},
29602 @{name="myPtr->field",value="1"@},
29603 @{name="myCount + 2",value="3"@},
29604 @{name="$tvar1 + 1",value="43970027"@}],
29605 registers=[@{number="0",value="0x7fe2c6e79ec8"@},
29606 @{number="1",value="0x0"@},
29607 @{number="2",value="0x4"@},
29608 ...
29609 @{number="125",value="0x0"@}],
29610 tvars=[@{name="$tvar1",current="43970026"@}],
29611 memory=[@{address="0x0000000000602264",length="4"@},
29612 @{address="0x0000000000615bc0",length="4"@}]
29613 (gdb)
29614 @end smallexample
29615
29616 Where:
29617
29618 @table @code
29619 @item explicit-variables
29620 The set of objects that have been collected in their entirety (as
29621 opposed to collecting just a few elements of an array or a few struct
29622 members). For each object, its name and value are printed.
29623 The @code{--var-print-values} option affects how or whether the value
29624 field is output. If @var{var_pval} is 0, then print only the names;
29625 if it is 1, print also their values; and if it is 2, print the name,
29626 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for
29627 arrays, structures and unions.
29628
29629 @item computed-expressions
29630 The set of computed expressions that have been collected at the
29631 current trace frame. The @code{--comp-print-values} option affects
29632 this set like the @code{--var-print-values} option affects the
29633 @code{explicit-variables} set. See above.
29634
29635 @item registers
29636 The registers that have been collected at the current trace frame.
29637 For each register collected, the name and current value are returned.
29638 The value is formatted according to the @code{--registers-format}
29639 option. See the @command{-data-list-register-values} command for a
29640 list of the allowed formats. The default is @samp{x}.
29641
29642 @item tvars
29643 The trace state variables that have been collected at the current
29644 trace frame. For each trace state variable collected, the name and
29645 current value are returned.
29646
29647 @item memory
29648 The set of memory ranges that have been collected at the current trace
29649 frame. Its content is a list of tuples. Each tuple represents a
29650 collected memory range and has the following fields:
29651
29652 @table @code
29653 @item address
29654 The start address of the memory range, as hexadecimal literal.
29655
29656 @item length
29657 The length of the memory range, as decimal literal.
29658
29659 @item contents
29660 The contents of the memory block, in hex. This field is only present
29661 if the @code{--memory-contents} option is specified.
29662
29663 @end table
29664
29665 @end table
29666
29667 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29668
29669 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
29670
29671 @subsubheading Example
29672
29673 @subheading -trace-list-variables
29674 @findex -trace-list-variables
29675
29676 @subsubheading Synopsis
29677
29678 @smallexample
29679 -trace-list-variables
29680 @end smallexample
29681
29682 Return a table of all defined trace variables. Each element of the
29683 table has the following fields:
29684
29685 @table @samp
29686 @item name
29687 The name of the trace variable. This field is always present.
29688
29689 @item initial
29690 The initial value. This is a 64-bit signed integer. This
29691 field is always present.
29692
29693 @item current
29694 The value the trace variable has at the moment. This is a 64-bit
29695 signed integer. This field is absent iff current value is
29696 not defined, for example if the trace was never run, or is
29697 presently running.
29698
29699 @end table
29700
29701 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29702
29703 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariables}.
29704
29705 @subsubheading Example
29706
29707 @smallexample
29708 (gdb)
29709 -trace-list-variables
29710 ^done,trace-variables=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="3",
29711 hdr=[@{width="15",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
29712 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="initial",colhdr="Initial"@},
29713 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr="Current"@}],
29714 body=[variable=@{name="$trace_timestamp",initial="0"@}
29715 variable=@{name="$foo",initial="10",current="15"@}]@}
29716 (gdb)
29717 @end smallexample
29718
29719 @subheading -trace-save
29720 @findex -trace-save
29721
29722 @subsubheading Synopsis
29723
29724 @smallexample
29725 -trace-save [-r ] @var{filename}
29726 @end smallexample
29727
29728 Saves the collected trace data to @var{filename}. Without the
29729 @samp{-r} option, the data is downloaded from the target and saved
29730 in a local file. With the @samp{-r} option the target is asked
29731 to perform the save.
29732
29733 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29734
29735 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tsave}.
29736
29737
29738 @subheading -trace-start
29739 @findex -trace-start
29740
29741 @subsubheading Synopsis
29742
29743 @smallexample
29744 -trace-start
29745 @end smallexample
29746
29747 Starts a tracing experiments. The result of this command does not
29748 have any fields.
29749
29750 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29751
29752 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstart}.
29753
29754 @subheading -trace-status
29755 @findex -trace-status
29756
29757 @subsubheading Synopsis
29758
29759 @smallexample
29760 -trace-status
29761 @end smallexample
29762
29763 Obtains the status of a tracing experiment. The result may include
29764 the following fields:
29765
29766 @table @samp
29767
29768 @item supported
29769 May have a value of either @samp{0}, when no tracing operations are
29770 supported, @samp{1}, when all tracing operations are supported, or
29771 @samp{file} when examining trace file. In the latter case, examining
29772 of trace frame is possible but new tracing experiement cannot be
29773 started. This field is always present.
29774
29775 @item running
29776 May have a value of either @samp{0} or @samp{1} depending on whether
29777 tracing experiement is in progress on target. This field is present
29778 if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
29779
29780 @item stop-reason
29781 Report the reason why the tracing was stopped last time. This field
29782 may be absent iff tracing was never stopped on target yet. The
29783 value of @samp{request} means the tracing was stopped as result of
29784 the @code{-trace-stop} command. The value of @samp{overflow} means
29785 the tracing buffer is full. The value of @samp{disconnection} means
29786 tracing was automatically stopped when @value{GDBN} has disconnected.
29787 The value of @samp{passcount} means tracing was stopped when a
29788 tracepoint was passed a maximal number of times for that tracepoint.
29789 This field is present if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
29790
29791 @item stopping-tracepoint
29792 The number of tracepoint whose passcount as exceeded. This field is
29793 present iff the @samp{stop-reason} field has the value of
29794 @samp{passcount}.
29795
29796 @item frames
29797 @itemx frames-created
29798 The @samp{frames} field is a count of the total number of trace frames
29799 in the trace buffer, while @samp{frames-created} is the total created
29800 during the run, including ones that were discarded, such as when a
29801 circular trace buffer filled up. Both fields are optional.
29802
29803 @item buffer-size
29804 @itemx buffer-free
29805 These fields tell the current size of the tracing buffer and the
29806 remaining space. These fields are optional.
29807
29808 @item circular
29809 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
29810 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
29811 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
29812 and may fill up.
29813
29814 @item disconnected
29815 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
29816 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
29817 that the trace run will stop.
29818
29819 @item trace-file
29820 The filename of the trace file being examined. This field is
29821 optional, and only present when examining a trace file.
29822
29823 @end table
29824
29825 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29826
29827 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstatus}.
29828
29829 @subheading -trace-stop
29830 @findex -trace-stop
29831
29832 @subsubheading Synopsis
29833
29834 @smallexample
29835 -trace-stop
29836 @end smallexample
29837
29838 Stops a tracing experiment. The result of this command has the same
29839 fields as @code{-trace-status}, except that the @samp{supported} and
29840 @samp{running} fields are not output.
29841
29842 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29843
29844 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstop}.
29845
29846
29847 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29848 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
29849 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
29850
29851
29852 @ignore
29853 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
29854 @findex -symbol-info-address
29855
29856 @subsubheading Synopsis
29857
29858 @smallexample
29859 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
29860 @end smallexample
29861
29862 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
29863
29864 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29865
29866 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
29867
29868 @subsubheading Example
29869 N.A.
29870
29871
29872 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
29873 @findex -symbol-info-file
29874
29875 @subsubheading Synopsis
29876
29877 @smallexample
29878 -symbol-info-file
29879 @end smallexample
29880
29881 Show the file for the symbol.
29882
29883 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29884
29885 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
29886 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
29887
29888 @subsubheading Example
29889 N.A.
29890
29891
29892 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
29893 @findex -symbol-info-function
29894
29895 @subsubheading Synopsis
29896
29897 @smallexample
29898 -symbol-info-function
29899 @end smallexample
29900
29901 Show which function the symbol lives in.
29902
29903 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29904
29905 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
29906
29907 @subsubheading Example
29908 N.A.
29909
29910
29911 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
29912 @findex -symbol-info-line
29913
29914 @subsubheading Synopsis
29915
29916 @smallexample
29917 -symbol-info-line
29918 @end smallexample
29919
29920 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
29921
29922 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29923
29924 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
29925 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
29926
29927 @subsubheading Example
29928 N.A.
29929
29930
29931 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
29932 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
29933
29934 @subsubheading Synopsis
29935
29936 @smallexample
29937 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
29938 @end smallexample
29939
29940 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
29941
29942 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29943
29944 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
29945
29946 @subsubheading Example
29947 N.A.
29948
29949
29950 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
29951 @findex -symbol-list-functions
29952
29953 @subsubheading Synopsis
29954
29955 @smallexample
29956 -symbol-list-functions
29957 @end smallexample
29958
29959 List the functions in the executable.
29960
29961 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29962
29963 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
29964 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
29965
29966 @subsubheading Example
29967 N.A.
29968 @end ignore
29969
29970
29971 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
29972 @findex -symbol-list-lines
29973
29974 @subsubheading Synopsis
29975
29976 @smallexample
29977 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
29978 @end smallexample
29979
29980 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
29981 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
29982 ascending PC order.
29983
29984 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29985
29986 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
29987
29988 @subsubheading Example
29989 @smallexample
29990 (gdb)
29991 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
29992 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
29993 (gdb)
29994 @end smallexample
29995
29996
29997 @ignore
29998 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
29999 @findex -symbol-list-types
30000
30001 @subsubheading Synopsis
30002
30003 @smallexample
30004 -symbol-list-types
30005 @end smallexample
30006
30007 List all the type names.
30008
30009 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30010
30011 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
30012 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
30013
30014 @subsubheading Example
30015 N.A.
30016
30017
30018 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
30019 @findex -symbol-list-variables
30020
30021 @subsubheading Synopsis
30022
30023 @smallexample
30024 -symbol-list-variables
30025 @end smallexample
30026
30027 List all the global and static variable names.
30028
30029 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30030
30031 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
30032
30033 @subsubheading Example
30034 N.A.
30035
30036
30037 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
30038 @findex -symbol-locate
30039
30040 @subsubheading Synopsis
30041
30042 @smallexample
30043 -symbol-locate
30044 @end smallexample
30045
30046 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30047
30048 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
30049
30050 @subsubheading Example
30051 N.A.
30052
30053
30054 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
30055 @findex -symbol-type
30056
30057 @subsubheading Synopsis
30058
30059 @smallexample
30060 -symbol-type @var{variable}
30061 @end smallexample
30062
30063 Show type of @var{variable}.
30064
30065 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30066
30067 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
30068 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
30069
30070 @subsubheading Example
30071 N.A.
30072 @end ignore
30073
30074
30075 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30076 @node GDB/MI File Commands
30077 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
30078
30079 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
30080 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
30081
30082 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
30083 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
30084
30085 @subsubheading Synopsis
30086
30087 @smallexample
30088 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
30089 @end smallexample
30090
30091 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
30092 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
30093 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
30094 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
30095 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
30096 notification.
30097
30098 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30099
30100 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
30101
30102 @subsubheading Example
30103
30104 @smallexample
30105 (gdb)
30106 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
30107 ^done
30108 (gdb)
30109 @end smallexample
30110
30111
30112 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
30113 @findex -file-exec-file
30114
30115 @subsubheading Synopsis
30116
30117 @smallexample
30118 -file-exec-file @var{file}
30119 @end smallexample
30120
30121 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
30122 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
30123 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
30124 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
30125 notification.
30126
30127 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30128
30129 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
30130
30131 @subsubheading Example
30132
30133 @smallexample
30134 (gdb)
30135 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
30136 ^done
30137 (gdb)
30138 @end smallexample
30139
30140
30141 @ignore
30142 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
30143 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
30144
30145 @subsubheading Synopsis
30146
30147 @smallexample
30148 -file-list-exec-sections
30149 @end smallexample
30150
30151 List the sections of the current executable file.
30152
30153 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30154
30155 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
30156 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
30157 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
30158
30159 @subsubheading Example
30160 N.A.
30161 @end ignore
30162
30163
30164 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
30165 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
30166
30167 @subsubheading Synopsis
30168
30169 @smallexample
30170 -file-list-exec-source-file
30171 @end smallexample
30172
30173 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
30174 to the current source file for the current executable. The macro
30175 information field has a value of @samp{1} or @samp{0} depending on
30176 whether or not the file includes preprocessor macro information.
30177
30178 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30179
30180 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
30181
30182 @subsubheading Example
30183
30184 @smallexample
30185 (gdb)
30186 123-file-list-exec-source-file
30187 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c,macro-info="1"
30188 (gdb)
30189 @end smallexample
30190
30191
30192 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
30193 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
30194
30195 @subsubheading Synopsis
30196
30197 @smallexample
30198 -file-list-exec-source-files
30199 @end smallexample
30200
30201 List the source files for the current executable.
30202
30203 It will always output both the filename and fullname (absolute file
30204 name) of a source file.
30205
30206 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30207
30208 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
30209 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
30210
30211 @subsubheading Example
30212 @smallexample
30213 (gdb)
30214 -file-list-exec-source-files
30215 ^done,files=[
30216 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
30217 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
30218 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
30219 (gdb)
30220 @end smallexample
30221
30222 @ignore
30223 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
30224 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
30225
30226 @subsubheading Synopsis
30227
30228 @smallexample
30229 -file-list-shared-libraries
30230 @end smallexample
30231
30232 List the shared libraries in the program.
30233
30234 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30235
30236 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}.
30237
30238 @subsubheading Example
30239 N.A.
30240
30241
30242 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
30243 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
30244
30245 @subsubheading Synopsis
30246
30247 @smallexample
30248 -file-list-symbol-files
30249 @end smallexample
30250
30251 List symbol files.
30252
30253 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30254
30255 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
30256
30257 @subsubheading Example
30258 N.A.
30259 @end ignore
30260
30261
30262 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
30263 @findex -file-symbol-file
30264
30265 @subsubheading Synopsis
30266
30267 @smallexample
30268 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
30269 @end smallexample
30270
30271 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
30272 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
30273 produced, except for a completion notification.
30274
30275 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30276
30277 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
30278
30279 @subsubheading Example
30280
30281 @smallexample
30282 (gdb)
30283 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
30284 ^done
30285 (gdb)
30286 @end smallexample
30287
30288 @ignore
30289 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30290 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
30291 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
30292
30293 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
30294
30295 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
30296
30297 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
30298
30299 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
30300
30301 @c @subheading -overlay-map
30302
30303 @c @subheading -overlay-off
30304
30305 @c @subheading -overlay-on
30306
30307 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
30308
30309 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30310 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
30311 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
30312
30313 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
30314
30315 @c @subheading -signal-handle
30316
30317 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
30318
30319 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
30320 @end ignore
30321
30322
30323 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30324 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
30325 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
30326
30327
30328 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
30329 @findex -target-attach
30330
30331 @subsubheading Synopsis
30332
30333 @smallexample
30334 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{gid} | @var{file}
30335 @end smallexample
30336
30337 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of
30338 @value{GDBN}, or a thread group @var{gid}. If attaching to a thread
30339 group, the id previously returned by
30340 @samp{-list-thread-groups --available} must be used.
30341
30342 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30343
30344 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
30345
30346 @subsubheading Example
30347 @smallexample
30348 (gdb)
30349 -target-attach 34
30350 =thread-created,id="1"
30351 *stopped,thread-id="1",frame=@{addr="0xb7f7e410",func="bar",args=[]@}
30352 ^done
30353 (gdb)
30354 @end smallexample
30355
30356 @ignore
30357 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
30358 @findex -target-compare-sections
30359
30360 @subsubheading Synopsis
30361
30362 @smallexample
30363 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
30364 @end smallexample
30365
30366 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
30367 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
30368
30369 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30370
30371 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
30372
30373 @subsubheading Example
30374 N.A.
30375 @end ignore
30376
30377
30378 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
30379 @findex -target-detach
30380
30381 @subsubheading Synopsis
30382
30383 @smallexample
30384 -target-detach [ @var{pid} | @var{gid} ]
30385 @end smallexample
30386
30387 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
30388 If either @var{pid} or @var{gid} is specified, detaches from either
30389 the specified process, or specified thread group. There's no output.
30390
30391 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30392
30393 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
30394
30395 @subsubheading Example
30396
30397 @smallexample
30398 (gdb)
30399 -target-detach
30400 ^done
30401 (gdb)
30402 @end smallexample
30403
30404
30405 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
30406 @findex -target-disconnect
30407
30408 @subsubheading Synopsis
30409
30410 @smallexample
30411 -target-disconnect
30412 @end smallexample
30413
30414 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
30415 generally not resumed.
30416
30417 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30418
30419 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
30420
30421 @subsubheading Example
30422
30423 @smallexample
30424 (gdb)
30425 -target-disconnect
30426 ^done
30427 (gdb)
30428 @end smallexample
30429
30430
30431 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
30432 @findex -target-download
30433
30434 @subsubheading Synopsis
30435
30436 @smallexample
30437 -target-download
30438 @end smallexample
30439
30440 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
30441 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
30442
30443 @table @samp
30444 @item section
30445 The name of the section.
30446 @item section-sent
30447 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
30448 @item section-size
30449 The size of the section.
30450 @item total-sent
30451 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
30452 @item total-size
30453 The size of the overall executable to download.
30454 @end table
30455
30456 @noindent
30457 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
30458 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
30459
30460 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
30461 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
30462
30463 @table @samp
30464 @item section
30465 The name of the section.
30466 @item section-size
30467 The size of the section.
30468 @item total-size
30469 The size of the overall executable to download.
30470 @end table
30471
30472 @noindent
30473 At the end, a summary is printed.
30474
30475 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30476
30477 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
30478
30479 @subsubheading Example
30480
30481 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
30482 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
30483
30484 @smallexample
30485 (gdb)
30486 -target-download
30487 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
30488 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
30489 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
30490 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
30491 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
30492 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
30493 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
30494 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
30495 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
30496 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
30497 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
30498 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
30499 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
30500 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
30501 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
30502 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
30503 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
30504 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
30505 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
30506 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
30507 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
30508 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
30509 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
30510 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
30511 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
30512 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
30513 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
30514 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
30515 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
30516 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
30517 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
30518 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
30519 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
30520 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
30521 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
30522 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
30523 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
30524 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
30525 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
30526 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
30527 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
30528 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
30529 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
30530 write-rate="429"
30531 (gdb)
30532 @end smallexample
30533
30534
30535 @ignore
30536 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
30537 @findex -target-exec-status
30538
30539 @subsubheading Synopsis
30540
30541 @smallexample
30542 -target-exec-status
30543 @end smallexample
30544
30545 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
30546 not, for instance).
30547
30548 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30549
30550 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
30551
30552 @subsubheading Example
30553 N.A.
30554
30555
30556 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
30557 @findex -target-list-available-targets
30558
30559 @subsubheading Synopsis
30560
30561 @smallexample
30562 -target-list-available-targets
30563 @end smallexample
30564
30565 List the possible targets to connect to.
30566
30567 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30568
30569 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
30570
30571 @subsubheading Example
30572 N.A.
30573
30574
30575 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
30576 @findex -target-list-current-targets
30577
30578 @subsubheading Synopsis
30579
30580 @smallexample
30581 -target-list-current-targets
30582 @end smallexample
30583
30584 Describe the current target.
30585
30586 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30587
30588 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
30589 other things).
30590
30591 @subsubheading Example
30592 N.A.
30593
30594
30595 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
30596 @findex -target-list-parameters
30597
30598 @subsubheading Synopsis
30599
30600 @smallexample
30601 -target-list-parameters
30602 @end smallexample
30603
30604 @c ????
30605 @end ignore
30606
30607 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30608
30609 No equivalent.
30610
30611 @subsubheading Example
30612 N.A.
30613
30614
30615 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
30616 @findex -target-select
30617
30618 @subsubheading Synopsis
30619
30620 @smallexample
30621 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
30622 @end smallexample
30623
30624 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
30625
30626 @table @samp
30627 @item @var{type}
30628 The type of target, for instance @samp{remote}, etc.
30629 @item @var{parameters}
30630 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
30631 Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
30632 @end table
30633
30634 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
30635 which the target program is, in the following form:
30636
30637 @smallexample
30638 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
30639 args=[@var{arg list}]
30640 @end smallexample
30641
30642 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30643
30644 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
30645
30646 @subsubheading Example
30647
30648 @smallexample
30649 (gdb)
30650 -target-select remote /dev/ttya
30651 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
30652 (gdb)
30653 @end smallexample
30654
30655 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30656 @node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands
30657 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands
30658
30659
30660 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
30661 @findex -target-file-put
30662
30663 @subsubheading Synopsis
30664
30665 @smallexample
30666 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
30667 @end smallexample
30668
30669 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
30670 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
30671
30672 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30673
30674 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}.
30675
30676 @subsubheading Example
30677
30678 @smallexample
30679 (gdb)
30680 -target-file-put localfile remotefile
30681 ^done
30682 (gdb)
30683 @end smallexample
30684
30685
30686 @subheading The @code{-target-file-get} Command
30687 @findex -target-file-get
30688
30689 @subsubheading Synopsis
30690
30691 @smallexample
30692 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
30693 @end smallexample
30694
30695 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
30696 on the host system.
30697
30698 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30699
30700 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}.
30701
30702 @subsubheading Example
30703
30704 @smallexample
30705 (gdb)
30706 -target-file-get remotefile localfile
30707 ^done
30708 (gdb)
30709 @end smallexample
30710
30711
30712 @subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command
30713 @findex -target-file-delete
30714
30715 @subsubheading Synopsis
30716
30717 @smallexample
30718 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile}
30719 @end smallexample
30720
30721 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
30722
30723 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30724
30725 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}.
30726
30727 @subsubheading Example
30728
30729 @smallexample
30730 (gdb)
30731 -target-file-delete remotefile
30732 ^done
30733 (gdb)
30734 @end smallexample
30735
30736
30737 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30738 @node GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands
30739 @section Ada Exceptions @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
30740
30741 @subheading The @code{-info-ada-exceptions} Command
30742 @findex -info-ada-exceptions
30743
30744 @subsubheading Synopsis
30745
30746 @smallexample
30747 -info-ada-exceptions [ @var{regexp}]
30748 @end smallexample
30749
30750 List all Ada exceptions defined within the program being debugged.
30751 With a regular expression @var{regexp}, only those exceptions whose
30752 names match @var{regexp} are listed.
30753
30754 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30755
30756 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info exceptions}.
30757
30758 @subsubheading Result
30759
30760 The result is a table of Ada exceptions. The following columns are
30761 defined for each exception:
30762
30763 @table @samp
30764 @item name
30765 The name of the exception.
30766
30767 @item address
30768 The address of the exception.
30769
30770 @end table
30771
30772 @subsubheading Example
30773
30774 @smallexample
30775 -info-ada-exceptions aint
30776 ^done,ada-exceptions=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="2",
30777 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
30778 @{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="address",colhdr="Address"@}],
30779 body=[@{name="constraint_error",address="0x0000000000613da0"@},
30780 @{name="const.aint_global_e",address="0x0000000000613b00"@}]@}
30781 @end smallexample
30782
30783 @subheading Catching Ada Exceptions
30784
30785 The commands describing how to ask @value{GDBN} to stop when a program
30786 raises an exception are described at @ref{Ada Exception GDB/MI
30787 Catchpoint Commands}.
30788
30789
30790 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30791 @node GDB/MI Support Commands
30792 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Support Commands
30793
30794 Since new commands and features get regularly added to @sc{gdb/mi},
30795 some commands are available to help front-ends query the debugger
30796 about support for these capabilities. Similarly, it is also possible
30797 to query @value{GDBN} about target support of certain features.
30798
30799 @subheading The @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} Command
30800 @cindex @code{-info-gdb-mi-command}
30801 @findex -info-gdb-mi-command
30802
30803 @subsubheading Synopsis
30804
30805 @smallexample
30806 -info-gdb-mi-command @var{cmd_name}
30807 @end smallexample
30808
30809 Query support for the @sc{gdb/mi} command named @var{cmd_name}.
30810
30811 Note that the dash (@code{-}) starting all @sc{gdb/mi} commands
30812 is technically not part of the command name (@pxref{GDB/MI Input
30813 Syntax}), and thus should be omitted in @var{cmd_name}. However,
30814 for ease of use, this command also accepts the form with the leading
30815 dash.
30816
30817 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30818
30819 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
30820
30821 @subsubheading Result
30822
30823 The result is a tuple. There is currently only one field:
30824
30825 @table @samp
30826 @item exists
30827 This field is equal to @code{"true"} if the @sc{gdb/mi} command exists,
30828 @code{"false"} otherwise.
30829
30830 @end table
30831
30832 @subsubheading Example
30833
30834 Here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command does not exist:
30835
30836 @smallexample
30837 -info-gdb-mi-command unsupported-command
30838 ^done,command=@{exists="false"@}
30839 @end smallexample
30840
30841 @noindent
30842 And here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command is known
30843 to the debugger:
30844
30845 @smallexample
30846 -info-gdb-mi-command symbol-list-lines
30847 ^done,command=@{exists="true"@}
30848 @end smallexample
30849
30850 @subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
30851 @findex -list-features
30852 @cindex supported @sc{gdb/mi} features, list
30853
30854 Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
30855 this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command,
30856 or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
30857 important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
30858 of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
30859 startup.
30860
30861 The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
30862 available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not
30863 have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names
30864 is given below.
30865
30866 Example output:
30867
30868 @smallexample
30869 (gdb) -list-features
30870 ^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
30871 @end smallexample
30872
30873 The current list of features is:
30874
30875 @ftable @samp
30876 @item frozen-varobjs
30877 Indicates support for the @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well
30878 as possible presense of the @code{frozen} field in the output
30879 of @code{-varobj-create}.
30880 @item pending-breakpoints
30881 Indicates support for the @option{-f} option to the @code{-break-insert}
30882 command.
30883 @item python
30884 Indicates Python scripting support, Python-based
30885 pretty-printing commands, and possible presence of the
30886 @samp{display_hint} field in the output of @code{-var-list-children}
30887 @item thread-info
30888 Indicates support for the @code{-thread-info} command.
30889 @item data-read-memory-bytes
30890 Indicates support for the @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} and the
30891 @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} commands.
30892 @item breakpoint-notifications
30893 Indicates that changes to breakpoints and breakpoints created via the
30894 CLI will be announced via async records.
30895 @item ada-task-info
30896 Indicates support for the @code{-ada-task-info} command.
30897 @item language-option
30898 Indicates that all @sc{gdb/mi} commands accept the @option{--language}
30899 option (@pxref{Context management}).
30900 @item info-gdb-mi-command
30901 Indicates support for the @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} command.
30902 @item undefined-command-error-code
30903 Indicates support for the "undefined-command" error code in error result
30904 records, produced when trying to execute an undefined @sc{gdb/mi} command
30905 (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}).
30906 @item exec-run-start-option
30907 Indicates that the @code{-exec-run} command supports the @option{--start}
30908 option (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}).
30909 @end ftable
30910
30911 @subheading The @code{-list-target-features} Command
30912 @findex -list-target-features
30913
30914 Returns a list of particular features that are supported by the
30915 target. Those features affect the permitted MI commands, but
30916 unlike the features reported by the @code{-list-features} command, the
30917 features depend on which target GDB is using at the moment. Whenever
30918 a target can change, due to commands such as @code{-target-select},
30919 @code{-target-attach} or @code{-exec-run}, the list of target features
30920 may change, and the frontend should obtain it again.
30921 Example output:
30922
30923 @smallexample
30924 (gdb) -list-target-features
30925 ^done,result=["async"]
30926 @end smallexample
30927
30928 The current list of features is:
30929
30930 @table @samp
30931 @item async
30932 Indicates that the target is capable of asynchronous command
30933 execution, which means that @value{GDBN} will accept further commands
30934 while the target is running.
30935
30936 @item reverse
30937 Indicates that the target is capable of reverse execution.
30938 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
30939
30940 @end table
30941
30942 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30943 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
30944 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
30945
30946 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
30947
30948 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
30949 @findex -gdb-exit
30950
30951 @subsubheading Synopsis
30952
30953 @smallexample
30954 -gdb-exit
30955 @end smallexample
30956
30957 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
30958
30959 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30960
30961 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
30962
30963 @subsubheading Example
30964
30965 @smallexample
30966 (gdb)
30967 -gdb-exit
30968 ^exit
30969 @end smallexample
30970
30971
30972 @ignore
30973 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
30974 @findex -exec-abort
30975
30976 @subsubheading Synopsis
30977
30978 @smallexample
30979 -exec-abort
30980 @end smallexample
30981
30982 Kill the inferior running program.
30983
30984 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30985
30986 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
30987
30988 @subsubheading Example
30989 N.A.
30990 @end ignore
30991
30992
30993 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
30994 @findex -gdb-set
30995
30996 @subsubheading Synopsis
30997
30998 @smallexample
30999 -gdb-set
31000 @end smallexample
31001
31002 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
31003 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
31004
31005 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31006
31007 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
31008
31009 @subsubheading Example
31010
31011 @smallexample
31012 (gdb)
31013 -gdb-set $foo=3
31014 ^done
31015 (gdb)
31016 @end smallexample
31017
31018
31019 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
31020 @findex -gdb-show
31021
31022 @subsubheading Synopsis
31023
31024 @smallexample
31025 -gdb-show
31026 @end smallexample
31027
31028 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
31029
31030 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31031
31032 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
31033
31034 @subsubheading Example
31035
31036 @smallexample
31037 (gdb)
31038 -gdb-show annotate
31039 ^done,value="0"
31040 (gdb)
31041 @end smallexample
31042
31043 @c @subheading -gdb-source
31044
31045
31046 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
31047 @findex -gdb-version
31048
31049 @subsubheading Synopsis
31050
31051 @smallexample
31052 -gdb-version
31053 @end smallexample
31054
31055 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
31056
31057 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31058
31059 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
31060 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
31061
31062 @subsubheading Example
31063
31064 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
31065 @c box in TeX.
31066 @smallexample
31067 (gdb)
31068 -gdb-version
31069 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
31070 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
31071 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
31072 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
31073 ~ certain conditions.
31074 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
31075 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
31076 ~ details.
31077 ~This GDB was configured as
31078 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
31079 ^done
31080 (gdb)
31081 @end smallexample
31082
31083 @subheading The @code{-list-thread-groups} Command
31084 @findex -list-thread-groups
31085
31086 @subheading Synopsis
31087
31088 @smallexample
31089 -list-thread-groups [ --available ] [ --recurse 1 ] [ @var{group} ... ]
31090 @end smallexample
31091
31092 Lists thread groups (@pxref{Thread groups}). When a single thread
31093 group is passed as the argument, lists the children of that group.
31094 When several thread group are passed, lists information about those
31095 thread groups. Without any parameters, lists information about all
31096 top-level thread groups.
31097
31098 Normally, thread groups that are being debugged are reported.
31099 With the @samp{--available} option, @value{GDBN} reports thread groups
31100 available on the target.
31101
31102 The output of this command may have either a @samp{threads} result or
31103 a @samp{groups} result. The @samp{thread} result has a list of tuples
31104 as value, with each tuple describing a thread (@pxref{GDB/MI Thread
31105 Information}). The @samp{groups} result has a list of tuples as value,
31106 each tuple describing a thread group. If top-level groups are
31107 requested (that is, no parameter is passed), or when several groups
31108 are passed, the output always has a @samp{groups} result. The format
31109 of the @samp{group} result is described below.
31110
31111 To reduce the number of roundtrips it's possible to list thread groups
31112 together with their children, by passing the @samp{--recurse} option
31113 and the recursion depth. Presently, only recursion depth of 1 is
31114 permitted. If this option is present, then every reported thread group
31115 will also include its children, either as @samp{group} or
31116 @samp{threads} field.
31117
31118 In general, any combination of option and parameters is permitted, with
31119 the following caveats:
31120
31121 @itemize @bullet
31122 @item
31123 When a single thread group is passed, the output will typically
31124 be the @samp{threads} result. Because threads may not contain
31125 anything, the @samp{recurse} option will be ignored.
31126
31127 @item
31128 When the @samp{--available} option is passed, limited information may
31129 be available. In particular, the list of threads of a process might
31130 be inaccessible. Further, specifying specific thread groups might
31131 not give any performance advantage over listing all thread groups.
31132 The frontend should assume that @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}
31133 is always an expensive operation and cache the results.
31134
31135 @end itemize
31136
31137 The @samp{groups} result is a list of tuples, where each tuple may
31138 have the following fields:
31139
31140 @table @code
31141 @item id
31142 Identifier of the thread group. This field is always present.
31143 The identifier is an opaque string; frontends should not try to
31144 convert it to an integer, even though it might look like one.
31145
31146 @item type
31147 The type of the thread group. At present, only @samp{process} is a
31148 valid type.
31149
31150 @item pid
31151 The target-specific process identifier. This field is only present
31152 for thread groups of type @samp{process} and only if the process exists.
31153
31154 @item num_children
31155 The number of children this thread group has. This field may be
31156 absent for an available thread group.
31157
31158 @item threads
31159 This field has a list of tuples as value, each tuple describing a
31160 thread. It may be present if the @samp{--recurse} option is
31161 specified, and it's actually possible to obtain the threads.
31162
31163 @item cores
31164 This field is a list of integers, each identifying a core that one
31165 thread of the group is running on. This field may be absent if
31166 such information is not available.
31167
31168 @item executable
31169 The name of the executable file that corresponds to this thread group.
31170 The field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process},
31171 and only if there is a corresponding executable file.
31172
31173 @end table
31174
31175 @subheading Example
31176
31177 @smallexample
31178 @value{GDBP}
31179 -list-thread-groups
31180 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2"@}]
31181 -list-thread-groups 17
31182 ^done,threads=[@{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
31183 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@},
31184 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
31185 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
31186 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},state="running"@}]]
31187 -list-thread-groups --available
31188 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2]@}]
31189 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1
31190 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
31191 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
31192 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},..]
31193 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1 17 18
31194 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
31195 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
31196 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},...]
31197 @end smallexample
31198
31199 @subheading The @code{-info-os} Command
31200 @findex -info-os
31201
31202 @subsubheading Synopsis
31203
31204 @smallexample
31205 -info-os [ @var{type} ]
31206 @end smallexample
31207
31208 If no argument is supplied, the command returns a table of available
31209 operating-system-specific information types. If one of these types is
31210 supplied as an argument @var{type}, then the command returns a table
31211 of data of that type.
31212
31213 The types of information available depend on the target operating
31214 system.
31215
31216 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31217
31218 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info os}.
31219
31220 @subsubheading Example
31221
31222 When run on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, the output will look something
31223 like this:
31224
31225 @smallexample
31226 @value{GDBP}
31227 -info-os
31228 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="9",nr_cols="3",
31229 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="Type"@},
31230 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="Description"@},
31231 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="Title"@}],
31232 body=[item=@{col0="processes",col1="Listing of all processes",
31233 col2="Processes"@},
31234 item=@{col0="procgroups",col1="Listing of all process groups",
31235 col2="Process groups"@},
31236 item=@{col0="threads",col1="Listing of all threads",
31237 col2="Threads"@},
31238 item=@{col0="files",col1="Listing of all file descriptors",
31239 col2="File descriptors"@},
31240 item=@{col0="sockets",col1="Listing of all internet-domain sockets",
31241 col2="Sockets"@},
31242 item=@{col0="shm",col1="Listing of all shared-memory regions",
31243 col2="Shared-memory regions"@},
31244 item=@{col0="semaphores",col1="Listing of all semaphores",
31245 col2="Semaphores"@},
31246 item=@{col0="msg",col1="Listing of all message queues",
31247 col2="Message queues"@},
31248 item=@{col0="modules",col1="Listing of all loaded kernel modules",
31249 col2="Kernel modules"@}]@}
31250 @value{GDBP}
31251 -info-os processes
31252 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="190",nr_cols="4",
31253 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="pid"@},
31254 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="user"@},
31255 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="command"@},
31256 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col3",colhdr="cores"@}],
31257 body=[item=@{col0="1",col1="root",col2="/sbin/init",col3="0"@},
31258 item=@{col0="2",col1="root",col2="[kthreadd]",col3="1"@},
31259 item=@{col0="3",col1="root",col2="[ksoftirqd/0]",col3="0"@},
31260 ...
31261 item=@{col0="26446",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="0"@},
31262 item=@{col0="28152",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="1"@}]@}
31263 (gdb)
31264 @end smallexample
31265
31266 (Note that the MI output here includes a @code{"Title"} column that
31267 does not appear in command-line @code{info os}; this column is useful
31268 for MI clients that want to enumerate the types of data, such as in a
31269 popup menu, but is needless clutter on the command line, and
31270 @code{info os} omits it.)
31271
31272 @subheading The @code{-add-inferior} Command
31273 @findex -add-inferior
31274
31275 @subheading Synopsis
31276
31277 @smallexample
31278 -add-inferior
31279 @end smallexample
31280
31281 Creates a new inferior (@pxref{Inferiors and Programs}). The created
31282 inferior is not associated with any executable. Such association may
31283 be established with the @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols} command
31284 (@pxref{GDB/MI File Commands}). The command response has a single
31285 field, @samp{inferior}, whose value is the identifier of the
31286 thread group corresponding to the new inferior.
31287
31288 @subheading Example
31289
31290 @smallexample
31291 @value{GDBP}
31292 -add-inferior
31293 ^done,inferior="i3"
31294 @end smallexample
31295
31296 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
31297 @findex -interpreter-exec
31298
31299 @subheading Synopsis
31300
31301 @smallexample
31302 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
31303 @end smallexample
31304 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
31305
31306 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
31307
31308 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
31309
31310 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
31311
31312 @subheading Example
31313
31314 @smallexample
31315 (gdb)
31316 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
31317 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
31318 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
31319 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
31320 ^done
31321 (gdb)
31322 @end smallexample
31323
31324 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
31325 @findex -inferior-tty-set
31326
31327 @subheading Synopsis
31328
31329 @smallexample
31330 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
31331 @end smallexample
31332
31333 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
31334
31335 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
31336
31337 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
31338
31339 @subheading Example
31340
31341 @smallexample
31342 (gdb)
31343 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
31344 ^done
31345 (gdb)
31346 @end smallexample
31347
31348 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
31349 @findex -inferior-tty-show
31350
31351 @subheading Synopsis
31352
31353 @smallexample
31354 -inferior-tty-show
31355 @end smallexample
31356
31357 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
31358
31359 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
31360
31361 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
31362
31363 @subheading Example
31364
31365 @smallexample
31366 (gdb)
31367 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
31368 ^done
31369 (gdb)
31370 -inferior-tty-show
31371 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
31372 (gdb)
31373 @end smallexample
31374
31375 @subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
31376 @findex -enable-timings
31377
31378 @subheading Synopsis
31379
31380 @smallexample
31381 -enable-timings [yes | no]
31382 @end smallexample
31383
31384 Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
31385 command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
31386 developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
31387 equivalent to @samp{yes}.
31388
31389 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
31390
31391 No equivalent.
31392
31393 @subheading Example
31394
31395 @smallexample
31396 (gdb)
31397 -enable-timings
31398 ^done
31399 (gdb)
31400 -break-insert main
31401 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
31402 addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
31403 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",thread-groups=["i1"],
31404 times="0"@},
31405 time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
31406 (gdb)
31407 -enable-timings no
31408 ^done
31409 (gdb)
31410 -exec-run
31411 ^running
31412 (gdb)
31413 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
31414 frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
31415 @{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
31416 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73"@}
31417 (gdb)
31418 @end smallexample
31419
31420 @node Annotations
31421 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
31422
31423 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
31424 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
31425 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
31426 relatively high level.
31427
31428 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
31429 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
31430
31431 @ignore
31432 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
31433 @end ignore
31434
31435 @menu
31436 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
31437 * Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
31438 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
31439 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
31440 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
31441 * Annotations for Running::
31442 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
31443 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
31444 @end menu
31445
31446 @node Annotations Overview
31447 @section What is an Annotation?
31448 @cindex annotations
31449
31450 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
31451 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
31452 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
31453 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
31454 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
31455 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
31456 cannot contain newline characters.
31457
31458 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
31459 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
31460 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
31461 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
31462 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
31463 means those three characters as output.
31464
31465 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
31466 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
31467 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
31468 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
31469 is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
31470 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
31471 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
31472 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
31473 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
31474
31475 @table @code
31476 @kindex set annotate
31477 @item set annotate @var{level}
31478 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
31479 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
31480
31481 @item show annotate
31482 @kindex show annotate
31483 Show the current annotation level.
31484 @end table
31485
31486 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
31487
31488 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
31489
31490 @smallexample
31491 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
31492 GNU gdb 6.0
31493 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
31494 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
31495 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
31496 under certain conditions.
31497 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
31498 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
31499 for details.
31500 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
31501
31502 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
31503 (@value{GDBP})
31504 ^Z^Zprompt
31505 @kbd{quit}
31506
31507 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
31508 $
31509 @end smallexample
31510
31511 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
31512 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
31513 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
31514 output from @value{GDBN}.
31515
31516 @node Server Prefix
31517 @section The Server Prefix
31518 @cindex server prefix
31519
31520 If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
31521 the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
31522 command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
31523 means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
31524 a transparent manner.
31525
31526 The @code{server } prefix does not affect the recording of values into
31527 the value history; to print a value without recording it into the
31528 value history, use the @code{output} command instead of the
31529 @code{print} command.
31530
31531 Using this prefix also disables confirmation requests
31532 (@pxref{confirmation requests}).
31533
31534 @node Prompting
31535 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
31536
31537 @cindex annotations for prompts
31538 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
31539 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
31540 over, etc.
31541
31542 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
31543 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
31544 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
31545 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
31546 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
31547 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
31548 features the following annotations:
31549
31550 @smallexample
31551 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
31552 ^Z^Zprompt
31553 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
31554 @end smallexample
31555
31556 The input types are
31557
31558 @table @code
31559 @findex pre-prompt annotation
31560 @findex prompt annotation
31561 @findex post-prompt annotation
31562 @item prompt
31563 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
31564
31565 @findex pre-commands annotation
31566 @findex commands annotation
31567 @findex post-commands annotation
31568 @item commands
31569 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
31570 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
31571
31572 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
31573 @findex overload-choice annotation
31574 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
31575 @item overload-choice
31576 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
31577
31578 @findex pre-query annotation
31579 @findex query annotation
31580 @findex post-query annotation
31581 @item query
31582 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
31583
31584 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
31585 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
31586 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
31587 @item prompt-for-continue
31588 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
31589 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
31590 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
31591 presence of annotations.
31592 @end table
31593
31594 @node Errors
31595 @section Errors
31596 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
31597
31598 @findex quit annotation
31599 @smallexample
31600 ^Z^Zquit
31601 @end smallexample
31602
31603 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
31604
31605 @findex error annotation
31606 @smallexample
31607 ^Z^Zerror
31608 @end smallexample
31609
31610 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
31611
31612 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
31613 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
31614 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
31615 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
31616 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
31617 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
31618 to the top level.
31619
31620 @findex error-begin annotation
31621 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
31622
31623 @smallexample
31624 ^Z^Zerror-begin
31625 @end smallexample
31626
31627 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
31628 message.
31629
31630 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
31631 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
31632 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
31633
31634 @node Invalidation
31635 @section Invalidation Notices
31636
31637 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
31638 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
31639 changed.
31640
31641 @table @code
31642 @findex frames-invalid annotation
31643 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
31644
31645 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
31646 have changed.
31647
31648 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
31649 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
31650
31651 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
31652 deleted a breakpoint.
31653 @end table
31654
31655 @node Annotations for Running
31656 @section Running the Program
31657 @cindex annotations for running programs
31658
31659 @findex starting annotation
31660 @findex stopping annotation
31661 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
31662 @code{step} or @code{continue},
31663
31664 @smallexample
31665 ^Z^Zstarting
31666 @end smallexample
31667
31668 is output. When the program stops,
31669
31670 @smallexample
31671 ^Z^Zstopped
31672 @end smallexample
31673
31674 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
31675 annotations describe how the program stopped.
31676
31677 @table @code
31678 @findex exited annotation
31679 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
31680 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
31681 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
31682
31683 @findex signalled annotation
31684 @findex signal-name annotation
31685 @findex signal-name-end annotation
31686 @findex signal-string annotation
31687 @findex signal-string-end annotation
31688 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
31689 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
31690 annotation continues:
31691
31692 @smallexample
31693 @var{intro-text}
31694 ^Z^Zsignal-name
31695 @var{name}
31696 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
31697 @var{middle-text}
31698 ^Z^Zsignal-string
31699 @var{string}
31700 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
31701 @var{end-text}
31702 @end smallexample
31703
31704 @noindent
31705 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
31706 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
31707 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}. The arguments
31708 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
31709 user's benefit and have no particular format.
31710
31711 @findex signal annotation
31712 @item ^Z^Zsignal
31713 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
31714 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
31715 terminated with it.
31716
31717 @findex breakpoint annotation
31718 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
31719 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
31720
31721 @findex watchpoint annotation
31722 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
31723 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
31724 @end table
31725
31726 @node Source Annotations
31727 @section Displaying Source
31728 @cindex annotations for source display
31729
31730 @findex source annotation
31731 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
31732
31733 @smallexample
31734 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
31735 @end smallexample
31736
31737 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
31738 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
31739 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
31740 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
31741 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
31742 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
31743 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
31744 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
31745 source which is being displayed. The @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
31746 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
31747 depend on the language).
31748
31749 @node JIT Interface
31750 @chapter JIT Compilation Interface
31751 @cindex just-in-time compilation
31752 @cindex JIT compilation interface
31753
31754 This chapter documents @value{GDBN}'s @dfn{just-in-time} (JIT) compilation
31755 interface. A JIT compiler is a program or library that generates native
31756 executable code at runtime and executes it, usually in order to achieve good
31757 performance while maintaining platform independence.
31758
31759 Programs that use JIT compilation are normally difficult to debug because
31760 portions of their code are generated at runtime, instead of being loaded from
31761 object files, which is where @value{GDBN} normally finds the program's symbols
31762 and debug information. In order to debug programs that use JIT compilation,
31763 @value{GDBN} has an interface that allows the program to register in-memory
31764 symbol files with @value{GDBN} at runtime.
31765
31766 If you are using @value{GDBN} to debug a program that uses this interface, then
31767 it should work transparently so long as you have not stripped the binary. If
31768 you are developing a JIT compiler, then the interface is documented in the rest
31769 of this chapter. At this time, the only known client of this interface is the
31770 LLVM JIT.
31771
31772 Broadly speaking, the JIT interface mirrors the dynamic loader interface. The
31773 JIT compiler communicates with @value{GDBN} by writing data into a global
31774 variable and calling a fuction at a well-known symbol. When @value{GDBN}
31775 attaches, it reads a linked list of symbol files from the global variable to
31776 find existing code, and puts a breakpoint in the function so that it can find
31777 out about additional code.
31778
31779 @menu
31780 * Declarations:: Relevant C struct declarations
31781 * Registering Code:: Steps to register code
31782 * Unregistering Code:: Steps to unregister code
31783 * Custom Debug Info:: Emit debug information in a custom format
31784 @end menu
31785
31786 @node Declarations
31787 @section JIT Declarations
31788
31789 These are the relevant struct declarations that a C program should include to
31790 implement the interface:
31791
31792 @smallexample
31793 typedef enum
31794 @{
31795 JIT_NOACTION = 0,
31796 JIT_REGISTER_FN,
31797 JIT_UNREGISTER_FN
31798 @} jit_actions_t;
31799
31800 struct jit_code_entry
31801 @{
31802 struct jit_code_entry *next_entry;
31803 struct jit_code_entry *prev_entry;
31804 const char *symfile_addr;
31805 uint64_t symfile_size;
31806 @};
31807
31808 struct jit_descriptor
31809 @{
31810 uint32_t version;
31811 /* This type should be jit_actions_t, but we use uint32_t
31812 to be explicit about the bitwidth. */
31813 uint32_t action_flag;
31814 struct jit_code_entry *relevant_entry;
31815 struct jit_code_entry *first_entry;
31816 @};
31817
31818 /* GDB puts a breakpoint in this function. */
31819 void __attribute__((noinline)) __jit_debug_register_code() @{ @};
31820
31821 /* Make sure to specify the version statically, because the
31822 debugger may check the version before we can set it. */
31823 struct jit_descriptor __jit_debug_descriptor = @{ 1, 0, 0, 0 @};
31824 @end smallexample
31825
31826 If the JIT is multi-threaded, then it is important that the JIT synchronize any
31827 modifications to this global data properly, which can easily be done by putting
31828 a global mutex around modifications to these structures.
31829
31830 @node Registering Code
31831 @section Registering Code
31832
31833 To register code with @value{GDBN}, the JIT should follow this protocol:
31834
31835 @itemize @bullet
31836 @item
31837 Generate an object file in memory with symbols and other desired debug
31838 information. The file must include the virtual addresses of the sections.
31839
31840 @item
31841 Create a code entry for the file, which gives the start and size of the symbol
31842 file.
31843
31844 @item
31845 Add it to the linked list in the JIT descriptor.
31846
31847 @item
31848 Point the relevant_entry field of the descriptor at the entry.
31849
31850 @item
31851 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_REGISTER} and call
31852 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
31853 @end itemize
31854
31855 When @value{GDBN} is attached and the breakpoint fires, @value{GDBN} uses the
31856 @code{relevant_entry} pointer so it doesn't have to walk the list looking for
31857 new code. However, the linked list must still be maintained in order to allow
31858 @value{GDBN} to attach to a running process and still find the symbol files.
31859
31860 @node Unregistering Code
31861 @section Unregistering Code
31862
31863 If code is freed, then the JIT should use the following protocol:
31864
31865 @itemize @bullet
31866 @item
31867 Remove the code entry corresponding to the code from the linked list.
31868
31869 @item
31870 Point the @code{relevant_entry} field of the descriptor at the code entry.
31871
31872 @item
31873 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_UNREGISTER} and call
31874 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
31875 @end itemize
31876
31877 If the JIT frees or recompiles code without unregistering it, then @value{GDBN}
31878 and the JIT will leak the memory used for the associated symbol files.
31879
31880 @node Custom Debug Info
31881 @section Custom Debug Info
31882 @cindex custom JIT debug info
31883 @cindex JIT debug info reader
31884
31885 Generating debug information in platform-native file formats (like ELF
31886 or COFF) may be an overkill for JIT compilers; especially if all the
31887 debug info is used for is displaying a meaningful backtrace. The
31888 issue can be resolved by having the JIT writers decide on a debug info
31889 format and also provide a reader that parses the debug info generated
31890 by the JIT compiler. This section gives a brief overview on writing
31891 such a parser. More specific details can be found in the source file
31892 @file{gdb/jit-reader.in}, which is also installed as a header at
31893 @file{@var{includedir}/gdb/jit-reader.h} for easy inclusion.
31894
31895 The reader is implemented as a shared object (so this functionality is
31896 not available on platforms which don't allow loading shared objects at
31897 runtime). Two @value{GDBN} commands, @code{jit-reader-load} and
31898 @code{jit-reader-unload} are provided, to be used to load and unload
31899 the readers from a preconfigured directory. Once loaded, the shared
31900 object is used the parse the debug information emitted by the JIT
31901 compiler.
31902
31903 @menu
31904 * Using JIT Debug Info Readers:: How to use supplied readers correctly
31905 * Writing JIT Debug Info Readers:: Creating a debug-info reader
31906 @end menu
31907
31908 @node Using JIT Debug Info Readers
31909 @subsection Using JIT Debug Info Readers
31910 @kindex jit-reader-load
31911 @kindex jit-reader-unload
31912
31913 Readers can be loaded and unloaded using the @code{jit-reader-load}
31914 and @code{jit-reader-unload} commands.
31915
31916 @table @code
31917 @item jit-reader-load @var{reader}
31918 Load the JIT reader named @var{reader}, which is a shared
31919 object specified as either an absolute or a relative file name. In
31920 the latter case, @value{GDBN} will try to load the reader from a
31921 pre-configured directory, usually @file{@var{libdir}/gdb/} on a UNIX
31922 system (here @var{libdir} is the system library directory, often
31923 @file{/usr/local/lib}).
31924
31925 Only one reader can be active at a time; trying to load a second
31926 reader when one is already loaded will result in @value{GDBN}
31927 reporting an error. A new JIT reader can be loaded by first unloading
31928 the current one using @code{jit-reader-unload} and then invoking
31929 @code{jit-reader-load}.
31930
31931 @item jit-reader-unload
31932 Unload the currently loaded JIT reader.
31933
31934 @end table
31935
31936 @node Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
31937 @subsection Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
31938 @cindex writing JIT debug info readers
31939
31940 As mentioned, a reader is essentially a shared object conforming to a
31941 certain ABI. This ABI is described in @file{jit-reader.h}.
31942
31943 @file{jit-reader.h} defines the structures, macros and functions
31944 required to write a reader. It is installed (along with
31945 @value{GDBN}), in @file{@var{includedir}/gdb} where @var{includedir} is
31946 the system include directory.
31947
31948 Readers need to be released under a GPL compatible license. A reader
31949 can be declared as released under such a license by placing the macro
31950 @code{GDB_DECLARE_GPL_COMPATIBLE_READER} in a source file.
31951
31952 The entry point for readers is the symbol @code{gdb_init_reader},
31953 which is expected to be a function with the prototype
31954
31955 @findex gdb_init_reader
31956 @smallexample
31957 extern struct gdb_reader_funcs *gdb_init_reader (void);
31958 @end smallexample
31959
31960 @cindex @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs}
31961
31962 @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs} contains a set of pointers to callback
31963 functions. These functions are executed to read the debug info
31964 generated by the JIT compiler (@code{read}), to unwind stack frames
31965 (@code{unwind}) and to create canonical frame IDs
31966 (@code{get_Frame_id}). It also has a callback that is called when the
31967 reader is being unloaded (@code{destroy}). The struct looks like this
31968
31969 @smallexample
31970 struct gdb_reader_funcs
31971 @{
31972 /* Must be set to GDB_READER_INTERFACE_VERSION. */
31973 int reader_version;
31974
31975 /* For use by the reader. */
31976 void *priv_data;
31977
31978 gdb_read_debug_info *read;
31979 gdb_unwind_frame *unwind;
31980 gdb_get_frame_id *get_frame_id;
31981 gdb_destroy_reader *destroy;
31982 @};
31983 @end smallexample
31984
31985 @cindex @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks}
31986 @cindex @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}
31987
31988 The callbacks are provided with another set of callbacks by
31989 @value{GDBN} to do their job. For @code{read}, these callbacks are
31990 passed in a @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} and for @code{unwind}
31991 and @code{get_frame_id}, in a @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}.
31992 @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} has callbacks to create new object
31993 files and new symbol tables inside those object files. @code{struct
31994 gdb_unwind_callbacks} has callbacks to read registers off the current
31995 frame and to write out the values of the registers in the previous
31996 frame. Both have a callback (@code{target_read}) to read bytes off the
31997 target's address space.
31998
31999 @node In-Process Agent
32000 @chapter In-Process Agent
32001 @cindex debugging agent
32002 The traditional debugging model is conceptually low-speed, but works fine,
32003 because most bugs can be reproduced in debugging-mode execution. However,
32004 as multi-core or many-core processors are becoming mainstream, and
32005 multi-threaded programs become more and more popular, there should be more
32006 and more bugs that only manifest themselves at normal-mode execution, for
32007 example, thread races, because debugger's interference with the program's
32008 timing may conceal the bugs. On the other hand, in some applications,
32009 it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt the program's execution
32010 long enough for the developer to learn anything helpful about its behavior.
32011 If the program's correctness depends on its real-time behavior, delays
32012 introduced by a debugger might cause the program to fail, even when the
32013 code itself is correct. It is useful to be able to observe the program's
32014 behavior without interrupting it.
32015
32016 Therefore, traditional debugging model is too intrusive to reproduce
32017 some bugs. In order to reduce the interference with the program, we can
32018 reduce the number of operations performed by debugger. The
32019 @dfn{In-Process Agent}, a shared library, is running within the same
32020 process with inferior, and is able to perform some debugging operations
32021 itself. As a result, debugger is only involved when necessary, and
32022 performance of debugging can be improved accordingly. Note that
32023 interference with program can be reduced but can't be removed completely,
32024 because the in-process agent will still stop or slow down the program.
32025
32026 The in-process agent can interpret and execute Agent Expressions
32027 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) during performing debugging operations. The
32028 agent expressions can be used for different purposes, such as collecting
32029 data in tracepoints, and condition evaluation in breakpoints.
32030
32031 @anchor{Control Agent}
32032 You can control whether the in-process agent is used as an aid for
32033 debugging with the following commands:
32034
32035 @table @code
32036 @kindex set agent on
32037 @item set agent on
32038 Causes the in-process agent to perform some operations on behalf of the
32039 debugger. Just which operations requested by the user will be done
32040 by the in-process agent depends on the its capabilities. For example,
32041 if you request to evaluate breakpoint conditions in the in-process agent,
32042 and the in-process agent has such capability as well, then breakpoint
32043 conditions will be evaluated in the in-process agent.
32044
32045 @kindex set agent off
32046 @item set agent off
32047 Disables execution of debugging operations by the in-process agent. All
32048 of the operations will be performed by @value{GDBN}.
32049
32050 @kindex show agent
32051 @item show agent
32052 Display the current setting of execution of debugging operations by
32053 the in-process agent.
32054 @end table
32055
32056 @menu
32057 * In-Process Agent Protocol::
32058 @end menu
32059
32060 @node In-Process Agent Protocol
32061 @section In-Process Agent Protocol
32062 @cindex in-process agent protocol
32063
32064 The in-process agent is able to communicate with both @value{GDBN} and
32065 GDBserver (@pxref{In-Process Agent}). This section documents the protocol
32066 used for communications between @value{GDBN} or GDBserver and the IPA.
32067 In general, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver sends commands
32068 (@pxref{IPA Protocol Commands}) and data to in-process agent, and then
32069 in-process agent replies back with the return result of the command, or
32070 some other information. The data sent to in-process agent is composed
32071 of primitive data types, such as 4-byte or 8-byte type, and composite
32072 types, which are called objects (@pxref{IPA Protocol Objects}).
32073
32074 @menu
32075 * IPA Protocol Objects::
32076 * IPA Protocol Commands::
32077 @end menu
32078
32079 @node IPA Protocol Objects
32080 @subsection IPA Protocol Objects
32081 @cindex ipa protocol objects
32082
32083 The commands sent to and results received from agent may contain some
32084 complex data types called @dfn{objects}.
32085
32086 The in-process agent is running on the same machine with @value{GDBN}
32087 or GDBserver, so it doesn't have to handle as much differences between
32088 two ends as remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}) tries to handle.
32089 However, there are still some differences of two ends in two processes:
32090
32091 @enumerate
32092 @item
32093 word size. On some 64-bit machines, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver can be
32094 compiled as a 64-bit executable, while in-process agent is a 32-bit one.
32095 @item
32096 ABI. Some machines may have multiple types of ABI, @value{GDBN} or
32097 GDBserver is compiled with one, and in-process agent is compiled with
32098 the other one.
32099 @end enumerate
32100
32101 Here are the IPA Protocol Objects:
32102
32103 @enumerate
32104 @item
32105 agent expression object. It represents an agent expression
32106 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
32107 @anchor{agent expression object}
32108 @item
32109 tracepoint action object. It represents a tracepoint action
32110 (@pxref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}) to collect registers,
32111 memory, static trace data and to evaluate expression.
32112 @anchor{tracepoint action object}
32113 @item
32114 tracepoint object. It represents a tracepoint (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
32115 @anchor{tracepoint object}
32116
32117 @end enumerate
32118
32119 The following table describes important attributes of each IPA protocol
32120 object:
32121
32122 @multitable @columnfractions .30 .20 .50
32123 @headitem Name @tab Size @tab Description
32124 @item @emph{agent expression object} @tab @tab
32125 @item length @tab 4 @tab length of bytes code
32126 @item byte code @tab @var{length} @tab contents of byte code
32127 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting memory} @tab @tab
32128 @item 'M' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
32129 @item addr @tab 8 @tab if @var{basereg} is @samp{-1}, @var{addr} is the
32130 address of the lowest byte to collect, otherwise @var{addr} is the offset
32131 of @var{basereg} for memory collecting.
32132 @item len @tab 8 @tab length of memory for collecting
32133 @item basereg @tab 4 @tab the register number containing the starting
32134 memory address for collecting.
32135 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting registers} @tab @tab
32136 @item 'R' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
32137 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting static trace data} @tab @tab
32138 @item 'L' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
32139 @item @emph{tracepoint action for expression evaluation} @tab @tab
32140 @item 'X' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
32141 @item agent expression @tab length of @tab @ref{agent expression object}
32142 @item @emph{tracepoint object} @tab @tab
32143 @item number @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint
32144 @item address @tab 8 @tab address of tracepoint inserted on
32145 @item type @tab 4 @tab type of tracepoint
32146 @item enabled @tab 1 @tab enable or disable of tracepoint
32147 @item step_count @tab 8 @tab step
32148 @item pass_count @tab 8 @tab pass
32149 @item numactions @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint actions
32150 @item hit count @tab 8 @tab hit count
32151 @item trace frame usage @tab 8 @tab trace frame usage
32152 @item compiled_cond @tab 8 @tab compiled condition
32153 @item orig_size @tab 8 @tab orig size
32154 @item condition @tab 4 if condition is NULL otherwise length of
32155 @ref{agent expression object}
32156 @tab zero if condition is NULL, otherwise is
32157 @ref{agent expression object}
32158 @item actions @tab variable
32159 @tab numactions number of @ref{tracepoint action object}
32160 @end multitable
32161
32162 @node IPA Protocol Commands
32163 @subsection IPA Protocol Commands
32164 @cindex ipa protocol commands
32165
32166 The spaces in each command are delimiters to ease reading this commands
32167 specification. They don't exist in real commands.
32168
32169 @table @samp
32170
32171 @item FastTrace:@var{tracepoint_object} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}
32172 Installs a new fast tracepoint described by @var{tracepoint_object}
32173 (@pxref{tracepoint object}). The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}, 8-byte long, is the
32174 head of @dfn{jumppad}, which is used to jump to data collection routine
32175 in IPA finally.
32176
32177 Replies:
32178 @table @samp
32179 @item OK @var{target_address} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} @var{fjump_size} @var{fjump}
32180 @var{target_address} is address of tracepoint in the inferior.
32181 The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} is updated head of jumppad. Both of
32182 @var{target_address} and @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} are 8-byte long.
32183 The @var{fjump} contains a sequence of instructions jump to jumppad entry.
32184 The @var{fjump_size}, 4-byte long, is the size of @var{fjump}.
32185 @item E @var{NN}
32186 for an error
32187
32188 @end table
32189
32190 @item close
32191 Closes the in-process agent. This command is sent when @value{GDBN} or GDBserver
32192 is about to kill inferiors.
32193
32194 @item qTfSTM
32195 @xref{qTfSTM}.
32196 @item qTsSTM
32197 @xref{qTsSTM}.
32198 @item qTSTMat
32199 @xref{qTSTMat}.
32200 @item probe_marker_at:@var{address}
32201 Asks in-process agent to probe the marker at @var{address}.
32202
32203 Replies:
32204 @table @samp
32205 @item E @var{NN}
32206 for an error
32207 @end table
32208 @item unprobe_marker_at:@var{address}
32209 Asks in-process agent to unprobe the marker at @var{address}.
32210 @end table
32211
32212 @node GDB Bugs
32213 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
32214 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
32215 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
32216
32217 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
32218
32219 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
32220 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
32221 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
32222 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
32223
32224 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
32225 information that enables us to fix the bug.
32226
32227 @menu
32228 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
32229 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
32230 @end menu
32231
32232 @node Bug Criteria
32233 @section Have You Found a Bug?
32234 @cindex bug criteria
32235
32236 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
32237
32238 @itemize @bullet
32239 @cindex fatal signal
32240 @cindex debugger crash
32241 @cindex crash of debugger
32242 @item
32243 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
32244 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
32245
32246 @cindex error on valid input
32247 @item
32248 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
32249 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
32250 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
32251
32252 @cindex invalid input
32253 @item
32254 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
32255 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
32256 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
32257 for traditional practice''.
32258
32259 @item
32260 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
32261 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
32262 @end itemize
32263
32264 @node Bug Reporting
32265 @section How to Report Bugs
32266 @cindex bug reports
32267 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
32268
32269 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
32270 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
32271 contact that organization first.
32272
32273 You can find contact information for many support companies and
32274 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
32275 distribution.
32276 @c should add a web page ref...
32277
32278 @ifset BUGURL
32279 @ifset BUGURL_DEFAULT
32280 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
32281 @value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
32282 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
32283 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
32284 be used.
32285
32286 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
32287 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
32288 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
32289 @samp{bug-gdb}.
32290
32291 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
32292 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
32293 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
32294 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
32295 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
32296 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
32297 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
32298 bug reports to the mailing list.
32299 @end ifset
32300 @ifclear BUGURL_DEFAULT
32301 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
32302 @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.
32303 @end ifclear
32304 @end ifset
32305
32306 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
32307 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
32308 fact or leave it out, state it!
32309
32310 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
32311 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
32312 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
32313 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
32314 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
32315 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
32316 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
32317 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
32318 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
32319
32320 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
32321 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
32322 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
32323 self-contained.
32324
32325 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
32326 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
32327 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
32328 bugs properly.
32329
32330 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
32331
32332 @itemize @bullet
32333 @item
32334 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
32335 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
32336 version}.
32337
32338 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
32339 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
32340
32341 @item
32342 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
32343 version number.
32344
32345 @item
32346 The details of the @value{GDBN} build-time configuration.
32347 @value{GDBN} shows these details if you invoke it with the
32348 @option{--configuration} command-line option, or if you type
32349 @code{show configuration} at @value{GDBN}'s prompt.
32350
32351 @item
32352 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
32353 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
32354
32355 @item
32356 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
32357 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
32358 C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
32359 to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
32360 those compilers.
32361
32362 @item
32363 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
32364 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
32365 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
32366 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
32367
32368 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
32369 and then we might not encounter the bug.
32370
32371 @item
32372 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
32373 reproduce the bug.
32374
32375 @item
32376 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
32377 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
32378
32379 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
32380 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
32381 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
32382 a chance to make a mistake.
32383
32384 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
32385 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
32386 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
32387 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
32388 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
32389 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
32390 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
32391 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
32392
32393 @pindex script
32394 @cindex recording a session script
32395 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
32396 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
32397 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
32398 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
32399
32400 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
32401 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
32402
32403 @item
32404 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
32405 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
32406 it by context, not by line number.
32407
32408 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
32409 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
32410
32411 @end itemize
32412
32413 Here are some things that are not necessary:
32414
32415 @itemize @bullet
32416 @item
32417 A description of the envelope of the bug.
32418
32419 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
32420 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
32421 changes will not affect it.
32422
32423 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
32424 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
32425 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
32426 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
32427
32428 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
32429 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
32430 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
32431 less time, and so on.
32432
32433 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
32434 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
32435
32436 @item
32437 A patch for the bug.
32438
32439 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
32440 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
32441 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
32442 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
32443
32444 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
32445 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
32446 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
32447 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
32448
32449 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
32450 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
32451 help us to understand.
32452
32453 @item
32454 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
32455
32456 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
32457 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
32458 @end itemize
32459
32460 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
32461 @c and consists of the two following files:
32462 @c rluser.texi
32463 @c hsuser.texi
32464 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
32465 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
32466 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
32467 @include rluser.texi
32468 @include hsuser.texi
32469 @end ifclear
32470
32471 @node In Memoriam
32472 @appendix In Memoriam
32473
32474 The @value{GDBN} project mourns the loss of the following long-time
32475 contributors:
32476
32477 @table @code
32478 @item Fred Fish
32479 Fred was a long-standing contributor to @value{GDBN} (1991-2006), and
32480 to Free Software in general. Outside of @value{GDBN}, he was known in
32481 the Amiga world for his series of Fish Disks, and the GeekGadget project.
32482
32483 @item Michael Snyder
32484 Michael was one of the Global Maintainers of the @value{GDBN} project,
32485 with contributions recorded as early as 1996, until 2011. In addition
32486 to his day to day participation, he was a large driving force behind
32487 adding Reverse Debugging to @value{GDBN}.
32488 @end table
32489
32490 Beyond their technical contributions to the project, they were also
32491 enjoyable members of the Free Software Community. We will miss them.
32492
32493 @node Formatting Documentation
32494 @appendix Formatting Documentation
32495
32496 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
32497 @cindex reference card
32498 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
32499 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
32500 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
32501 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
32502 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
32503 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
32504
32505 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
32506 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
32507
32508 @smallexample
32509 make refcard.dvi
32510 @end smallexample
32511
32512 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
32513 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
32514 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
32515 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
32516 your @sc{dvi} output program.
32517
32518 @cindex documentation
32519
32520 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
32521 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
32522 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
32523 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
32524 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
32525 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
32526
32527 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
32528 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
32529 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
32530 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
32531 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
32532 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
32533 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
32534 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
32535
32536 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
32537 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
32538 @code{makeinfo}.
32539
32540 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
32541 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
32542 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
32543
32544 @smallexample
32545 cd gdb
32546 make gdb.info
32547 @end smallexample
32548
32549 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
32550 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
32551 Texinfo definitions file.
32552
32553 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
32554 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
32555 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
32556 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
32557 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
32558 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
32559 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
32560
32561 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
32562 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
32563 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
32564 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
32565 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
32566 directory.
32567
32568 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
32569 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
32570 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
32571 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
32572
32573 @smallexample
32574 make gdb.dvi
32575 @end smallexample
32576
32577 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
32578
32579 @node Installing GDB
32580 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
32581 @cindex installation
32582
32583 @menu
32584 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
32585 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
32586 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
32587 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
32588 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
32589 * System-wide configuration:: Having a system-wide init file
32590 @end menu
32591
32592 @node Requirements
32593 @section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
32594 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
32595
32596 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
32597 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
32598
32599 @heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
32600 @table @asis
32601 @item ISO C90 compiler
32602 @value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90. It should be buildable with any
32603 working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
32604
32605 @end table
32606
32607 @heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
32608 @table @asis
32609 @item Expat
32610 @anchor{Expat}
32611 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
32612 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
32613 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
32614 The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
32615 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
32616 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
32617
32618 Expat is used for:
32619
32620 @itemize @bullet
32621 @item
32622 Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
32623 @item
32624 Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
32625 @item
32626 Remote shared library lists (@xref{Library List Format},
32627 or alternatively @pxref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets})
32628 @item
32629 MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
32630 @item
32631 Traceframe info (@pxref{Traceframe Info Format})
32632 @item
32633 Branch trace (@pxref{Branch Trace Format})
32634 @end itemize
32635
32636 @item zlib
32637 @cindex compressed debug sections
32638 @value{GDBN} will use the @samp{zlib} library, if available, to read
32639 compressed debug sections. Some linkers, such as GNU gold, are capable
32640 of producing binaries with compressed debug sections. If @value{GDBN}
32641 is compiled with @samp{zlib}, it will be able to read the debug
32642 information in such binaries.
32643
32644 The @samp{zlib} library is likely included with your operating system
32645 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
32646 @url{http://zlib.net}.
32647
32648 @item iconv
32649 @value{GDBN}'s features related to character sets (@pxref{Character
32650 Sets}) require a functioning @code{iconv} implementation. If you are
32651 on a GNU system, then this is provided by the GNU C Library. Some
32652 other systems also provide a working @code{iconv}.
32653
32654 If @value{GDBN} is using the @code{iconv} program which is installed
32655 in a non-standard place, you will need to tell @value{GDBN} where to find it.
32656 This is done with @option{--with-iconv-bin} which specifies the
32657 directory that contains the @code{iconv} program.
32658
32659 On systems without @code{iconv}, you can install GNU Libiconv. If you
32660 have previously installed Libiconv, you can use the
32661 @option{--with-libiconv-prefix} option to configure.
32662
32663 @value{GDBN}'s top-level @file{configure} and @file{Makefile} will
32664 arrange to build Libiconv if a directory named @file{libiconv} appears
32665 in the top-most source directory. If Libiconv is built this way, and
32666 if the operating system does not provide a suitable @code{iconv}
32667 implementation, then the just-built library will automatically be used
32668 by @value{GDBN}. One easy way to set this up is to download GNU
32669 Libiconv, unpack it, and then rename the directory holding the
32670 Libiconv source code to @samp{libiconv}.
32671 @end table
32672
32673 @node Running Configure
32674 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
32675 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
32676 @value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
32677 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
32678 build the @code{gdb} program.
32679 @iftex
32680 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
32681 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
32682 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
32683 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
32684 @end iftex
32685
32686 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
32687 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
32688 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
32689
32690 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
32691 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
32692
32693 @table @code
32694 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
32695 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
32696
32697 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
32698 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
32699
32700 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
32701 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
32702
32703 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
32704 @sc{gnu} include files
32705
32706 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
32707 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
32708
32709 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
32710 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
32711
32712 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
32713 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
32714
32715 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
32716 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
32717
32718 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
32719 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
32720 @end table
32721
32722 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
32723 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
32724 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
32725
32726 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
32727 if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
32728 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
32729 argument.
32730
32731 For example:
32732
32733 @smallexample
32734 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
32735 ./configure @var{host}
32736 make
32737 @end smallexample
32738
32739 @noindent
32740 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
32741 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
32742 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @file{configure} tries to guess the
32743 correct value by examining your system.)
32744
32745 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
32746 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
32747 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
32748 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
32749
32750 @need 750
32751 @file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
32752 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
32753 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
32754
32755 @smallexample
32756 sh configure @var{host}
32757 @end smallexample
32758
32759 If you run @file{configure} from a directory that contains source
32760 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
32761 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN},
32762 @file{configure}
32763 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
32764 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
32765
32766 You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
32767 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
32768 @file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
32769 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
32770 if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
32771 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
32772 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
32773 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
32774 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
32775
32776 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
32777 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
32778 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
32779 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
32780 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
32781
32782 @node Separate Objdir
32783 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
32784
32785 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
32786 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
32787 host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
32788 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
32789 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
32790 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
32791 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
32792 program specified there.
32793
32794 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
32795 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
32796 (You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
32797 itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
32798 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
32799 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
32800
32801 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
32802 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
32803
32804 @smallexample
32805 @group
32806 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
32807 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
32808 cd ../gdb-sun4
32809 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
32810 make
32811 @end group
32812 @end smallexample
32813
32814 When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
32815 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
32816 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
32817 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
32818 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
32819 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
32820
32821 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
32822 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
32823 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
32824 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
32825 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
32826
32827 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
32828 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
32829 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
32830 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
32831 You specify a cross-debugging target by
32832 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
32833
32834 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
32835 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
32836 called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
32837
32838 The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
32839 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
32840 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
32841 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
32842 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
32843
32844 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
32845 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
32846 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
32847 with each other.
32848
32849 @node Config Names
32850 @section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
32851
32852 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
32853 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
32854 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
32855 of information in the following pattern:
32856
32857 @smallexample
32858 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
32859 @end smallexample
32860
32861 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
32862 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
32863 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
32864
32865 The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
32866 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
32867 aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
32868 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
32869 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
32870 abbreviations---for example:
32871
32872 @smallexample
32873 % sh config.sub i386-linux
32874 i386-pc-linux-gnu
32875 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
32876 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
32877 % sh config.sub hp9k700
32878 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
32879 % sh config.sub sun4
32880 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
32881 % sh config.sub sun3
32882 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
32883 % sh config.sub i986v
32884 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
32885 @end smallexample
32886
32887 @noindent
32888 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
32889 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
32890
32891 @node Configure Options
32892 @section @file{configure} Options
32893
32894 Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
32895 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure} also has
32896 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
32897 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @file{configure}.
32898
32899 @smallexample
32900 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
32901 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
32902 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
32903 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
32904 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
32905 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
32906 @var{host}
32907 @end smallexample
32908
32909 @noindent
32910 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
32911 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
32912 @samp{--}.
32913
32914 @table @code
32915 @item --help
32916 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
32917
32918 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
32919 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
32920 @file{@var{dir}}.
32921
32922 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
32923 Configure the source to install programs under directory
32924 @file{@var{dir}}.
32925
32926 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
32927 @need 2000
32928 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
32929 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
32930 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
32931 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
32932 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
32933 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
32934 directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
32935 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
32936 directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
32937 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
32938 @var{dirname}.
32939
32940 @item --norecursion
32941 Configure only the directory level where @file{configure} is executed; do not
32942 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
32943
32944 @item --target=@var{target}
32945 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
32946 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
32947 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
32948
32949 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
32950
32951 @item @var{host} @dots{}
32952 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
32953
32954 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
32955 @end table
32956
32957 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
32958 needed for special purposes only.
32959
32960 @node System-wide configuration
32961 @section System-wide configuration and settings
32962 @cindex system-wide init file
32963
32964 @value{GDBN} can be configured to have a system-wide init file;
32965 this file will be read and executed at startup (@pxref{Startup, , What
32966 @value{GDBN} does during startup}).
32967
32968 Here is the corresponding configure option:
32969
32970 @table @code
32971 @item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file}
32972 Specify that the default location of the system-wide init file is
32973 @var{file}.
32974 @end table
32975
32976 If @value{GDBN} has been configured with the option @option{--prefix=$prefix},
32977 it may be subject to relocation. Two possible cases:
32978
32979 @itemize @bullet
32980 @item
32981 If the default location of this init file contains @file{$prefix},
32982 it will be subject to relocation. Suppose that the configure options
32983 are @option{--prefix=$prefix --with-system-gdbinit=$prefix/etc/gdbinit};
32984 if @value{GDBN} is moved from @file{$prefix} to @file{$install}, the system
32985 init file is looked for as @file{$install/etc/gdbinit} instead of
32986 @file{$prefix/etc/gdbinit}.
32987
32988 @item
32989 By contrast, if the default location does not contain the prefix,
32990 it will not be relocated. E.g.@: if @value{GDBN} has been configured with
32991 @option{--prefix=/usr/local --with-system-gdbinit=/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
32992 then @value{GDBN} will always look for @file{/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
32993 wherever @value{GDBN} is installed.
32994 @end itemize
32995
32996 If the configured location of the system-wide init file (as given by the
32997 @option{--with-system-gdbinit} option at configure time) is in the
32998 data-directory (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure
32999 time) or in one of its subdirectories, then @value{GDBN} will look for the
33000 system-wide init file in the directory specified by the
33001 @option{--data-directory} command-line option.
33002 Note that the system-wide init file is only read once, during @value{GDBN}
33003 initialization. If the data-directory is changed after @value{GDBN} has
33004 started with the @code{set data-directory} command, the file will not be
33005 reread.
33006
33007 @menu
33008 * System-wide Configuration Scripts:: Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
33009 @end menu
33010
33011 @node System-wide Configuration Scripts
33012 @subsection Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
33013 @cindex system-wide configuration scripts
33014
33015 The @file{system-gdbinit} directory, located inside the data-directory
33016 (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure time) contains
33017 a number of scripts which can be used as system-wide init files. To
33018 automatically source those scripts at startup, @value{GDBN} should be
33019 configured with @option{--with-system-gdbinit}. Otherwise, any user
33020 should be able to source them by hand as needed.
33021
33022 The following scripts are currently available:
33023 @itemize @bullet
33024
33025 @item @file{elinos.py}
33026 @pindex elinos.py
33027 @cindex ELinOS system-wide configuration script
33028 This script is useful when debugging a program on an ELinOS target.
33029 It takes advantage of the environment variables defined in a standard
33030 ELinOS environment in order to determine the location of the system
33031 shared libraries, and then sets the @samp{solib-absolute-prefix}
33032 and @samp{solib-search-path} variables appropriately.
33033
33034 @item @file{wrs-linux.py}
33035 @pindex wrs-linux.py
33036 @cindex Wind River Linux system-wide configuration script
33037 This script is useful when debugging a program on a target running
33038 Wind River Linux. It expects the @env{ENV_PREFIX} to be set to
33039 the host-side sysroot used by the target system.
33040
33041 @end itemize
33042
33043 @node Maintenance Commands
33044 @appendix Maintenance Commands
33045 @cindex maintenance commands
33046 @cindex internal commands
33047
33048 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
33049 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
33050 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
33051 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
33052 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
33053
33054 @table @code
33055 @kindex maint agent
33056 @kindex maint agent-eval
33057 @item maint agent @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
33058 @itemx maint agent-eval @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
33059 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
33060 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
33061 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}). The @samp{agent} version produces an
33062 expression useful for data collection, such as by tracepoints, while
33063 @samp{maint agent-eval} produces an expression that evaluates directly
33064 to a result. For instance, a collection expression for @code{globa +
33065 globb} will include bytecodes to record four bytes of memory at each
33066 of the addresses of @code{globa} and @code{globb}, while discarding
33067 the result of the addition, while an evaluation expression will do the
33068 addition and return the sum.
33069 If @code{-at} is given, generate remote agent bytecode for @var{location}.
33070 If not, generate remote agent bytecode for current frame PC address.
33071
33072 @kindex maint agent-printf
33073 @item maint agent-printf @var{format},@var{expr},...
33074 Translate the given format string and list of argument expressions
33075 into remote agent bytecodes and display them as a disassembled list.
33076 This command is useful for debugging the agent version of dynamic
33077 printf (@pxref{Dynamic Printf}).
33078
33079 @kindex maint info breakpoints
33080 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
33081 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
33082 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
33083 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
33084 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
33085 is shown:
33086
33087 @table @code
33088 @item breakpoint
33089 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
33090
33091 @item watchpoint
33092 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
33093
33094 @item longjmp
33095 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
33096 @code{longjmp} calls.
33097
33098 @item longjmp resume
33099 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
33100
33101 @item until
33102 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
33103
33104 @item finish
33105 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
33106
33107 @item shlib events
33108 Shared library events.
33109
33110 @end table
33111
33112 @kindex maint info bfds
33113 @item maint info bfds
33114 This prints information about each @code{bfd} object that is known to
33115 @value{GDBN}. @xref{Top, , BFD, bfd, The Binary File Descriptor Library}.
33116
33117 @kindex set displaced-stepping
33118 @kindex show displaced-stepping
33119 @cindex displaced stepping support
33120 @cindex out-of-line single-stepping
33121 @item set displaced-stepping
33122 @itemx show displaced-stepping
33123 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will do @dfn{displaced stepping}
33124 if the target supports it. Displaced stepping is a way to single-step
33125 over breakpoints without removing them from the inferior, by executing
33126 an out-of-line copy of the instruction that was originally at the
33127 breakpoint location. It is also known as out-of-line single-stepping.
33128
33129 @table @code
33130 @item set displaced-stepping on
33131 If the target architecture supports it, @value{GDBN} will use
33132 displaced stepping to step over breakpoints.
33133
33134 @item set displaced-stepping off
33135 @value{GDBN} will not use displaced stepping to step over breakpoints,
33136 even if such is supported by the target architecture.
33137
33138 @cindex non-stop mode, and @samp{set displaced-stepping}
33139 @item set displaced-stepping auto
33140 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} will use displaced stepping
33141 only if non-stop mode is active (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) and the target
33142 architecture supports displaced stepping.
33143 @end table
33144
33145 @kindex maint check-psymtabs
33146 @item maint check-psymtabs
33147 Check the consistency of currently expanded psymtabs versus symtabs.
33148 Use this to check, for example, whether a symbol is in one but not the other.
33149
33150 @kindex maint check-symtabs
33151 @item maint check-symtabs
33152 Check the consistency of currently expanded symtabs.
33153
33154 @kindex maint expand-symtabs
33155 @item maint expand-symtabs [@var{regexp}]
33156 Expand symbol tables.
33157 If @var{regexp} is specified, only expand symbol tables for file
33158 names matching @var{regexp}.
33159
33160 @kindex maint set catch-demangler-crashes
33161 @kindex maint show catch-demangler-crashes
33162 @cindex demangler crashes
33163 @item maint set catch-demangler-crashes [on|off]
33164 @itemx maint show catch-demangler-crashes
33165 Control whether @value{GDBN} should attempt to catch crashes in the
33166 symbol name demangler. The default is to attempt to catch crashes.
33167 If enabled, the first time a crash is caught, a core file is created,
33168 the offending symbol is displayed and the user is presented with the
33169 option to terminate the current session.
33170
33171 @kindex maint cplus first_component
33172 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
33173 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
33174
33175 @kindex maint cplus namespace
33176 @item maint cplus namespace
33177 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
33178
33179 @kindex maint demangle
33180 @item maint demangle @var{name}
33181 Demangle a C@t{++} or Objective-C mangled @var{name}.
33182
33183 @kindex maint deprecate
33184 @kindex maint undeprecate
33185 @cindex deprecated commands
33186 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
33187 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
33188 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
33189 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
33190 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
33191 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
33192 the replacement as part of the warning.
33193
33194 @kindex maint dump-me
33195 @item maint dump-me
33196 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
33197 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
33198 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
33199 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
33200
33201 @kindex maint internal-error
33202 @kindex maint internal-warning
33203 @kindex maint demangler-warning
33204 @cindex demangler crashes
33205 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
33206 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
33207 @itemx maint demangler-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
33208
33209 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error},
33210 @code{internal_warning} or @code{demangler_warning} and hence behave
33211 as though an internal problam has been detected. In addition to
33212 reporting the internal problem, these functions give the user the
33213 opportunity to either quit @value{GDBN} or (for @code{internal_error}
33214 and @code{internal_warning}) create a core file of the current
33215 @value{GDBN} session.
33216
33217 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
33218 used as the text of the error or warning message.
33219
33220 Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
33221
33222 @smallexample
33223 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
33224 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
33225 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
33226 debugging may prove unreliable.
33227 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
33228 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
33229 (@value{GDBP})
33230 @end smallexample
33231
33232 @cindex @value{GDBN} internal error
33233 @cindex internal errors, control of @value{GDBN} behavior
33234 @cindex demangler crashes
33235
33236 @kindex maint set internal-error
33237 @kindex maint show internal-error
33238 @kindex maint set internal-warning
33239 @kindex maint show internal-warning
33240 @kindex maint set demangler-warning
33241 @kindex maint show demangler-warning
33242 @item maint set internal-error @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
33243 @itemx maint show internal-error @var{action}
33244 @itemx maint set internal-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
33245 @itemx maint show internal-warning @var{action}
33246 @itemx maint set demangler-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
33247 @itemx maint show demangler-warning @var{action}
33248 When @value{GDBN} reports an internal problem (error or warning) it
33249 gives the user the opportunity to both quit @value{GDBN} and create a
33250 core file of the current @value{GDBN} session. These commands let you
33251 override the default behaviour for each particular @var{action},
33252 described in the table below.
33253
33254 @table @samp
33255 @item quit
33256 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
33257 quit. The default is to ask the user what to do.
33258
33259 @item corefile
33260 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
33261 create a core file. The default is to ask the user what to do. Note
33262 that there is no @code{corefile} option for @code{demangler-warning}:
33263 demangler warnings always create a core file and this cannot be
33264 disabled.
33265 @end table
33266
33267 @kindex maint packet
33268 @item maint packet @var{text}
33269 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
33270 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
33271 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
33272 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
33273 checksum.
33274
33275 @kindex maint print architecture
33276 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
33277 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
33278 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
33279
33280 @kindex maint print c-tdesc
33281 @item maint print c-tdesc
33282 Print the current target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
33283 a C source file. The created source file can be used in @value{GDBN}
33284 when an XML parser is not available to parse the description.
33285
33286 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
33287 @item maint print dummy-frames
33288 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
33289
33290 @smallexample
33291 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
33292 @dots{}
33293 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
33294 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
33295 58 return (a + b);
33296 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
33297 @dots{}
33298 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
33299 0xa8206d8: id=@{stack=0xbfffe734,code=0xbfffe73f,!special@}, ptid=process 9353
33300 (@value{GDBP})
33301 @end smallexample
33302
33303 Takes an optional file parameter.
33304
33305 @kindex maint print registers
33306 @kindex maint print raw-registers
33307 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
33308 @kindex maint print register-groups
33309 @kindex maint print remote-registers
33310 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
33311 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
33312 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
33313 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
33314 @itemx maint print remote-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
33315 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
33316
33317 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
33318 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print
33319 cooked-registers} includes the (cooked) value of all registers,
33320 including registers which aren't available on the target nor visible
33321 to user; the command @code{maint print register-groups} includes the
33322 groups that each register is a member of; and the command @code{maint
33323 print remote-registers} includes the remote target's register numbers
33324 and offsets in the `G' packets.
33325
33326 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
33327 write the information.
33328
33329 @kindex maint print reggroups
33330 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
33331 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
33332 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
33333 information.
33334
33335 The register groups info looks like this:
33336
33337 @smallexample
33338 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
33339 Group Type
33340 general user
33341 float user
33342 all user
33343 vector user
33344 system user
33345 save internal
33346 restore internal
33347 @end smallexample
33348
33349 @kindex flushregs
33350 @item flushregs
33351 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
33352
33353 @kindex maint print objfiles
33354 @cindex info for known object files
33355 @item maint print objfiles @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
33356 Print a dump of all known object files.
33357 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print object files whose names
33358 match @var{regexp}. For each object file, this command prints its name,
33359 address in memory, and all of its psymtabs and symtabs.
33360
33361 @kindex maint print section-scripts
33362 @cindex info for known .debug_gdb_scripts-loaded scripts
33363 @item maint print section-scripts [@var{regexp}]
33364 Print a dump of scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_section} section.
33365 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print scripts loaded by object files
33366 matching @var{regexp}.
33367 For each script, this command prints its name as specified in the objfile,
33368 and the full path if known.
33369 @xref{dotdebug_gdb_scripts section}.
33370
33371 @kindex maint print statistics
33372 @cindex bcache statistics
33373 @item maint print statistics
33374 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
33375 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
33376 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
33377 of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
33378 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
33379 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
33380 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
33381 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
33382 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
33383 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
33384 lengths.
33385
33386 @kindex maint print target-stack
33387 @cindex target stack description
33388 @item maint print target-stack
33389 A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
33390 kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
33391 so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
33392 In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
33393 until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
33394 address.
33395
33396 This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
33397 the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
33398
33399 @kindex maint print type
33400 @cindex type chain of a data type
33401 @item maint print type @var{expr}
33402 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
33403 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
33404 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
33405 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
33406 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
33407
33408 @kindex maint set dwarf2 always-disassemble
33409 @kindex maint show dwarf2 always-disassemble
33410 @item maint set dwarf2 always-disassemble
33411 @item maint show dwarf2 always-disassemble
33412 Control the behavior of @code{info address} when using DWARF debugging
33413 information.
33414
33415 The default is @code{off}, which means that @value{GDBN} should try to
33416 describe a variable's location in an easily readable format. When
33417 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will instead display the DWARF location
33418 expression in an assembly-like format. Note that some locations are
33419 too complex for @value{GDBN} to describe simply; in this case you will
33420 always see the disassembly form.
33421
33422 Here is an example of the resulting disassembly:
33423
33424 @smallexample
33425 (gdb) info addr argc
33426 Symbol "argc" is a complex DWARF expression:
33427 1: DW_OP_fbreg 0
33428 @end smallexample
33429
33430 For more information on these expressions, see
33431 @uref{http://www.dwarfstd.org/, the DWARF standard}.
33432
33433 @kindex maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
33434 @kindex maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
33435 @item maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
33436 @itemx maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
33437 Control the DWARF 2 compilation unit cache.
33438
33439 @cindex DWARF 2 compilation units cache
33440 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
33441 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF 2
33442 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
33443 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
33444 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
33445 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
33446 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
33447 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
33448
33449 @kindex maint set profile
33450 @kindex maint show profile
33451 @cindex profiling GDB
33452 @item maint set profile
33453 @itemx maint show profile
33454 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
33455
33456 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
33457 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
33458 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
33459 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
33460 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
33461 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
33462 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
33463
33464 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
33465 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
33466
33467 @kindex maint set show-debug-regs
33468 @kindex maint show show-debug-regs
33469 @cindex hardware debug registers
33470 @item maint set show-debug-regs
33471 @itemx maint show show-debug-regs
33472 Control whether to show variables that mirror the hardware debug
33473 registers. Use @code{on} to enable, @code{off} to disable. If
33474 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
33475 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
33476 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
33477
33478 @kindex maint set show-all-tib
33479 @kindex maint show show-all-tib
33480 @item maint set show-all-tib
33481 @itemx maint show show-all-tib
33482 Control whether to show all non zero areas within a 1k block starting
33483 at thread local base, when using the @samp{info w32 thread-information-block}
33484 command.
33485
33486 @kindex maint set target-async
33487 @kindex maint show target-async
33488 @item maint set target-async
33489 @itemx maint show target-async
33490 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets operate in synchronous or
33491 asynchronous mode (@pxref{Background Execution}). Normally the
33492 default is asynchronous, if it is available; but this can be changed
33493 to more easily debug problems occurring only in synchronous mode.
33494
33495 @kindex maint set per-command
33496 @kindex maint show per-command
33497 @item maint set per-command
33498 @itemx maint show per-command
33499 @cindex resources used by commands
33500
33501 @value{GDBN} can display the resources used by each command.
33502 This is useful in debugging performance problems.
33503
33504 @table @code
33505 @item maint set per-command space [on|off]
33506 @itemx maint show per-command space
33507 Enable or disable the printing of the memory used by GDB for each command.
33508 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
33509 took, following the command's own output.
33510 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
33511 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
33512
33513 @item maint set per-command time [on|off]
33514 @itemx maint show per-command time
33515 Enable or disable the printing of the execution time of @value{GDBN}
33516 for each command.
33517 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
33518 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
33519 Both CPU time and wallclock time are printed.
33520 Printing both is useful when trying to determine whether the cost is
33521 CPU or, e.g., disk/network latency.
33522 Note that the CPU time printed is for @value{GDBN} only, it does not include
33523 the execution time of the inferior because there's no mechanism currently
33524 to compute how much time was spent by @value{GDBN} and how much time was
33525 spent by the program been debugged.
33526 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
33527 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
33528
33529 @item maint set per-command symtab [on|off]
33530 @itemx maint show per-command symtab
33531 Enable or disable the printing of basic symbol table statistics
33532 for each command.
33533 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display the following information:
33534
33535 @enumerate a
33536 @item
33537 number of symbol tables
33538 @item
33539 number of primary symbol tables
33540 @item
33541 number of blocks in the blockvector
33542 @end enumerate
33543 @end table
33544
33545 @kindex maint space
33546 @cindex memory used by commands
33547 @item maint space @var{value}
33548 An alias for @code{maint set per-command space}.
33549 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
33550
33551 @kindex maint time
33552 @cindex time of command execution
33553 @item maint time @var{value}
33554 An alias for @code{maint set per-command time}.
33555 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
33556
33557 @kindex maint translate-address
33558 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
33559 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
33560 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
33561 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
33562 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
33563 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
33564 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
33565
33566 If section was not specified, the section in which the symbol was found
33567 is also printed. For dynamically linked executables, the name of
33568 executable or shared library containing the symbol is printed as well.
33569
33570 @end table
33571
33572 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
33573 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
33574
33575 @table @code
33576 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
33577 @kindex set watchdog
33578 @cindex watchdog timer
33579 @cindex timeout for commands
33580 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
33581 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
33582 reports and error and the command is aborted.
33583
33584 @item show watchdog
33585 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
33586 @end table
33587
33588 @node Remote Protocol
33589 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
33590
33591 @menu
33592 * Overview::
33593 * Packets::
33594 * Stop Reply Packets::
33595 * General Query Packets::
33596 * Architecture-Specific Protocol Details::
33597 * Tracepoint Packets::
33598 * Host I/O Packets::
33599 * Interrupts::
33600 * Notification Packets::
33601 * Remote Non-Stop::
33602 * Packet Acknowledgment::
33603 * Examples::
33604 * File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
33605 * Library List Format::
33606 * Library List Format for SVR4 Targets::
33607 * Memory Map Format::
33608 * Thread List Format::
33609 * Traceframe Info Format::
33610 * Branch Trace Format::
33611 @end menu
33612
33613 @node Overview
33614 @section Overview
33615
33616 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
33617 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
33618 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
33619 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
33620
33621 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
33622 transmitted and received data, respectively.
33623
33624 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
33625 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
33626 @cindex remote serial protocol
33627 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments
33628 and notifications, see @ref{Notification Packets}) are sent as a
33629 @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
33630 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
33631 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
33632
33633 @smallexample
33634 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
33635 @end smallexample
33636 @noindent
33637
33638 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
33639 @noindent
33640 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
33641 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
33642 eight bit unsigned checksum).
33643
33644 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
33645 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
33646
33647 @smallexample
33648 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
33649 @end smallexample
33650
33651 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
33652 @noindent
33653 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
33654 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
33655 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
33656
33657 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
33658 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
33659 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
33660 retransmission):
33661
33662 @smallexample
33663 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
33664 <- @code{+}
33665 @end smallexample
33666 @noindent
33667
33668 The @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments can be disabled
33669 once a connection is established.
33670 @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}, for details.
33671
33672 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
33673 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
33674 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
33675 when the operation has completed, and the target has again stopped all
33676 threads in all attached processes. This is the default all-stop mode
33677 behavior, but the remote protocol also supports @value{GDBN}'s non-stop
33678 execution mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}, for details.
33679
33680 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
33681 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
33682 exceptions).
33683
33684 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
33685 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
33686 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
33687 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
33688
33689 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
33690 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
33691 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
33692
33693 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
33694 @anchor{Binary Data}
33695 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
33696 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
33697 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
33698 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
33699 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
33700 binary data.
33701
33702 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
33703 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
33704 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
33705 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
33706 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
33707 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
33708 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
33709 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
33710 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
33711 (described next).
33712
33713 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.
33714 Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one
33715 instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a
33716 repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid
33717 binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as
33718 @code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this
33719 produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii}
33720 code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length
33721 encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example,
33722 @samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character
33723 after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 =
33724 3}} more times.
33725
33726 The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value
33727 greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or
33728 seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only
33729 five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as
33730 @samp{0*"00}.
33731
33732 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
33733 error number. That number is not well defined.
33734
33735 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
33736 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
33737 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
33738 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
33739 on that response.
33740
33741 At a minimum, a stub is required to support the @samp{g} and @samp{G}
33742 commands for register access, and the @samp{m} and @samp{M} commands
33743 for memory access. Stubs that only control single-threaded targets
33744 can implement run control with the @samp{c} (continue), and @samp{s}
33745 (step) commands. Stubs that support multi-threading targets should
33746 support the @samp{vCont} command. All other commands are optional.
33747
33748 @node Packets
33749 @section Packets
33750
33751 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
33752 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
33753 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
33754 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
33755
33756 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
33757 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
33758 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
33759 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
33760 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
33761 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
33762 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
33763 @var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
33764 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
33765 @var{baz}.
33766
33767 @cindex @var{thread-id}, in remote protocol
33768 @anchor{thread-id syntax}
33769 Several packets and replies include a @var{thread-id} field to identify
33770 a thread. Normally these are positive numbers with a target-specific
33771 interpretation, formatted as big-endian hex strings. A @var{thread-id}
33772 can also be a literal @samp{-1} to indicate all threads, or @samp{0} to
33773 pick any thread.
33774
33775 In addition, the remote protocol supports a multiprocess feature in
33776 which the @var{thread-id} syntax is extended to optionally include both
33777 process and thread ID fields, as @samp{p@var{pid}.@var{tid}}.
33778 The @var{pid} (process) and @var{tid} (thread) components each have the
33779 format described above: a positive number with target-specific
33780 interpretation formatted as a big-endian hex string, literal @samp{-1}
33781 to indicate all processes or threads (respectively), or @samp{0} to
33782 indicate an arbitrary process or thread. Specifying just a process, as
33783 @samp{p@var{pid}}, is equivalent to @samp{p@var{pid}.-1}. It is an
33784 error to specify all processes but a specific thread, such as
33785 @samp{p-1.@var{tid}}. Note that the @samp{p} prefix is @emph{not} used
33786 for those packets and replies explicitly documented to include a process
33787 ID, rather than a @var{thread-id}.
33788
33789 The multiprocess @var{thread-id} syntax extensions are only used if both
33790 @value{GDBN} and the stub report support for the @samp{multiprocess}
33791 feature using @samp{qSupported}. @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for
33792 more information.
33793
33794 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
33795 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
33796
33797 Here are the packet descriptions.
33798
33799 @table @samp
33800
33801 @item !
33802 @cindex @samp{!} packet
33803 @anchor{extended mode}
33804 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
33805 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
33806 debugged.
33807
33808 Reply:
33809 @table @samp
33810 @item OK
33811 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
33812 @end table
33813
33814 @item ?
33815 @cindex @samp{?} packet
33816 @anchor{? packet}
33817 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
33818 step and continue. This packet has a special interpretation when the
33819 target is in non-stop mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}.
33820
33821 Reply:
33822 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
33823
33824 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
33825 @cindex @samp{A} packet
33826 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
33827 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
33828 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
33829
33830 Reply:
33831 @table @samp
33832 @item OK
33833 The arguments were set.
33834 @item E @var{NN}
33835 An error occurred.
33836 @end table
33837
33838 @item b @var{baud}
33839 @cindex @samp{b} packet
33840 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
33841 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
33842
33843 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
33844 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
33845 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
33846
33847 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
33848 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
33849 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
33850 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
33851 of view, nothing actually happened.}
33852
33853 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
33854 @cindex @samp{B} packet
33855 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
33856 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
33857
33858 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
33859 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
33860
33861 @cindex @samp{bc} packet
33862 @anchor{bc}
33863 @item bc
33864 Backward continue. Execute the target system in reverse. No parameter.
33865 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
33866
33867 Reply:
33868 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
33869
33870 @cindex @samp{bs} packet
33871 @anchor{bs}
33872 @item bs
33873 Backward single step. Execute one instruction in reverse. No parameter.
33874 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
33875
33876 Reply:
33877 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
33878
33879 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
33880 @cindex @samp{c} packet
33881 Continue at @var{addr}, which is the address to resume. If @var{addr}
33882 is omitted, resume at current address.
33883
33884 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
33885 packet}.
33886
33887 Reply:
33888 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
33889
33890 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
33891 @cindex @samp{C} packet
33892 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
33893 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
33894
33895 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
33896 packet}.
33897
33898 Reply:
33899 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
33900
33901 @item d
33902 @cindex @samp{d} packet
33903 Toggle debug flag.
33904
33905 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
33906 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
33907
33908 @item D
33909 @itemx D;@var{pid}
33910 @cindex @samp{D} packet
33911 The first form of the packet is used to detach @value{GDBN} from the
33912 remote system. It is sent to the remote target
33913 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
33914
33915 The second form, including a process ID, is used when multiprocess
33916 protocol extensions are enabled (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}), to
33917 detach only a specific process. The @var{pid} is specified as a
33918 big-endian hex string.
33919
33920 Reply:
33921 @table @samp
33922 @item OK
33923 for success
33924 @item E @var{NN}
33925 for an error
33926 @end table
33927
33928 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
33929 @cindex @samp{F} packet
33930 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
33931 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
33932 Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
33933
33934 @item g
33935 @anchor{read registers packet}
33936 @cindex @samp{g} packet
33937 Read general registers.
33938
33939 Reply:
33940 @table @samp
33941 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
33942 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
33943 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
33944 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
33945 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
33946 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}. The
33947 specification of several standard @samp{g} packets is specified below.
33948
33949 When reading registers from a trace frame (@pxref{Analyze Collected
33950 Data,,Using the Collected Data}), the stub may also return a string of
33951 literal @samp{x}'s in place of the register data digits, to indicate
33952 that the corresponding register has not been collected, thus its value
33953 is unavailable. For example, for an architecture with 4 registers of
33954 4 bytes each, the following reply indicates to @value{GDBN} that
33955 registers 0 and 2 have not been collected, while registers 1 and 3
33956 have been collected, and both have zero value:
33957
33958 @smallexample
33959 -> @code{g}
33960 <- @code{xxxxxxxx00000000xxxxxxxx00000000}
33961 @end smallexample
33962
33963 @item E @var{NN}
33964 for an error.
33965 @end table
33966
33967 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
33968 @cindex @samp{G} packet
33969 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
33970 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
33971
33972 Reply:
33973 @table @samp
33974 @item OK
33975 for success
33976 @item E @var{NN}
33977 for an error
33978 @end table
33979
33980 @item H @var{op} @var{thread-id}
33981 @cindex @samp{H} packet
33982 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
33983 @samp{G}, et.al.). Depending on the operation to be performed, @var{op}
33984 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations (note that this
33985 is deprecated, supporting the @samp{vCont} command is a better
33986 option), and @samp{g} for other operations. The thread designator
33987 @var{thread-id} has the format and interpretation described in
33988 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
33989
33990 Reply:
33991 @table @samp
33992 @item OK
33993 for success
33994 @item E @var{NN}
33995 for an error
33996 @end table
33997
33998 @c FIXME: JTC:
33999 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
34000 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
34001 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
34002 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
34003 @c described. For example:
34004 @c
34005 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
34006 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
34007 @c otherwise returns current registers.
34008 @c
34009 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
34010 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
34011 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
34012
34013 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
34014 @anchor{cycle step packet}
34015 @cindex @samp{i} packet
34016 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
34017 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
34018 step starting at that address.
34019
34020 @item I
34021 @cindex @samp{I} packet
34022 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
34023 step packet}.
34024
34025 @item k
34026 @cindex @samp{k} packet
34027 Kill request.
34028
34029 The exact effect of this packet is not specified.
34030
34031 For a bare-metal target, it may power cycle or reset the target
34032 system. For that reason, the @samp{k} packet has no reply.
34033
34034 For a single-process target, it may kill that process if possible.
34035
34036 A multiple-process target may choose to kill just one process, or all
34037 that are under @value{GDBN}'s control. For more precise control, use
34038 the vKill packet (@pxref{vKill packet}).
34039
34040 If the target system immediately closes the connection in response to
34041 @samp{k}, @value{GDBN} does not consider the lack of packet
34042 acknowledgment to be an error, and assumes the kill was successful.
34043
34044 If connected using @kbd{target extended-remote}, and the target does
34045 not close the connection in response to a kill request, @value{GDBN}
34046 probes the target state as if a new connection was opened
34047 (@pxref{? packet}).
34048
34049 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
34050 @cindex @samp{m} packet
34051 Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
34052 Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to any particular boundary.
34053
34054 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
34055 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
34056 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
34057 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
34058 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
34059 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
34060 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
34061 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
34062
34063 Reply:
34064 @table @samp
34065 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
34066 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal
34067 number. The reply may contain fewer bytes than requested if the
34068 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
34069 @item E @var{NN}
34070 @var{NN} is errno
34071 @end table
34072
34073 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
34074 @cindex @samp{M} packet
34075 Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
34076 The data is given by @var{XX@dots{}}; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit
34077 hexadecimal number.
34078
34079 Reply:
34080 @table @samp
34081 @item OK
34082 for success
34083 @item E @var{NN}
34084 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
34085 written).
34086 @end table
34087
34088 @item p @var{n}
34089 @cindex @samp{p} packet
34090 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
34091 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
34092 register value is encoded.
34093
34094 Reply:
34095 @table @samp
34096 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
34097 the register's value
34098 @item E @var{NN}
34099 for an error
34100 @item @w{}
34101 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
34102 @end table
34103
34104 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
34105 @anchor{write register packet}
34106 @cindex @samp{P} packet
34107 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
34108 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
34109 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
34110
34111 Reply:
34112 @table @samp
34113 @item OK
34114 for success
34115 @item E @var{NN}
34116 for an error
34117 @end table
34118
34119 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
34120 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
34121 @cindex @samp{q} packet
34122 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
34123 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
34124 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
34125
34126 @item r
34127 @cindex @samp{r} packet
34128 Reset the entire system.
34129
34130 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
34131
34132 @item R @var{XX}
34133 @cindex @samp{R} packet
34134 Restart the program being debugged. The @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
34135 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
34136
34137 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
34138
34139 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
34140 @cindex @samp{s} packet
34141 Single step, resuming at @var{addr}. If
34142 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
34143
34144 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
34145 packet}.
34146
34147 Reply:
34148 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34149
34150 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
34151 @anchor{step with signal packet}
34152 @cindex @samp{S} packet
34153 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
34154 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
34155
34156 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
34157 packet}.
34158
34159 Reply:
34160 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34161
34162 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
34163 @cindex @samp{t} packet
34164 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
34165 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}, both of which are are 4 byte long.
34166 There must be at least 3 digits in @var{addr}.
34167
34168 @item T @var{thread-id}
34169 @cindex @samp{T} packet
34170 Find out if the thread @var{thread-id} is alive. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
34171
34172 Reply:
34173 @table @samp
34174 @item OK
34175 thread is still alive
34176 @item E @var{NN}
34177 thread is dead
34178 @end table
34179
34180 @item v
34181 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
34182 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
34183
34184 @item vAttach;@var{pid}
34185 @cindex @samp{vAttach} packet
34186 Attach to a new process with the specified process ID @var{pid}.
34187 The process ID is a
34188 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. In all-stop mode, all
34189 threads in the attached process are stopped; in non-stop mode, it may be
34190 attached without being stopped if that is supported by the target.
34191
34192 @c In non-stop mode, on a successful vAttach, the stub should set the
34193 @c current thread to a thread of the newly-attached process. After
34194 @c attaching, GDB queries for the attached process's thread ID with qC.
34195 @c Also note that, from a user perspective, whether or not the
34196 @c target is stopped on attach in non-stop mode depends on whether you
34197 @c use the foreground or background version of the attach command, not
34198 @c on what vAttach does; GDB does the right thing with respect to either
34199 @c stopping or restarting threads.
34200
34201 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
34202
34203 Reply:
34204 @table @samp
34205 @item E @var{nn}
34206 for an error
34207 @item @r{Any stop packet}
34208 for success in all-stop mode (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
34209 @item OK
34210 for success in non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop})
34211 @end table
34212
34213 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{thread-id}@r{]]}@dots{}
34214 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
34215 @anchor{vCont packet}
34216 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
34217 If an action is specified with no @var{thread-id}, then it is applied to any
34218 threads that don't have a specific action specified; if no default action is
34219 specified then other threads should remain stopped in all-stop mode and
34220 in their current state in non-stop mode.
34221 Specifying multiple
34222 default actions is an error; specifying no actions is also an error.
34223 Thread IDs are specified using the syntax described in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
34224
34225 Currently supported actions are:
34226
34227 @table @samp
34228 @item c
34229 Continue.
34230 @item C @var{sig}
34231 Continue with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
34232 @item s
34233 Step.
34234 @item S @var{sig}
34235 Step with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
34236 @item t
34237 Stop.
34238 @item r @var{start},@var{end}
34239 Step once, and then keep stepping as long as the thread stops at
34240 addresses between @var{start} (inclusive) and @var{end} (exclusive).
34241 The remote stub reports a stop reply when either the thread goes out
34242 of the range or is stopped due to an unrelated reason, such as hitting
34243 a breakpoint. @xref{range stepping}.
34244
34245 If the range is empty (@var{start} == @var{end}), then the action
34246 becomes equivalent to the @samp{s} action. In other words,
34247 single-step once, and report the stop (even if the stepped instruction
34248 jumps to @var{start}).
34249
34250 (A stop reply may be sent at any point even if the PC is still within
34251 the stepping range; for example, it is valid to implement this packet
34252 in a degenerate way as a single instruction step operation.)
34253
34254 @end table
34255
34256 The optional argument @var{addr} normally associated with the
34257 @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, and @samp{S} packets is
34258 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
34259
34260 The @samp{t} action is only relevant in non-stop mode
34261 (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}) and may be ignored by the stub otherwise.
34262 A stop reply should be generated for any affected thread not already stopped.
34263 When a thread is stopped by means of a @samp{t} action,
34264 the corresponding stop reply should indicate that the thread has stopped with
34265 signal @samp{0}, regardless of whether the target uses some other signal
34266 as an implementation detail.
34267
34268 The stub must support @samp{vCont} if it reports support for
34269 multiprocess extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}). Note that in
34270 this case @samp{vCont} actions can be specified to apply to all threads
34271 in a process by using the @samp{p@var{pid}.-1} form of the
34272 @var{thread-id}.
34273
34274 Reply:
34275 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34276
34277 @item vCont?
34278 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
34279 Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
34280
34281 Reply:
34282 @table @samp
34283 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
34284 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
34285 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
34286 @item @w{}
34287 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
34288 @end table
34289
34290 @item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{}
34291 @cindex @samp{vFile} packet
34292 Perform a file operation on the target system. For details,
34293 see @ref{Host I/O Packets}.
34294
34295 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
34296 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
34297 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
34298 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
34299 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
34300 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
34301 Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
34302 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
34303 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
34304 packet is received.
34305
34306 Reply:
34307 @table @samp
34308 @item OK
34309 for success
34310 @item E @var{NN}
34311 for an error
34312 @end table
34313
34314 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
34315 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
34316 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
34317 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
34318 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
34319 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
34320 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
34321 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
34322 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
34323 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
34324 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
34325 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
34326
34327
34328 Reply:
34329 @table @samp
34330 @item OK
34331 for success
34332 @item E.memtype
34333 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
34334 @item E @var{NN}
34335 for an error
34336 @end table
34337
34338 @item vFlashDone
34339 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
34340 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
34341 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
34342 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
34343 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
34344 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
34345 request is completed.
34346
34347 @item vKill;@var{pid}
34348 @cindex @samp{vKill} packet
34349 @anchor{vKill packet}
34350 Kill the process with the specified process ID @var{pid}, which is a
34351 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. This packet is used in
34352 preference to @samp{k} when multiprocess protocol extensions are
34353 supported; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
34354
34355 Reply:
34356 @table @samp
34357 @item E @var{nn}
34358 for an error
34359 @item OK
34360 for success
34361 @end table
34362
34363 @item vRun;@var{filename}@r{[};@var{argument}@r{]}@dots{}
34364 @cindex @samp{vRun} packet
34365 Run the program @var{filename}, passing it each @var{argument} on its
34366 command line. The file and arguments are hex-encoded strings. If
34367 @var{filename} is an empty string, the stub may use a default program
34368 (e.g.@: the last program run). The program is created in the stopped
34369 state.
34370
34371 @c FIXME: What about non-stop mode?
34372
34373 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
34374
34375 Reply:
34376 @table @samp
34377 @item E @var{nn}
34378 for an error
34379 @item @r{Any stop packet}
34380 for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
34381 @end table
34382
34383 @item vStopped
34384 @cindex @samp{vStopped} packet
34385 @xref{Notification Packets}.
34386
34387 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
34388 @anchor{X packet}
34389 @cindex @samp{X} packet
34390 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
34391 Memory is specified by its address @var{addr} and number of bytes @var{length};
34392 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
34393
34394 Reply:
34395 @table @samp
34396 @item OK
34397 for success
34398 @item E @var{NN}
34399 for an error
34400 @end table
34401
34402 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
34403 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
34404 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
34405 @cindex @samp{z} packet
34406 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
34407 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
34408 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} of kind @var{kind}.
34409
34410 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
34411 separately.
34412
34413 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
34414 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
34415 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
34416 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
34417 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
34418 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
34419
34420 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}
34421 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
34422 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
34423 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
34424 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
34425 @var{addr} of type @var{kind}.
34426
34427 A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
34428 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
34429 @var{kind} is target-specific and typically indicates the size of
34430 the breakpoint in bytes that should be inserted. E.g., the @sc{arm}
34431 and @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint. Some
34432 architectures have additional meanings for @var{kind};
34433 @var{cond_list} is an optional list of conditional expressions in bytecode
34434 form that should be evaluated on the target's side. These are the
34435 conditions that should be taken into consideration when deciding if
34436 the breakpoint trigger should be reported back to @var{GDBN}.
34437
34438 The @var{cond_list} parameter is comprised of a series of expressions,
34439 concatenated without separators. Each expression has the following form:
34440
34441 @table @samp
34442
34443 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
34444 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
34445 actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
34446
34447 @end table
34448
34449 The optional @var{cmd_list} parameter introduces commands that may be
34450 run on the target, rather than being reported back to @value{GDBN}.
34451 The parameter starts with a numeric flag @var{persist}; if the flag is
34452 nonzero, then the breakpoint may remain active and the commands
34453 continue to be run even when @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target.
34454 Following this flag is a series of expressions concatenated with no
34455 separators. Each expression has the following form:
34456
34457 @table @samp
34458
34459 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
34460 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
34461 actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
34462
34463 @end table
34464
34465 see @ref{Architecture-Specific Protocol Details}.
34466
34467 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
34468 code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
34469 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
34470 target, is not defined.}
34471
34472 Reply:
34473 @table @samp
34474 @item OK
34475 success
34476 @item @w{}
34477 not supported
34478 @item E @var{NN}
34479 for an error
34480 @end table
34481
34482 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}
34483 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}
34484 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
34485 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
34486 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
34487 address @var{addr}.
34488
34489 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
34490 dependant on being able to modify the target's memory. The @var{kind}
34491 and @var{cond_list} have the same meaning as in @samp{Z0} packets.
34492
34493 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
34494 movement.}
34495
34496 Reply:
34497 @table @samp
34498 @item OK
34499 success
34500 @item @w{}
34501 not supported
34502 @item E @var{NN}
34503 for an error
34504 @end table
34505
34506 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
34507 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
34508 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
34509 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
34510 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint at @var{addr}.
34511 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
34512
34513 Reply:
34514 @table @samp
34515 @item OK
34516 success
34517 @item @w{}
34518 not supported
34519 @item E @var{NN}
34520 for an error
34521 @end table
34522
34523 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
34524 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
34525 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
34526 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
34527 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint at @var{addr}.
34528 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
34529
34530 Reply:
34531 @table @samp
34532 @item OK
34533 success
34534 @item @w{}
34535 not supported
34536 @item E @var{NN}
34537 for an error
34538 @end table
34539
34540 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
34541 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
34542 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
34543 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
34544 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint at @var{addr}.
34545 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
34546
34547 Reply:
34548 @table @samp
34549 @item OK
34550 success
34551 @item @w{}
34552 not supported
34553 @item E @var{NN}
34554 for an error
34555 @end table
34556
34557 @end table
34558
34559 @node Stop Reply Packets
34560 @section Stop Reply Packets
34561 @cindex stop reply packets
34562
34563 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s}, @samp{vCont},
34564 @samp{vAttach}, @samp{vRun}, @samp{vStopped}, and @samp{?} packets can
34565 receive any of the below as a reply. Except for @samp{?}
34566 and @samp{vStopped}, that reply is only returned
34567 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
34568 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
34569 @value{GDBN} source code.
34570
34571 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
34572 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
34573 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
34574 components.
34575
34576 @table @samp
34577
34578 @item S @var{AA}
34579 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
34580 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
34581 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
34582
34583 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
34584 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
34585 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
34586 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
34587 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
34588 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
34589 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
34590 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
34591
34592 @itemize @bullet
34593 @item
34594 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
34595 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. The data @var{r} is a
34596 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
34597 two-digit hex number.
34598
34599 @item
34600 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the @var{thread-id} of
34601 the stopped thread, as specified in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
34602
34603 @item
34604 If @var{n} is @samp{core}, then @var{r} is the hexadecimal number of
34605 the core on which the stop event was detected.
34606
34607 @item
34608 If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
34609 specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
34610 reasons are listed below. The @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
34611 signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
34612
34613 @item
34614 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
34615 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
34616 future.
34617 @end itemize
34618
34619 The currently defined stop reasons are:
34620
34621 @table @samp
34622 @item watch
34623 @itemx rwatch
34624 @itemx awatch
34625 The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
34626 hex.
34627
34628 @cindex shared library events, remote reply
34629 @item library
34630 The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
34631 @value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
34632 list of loaded libraries. The @var{r} part is ignored.
34633
34634 @cindex replay log events, remote reply
34635 @item replaylog
34636 The packet indicates that the target cannot continue replaying
34637 logged execution events, because it has reached the end (or the
34638 beginning when executing backward) of the log. The value of @var{r}
34639 will be either @samp{begin} or @samp{end}. @xref{Reverse Execution},
34640 for more information.
34641 @end table
34642
34643 @item W @var{AA}
34644 @itemx W @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
34645 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
34646 applicable to certain targets.
34647
34648 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the exited
34649 process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported support for
34650 multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
34651 The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
34652
34653 @item X @var{AA}
34654 @itemx X @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
34655 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
34656
34657 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
34658 terminated process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
34659 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
34660 extensions}. The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
34661
34662 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
34663 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
34664 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
34665 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
34666 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc. This reply is not permitted in non-stop mode.
34667
34668 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
34669 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
34670 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
34671 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
34672 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
34673 system calls.
34674
34675 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
34676 this very system call.
34677
34678 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
34679 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
34680 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
34681 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
34682 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
34683 Protocol Extension}, for more details.
34684
34685 @end table
34686
34687 @node General Query Packets
34688 @section General Query Packets
34689 @cindex remote query requests
34690
34691 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
34692 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
34693 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
34694 sending information to and from the stub.
34695
34696 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
34697 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
34698 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
34699 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
34700 conventions:
34701
34702 @itemize @bullet
34703 @item
34704 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
34705 @item
34706 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
34707 letter.
34708 @item
34709 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
34710 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
34711 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
34712 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
34713 @end itemize
34714
34715 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
34716 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
34717 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
34718 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
34719 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
34720 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
34721 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
34722 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
34723 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
34724 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
34725 packet.}.
34726
34727 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
34728 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
34729 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
34730 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
34731 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
34732
34733 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
34734
34735 @table @samp
34736
34737 @item QAgent:1
34738 @itemx QAgent:0
34739 Turn on or off the agent as a helper to perform some debugging operations
34740 delegated from @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Control Agent}).
34741
34742 @item QAllow:@var{op}:@var{val}@dots{}
34743 @cindex @samp{QAllow} packet
34744 Specify which operations @value{GDBN} expects to request of the
34745 target, as a semicolon-separated list of operation name and value
34746 pairs. Possible values for @var{op} include @samp{WriteReg},
34747 @samp{WriteMem}, @samp{InsertBreak}, @samp{InsertTrace},
34748 @samp{InsertFastTrace}, and @samp{Stop}. @var{val} is either 0,
34749 indicating that @value{GDBN} will not request the operation, or 1,
34750 indicating that it may. (The target can then use this to set up its
34751 own internals optimally, for instance if the debugger never expects to
34752 insert breakpoints, it may not need to install its own trap handler.)
34753
34754 @item qC
34755 @cindex current thread, remote request
34756 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
34757 Return the current thread ID.
34758
34759 Reply:
34760 @table @samp
34761 @item QC @var{thread-id}
34762 Where @var{thread-id} is a thread ID as documented in
34763 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
34764 @item @r{(anything else)}
34765 Any other reply implies the old thread ID.
34766 @end table
34767
34768 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
34769 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
34770 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
34771 @anchor{qCRC packet}
34772 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory using CRC-32 defined in
34773 IEEE 802.3. The CRC is computed byte at a time, taking the most
34774 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern code
34775 @code{0xffffffff} is used to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC.
34776
34777 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC used in validating separate debug
34778 files (@pxref{Separate Debug Files, , Debugging Information in Separate
34779 Files}). However the algorithm is slightly different. When validating
34780 separate debug files, the CRC is computed taking the @emph{least}
34781 significant bit of each byte first, and the final result is inverted to
34782 detect trailing zeros.
34783
34784 Reply:
34785 @table @samp
34786 @item E @var{NN}
34787 An error (such as memory fault)
34788 @item C @var{crc32}
34789 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
34790 @end table
34791
34792 @item QDisableRandomization:@var{value}
34793 @cindex disable address space randomization, remote request
34794 @cindex @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet
34795 Some target operating systems will randomize the virtual address space
34796 of the inferior process as a security feature, but provide a feature
34797 to disable such randomization, e.g.@: to allow for a more deterministic
34798 debugging experience. On such systems, this packet with a @var{value}
34799 of 1 directs the target to disable address space randomization for
34800 processes subsequently started via @samp{vRun} packets, while a packet
34801 with a @var{value} of 0 tells the target to enable address space
34802 randomization.
34803
34804 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
34805
34806 Reply:
34807 @table @samp
34808 @item OK
34809 The request succeeded.
34810
34811 @item E @var{nn}
34812 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
34813
34814 @item @w{}
34815 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QDisableRandomization} is not supported
34816 by the stub.
34817 @end table
34818
34819 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
34820 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
34821 This should only be done on targets that actually support disabling
34822 address space randomization.
34823
34824 @item qfThreadInfo
34825 @itemx qsThreadInfo
34826 @cindex list active threads, remote request
34827 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
34828 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
34829 Obtain a list of all active thread IDs from the target (OS). Since there
34830 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
34831 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
34832 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
34833 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
34834 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
34835
34836 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
34837
34838 Reply:
34839 @table @samp
34840 @item m @var{thread-id}
34841 A single thread ID
34842 @item m @var{thread-id},@var{thread-id}@dots{}
34843 a comma-separated list of thread IDs
34844 @item l
34845 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
34846 @end table
34847
34848 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
34849 more thread IDs, separated by commas.
34850 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
34851 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
34852 with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for @dfn{last}).
34853 Refer to @ref{thread-id syntax}, for the format of the @var{thread-id}
34854 fields.
34855
34856 @emph{Note: @value{GDBN} will send the @code{qfThreadInfo} query during the
34857 initial connection with the remote target, and the very first thread ID
34858 mentioned in the reply will be stopped by @value{GDBN} in a subsequent
34859 message. Therefore, the stub should ensure that the first thread ID in
34860 the @code{qfThreadInfo} reply is suitable for being stopped by @value{GDBN}.}
34861
34862 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
34863 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
34864 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
34865 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
34866 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
34867
34868 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the
34869 thread for which to fetch the TLS address. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
34870
34871 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
34872 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
34873 information associated with the variable.)
34874
34875 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
34876 load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
34877 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
34878 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
34879 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
34880 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
34881
34882 Reply:
34883 @table @samp
34884 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
34885 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
34886 local storage requested.
34887
34888 @item E @var{nn}
34889 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
34890
34891 @item @w{}
34892 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
34893 @end table
34894
34895 @item qGetTIBAddr:@var{thread-id}
34896 @cindex get thread information block address
34897 @cindex @samp{qGetTIBAddr} packet
34898 Fetch address of the Windows OS specific Thread Information Block.
34899
34900 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the thread.
34901
34902 Reply:
34903 @table @samp
34904 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
34905 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the linear address of the
34906 thread information block.
34907
34908 @item E @var{nn}
34909 An error occured. This means that either the thread was not found, or the
34910 address could not be retrieved.
34911
34912 @item @w{}
34913 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTIBAddr} is not supported by the stub.
34914 @end table
34915
34916 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
34917 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
34918 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
34919 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
34920 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
34921 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
34922 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
34923
34924 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
34925
34926 Reply:
34927 @table @samp
34928 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
34929 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
34930 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
34931 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
34932 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
34933 is a sequence of thread IDs, @var{threadid} (eight hex
34934 digits), from the target. See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
34935 @end table
34936
34937 @item qOffsets
34938 @cindex section offsets, remote request
34939 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
34940 Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
34941 image.
34942
34943 Reply:
34944 @table @samp
34945 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
34946 Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
34947 Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
34948 If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
34949 @samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
34950 segments by the supplied offsets.
34951
34952 @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
34953 @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
34954 to the @code{Bss} section.}
34955
34956 @item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
34957 Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
34958 contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
34959 @samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
34960 conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
34961 @var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
34962 does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
34963 as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
34964 kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
34965 @end table
34966
34967 @item qP @var{mode} @var{thread-id}
34968 @cindex thread information, remote request
34969 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
34970 Returns information on @var{thread-id}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
34971 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{thread-id} is a thread ID
34972 (@pxref{thread-id syntax}).
34973
34974 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
34975 (see below).
34976
34977 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
34978
34979 @item QNonStop:1
34980 @itemx QNonStop:0
34981 @cindex non-stop mode, remote request
34982 @cindex @samp{QNonStop} packet
34983 @anchor{QNonStop}
34984 Enter non-stop (@samp{QNonStop:1}) or all-stop (@samp{QNonStop:0}) mode.
34985 @xref{Remote Non-Stop}, for more information.
34986
34987 Reply:
34988 @table @samp
34989 @item OK
34990 The request succeeded.
34991
34992 @item E @var{nn}
34993 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
34994
34995 @item @w{}
34996 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QNonStop} is not supported by
34997 the stub.
34998 @end table
34999
35000 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35001 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35002 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set non-stop} command;
35003 @pxref{Non-Stop Mode}.
35004
35005 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
35006 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
35007 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
35008 @anchor{QPassSignals}
35009 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
35010 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
35011 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
35012 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
35013 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
35014 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
35015 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
35016 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
35017 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
35018
35019 Reply:
35020 @table @samp
35021 @item OK
35022 The request succeeded.
35023
35024 @item E @var{nn}
35025 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
35026
35027 @item @w{}
35028 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
35029 the stub.
35030 @end table
35031
35032 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
35033 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
35034 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35035 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35036
35037 @item QProgramSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
35038 @cindex signals the inferior may see, remote request
35039 @cindex @samp{QProgramSignals} packet
35040 @anchor{QProgramSignals}
35041 Each listed @var{signal} may be delivered to the inferior process.
35042 Others should be silently discarded.
35043
35044 In some cases, the remote stub may need to decide whether to deliver a
35045 signal to the program or not without @value{GDBN} involvement. One
35046 example of that is while detaching --- the program's threads may have
35047 stopped for signals that haven't yet had a chance of being reported to
35048 @value{GDBN}, and so the remote stub can use the signal list specified
35049 by this packet to know whether to deliver or ignore those pending
35050 signals.
35051
35052 This does not influence whether to deliver a signal as requested by a
35053 resumption packet (@pxref{vCont packet}).
35054
35055 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
35056 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
35057 strictly greater than the previous item. Multiple
35058 @samp{QProgramSignals} packets do not combine; any earlier
35059 @samp{QProgramSignals} list is completely replaced by the new list.
35060
35061 Reply:
35062 @table @samp
35063 @item OK
35064 The request succeeded.
35065
35066 @item E @var{nn}
35067 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
35068
35069 @item @w{}
35070 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QProgramSignals} is not supported
35071 by the stub.
35072 @end table
35073
35074 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote program-signals}
35075 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote program-signals}).
35076 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35077 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35078
35079 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
35080 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
35081 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
35082 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
35083 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
35084 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
35085 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
35086 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
35087 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
35088
35089 Reply:
35090 @table @samp
35091 @item OK
35092 A command response with no output.
35093 @item @var{OUTPUT}
35094 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
35095 @item E @var{NN}
35096 Indicate a badly formed request.
35097 @item @w{}
35098 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
35099 @end table
35100
35101 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
35102 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
35103 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
35104 packets.)
35105
35106 @item qSearch:memory:@var{address};@var{length};@var{search-pattern}
35107 @cindex searching memory, in remote debugging
35108 @ifnotinfo
35109 @cindex @samp{qSearch:memory} packet
35110 @end ifnotinfo
35111 @cindex @samp{qSearch memory} packet
35112 @anchor{qSearch memory}
35113 Search @var{length} bytes at @var{address} for @var{search-pattern}.
35114 Both @var{address} and @var{length} are encoded in hex;
35115 @var{search-pattern} is a sequence of bytes, also hex encoded.
35116
35117 Reply:
35118 @table @samp
35119 @item 0
35120 The pattern was not found.
35121 @item 1,address
35122 The pattern was found at @var{address}.
35123 @item E @var{NN}
35124 A badly formed request or an error was encountered while searching memory.
35125 @item @w{}
35126 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSearch:memory} is not recognized.
35127 @end table
35128
35129 @item QStartNoAckMode
35130 @cindex @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet
35131 @anchor{QStartNoAckMode}
35132 Request that the remote stub disable the normal @samp{+}/@samp{-}
35133 protocol acknowledgments (@pxref{Packet Acknowledgment}).
35134
35135 Reply:
35136 @table @samp
35137 @item OK
35138 The stub has switched to no-acknowledgment mode.
35139 @value{GDBN} acknowledges this reponse,
35140 but neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or expect further
35141 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments in the current connection.
35142 @item @w{}
35143 An empty reply indicates that the stub does not support no-acknowledgment mode.
35144 @end table
35145
35146 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
35147 @cindex supported packets, remote query
35148 @cindex features of the remote protocol
35149 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
35150 @anchor{qSupported}
35151 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
35152 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
35153 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
35154 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
35155 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
35156 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
35157 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
35158 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
35159 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
35160 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
35161 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
35162 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
35163 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
35164 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
35165
35166 Reply:
35167 @table @samp
35168 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
35169 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
35170 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
35171 possible forms).
35172 @item @w{}
35173 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
35174 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
35175 @end table
35176
35177 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
35178 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
35179 are:
35180
35181 @table @samp
35182 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
35183 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
35184 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
35185 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
35186 @item @var{name}+
35187 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
35188 need an associated value.
35189 @item @var{name}-
35190 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
35191 @item @var{name}?
35192 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
35193 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
35194 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
35195 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
35196 @end table
35197
35198 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
35199 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
35200 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
35201 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
35202 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
35203
35204 The following values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
35205 are defined:
35206
35207 @table @samp
35208 @item multiprocess
35209 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports multiprocess
35210 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
35211 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
35212 including @samp{multiprocess+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
35213 @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for details.
35214
35215 @item xmlRegisters
35216 This feature indicates that @value{GDBN} supports the XML target
35217 description. If the stub sees @samp{xmlRegisters=} with target
35218 specific strings separated by a comma, it will report register
35219 description.
35220
35221 @item qRelocInsn
35222 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the
35223 @samp{qRelocInsn} packet (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
35224 instruction reply packet}).
35225 @end table
35226
35227 Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
35228 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
35229 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
35230 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Additional values
35231 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
35232 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
35233 improvements in the remote protocol---the @samp{multiprocess} feature is
35234 an example of such a feature. The stub's reply should be independent
35235 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
35236 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
35237 all the features it supports.
35238
35239 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
35240 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
35241
35242 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
35243 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
35244 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
35245 form response.
35246
35247 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
35248 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
35249 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
35250 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
35251
35252 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
35253 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
35254 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
35255 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
35256 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
35257
35258 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
35259
35260 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
35261 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
35262 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
35263 @item Feature Name
35264 @tab Value Required
35265 @tab Default
35266 @tab Probe Allowed
35267
35268 @item @samp{PacketSize}
35269 @tab Yes
35270 @tab @samp{-}
35271 @tab No
35272
35273 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
35274 @tab No
35275 @tab @samp{-}
35276 @tab Yes
35277
35278 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
35279 @tab No
35280 @tab @samp{-}
35281 @tab Yes
35282
35283 @item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
35284 @tab No
35285 @tab @samp{-}
35286 @tab Yes
35287
35288 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
35289 @tab No
35290 @tab @samp{-}
35291 @tab Yes
35292
35293 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read}
35294 @tab No
35295 @tab @samp{-}
35296 @tab Yes
35297
35298 @item @samp{augmented-libraries-svr4-read}
35299 @tab No
35300 @tab @samp{-}
35301 @tab No
35302
35303 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
35304 @tab No
35305 @tab @samp{-}
35306 @tab Yes
35307
35308 @item @samp{qXfer:sdata:read}
35309 @tab No
35310 @tab @samp{-}
35311 @tab Yes
35312
35313 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
35314 @tab No
35315 @tab @samp{-}
35316 @tab Yes
35317
35318 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
35319 @tab No
35320 @tab @samp{-}
35321 @tab Yes
35322
35323 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read}
35324 @tab No
35325 @tab @samp{-}
35326 @tab Yes
35327
35328 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write}
35329 @tab No
35330 @tab @samp{-}
35331 @tab Yes
35332
35333 @item @samp{qXfer:threads:read}
35334 @tab No
35335 @tab @samp{-}
35336 @tab Yes
35337
35338 @item @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
35339 @tab No
35340 @tab @samp{-}
35341 @tab Yes
35342
35343 @item @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
35344 @tab No
35345 @tab @samp{-}
35346 @tab Yes
35347
35348 @item @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
35349 @tab No
35350 @tab @samp{-}
35351 @tab Yes
35352
35353 @item @samp{Qbtrace:off}
35354 @tab Yes
35355 @tab @samp{-}
35356 @tab Yes
35357
35358 @item @samp{Qbtrace:bts}
35359 @tab Yes
35360 @tab @samp{-}
35361 @tab Yes
35362
35363 @item @samp{QNonStop}
35364 @tab No
35365 @tab @samp{-}
35366 @tab Yes
35367
35368 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
35369 @tab No
35370 @tab @samp{-}
35371 @tab Yes
35372
35373 @item @samp{QStartNoAckMode}
35374 @tab No
35375 @tab @samp{-}
35376 @tab Yes
35377
35378 @item @samp{multiprocess}
35379 @tab No
35380 @tab @samp{-}
35381 @tab No
35382
35383 @item @samp{ConditionalBreakpoints}
35384 @tab No
35385 @tab @samp{-}
35386 @tab No
35387
35388 @item @samp{ConditionalTracepoints}
35389 @tab No
35390 @tab @samp{-}
35391 @tab No
35392
35393 @item @samp{ReverseContinue}
35394 @tab No
35395 @tab @samp{-}
35396 @tab No
35397
35398 @item @samp{ReverseStep}
35399 @tab No
35400 @tab @samp{-}
35401 @tab No
35402
35403 @item @samp{TracepointSource}
35404 @tab No
35405 @tab @samp{-}
35406 @tab No
35407
35408 @item @samp{QAgent}
35409 @tab No
35410 @tab @samp{-}
35411 @tab No
35412
35413 @item @samp{QAllow}
35414 @tab No
35415 @tab @samp{-}
35416 @tab No
35417
35418 @item @samp{QDisableRandomization}
35419 @tab No
35420 @tab @samp{-}
35421 @tab No
35422
35423 @item @samp{EnableDisableTracepoints}
35424 @tab No
35425 @tab @samp{-}
35426 @tab No
35427
35428 @item @samp{QTBuffer:size}
35429 @tab No
35430 @tab @samp{-}
35431 @tab No
35432
35433 @item @samp{tracenz}
35434 @tab No
35435 @tab @samp{-}
35436 @tab No
35437
35438 @item @samp{BreakpointCommands}
35439 @tab No
35440 @tab @samp{-}
35441 @tab No
35442
35443 @end multitable
35444
35445 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
35446
35447 @table @samp
35448 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
35449 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
35450 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
35451 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
35452 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
35453 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
35454 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
35455 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
35456 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
35457 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
35458
35459 @item qXfer:auxv:read
35460 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
35461 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
35462
35463 @item qXfer:btrace:read
35464 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
35465 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}).
35466
35467 @item qXfer:features:read
35468 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
35469 (@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
35470
35471 @item qXfer:libraries:read
35472 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
35473 (@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
35474
35475 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read
35476 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
35477 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
35478
35479 @item augmented-libraries-svr4-read
35480 The remote stub understands the augmented form of the
35481 @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
35482 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
35483
35484 @item qXfer:memory-map:read
35485 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
35486 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
35487
35488 @item qXfer:sdata:read
35489 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:sdata:read} packet
35490 (@pxref{qXfer sdata read}).
35491
35492 @item qXfer:spu:read
35493 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
35494 (@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
35495
35496 @item qXfer:spu:write
35497 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
35498 (@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
35499
35500 @item qXfer:siginfo:read
35501 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read} packet
35502 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo read}).
35503
35504 @item qXfer:siginfo:write
35505 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write} packet
35506 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo write}).
35507
35508 @item qXfer:threads:read
35509 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
35510 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}).
35511
35512 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read
35513 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
35514 packet (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}).
35515
35516 @item qXfer:uib:read
35517 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
35518 packet (@pxref{qXfer unwind info block}).
35519
35520 @item qXfer:fdpic:read
35521 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
35522 packet (@pxref{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}).
35523
35524 @item QNonStop
35525 The remote stub understands the @samp{QNonStop} packet
35526 (@pxref{QNonStop}).
35527
35528 @item QPassSignals
35529 The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
35530 (@pxref{QPassSignals}).
35531
35532 @item QStartNoAckMode
35533 The remote stub understands the @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet and
35534 prefers to operate in no-acknowledgment mode. @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}.
35535
35536 @item multiprocess
35537 @anchor{multiprocess extensions}
35538 @cindex multiprocess extensions, in remote protocol
35539 The remote stub understands the multiprocess extensions to the remote
35540 protocol syntax. The multiprocess extensions affect the syntax of
35541 thread IDs in both packets and replies (@pxref{thread-id syntax}), and
35542 add process IDs to the @samp{D} packet and @samp{W} and @samp{X}
35543 replies. Note that reporting this feature indicates support for the
35544 syntactic extensions only, not that the stub necessarily supports
35545 debugging of more than one process at a time. The stub must not use
35546 multiprocess extensions in packet replies unless @value{GDBN} has also
35547 indicated it supports them in its @samp{qSupported} request.
35548
35549 @item qXfer:osdata:read
35550 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet
35551 ((@pxref{qXfer osdata read}).
35552
35553 @item ConditionalBreakpoints
35554 The target accepts and implements evaluation of conditional expressions
35555 defined for breakpoints. The target will only report breakpoint triggers
35556 when such conditions are true (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
35557
35558 @item ConditionalTracepoints
35559 The remote stub accepts and implements conditional expressions defined
35560 for tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoint Conditions}).
35561
35562 @item ReverseContinue
35563 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse continue packet
35564 (@pxref{bc}).
35565
35566 @item ReverseStep
35567 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse step packet
35568 (@pxref{bs}).
35569
35570 @item TracepointSource
35571 The remote stub understands the @samp{QTDPsrc} packet that supplies
35572 the source form of tracepoint definitions.
35573
35574 @item QAgent
35575 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAgent} packet.
35576
35577 @item QAllow
35578 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAllow} packet.
35579
35580 @item QDisableRandomization
35581 The remote stub understands the @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet.
35582
35583 @item StaticTracepoint
35584 @cindex static tracepoints, in remote protocol
35585 The remote stub supports static tracepoints.
35586
35587 @item InstallInTrace
35588 @anchor{install tracepoint in tracing}
35589 The remote stub supports installing tracepoint in tracing.
35590
35591 @item EnableDisableTracepoints
35592 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTEnable} (@pxref{QTEnable}) and
35593 @samp{QTDisable} (@pxref{QTDisable}) packets that allow tracepoints
35594 to be enabled and disabled while a trace experiment is running.
35595
35596 @item QTBuffer:size
35597 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTBuffer:size} (@pxref{QTBuffer-size})
35598 packet that allows to change the size of the trace buffer.
35599
35600 @item tracenz
35601 @cindex string tracing, in remote protocol
35602 The remote stub supports the @samp{tracenz} bytecode for collecting strings.
35603 See @ref{Bytecode Descriptions} for details about the bytecode.
35604
35605 @item BreakpointCommands
35606 @cindex breakpoint commands, in remote protocol
35607 The remote stub supports running a breakpoint's command list itself,
35608 rather than reporting the hit to @value{GDBN}.
35609
35610 @item Qbtrace:off
35611 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:off} packet.
35612
35613 @item Qbtrace:bts
35614 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:bts} packet.
35615
35616 @end table
35617
35618 @item qSymbol::
35619 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
35620 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
35621 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
35622 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
35623
35624 Reply:
35625 @table @samp
35626 @item OK
35627 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
35628 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
35629 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
35630 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
35631 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
35632 below.
35633 @end table
35634
35635 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
35636 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
35637
35638 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
35639 target has previously requested.
35640
35641 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
35642 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
35643 will be empty.
35644
35645 Reply:
35646 @table @samp
35647 @item OK
35648 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
35649 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
35650 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
35651 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
35652 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
35653 @end table
35654
35655 @item qTBuffer
35656 @itemx QTBuffer
35657 @itemx QTDisconnected
35658 @itemx QTDP
35659 @itemx QTDPsrc
35660 @itemx QTDV
35661 @itemx qTfP
35662 @itemx qTfV
35663 @itemx QTFrame
35664 @itemx qTMinFTPILen
35665
35666 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
35667
35668 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{thread-id}
35669 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
35670 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
35671 Obtain from the target OS a printable string description of thread
35672 attributes for the thread @var{thread-id}; see @ref{thread-id syntax},
35673 for the forms of @var{thread-id}. This
35674 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
35675 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
35676 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
35677 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
35678 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
35679
35680 Reply:
35681 @table @samp
35682 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
35683 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
35684 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
35685 the thread's attributes.
35686 @end table
35687
35688 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
35689 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
35690 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
35691 packets.)
35692
35693 @item QTNotes
35694 @itemx qTP
35695 @itemx QTSave
35696 @itemx qTsP
35697 @itemx qTsV
35698 @itemx QTStart
35699 @itemx QTStop
35700 @itemx QTEnable
35701 @itemx QTDisable
35702 @itemx QTinit
35703 @itemx QTro
35704 @itemx qTStatus
35705 @itemx qTV
35706 @itemx qTfSTM
35707 @itemx qTsSTM
35708 @itemx qTSTMat
35709 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
35710
35711 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
35712 @cindex read special object, remote request
35713 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
35714 @anchor{qXfer read}
35715 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
35716 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
35717 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
35718 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
35719 additional details about what data to access.
35720
35721 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
35722 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
35723 formats, listed below.
35724
35725 @table @samp
35726 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
35727 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
35728 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
35729 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
35730
35731 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35732 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35733
35734 @item qXfer:btrace:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
35735 @anchor{qXfer btrace read}
35736
35737 Return a description of the current branch trace.
35738 @xref{Branch Trace Format}. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer}
35739 packet may have one of the following values:
35740
35741 @table @code
35742 @item all
35743 Returns all available branch trace.
35744
35745 @item new
35746 Returns all available branch trace if the branch trace changed since
35747 the last read request.
35748
35749 @item delta
35750 Returns the new branch trace since the last read request. Adds a new
35751 block to the end of the trace that begins at zero and ends at the source
35752 location of the first branch in the trace buffer. This extra block is
35753 used to stitch traces together.
35754
35755 If the trace buffer overflowed, returns an error indicating the overflow.
35756 @end table
35757
35758 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
35759 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35760
35761 @item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
35762 @anchor{qXfer target description read}
35763 Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
35764 annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
35765 always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
35766
35767 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35768 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35769
35770 @item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
35771 @anchor{qXfer library list read}
35772 Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
35773 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
35774 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
35775
35776 Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
35777 not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
35778 the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
35779
35780 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35781 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35782
35783 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
35784 @anchor{qXfer svr4 library list read}
35785 Access the target's list of loaded libraries when the target is an SVR4
35786 platform. @xref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets}. The annex part
35787 of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty unless the remote
35788 stub indicated it supports the augmented form of this packet
35789 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
35790 (@pxref{qXfer read}, @ref{qSupported}).
35791
35792 This packet is optional for better performance on SVR4 targets.
35793 @value{GDBN} uses memory read packets to read the SVR4 library list otherwise.
35794
35795 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35796 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35797
35798 If the remote stub indicates it supports the augmented form of this
35799 packet then the annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet may
35800 contain a semicolon-separated list of @samp{@var{name}=@var{value}}
35801 arguments. The currently supported arguments are:
35802
35803 @table @code
35804 @item start=@var{address}
35805 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
35806 link_map} to start reading the library list from. If unset or zero
35807 then the first @samp{struct link_map} in the library list will be
35808 chosen as the starting point.
35809
35810 @item prev=@var{address}
35811 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
35812 link_map} immediately preceding the @samp{struct link_map}
35813 specified by the @samp{start} argument. If unset or zero then
35814 the remote stub will expect that no @samp{struct link_map}
35815 exists prior to the starting point.
35816
35817 @end table
35818
35819 Arguments that are not understood by the remote stub will be silently
35820 ignored.
35821
35822 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
35823 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
35824 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
35825 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
35826 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
35827
35828 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35829 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35830
35831 @item qXfer:sdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
35832 @anchor{qXfer sdata read}
35833
35834 Read contents of the extra collected static tracepoint marker
35835 information. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must
35836 be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}). @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint
35837 Action Lists}.
35838
35839 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35840 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
35841 (@pxref{qSupported}).
35842
35843 @item qXfer:siginfo:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
35844 @anchor{qXfer siginfo read}
35845 Read contents of the extra signal information on the target
35846 system. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
35847 empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
35848
35849 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35850 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
35851 (@pxref{qSupported}).
35852
35853 @item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
35854 @anchor{qXfer spu read}
35855 Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
35856 annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
35857 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
35858 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
35859 in that context to be accessed.
35860
35861 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35862 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
35863 (@pxref{qSupported}).
35864
35865 @item qXfer:threads:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
35866 @anchor{qXfer threads read}
35867 Access the list of threads on target. @xref{Thread List Format}. The
35868 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
35869 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
35870
35871 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35872 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35873
35874 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
35875 @anchor{qXfer traceframe info read}
35876
35877 Return a description of the current traceframe's contents.
35878 @xref{Traceframe Info Format}. The annex part of the generic
35879 @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
35880
35881 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35882 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35883
35884 @item qXfer:uib:read:@var{pc}:@var{offset},@var{length}
35885 @anchor{qXfer unwind info block}
35886
35887 Return the unwind information block for @var{pc}. This packet is used
35888 on OpenVMS/ia64 to ask the kernel unwind information.
35889
35890 This packet is not probed by default.
35891
35892 @item qXfer:fdpic:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
35893 @anchor{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}
35894 Read contents of @code{loadmap}s on the target system. The
35895 annex, either @samp{exec} or @samp{interp}, specifies which @code{loadmap},
35896 executable @code{loadmap} or interpreter @code{loadmap} to read.
35897
35898 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35899 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35900
35901 @item qXfer:osdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
35902 @anchor{qXfer osdata read}
35903 Access the target's @dfn{operating system information}.
35904 @xref{Operating System Information}.
35905
35906 @end table
35907
35908 Reply:
35909 @table @samp
35910 @item m @var{data}
35911 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
35912 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
35913 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
35914 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
35915 It is possible for @var{data} to have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
35916 request.
35917
35918 @item l @var{data}
35919 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
35920 There is no more data to be read. It is possible for @var{data} to
35921 have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the request.
35922
35923 @item l
35924 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
35925 There is no more data to be read.
35926
35927 @item E00
35928 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
35929
35930 @item E @var{nn}
35931 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
35932 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
35933
35934 @item @w{}
35935 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
35936 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
35937 @end table
35938
35939 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
35940 @cindex write data into object, remote request
35941 @anchor{qXfer write}
35942 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
35943 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
35944 into the data. The binary-encoded data (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be
35945 written is given by @var{data}@dots{}. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
35946 is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
35947 to access.
35948
35949 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
35950 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
35951 formats, listed below.
35952
35953 @table @samp
35954 @item qXfer:siginfo:write::@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
35955 @anchor{qXfer siginfo write}
35956 Write @var{data} to the extra signal information on the target system.
35957 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
35958 empty (@pxref{qXfer write}).
35959
35960 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35961 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
35962 (@pxref{qSupported}).
35963
35964 @item qXfer:spu:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
35965 @anchor{qXfer spu write}
35966 Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
35967 annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
35968 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
35969 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
35970 in that context to be accessed.
35971
35972 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35973 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35974 @end table
35975
35976 Reply:
35977 @table @samp
35978 @item @var{nn}
35979 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
35980 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
35981
35982 @item E00
35983 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
35984
35985 @item E @var{nn}
35986 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
35987 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
35988
35989 @item @w{}
35990 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
35991 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
35992 @end table
35993
35994 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
35995 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
35996 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
35997 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
35998 must respond with an empty packet.
35999
36000 @item qAttached:@var{pid}
36001 @cindex query attached, remote request
36002 @cindex @samp{qAttached} packet
36003 Return an indication of whether the remote server attached to an
36004 existing process or created a new process. When the multiprocess
36005 protocol extensions are supported (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}),
36006 @var{pid} is an integer in hexadecimal format identifying the target
36007 process. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will omit the @var{pid} field and
36008 the query packet will be simplified as @samp{qAttached}.
36009
36010 This query is used, for example, to know whether the remote process
36011 should be detached or killed when a @value{GDBN} session is ended with
36012 the @code{quit} command.
36013
36014 Reply:
36015 @table @samp
36016 @item 1
36017 The remote server attached to an existing process.
36018 @item 0
36019 The remote server created a new process.
36020 @item E @var{NN}
36021 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
36022 @end table
36023
36024 @item Qbtrace:bts
36025 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using bts tracing.
36026
36027 Reply:
36028 @table @samp
36029 @item OK
36030 Branch tracing has been enabled.
36031 @item E.errtext
36032 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
36033 @end table
36034
36035 @item Qbtrace:off
36036 Disable branch tracing for the current thread.
36037
36038 Reply:
36039 @table @samp
36040 @item OK
36041 Branch tracing has been disabled.
36042 @item E.errtext
36043 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
36044 @end table
36045
36046 @end table
36047
36048 @node Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
36049 @section Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
36050
36051 This section describes how the remote protocol is applied to specific
36052 target architectures. Also see @ref{Standard Target Features}, for
36053 details of XML target descriptions for each architecture.
36054
36055 @menu
36056 * ARM-Specific Protocol Details::
36057 * MIPS-Specific Protocol Details::
36058 @end menu
36059
36060 @node ARM-Specific Protocol Details
36061 @subsection @acronym{ARM}-specific Protocol Details
36062
36063 @menu
36064 * ARM Breakpoint Kinds::
36065 @end menu
36066
36067 @node ARM Breakpoint Kinds
36068 @subsubsection @acronym{ARM} Breakpoint Kinds
36069 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{ARM}
36070
36071 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
36072
36073 @table @r
36074
36075 @item 2
36076 16-bit Thumb mode breakpoint.
36077
36078 @item 3
36079 32-bit Thumb mode (Thumb-2) breakpoint.
36080
36081 @item 4
36082 32-bit @acronym{ARM} mode breakpoint.
36083
36084 @end table
36085
36086 @node MIPS-Specific Protocol Details
36087 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}-specific Protocol Details
36088
36089 @menu
36090 * MIPS Register packet Format::
36091 * MIPS Breakpoint Kinds::
36092 @end menu
36093
36094 @node MIPS Register packet Format
36095 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Register Packet Format
36096 @cindex register packet format, @acronym{MIPS}
36097
36098 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
36099 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
36100 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
36101 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
36102 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
36103 most-significant -- least-significant.
36104
36105 @table @r
36106
36107 @item MIPS32
36108 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
36109 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
36110 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
36111
36112 @item MIPS64
36113 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
36114 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
36115 as @code{MIPS32}.
36116
36117 @end table
36118
36119 @node MIPS Breakpoint Kinds
36120 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Breakpoint Kinds
36121 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{MIPS}
36122
36123 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
36124
36125 @table @r
36126
36127 @item 2
36128 16-bit @acronym{MIPS16} mode breakpoint.
36129
36130 @item 3
36131 16-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
36132
36133 @item 4
36134 32-bit standard @acronym{MIPS} mode breakpoint.
36135
36136 @item 5
36137 32-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
36138
36139 @end table
36140
36141 @node Tracepoint Packets
36142 @section Tracepoint Packets
36143 @cindex tracepoint packets
36144 @cindex packets, tracepoint
36145
36146 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
36147 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
36148
36149 @table @samp
36150
36151 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}[:F@var{flen}][:X@var{len},@var{bytes}]@r{[}-@r{]}
36152 @cindex @samp{QTDP} packet
36153 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
36154 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
36155 the tracepoint is disabled. The @var{step} gives the tracepoint's step
36156 count, and @var{pass} gives its pass count. If an @samp{F} is present,
36157 then the tracepoint is to be a fast tracepoint, and the @var{flen} is
36158 the number of bytes that the target should copy elsewhere to make room
36159 for the tracepoint. If an @samp{X} is present, it introduces a
36160 tracepoint condition, which consists of a hexadecimal length, followed
36161 by a comma and hex-encoded bytes, in a manner similar to action
36162 encodings as described below. If the trailing @samp{-} is present,
36163 further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this tracepoint's
36164 actions.
36165
36166 Replies:
36167 @table @samp
36168 @item OK
36169 The packet was understood and carried out.
36170 @item qRelocInsn
36171 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
36172 @item @w{}
36173 The packet was not recognized.
36174 @end table
36175
36176 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
36177 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. The @var{n} and
36178 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
36179 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
36180 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
36181 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
36182 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
36183
36184 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
36185 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
36186 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
36187 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
36188 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
36189 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
36190 tracepoint actions.
36191
36192 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
36193 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
36194 following forms:
36195
36196 @table @samp
36197
36198 @item R @var{mask}
36199 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask},
36200 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
36201 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
36202 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
36203 not fit in a 32-bit word.
36204
36205 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
36206 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
36207 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
36208 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
36209 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
36210 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
36211 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
36212
36213 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
36214 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
36215 it directs. The agent expression @var{expr} is as described in
36216 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
36217 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
36218 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
36219 packet).
36220
36221 @end table
36222
36223 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
36224 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
36225 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
36226 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
36227 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
36228 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
36229 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
36230 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
36231
36232 Replies:
36233 @table @samp
36234 @item OK
36235 The packet was understood and carried out.
36236 @item qRelocInsn
36237 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
36238 @item @w{}
36239 The packet was not recognized.
36240 @end table
36241
36242 @item QTDPsrc:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{type}:@var{start}:@var{slen}:@var{bytes}
36243 @cindex @samp{QTDPsrc} packet
36244 Specify a source string of tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr}.
36245 This is useful to get accurate reproduction of the tracepoints
36246 originally downloaded at the beginning of the trace run. The @var{type}
36247 is the name of the tracepoint part, such as @samp{cond} for the
36248 tracepoint's conditional expression (see below for a list of types), while
36249 @var{bytes} is the string, encoded in hexadecimal.
36250
36251 @var{start} is the offset of the @var{bytes} within the overall source
36252 string, while @var{slen} is the total length of the source string.
36253 This is intended for handling source strings that are longer than will
36254 fit in a single packet.
36255 @c Add detailed example when this info is moved into a dedicated
36256 @c tracepoint descriptions section.
36257
36258 The available string types are @samp{at} for the location,
36259 @samp{cond} for the conditional, and @samp{cmd} for an action command.
36260 @value{GDBN} sends a separate packet for each command in the action
36261 list, in the same order in which the commands are stored in the list.
36262
36263 The target does not need to do anything with source strings except
36264 report them back as part of the replies to the @samp{qTfP}/@samp{qTsP}
36265 query packets.
36266
36267 Although this packet is optional, and @value{GDBN} will only send it
36268 if the target replies with @samp{TracepointSource} @xref{General
36269 Query Packets}, it makes both disconnected tracing and trace files
36270 much easier to use. Otherwise the user must be careful that the
36271 tracepoints in effect while looking at trace frames are identical to
36272 the ones in effect during the trace run; even a small discrepancy
36273 could cause @samp{tdump} not to work, or a particular trace frame not
36274 be found.
36275
36276 @item QTDV:@var{n}:@var{value}
36277 @cindex define trace state variable, remote request
36278 @cindex @samp{QTDV} packet
36279 Create a new trace state variable, number @var{n}, with an initial
36280 value of @var{value}, which is a 64-bit signed integer. Both @var{n}
36281 and @var{value} are encoded as hexadecimal values. @value{GDBN} has
36282 the option of not using this packet for initial values of zero; the
36283 target should simply create the trace state variables as they are
36284 mentioned in expressions.
36285
36286 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
36287 @cindex @samp{QTFrame} packet
36288 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
36289 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
36290 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
36291
36292 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
36293 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
36294 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
36295 one of the following forms:
36296
36297 @table @samp
36298 @item F @var{f}
36299 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
36300 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
36301 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
36302
36303 @item T @var{t}
36304 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
36305 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
36306
36307 @end table
36308
36309 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
36310 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
36311 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
36312 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
36313
36314 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
36315 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
36316 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
36317 is a hexadecimal number.
36318
36319 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
36320 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
36321 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
36322 and @var{end} (inclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
36323 numbers.
36324
36325 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
36326 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
36327 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses (exclusive).
36328
36329 @item qTMinFTPILen
36330 @cindex @samp{qTMinFTPILen} packet
36331 This packet requests the minimum length of instruction at which a fast
36332 tracepoint (@pxref{Set Tracepoints}) may be placed. For instance, on
36333 the 32-bit x86 architecture, it is possible to use a 4-byte jump, but
36334 it depends on the target system being able to create trampolines in
36335 the first 64K of memory, which might or might not be possible for that
36336 system. So the reply to this packet will be 4 if it is able to
36337 arrange for that.
36338
36339 Replies:
36340
36341 @table @samp
36342 @item 0
36343 The minimum instruction length is currently unknown.
36344 @item @var{length}
36345 The minimum instruction length is @var{length}, where @var{length}
36346 is a hexadecimal number greater or equal to 1. A reply
36347 of 1 means that a fast tracepoint may be placed on any instruction
36348 regardless of size.
36349 @item E
36350 An error has occurred.
36351 @item @w{}
36352 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the stub.
36353 @end table
36354
36355 @item QTStart
36356 @cindex @samp{QTStart} packet
36357 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from
36358 tracepoint hits in the trace frame buffer. This packet supports the
36359 @samp{qRelocInsn} reply (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
36360 instruction reply packet}).
36361
36362 @item QTStop
36363 @cindex @samp{QTStop} packet
36364 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
36365
36366 @item QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
36367 @anchor{QTEnable}
36368 @cindex @samp{QTEnable} packet
36369 Enable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
36370 experiment. If the tracepoint was previously disabled, then collection
36371 of data from it will resume.
36372
36373 @item QTDisable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
36374 @anchor{QTDisable}
36375 @cindex @samp{QTDisable} packet
36376 Disable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
36377 experiment. No more data will be collected from the tracepoint unless
36378 @samp{QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}} is subsequently issued.
36379
36380 @item QTinit
36381 @cindex @samp{QTinit} packet
36382 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
36383
36384 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
36385 @cindex @samp{QTro} packet
36386 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
36387 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
36388 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
36389
36390 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
36391 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
36392 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
36393 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
36394
36395 @item QTDisconnected:@var{value}
36396 @cindex @samp{QTDisconnected} packet
36397 Set the choice to what to do with the tracing run when @value{GDBN}
36398 disconnects from the target. A @var{value} of 1 directs the target to
36399 continue the tracing run, while 0 tells the target to stop tracing if
36400 @value{GDBN} is no longer in the picture.
36401
36402 @item qTStatus
36403 @cindex @samp{qTStatus} packet
36404 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
36405
36406 The reply has the form:
36407
36408 @table @samp
36409
36410 @item T@var{running}@r{[};@var{field}@r{]}@dots{}
36411 @var{running} is a single digit @code{1} if the trace is presently
36412 running, or @code{0} if not. It is followed by semicolon-separated
36413 optional fields that an agent may use to report additional status.
36414
36415 @end table
36416
36417 If the trace is not running, the agent may report any of several
36418 explanations as one of the optional fields:
36419
36420 @table @samp
36421
36422 @item tnotrun:0
36423 No trace has been run yet.
36424
36425 @item tstop[:@var{text}]:0
36426 The trace was stopped by a user-originated stop command. The optional
36427 @var{text} field is a user-supplied string supplied as part of the
36428 stop command (for instance, an explanation of why the trace was
36429 stopped manually). It is hex-encoded.
36430
36431 @item tfull:0
36432 The trace stopped because the trace buffer filled up.
36433
36434 @item tdisconnected:0
36435 The trace stopped because @value{GDBN} disconnected from the target.
36436
36437 @item tpasscount:@var{tpnum}
36438 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} exceeded its pass count.
36439
36440 @item terror:@var{text}:@var{tpnum}
36441 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} had an error. The
36442 string @var{text} is available to describe the nature of the error
36443 (for instance, a divide by zero in the condition expression); it
36444 is hex encoded.
36445
36446 @item tunknown:0
36447 The trace stopped for some other reason.
36448
36449 @end table
36450
36451 Additional optional fields supply statistical and other information.
36452 Although not required, they are extremely useful for users monitoring
36453 the progress of a trace run. If a trace has stopped, and these
36454 numbers are reported, they must reflect the state of the just-stopped
36455 trace.
36456
36457 @table @samp
36458
36459 @item tframes:@var{n}
36460 The number of trace frames in the buffer.
36461
36462 @item tcreated:@var{n}
36463 The total number of trace frames created during the run. This may
36464 be larger than the trace frame count, if the buffer is circular.
36465
36466 @item tsize:@var{n}
36467 The total size of the trace buffer, in bytes.
36468
36469 @item tfree:@var{n}
36470 The number of bytes still unused in the buffer.
36471
36472 @item circular:@var{n}
36473 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
36474 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
36475 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
36476 and may fill up.
36477
36478 @item disconn:@var{n}
36479 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
36480 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
36481 that the trace run will stop.
36482
36483 @end table
36484
36485 @item qTP:@var{tp}:@var{addr}
36486 @cindex tracepoint status, remote request
36487 @cindex @samp{qTP} packet
36488 Ask the stub for the current state of tracepoint number @var{tp} at
36489 address @var{addr}.
36490
36491 Replies:
36492 @table @samp
36493 @item V@var{hits}:@var{usage}
36494 The tracepoint has been hit @var{hits} times so far during the trace
36495 run, and accounts for @var{usage} in the trace buffer. Note that
36496 @code{while-stepping} steps are not counted as separate hits, but the
36497 steps' space consumption is added into the usage number.
36498
36499 @end table
36500
36501 @item qTV:@var{var}
36502 @cindex trace state variable value, remote request
36503 @cindex @samp{qTV} packet
36504 Ask the stub for the value of the trace state variable number @var{var}.
36505
36506 Replies:
36507 @table @samp
36508 @item V@var{value}
36509 The value of the variable is @var{value}. This will be the current
36510 value of the variable if the user is examining a running target, or a
36511 saved value if the variable was collected in the trace frame that the
36512 user is looking at. Note that multiple requests may result in
36513 different reply values, such as when requesting values while the
36514 program is running.
36515
36516 @item U
36517 The value of the variable is unknown. This would occur, for example,
36518 if the user is examining a trace frame in which the requested variable
36519 was not collected.
36520 @end table
36521
36522 @item qTfP
36523 @cindex @samp{qTfP} packet
36524 @itemx qTsP
36525 @cindex @samp{qTsP} packet
36526 These packets request data about tracepoints that are being used by
36527 the target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfP} to get the first piece
36528 of data, and multiple @code{qTsP} to get additional pieces. Replies
36529 to these packets generally take the form of the @code{QTDP} packets
36530 that define tracepoints. (FIXME add detailed syntax)
36531
36532 @item qTfV
36533 @cindex @samp{qTfV} packet
36534 @itemx qTsV
36535 @cindex @samp{qTsV} packet
36536 These packets request data about trace state variables that are on the
36537 target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfV} to get the first vari of data,
36538 and multiple @code{qTsV} to get additional variables. Replies to
36539 these packets follow the syntax of the @code{QTDV} packets that define
36540 trace state variables.
36541
36542 @item qTfSTM
36543 @itemx qTsSTM
36544 @anchor{qTfSTM}
36545 @anchor{qTsSTM}
36546 @cindex @samp{qTfSTM} packet
36547 @cindex @samp{qTsSTM} packet
36548 These packets request data about static tracepoint markers that exist
36549 in the target program. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfSTM} to get the
36550 first piece of data, and multiple @code{qTsSTM} to get additional
36551 pieces. Replies to these packets take the following form:
36552
36553 Reply:
36554 @table @samp
36555 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}
36556 A single marker
36557 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra},@var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}@dots{}
36558 a comma-separated list of markers
36559 @item l
36560 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
36561 @item E @var{nn}
36562 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36563 @item @w{}
36564 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the
36565 stub.
36566 @end table
36567
36568 The @var{address} is encoded in hex;
36569 @var{id} and @var{extra} are strings encoded in hex.
36570
36571 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
36572 more markers, separated by commas. @value{GDBN} will respond to each
36573 reply with a request for more markers (using the @samp{qs} form of the
36574 query), until the target responds with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for
36575 @dfn{last}).
36576
36577 @item qTSTMat:@var{address}
36578 @anchor{qTSTMat}
36579 @cindex @samp{qTSTMat} packet
36580 This packets requests data about static tracepoint markers in the
36581 target program at @var{address}. Replies to this packet follow the
36582 syntax of the @samp{qTfSTM} and @code{qTsSTM} packets that list static
36583 tracepoint markers.
36584
36585 @item QTSave:@var{filename}
36586 @cindex @samp{QTSave} packet
36587 This packet directs the target to save trace data to the file name
36588 @var{filename} in the target's filesystem. The @var{filename} is encoded
36589 as a hex string; the interpretation of the file name (relative vs
36590 absolute, wild cards, etc) is up to the target.
36591
36592 @item qTBuffer:@var{offset},@var{len}
36593 @cindex @samp{qTBuffer} packet
36594 Return up to @var{len} bytes of the current contents of trace buffer,
36595 starting at @var{offset}. The trace buffer is treated as if it were
36596 a contiguous collection of traceframes, as per the trace file format.
36597 The reply consists as many hex-encoded bytes as the target can deliver
36598 in a packet; it is not an error to return fewer than were asked for.
36599 A reply consisting of just @code{l} indicates that no bytes are
36600 available.
36601
36602 @item QTBuffer:circular:@var{value}
36603 This packet directs the target to use a circular trace buffer if
36604 @var{value} is 1, or a linear buffer if the value is 0.
36605
36606 @item QTBuffer:size:@var{size}
36607 @anchor{QTBuffer-size}
36608 @cindex @samp{QTBuffer size} packet
36609 This packet directs the target to make the trace buffer be of size
36610 @var{size} if possible. A value of @code{-1} tells the target to
36611 use whatever size it prefers.
36612
36613 @item QTNotes:@r{[}@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@r{[};@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@dots{}
36614 @cindex @samp{QTNotes} packet
36615 This packet adds optional textual notes to the trace run. Allowable
36616 types include @code{user}, @code{notes}, and @code{tstop}, the
36617 @var{text} fields are arbitrary strings, hex-encoded.
36618
36619 @end table
36620
36621 @subsection Relocate instruction reply packet
36622 When installing fast tracepoints in memory, the target may need to
36623 relocate the instruction currently at the tracepoint address to a
36624 different address in memory. For most instructions, a simple copy is
36625 enough, but, for example, call instructions that implicitly push the
36626 return address on the stack, and relative branches or other
36627 PC-relative instructions require offset adjustment, so that the effect
36628 of executing the instruction at a different address is the same as if
36629 it had executed in the original location.
36630
36631 In response to several of the tracepoint packets, the target may also
36632 respond with a number of intermediate @samp{qRelocInsn} request
36633 packets before the final result packet, to have @value{GDBN} handle
36634 this relocation operation. If a packet supports this mechanism, its
36635 documentation will explicitly say so. See for example the above
36636 descriptions for the @samp{QTStart} and @samp{QTDP} packets. The
36637 format of the request is:
36638
36639 @table @samp
36640 @item qRelocInsn:@var{from};@var{to}
36641
36642 This requests @value{GDBN} to copy instruction at address @var{from}
36643 to address @var{to}, possibly adjusted so that executing the
36644 instruction at @var{to} has the same effect as executing it at
36645 @var{from}. @value{GDBN} writes the adjusted instruction to target
36646 memory starting at @var{to}.
36647 @end table
36648
36649 Replies:
36650 @table @samp
36651 @item qRelocInsn:@var{adjusted_size}
36652 Informs the stub the relocation is complete. The @var{adjusted_size} is
36653 the length in bytes of resulting relocated instruction sequence.
36654 @item E @var{NN}
36655 A badly formed request was detected, or an error was encountered while
36656 relocating the instruction.
36657 @end table
36658
36659 @node Host I/O Packets
36660 @section Host I/O Packets
36661 @cindex Host I/O, remote protocol
36662 @cindex file transfer, remote protocol
36663
36664 The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O
36665 operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is
36666 used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own
36667 filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure
36668 layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the
36669 Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated
36670 protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers.
36671 Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the
36672 target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol
36673 Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol.
36674
36675 The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with
36676 its arguments. They have this format:
36677
36678 @table @samp
36679
36680 @item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{}
36681 @var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target
36682 should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking
36683 for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on
36684 the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative
36685 numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not
36686 used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of
36687 hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a
36688 buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
36689
36690 @end table
36691
36692 The valid responses to Host I/O packets are:
36693
36694 @table @samp
36695
36696 @item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}]
36697 @var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually
36698 non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured,
36699 @var{errno} will be included in the result specifying a
36700 value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For
36701 operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a
36702 binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the
36703 normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet
36704 documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and
36705 @var{attachment}.
36706
36707 @item @w{}
36708 An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized.
36709
36710 @end table
36711
36712 These are the supported Host I/O operations:
36713
36714 @table @samp
36715 @item vFile:open: @var{filename}, @var{flags}, @var{mode}
36716 Open a file at @var{filename} and return a file descriptor for it, or
36717 return -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string,
36718 @var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags
36719 (@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask
36720 of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}).
36721 @xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values.
36722
36723 @item vFile:close: @var{fd}
36724 Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or
36725 -1 if an error occurs.
36726
36727 @item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset}
36728 Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to
36729 @var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset}
36730 relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes;
36731 common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file
36732 condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be
36733 returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if
36734 @var{count} was zero.
36735
36736 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
36737 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
36738 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
36739 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
36740 some characters were escaped.
36741
36742 @item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data}
36743 Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding
36744 to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the
36745 file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no
36746 separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the
36747 packet is used. @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written,
36748 which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an
36749 error occurred.
36750
36751 @item vFile:unlink: @var{filename}
36752 Delete the file at @var{filename} on the target. Return 0,
36753 or -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string.
36754
36755 @item vFile:readlink: @var{filename}
36756 Read value of symbolic link @var{filename} on the target. Return
36757 the number of bytes read, or -1 if an error occurs.
36758
36759 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
36760 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
36761 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
36762 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
36763 some characters were escaped.
36764
36765 @end table
36766
36767 @node Interrupts
36768 @section Interrupts
36769 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
36770
36771 When a program on the remote target is running, @value{GDBN} may
36772 attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or
36773 a @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g},
36774 control of which is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{interrupt-sequence}.
36775
36776 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
36777 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does not
36778 currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
36779 interfaces except for TCP, in which case @value{GDBN} sends the
36780 @code{telnet} BREAK sequence.
36781
36782 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
36783 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
36784 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
36785 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
36786 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
36787 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
36788 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
36789 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
36790
36791 @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g} is also known as Magic SysRq g.
36792 When Linux kernel receives this sequence from serial port,
36793 it stops execution and connects to gdb.
36794
36795 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
36796 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
36797 implementation defined. If the target supports debugging of multiple
36798 threads and/or processes, it should attempt to interrupt all
36799 currently-executing threads and processes.
36800 If the stub is successful at interrupting the
36801 running program, it should send one of the stop
36802 reply packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
36803 of successfully stopping the program in all-stop mode, and a stop reply
36804 for each stopped thread in non-stop mode.
36805 Interrupts received while the
36806 program is stopped are discarded.
36807
36808 @node Notification Packets
36809 @section Notification Packets
36810 @cindex notification packets
36811 @cindex packets, notification
36812
36813 The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol includes @dfn{notifications},
36814 packets that require no acknowledgment. Both the GDB and the stub
36815 may send notifications (although the only notifications defined at
36816 present are sent by the stub). Notifications carry information
36817 without incurring the round-trip latency of an acknowledgment, and so
36818 are useful for low-impact communications where occasional packet loss
36819 is not a problem.
36820
36821 A notification packet has the form @samp{% @var{data} #
36822 @var{checksum}}, where @var{data} is the content of the notification,
36823 and @var{checksum} is a checksum of @var{data}, computed and formatted
36824 as for ordinary @value{GDBN} packets. A notification's @var{data}
36825 never contains @samp{$}, @samp{%} or @samp{#} characters. Upon
36826 receiving a notification, the recipient sends no @samp{+} or @samp{-}
36827 to acknowledge the notification's receipt or to report its corruption.
36828
36829 Every notification's @var{data} begins with a name, which contains no
36830 colon characters, followed by a colon character.
36831
36832 Recipients should silently ignore corrupted notifications and
36833 notifications they do not understand. Recipients should restart
36834 timeout periods on receipt of a well-formed notification, whether or
36835 not they understand it.
36836
36837 Senders should only send the notifications described here when this
36838 protocol description specifies that they are permitted. In the
36839 future, we may extend the protocol to permit existing notifications in
36840 new contexts; this rule helps older senders avoid confusing newer
36841 recipients.
36842
36843 (Older versions of @value{GDBN} ignore bytes received until they see
36844 the @samp{$} byte that begins an ordinary packet, so new stubs may
36845 transmit notifications without fear of confusing older clients. There
36846 are no notifications defined for @value{GDBN} to send at the moment, but we
36847 assume that most older stubs would ignore them, as well.)
36848
36849 Each notification is comprised of three parts:
36850 @table @samp
36851 @item @var{name}:@var{event}
36852 The notification packet is sent by the side that initiates the
36853 exchange (currently, only the stub does that), with @var{event}
36854 carrying the specific information about the notification, and
36855 @var{name} specifying the name of the notification.
36856 @item @var{ack}
36857 The acknowledge sent by the other side, usually @value{GDBN}, to
36858 acknowledge the exchange and request the event.
36859 @end table
36860
36861 The purpose of an asynchronous notification mechanism is to report to
36862 @value{GDBN} that something interesting happened in the remote stub.
36863
36864 The remote stub may send notification @var{name}:@var{event}
36865 at any time, but @value{GDBN} acknowledges the notification when
36866 appropriate. The notification event is pending before @value{GDBN}
36867 acknowledges. Only one notification at a time may be pending; if
36868 additional events occur before @value{GDBN} has acknowledged the
36869 previous notification, they must be queued by the stub for later
36870 synchronous transmission in response to @var{ack} packets from
36871 @value{GDBN}. Because the notification mechanism is unreliable,
36872 the stub is permitted to resend a notification if it believes
36873 @value{GDBN} may not have received it.
36874
36875 Specifically, notifications may appear when @value{GDBN} is not
36876 otherwise reading input from the stub, or when @value{GDBN} is
36877 expecting to read a normal synchronous response or a
36878 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgment to a packet it has sent.
36879 Notification packets are distinct from any other communication from
36880 the stub so there is no ambiguity.
36881
36882 After receiving a notification, @value{GDBN} shall acknowledge it by
36883 sending a @var{ack} packet as a regular, synchronous request to the
36884 stub. Such acknowledgment is not required to happen immediately, as
36885 @value{GDBN} is permitted to send other, unrelated packets to the
36886 stub first, which the stub should process normally.
36887
36888 Upon receiving a @var{ack} packet, if the stub has other queued
36889 events to report to @value{GDBN}, it shall respond by sending a
36890 normal @var{event}. @value{GDBN} shall then send another @var{ack}
36891 packet to solicit further responses; again, it is permitted to send
36892 other, unrelated packets as well which the stub should process
36893 normally.
36894
36895 If the stub receives a @var{ack} packet and there are no additional
36896 @var{event} to report, the stub shall return an @samp{OK} response.
36897 At this point, @value{GDBN} has finished processing a notification
36898 and the stub has completed sending any queued events. @value{GDBN}
36899 won't accept any new notifications until the final @samp{OK} is
36900 received . If further notification events occur, the stub shall send
36901 a new notification, @value{GDBN} shall accept the notification, and
36902 the process shall be repeated.
36903
36904 The process of asynchronous notification can be illustrated by the
36905 following example:
36906 @smallexample
36907 <- @code{%%Stop:T0505:98e7ffbf;04:4ce6ffbf;08:b1b6e54c;thread:p7526.7526;core:0;}
36908 @code{...}
36909 -> @code{vStopped}
36910 <- @code{T0505:68f37db7;04:40f37db7;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7528;core:0;}
36911 -> @code{vStopped}
36912 <- @code{T0505:68e3fdb6;04:40e3fdb6;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7529;core:0;}
36913 -> @code{vStopped}
36914 <- @code{OK}
36915 @end smallexample
36916
36917 The following notifications are defined:
36918 @multitable @columnfractions 0.12 0.12 0.38 0.38
36919
36920 @item Notification
36921 @tab Ack
36922 @tab Event
36923 @tab Description
36924
36925 @item Stop
36926 @tab vStopped
36927 @tab @var{reply}. The @var{reply} has the form of a stop reply, as
36928 described in @ref{Stop Reply Packets}. Refer to @ref{Remote Non-Stop},
36929 for information on how these notifications are acknowledged by
36930 @value{GDBN}.
36931 @tab Report an asynchronous stop event in non-stop mode.
36932
36933 @end multitable
36934
36935 @node Remote Non-Stop
36936 @section Remote Protocol Support for Non-Stop Mode
36937
36938 @value{GDBN}'s remote protocol supports non-stop debugging of
36939 multi-threaded programs, as described in @ref{Non-Stop Mode}. If the stub
36940 supports non-stop mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN} by including
36941 @samp{QNonStop+} in its @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36942
36943 @value{GDBN} typically sends a @samp{QNonStop} packet only when
36944 establishing a new connection with the stub. Entering non-stop mode
36945 does not alter the state of any currently-running threads, but targets
36946 must stop all threads in any already-attached processes when entering
36947 all-stop mode. @value{GDBN} uses the @samp{?} packet as necessary to
36948 probe the target state after a mode change.
36949
36950 In non-stop mode, when an attached process encounters an event that
36951 would otherwise be reported with a stop reply, it uses the
36952 asynchronous notification mechanism (@pxref{Notification Packets}) to
36953 inform @value{GDBN}. In contrast to all-stop mode, where all threads
36954 in all processes are stopped when a stop reply is sent, in non-stop
36955 mode only the thread reporting the stop event is stopped. That is,
36956 when reporting a @samp{S} or @samp{T} response to indicate completion
36957 of a step operation, hitting a breakpoint, or a fault, only the
36958 affected thread is stopped; any other still-running threads continue
36959 to run. When reporting a @samp{W} or @samp{X} response, all running
36960 threads belonging to other attached processes continue to run.
36961
36962 In non-stop mode, the target shall respond to the @samp{?} packet as
36963 follows. First, any incomplete stop reply notification/@samp{vStopped}
36964 sequence in progress is abandoned. The target must begin a new
36965 sequence reporting stop events for all stopped threads, whether or not
36966 it has previously reported those events to @value{GDBN}. The first
36967 stop reply is sent as a synchronous reply to the @samp{?} packet, and
36968 subsequent stop replies are sent as responses to @samp{vStopped} packets
36969 using the mechanism described above. The target must not send
36970 asynchronous stop reply notifications until the sequence is complete.
36971 If all threads are running when the target receives the @samp{?} packet,
36972 or if the target is not attached to any process, it shall respond
36973 @samp{OK}.
36974
36975 @node Packet Acknowledgment
36976 @section Packet Acknowledgment
36977
36978 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
36979 @cindex packet acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
36980 By default, when either the host or the target machine receives a packet,
36981 the first response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
36982 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request retransmission).
36983 This mechanism allows the @value{GDBN} remote protocol to operate over
36984 unreliable transport mechanisms, such as a serial line.
36985
36986 In cases where the transport mechanism is itself reliable (such as a pipe or
36987 TCP connection), the @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are redundant.
36988 It may be desirable to disable them in that case to reduce communication
36989 overhead, or for other reasons. This can be accomplished by means of the
36990 @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet; @pxref{QStartNoAckMode}.
36991
36992 When in no-acknowledgment mode, neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or
36993 expect @samp{+}/@samp{-} protocol acknowledgments. The packet
36994 and response format still includes the normal checksum, as described in
36995 @ref{Overview}, but the checksum may be ignored by the receiver.
36996
36997 If the stub supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and prefers to operate in
36998 no-acknowledgment mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN}
36999 by including @samp{QStartNoAckMode+} in its response to @samp{qSupported};
37000 @pxref{qSupported}.
37001 If @value{GDBN} also supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and it has not been
37002 disabled via the @code{set remote noack-packet off} command
37003 (@pxref{Remote Configuration}),
37004 @value{GDBN} may then send a @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet to the stub.
37005 Only then may the stub actually turn off packet acknowledgments.
37006 @value{GDBN} sends a final @samp{+} acknowledgment of the stub's @samp{OK}
37007 response, which can be safely ignored by the stub.
37008
37009 Note that @code{set remote noack-packet} command only affects negotiation
37010 between @value{GDBN} and the stub when subsequent connections are made;
37011 it does not affect the protocol acknowledgment state for any current
37012 connection.
37013 Since @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are enabled by default when a
37014 new connection is established,
37015 there is also no protocol request to re-enable the acknowledgments
37016 for the current connection, once disabled.
37017
37018 @node Examples
37019 @section Examples
37020
37021 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
37022 does not get any direct output:
37023
37024 @smallexample
37025 -> @code{R00}
37026 <- @code{+}
37027 @emph{target restarts}
37028 -> @code{?}
37029 <- @code{+}
37030 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
37031 -> @code{+}
37032 @end smallexample
37033
37034 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
37035
37036 @smallexample
37037 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
37038 <- @code{+}
37039 -> @code{s}
37040 <- @code{+}
37041 @emph{time passes}
37042 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
37043 -> @code{+}
37044 -> @code{g}
37045 <- @code{+}
37046 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
37047 -> @code{+}
37048 @end smallexample
37049
37050 @node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
37051 @section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
37052 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
37053
37054 @menu
37055 * File-I/O Overview::
37056 * Protocol Basics::
37057 * The F Request Packet::
37058 * The F Reply Packet::
37059 * The Ctrl-C Message::
37060 * Console I/O::
37061 * List of Supported Calls::
37062 * Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
37063 * Constants::
37064 * File-I/O Examples::
37065 @end menu
37066
37067 @node File-I/O Overview
37068 @subsection File-I/O Overview
37069 @cindex file-i/o overview
37070
37071 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
37072 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
37073 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
37074 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
37075 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
37076 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
37077
37078 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
37079 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
37080 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
37081 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
37082 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
37083
37084 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
37085 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
37086 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
37087 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
37088 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
37089 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
37090 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
37091
37092 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
37093 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
37094 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
37095 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
37096 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
37097
37098 @smallexample
37099 (@value{GDBP}) continue
37100 <- target requests 'system call X'
37101 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
37102 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
37103 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
37104 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
37105 @end smallexample
37106
37107 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
37108 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
37109 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
37110 system are not supported by this protocol.
37111
37112 File I/O is not supported in non-stop mode.
37113
37114 @node Protocol Basics
37115 @subsection Protocol Basics
37116 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
37117
37118 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
37119 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
37120 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
37121 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
37122 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
37123 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
37124 to call the appropriate host system call:
37125
37126 @itemize @bullet
37127 @item
37128 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
37129
37130 @item
37131 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
37132 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
37133 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
37134 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
37135
37136 @end itemize
37137
37138 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
37139
37140 @itemize @bullet
37141 @item
37142 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
37143 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
37144 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
37145 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
37146 packet.
37147
37148 @item
37149 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
37150 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
37151
37152 @item
37153 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
37154
37155 @item
37156 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
37157
37158 @item
37159 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
37160 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
37161 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
37162 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
37163 packet.
37164
37165 @end itemize
37166
37167 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
37168 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
37169
37170 @itemize @bullet
37171 @item
37172 Return value.
37173
37174 @item
37175 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
37176
37177 @item
37178 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
37179
37180 @end itemize
37181
37182 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
37183 the latest continue or step action.
37184
37185 @node The F Request Packet
37186 @subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
37187 @cindex file-i/o request packet
37188 @cindex @code{F} request packet
37189
37190 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
37191
37192 @table @samp
37193 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
37194
37195 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
37196 This is just the name of the function.
37197
37198 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
37199 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
37200 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
37201 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
37202 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
37203 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
37204 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
37205
37206 @end table
37207
37208
37209
37210 @node The F Reply Packet
37211 @subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
37212 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
37213 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
37214
37215 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
37216
37217 @table @samp
37218
37219 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
37220
37221 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
37222
37223 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
37224 representation.
37225 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
37226
37227 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
37228 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
37229 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
37230
37231 @smallexample
37232 F0,0,C
37233 @end smallexample
37234
37235 @noindent
37236 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
37237
37238 @smallexample
37239 F-1,4,C
37240 @end smallexample
37241
37242 @noindent
37243 assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
37244
37245 @end table
37246
37247
37248 @node The Ctrl-C Message
37249 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
37250 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
37251
37252 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
37253 reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
37254 the target should behave as if it had
37255 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
37256 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
37257 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
37258 packet.
37259
37260 It's important for the target to know in which
37261 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
37262
37263 @itemize @bullet
37264 @item
37265 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
37266
37267 @item
37268 The system call on the host has been finished.
37269
37270 @end itemize
37271
37272 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
37273 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
37274 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
37275 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
37276 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
37277 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
37278
37279 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
37280 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
37281 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
37282 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
37283 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
37284 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
37285 or the full action has been completed.
37286
37287 @node Console I/O
37288 @subsection Console I/O
37289 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
37290
37291 By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
37292 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
37293 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
37294 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
37295 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
37296 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
37297 conditions is met:
37298
37299 @itemize @bullet
37300 @item
37301 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
37302 @code{read}
37303 system call is treated as finished.
37304
37305 @item
37306 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
37307 newline.
37308
37309 @item
37310 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
37311 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
37312
37313 @end itemize
37314
37315 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
37316 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
37317 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
37318 is stopped at the user's request.
37319
37320
37321 @node List of Supported Calls
37322 @subsection List of Supported Calls
37323 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
37324
37325 @menu
37326 * open::
37327 * close::
37328 * read::
37329 * write::
37330 * lseek::
37331 * rename::
37332 * unlink::
37333 * stat/fstat::
37334 * gettimeofday::
37335 * isatty::
37336 * system::
37337 @end menu
37338
37339 @node open
37340 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
37341 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
37342
37343 @table @asis
37344 @item Synopsis:
37345 @smallexample
37346 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
37347 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
37348 @end smallexample
37349
37350 @item Request:
37351 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
37352
37353 @noindent
37354 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
37355
37356 @table @code
37357 @item O_CREAT
37358 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
37359 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
37360 are concerned.
37361
37362 @item O_EXCL
37363 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
37364 an error and open() fails.
37365
37366 @item O_TRUNC
37367 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
37368 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
37369 truncated to zero length.
37370
37371 @item O_APPEND
37372 The file is opened in append mode.
37373
37374 @item O_RDONLY
37375 The file is opened for reading only.
37376
37377 @item O_WRONLY
37378 The file is opened for writing only.
37379
37380 @item O_RDWR
37381 The file is opened for reading and writing.
37382 @end table
37383
37384 @noindent
37385 Other bits are silently ignored.
37386
37387
37388 @noindent
37389 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
37390
37391 @table @code
37392 @item S_IRUSR
37393 User has read permission.
37394
37395 @item S_IWUSR
37396 User has write permission.
37397
37398 @item S_IRGRP
37399 Group has read permission.
37400
37401 @item S_IWGRP
37402 Group has write permission.
37403
37404 @item S_IROTH
37405 Others have read permission.
37406
37407 @item S_IWOTH
37408 Others have write permission.
37409 @end table
37410
37411 @noindent
37412 Other bits are silently ignored.
37413
37414
37415 @item Return value:
37416 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
37417 occurred.
37418
37419 @item Errors:
37420
37421 @table @code
37422 @item EEXIST
37423 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
37424
37425 @item EISDIR
37426 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
37427
37428 @item EACCES
37429 The requested access is not allowed.
37430
37431 @item ENAMETOOLONG
37432 @var{pathname} was too long.
37433
37434 @item ENOENT
37435 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
37436
37437 @item ENODEV
37438 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
37439
37440 @item EROFS
37441 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
37442 write access was requested.
37443
37444 @item EFAULT
37445 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
37446
37447 @item ENOSPC
37448 No space on device to create the file.
37449
37450 @item EMFILE
37451 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
37452
37453 @item ENFILE
37454 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
37455 has been reached.
37456
37457 @item EINTR
37458 The call was interrupted by the user.
37459 @end table
37460
37461 @end table
37462
37463 @node close
37464 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
37465 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
37466
37467 @table @asis
37468 @item Synopsis:
37469 @smallexample
37470 int close(int fd);
37471 @end smallexample
37472
37473 @item Request:
37474 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
37475
37476 @item Return value:
37477 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
37478
37479 @item Errors:
37480
37481 @table @code
37482 @item EBADF
37483 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
37484
37485 @item EINTR
37486 The call was interrupted by the user.
37487 @end table
37488
37489 @end table
37490
37491 @node read
37492 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
37493 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
37494
37495 @table @asis
37496 @item Synopsis:
37497 @smallexample
37498 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
37499 @end smallexample
37500
37501 @item Request:
37502 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
37503
37504 @item Return value:
37505 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
37506 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
37507 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
37508
37509 @item Errors:
37510
37511 @table @code
37512 @item EBADF
37513 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
37514 reading.
37515
37516 @item EFAULT
37517 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
37518
37519 @item EINTR
37520 The call was interrupted by the user.
37521 @end table
37522
37523 @end table
37524
37525 @node write
37526 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
37527 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
37528
37529 @table @asis
37530 @item Synopsis:
37531 @smallexample
37532 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
37533 @end smallexample
37534
37535 @item Request:
37536 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
37537
37538 @item Return value:
37539 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
37540 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
37541 is returned.
37542
37543 @item Errors:
37544
37545 @table @code
37546 @item EBADF
37547 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
37548 writing.
37549
37550 @item EFAULT
37551 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
37552
37553 @item EFBIG
37554 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
37555 host-specific maximum file size allowed.
37556
37557 @item ENOSPC
37558 No space on device to write the data.
37559
37560 @item EINTR
37561 The call was interrupted by the user.
37562 @end table
37563
37564 @end table
37565
37566 @node lseek
37567 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
37568 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
37569
37570 @table @asis
37571 @item Synopsis:
37572 @smallexample
37573 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
37574 @end smallexample
37575
37576 @item Request:
37577 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
37578
37579 @var{flag} is one of:
37580
37581 @table @code
37582 @item SEEK_SET
37583 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
37584
37585 @item SEEK_CUR
37586 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
37587 bytes.
37588
37589 @item SEEK_END
37590 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
37591 bytes.
37592 @end table
37593
37594 @item Return value:
37595 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
37596 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
37597 value of -1 is returned.
37598
37599 @item Errors:
37600
37601 @table @code
37602 @item EBADF
37603 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
37604
37605 @item ESPIPE
37606 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
37607
37608 @item EINVAL
37609 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
37610
37611 @item EINTR
37612 The call was interrupted by the user.
37613 @end table
37614
37615 @end table
37616
37617 @node rename
37618 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
37619 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
37620
37621 @table @asis
37622 @item Synopsis:
37623 @smallexample
37624 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
37625 @end smallexample
37626
37627 @item Request:
37628 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
37629
37630 @item Return value:
37631 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
37632
37633 @item Errors:
37634
37635 @table @code
37636 @item EISDIR
37637 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
37638 directory.
37639
37640 @item EEXIST
37641 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
37642
37643 @item EBUSY
37644 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
37645 process.
37646
37647 @item EINVAL
37648 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
37649 of itself.
37650
37651 @item ENOTDIR
37652 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
37653 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
37654 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
37655
37656 @item EFAULT
37657 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
37658
37659 @item EACCES
37660 No access to the file or the path of the file.
37661
37662 @item ENAMETOOLONG
37663
37664 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
37665
37666 @item ENOENT
37667 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
37668
37669 @item EROFS
37670 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
37671
37672 @item ENOSPC
37673 The device containing the file has no room for the new
37674 directory entry.
37675
37676 @item EINTR
37677 The call was interrupted by the user.
37678 @end table
37679
37680 @end table
37681
37682 @node unlink
37683 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
37684 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
37685
37686 @table @asis
37687 @item Synopsis:
37688 @smallexample
37689 int unlink(const char *pathname);
37690 @end smallexample
37691
37692 @item Request:
37693 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
37694
37695 @item Return value:
37696 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
37697
37698 @item Errors:
37699
37700 @table @code
37701 @item EACCES
37702 No access to the file or the path of the file.
37703
37704 @item EPERM
37705 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
37706
37707 @item EBUSY
37708 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
37709 being used by another process.
37710
37711 @item EFAULT
37712 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
37713
37714 @item ENAMETOOLONG
37715 @var{pathname} was too long.
37716
37717 @item ENOENT
37718 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
37719
37720 @item ENOTDIR
37721 A component of the path is not a directory.
37722
37723 @item EROFS
37724 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
37725
37726 @item EINTR
37727 The call was interrupted by the user.
37728 @end table
37729
37730 @end table
37731
37732 @node stat/fstat
37733 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
37734 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
37735 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
37736
37737 @table @asis
37738 @item Synopsis:
37739 @smallexample
37740 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
37741 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
37742 @end smallexample
37743
37744 @item Request:
37745 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
37746 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
37747
37748 @item Return value:
37749 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
37750
37751 @item Errors:
37752
37753 @table @code
37754 @item EBADF
37755 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
37756
37757 @item ENOENT
37758 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
37759 path is an empty string.
37760
37761 @item ENOTDIR
37762 A component of the path is not a directory.
37763
37764 @item EFAULT
37765 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
37766
37767 @item EACCES
37768 No access to the file or the path of the file.
37769
37770 @item ENAMETOOLONG
37771 @var{pathname} was too long.
37772
37773 @item EINTR
37774 The call was interrupted by the user.
37775 @end table
37776
37777 @end table
37778
37779 @node gettimeofday
37780 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
37781 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
37782
37783 @table @asis
37784 @item Synopsis:
37785 @smallexample
37786 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
37787 @end smallexample
37788
37789 @item Request:
37790 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
37791
37792 @item Return value:
37793 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
37794
37795 @item Errors:
37796
37797 @table @code
37798 @item EINVAL
37799 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
37800
37801 @item EFAULT
37802 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
37803 @end table
37804
37805 @end table
37806
37807 @node isatty
37808 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
37809 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
37810
37811 @table @asis
37812 @item Synopsis:
37813 @smallexample
37814 int isatty(int fd);
37815 @end smallexample
37816
37817 @item Request:
37818 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
37819
37820 @item Return value:
37821 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
37822
37823 @item Errors:
37824
37825 @table @code
37826 @item EINTR
37827 The call was interrupted by the user.
37828 @end table
37829
37830 @end table
37831
37832 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
37833 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
37834 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
37835 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
37836 needed.
37837
37838
37839 @node system
37840 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
37841 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
37842
37843 @table @asis
37844 @item Synopsis:
37845 @smallexample
37846 int system(const char *command);
37847 @end smallexample
37848
37849 @item Request:
37850 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
37851
37852 @item Return value:
37853 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
37854 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
37855 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
37856 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
37857 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
37858 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
37859 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
37860
37861 @item Errors:
37862
37863 @table @code
37864 @item EINTR
37865 The call was interrupted by the user.
37866 @end table
37867
37868 @end table
37869
37870 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
37871 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
37872 the host is simplified before it's returned
37873 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
37874 is discarded, and the return value consists
37875 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
37876
37877 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
37878 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
37879 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
37880
37881 @table @code
37882 @item set remote system-call-allowed
37883 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
37884 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
37885 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
37886
37887 @item show remote system-call-allowed
37888 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
37889 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
37890 protocol.
37891 @end table
37892
37893 @node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
37894 @subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
37895 @cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
37896
37897 @menu
37898 * Integral Datatypes::
37899 * Pointer Values::
37900 * Memory Transfer::
37901 * struct stat::
37902 * struct timeval::
37903 @end menu
37904
37905 @node Integral Datatypes
37906 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
37907 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
37908
37909 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
37910 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
37911 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
37912
37913 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
37914 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
37915
37916 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
37917
37918 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
37919 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
37920
37921 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
37922
37923 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
37924 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
37925 byte order.
37926
37927 @node Pointer Values
37928 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
37929 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
37930
37931 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
37932 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
37933 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
37934 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
37935
37936 @smallexample
37937 @code{1aaf/12}
37938 @end smallexample
37939
37940 @noindent
37941 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
37942 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
37943 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
37944 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
37945
37946 @smallexample
37947 @code{123456/d}
37948 @end smallexample
37949
37950 @node Memory Transfer
37951 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
37952 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
37953
37954 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
37955 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
37956 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
37957 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
37958 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
37959 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
37960 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
37961
37962
37963 @node struct stat
37964 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
37965 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
37966
37967 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
37968 is defined as follows:
37969
37970 @smallexample
37971 struct stat @{
37972 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
37973 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
37974 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
37975 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
37976 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
37977 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
37978 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
37979 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
37980 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
37981 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
37982 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
37983 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
37984 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
37985 @};
37986 @end smallexample
37987
37988 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
37989 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
37990 structure is of size 64 bytes.
37991
37992 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
37993 range of values.
37994
37995 @table @code
37996
37997 @item st_dev
37998 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
37999
38000 @item st_ino
38001 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
38002
38003 @item st_mode
38004 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
38005 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
38006
38007 @item st_uid
38008 @itemx st_gid
38009 @itemx st_rdev
38010 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
38011
38012 @item st_atime
38013 @itemx st_mtime
38014 @itemx st_ctime
38015 These values have a host and file system dependent
38016 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
38017 support exact timing values.
38018 @end table
38019
38020 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
38021 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
38022 continuing.
38023
38024 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
38025 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
38026 get truncated on the target.
38027
38028 @node struct timeval
38029 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
38030 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
38031
38032 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
38033 is defined as follows:
38034
38035 @smallexample
38036 struct timeval @{
38037 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
38038 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
38039 @};
38040 @end smallexample
38041
38042 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
38043 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
38044 structure is of size 8 bytes.
38045
38046 @node Constants
38047 @subsection Constants
38048 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
38049
38050 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
38051 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
38052 values before and after the call as needed.
38053
38054 @menu
38055 * Open Flags::
38056 * mode_t Values::
38057 * Errno Values::
38058 * Lseek Flags::
38059 * Limits::
38060 @end menu
38061
38062 @node Open Flags
38063 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
38064 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
38065
38066 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
38067
38068 @smallexample
38069 O_RDONLY 0x0
38070 O_WRONLY 0x1
38071 O_RDWR 0x2
38072 O_APPEND 0x8
38073 O_CREAT 0x200
38074 O_TRUNC 0x400
38075 O_EXCL 0x800
38076 @end smallexample
38077
38078 @node mode_t Values
38079 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
38080 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
38081
38082 All values are given in octal representation.
38083
38084 @smallexample
38085 S_IFREG 0100000
38086 S_IFDIR 040000
38087 S_IRUSR 0400
38088 S_IWUSR 0200
38089 S_IXUSR 0100
38090 S_IRGRP 040
38091 S_IWGRP 020
38092 S_IXGRP 010
38093 S_IROTH 04
38094 S_IWOTH 02
38095 S_IXOTH 01
38096 @end smallexample
38097
38098 @node Errno Values
38099 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
38100 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
38101
38102 All values are given in decimal representation.
38103
38104 @smallexample
38105 EPERM 1
38106 ENOENT 2
38107 EINTR 4
38108 EBADF 9
38109 EACCES 13
38110 EFAULT 14
38111 EBUSY 16
38112 EEXIST 17
38113 ENODEV 19
38114 ENOTDIR 20
38115 EISDIR 21
38116 EINVAL 22
38117 ENFILE 23
38118 EMFILE 24
38119 EFBIG 27
38120 ENOSPC 28
38121 ESPIPE 29
38122 EROFS 30
38123 ENAMETOOLONG 91
38124 EUNKNOWN 9999
38125 @end smallexample
38126
38127 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
38128 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
38129
38130 @node Lseek Flags
38131 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
38132 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
38133
38134 @smallexample
38135 SEEK_SET 0
38136 SEEK_CUR 1
38137 SEEK_END 2
38138 @end smallexample
38139
38140 @node Limits
38141 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
38142 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
38143
38144 All values are given in decimal representation.
38145
38146 @smallexample
38147 INT_MIN -2147483648
38148 INT_MAX 2147483647
38149 UINT_MAX 4294967295
38150 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
38151 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
38152 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
38153 @end smallexample
38154
38155 @node File-I/O Examples
38156 @subsection File-I/O Examples
38157 @cindex file-i/o examples
38158
38159 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
38160 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
38161
38162 @smallexample
38163 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
38164 @emph{request memory read from target}
38165 -> @code{m1234,6}
38166 <- XXXXXX
38167 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
38168 -> @code{F6}
38169 @end smallexample
38170
38171 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
38172 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
38173
38174 @smallexample
38175 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
38176 @emph{request memory write to target}
38177 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
38178 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
38179 -> @code{F6}
38180 @end smallexample
38181
38182 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
38183 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
38184
38185 @smallexample
38186 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
38187 -> @code{F-1,9}
38188 @end smallexample
38189
38190 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
38191 host is called:
38192
38193 @smallexample
38194 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
38195 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
38196 <- @code{T02}
38197 @end smallexample
38198
38199 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
38200 host is called:
38201
38202 @smallexample
38203 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
38204 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
38205 <- @code{T02}
38206 @end smallexample
38207
38208 @node Library List Format
38209 @section Library List Format
38210 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
38211
38212 On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
38213 same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
38214 @value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
38215 operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
38216 platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
38217 @value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
38218 through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
38219 packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
38220 queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
38221 are loaded.
38222
38223 The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
38224 lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
38225 associated name and one or more segment or section base addresses,
38226 which report where the library was loaded in memory.
38227
38228 For the common case of libraries that are fully linked binaries, the
38229 library should have a list of segments. If the target supports
38230 dynamic linking of a relocatable object file, its library XML element
38231 should instead include a list of allocated sections. The segment or
38232 section bases are start addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not
38233 depend on the library's link-time base addresses.
38234
38235 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
38236 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
38237
38238 A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
38239 offset, looks like this:
38240
38241 @smallexample
38242 <library-list>
38243 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
38244 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
38245 </library>
38246 </library-list>
38247 @end smallexample
38248
38249 Another simple memory map, with one loaded library with three
38250 allocated sections (.text, .data, .bss), looks like this:
38251
38252 @smallexample
38253 <library-list>
38254 <library name="sharedlib.o">
38255 <section address="0x10000000"/>
38256 <section address="0x20000000"/>
38257 <section address="0x30000000"/>
38258 </library>
38259 </library-list>
38260 @end smallexample
38261
38262 The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
38263
38264 @smallexample
38265 <!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
38266 <!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
38267 <!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
38268 <!ELEMENT library (segment*, section*)>
38269 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
38270 <!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
38271 <!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
38272 <!ELEMENT section EMPTY>
38273 <!ATTLIST section address CDATA #REQUIRED>
38274 @end smallexample
38275
38276 In addition, segments and section descriptors cannot be mixed within a
38277 single library element, and you must supply at least one segment or
38278 section for each library.
38279
38280 @node Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
38281 @section Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
38282 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
38283
38284 On SVR4 platforms @value{GDBN} can use the symbol table of a dynamic loader
38285 (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) and normal memory operations to maintain a list of
38286 shared libraries. Still a special library list provided by this packet is
38287 more efficient for the @value{GDBN} remote protocol.
38288
38289 The @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet returns an XML document which lists
38290 loaded libraries and their SVR4 linker parameters. For each library on SVR4
38291 target, the following parameters are reported:
38292
38293 @itemize @minus
38294 @item
38295 @code{name}, the absolute file name from the @code{l_name} field of
38296 @code{struct link_map}.
38297 @item
38298 @code{lm} with address of @code{struct link_map} used for TLS
38299 (Thread Local Storage) access.
38300 @item
38301 @code{l_addr}, the displacement as read from the field @code{l_addr} of
38302 @code{struct link_map}. For prelinked libraries this is not an absolute
38303 memory address. It is a displacement of absolute memory address against
38304 address the file was prelinked to during the library load.
38305 @item
38306 @code{l_ld}, which is memory address of the @code{PT_DYNAMIC} segment
38307 @end itemize
38308
38309 Additionally the single @code{main-lm} attribute specifies address of
38310 @code{struct link_map} used for the main executable. This parameter is used
38311 for TLS access and its presence is optional.
38312
38313 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
38314 SVR4 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
38315
38316 A simple memory map, with two loaded libraries (which do not use prelink),
38317 looks like this:
38318
38319 @smallexample
38320 <library-list-svr4 version="1.0" main-lm="0xe4f8f8">
38321 <library name="/lib/ld-linux.so.2" lm="0xe4f51c" l_addr="0xe2d000"
38322 l_ld="0xe4eefc"/>
38323 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6" lm="0xe4fbe8" l_addr="0x154000"
38324 l_ld="0x152350"/>
38325 </library-list-svr>
38326 @end smallexample
38327
38328 The format of an SVR4 library list is described by this DTD:
38329
38330 @smallexample
38331 <!-- library-list-svr4: Root element with versioning -->
38332 <!ELEMENT library-list-svr4 (library)*>
38333 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
38334 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 main-lm CDATA #IMPLIED>
38335 <!ELEMENT library EMPTY>
38336 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
38337 <!ATTLIST library lm CDATA #REQUIRED>
38338 <!ATTLIST library l_addr CDATA #REQUIRED>
38339 <!ATTLIST library l_ld CDATA #REQUIRED>
38340 @end smallexample
38341
38342 @node Memory Map Format
38343 @section Memory Map Format
38344 @cindex memory map format
38345
38346 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
38347 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
38348 memory map.
38349
38350 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
38351 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
38352 lists memory regions.
38353
38354 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
38355 memory maps. @xref{Expat}.
38356
38357 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
38358
38359 @smallexample
38360 <?xml version="1.0"?>
38361 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
38362 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
38363 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
38364 <memory-map>
38365 region...
38366 </memory-map>
38367 @end smallexample
38368
38369 Each region can be either:
38370
38371 @itemize
38372
38373 @item
38374 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
38375 bytes from there:
38376
38377 @smallexample
38378 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
38379 @end smallexample
38380
38381
38382 @item
38383 A region of read-only memory:
38384
38385 @smallexample
38386 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
38387 @end smallexample
38388
38389
38390 @item
38391 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
38392 bytes in length:
38393
38394 @smallexample
38395 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
38396 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
38397 </memory>
38398 @end smallexample
38399
38400 @end itemize
38401
38402 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
38403 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
38404 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
38405
38406 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
38407
38408 @smallexample
38409 <!-- ................................................... -->
38410 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
38411 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
38412 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
38413 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
38414 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
38415 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory | property)>
38416 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
38417 <!ELEMENT memory (property)>
38418 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
38419 and its type, or device. -->
38420 <!ATTLIST memory type CDATA #REQUIRED
38421 start CDATA #REQUIRED
38422 length CDATA #REQUIRED
38423 device CDATA #IMPLIED>
38424 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
38425 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
38426 <!ATTLIST property name CDATA #REQUIRED>
38427 @end smallexample
38428
38429 @node Thread List Format
38430 @section Thread List Format
38431 @cindex thread list format
38432
38433 To efficiently update the list of threads and their attributes,
38434 @value{GDBN} issues the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
38435 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}) and obtains the XML document with
38436 the following structure:
38437
38438 @smallexample
38439 <?xml version="1.0"?>
38440 <threads>
38441 <thread id="id" core="0">
38442 ... description ...
38443 </thread>
38444 </threads>
38445 @end smallexample
38446
38447 Each @samp{thread} element must have the @samp{id} attribute that
38448 identifies the thread (@pxref{thread-id syntax}). The
38449 @samp{core} attribute, if present, specifies which processor core
38450 the thread was last executing on. The content of the of @samp{thread}
38451 element is interpreted as human-readable auxilliary information.
38452
38453 @node Traceframe Info Format
38454 @section Traceframe Info Format
38455 @cindex traceframe info format
38456
38457 To be able to know which objects in the inferior can be examined when
38458 inspecting a tracepoint hit, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of
38459 memory ranges, registers and trace state variables that have been
38460 collected in a traceframe.
38461
38462 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
38463 (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}) packet and is an XML document.
38464
38465 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
38466 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
38467
38468 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
38469
38470 @smallexample
38471 <?xml version="1.0"?>
38472 <!DOCTYPE traceframe-info
38473 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
38474 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-traceframe-info.dtd">
38475 <traceframe-info>
38476 block...
38477 </traceframe-info>
38478 @end smallexample
38479
38480 Each traceframe block can be either:
38481
38482 @itemize
38483
38484 @item
38485 A region of collected memory starting at @var{addr} and extending for
38486 @var{length} bytes from there:
38487
38488 @smallexample
38489 <memory start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
38490 @end smallexample
38491
38492 @item
38493 A block indicating trace state variable numbered @var{number} has been
38494 collected:
38495
38496 @smallexample
38497 <tvar id="@var{number}"/>
38498 @end smallexample
38499
38500 @end itemize
38501
38502 The formal DTD for the traceframe info format is given below:
38503
38504 @smallexample
38505 <!ELEMENT traceframe-info (memory | tvar)* >
38506 <!ATTLIST traceframe-info version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
38507
38508 <!ELEMENT memory EMPTY>
38509 <!ATTLIST memory start CDATA #REQUIRED
38510 length CDATA #REQUIRED>
38511 <!ELEMENT tvar>
38512 <!ATTLIST tvar id CDATA #REQUIRED>
38513 @end smallexample
38514
38515 @node Branch Trace Format
38516 @section Branch Trace Format
38517 @cindex branch trace format
38518
38519 In order to display the branch trace of an inferior thread,
38520 @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of branches. This list is
38521 represented as list of sequential code blocks that are connected via
38522 branches. The code in each block has been executed sequentially.
38523
38524 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
38525 (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}) packet and is an XML document.
38526
38527 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
38528 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
38529
38530 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
38531
38532 @smallexample
38533 <?xml version="1.0"?>
38534 <!DOCTYPE btrace
38535 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Branch Trace V1.0//EN"
38536 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-btrace.dtd">
38537 <btrace>
38538 block...
38539 </btrace>
38540 @end smallexample
38541
38542 @itemize
38543
38544 @item
38545 A block of sequentially executed instructions starting at @var{begin}
38546 and ending at @var{end}:
38547
38548 @smallexample
38549 <block begin="@var{begin}" end="@var{end}"/>
38550 @end smallexample
38551
38552 @end itemize
38553
38554 The formal DTD for the branch trace format is given below:
38555
38556 @smallexample
38557 <!ELEMENT btrace (block)* >
38558 <!ATTLIST btrace version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
38559
38560 <!ELEMENT block EMPTY>
38561 <!ATTLIST block begin CDATA #REQUIRED
38562 end CDATA #REQUIRED>
38563 @end smallexample
38564
38565 @include agentexpr.texi
38566
38567 @node Target Descriptions
38568 @appendix Target Descriptions
38569 @cindex target descriptions
38570
38571 One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
38572 is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
38573 architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
38574 a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or @acronym{MIPS}, for example ---
38575 and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
38576 architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
38577 vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
38578
38579 @itemize @bullet
38580 @item
38581 With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
38582 the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
38583 @item
38584 Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
38585 audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
38586 variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
38587 @item
38588 When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
38589 at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
38590 @command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
38591 @end itemize
38592
38593 To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
38594 target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
38595 actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
38596 processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
38597 descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
38598
38599 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
38600 target descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
38601
38602 @menu
38603 * Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
38604 * Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
38605 * Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
38606 descriptions.
38607 * Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
38608 @end menu
38609
38610 @node Retrieving Descriptions
38611 @section Retrieving Descriptions
38612
38613 Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
38614 specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
38615 description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
38616 protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
38617 qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
38618 @samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
38619 XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
38620 Format}.
38621
38622 Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
38623 If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
38624 specify a file are:
38625
38626 @table @code
38627 @cindex set tdesc filename
38628 @item set tdesc filename @var{path}
38629 Read the target description from @var{path}.
38630
38631 @cindex unset tdesc filename
38632 @item unset tdesc filename
38633 Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
38634 will use the description supplied by the current target.
38635
38636 @cindex show tdesc filename
38637 @item show tdesc filename
38638 Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
38639 @end table
38640
38641
38642 @node Target Description Format
38643 @section Target Description Format
38644 @cindex target descriptions, XML format
38645
38646 A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
38647 document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
38648 the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
38649 means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
38650 check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
38651 However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
38652 their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
38653
38654 Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
38655 and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
38656 sets. They can also identify the OS ABI of the remote target.
38657 @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
38658 target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
38659
38660 Here is a simple target description:
38661
38662 @smallexample
38663 <target version="1.0">
38664 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
38665 </target>
38666 @end smallexample
38667
38668 @noindent
38669 This minimal description only says that the target uses
38670 the x86-64 architecture.
38671
38672 A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
38673 optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
38674 are explained further below.
38675
38676 @smallexample
38677 <?xml version="1.0"?>
38678 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
38679 <target version="1.0">
38680 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
38681 @r{[}@var{osabi}@r{]}
38682 @r{[}@var{compatible}@r{]}
38683 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
38684 </target>
38685 @end smallexample
38686
38687 @noindent
38688 The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
38689 breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
38690 declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
38691 (@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
38692 useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
38693 @samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
38694 including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
38695 revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
38696 the version mismatch.
38697
38698 @subsection Inclusion
38699 @cindex target descriptions, inclusion
38700 @cindex XInclude
38701 @ifnotinfo
38702 @cindex <xi:include>
38703 @end ifnotinfo
38704
38705 It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
38706 several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
38707 share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
38708 divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
38709 the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
38710
38711 @smallexample
38712 <xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
38713 @end smallexample
38714
38715 @noindent
38716 When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
38717 the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
38718 the contents of that document. If the current description was read
38719 using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
38720 @var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
38721 current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
38722 @var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
38723 original description.
38724
38725 @subsection Architecture
38726 @cindex <architecture>
38727
38728 An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
38729
38730 @smallexample
38731 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
38732 @end smallexample
38733
38734 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
38735 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
38736
38737 @subsection OS ABI
38738 @cindex @code{<osabi>}
38739
38740 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
38741 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
38742
38743 An @samp{<osabi>} element has this form:
38744
38745 @smallexample
38746 <osabi>@var{abi-name}</osabi>
38747 @end smallexample
38748
38749 @var{abi-name} is an OS ABI name from the same selection accepted by
38750 @w{@code{set osabi}} (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
38751
38752 @subsection Compatible Architecture
38753 @cindex @code{<compatible>}
38754
38755 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
38756 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
38757
38758 A @samp{<compatible>} element has this form:
38759
38760 @smallexample
38761 <compatible>@var{arch}</compatible>
38762 @end smallexample
38763
38764 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
38765 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
38766
38767 A @samp{<compatible>} element is used to specify that the target
38768 is able to run binaries in some other than the main target architecture
38769 given by the @samp{<architecture>} element. For example, on the
38770 Cell Broadband Engine, the main architecture is @code{powerpc:common}
38771 or @code{powerpc:common64}, but the system is able to run binaries
38772 in the @code{spu} architecture as well. The way to describe this
38773 capability with @samp{<compatible>} is as follows:
38774
38775 @smallexample
38776 <architecture>powerpc:common</architecture>
38777 <compatible>spu</compatible>
38778 @end smallexample
38779
38780 @subsection Features
38781 @cindex <feature>
38782
38783 Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
38784 system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
38785 registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
38786 has this form:
38787
38788 @smallexample
38789 <feature name="@var{name}">
38790 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
38791 @var{reg}@dots{}
38792 </feature>
38793 @end smallexample
38794
38795 @noindent
38796 Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
38797 of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
38798 knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
38799 should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
38800
38801 @subsection Types
38802
38803 Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
38804 interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
38805 but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
38806 Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
38807 Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite types.
38808
38809 Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
38810 a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
38811 Types must be defined before they are used.
38812
38813 @cindex <vector>
38814 Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
38815 of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
38816 specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
38817 @var{count}:
38818
38819 @smallexample
38820 <vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
38821 @end smallexample
38822
38823 @cindex <union>
38824 If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
38825 with a union type containing the useful representations. The
38826 @samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
38827 each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
38828
38829 @smallexample
38830 <union id="@var{id}">
38831 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
38832 @dots{}
38833 </union>
38834 @end smallexample
38835
38836 @cindex <struct>
38837 If a register's value is composed from several separate values, define
38838 it with a structure type. There are two forms of the @samp{<struct>}
38839 element; a @samp{<struct>} element must either contain only bitfields
38840 or contain no bitfields. If the structure contains only bitfields,
38841 its total size in bytes must be specified, each bitfield must have an
38842 explicit start and end, and bitfields are automatically assigned an
38843 integer type. The field's @var{start} should be less than or
38844 equal to its @var{end}, and zero represents the least significant bit.
38845
38846 @smallexample
38847 <struct id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
38848 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}"/>
38849 @dots{}
38850 </struct>
38851 @end smallexample
38852
38853 If the structure contains no bitfields, then each field has an
38854 explicit type, and no implicit padding is added.
38855
38856 @smallexample
38857 <struct id="@var{id}">
38858 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
38859 @dots{}
38860 </struct>
38861 @end smallexample
38862
38863 @cindex <flags>
38864 If a register's value is a series of single-bit flags, define it with
38865 a flags type. The @samp{<flags>} element has an explicit @var{size}
38866 and contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements. Each field has a
38867 @var{name}, a @var{start}, and an @var{end}. Only single-bit flags
38868 are supported.
38869
38870 @smallexample
38871 <flags id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
38872 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}"/>
38873 @dots{}
38874 </flags>
38875 @end smallexample
38876
38877 @subsection Registers
38878 @cindex <reg>
38879
38880 Each register is represented as an element with this form:
38881
38882 @smallexample
38883 <reg name="@var{name}"
38884 bitsize="@var{size}"
38885 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
38886 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
38887 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
38888 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
38889 @end smallexample
38890
38891 @noindent
38892 The components are as follows:
38893
38894 @table @var
38895
38896 @item name
38897 The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
38898
38899 @item bitsize
38900 The register's size, in bits.
38901
38902 @item regnum
38903 The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
38904 than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
38905 a preceding feature); the first register in the target description
38906 defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
38907 the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
38908 packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
38909 in order of increasing register number.
38910
38911 @item save-restore
38912 Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
38913 calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
38914 @code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
38915 some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
38916 ABI.
38917
38918 @item type
38919 The type of the register. It may be a predefined type, a type
38920 defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
38921 and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
38922 for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
38923 architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
38924 @var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
38925
38926 @item group
38927 The register group to which this register belongs. It must
38928 be either @code{general}, @code{float}, or @code{vector}. If no
38929 @var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register
38930 in @code{info registers}.
38931
38932 @end table
38933
38934 @node Predefined Target Types
38935 @section Predefined Target Types
38936 @cindex target descriptions, predefined types
38937
38938 Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
38939 from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
38940 standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
38941 types. The currently supported types are:
38942
38943 @table @code
38944
38945 @item int8
38946 @itemx int16
38947 @itemx int32
38948 @itemx int64
38949 @itemx int128
38950 Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
38951
38952 @item uint8
38953 @itemx uint16
38954 @itemx uint32
38955 @itemx uint64
38956 @itemx uint128
38957 Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
38958
38959 @item code_ptr
38960 @itemx data_ptr
38961 Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
38962 any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
38963 pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
38964 address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
38965 may be marked as data pointers.
38966
38967 @item ieee_single
38968 Single precision IEEE floating point.
38969
38970 @item ieee_double
38971 Double precision IEEE floating point.
38972
38973 @item arm_fpa_ext
38974 The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
38975
38976 @item i387_ext
38977 The 10-byte extended precision format used by x87 registers.
38978
38979 @item i386_eflags
38980 32bit @sc{eflags} register used by x86.
38981
38982 @item i386_mxcsr
38983 32bit @sc{mxcsr} register used by x86.
38984
38985 @end table
38986
38987 @node Standard Target Features
38988 @section Standard Target Features
38989 @cindex target descriptions, standard features
38990
38991 A target description must contain either no registers or all the
38992 target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
38993 @value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
38994 the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
38995 default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
38996 described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
38997 can recognize them.
38998
38999 This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
39000 which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
39001 with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
39002 if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
39003 feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
39004 description. You can add additional registers to any of the
39005 standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
39006 they were added to an unrecognized feature.
39007
39008 This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
39009 Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
39010 @value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
39011
39012 Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
39013 company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
39014 architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
39015 containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
39016
39017 The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
39018 of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
39019 registers using the capitalization used in the description.
39020
39021 @menu
39022 * AArch64 Features::
39023 * ARM Features::
39024 * i386 Features::
39025 * MicroBlaze Features::
39026 * MIPS Features::
39027 * M68K Features::
39028 * Nios II Features::
39029 * PowerPC Features::
39030 * S/390 and System z Features::
39031 * TIC6x Features::
39032 @end menu
39033
39034
39035 @node AArch64 Features
39036 @subsection AArch64 Features
39037 @cindex target descriptions, AArch64 features
39038
39039 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.core} feature is required for AArch64
39040 targets. It should contain registers @samp{x0} through @samp{x30},
39041 @samp{sp}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
39042
39043 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
39044 it should contain registers @samp{v0} through @samp{v31}, @samp{fpsr},
39045 and @samp{fpcr}.
39046
39047 @node ARM Features
39048 @subsection ARM Features
39049 @cindex target descriptions, ARM features
39050
39051 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for non-M-profile
39052 ARM targets.
39053 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
39054 @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
39055
39056 For M-profile targets (e.g. Cortex-M3), the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}
39057 feature is replaced by @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.m-profile}. It should contain
39058 registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp}, @samp{lr}, @samp{pc},
39059 and @samp{xpsr}.
39060
39061 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
39062 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
39063
39064 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
39065 it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
39066 @samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
39067 @samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
39068
39069 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} feature is optional. If present, it
39070 should contain at least registers @samp{d0} through @samp{d15}. If
39071 they are present, @samp{d16} through @samp{d31} should also be included.
39072 @value{GDBN} will synthesize the single-precision registers from
39073 halves of the double-precision registers.
39074
39075 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.neon} feature is optional. It does not
39076 need to contain registers; it instructs @value{GDBN} to display the
39077 VFP double-precision registers as vectors and to synthesize the
39078 quad-precision registers from pairs of double-precision registers.
39079 If this feature is present, @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} must also
39080 be present and include 32 double-precision registers.
39081
39082 @node i386 Features
39083 @subsection i386 Features
39084 @cindex target descriptions, i386 features
39085
39086 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.core} feature is required for i386/amd64
39087 targets. It should describe the following registers:
39088
39089 @itemize @minus
39090 @item
39091 @samp{eax} through @samp{edi} plus @samp{eip} for i386
39092 @item
39093 @samp{rax} through @samp{r15} plus @samp{rip} for amd64
39094 @item
39095 @samp{eflags}, @samp{cs}, @samp{ss}, @samp{ds}, @samp{es},
39096 @samp{fs}, @samp{gs}
39097 @item
39098 @samp{st0} through @samp{st7}
39099 @item
39100 @samp{fctrl}, @samp{fstat}, @samp{ftag}, @samp{fiseg}, @samp{fioff},
39101 @samp{foseg}, @samp{fooff} and @samp{fop}
39102 @end itemize
39103
39104 The register sets may be different, depending on the target.
39105
39106 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature is optional. It should
39107 describe registers:
39108
39109 @itemize @minus
39110 @item
39111 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm7} for i386
39112 @item
39113 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm15} for amd64
39114 @item
39115 @samp{mxcsr}
39116 @end itemize
39117
39118 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature is optional and requires the
39119 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature. It should
39120 describe the upper 128 bits of @sc{ymm} registers:
39121
39122 @itemize @minus
39123 @item
39124 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm7h} for i386
39125 @item
39126 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm15h} for amd64
39127 @end itemize
39128
39129 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.mpx} is an optional feature representing Intel(R)
39130 Memory Protection Extension (MPX). It should describe the following registers:
39131
39132 @itemize @minus
39133 @item
39134 @samp{bnd0raw} through @samp{bnd3raw} for i386 and amd64.
39135 @item
39136 @samp{bndcfgu} and @samp{bndstatus} for i386 and amd64.
39137 @end itemize
39138
39139 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.linux} feature is optional. It should
39140 describe a single register, @samp{orig_eax}.
39141
39142 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx512} feature is optional and requires the
39143 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature. It should
39144 describe additional @sc{xmm} registers:
39145
39146 @itemize @minus
39147 @item
39148 @samp{xmm16h} through @samp{xmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
39149 @end itemize
39150
39151 It should describe the upper 128 bits of additional @sc{ymm} registers:
39152
39153 @itemize @minus
39154 @item
39155 @samp{ymm16h} through @samp{ymm31h}, only valid for amd64.
39156 @end itemize
39157
39158 It should
39159 describe the upper 256 bits of @sc{zmm} registers:
39160
39161 @itemize @minus
39162 @item
39163 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm7h} for i386.
39164 @item
39165 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm15h} for amd64.
39166 @end itemize
39167
39168 It should
39169 describe the additional @sc{zmm} registers:
39170
39171 @itemize @minus
39172 @item
39173 @samp{zmm16h} through @samp{zmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
39174 @end itemize
39175
39176 @node MicroBlaze Features
39177 @subsection MicroBlaze Features
39178 @cindex target descriptions, MicroBlaze features
39179
39180 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.core} feature is required for MicroBlaze
39181 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
39182 @samp{rpc}, @samp{rmsr}, @samp{rear}, @samp{resr}, @samp{rfsr}, @samp{rbtr},
39183 @samp{rpvr}, @samp{rpvr1} through @samp{rpvr11}, @samp{redr}, @samp{rpid},
39184 @samp{rzpr}, @samp{rtlbx}, @samp{rtlbsx}, @samp{rtlblo}, and @samp{rtlbhi}.
39185
39186 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.stack-protect} feature is optional.
39187 If present, it should contain registers @samp{rshr} and @samp{rslr}
39188
39189 @node MIPS Features
39190 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Features
39191 @cindex target descriptions, @acronym{MIPS} features
39192
39193 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for @acronym{MIPS} targets.
39194 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
39195 @samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
39196 on the target.
39197
39198 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
39199 contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
39200 registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
39201
39202 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
39203 it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
39204 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
39205 @samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
39206
39207 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.dsp} feature is optional. It should
39208 contain registers @samp{hi1} through @samp{hi3}, @samp{lo1} through
39209 @samp{lo3}, and @samp{dspctl}. The @samp{dspctl} register should
39210 be 32-bit and the rest may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
39211
39212 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
39213 contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
39214 Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
39215
39216 @node M68K Features
39217 @subsection M68K Features
39218 @cindex target descriptions, M68K features
39219
39220 @table @code
39221 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
39222 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
39223 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
39224 One of those features must be always present.
39225 The feature that is present determines which flavor of m68k is
39226 used. The feature that is present should contain registers
39227 @samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
39228 @samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
39229
39230 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
39231 This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
39232 @samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
39233 @samp{fpiaddr}.
39234 @end table
39235
39236 @node Nios II Features
39237 @subsection Nios II Features
39238 @cindex target descriptions, Nios II features
39239
39240 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nios2.cpu} feature is required for Nios II
39241 targets. It should contain the 32 core registers (@samp{zero},
39242 @samp{at}, @samp{r2} through @samp{r23}, @samp{et} through @samp{ra}),
39243 @samp{pc}, and the 16 control registers (@samp{status} through
39244 @samp{mpuacc}).
39245
39246 @node PowerPC Features
39247 @subsection PowerPC Features
39248 @cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
39249
39250 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
39251 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
39252 @samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
39253 @samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
39254
39255 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should
39256 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
39257
39258 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should
39259 contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr},
39260 and @samp{vrsave}.
39261
39262 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.vsx} feature is optional. It should
39263 contain registers @samp{vs0h} through @samp{vs31h}. @value{GDBN}
39264 will combine these registers with the floating point registers
39265 (@samp{f0} through @samp{f31}) and the altivec registers (@samp{vr0}
39266 through @samp{vr31}) to present the 128-bit wide registers @samp{vs0}
39267 through @samp{vs63}, the set of vector registers for POWER7.
39268
39269 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should
39270 contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
39271 @samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
39272 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
39273 @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine
39274 these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
39275 user.
39276
39277 @node S/390 and System z Features
39278 @subsection S/390 and System z Features
39279 @cindex target descriptions, S/390 features
39280 @cindex target descriptions, System z features
39281
39282 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.core} feature is required for S/390 and
39283 System z targets. It should contain the PSW and the 16 general
39284 registers. In particular, System z targets should provide the 64-bit
39285 registers @samp{pswm}, @samp{pswa}, and @samp{r0} through @samp{r15}.
39286 S/390 targets should provide the 32-bit versions of these registers.
39287 A System z target that runs in 31-bit addressing mode should provide
39288 32-bit versions of @samp{pswm} and @samp{pswa}, as well as the general
39289 register's upper halves @samp{r0h} through @samp{r15h}, and their
39290 lower halves @samp{r0l} through @samp{r15l}.
39291
39292 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.fpr} feature is required. It should
39293 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f15}, and
39294 @samp{fpc}.
39295
39296 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.acr} feature is required. It should
39297 contain the 32-bit registers @samp{acr0} through @samp{acr15}.
39298
39299 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.linux} feature is optional. It should
39300 contain the register @samp{orig_r2}, which is 64-bit wide on System z
39301 targets and 32-bit otherwise. In addition, the feature may contain
39302 the @samp{last_break} register, whose width depends on the addressing
39303 mode, as well as the @samp{system_call} register, which is always
39304 32-bit wide.
39305
39306 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.tdb} feature is optional. It should
39307 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{tdb0}, @samp{tac}, @samp{tct},
39308 @samp{atia}, and @samp{tr0} through @samp{tr15}.
39309
39310 @node TIC6x Features
39311 @subsection TMS320C6x Features
39312 @cindex target descriptions, TIC6x features
39313 @cindex target descriptions, TMS320C6x features
39314 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.core} feature is required for TMS320C6x
39315 targets. It should contain registers @samp{A0} through @samp{A15},
39316 registers @samp{B0} through @samp{B15}, @samp{CSR} and @samp{PC}.
39317
39318 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.gp} feature is optional. It should
39319 contain registers @samp{A16} through @samp{A31} and @samp{B16}
39320 through @samp{B31}.
39321
39322 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.c6xp} feature is optional. It should
39323 contain registers @samp{TSR}, @samp{ILC} and @samp{RILC}.
39324
39325 @node Operating System Information
39326 @appendix Operating System Information
39327 @cindex operating system information
39328
39329 @menu
39330 * Process list::
39331 @end menu
39332
39333 Users of @value{GDBN} often wish to obtain information about the state of
39334 the operating system running on the target---for example the list of
39335 processes, or the list of open files. This section describes the
39336 mechanism that makes it possible. This mechanism is similar to the
39337 target features mechanism (@pxref{Target Descriptions}), but focuses
39338 on a different aspect of target.
39339
39340 Operating system information is retrived from the target via the
39341 remote protocol, using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{qXfer osdata
39342 read}). The object name in the request should be @samp{osdata}, and
39343 the @var{annex} identifies the data to be fetched.
39344
39345 @node Process list
39346 @appendixsection Process list
39347 @cindex operating system information, process list
39348
39349 When requesting the process list, the @var{annex} field in the
39350 @samp{qXfer} request should be @samp{processes}. The returned data is
39351 an XML document. The formal syntax of this document is defined in
39352 @file{gdb/features/osdata.dtd}.
39353
39354 An example document is:
39355
39356 @smallexample
39357 <?xml version="1.0"?>
39358 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "osdata.dtd">
39359 <osdata type="processes">
39360 <item>
39361 <column name="pid">1</column>
39362 <column name="user">root</column>
39363 <column name="command">/sbin/init</column>
39364 <column name="cores">1,2,3</column>
39365 </item>
39366 </osdata>
39367 @end smallexample
39368
39369 Each item should include a column whose name is @samp{pid}. The value
39370 of that column should identify the process on the target. The
39371 @samp{user} and @samp{command} columns are optional, and will be
39372 displayed by @value{GDBN}. The @samp{cores} column, if present,
39373 should contain a comma-separated list of cores that this process
39374 is running on. Target may provide additional columns,
39375 which @value{GDBN} currently ignores.
39376
39377 @node Trace File Format
39378 @appendix Trace File Format
39379 @cindex trace file format
39380
39381 The trace file comes in three parts: a header, a textual description
39382 section, and a trace frame section with binary data.
39383
39384 The header has the form @code{\x7fTRACE0\n}. The first byte is
39385 @code{0x7f} so as to indicate that the file contains binary data,
39386 while the @code{0} is a version number that may have different values
39387 in the future.
39388
39389 The description section consists of multiple lines of @sc{ascii} text
39390 separated by newline characters (@code{0xa}). The lines may include a
39391 variety of optional descriptive or context-setting information, such
39392 as tracepoint definitions or register set size. @value{GDBN} will
39393 ignore any line that it does not recognize. An empty line marks the end
39394 of this section.
39395
39396 @c FIXME add some specific types of data
39397
39398 The trace frame section consists of a number of consecutive frames.
39399 Each frame begins with a two-byte tracepoint number, followed by a
39400 four-byte size giving the amount of data in the frame. The data in
39401 the frame consists of a number of blocks, each introduced by a
39402 character indicating its type (at least register, memory, and trace
39403 state variable). The data in this section is raw binary, not a
39404 hexadecimal or other encoding; its endianness matches the target's
39405 endianness.
39406
39407 @c FIXME bi-arch may require endianness/arch info in description section
39408
39409 @table @code
39410 @item R @var{bytes}
39411 Register block. The number and ordering of bytes matches that of a
39412 @code{g} packet in the remote protocol. Note that these are the
39413 actual bytes, in target order and @value{GDBN} register order, not a
39414 hexadecimal encoding.
39415
39416 @item M @var{address} @var{length} @var{bytes}...
39417 Memory block. This is a contiguous block of memory, at the 8-byte
39418 address @var{address}, with a 2-byte length @var{length}, followed by
39419 @var{length} bytes.
39420
39421 @item V @var{number} @var{value}
39422 Trace state variable block. This records the 8-byte signed value
39423 @var{value} of trace state variable numbered @var{number}.
39424
39425 @end table
39426
39427 Future enhancements of the trace file format may include additional types
39428 of blocks.
39429
39430 @node Index Section Format
39431 @appendix @code{.gdb_index} section format
39432 @cindex .gdb_index section format
39433 @cindex index section format
39434
39435 This section documents the index section that is created by @code{save
39436 gdb-index} (@pxref{Index Files}). The index section is
39437 DWARF-specific; some knowledge of DWARF is assumed in this
39438 description.
39439
39440 The mapped index file format is designed to be directly
39441 @code{mmap}able on any architecture. In most cases, a datum is
39442 represented using a little-endian 32-bit integer value, called an
39443 @code{offset_type}. Big endian machines must byte-swap the values
39444 before using them. Exceptions to this rule are noted. The data is
39445 laid out such that alignment is always respected.
39446
39447 A mapped index consists of several areas, laid out in order.
39448
39449 @enumerate
39450 @item
39451 The file header. This is a sequence of values, of @code{offset_type}
39452 unless otherwise noted:
39453
39454 @enumerate
39455 @item
39456 The version number, currently 8. Versions 1, 2 and 3 are obsolete.
39457 Version 4 uses a different hashing function from versions 5 and 6.
39458 Version 6 includes symbols for inlined functions, whereas versions 4
39459 and 5 do not. Version 7 adds attributes to the CU indices in the
39460 symbol table. Version 8 specifies that symbols from DWARF type units
39461 (@samp{DW_TAG_type_unit}) refer to the type unit's symbol table and not the
39462 compilation unit (@samp{DW_TAG_comp_unit}) using the type.
39463
39464 @value{GDBN} will only read version 4, 5, or 6 indices
39465 by specifying @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
39466 GDB has a workaround for potentially broken version 7 indices so it is
39467 currently not flagged as deprecated.
39468
39469 @item
39470 The offset, from the start of the file, of the CU list.
39471
39472 @item
39473 The offset, from the start of the file, of the types CU list. Note
39474 that this area can be empty, in which case this offset will be equal
39475 to the next offset.
39476
39477 @item
39478 The offset, from the start of the file, of the address area.
39479
39480 @item
39481 The offset, from the start of the file, of the symbol table.
39482
39483 @item
39484 The offset, from the start of the file, of the constant pool.
39485 @end enumerate
39486
39487 @item
39488 The CU list. This is a sequence of pairs of 64-bit little-endian
39489 values, sorted by the CU offset. The first element in each pair is
39490 the offset of a CU in the @code{.debug_info} section. The second
39491 element in each pair is the length of that CU. References to a CU
39492 elsewhere in the map are done using a CU index, which is just the
39493 0-based index into this table. Note that if there are type CUs, then
39494 conceptually CUs and type CUs form a single list for the purposes of
39495 CU indices.
39496
39497 @item
39498 The types CU list. This is a sequence of triplets of 64-bit
39499 little-endian values. In a triplet, the first value is the CU offset,
39500 the second value is the type offset in the CU, and the third value is
39501 the type signature. The types CU list is not sorted.
39502
39503 @item
39504 The address area. The address area consists of a sequence of address
39505 entries. Each address entry has three elements:
39506
39507 @enumerate
39508 @item
39509 The low address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value.
39510
39511 @item
39512 The high address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value. Like
39513 @code{DW_AT_high_pc}, the value is one byte beyond the end.
39514
39515 @item
39516 The CU index. This is an @code{offset_type} value.
39517 @end enumerate
39518
39519 @item
39520 The symbol table. This is an open-addressed hash table. The size of
39521 the hash table is always a power of 2.
39522
39523 Each slot in the hash table consists of a pair of @code{offset_type}
39524 values. The first value is the offset of the symbol's name in the
39525 constant pool. The second value is the offset of the CU vector in the
39526 constant pool.
39527
39528 If both values are 0, then this slot in the hash table is empty. This
39529 is ok because while 0 is a valid constant pool index, it cannot be a
39530 valid index for both a string and a CU vector.
39531
39532 The hash value for a table entry is computed by applying an
39533 iterative hash function to the symbol's name. Starting with an
39534 initial value of @code{r = 0}, each (unsigned) character @samp{c} in
39535 the string is incorporated into the hash using the formula depending on the
39536 index version:
39537
39538 @table @asis
39539 @item Version 4
39540 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + c - 113}.
39541
39542 @item Versions 5 to 7
39543 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + tolower (c) - 113}.
39544 @end table
39545
39546 The terminating @samp{\0} is not incorporated into the hash.
39547
39548 The step size used in the hash table is computed via
39549 @code{((hash * 17) & (size - 1)) | 1}, where @samp{hash} is the hash
39550 value, and @samp{size} is the size of the hash table. The step size
39551 is used to find the next candidate slot when handling a hash
39552 collision.
39553
39554 The names of C@t{++} symbols in the hash table are canonicalized. We
39555 don't currently have a simple description of the canonicalization
39556 algorithm; if you intend to create new index sections, you must read
39557 the code.
39558
39559 @item
39560 The constant pool. This is simply a bunch of bytes. It is organized
39561 so that alignment is correct: CU vectors are stored first, followed by
39562 strings.
39563
39564 A CU vector in the constant pool is a sequence of @code{offset_type}
39565 values. The first value is the number of CU indices in the vector.
39566 Each subsequent value is the index and symbol attributes of a CU in
39567 the CU list. This element in the hash table is used to indicate which
39568 CUs define the symbol and how the symbol is used.
39569 See below for the format of each CU index+attributes entry.
39570
39571 A string in the constant pool is zero-terminated.
39572 @end enumerate
39573
39574 Attributes were added to CU index values in @code{.gdb_index} version 7.
39575 If a symbol has multiple uses within a CU then there is one
39576 CU index+attributes value for each use.
39577
39578 The format of each CU index+attributes entry is as follows
39579 (bit 0 = LSB):
39580
39581 @table @asis
39582
39583 @item Bits 0-23
39584 This is the index of the CU in the CU list.
39585 @item Bits 24-27
39586 These bits are reserved for future purposes and must be zero.
39587 @item Bits 28-30
39588 The kind of the symbol in the CU.
39589
39590 @table @asis
39591 @item 0
39592 This value is reserved and should not be used.
39593 By reserving zero the full @code{offset_type} value is backwards compatible
39594 with previous versions of the index.
39595 @item 1
39596 The symbol is a type.
39597 @item 2
39598 The symbol is a variable or an enum value.
39599 @item 3
39600 The symbol is a function.
39601 @item 4
39602 Any other kind of symbol.
39603 @item 5,6,7
39604 These values are reserved.
39605 @end table
39606
39607 @item Bit 31
39608 This bit is zero if the value is global and one if it is static.
39609
39610 The determination of whether a symbol is global or static is complicated.
39611 The authorative reference is the file @file{dwarf2read.c} in
39612 @value{GDBN} sources.
39613
39614 @end table
39615
39616 This pseudo-code describes the computation of a symbol's kind and
39617 global/static attributes in the index.
39618
39619 @smallexample
39620 is_external = get_attribute (die, DW_AT_external);
39621 language = get_attribute (cu_die, DW_AT_language);
39622 switch (die->tag)
39623 @{
39624 case DW_TAG_typedef:
39625 case DW_TAG_base_type:
39626 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
39627 kind = TYPE;
39628 is_static = 1;
39629 break;
39630 case DW_TAG_enumerator:
39631 kind = VARIABLE;
39632 is_static = (language != CPLUS && language != JAVA);
39633 break;
39634 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
39635 kind = FUNCTION;
39636 is_static = ! (is_external || language == ADA);
39637 break;
39638 case DW_TAG_constant:
39639 kind = VARIABLE;
39640 is_static = ! is_external;
39641 break;
39642 case DW_TAG_variable:
39643 kind = VARIABLE;
39644 is_static = ! is_external;
39645 break;
39646 case DW_TAG_namespace:
39647 kind = TYPE;
39648 is_static = 0;
39649 break;
39650 case DW_TAG_class_type:
39651 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
39652 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
39653 case DW_TAG_union_type:
39654 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
39655 kind = TYPE;
39656 is_static = (language != CPLUS && language != JAVA);
39657 break;
39658 default:
39659 assert (0);
39660 @}
39661 @end smallexample
39662
39663 @node Man Pages
39664 @appendix Manual pages
39665 @cindex Man pages
39666
39667 @menu
39668 * gdb man:: The GNU Debugger man page
39669 * gdbserver man:: Remote Server for the GNU Debugger man page
39670 * gcore man:: Generate a core file of a running program
39671 * gdbinit man:: gdbinit scripts
39672 @end menu
39673
39674 @node gdb man
39675 @heading gdb man
39676
39677 @c man title gdb The GNU Debugger
39678
39679 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdb
39680 gdb [@option{-help}] [@option{-nh}] [@option{-nx}] [@option{-q}]
39681 [@option{-batch}] [@option{-cd=}@var{dir}] [@option{-f}]
39682 [@option{-b}@w{ }@var{bps}]
39683 [@option{-tty=}@var{dev}] [@option{-s} @var{symfile}]
39684 [@option{-e}@w{ }@var{prog}] [@option{-se}@w{ }@var{prog}]
39685 [@option{-c}@w{ }@var{core}] [@option{-p}@w{ }@var{procID}]
39686 [@option{-x}@w{ }@var{cmds}] [@option{-d}@w{ }@var{dir}]
39687 [@var{prog}|@var{prog} @var{procID}|@var{prog} @var{core}]
39688 @c man end
39689
39690 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdb
39691 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
39692 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes -- or what another
39693 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
39694
39695 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
39696 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
39697
39698 @itemize @bullet
39699 @item
39700 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
39701
39702 @item
39703 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
39704
39705 @item
39706 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
39707
39708 @item
39709 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
39710 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
39711 @end itemize
39712
39713 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C, C@t{++}, Fortran and
39714 Modula-2.
39715
39716 @value{GDBN} is invoked with the shell command @code{gdb}. Once started, it reads
39717 commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit with the @value{GDBN}
39718 command @code{quit}. You can get online help from @value{GDBN} itself
39719 by using the command @code{help}.
39720
39721 You can run @code{gdb} with no arguments or options; but the most
39722 usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument or two, specifying an
39723 executable program as the argument:
39724
39725 @smallexample
39726 gdb program
39727 @end smallexample
39728
39729 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file specified:
39730
39731 @smallexample
39732 gdb program core
39733 @end smallexample
39734
39735 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
39736 to debug a running process:
39737
39738 @smallexample
39739 gdb program 1234
39740 gdb -p 1234
39741 @end smallexample
39742
39743 @noindent
39744 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
39745 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
39746 With option @option{-p} you can omit the @var{program} filename.
39747
39748 Here are some of the most frequently needed @value{GDBN} commands:
39749
39750 @c pod2man highlights the right hand side of the @item lines.
39751 @table @env
39752 @item break [@var{file}:]@var{functiop}
39753 Set a breakpoint at @var{function} (in @var{file}).
39754
39755 @item run [@var{arglist}]
39756 Start your program (with @var{arglist}, if specified).
39757
39758 @item bt
39759 Backtrace: display the program stack.
39760
39761 @item print @var{expr}
39762 Display the value of an expression.
39763
39764 @item c
39765 Continue running your program (after stopping, e.g. at a breakpoint).
39766
39767 @item next
39768 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{over} any
39769 function calls in the line.
39770
39771 @item edit [@var{file}:]@var{function}
39772 look at the program line where it is presently stopped.
39773
39774 @item list [@var{file}:]@var{function}
39775 type the text of the program in the vicinity of where it is presently stopped.
39776
39777 @item step
39778 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{into} any
39779 function calls in the line.
39780
39781 @item help [@var{name}]
39782 Show information about @value{GDBN} command @var{name}, or general information
39783 about using @value{GDBN}.
39784
39785 @item quit
39786 Exit from @value{GDBN}.
39787 @end table
39788
39789 @ifset man
39790 For full details on @value{GDBN},
39791 see @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
39792 by Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch. The same text is available online
39793 as the @code{gdb} entry in the @code{info} program.
39794 @end ifset
39795 @c man end
39796
39797 @c man begin OPTIONS gdb
39798 Any arguments other than options specify an executable
39799 file and core file (or process ID); that is, the first argument
39800 encountered with no
39801 associated option flag is equivalent to a @option{-se} option, and the second,
39802 if any, is equivalent to a @option{-c} option if it's the name of a file.
39803 Many options have
39804 both long and short forms; both are shown here. The long forms are also
39805 recognized if you truncate them, so long as enough of the option is
39806 present to be unambiguous. (If you prefer, you can flag option
39807 arguments with @option{+} rather than @option{-}, though we illustrate the
39808 more usual convention.)
39809
39810 All the options and command line arguments you give are processed
39811 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the @option{-x}
39812 option is used.
39813
39814 @table @env
39815 @item -help
39816 @itemx -h
39817 List all options, with brief explanations.
39818
39819 @item -symbols=@var{file}
39820 @itemx -s @var{file}
39821 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
39822
39823 @item -write
39824 Enable writing into executable and core files.
39825
39826 @item -exec=@var{file}
39827 @itemx -e @var{file}
39828 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when
39829 appropriate, and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core
39830 dump.
39831
39832 @item -se=@var{file}
39833 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
39834 file.
39835
39836 @item -core=@var{file}
39837 @itemx -c @var{file}
39838 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
39839
39840 @item -command=@var{file}
39841 @itemx -x @var{file}
39842 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}.
39843
39844 @item -ex @var{command}
39845 Execute given @value{GDBN} @var{command}.
39846
39847 @item -directory=@var{directory}
39848 @itemx -d @var{directory}
39849 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
39850
39851 @item -nh
39852 Do not execute commands from @file{~/.gdbinit}.
39853
39854 @item -nx
39855 @itemx -n
39856 Do not execute commands from any @file{.gdbinit} initialization files.
39857
39858 @item -quiet
39859 @itemx -q
39860 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
39861 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
39862
39863 @item -batch
39864 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the command
39865 files specified with @option{-x} (and @file{.gdbinit}, if not inhibited).
39866 Exit with nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN}
39867 commands in the command files.
39868
39869 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for example to
39870 download and run a program on another computer; in order to make this
39871 more useful, the message
39872
39873 @smallexample
39874 Program exited normally.
39875 @end smallexample
39876
39877 @noindent
39878 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under @value{GDBN} control
39879 terminates) is not issued when running in batch mode.
39880
39881 @item -cd=@var{directory}
39882 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
39883 instead of the current directory.
39884
39885 @item -fullname
39886 @itemx -f
39887 Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells
39888 @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line number in a standard,
39889 recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is displayed (which
39890 includes each time the program stops). This recognizable format looks
39891 like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by the file name, line number
39892 and character position separated by colons, and a newline. The
39893 Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two @samp{\032}
39894 characters as a signal to display the source code for the frame.
39895
39896 @item -b @var{bps}
39897 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
39898 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
39899
39900 @item -tty=@var{device}
39901 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
39902 @end table
39903 @c man end
39904
39905 @c man begin SEEALSO gdb
39906 @ifset man
39907 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
39908 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
39909 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
39910
39911 @smallexample
39912 info gdb
39913 @end smallexample
39914
39915 @noindent
39916 should give you access to the complete manual.
39917
39918 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
39919 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
39920 @end ifset
39921 @c man end
39922
39923 @node gdbserver man
39924 @heading gdbserver man
39925
39926 @c man title gdbserver Remote Server for the GNU Debugger
39927 @format
39928 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbserver
39929 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
39930
39931 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
39932
39933 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
39934 @c man end
39935 @end format
39936
39937 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbserver
39938 @command{gdbserver} is a program that allows you to run @value{GDBN} on a different machine
39939 than the one which is running the program being debugged.
39940
39941 @ifclear man
39942 @subheading Usage (server (target) side)
39943 @end ifclear
39944 @ifset man
39945 Usage (server (target) side):
39946 @end ifset
39947
39948 First, you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug put onto
39949 the target system. The program can be stripped to save space if needed, as
39950 @command{gdbserver} doesn't care about symbols. All symbol handling is taken care of by
39951 the @value{GDBN} running on the host system.
39952
39953 To use the server, you log on to the target system, and run the @command{gdbserver}
39954 program. You must tell it (a) how to communicate with @value{GDBN}, (b) the name of
39955 your program, and (c) its arguments. The general syntax is:
39956
39957 @smallexample
39958 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [@var{args} ...]
39959 @end smallexample
39960
39961 For example, using a serial port, you might say:
39962
39963 @smallexample
39964 @ifset man
39965 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/com1>.
39966 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
39967 @end ifset
39968 @ifclear man
39969 target> gdbserver @file{/dev/com1} emacs foo.txt
39970 @end ifclear
39971 @end smallexample
39972
39973 This tells @command{gdbserver} to debug emacs with an argument of foo.txt, and
39974 to communicate with @value{GDBN} via @file{/dev/com1}. @command{gdbserver} now
39975 waits patiently for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate with it.
39976
39977 To use a TCP connection, you could say:
39978
39979 @smallexample
39980 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
39981 @end smallexample
39982
39983 This says pretty much the same thing as the last example, except that we are
39984 going to communicate with the @code{host} @value{GDBN} via TCP. The @code{host:2345} argument means
39985 that we are expecting to see a TCP connection from @code{host} to local TCP port
39986 2345. (Currently, the @code{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number you
39987 want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any existing TCP
39988 ports on the target system. This same port number must be used in the host
39989 @value{GDBN}s @code{target remote} command, which will be described shortly. Note that if
39990 you chose a port number that conflicts with another service, @command{gdbserver} will
39991 print an error message and exit.
39992
39993 @command{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
39994 This is accomplished via the @option{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
39995
39996 @smallexample
39997 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
39998 @end smallexample
39999
40000 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
40001 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
40002
40003 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
40004 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
40005 In such case you should connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} to start
40006 the program you want to debug.
40007
40008 @smallexample
40009 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
40010 @end smallexample
40011
40012 @ifclear man
40013 @subheading Usage (host side)
40014 @end ifclear
40015 @ifset man
40016 Usage (host side):
40017 @end ifset
40018
40019 You need an unstripped copy of the target program on your host system, since
40020 @value{GDBN} needs to examine it's symbol tables and such. Start up @value{GDBN} as you normally
40021 would, with the target program as the first argument. (You may need to use the
40022 @option{--baud} option if the serial line is running at anything except 9600 baud.)
40023 That is @code{gdb TARGET-PROG}, or @code{gdb --baud BAUD TARGET-PROG}. After that, the only
40024 new command you need to know about is @code{target remote}
40025 (or @code{target extended-remote}). Its argument is either
40026 a device name (usually a serial device, like @file{/dev/ttyb}), or a @code{HOST:PORT}
40027 descriptor. For example:
40028
40029 @smallexample
40030 @ifset man
40031 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/ttyb>.
40032 (gdb) target remote /dev/ttyb
40033 @end ifset
40034 @ifclear man
40035 (gdb) target remote @file{/dev/ttyb}
40036 @end ifclear
40037 @end smallexample
40038
40039 @noindent
40040 communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and:
40041
40042 @smallexample
40043 (gdb) target remote the-target:2345
40044 @end smallexample
40045
40046 @noindent
40047 communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host `the-target', where
40048 you previously started up @command{gdbserver} with the same port number. Note that for
40049 TCP connections, you must start up @command{gdbserver} prior to using the `target remote'
40050 command, otherwise you may get an error that looks something like
40051 `Connection refused'.
40052
40053 @command{gdbserver} can also debug multiple inferiors at once,
40054 described in
40055 @ifset man
40056 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Inferiors and Programs}
40057 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Inferiors and Programs'}.
40058 @end ifset
40059 @ifclear man
40060 @ref{Inferiors and Programs}.
40061 @end ifclear
40062 In such case use the @code{extended-remote} @value{GDBN} command variant:
40063
40064 @smallexample
40065 (gdb) target extended-remote the-target:2345
40066 @end smallexample
40067
40068 The @command{gdbserver} option @option{--multi} may or may not be used in such
40069 case.
40070 @c man end
40071
40072 @c man begin OPTIONS gdbserver
40073 There are three different modes for invoking @command{gdbserver}:
40074
40075 @itemize @bullet
40076
40077 @item
40078 Debug a specific program specified by its program name:
40079
40080 @smallexample
40081 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
40082 @end smallexample
40083
40084 The @var{comm} parameter specifies how should the server communicate
40085 with @value{GDBN}; it is either a device name (to use a serial line),
40086 a TCP port number (@code{:1234}), or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
40087 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}. Specify the name of the program to
40088 debug in @var{prog}. Any remaining arguments will be passed to the
40089 program verbatim. When the program exits, @value{GDBN} will close the
40090 connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
40091
40092 @item
40093 Debug a specific program by specifying the process ID of a running
40094 program:
40095
40096 @smallexample
40097 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
40098 @end smallexample
40099
40100 The @var{comm} parameter is as described above. Supply the process ID
40101 of a running program in @var{pid}; @value{GDBN} will do everything
40102 else. Like with the previous mode, when the process @var{pid} exits,
40103 @value{GDBN} will close the connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
40104
40105 @item
40106 Multi-process mode -- debug more than one program/process:
40107
40108 @smallexample
40109 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
40110 @end smallexample
40111
40112 In this mode, @value{GDBN} can instruct @command{gdbserver} which
40113 command(s) to run. Unlike the other 2 modes, @value{GDBN} will not
40114 close the connection when a process being debugged exits, so you can
40115 debug several processes in the same session.
40116 @end itemize
40117
40118 In each of the modes you may specify these options:
40119
40120 @table @env
40121
40122 @item --help
40123 List all options, with brief explanations.
40124
40125 @item --version
40126 This option causes @command{gdbserver} to print its version number and exit.
40127
40128 @item --attach
40129 @command{gdbserver} will attach to a running program. The syntax is:
40130
40131 @smallexample
40132 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
40133 @end smallexample
40134
40135 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
40136 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
40137
40138 @item --multi
40139 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
40140 or process ID to attach, use this command line option.
40141 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
40142 the program you want to debug. The syntax is:
40143
40144 @smallexample
40145 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
40146 @end smallexample
40147
40148 @item --debug
40149 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display extra status information about the debugging
40150 process.
40151 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
40152 the developers.
40153
40154 @item --remote-debug
40155 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display remote protocol debug output.
40156 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
40157 the developers.
40158
40159 @item --debug-format=option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
40160 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to include extra information in each line
40161 of debugging output.
40162 @xref{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}.
40163
40164 @item --wrapper
40165 Specify a wrapper to launch programs
40166 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
40167 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
40168 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
40169
40170 @item --once
40171 By default, @command{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
40172 additional connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
40173 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
40174 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session.
40175
40176 @c --disable-packet is not documented for users.
40177
40178 @c --disable-randomization and --no-disable-randomization are superseded by
40179 @c QDisableRandomization.
40180
40181 @end table
40182 @c man end
40183
40184 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbserver
40185 @ifset man
40186 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
40187 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
40188 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
40189
40190 @smallexample
40191 info gdb
40192 @end smallexample
40193
40194 should give you access to the complete manual.
40195
40196 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
40197 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
40198 @end ifset
40199 @c man end
40200
40201 @node gcore man
40202 @heading gcore
40203
40204 @c man title gcore Generate a core file of a running program
40205
40206 @format
40207 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gcore
40208 gcore [-o @var{filename}] @var{pid}
40209 @c man end
40210 @end format
40211
40212 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gcore
40213 Generate a core dump of a running program with process ID @var{pid}.
40214 Produced file is equivalent to a kernel produced core file as if the process
40215 crashed (and if @kbd{ulimit -c} were used to set up an appropriate core dump
40216 limit). Unlike after a crash, after @command{gcore} the program remains
40217 running without any change.
40218 @c man end
40219
40220 @c man begin OPTIONS gcore
40221 @table @env
40222 @item -o @var{filename}
40223 The optional argument
40224 @var{filename} specifies the file name where to put the core dump.
40225 If not specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}},
40226 where @var{pid} is the running program process ID.
40227 @end table
40228 @c man end
40229
40230 @c man begin SEEALSO gcore
40231 @ifset man
40232 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
40233 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
40234 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
40235
40236 @smallexample
40237 info gdb
40238 @end smallexample
40239
40240 @noindent
40241 should give you access to the complete manual.
40242
40243 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
40244 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
40245 @end ifset
40246 @c man end
40247
40248 @node gdbinit man
40249 @heading gdbinit
40250
40251 @c man title gdbinit GDB initialization scripts
40252
40253 @format
40254 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbinit
40255 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
40256 @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
40257 @end ifset
40258
40259 ~/.gdbinit
40260
40261 ./.gdbinit
40262 @c man end
40263 @end format
40264
40265 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbinit
40266 These files contain @value{GDBN} commands to automatically execute during
40267 @value{GDBN} startup. The lines of contents are canned sequences of commands,
40268 described in
40269 @ifset man
40270 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Sequences}
40271 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Sequences}.
40272 @end ifset
40273 @ifclear man
40274 @ref{Sequences}.
40275 @end ifclear
40276
40277 Please read more in
40278 @ifset man
40279 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Startup}
40280 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}.
40281 @end ifset
40282 @ifclear man
40283 @ref{Startup}.
40284 @end ifclear
40285
40286 @table @env
40287 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
40288 @item @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
40289 @end ifset
40290 @ifclear SYSTEM_GDBINIT
40291 @item (not enabled with @code{--with-system-gdbinit} during compilation)
40292 @end ifclear
40293 System-wide initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
40294 @value{GDBN} option @code{-nx} or @code{-n}.
40295 See more in
40296 @ifset man
40297 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{System-wide configuration}
40298 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'System-wide configuration'}.
40299 @end ifset
40300 @ifclear man
40301 @ref{System-wide configuration}.
40302 @end ifclear
40303
40304 @item ~/.gdbinit
40305 User initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
40306 @value{GDBN} options @code{-nx}, @code{-n} or @code{-nh}.
40307
40308 @item ./.gdbinit
40309 Initialization file for current directory. It may need to be enabled with
40310 @value{GDBN} security command @code{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
40311 See more in
40312 @ifset man
40313 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Init File in the Current Directory}
40314 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Init File in the Current Directory'}.
40315 @end ifset
40316 @ifclear man
40317 @ref{Init File in the Current Directory}.
40318 @end ifclear
40319 @end table
40320 @c man end
40321
40322 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbinit
40323 @ifset man
40324 gdb(1), @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}
40325
40326 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
40327 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
40328 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
40329
40330 @smallexample
40331 info gdb
40332 @end smallexample
40333
40334 should give you access to the complete manual.
40335
40336 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
40337 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
40338 @end ifset
40339 @c man end
40340
40341 @include gpl.texi
40342
40343 @node GNU Free Documentation License
40344 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
40345 @include fdl.texi
40346
40347 @node Concept Index
40348 @unnumbered Concept Index
40349
40350 @printindex cp
40351
40352 @node Command and Variable Index
40353 @unnumbered Command, Variable, and Function Index
40354
40355 @printindex fn
40356
40357 @tex
40358 % I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
40359 % meantime:
40360 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
40361 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
40362 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
40363 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
40364 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
40365 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
40366 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
40367 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
40368 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
40369 \page\colophon
40370 % Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 1991.
40371 @end tex
40372
40373 @bye
This page took 0.92336 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.